diff options
Diffstat (limited to 'docs/htmldocs')
51 files changed, 16280 insertions, 0 deletions
diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/AccessControls.html b/docs/htmldocs/AccessControls.html new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..9a15b01948 --- /dev/null +++ b/docs/htmldocs/AccessControls.html @@ -0,0 +1,652 @@ +<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>Chapter 13. File, Directory and Share Access Controls</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.60.1"><link rel="home" href="index.html" title="SAMBA Project Documentation"><link rel="up" href="optional.html" title="Part III. Advanced Configuration"><link rel="previous" href="groupmapping.html" title="Chapter 12. Group Mapping MS Windows and UNIX"><link rel="next" href="locking.html" title="Chapter 14. File and Record Locking"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="navheader"><table width="100%" summary="Navigation header"><tr><th colspan="3" align="center">Chapter 13. File, Directory and Share Access Controls</th></tr><tr><td width="20%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="groupmapping.html">Prev</a> </td><th width="60%" align="center">Part III. Advanced Configuration</th><td width="20%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="locking.html">Next</a></td></tr></table><hr></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="AccessControls"></a>Chapter 13. File, Directory and Share Access Controls</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">John</span> <span class="othername">H.</span> <span class="surname">Terpstra</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org">jht@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Jeremy</span> <span class="surname">Allison</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jra@samba.org">jra@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Jelmer</span> <span class="othername">R.</span> <span class="surname">Vernooij</span></h3><span class="contrib">drawing</span><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">The Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jelmer@samba.org">jelmer@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><p class="pubdate">May 10, 2003</p></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="AccessControls.html#id2911341">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="AccessControls.html#id2911525">File System Access Controls</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="AccessControls.html#id2911543">MS Windows NTFS Comparison with UNIX File Systems</a></dt><dt><a href="AccessControls.html#id2911956">Managing Directories</a></dt><dt><a href="AccessControls.html#id2912050">File and Directory Access Control</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="AccessControls.html#id2912290">Share Definition Access Controls</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="AccessControls.html#id2912329">User and Group-Based Controls</a></dt><dt><a href="AccessControls.html#id2912779">File and Directory Permissions-Based Controls</a></dt><dt><a href="AccessControls.html#id2913187">Miscellaneous Controls</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="AccessControls.html#id2913585">Access Controls on Shares</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="AccessControls.html#id2913670">Share Permissions Management</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="AccessControls.html#id2913978">MS Windows Access Control Lists and UNIX Interoperability</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="AccessControls.html#id2913986">Managing UNIX Permissions Using NT Security Dialogs</a></dt><dt><a href="AccessControls.html#id2914042">Viewing File Security on a Samba Share</a></dt><dt><a href="AccessControls.html#id2914124">Viewing File Ownership</a></dt><dt><a href="AccessControls.html#id2914264">Viewing File or Directory Permissions</a></dt><dt><a href="AccessControls.html#id2914515">Modifying File or Directory Permissions</a></dt><dt><a href="AccessControls.html#id2914698">Interaction with the Standard Samba create mask Parameters</a></dt><dt><a href="AccessControls.html#id2915106">Interaction with the Standard Samba File Attribute Mapping</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="AccessControls.html#id2915195">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="AccessControls.html#id2915209">Users Cannot Write to a Public Share</a></dt><dt><a href="AccessControls.html#id2915635">File Operations Done as root with force user Set</a></dt><dt><a href="AccessControls.html#id2915690">MS Word with Samba Changes Owner of File</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></div><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2911255"></a> +Advanced MS Windows users are frequently perplexed when file, directory and share manipulation of +resources shared via Samba do not behave in the manner they might expect. MS Windows network +administrators are often confused regarding network access controls and how to +provide users with the access they need while protecting resources from unauthorized access. +</p><p> +Many UNIX administrators are unfamiliar with the MS Windows environment and in particular +have difficulty in visualizing what the MS Windows user wishes to achieve in attempts to set file +and directory access permissions. +</p><p> +The problem lies in the differences in how file and directory permissions and controls work +between the two environments. This difference is one that Samba cannot completely hide, even +though it does try to bridge the chasm to a degree. +</p><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2911291"></a> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2911300"></a> + +POSIX Access Control List technology has been available (along with Extended Attributes) +for UNIX for many years, yet there is little evidence today of any significant use. This +explains to some extent the slow adoption of ACLs into commercial Linux products. MS Windows +administrators are astounded at this, given that ACLs were a foundational capability of the now +decade-old MS Windows NT operating system. +</p><p> +The purpose of this chapter is to present each of the points of control that are possible with +Samba-3 in the hope that this will help the network administrator to find the optimum method +for delivering the best environment for MS Windows desktop users. +</p><p> +This is an opportune point to mention that Samba was created to provide a means of interoperability +and interchange of data between differing operating environments. Samba has no intent to change +UNIX/Linux into a platform like MS Windows. Instead the purpose was and is to provide a sufficient +level of exchange of data between the two environments. What is available today extends well +beyond early plans and expectations, yet the gap continues to shrink. +</p><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2911341"></a>Features and Benefits</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> + Samba offers a lot of flexibility in file system access management. These are the key access control + facilities present in Samba today: + </p><div class="itemizedlist"><p class="title"><b>Samba Access Control Facilities</b></p><ul type="disc"><li><p> + <a class="indexterm" name="id2911368"></a> + <span class="emphasis"><em>UNIX File and Directory Permissions</em></span> + </p><p> + Samba honors and implements UNIX file system access controls. Users + who access a Samba server will do so as a particular MS Windows user. + This information is passed to the Samba server as part of the logon or + connection setup process. Samba uses this user identity to validate + whether or not the user should be given access to file system resources + (files and directories). This chapter provides an overview for those + to whom the UNIX permissions and controls are a little strange or unknown. + </p></li><li><p> + <span class="emphasis"><em>Samba Share Definitions</em></span> + </p><p> + In configuring share settings and controls in the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file, + the network administrator can exercise overrides to native file + system permissions and behaviors. This can be handy and convenient + to effect behavior that is more like what MS Windows NT users expect + but it is seldom the <span class="emphasis"><em>best</em></span> way to achieve this. + The basic options and techniques are described herein. + </p></li><li><p> + <span class="emphasis"><em>Samba Share ACLs</em></span> + <a class="indexterm" name="id2911453"></a> + </p><p> + Just like it is possible in MS Windows NT to set ACLs on shares + themselves, so it is possible to do this in Samba. + Few people make use of this facility, yet it remains on of the + easiest ways to affect access controls (restrictions) and can often + do so with minimum invasiveness compared with other methods. + </p></li><li><p> + <a class="indexterm" name="id2911481"></a> + <a class="indexterm" name="id2911492"></a> + <span class="emphasis"><em>MS Windows ACLs through UNIX POSIX ACLs</em></span> + </p><p> + The use of POSIX ACLs on UNIX/Linux is possible only if the underlying + operating system supports them. If not, then this option will not be + available to you. Current UNIX technology platforms have native support + for POSIX ACLs. There are patches for the Linux kernel that also provide + this. Sadly, few Linux platforms ship today with native ACLs and + Extended Attributes enabled. This chapter has pertinent information + for users of platforms that support them. + </p></li></ul></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2911525"></a>File System Access Controls</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +Perhaps the most important recognition to be made is the simple fact that MS Windows NT4/200x/XP +implement a totally divergent file system technology from what is provided in the UNIX operating system +environment. First we consider what the most significant differences are, then we look +at how Samba helps to bridge the differences. +</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2911543"></a>MS Windows NTFS Comparison with UNIX File Systems</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2911555"></a> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2911563"></a> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2911571"></a> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2911582"></a> + + Samba operates on top of the UNIX file system. This means it is subject to UNIX file system conventions + and permissions. It also means that if the MS Windows networking environment requires file system + behavior that differs from UNIX file system behavior then somehow Samba is responsible for emulating + that in a transparent and consistent manner. + </p><p> + It is good news that Samba does this to a large extent and on top of that provides a high degree + of optional configuration to override the default behavior. We look at some of these over-rides, + but for the greater part we will stay within the bounds of default behavior. Those wishing to explore + the depths of control ability should review the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> man page. + </p><p>The following compares file system features for UNIX with those of Microsoft Windows NT/200x: + <a class="indexterm" name="id2911624"></a> + + </p><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">Name Space</span></dt><dd><p> + MS Windows NT4/200x/XP files names may be up to 254 characters long, and UNIX file names + may be 1023 characters long. In MS Windows, file extensions indicate particular file types, + in UNIX this is not so rigorously observed as all names are considered arbitrary. + </p><p> + What MS Windows calls a folder, UNIX calls a directory. + </p></dd><dt><span class="term">Case Sensitivity</span></dt><dd><p> + <a class="indexterm" name="id2911680"></a> + <a class="indexterm" name="id2911689"></a> + MS Windows file names are generally upper case if made up of 8.3 (8 character file name + and 3 character extension. File names that are longer than 8.3 are case preserving and case + insensitive. + </p><p> + UNIX file and directory names are case sensitive and case preserving. Samba implements the + MS Windows file name behavior, but it does so as a user application. The UNIX file system + provides no mechanism to perform case insensitive file name lookups. MS Windows does this + by default. This means that Samba has to carry the processing overhead to provide features + that are not native to the UNIX operating system environment. + </p><p> + Consider the following. All are unique UNIX names but one single MS Windows file name: + </p><pre class="screen"> + MYFILE.TXT + MyFile.txt + myfile.txt + </pre><p> + So clearly, in an MS Windows file name space these three files cannot co-exist, but in UNIX + they can. + </p><p> + So what should Samba do if all three are present? That which is lexically first will be + accessible to MS Windows users, the others are invisible and unaccessible any + other solution would be suicidal. + </p></dd><dt><span class="term">Directory Separators</span></dt><dd><p> + <a class="indexterm" name="id2911762"></a> + MS Windows and DOS uses the backslash <tt class="constant">\</tt> as a directory delimiter, and UNIX uses + the forward-slash <tt class="constant">/</tt> as its directory delimiter. This is handled transparently by Samba. + </p></dd><dt><span class="term">Drive Identification</span></dt><dd><p> + <a class="indexterm" name="id2911799"></a> + MS Windows products support a notion of drive letters, like <b class="command">C:</b> to represent + disk partitions. UNIX has no concept of separate identifiers for file partitions, each + such file system is mounted to become part of the overall directory tree. + The UNIX directory tree begins at <tt class="constant">/</tt> just like the root of a DOS drive is specified as + <tt class="constant">C:\</tt>. + </p></dd><dt><span class="term">File Naming Conventions</span></dt><dd><p> + <a class="indexterm" name="id2911846"></a> + MS Windows generally never experiences file names that begin with a dot (<tt class="constant">.</tt>) while in UNIX these + are commonly found in a user's home directory. Files that begin with a dot (<tt class="constant">.</tt>) are typically + either start-up files for various UNIX applications, or they may be files that contain + start-up configuration data. + </p></dd><dt><span class="term">Links and Short-Cuts</span></dt><dd><p> + <a class="indexterm" name="id2911886"></a> + <a class="indexterm" name="id2911897"></a> + <a class="indexterm" name="id2911908"></a> + MS Windows make use of “<span class="quote">links and short-cuts</span>” that are actually special types of files that will + redirect an attempt to execute the file to the real location of the file. UNIX knows of file and directory + links, but they are entirely different from what MS Windows users are used to. + </p><p> + Symbolic links are files in UNIX that contain the actual location of the data (file or directory). An + operation (like read or write) will operate directly on the file referenced. Symbolic links are also + referred to as “<span class="quote">soft links.</span>” A hard link is something that MS Windows is not familiar with. It allows + one physical file to be known simultaneously by more than one file name. + </p></dd></dl></div><p> + There are many other subtle differences that may cause the MS Windows administrator some temporary discomfort + in the process of becoming familiar with UNIX/Linux. These are best left for a text that is dedicated to the + purpose of UNIX/Linux training and education. + </p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2911956"></a>Managing Directories</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + There are three basic operations for managing directories: <b class="command">create, delete, rename</b>. + </p><div class="table"><a name="id2911975"></a><p class="title"><b>Table 13.1. Managing Directories with UNIX and Windows</b></p><table summary="Managing Directories with UNIX and Windows" border="1"><colgroup><col><col><col></colgroup><thead><tr><th align="center">Action</th><th align="center">MS Windows Command</th><th align="center">UNIX Command</th></tr></thead><tbody><tr><td align="center">create</td><td align="center">md folder</td><td align="center">mkdir folder</td></tr><tr><td align="center">delete</td><td align="center">rd folder</td><td align="center">rmdir folder</td></tr><tr><td align="center">rename</td><td align="center">rename oldname newname</td><td align="center">mv oldname newname</td></tr></tbody></table></div><p> + </p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2912050"></a>File and Directory Access Control</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + <a class="indexterm" name="id2912062"></a> + The network administrator is strongly advised to read foundational training manuals and reference materials + regarding file and directory permissions maintenance. Much can be achieved with the basic UNIX permissions + without having to resort to more complex facilities like POSIX Access Control Lists (ACLs) or Extended + Attributes (EAs). + </p><p> + UNIX/Linux file and directory access permissions involves setting three primary sets of data and one control set. + A UNIX file listing looks as follows: +</p><pre class="screen"> +<tt class="prompt">$ </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>ls -la</tt></b> +total 632 +drwxr-xr-x 13 maryo gnomes 816 2003-05-12 22:56 . +drwxrwxr-x 37 maryo gnomes 3800 2003-05-12 22:29 .. +dr-xr-xr-x 2 maryo gnomes 48 2003-05-12 22:29 muchado02 +drwxrwxrwx 2 maryo gnomes 48 2003-05-12 22:29 muchado03 +drw-rw-rw- 2 maryo gnomes 48 2003-05-12 22:29 muchado04 +d-w--w--w- 2 maryo gnomes 48 2003-05-12 22:29 muchado05 +dr--r--r-- 2 maryo gnomes 48 2003-05-12 22:29 muchado06 +drwsrwsrwx 2 maryo gnomes 48 2003-05-12 22:29 muchado08 +---------- 1 maryo gnomes 1242 2003-05-12 22:31 mydata00.lst +--w--w--w- 1 maryo gnomes 7754 2003-05-12 22:33 mydata02.lst +-r--r--r-- 1 maryo gnomes 21017 2003-05-12 22:32 mydata04.lst +-rw-rw-rw- 1 maryo gnomes 41105 2003-05-12 22:32 mydata06.lst +<tt class="prompt">$ </tt> +</pre><p> + </p><p> + The columns above represent (from left to right): permissions, number of hard links to file, owner, group, size (bytes), access date, access time, file name. + </p><p> + An overview of the permissions field can be found in <link linkend="access1">. + </p><div class="figure"><a name="access1"></a><p class="title"><b>Figure 13.1. Overview of UNIX permissions field.</b></p><div class="mediaobject"><img src="projdoc/imagefiles/access1.png" width="270" alt="Overview of UNIX permissions field."></div></div><p> + Any bit flag may be unset. An unset bit flag is the equivalent of “<span class="quote">cannot</span>” and is represented as a “<span class="quote">-</span>” character. + + </p><div class="example"><a name="id2912202"></a><p class="title"><b>Example 13.1. Example File</b></p><pre class="programlisting"> + -rwxr-x--- Means: The owner (user) can read, write, execute + the group can read and execute + everyone else cannot do anything with it. + </pre></div><p> + + </p><p> + Additional possibilities in the [type] field are: c = character device, b = block device, p = pipe device, s = UNIX Domain Socket. + </p><p> + The letters <tt class="constant">rwxXst</tt> set permissions for the user, group and others as: read (r), write (w), execute (or access for directories) (x), + execute only if the file is a directory or already has execute permission for some user (X), set user or group ID on execution (s), + sticky (t). + </p><p> + When the sticky bit is set on a directory, files in that directory may be unlinked (deleted) or renamed only by root or their owner. + Without the sticky bit, anyone able to write to the directory can delete or rename files. The sticky bit is commonly found on + directories, such as <tt class="filename">/tmp</tt>, that are world-writable. + </p><p> + When the set user or group ID bit (s) is set on a directory, then all files created within it will be owned by the user and/or + group whose `set user or group' bit is set. This can be helpful in setting up directories for which it is desired that + all users who are in a group should be able to write to and read from a file, particularly when it is undesirable for that file + to be exclusively owned by a user whose primary group is not the group that all such users belong to. + </p><p> + When a directory is set <tt class="constant">drw-r-----</tt> this means that the owner can read and create (write) files in it, but because + the (x) execute flags are not set, files cannot be listed (seen) in the directory by anyone. The group can read files in the + directory but cannot create new files. If files in the directory are set to be readable and writable for the group, then + group members will be able to write to (or delete) them. + </p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2912290"></a>Share Definition Access Controls</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2912301"></a> +The following parameters in the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file sections define a share control or effect access controls. +Before using any of the following options, please refer to the man page for <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt>. +</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2912329"></a>User and Group-Based Controls</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + User and group-based controls can prove quite useful. In some situations it is distinctly desirable to affect all + file system operations as if a single user were doing so. The use of the <a class="indexterm" name="id2912343"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>force user</tt></i> and + <a class="indexterm" name="id2912356"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>force group</tt></i> behavior will achieve this. In other situations it may be necessary to effect a + paranoia level of control to ensure that only particular authorized persons will be able to access a share or + its contents. Here the use of the <a class="indexterm" name="id2912374"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>valid users</tt></i> or the + <a class="indexterm" name="id2912388"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>invalid users</tt></i> may be most useful. + </p><p> + As always, it is highly advisable to use the least difficult to maintain and the least ambiguous method for + controlling access. Remember, when you leave the scene someone else will need to provide assistance and + if he finds too great a mess or does not understand what you have done, there is risk of + Samba being removed and an alternative solution being adopted. + </p><p> + <link linkend="ugbc"> enumerates these controls. + </p><div class="table"><a name="ugbc"></a><p class="title"><b>Table 13.2. User and Group Based Controls</b></p><table summary="User and Group Based Controls" border="1"><colgroup><col align="left"><col align="justify"></colgroup><thead><tr><th align="center">Control Parameter</th><th align="center">Description - Action - Notes</th></tr></thead><tbody><tr><td align="left"><a class="indexterm" name="id2912501"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>admin users</tt></i></td><td align="justify"><p> + List of users who will be granted administrative privileges on the share. + They will do all file operations as the super-user (root). + Any user in this list will be able to do anything they like on the share, + irrespective of file permissions. + </p></td></tr><tr><td align="left"><a class="indexterm" name="id2912530"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>force group</tt></i></td><td align="justify"><p> + Specifies a UNIX group name that will be assigned as the default primary group + for all users connecting to this service. + </p></td></tr><tr><td align="left"><a class="indexterm" name="id2912558"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>force user</tt></i></td><td align="justify"><p> + Specifies a UNIX user name that will be assigned as the default user for all users connecting to this service. + This is useful for sharing files. Incorrect use can cause security problems. + </p></td></tr><tr><td align="left"><a class="indexterm" name="id2912586"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>guest ok</tt></i></td><td align="justify"><p> + If this parameter is set for a service, then no password is required to connect to the service. Privileges will be + those of the guest account. + </p></td></tr><tr><td align="left"><a class="indexterm" name="id2912614"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>invalid users</tt></i></td><td align="justify"><p> + List of users that should not be allowed to login to this service. + </p></td></tr><tr><td align="left"><a class="indexterm" name="id2912640"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>only user</tt></i></td><td align="justify"><p> + Controls whether connections with usernames not in the user list will be allowed. + </p></td></tr><tr><td align="left"><a class="indexterm" name="id2912666"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>read list</tt></i></td><td align="justify"><p> + List of users that are given read-only access to a service. Users in this list + will not be given write access, no matter what the read only option is set to. + </p></td></tr><tr><td align="left"><a class="indexterm" name="id2912694"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>username</tt></i></td><td align="justify"><p> + Refer to the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> man page for more information -- this is a complex and potentially misused parameter. + </p></td></tr><tr><td align="left"><a class="indexterm" name="id2912727"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>valid users</tt></i></td><td align="justify"><p> + List of users that should be allowed to login to this service. + </p></td></tr><tr><td align="left"><a class="indexterm" name="id2912754"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>write list</tt></i></td><td align="justify"><p> + List of users that are given read-write access to a service. + </p></td></tr></tbody></table></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2912779"></a>File and Directory Permissions-Based Controls</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + The following file and directory permission-based controls, if misused, can result in considerable difficulty to + diagnose causes of misconfiguration. Use them sparingly and carefully. By gradually introducing each one by one, + undesirable side effects may be detected. In the event of a problem, always comment all of them out and then gradually + reintroduce them in a controlled way. + </p><p> + Refer to <link linkend="fdpbc"> for information regarding the parameters that may be used to affect file and + directory permission-based access controls. + </p><div class="table"><a name="fdpbc"></a><p class="title"><b>Table 13.3. File and Directory Permission Based Controls</b></p><table summary="File and Directory Permission Based Controls" border="1"><colgroup><col align="left"><col align="justify"></colgroup><thead><tr><th align="center">Control Parameter</th><th align="center">Description - Action - Notes</th></tr></thead><tbody><tr><td align="left"><a class="indexterm" name="id2912884"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>create mask</tt></i></td><td align="justify"><p> + Refer to the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> man page. + </p></td></tr><tr><td align="left"><a class="indexterm" name="id2912916"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>directory mask</tt></i></td><td align="justify"><p> + The octal modes used when converting DOS modes to UNIX modes when creating UNIX directories. + See also: directory security mask. + </p></td></tr><tr><td align="left"><a class="indexterm" name="id2912942"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>dos filemode</tt></i></td><td align="justify"><p> + Enabling this parameter allows a user who has write access to the file to modify the permissions on it. + </p></td></tr><tr><td align="left"><a class="indexterm" name="id2912969"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>force create mode</tt></i></td><td align="justify"><p> + This parameter specifies a set of UNIX mode bit permissions that will always be set on a file created by Samba. + </p></td></tr><tr><td align="left"><a class="indexterm" name="id2912996"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>force directory mode</tt></i></td><td align="justify"><p> + This parameter specifies a set of UNIX mode bit permissions that will always be set on a directory created by Samba. + </p></td></tr><tr><td align="left"><a class="indexterm" name="id2913024"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>force directory security mode</tt></i></td><td align="justify"><p> + Controls UNIX permission bits modified when a Windows NT client is manipulating UNIX permissions on a directory. + </p></td></tr><tr><td align="left"><a class="indexterm" name="id2913052"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>force security mode</tt></i></td><td align="justify"><p> + Controls UNIX permission bits modified when a Windows NT client manipulates UNIX permissions. + </p></td></tr><tr><td align="left"><a class="indexterm" name="id2913079"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>hide unreadable</tt></i></td><td align="justify"><p> + Prevents clients from seeing the existence of files that cannot be read. + </p></td></tr><tr><td align="left"><a class="indexterm" name="id2913105"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>hide unwriteable files</tt></i></td><td align="justify"><p> + Prevents clients from seeing the existence of files that cannot be written to. Unwriteable directories are shown as usual. + </p></td></tr><tr><td align="left"><a class="indexterm" name="id2913133"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>nt acl support</tt></i></td><td align="justify"><p> + This parameter controls whether smbd will attempt to map UNIX permissions into Windows NT access control lists. + </p></td></tr><tr><td align="left"><a class="indexterm" name="id2913160"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>security mask</tt></i></td><td align="justify"><p> + Controls UNIX permission bits modified when a Windows NT client is manipulating the UNIX permissions on a file. + </p></td></tr></tbody></table></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2913187"></a>Miscellaneous Controls</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + The following are documented because of the prevalence of administrators creating inadvertent barriers to file + access by not understanding the full implications of <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file settings. See <link linkend="mcoc">. + </p><div class="table"><a name="mcoc"></a><p class="title"><b>Table 13.4. Other Controls</b></p><table summary="Other Controls" border="1"><colgroup><col align="justify"><col align="justify"></colgroup><thead><tr><th align="center">Control Parameter</th><th align="center">Description - Action - Notes</th></tr></thead><tbody><tr><td align="justify"><a class="indexterm" name="id2913282"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>case sensitive</tt></i>, <a class="indexterm" name="id2913296"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>default case</tt></i>, <a class="indexterm" name="id2913310"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>short preserve case</tt></i></td><td align="justify"><p> + This means that all file name lookup will be done in a case sensitive manner. + Files will be created with the precise file name Samba received from the MS Windows client. + </p></td></tr><tr><td align="justify"><a class="indexterm" name="id2913339"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>csc policy</tt></i></td><td align="justify"><p> + Client Side Caching Policy - parallels MS Windows client side file caching capabilities. + </p></td></tr><tr><td align="justify"><a class="indexterm" name="id2913365"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>dont descend</tt></i></td><td align="justify"><p> + Allows specifying a comma-delimited list of directories that the server should always show as empty. + </p></td></tr><tr><td align="justify"><a class="indexterm" name="id2913392"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>dos filetime resolution</tt></i></td><td align="justify"><p> + This option is mainly used as a compatibility option for Visual C++ when used against Samba shares. + </p></td></tr><tr><td align="justify"><a class="indexterm" name="id2913419"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>dos filetimes</tt></i></td><td align="justify"><p> + DOS and Windows allow users to change file time stamps if they can write to the file. POSIX semantics prevent this. + This option allows DOS and Windows behavior. + </p></td></tr><tr><td align="justify"><a class="indexterm" name="id2913448"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>fake oplocks</tt></i></td><td align="justify"><p> + Oplocks are the way that SMB clients get permission from a server to locally cache file operations. If a server grants an + oplock, the client is free to assume that it is the only one accessing the file and it will aggressively cache file data. + </p></td></tr><tr><td align="justify"><a class="indexterm" name="id2913477"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>hide dot files</tt></i>, <a class="indexterm" name="id2913492"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>hide files</tt></i>, <a class="indexterm" name="id2913505"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>veto files</tt></i></td><td align="justify"><p> + Note: MS Windows Explorer allows over-ride of files marked as hidden so they will still be visible. + </p></td></tr><tr><td align="justify"><a class="indexterm" name="id2913532"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>read only</tt></i></td><td align="justify"><p> + If this parameter is yes, then users of a service may not create or modify files in the service's directory. + </p></td></tr><tr><td align="justify"><a class="indexterm" name="id2913559"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>veto files</tt></i></td><td align="justify"><p> + List of files and directories that are neither visible nor accessible. + </p></td></tr></tbody></table></div></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2913585"></a>Access Controls on Shares</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2913597"></a> + This section deals with how to configure Samba per share access control restrictions. + By default, Samba sets no restrictions on the share itself. Restrictions on the share itself + can be set on MS Windows NT4/200x/XP shares. This can be an effective way to limit who can + connect to a share. In the absence of specific restrictions the default setting is to allow + the global user <tt class="constant">Everyone - Full Control</tt> (full control, change and read). + </p><p> + At this time Samba does not provide a tool for configuring access control setting on the share + itself. Samba does have the capacity to store and act on access control settings, but the only + way to create those settings is to use either the NT4 Server Manager or the Windows 200x MMC for + Computer Management. + </p><p> + Samba stores the per share access control settings in a file called <tt class="filename">share_info.tdb</tt>. + The location of this file on your system will depend on how Samba was compiled. The default location + for Samba's tdb files is under <tt class="filename">/usr/local/samba/var</tt>. If the <tt class="filename">tdbdump</tt> + utility has been compiled and installed on your system, then you can examine the contents of this file + by executing: <b class="command">tdbdump share_info.tdb</b> in the directory containing the tdb files. + </p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2913670"></a>Share Permissions Management</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + The best tool for the task is platform dependant. Choose the best tool for your environment. + </p><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2913682"></a>Windows NT4 Workstation/Server</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> + The tool you need to use to manage share permissions on a Samba server is the NT Server Manager. + Server Manager is shipped with Windows NT4 Server products but not with Windows NT4 Workstation. + You can obtain the NT Server Manager for MS Windows NT4 Workstation from Microsoft see details below. + </p><div class="procedure"><p class="title"><b>Procedure 13.1. Instructions</b></p><ol type="1"><li><p> + Launch the <span class="application">NT4 Server Manager</span>, click on the Samba server you want to administer. From the menu + select <span class="guimenu">Computer</span>, then click on <span class="guimenuitem">Shared Directories</span>. + </p></li><li><p> + Click on the share that you wish to manage, then click the <span class="guilabel">Properties</span> tab. then click + the <span class="guilabel">Permissions</span> tab. Now you can add or change access control settings as you wish. + </p></li></ol></div></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2913771"></a>Windows 200x/XP</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> + On <span class="application">MS Windows NT4/200x/XP</span> system access control lists on the share itself are set using native + tools, usually from File Manager. For example, in Windows 200x, right click on the shared folder, + then select <span class="guimenuitem">Sharing</span>, then click on <span class="guilabel">Permissions</span>. The default + Windows NT4/200x permission allows “<span class="quote">Everyone</span>” full control on the share. + </p><p> + MS Windows 200x and later versions come with a tool called the <span class="application">Computer Management</span> snap-in for the + Microsoft Management Console (MMC). This tool is located by clicking on <span class="guimenu">Control Panel -> + Administrative Tools -> Computer Management</span>. + </p><div class="procedure"><p class="title"><b>Procedure 13.2. Instructions</b></p><ol type="1"><li><p> + After launching the MMC with the Computer Management snap-in, click the menu item <span class="guimenuitem">Action</span>, + and select <span class="guilabel">Connect to another computer</span>. If you are not logged onto a domain you will be prompted + to enter a domain login user identifier and a password. This will authenticate you to the domain. + If you are already logged in with administrative privilege, this step is not offered. + </p></li><li><p> + If the Samba server is not shown in the <span class="guilabel">Select Computer</span> box, type in the name of the target + Samba server in the field <span class="guilabel">Name:</span>. Now click the on <span class="guibutton">[+]</span> next to + <span class="guilabel">System Tools</span>, then on the <span class="guibutton">[+]</span> next to <span class="guilabel">Shared Folders</span> in the + left panel. + </p></li><li><p> + In the right panel, double-click on the share on which you wish to set access control permissions. + Then click the tab <span class="guilabel">Share Permissions</span>. It is now possible to add access control entities + to the shared folder. Remember to set what type of access (full control, change, read) you + wish to assign for each entry. + </p></li></ol></div><div class="warning" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Warning</h3><p> + Be careful. If you take away all permissions from the <tt class="constant">Everyone</tt> user without removing this user, + effectively no user will be able to access the share. This is a result of what is known as + ACL precedence. Everyone with <span class="emphasis"><em>no access</em></span> means that <tt class="constant">MaryK</tt> who is part of the group + <tt class="constant">Everyone</tt> will have no access even if she is given explicit full control access. + </p></div></div></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2913978"></a>MS Windows Access Control Lists and UNIX Interoperability</h2></div></div><div></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2913986"></a>Managing UNIX Permissions Using NT Security Dialogs</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2913998"></a> + Windows NT clients can use their native security settings dialog box to view and modify the + underlying UNIX permissions. + </p><p> + This ability is careful not to compromise the security of the UNIX host on which Samba is running, and + still obeys all the file permission rules that a Samba administrator can set. + </p><p> + Samba does not attempt to go beyond POSIX ACLs, so the various finer-grained access control + options provided in Windows are actually ignored. + </p><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p> + All access to UNIX/Linux system files via Samba is controlled by the operating system file access controls. + When trying to figure out file access problems, it is vitally important to find the identity of the Windows + user as it is presented by Samba at the point of file access. This can best be determined from the + Samba log files. + </p></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2914042"></a>Viewing File Security on a Samba Share</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + From an NT4/2000/XP client, right click on any file or directory in a Samba-mounted drive letter + or UNC path. When the menu pops up, click on the <span class="guilabel">Properties</span> entry at the bottom + of the menu. This brings up the file <tt class="constant">Properties</tt> dialog box. Click on the + <span class="guilabel">Security</span> tab and you will see three buttons: <span class="guibutton">Permissions</span>, + <span class="guibutton">Auditing</span>, and <span class="guibutton">Ownership</span>. The <span class="guibutton">Auditing</span> + button will cause either an error message <span class="errorname">`A requested privilege is not held by the client'</span> + to appear if the user is not the NT Administrator, or a dialog which is intended to allow an Administrator + to add auditing requirements to a file if the user is logged on as the NT Administrator. This dialog is + non-functional with a Samba share at this time, as the only useful button, the <span class="guibutton">Add</span> + button, will not currently allow a list of users to be seen. + </p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2914124"></a>Viewing File Ownership</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + Clicking on the <span class="guibutton">Ownership</span> button brings up a dialog box telling you who owns + the given file. The owner name will be displayed like this: + </p><p> + <b class="command">“<span class="quote">SERVER\user (Long name)</span>”</b> + </p><p> + <i class="replaceable"><tt>SERVER</tt></i> is the NetBIOS name of the Samba server, <i class="replaceable"><tt>user</tt></i> + is the user name of the UNIX user who owns the file, and <i class="replaceable"><tt>(Long name)</tt></i> is the + descriptive string identifying the user (normally found in the GECOS field of the UNIX password database). + Click on the <span class="guibutton">Close </span> button to remove this dialog. + </p><p> + If the parameter <a class="indexterm" name="id2914189"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>nt acl support</tt></i> is set to <tt class="constant">false</tt>, + the file owner will be shown as the NT user <span class="emphasis"><em>Everyone</em></span>. + </p><p> + The <span class="guibutton">Take Ownership</span> button will not allow you to change the ownership of this file to + yourself (clicking it will display a dialog box complaining that the user you are currently logged onto + the NT client cannot be found). The reason for this is that changing the ownership of a file is a privileged + operation in UNIX, available only to the <span class="emphasis"><em>root</em></span> user. As clicking on this button causes + NT to attempt to change the ownership of a file to the current user logged into the NT clienti, this will + not work with Samba at this time.</p><p> + There is an NT <b class="command">chown</b> command that will work with Samba and allow a user with Administrator privilege connected + to a Samba server as root to change the ownership of files on both a local NTFS filesystem or remote mounted NTFS + or Samba drive. This is available as part of the <span class="application">Seclib</span> NT security library written + by Jeremy Allison of the Samba Team, and is available from the main Samba FTP site.</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2914264"></a>Viewing File or Directory Permissions</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + The third button is the <span class="guibutton">Permissions</span> button. Clicking on this brings up a dialog box + that shows both the permissions and the UNIX owner of the file or directory. The owner is displayed like this: + </p><p><b class="command"><i class="replaceable"><tt>SERVER</tt></i>\ + <i class="replaceable"><tt>user</tt></i> + <i class="replaceable"><tt>(Long name)</tt></i></b></p><p>Where <i class="replaceable"><tt>SERVER</tt></i> is the NetBIOS name of the Samba server, + <i class="replaceable"><tt>user</tt></i> is the user name of the UNIX user who owns the file, and + <i class="replaceable"><tt>(Long name)</tt></i> is the descriptive string identifying the user (normally found in the + GECOS field of the UNIX password database).</p><p> + If the parameter <a class="indexterm" name="id2914328"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>nt acl support</tt></i> is set to <tt class="constant">false</tt>, + the file owner will be shown as the NT user <tt class="constant">Everyone</tt> and the permissions will be + shown as NT “<span class="quote">Full Control</span>”. + </p><p> + The permissions field is displayed differently for files and directories, so I'll describe the way file permissions + are displayed first. + </p><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2914362"></a>File Permissions</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p>The standard UNIX user/group/world triplet and the corresponding <tt class="constant">read, write, execute</tt> permissions + triplets are mapped by Samba into a three element NT ACL with the “<span class="quote">r</span>”, “<span class="quote">w</span>” and “<span class="quote">x</span>” bits mapped into the corresponding + NT permissions. The UNIX world permissions are mapped into the global NT group <tt class="constant">Everyone</tt>, followed + by the list of permissions allowed for UNIX world. The UNIX owner and group permissions are displayed as an NT + <span class="guiicon">user</span> icon and an NT <span class="guiicon">local group</span> icon, respectively, followed by the list + of permissions allowed for the UNIX user and group.</p><p>Because many UNIX permission sets do not map into common NT names such as <tt class="constant">read</tt>, + <tt class="constant">change</tt> or <tt class="constant">full control</tt>, usually the permissions will be prefixed + by the words <tt class="constant">Special Access</tt> in the NT display list.</p><p>But what happens if the file has no permissions allowed for a particular UNIX user group or world component? In order + to allow “<span class="quote">no permissions</span>” to be seen and modified Samba then overloads the NT <tt class="constant">Take Ownership</tt> ACL attribute + (which has no meaning in UNIX) and reports a component with no permissions as having the NT <b class="command">O</b> bit set. + This was chosen, of course, to make it look like a zero, meaning zero permissions. More details on the decision behind this is + given below.</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2914471"></a>Directory Permissions</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p>Directories on an NT NTFS file system have two different sets of permissions. The first set is the ACL set on the + directory itself, which is usually displayed in the first set of parentheses in the normal <tt class="constant">RW</tt> + NT style. This first set of permissions is created by Samba in exactly the same way as normal file permissions are, described + above, and is displayed in the same way.</p><p>The second set of directory permissions has no real meaning in the UNIX permissions world and represents the <tt class="constant"> + inherited</tt> permissions that any file created within this directory would inherit.</p><p>Samba synthesises these inherited permissions for NT by returning as an NT ACL the UNIX permission mode that a new file + created by Samba on this share would receive.</p></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2914515"></a>Modifying File or Directory Permissions</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>Modifying file and directory permissions is as simple + as changing the displayed permissions in the dialog box, and + clicking on <span class="guibutton">OK</span>. However, there are + limitations that a user needs to be aware of, and also interactions + with the standard Samba permission masks and mapping of DOS + attributes that need to also be taken into account.</p><p>If the parameter <a class="indexterm" name="id2914543"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>nt acl support</tt></i> + is set to <tt class="constant">false</tt>, any attempt to set + security permissions will fail with an <span class="errorname">`Access Denied' + </span> message.</p><p>The first thing to note is that the <span class="guibutton">Add</span> + button will not return a list of users in Samba (it will give + an error message saying <span class="errorname">`The remote procedure call failed + and did not execute'</span>). This means that you can only + manipulate the current user/group/world permissions listed in + the dialog box. This actually works quite well as these are the + only permissions that UNIX actually has.</p><p>If a permission triplet (either user, group, or world) + is removed from the list of permissions in the NT dialog box, + then when the <span class="guibutton">OK</span> button is pressed it will + be applied as “<span class="quote">no permissions</span>” on the UNIX side. If you then + view the permissions again, the “<span class="quote">no permissions</span>” entry will appear + as the NT <b class="command">O</b> flag, as described above. This + allows you to add permissions back to a file or directory once + you have removed them from a triplet component.</p><p>As UNIX supports only the “<span class="quote">r</span>”, “<span class="quote">w</span>” and “<span class="quote">x</span>” bits of + an NT ACL, if other NT security attributes such as <tt class="constant">Delete Access</tt> are + selected they will be ignored when applied on the Samba server.</p><p>When setting permissions on a directory, the second + set of permissions (in the second set of parentheses) is + by default applied to all files within that directory. If this + is not what you want, you must uncheck the <span class="guilabel">Replace + permissions on existing files</span> checkbox in the NT + dialog before clicking on <span class="guibutton">OK</span>.</p><p>If you wish to remove all permissions from a + user/group/world component, you may either highlight the + component and click on the <span class="guibutton">Remove</span> button, + or set the component to only have the special <tt class="constant">Take + Ownership</tt> permission (displayed as <b class="command">O + </b>) highlighted.</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2914698"></a>Interaction with the Standard Samba “<span class="quote">create mask</span>” Parameters</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>There are four parameters that control interaction with the standard Samba <i class="parameter"><tt>create mask</tt></i> parameters. + These are: + + </p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><a class="indexterm" name="id2914726"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>security mask</tt></i></li><li><a class="indexterm" name="id2914742"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>force security mode</tt></i></li><li><a class="indexterm" name="id2914757"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>directory security mask</tt></i></li><li><a class="indexterm" name="id2914773"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>force directory security mode</tt></i></li></ul></div><p> + + </p><p>Once a user clicks on <span class="guibutton">OK</span> to apply the + permissions, Samba maps the given permissions into a user/group/world + r/w/x triplet set, and then checks the changed permissions for a + file against the bits set in the + <a class="indexterm" name="id2914803"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>security mask</tt></i> parameter. Any bits that + were changed that are not set to “<span class="quote">1</span>” in this parameter are left alone + in the file permissions.</p><p>Essentially, zero bits in the <a class="indexterm" name="id2914828"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>security mask</tt></i> + may be treated as a set of bits the user is <span class="emphasis"><em>not</em></span> + allowed to change, and one bits are those the user is allowed to change. + </p><p>If not explicitly set, this parameter defaults to the same value as + the <a class="indexterm" name="id2914853"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>create mask</tt></i> parameter. To allow a user to modify all the + user/group/world permissions on a file, set this parameter to 0777. + </p><p>Next Samba checks the changed permissions for a file against the bits set in the + <a class="indexterm" name="id2914875"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>force security mode</tt></i> parameter. Any bits + that were changed that correspond to bits set to “<span class="quote">1</span>” in this parameter + are forced to be set.</p><p>Essentially, bits set in the <i class="parameter"><tt>force security mode</tt></i> parameter + may be treated as a set of bits that, when modifying security on a file, the user has always set to be “<span class="quote">on</span>”.</p><p>If not explicitly set, this parameter defaults to the same value + as the <a class="indexterm" name="id2914918"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>force create mode</tt></i> parameter. + To allow a user to modify all the user/group/world permissions on a file + with no restrictions set this parameter to 000. The + <a class="indexterm" name="id2914935"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>security mask</tt></i> and <i class="parameter"><tt>force + security mode</tt></i> parameters are applied to the change + request in that order.</p><p>For a directory, Samba will perform the same operations as + described above for a file except it uses the parameter <i class="parameter"><tt> + directory security mask</tt></i> instead of <i class="parameter"><tt>security + mask</tt></i>, and <i class="parameter"><tt>force directory security mode + </tt></i> parameter instead of <i class="parameter"><tt>force security mode + </tt></i>.</p><p>The <a class="indexterm" name="id2914996"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>directory security mask</tt></i> parameter + by default is set to the same value as the <i class="parameter"><tt>directory mask + </tt></i> parameter and the <i class="parameter"><tt>force directory security + mode</tt></i> parameter by default is set to the same value as + the <a class="indexterm" name="id2915027"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>force directory mode</tt></i> parameter. + In this way Samba enforces the permission restrictions that + an administrator can set on a Samba share, while still allowing users + to modify the permission bits within that restriction.</p><p>If you want to set up a share that allows users full control + in modifying the permission bits on their files and directories and + does not force any particular bits to be set “<span class="quote">on</span>”, then set the following + parameters in the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file in that share-specific section: + </p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>security mask = 0777</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>force security mode = 0</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>directory security mask = 0777</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>force directory security mode = 0</tt></i></td></tr></table></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2915106"></a>Interaction with the Standard Samba File Attribute Mapping</h3></div></div><div></div></div><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p>Samba maps some of the DOS attribute bits (such as “<span class="quote">read + only</span>”) into the UNIX permissions of a file. This means there can + be a conflict between the permission bits set via the security + dialog and the permission bits set by the file attribute mapping. + </p></div><p>If a file has no UNIX read access for the owner, it will show up + as “<span class="quote">read only</span>” in the standard file attributes tabbed dialog. + Unfortunately, this dialog is the same one that contains the security information + in another tab.</p><p>What this can mean is that if the owner changes the permissions + to allow himself read access using the security dialog, clicks on + <span class="guibutton">OK</span> to get back to the standard attributes tab + dialog, and clicks on <span class="guibutton">OK</span> on that dialog, then + NT will set the file permissions back to read-only (as that is what + the attributes still say in the dialog). This means that after setting + permissions and clicking on <span class="guibutton">OK</span> to get back to the + attributes dialog, you should always press <span class="guibutton">Cancel</span> + rather than <span class="guibutton">OK</span> to ensure that your changes + are not overridden.</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2915195"></a>Common Errors</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +File, directory and share access problems are common on the mailing list. The following +are examples taken from the mailing list in recent times. +</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2915209"></a>Users Cannot Write to a Public Share</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + “<span class="quote"> + We are facing some troubles with file/directory permissions. I can log on the domain as admin user(root), + and there's a public share on which everyone needs to have permission to create/modify files, but only + root can change the file, no one else can. We need to constantly go to the server to + <b class="userinput"><tt>chgrp -R users *</tt></b> and <b class="userinput"><tt>chown -R nobody *</tt></b> to allow others users to change the file. + </span>” + </p><p> + There are many ways to solve this problem and here are a few hints: + </p><div class="procedure"><ol type="1"><li><p> + Go to the top of the directory that is shared. + </p></li><li><p> + Set the ownership to what ever public owner and group you want +</p><pre class="screen"> +<tt class="prompt">$ </tt>find 'directory_name' -type d -exec chown user.group {}\; +<tt class="prompt">$ </tt>find 'directory_name' -type d -exec chmod 6775 'directory_name' +<tt class="prompt">$ </tt>find 'directory_name' -type f -exec chmod 0775 {} \; +<tt class="prompt">$ </tt>find 'directory_name' -type f -exec chown user.group {}\; +</pre><p> + </p><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p> + The above will set the <tt class="constant">sticky bit</tt> on all directories. Read your + UNIX/Linux man page on what that does. It causes the OS to assign + to all files created in the directories the ownership of the + directory. + </p></div></li><li><p> + + Directory is: <i class="replaceable"><tt>/foodbar</tt></i> +</p><pre class="screen"> +<tt class="prompt">$ </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>chown jack.engr /foodbar</tt></b> +</pre><p> + </p><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p> + </p><p>This is the same as doing:</p><p> +</p><pre class="screen"> +<tt class="prompt">$ </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>chown jack /foodbar</tt></b> +<tt class="prompt">$ </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>chgrp engr /foodbar</tt></b> +</pre><p> + </p></div></li><li><p>Now type: + +</p><pre class="screen"> +<tt class="prompt">$ </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>chmod 6775 /foodbar</tt></b> +<tt class="prompt">$ </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>ls -al /foodbar/..</tt></b> +</pre><p> + + </p><p>You should see: +</p><pre class="screen"> +drwsrwsr-x 2 jack engr 48 2003-02-04 09:55 foodbar +</pre><p> + </p></li><li><p>Now type: +</p><pre class="screen"> +<tt class="prompt">$ </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>su - jill</tt></b> +<tt class="prompt">$ </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>cd /foodbar</tt></b> +<tt class="prompt">$ </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>touch Afile</tt></b> +<tt class="prompt">$ </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>ls -al</tt></b> +</pre><p> + </p><p> + You should see that the file <tt class="filename">Afile</tt> created by Jill will have ownership + and permissions of Jack, as follows: +</p><pre class="screen"> +-rw-r--r-- 1 jack engr 0 2003-02-04 09:57 Afile +</pre><p> + </p></li><li><p> + Now in your <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> for the share add: + </p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>force create mode = 0775</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>force direcrtory mode = 6775</tt></i></td></tr></table><p> + </p><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p> + These procedures are needed only if your users are not members of the group + you have used. That is if within the OS do not have write permission on the directory. + </p></div><p> + An alternative is to set in the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> entry for the share: + </p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>force user = jack</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>force group = engr</tt></i></td></tr></table><p> + </p></li></ol></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2915635"></a>File Operations Done as <span class="emphasis"><em>root</em></span> with <span class="emphasis"><em>force user</em></span> Set</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + When you have a user in <a class="indexterm" name="id2915654"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>admin users</tt></i>, Samba will always do file operations for + this user as <span class="emphasis"><em>root</em></span>, even if <a class="indexterm" name="id2915674"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>force user</tt></i> has been set. + </p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2915690"></a>MS Word with Samba Changes Owner of File</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + <span class="emphasis"><em>Question:</em></span> “<span class="quote">When user B saves a word document that is owned by user A the updated file is now owned by user B. + Why is Samba doing this? How do I fix this?</span>” + </p><p> + <span class="emphasis"><em>Answer:</em></span> Word does the following when you modify/change a Word document: MS Word creates a NEW document with + a temporary name, Word then closes the old document and deletes it, Word then renames the new document to the original document name. + There is no mechanism by which Samba can in any way know that the new document really should be owned by the owners + of the original file. Samba has no way of knowing that the file will be renamed by MS Word. As far as Samba is able + to tell, the file that gets created is a NEW file, not one that the application (Word) is updating. + </p><p> + There is a work-around to solve the permissions problem. That work-around involves understanding how you can manage file + system behavior from within the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file, as well as understanding how UNIX file systems work. Set on the directory + in which you are changing Word documents: <b class="command">chmod g+s `directory_name'</b> This ensures that all files will + be created with the group that owns the directory. In <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> share declaration section set: + </p><p> + </p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>force create mode = 0660</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>force directory mode = 0770</tt></i></td></tr></table><p> + </p><p> + These two settings will ensure that all directories and files that get created in the share will be read/writable by the + owner and group set on the directory itself. + </p></div></div></div><div class="navfooter"><hr><table width="100%" summary="Navigation footer"><tr><td width="40%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="groupmapping.html">Prev</a> </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="u" href="optional.html">Up</a></td><td width="40%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="locking.html">Next</a></td></tr><tr><td width="40%" align="left" valign="top">Chapter 12. Group Mapping MS Windows and UNIX </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="h" href="index.html">Home</a></td><td width="40%" align="right" valign="top"> Chapter 14. File and Record Locking</td></tr></table></div></body></html> diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/AdvancedNetworkManagement.html b/docs/htmldocs/AdvancedNetworkManagement.html new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..aa13cd37ee --- /dev/null +++ b/docs/htmldocs/AdvancedNetworkManagement.html @@ -0,0 +1,217 @@ +<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>Chapter 22. Advanced Network Management</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.60.1"><link rel="home" href="index.html" title="SAMBA Project Documentation"><link rel="up" href="optional.html" title="Part III. Advanced Configuration"><link rel="previous" href="winbind.html" title="Chapter 21. Winbind: Use of Domain Accounts"><link rel="next" href="PolicyMgmt.html" title="Chapter 23. System and Account Policies"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="navheader"><table width="100%" summary="Navigation header"><tr><th colspan="3" align="center">Chapter 22. Advanced Network Management</th></tr><tr><td width="20%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="winbind.html">Prev</a> </td><th width="60%" align="center">Part III. Advanced Configuration</th><td width="20%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="PolicyMgmt.html">Next</a></td></tr></table><hr></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="AdvancedNetworkManagement"></a>Chapter 22. Advanced Network Management</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">John</span> <span class="othername">H.</span> <span class="surname">Terpstra</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org">jht@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><p class="pubdate">April 3 2003</p></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="AdvancedNetworkManagement.html#id2952277">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="AdvancedNetworkManagement.html#id2952308">Remote Server Administration</a></dt><dt><a href="AdvancedNetworkManagement.html#id2952449">Remote Desktop Management</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="AdvancedNetworkManagement.html#id2952467">Remote Management from NoMachine.Com</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="AdvancedNetworkManagement.html#id2952700">Network Logon Script Magic</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="AdvancedNetworkManagement.html#id2952929">Adding Printers without User Intervention</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></div><p> +This section documents peripheral issues that are of great importance to network +administrators who want to improve network resource access control, to automate the user +environment and to make their lives a little easier. +</p><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2952277"></a>Features and Benefits</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +Often the difference between a working network environment and a well appreciated one can +best be measured by the <span class="emphasis"><em>little things</em></span> that make everything work more +harmoniously. A key part of every network environment solution is the +ability to remotely +manage MS Windows workstations, remotely access the Samba server, provide customized +logon scripts, as well as other housekeeping activities that help to sustain more reliable +network operations. +</p><p> +This chapter presents information on each of these areas. They are placed here, and not in +other chapters, for ease of reference. +</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2952308"></a>Remote Server Administration</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p>“<span class="quote">How do I get `User Manager' and `Server Manager'?</span>”</p><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2952326"></a> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2952334"></a> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2952343"></a> +Since I do not need to buy an <span class="application">NT4 Server</span>, how do I get the `User Manager for Domains' +and the `Server Manager'? +</p><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2952364"></a> +Microsoft distributes a version of these tools called <tt class="filename">Nexus.exe</tt> for installation +on <span class="application">Windows 9x/Me</span> systems. The tools set includes: +</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li>Server Manager</li><li>User Manager for Domains</li><li>Event Viewer</li></ul></div><p> +Download the archived file at <ulink url="ftp://ftp.microsoft.com/Softlib/MSLFILES/NEXUS.EXE">ftp://ftp.microsoft.com/Softlib/MSLFILES/NEXUS.EXE.</ulink> +</p><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2952422"></a> +The <span class="application">Windows NT 4.0</span> version of the `User Manager for +Domains' and `Server Manager' are available from Microsoft <ulink url="ftp://ftp.microsoft.com/Softlib/MSLFILES/SRVTOOLS.EXE">via ftp</ulink>. +</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2952449"></a>Remote Desktop Management</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +There are a number of possible remote desktop management solutions that range from free +through costly. Do not let that put you off. Sometimes the most costly solution is the +most cost effective. In any case, you will need to draw your own conclusions as to which +is the best tool in your network environment. +</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2952467"></a>Remote Management from NoMachine.Com</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + <a class="indexterm" name="id2952479"></a> + The following information was posted to the Samba mailing list at Apr 3 23:33:50 GMT 2003. + It is presented in slightly edited form (with author details omitted for privacy reasons). + The entire answer is reproduced below with some comments removed. + </p><p>“<span class="quote"> + I have a wonderful Linux/Samba server running as pdc for a network. Now I would like to add remote + desktop capabilities so users outside could login to the system and get their desktop up from home or + another country. + </span>”</p><p>“<span class="quote"> + Is there a way to accomplish this? Do I need a Windows Terminal Server? Do I need to configure it so + it is a member of the domain or a BDC,PDC? Are there any hacks for MS Windows XP to enable remote login + even if the computer is in a domain? + </span>”</p><p> + Answer provided: Check out the new offer from NoMachine, “<span class="quote">NX</span>” software: + <ulink url="http://www.nomachine.com/">http://www.nomachine.com/</ulink>. + </p><p> + It implements an easy-to-use interface to the Remote X protocol as + well as incorporating VNC/RFB and rdesktop/RDP into it, but at a speed + performance much better than anything you may have ever seen. + </p><p> + Remote X is not new at all, but what they did achieve successfully is + a new way of compression and caching technologies that makes the thing + fast enough to run even over slow modem/ISDN connections. + </p><p> + I could test drive their (public) Red Hat machine in Italy, over a loaded + Internet connection, with enabled thumbnail previews in KDE konqueror + which popped up immediately on “<span class="quote">mouse-over</span>”. From inside that (remote X) + session I started a rdesktop session on another, a Windows XP machine. + To test the performance, I played Pinball. I am proud to announce + that my score was 631750 points at first try. + </p><p> + NX performs better on my local LAN than any of the other “<span class="quote">pure</span>” + connection methods I am using from time to time: TightVNC, rdesktop or + Remote X. It is even faster than a direct crosslink connection between + two nodes. + </p><p> + I even got sound playing from the Remote X app to my local boxes, and + had a working “<span class="quote">copy'n'paste</span>” from an NX window (running a KDE session + in Italy) to my Mozilla mailing agent. These guys are certainly doing + something right! + </p><p> + I recommend to test drive NX to anybody with a only a passing interest in remote computing + <ulink url="http://www.nomachine.com/testdrive.php">http://www.nomachine.com/testdrive.php</ulink>. + </p><p> + Just download the free of charge client software (available for Red Hat, + SuSE, Debian and Windows) and be up and running within five minutes (they + need to send you your account data, though, because you are assigned + a real UNIX account on their testdrive.nomachine.com box. + </p><p> + They plan to get to the point were you can have NX application servers + running as a cluster of nodes, and users simply start an NX session locally, + and can select applications to run transparently (apps may even run on + another NX node, but pretend to be on the same as used for initial login, + because it displays in the same window. You also can run it + fullscreen, and after a short time you forget that it is a remote session + at all). + </p><p> + Now the best thing for last: All the core compression and caching + technologies are released under the GPL and available as source code + to anybody who wants to build on it! These technologies are working, + albeit started from the command line only (and very inconvenient to + use in order to get a fully running remote X session up and running.) + </p><p> + To answer your questions: + </p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p> + You do not need to install a terminal server; XP has RDP support built in. + </p></li><li><p> + NX is much cheaper than Citrix and comparable in performance, probably faster. + </p></li><li><p> + You do not need to hack XP it just works. + </p></li><li><p> + You log into the XP box from remote transparently (and I think there is no + need to change anything to get a connection, even if authentication is against a domain). + </p></li><li><p> + The NX core technologies are all Open Source and released under the GPL + you can now use a (very inconvenient) commandline at no cost, + but you can buy a comfortable (proprietary) NX GUI frontend for money. + </p></li><li><p> + NoMachine are encouraging and offering help to OSS/Free Software implementations + for such a frontend too, even if it means competition to them (they have written + to this effect even to the LTSP, KDE and GNOME developer mailing lists). + </p></li></ul></div></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2952700"></a>Network Logon Script Magic</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +There are several opportunities for creating a custom network startup configuration environment. +</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li>No Logon Script.</li><li>Simple universal Logon Script that applies to all users.</li><li>Use of a conditional Logon Script that applies per user or per group attributes.</li><li>Use of Samba's preexec and postexec functions on access to the NETLOGON share to create + a custom logon script and then execute it.</li><li>User of a tool such as KixStart.</li></ul></div><p> +The Samba source code tree includes two logon script generation/execution tools. +See <tt class="filename">examples</tt> directory <tt class="filename">genlogon</tt> and +<tt class="filename">ntlogon</tt> subdirectories. +</p><p> +The following listings are from the genlogon directory. +</p><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2952778"></a> +This is the <tt class="filename">genlogon.pl</tt> file: + +</p><pre class="programlisting"> + #!/usr/bin/perl + # + # genlogon.pl + # + # Perl script to generate user logon scripts on the fly, when users + # connect from a Windows client. This script should be called from + # smb.conf with the %U, %G and %L parameters. I.e: + # + # root preexec = genlogon.pl %U %G %L + # + # The script generated will perform + # the following: + # + # 1. Log the user connection to /var/log/samba/netlogon.log + # 2. Set the PC's time to the Linux server time (which is maintained + # daily to the National Institute of Standard's Atomic clock on the + # internet. + # 3. Connect the user's home drive to H: (H for Home). + # 4. Connect common drives that everyone uses. + # 5. Connect group-specific drives for certain user groups. + # 6. Connect user-specific drives for certain users. + # 7. Connect network printers. + + # Log client connection + #($sec,$min,$hour,$mday,$mon,$year,$wday,$yday,$isdst) = localtime(time); + ($sec,$min,$hour,$mday,$mon,$year,$wday,$yday,$isdst) = localtime(time); + open LOG, ">>/var/log/samba/netlogon.log"; + print LOG "$mon/$mday/$year $hour:$min:$sec"; + print LOG " - User $ARGV[0] logged into $ARGV[1]\n"; + close LOG; + + # Start generating logon script + open LOGON, ">/shared/netlogon/$ARGV[0].bat"; + print LOGON "\@ECHO OFF\r\n"; + + # Connect shares just use by Software Development group + if ($ARGV[1] eq "SOFTDEV" || $ARGV[0] eq "softdev") + { + print LOGON "NET USE M: \\\\$ARGV[2]\\SOURCE\r\n"; + } + + # Connect shares just use by Technical Support staff + if ($ARGV[1] eq "SUPPORT" || $ARGV[0] eq "support") + { + print LOGON "NET USE S: \\\\$ARGV[2]\\SUPPORT\r\n"; + } + + # Connect shares just used by Administration staff + If ($ARGV[1] eq "ADMIN" || $ARGV[0] eq "admin") + { + print LOGON "NET USE L: \\\\$ARGV[2]\\ADMIN\r\n"; + print LOGON "NET USE K: \\\\$ARGV[2]\\MKTING\r\n"; + } + + # Now connect Printers. We handle just two or three users a little + # differently, because they are the exceptions that have desktop + # printers on LPT1: - all other user's go to the LaserJet on the + # server. + if ($ARGV[0] eq 'jim' + || $ARGV[0] eq 'yvonne') + { + print LOGON "NET USE LPT2: \\\\$ARGV[2]\\LJET3\r\n"; + print LOGON "NET USE LPT3: \\\\$ARGV[2]\\FAXQ\r\n"; + } + else + { + print LOGON "NET USE LPT1: \\\\$ARGV[2]\\LJET3\r\n"; + print LOGON "NET USE LPT3: \\\\$ARGV[2]\\FAXQ\r\n"; + } + + # All done! Close the output file. + close LOGON; +</pre><p> +</p><p> +Those wishing to use more elaborate or capable logon processing system should check out these sites: +</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><ulink url="http://www.craigelachi.e.org/rhacer/ntlogon">http://www.craigelachi.e.org/rhacer/ntlogon</ulink></li><li><ulink url="http://www.kixtart.org">http://www.kixtart.org</ulink></li></ul></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2952929"></a>Adding Printers without User Intervention</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2952940"></a> +Printers may be added automatically during logon script processing through the use of: + +</p><pre class="screen"> +<tt class="prompt">C:\> </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>rundll32 printui.dll,PrintUIEntry /?</tt></b> +</pre><p> + +See the documentation in the <ulink url="http://support.microsoft.com/default.asp?scid=kb;en-us;189105">Microsoft knowledgebase article 189105.</ulink> +</p></div></div></div><div class="navfooter"><hr><table width="100%" summary="Navigation footer"><tr><td width="40%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="winbind.html">Prev</a> </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="u" href="optional.html">Up</a></td><td width="40%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="PolicyMgmt.html">Next</a></td></tr><tr><td width="40%" align="left" valign="top">Chapter 21. Winbind: Use of Domain Accounts </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="h" href="index.html">Home</a></td><td width="40%" align="right" valign="top"> Chapter 23. System and Account Policies</td></tr></table></div></body></html> diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/Appendixes.html b/docs/htmldocs/Appendixes.html new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..c2e126377e --- /dev/null +++ b/docs/htmldocs/Appendixes.html @@ -0,0 +1 @@ +<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>Part VI. Appendixes</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.60.1"><link rel="home" href="index.html" title="SAMBA Project Documentation"><link rel="up" href="index.html" title="SAMBA Project Documentation"><link rel="previous" href="bugreport.html" title="Chapter 35. Reporting Bugs"><link rel="next" href="compiling.html" title="Chapter 36. How to Compile Samba"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="navheader"><table width="100%" summary="Navigation header"><tr><th colspan="3" align="center">Part VI. Appendixes</th></tr><tr><td width="20%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="bugreport.html">Prev</a> </td><th width="60%" align="center"> </th><td width="20%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="compiling.html">Next</a></td></tr></table><hr></div><div class="part" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h1 class="title"><a name="Appendixes"></a>Appendixes</h1></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt>36. <a href="compiling.html">How to Compile Samba</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="compiling.html#id2972995">Access Samba Source Code via CVS</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="compiling.html#id2973003">Introduction</a></dt><dt><a href="compiling.html#id2973049">CVS Access to samba.org</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="compiling.html#id2973311">Accessing the Samba Sources via rsync and ftp</a></dt><dt><a href="compiling.html#id2973389">Verifying Samba's PGP Signature</a></dt><dt><a href="compiling.html#id2973553">Building the Binaries</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="compiling.html#id2973768">Compiling Samba with Active Directory Support</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="compiling.html#id2973958">Starting the smbd and nmbd</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="compiling.html#id2974066">Starting from inetd.conf</a></dt><dt><a href="compiling.html#id2974312">Alternative: Starting smbd as a Daemon</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>37. <a href="Portability.html">Portability</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="Portability.html#id2974513">HPUX</a></dt><dt><a href="Portability.html#id2974600">SCO UNIX</a></dt><dt><a href="Portability.html#id2974655">DNIX</a></dt><dt><a href="Portability.html#id2974825">Red Hat Linux</a></dt><dt><a href="Portability.html#id2974869">AIX</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="Portability.html#id2974876">Sequential Read Ahead</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="Portability.html#id2974902">Solaris</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="Portability.html#id2974909">Locking Improvements</a></dt><dt><a href="Portability.html#winbind-solaris9">Winbind on Solaris 9</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>38. <a href="Other-Clients.html">Samba and Other CIFS Clients</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="Other-Clients.html#id2975129">Macintosh Clients</a></dt><dt><a href="Other-Clients.html#id2975206">OS2 Client</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="Other-Clients.html#id2975213">Configuring OS/2 Warp Connect or OS/2 Warp 4</a></dt><dt><a href="Other-Clients.html#id2975348">Configuring Other Versions of OS/2</a></dt><dt><a href="Other-Clients.html#id2975411">Printer Driver Download for OS/2 Clients</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="Other-Clients.html#id2975516">Windows for Workgroups</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="Other-Clients.html#id2975524">Latest TCP/IP Stack from Microsoft</a></dt><dt><a href="Other-Clients.html#id2975610">Delete .pwl Files After Password Change</a></dt><dt><a href="Other-Clients.html#id2975641">Configuring Windows for Workgroups Password Handling</a></dt><dt><a href="Other-Clients.html#id2975701">Password Case Sensitivity</a></dt><dt><a href="Other-Clients.html#id2975739">Use TCP/IP as Default Protocol</a></dt><dt><a href="Other-Clients.html#id2975757">Speed Improvement</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="Other-Clients.html#id2975803">Windows 95/98</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="Other-Clients.html#id2975876">Speed Improvement</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="Other-Clients.html#id2975901">Windows 2000 Service Pack 2</a></dt><dt><a href="Other-Clients.html#id2976103">Windows NT 3.1</a></dt></dl></dd><dt>39. <a href="speed.html">Samba Performance Tuning</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="speed.html#id2976235">Comparisons</a></dt><dt><a href="speed.html#id2976281">Socket Options</a></dt><dt><a href="speed.html#id2976372">Read Size</a></dt><dt><a href="speed.html#id2976422">Max Xmit</a></dt><dt><a href="speed.html#id2976477">Log Level</a></dt><dt><a href="speed.html#id2976507">Read Raw</a></dt><dt><a href="speed.html#id2976592">Write Raw</a></dt><dt><a href="speed.html#id2976655">Slow Logins</a></dt><dt><a href="speed.html#id2976683">Client Tuning</a></dt><dt><a href="speed.html#id2976707">Samba Performance Problem Due to Changing Linux Kernel</a></dt><dt><a href="speed.html#id2976766">Corrupt tdb Files</a></dt></dl></dd><dt>40. <a href="DNSDHCP.html">DNS and DHCP Configuration Guide</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="DNSDHCP.html#id2976885">Note</a></dt></dl></dd><dt>41. <a href="Further-Resources.html">Further Resources</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="Further-Resources.html#id2976952">Websites</a></dt><dt><a href="Further-Resources.html#id2977349">Related updates from Microsoft</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></div></div><div class="navfooter"><hr><table width="100%" summary="Navigation footer"><tr><td width="40%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="bugreport.html">Prev</a> </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="u" href="index.html">Up</a></td><td width="40%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="compiling.html">Next</a></td></tr><tr><td width="40%" align="left" valign="top">Chapter 35. Reporting Bugs </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="h" href="index.html">Home</a></td><td width="40%" align="right" valign="top"> Chapter 36. How to Compile Samba</td></tr></table></div></body></html> diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/Backup.html b/docs/htmldocs/Backup.html new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..aa573dfdb7 --- /dev/null +++ b/docs/htmldocs/Backup.html @@ -0,0 +1,11 @@ +<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>Chapter 28. Samba Backup Techniques</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.60.1"><link rel="home" href="index.html" title="SAMBA Project Documentation"><link rel="up" href="optional.html" title="Part III. Advanced Configuration"><link rel="previous" href="unicode.html" title="Chapter 27. Unicode/Charsets"><link rel="next" href="SambaHA.html" title="Chapter 29. High Availability Options"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="navheader"><table width="100%" summary="Navigation header"><tr><th colspan="3" align="center">Chapter 28. Samba Backup Techniques</th></tr><tr><td width="20%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="unicode.html">Prev</a> </td><th width="60%" align="center">Part III. Advanced Configuration</th><td width="20%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="SambaHA.html">Next</a></td></tr></table><hr></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="Backup"></a>Chapter 28. Samba Backup Techniques</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">John</span> <span class="othername">H.</span> <span class="surname">Terpstra</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org">jht@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="Backup.html#id2963903">Note</a></dt><dt><a href="Backup.html#id2963917">Features and Benefits</a></dt></dl></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2963903"></a>Note</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +This chapter did not make it into this release. +It is planned for the published release of this document. +</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2963917"></a>Features and Benefits</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +We need feedback from people who are backing up samba servers. +We would like to know what software tools you are using to backup +your samba server/s. +</p><p> +In particular, if you have any success and / or failure stories you could +share with other users this would be appreciated. +</p></div></div><div class="navfooter"><hr><table width="100%" summary="Navigation footer"><tr><td width="40%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="unicode.html">Prev</a> </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="u" href="optional.html">Up</a></td><td width="40%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="SambaHA.html">Next</a></td></tr><tr><td width="40%" align="left" valign="top">Chapter 27. Unicode/Charsets </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="h" href="index.html">Home</a></td><td width="40%" align="right" valign="top"> Chapter 29. High Availability Options</td></tr></table></div></body></html> diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/CUPS-printing.html b/docs/htmldocs/CUPS-printing.html new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..19c9d7a021 --- /dev/null +++ b/docs/htmldocs/CUPS-printing.html @@ -0,0 +1,3311 @@ +<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>Chapter 19. CUPS Printing Support</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.60.1"><link rel="home" href="index.html" title="SAMBA Project Documentation"><link rel="up" href="optional.html" title="Part III. Advanced Configuration"><link rel="previous" href="printing.html" title="Chapter 18. Classical Printing Support"><link rel="next" href="VFS.html" title="Chapter 20. Stackable VFS modules"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="navheader"><table width="100%" summary="Navigation header"><tr><th colspan="3" align="center">Chapter 19. CUPS Printing Support</th></tr><tr><td width="20%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="printing.html">Prev</a> </td><th width="60%" align="center">Part III. Advanced Configuration</th><td width="20%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="VFS.html">Next</a></td></tr></table><hr></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="CUPS-printing"></a>Chapter 19. CUPS Printing Support</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Kurt</span> <span class="surname">Pfeifle</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Danka Deutschland GmbH <br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:kpfeifle@danka.de">kpfeifle@danka.de</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Ciprian</span> <span class="surname">Vizitiu</span></h3><span class="contrib">drawings</span><div class="affiliation"><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:CVizitiu@gbif.org">CVizitiu@gbif.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Jelmer</span> <span class="othername">R.</span> <span class="surname">Vernooij</span></h3><span class="contrib">drawings</span><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">The Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jelmer@samba.org">jelmer@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><p class="pubdate"> (3 June 2003) </p></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2931072">Introduction</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2931079">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2931130">Overview</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2931182">Basic CUPS Support Configuration</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2931276">Linking smbd with libcups.so</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2931526">Simple smb.conf Settings for CUPS</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2931722">More Complex CUPS smb.conf Settings</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2932089">Advanced Configuration</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2932110">Central Spooling vs. Peer-to-Peer Printing</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2932163">Raw Print Serving Vendor Drivers on Windows Clients</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2932223">Installation of Windows Client Drivers</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#cups-raw">Explicitly Enable raw Printing for application/octet-stream</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2932552">Driver Upload Methods</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2932699">Advanced Intelligent Printing with PostScript Driver Download</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#gdipost">GDI on Windows -- PostScript on UNIX</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2932876">Windows Drivers, GDI and EMF</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2933049">UNIX Printfile Conversion and GUI Basics</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#post-and-ghost">PostScript and Ghostscript</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2933354">Ghostscript the Software RIP for Non-PostScript Printers</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2933497">PostScript Printer Description (PPD) Specification</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2933573">Using Windows-Formatted Vendor PPDs</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2933679">CUPS Also Uses PPDs for Non-PostScript Printers</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2933709">The CUPS Filtering Architecture</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2933883">MIME Types and CUPS Filters</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2934118">MIME Type Conversion Rules</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2934287">Filtering Overview</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2934481">Prefilters</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2934591">pstops</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2934715">pstoraster</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2934912">imagetops and imagetoraster</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2934991">rasterto [printers specific]</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2935143">CUPS Backends</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2935508">The Role of cupsomatic/foomatic</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2935673">The Complete Picture</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2935688">mime.convs</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2935752">Raw Printing</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2935861">application/octet-stream Printing</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2936129">PostScript Printer Descriptions (PPDs) for Non-PS Printers</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2936430">cupsomatic/foomatic-rip Versus native CUPS Printing</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2936743">Examples for Filtering Chains</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2937128">Sources of CUPS Drivers/PPDs</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2937265">Printing with Interface Scripts</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2937358">Network Printing (Purely Windows)</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2937377">From Windows Clients to an NT Print Server</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2937434">Driver Execution on the Client</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2937506">Driver Execution on the Server</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2937618">Network Printing (Windows Clients UNIX/Samba Print +Servers)</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2937639">From Windows Clients to a CUPS/Samba Print Server</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2937834">Samba Receiving Jobfiles and Passing Them to CUPS</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2937924">Network PostScript RIP</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2938025">PPDs for Non-PS Printers on UNIX</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2938085">PPDs for Non-PS Printers on Windows</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2938166">Windows Terminal Servers (WTS) as CUPS Clients</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2938184">Printer Drivers Running in Kernel Mode Cause Many +Problems</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2938229">Workarounds Impose Heavy Limitations</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2938250">CUPS: A Magical Stone?</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2938313">PostScript Drivers with No Major Problems Even in Kernel +Mode</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2938378">Configuring CUPS for Driver Download</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2938397">cupsaddsmb: The Unknown Utility</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2938514">Prepare Your smb.conf for cupsaddsmb</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2938755">CUPS PostScript Driver for Windows NT/200x/XP</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2939044">Recognizing Different Driver Files</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2939174">Acquiring the Adobe Driver Files</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2939204">ESP Print Pro PostScript Driver for Windows NT/200x/XP</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2939274">Caveats to be Considered</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2939571">Windows CUPS PostScript Driver Versus Adobe Driver</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2939801">Run cupsaddsmb (Quiet Mode)</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2939946">Run cupsaddsmb with Verbose Output</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2940175">Understanding cupsaddsmb</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2940352">How to Recognize If cupsaddsmb Completed Successfully</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2940450">cupsaddsmb with a Samba PDC</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2940538">cupsaddsmb Flowchart</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2940621">Installing the PostScript Driver on a Client</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2940801">Avoiding Critical PostScript Driver Settings on the Client</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2940875">Installing PostScript Driver Files Manually Using rpcclient</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2941083">A Check of the rpcclient man Page</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2941229">Understanding the rpcclient man Page</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2941358">Producing an Example by Querying a Windows Box</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2941534">Requirements for adddriver and setdriver to Succeed</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2941782">Manual Driver Installation in 15 Steps</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2942909">Troubleshooting Revisited</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2943077">The Printing *.tdb Files</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2943322">Trivial Database Files</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2943400">Binary Format</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2943470">Losing *.tdb Files</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2943528">Using tdbbackup</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2943673">CUPS Print Drivers from Linuxprinting.org</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2943860">foomatic-rip and Foomatic Explained</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2944657">foomatic-rip and Foomatic-PPD Download and Installation</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2945207">Page Accounting with CUPS</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2945248">Setting Up Quotas</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2945318">Correct and Incorrect Accounting</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2945366">Adobe and CUPS PostScript Drivers for Windows Clients</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2945495">The page_log File Syntax</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2945665">Possible Shortcomings</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2945745">Future Developments</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2945799">Additional Material</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2946030">Auto-Deletion or Preservation of CUPS Spool Files</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2946094">CUPS Configuration Settings Explained</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2946198">Pre-Conditions</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2946367">Manual Configuration</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2946425">Printing from CUPS to Windows Attached Printers</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2946721">More CUPS-Filtering Chains</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2946814">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2946820">Windows 9x/ME Client Can't Install Driver</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2946839">cupsaddsmb Keeps Asking for Root Password in Never-ending Loop</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2946889">cupsaddsmb Errors</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2946973">Client Can't Connect to Samba Printer</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2947002">New Account Reconnection from Windows 200x/XP Troubles</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2947106">Avoid Being Connected to the Samba Server as the Wrong User</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2947158">Upgrading to CUPS Drivers from Adobe Drivers</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2947200">Can't Use cupsaddsmb on Samba Server Which Is a PDC</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2947239">Deleted Windows 200x Printer Driver Is Still Shown</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2947278">Windows 200x/XP "Local Security Policies"</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2947293">Administrator Cannot Install Printers for All Local Users</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2947323">Print Change Notify Functions on NT-clients</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2947350">WinXP-SP1</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2947402">Print Options for All Users Can't Be Set on Windows 200x/XP</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2947717">Most Common Blunders in Driver Settings on Windows Clients</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2947779">cupsaddsmb Does Not Work with Newly Installed Printer</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2947835">Permissions on /var/spool/samba/ Get Reset After Each Reboot</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2947951">Print Queue Called lp Mis-handles Print Jobs</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2948008">Location of Adobe PostScript Driver Files for cupsaddsmb</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2948065">Overview of the CUPS Printing Processes</a></dt></dl></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2931072"></a>Introduction</h2></div></div><div></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2931079"></a>Features and Benefits</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + The Common UNIX Print System (<ulink url="http://www.cups.org/">CUPS</ulink>) + has become quite popular. All major Linux distributions now ship it as their default printing + system. To many, it is still a mystical tool. Mostly, it just works. + People tend to regard it as a “<span class="quote">black box</span>” + that they do not want to look into as long as it works. But once + there is a little problem, they are in trouble to find out where to + start debugging it. Refer to the chapter “<span class="quote">Classical Printing</span>” that + contains a lot of information that is relevant for CUPS. + </p><p> + CUPS sports quite a few unique and powerful features. While their + basic functions may be grasped quite easily, they are also + new. Because they are different from other, more traditional printing + systems, it is best not to try and apply any prior knowledge about + printing to this new system. Rather, try to understand CUPS + from the beginning. This documentation will lead you to a + complete understanding of CUPS. Let's start with the most basic + things first. + </p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2931130"></a>Overview</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + CUPS is more than just a print spooling system. It is a complete + printer management system that complies with the new + Internet Printing Protocol (IPP). IPP is an industry + and Internet Engineering Task Force (IETF) + standard for network printing. Many of its functions can be managed + remotely (or locally) via a Web browser (giving you a + platform-independent access to the CUPS print server). Additionally, it + has the traditional command line and several more modern GUI interfaces + (GUI interfaces developed by third parties, like KDE's + overwhelming <ulink url="http://printing.kde.org/">KDEPrint</ulink>). + </p><p> + CUPS allows creation of “<span class="quote">raw</span>” printers (i.e., no print file + format translation) as well as “<span class="quote">smart</span>” printers (i.e., CUPS does + file format conversion as required for the printer). In many ways + this gives CUPS similar capabilities to the MS Windows print + monitoring system. Of course, if you are a CUPS advocate, you would + argue that CUPS is better! In any case, let us now move on to + explore how one may configure CUPS for interfacing with MS Windows + print clients via Samba. + </p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2931182"></a>Basic CUPS Support Configuration</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> + Printing with CUPS in the most basic <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> setup in Samba-3.0 (as was true for 2.2.x) only needs two + settings: <a class="indexterm" name="id2931202"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>printing</tt></i> = cups and + <a class="indexterm" name="id2931216"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>printcap</tt></i> = cups. CUPS does not need a printcap file. + However, the <tt class="filename">cupsd.conf</tt> configuration file knows of two related directives that control + how such a file will be automatically created and maintained by CUPS for the convenience of third-party + applications (example: <i class="parameter"><tt>Printcap /etc/printcap</tt></i> and <i class="parameter"><tt>PrintcapFormat BSD</tt></i>). + Legacy programs often require the existence of a printcap file containing printer names or they will refuse to + print. Make sure CUPS is set to generate and maintain a printcap file. For details, see + <b class="command">man cupsd.conf</b> and other CUPS-related documentation, like the wealth of documents on your CUPS server + itself: <ulink url="http://localhost:631/documentation.html">http://localhost:631/documentation.html</ulink>. + </p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2931276"></a>Linking smbd with libcups.so</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + Samba has a special relationship to CUPS. Samba can be compiled with CUPS library support. + Most recent installations have this support enabled. Per default, CUPS linking is compiled + into smbd and other Samba binaries. Of course, you can use CUPS even + if Samba is not linked against <tt class="filename">libcups.so</tt> but + there are some differences in required or supported configuration. + </p><p> + When Samba is compiled against <tt class="filename">libcups</tt>, <a class="indexterm" name="id2931315"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>printcap</tt></i> = cups + uses the CUPS API to list printers, submit jobs, query queues, and so on. Otherwise it maps to the System V + commands with an additional <b class="command">-oraw</b> option for printing. On a Linux + system, you can use the <b class="command">ldd</b> utility to find out details (ldd may not be present on + other OS platforms, or its function may be embodied by a different command): + </p><pre class="screen"> +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>ldd `which smbd`</tt></b> +libssl.so.0.9.6 => /usr/lib/libssl.so.0.9.6 (0x4002d000) +libcrypto.so.0.9.6 => /usr/lib/libcrypto.so.0.9.6 (0x4005a000) +libcups.so.2 => /usr/lib/libcups.so.2 (0x40123000) +[....] +</pre><p> + The line <tt class="computeroutput">libcups.so.2 => /usr/lib/libcups.so.2 (0x40123000)</tt> shows + there is CUPS support compiled into this version of Samba. If this is the case, and printing = cups + is set, then <span class="emphasis"><em>any otherwise manually set print command in <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> is ignored</em></span>. + This is an important point to remember! + </p><div class="tip" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Tip</h3><p> Should it be necessary, for any reason, to set your own print commands, you can do this by setting + <a class="indexterm" name="id2931409"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>printing</tt></i> = sysv. However, you will loose all the benefits + of tight CUPS/Samba integration. When you do this you must manually configure the printing system commands + (most important: + <a class="indexterm" name="id2931426"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>print command</tt></i>; other commands are + <a class="indexterm" name="id2931440"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>lppause command</tt></i>, + <a class="indexterm" name="id2931454"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>lpresume command</tt></i>, + <a class="indexterm" name="id2931468"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>lpq command</tt></i>, + <a class="indexterm" name="id2931482"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>lprm command</tt></i>, + <a class="indexterm" name="id2931496"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>queuepause command</tt></i> and + <a class="indexterm" name="id2931510"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>queue resume command</tt></i>).</p></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2931526"></a>Simple <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> Settings for CUPS</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + To summarize, <link linkend="cups-exam-simple"> shows simplest printing-related setup for <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> to enable basic CUPS support: + </p><div class="example"><a name="cups-exam-simple"></a><p class="title"><b>Example 19.1. Simplest printing-related smb.conf</b></p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td> </td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>[global]</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>load printers = yes</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>printing = cups</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>printcap name = cups</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td> </td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>[printers]</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>comment = All Printers</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>path = /var/spool/samba</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>browseable = no</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>public = yes</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>guest ok = yes</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>writable = no</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>printable = yes</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>printer admin = root, @ntadmins</tt></i></td></tr></table></div><p> + This is all you need for basic printing setup for CUPS. It will print + all graphic, text, PDF, and PostScript files submitted from Windows + clients. However, most of your Windows users would not know how to + send these kinds of files to print without opening a GUI + application. Windows clients tend to have local printer drivers + installed, and the GUI application's print buttons start a printer + driver. Your users also rarely send files from the command + line. Unlike UNIX clients, they hardly submit graphic, text or PDF + formatted files directly to the spooler. They nearly exclusively print + from GUI applications with a “<span class="quote">printer driver</span>” hooked in between the + application's native format and the print-data-stream. If the backend + printer is not a PostScript device, the print data stream is “<span class="quote">binary,</span>” + sensible only for the target printer. Read on to learn which problem + this may cause and how to avoid it. + </p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2931722"></a>More Complex CUPS <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> Settings</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + <link linkend="overridesettings"> is a slightly more complex printing-related setup + for <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt>. It enables general CUPS printing + support for all printers, but defines one printer share, which is set + up differently. + </p><div class="example"><a name="overridesettings"></a><p class="title"><b>Example 19.2. Overriding global CUPS settings for one printer</b></p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td> </td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>[global]</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>printing = cups</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>printcap name = cups</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>load printers = yes</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td> </td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>[printers]</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>comment = All Printers</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>path = /var/spool/samba</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>public = yes</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>guest ok = yes</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>writable = no</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>printable = yes</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>printer admin = root, @ntadmins</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td> </td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>[special_printer]</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>comment = A special printer with his own settings</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>path = /var/spool/samba-special</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>printing = sysv</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>printcap = lpstat</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>print command = echo "NEW: `date`: printfile %f" >> /tmp/smbprn.log ; \</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>echo " `date`: p-%p s-%s f-%f" >> /tmp/smbprn.log ; \</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>echo " `date`: j-%j J-%J z-%z c-%c" >> /tmp/smbprn.log : rm %f</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>public = no</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>guest ok = no</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>writeable = no</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>printable = yes</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>printer admin = kurt</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>hosts deny = 0.0.0.0</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>hosts allow = turbo_xp, 10.160.50.23, 10.160.51.60</tt></i></td></tr></table></div><p> + This special share is only there for testing purposes. It does not write the print job to a file. It just logs the job parameters + known to Samba into the <tt class="filename">/tmp/smbprn.log</tt> file and deletes the jobfile. Moreover, the + <a class="indexterm" name="id2932031"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>printer admin</tt></i> of this share is “<span class="quote">kurt</span>” (not the “<span class="quote">@ntadmins</span>” group), + guest access is not allowed, the share isn't published to the Network Neighborhood (so you need to know it is there), and it only + allows access from only three hosts. To prevent CUPS kicking in and taking over the print jobs for that share, we need to set + <a class="indexterm" name="id2932058"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>printing</tt></i> = sysv and + <a class="indexterm" name="id2932072"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>printcap</tt></i> = lpstat. + </p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2932089"></a>Advanced Configuration</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> + Before we delve into all the configuration options, let us clarify a few + points. <span class="emphasis"><em>Network printing needs to be organized and setup + correctly</em></span>. This frequently doesn't happen. Legacy systems + or small business LAN environments often lack design and good housekeeping. + </p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2932110"></a>Central Spooling vs. “<span class="quote">Peer-to-Peer</span>” Printing</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2932125"></a> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2932136"></a> + Many small office or home networks, as well as badly organized larger + environments, allow each client a direct access to available network + printers. This is generally a bad idea. It often blocks one client's + access to the printer when another client's job is printing. It might + freeze the first client's application while it is waiting to get + rid of the job. Also, there are frequent complaints about various jobs + being printed with their pages mixed with each other. A better concept + is the usage of a print server: it routes all jobs through one + central system, which responds immediately, takes jobs from multiple + concurrent clients at the same time, and in turn transfers them to the + printer(s) in the correct order. + </p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2932163"></a>Raw Print Serving Vendor Drivers on Windows Clients</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + <a class="indexterm" name="id2932178"></a> + <a class="indexterm" name="id2932186"></a> + Most traditionally configured UNIX print servers acting on behalf of + Samba's Windows clients represented a really simple setup. Their only + task was to manage the “<span class="quote">raw</span>” spooling of all jobs handed to them by + Samba. This approach meant that the Windows clients were expected to + prepare the print job file that its ready to be sent to the printing + device. Here is a native (vendor-supplied) Windows printer + driver for the target device needed to be installed on each and every + client. + </p><p> + It is possible to configure CUPS, Samba and your Windows clients in the + same traditional and simple way. When CUPS printers are configured + for RAW print-through mode operation, it is the responsibility of the + Samba client to fully render the print job (file). The file must be + sent in a format that is suitable for direct delivery to the + printer. Clients need to run the vendor-provided drivers to do + this. In this case, CUPS will not do any print file format conversion + work. + </p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2932223"></a>Installation of Windows Client Drivers</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + The printer drivers on the Windows clients may be installed + in two functionally different ways: + </p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Manually install the drivers locally on each client, + one by one; this yields the old <span class="emphasis"><em>LanMan</em></span> style + printing and uses a <tt class="filename">\\sambaserver\printershare</tt> + type of connection.</p></li><li><p> + <a class="indexterm" name="id2932265"></a> + Deposit and prepare the drivers (for later download) on + the print server (Samba); this enables the clients to use + “<span class="quote">Point'n'Print</span>” to get drivers semi-automatically installed the + first time they access the printer; with this method NT/200x/XP + clients use the <span class="emphasis"><em>SPOOLSS/MS-RPC</em></span> + type printing calls.</p></li></ul></div><p> + The second method is recommended for use over the first. + </p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="cups-raw"></a>Explicitly Enable “<span class="quote">raw</span>” Printing for <span class="emphasis"><em>application/octet-stream</em></span></h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + <a class="indexterm" name="id2932317"></a> + <a class="indexterm" name="id2932325"></a> + <a class="indexterm" name="id2932334"></a> + If you use the first option (drivers are installed on the client + side), there is one setting to take care of: CUPS needs to be told + that it should allow “<span class="quote">raw</span>” printing of deliberate (binary) file + formats. The CUPS files that need to be correctly set for RAW mode + printers to work are: + </p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p><tt class="filename">/etc/cups/mime.types</tt></p></li><li><p><tt class="filename">/etc/cups/mime.convs</tt></p></li></ul></div><p> + Both contain entries (at the end of the respective files) which must + be uncommented to allow RAW mode operation. + In <tt class="filename">/etc/cups/mime.types</tt>, make sure this line is + present: + + </p><pre class="programlisting"> + application/octet-stream + </pre><p> + + <a class="indexterm" name="id2932400"></a> + <a class="indexterm" name="id2932408"></a> + + In <tt class="filename">/etc/cups/mime.convs</tt>, + have this line: + + <a class="indexterm" name="id2932425"></a> + + </p><pre class="programlisting"> + application/octet-stream application/vnd.cups-raw 0 - + </pre><p> + + If these two files are not set up correctly for raw Windows client + printing, you may encounter the dreaded <tt class="computeroutput">Unable to + convert file 0</tt> in your CUPS error_log file. + </p><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p>Editing the <tt class="filename">mime.convs</tt> and the + <tt class="filename">mime.types</tt> file does not + <span class="emphasis"><em>enforce</em></span> “<span class="quote">raw</span>” printing, it only + <span class="emphasis"><em>allows</em></span> it. + </p></div><p><b>Background. </b> + <a class="indexterm" name="id2932493"></a> + CUPS being a more security-aware printing system than traditional ones + does not by default allow a user to send deliberate (possibly binary) + data to printing devices. This could be easily abused to launch a + “<span class="quote">Denial of Service</span>” attack on your printer(s), causing at least + the loss of a lot of paper and ink. “<span class="quote">Unknown</span>” data are tagged by CUPS + as <i class="parameter"><tt>MIME type: application/octet-stream</tt></i> and not + allowed to go to the printer. By default, you can only send other + (known) MIME types “<span class="quote">raw</span>”. Sending data “<span class="quote">raw</span>” means that CUPS does not + try to convert them and passes them to the printer untouched (see the next + chapter for even more background explanations). + </p><p> + This is all you need to know to get the CUPS/Samba combo printing + “<span class="quote">raw</span>” files prepared by Windows clients, which have vendor drivers + locally installed. If you are not interested in background information about + more advanced CUPS/Samba printing, simply skip the remaining sections + of this chapter. + </p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2932552"></a>Driver Upload Methods</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + This section describes three familiar methods, plus one new one, by which + printer drivers may be uploaded. + </p><p> + <a class="indexterm" name="id2932570"></a> + If you want to use the MS-RPC type printing, you must upload the + drivers onto the Samba server first (<i class="parameter"><tt>[print$]</tt></i> + share). For a discussion on how to deposit printer drivers on the + Samba host (so the Windows clients can download and use them via + “<span class="quote">Point'n'Print</span>”), please refer to the previous chapter of this + HOWTO Collection. There you will find a description or reference to + three methods of preparing the client drivers on the Samba server: + </p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p> + <a class="indexterm" name="id2932606"></a> + The GUI, “<span class="quote">Add Printer Wizard</span>” + <span class="emphasis"><em>upload-from-a-Windows-client</em></span> + method.</p></li><li><p>The command line, “<span class="quote">smbclient/rpcclient</span>” + upload-from-a-UNIX-workstation method.</p></li><li><p> + <a class="indexterm" name="id2932640"></a> + The Imprints Toolset + method.</p></li></ul></div><p> + These three methods apply to CUPS all the same. A new and more + convenient way to load the Windows drivers into Samba is provided + if you use CUPS: + </p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p> + <a class="indexterm" name="id2932666"></a> + the <i class="parameter"><tt>cupsaddsmb</tt></i> + utility.</p></li></ul></div><p> + <b class="command">cupsaddsmb</b> is discussed in much detail further below. But we first + explore the CUPS filtering system and compare the Windows and UNIX printing architectures. + </p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2932699"></a>Advanced Intelligent Printing with PostScript Driver Download</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> + <a class="indexterm" name="id2932710"></a> + We now know + how to set up a “<span class="quote">dump</span>” printserver, that is, a server which is spooling + printjobs “<span class="quote">raw</span>”, leaving the print data untouched. + </p><p> + Possibly you need to setup CUPS in a smarter way. The reasons could + be manifold: + </p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Maybe your boss wants to get monthly statistics: Which + printer did how many pages? What was the average data size of a job? + What was the average print run per day? What are the typical hourly + peaks in printing? Which department prints how much?</p></li><li><p>Maybe you are asked to setup a print quota system: + Users should not be able to print more jobs, once they have surpassed + a given limit per period.</p></li><li><p>Maybe your previous network printing setup is a mess + and must be re-organized from a clean beginning.</p></li><li><p>Maybe you have experiencing too many “<span class="quote">blue screens</span>” + originating from poorly debugged printer drivers running in NT “<span class="quote">kernel mode</span>”?</p></li></ul></div><p> + These goals cannot be achieved by a raw print server. To build a + server meeting these requirements, you'll first need to learn about + how CUPS works and how you can enable its features. + </p><p> + What follows is the comparison of some fundamental concepts for + Windows and UNIX printing; then follows a description of the + CUPS filtering system, how it works and how you can tweak it. + </p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="gdipost"></a>GDI on Windows -- PostScript on UNIX</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + <a class="indexterm" name="id2932814"></a> + <a class="indexterm" name="id2932822"></a> + Network printing is one of the most complicated and error-prone + day-to-day tasks any user or administrator may encounter. This is + true for all OS platforms. And there are reasons for this. + </p><p> + <a class="indexterm" name="id2932838"></a> + <a class="indexterm" name="id2932846"></a> + You can't expect most file formats to just throw them toward + printers and they get printed. There needs to be a file format + conversion in between. The problem is that there is no common standard for + print file formats across all manufacturers and printer types. While + PostScript (trademark held by Adobe) and, to an + extent, PCL (trademark held by HP) have developed + into semi-official “<span class="quote">standards</span>” by being the most widely used PDLs + Page Description Languages (PDLs), there are still + many manufacturers who “<span class="quote">roll their own</span>” (their reasons may be + unacceptable license fees for using printer-embedded PostScript + interpreters, and so on). + </p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2932876"></a>Windows Drivers, GDI and EMF</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + <a class="indexterm" name="id2932888"></a> + <a class="indexterm" name="id2932896"></a> + <a class="indexterm" name="id2932904"></a> + In Windows OS, the format conversion job is done by the printer + drivers. On MS Windows OS platforms all application programmers have + at their disposal a built-in API, the Graphical Device + Interface (GDI), as part and parcel of the OS itself to base + themselves on. This GDI core is used as one common unified ground for + all Windows programs to draw pictures, fonts and documents + <span class="emphasis"><em>on screen</em></span> as well as <span class="emphasis"><em>on + paper</em></span> (print). Therefore, printer driver developers can + standardize on a well-defined GDI output for their own driver + input. Achieving WYSIWYG (“<span class="quote">What You See Is What You Get</span>”) is + relatively easy, because the on-screen graphic primitives, as well as + the on-paper drawn objects, come from one common source. This source, + the GDI, often produces a file format called Enhanced + MetaFile (EMF). The EMF is processed by the printer driver and + converted to the printer-specific file format. + </p><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p> + <a class="indexterm" name="id2932947"></a> + To the GDI foundation in MS Windows, Apple has chosen to + put paper and screen output on a common foundation for their + (BSD-UNIX-based, did you know?) Mac OS X and Darwin Operating + <a class="indexterm" name="id2932959"></a> + <a class="indexterm" name="id2932967"></a> + <a class="indexterm" name="id2932976"></a> + <a class="indexterm" name="id2932984"></a> + Systems. Their <span class="emphasis"><em>Core Graphic Engine</em></span> uses a + <span class="emphasis"><em>PDF</em></span> derivative for all display work. + </p></div><p> + + </p><div class="figure"><a name="1small"></a><p class="title"><b>Figure 19.1. Windows printing to a local printer.</b></p><div class="mediaobject"><img src="projdoc/imagefiles/1small.png" width="270" alt="Windows printing to a local printer."></div></div><p> + </p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2933049"></a>UNIX Printfile Conversion and GUI Basics</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + <a class="indexterm" name="id2933059"></a> + <a class="indexterm" name="id2933067"></a> + <a class="indexterm" name="id2933075"></a> + <a class="indexterm" name="id2933084"></a> + In UNIX and Linux, there is no comparable layer built into the OS + kernel(s) or the X (screen display) server. Every application is + responsible for itself to create its print output. Fortunately, most + use PostScript and that at least gives some common ground. Unfortunately, + there are many different levels of quality for this PostScript. And + worse, there is a huge difference (and no common root) in the way + the same document is displayed on screen and how it is presented on + paper. WYSIWYG is more difficult to achieve. This goes back to the + time, decades ago, when the predecessors of X.org, + designing the UNIX foundations and protocols for Graphical User + Interfaces, refused to take responsibility for “<span class="quote">paper output</span>” + also, as some had demanded at the time, and restricted itself to + “<span class="quote">on-screen only.</span>” (For some years now, the “<span class="quote">Xprint</span>” project has been + under development, attempting to build printing support into the X + framework, including a PostScript and a PCL driver, but it is not yet + ready for prime time.) You can see this unfavorable inheritance up to + the present day by looking into the various “<span class="quote">font</span>” directories on your + system; there are separate ones for fonts used for X display and fonts + to be used on paper. + </p><p><b>Background. </b> + <a class="indexterm" name="id2933141"></a> + The PostScript programming language is an “<span class="quote">invention</span>” by Adobe Inc., + but its specifications have been published to the full. Its strength + lies in its powerful abilities to describe graphical objects (fonts, + shapes, patterns, lines, curves, and dots), their attributes (color, + linewidth) and the way to manipulate (scale, distort, rotate, + shift) them. Because of its open specification, anybody with the + skill can start writing his own implementation of a PostScript + interpreter and use it to display PostScript files on screen or on + paper. Most graphical output devices are based on the concept of + “<span class="quote">raster images</span>” or “<span class="quote">pixels</span>” (one notable exception is pen + plotters). Of course, you can look at a PostScript file in its textual + form and you will be reading its PostScript code, the language + instructions which need to be interpreted by a rasterizer. Rasterizers + produce pixel images, which may be displayed on screen by a viewer + program or on paper by a printer. + </p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="post-and-ghost"></a>PostScript and Ghostscript</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + <a class="indexterm" name="id2933199"></a> + <a class="indexterm" name="id2933207"></a> + <a class="indexterm" name="id2933218"></a> + So, UNIX is lacking a common ground for printing on paper and + displaying on screen. Despite this unfavorable legacy for UNIX, basic + printing is fairly easy if you have PostScript printers at your + disposal. The reason is these devices have a built-in PostScript + language “<span class="quote">interpreter,</span>” also called a Raster Image + Processor (RIP) (which makes them more expensive than + other types of printers); throw PostScript toward them, and they will + spit out your printed pages. Their RIP is doing all the hard work of + converting the PostScript drawing commands into a bitmap picture as + you see it on paper, in a resolution as done by your printer. This is + no different to PostScript printing a file from a Windows origin. + </p><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p> + <a class="indexterm" name="id2933261"></a> + Traditional UNIX programs and printing systems while + using PostScript are largely not PPD-aware. PPDs are “<span class="quote">PostScript + Printer Description</span>” files. They enable you to specify and control all + options a printer supports: duplexing, stapling and punching. Therefore, + UNIX users for a long time couldn't choose many of the supported + device and job options, unlike Windows or Apple users. But now there + is CUPS. + </p></div><p> + </p><div class="figure"><a name="2small"></a><p class="title"><b>Figure 19.2. Printing to a PostScript printer.</b></p><div class="mediaobject"><img src="projdoc/imagefiles/2small.png" width="270" alt="Printing to a PostScript printer."></div></div><p> + </p><p> + <a class="indexterm" name="id2933337"></a> + However, there are other types of printers out there. These do not know + how to print PostScript. They use their own Page Description + Language (PDL, often proprietary). To print to them is much + more demanding. Since your UNIX applications mostly produce + PostScript, and since these devices do not understand PostScript, you + need to convert the printfiles to a format suitable for your printer + on the host before you can send it away. + </p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2933354"></a>Ghostscript the Software RIP for Non-PostScript Printers</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + <a class="indexterm" name="id2933369"></a> + Here is where Ghostscript kicks in. Ghostscript is + the traditional (and quite powerful) PostScript interpreter used on + UNIX platforms. It is a RIP in software, capable of doing a + <span class="emphasis"><em>lot</em></span> of file format conversions for a very broad + spectrum of hardware devices as well as software file formats. + Ghostscript technology and drivers are what enable PostScript printing + to non-PostScript hardware. + </p><p> + </p><div class="figure"><a name="3small"></a><p class="title"><b>Figure 19.3. Ghostscript as a RIP for non-postscript printers.</b></p><div class="mediaobject"><img src="projdoc/imagefiles/3small.png" width="270" alt="Ghostscript as a RIP for non-postscript printers."></div></div><p> + </p><div class="tip" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Tip</h3><p> + Use the “<span class="quote">gs -h</span>” command to check for all built-in “<span class="quote">devices</span>” + of your Ghostscript version. If you specify a parameter of + <i class="parameter"><tt>-sDEVICE=png256</tt></i> on your Ghostscript command + line, you are asking Ghostscript to convert the input into a PNG + file. Naming a “<span class="quote">device</span>” on the command line is the most important + single parameter to tell Ghostscript exactly how it should render the + input. New Ghostscript versions are released at fairly regular + intervals, now by artofcode LLC. They are initially put under the + “<span class="quote">AFPL</span>” license, but re-released under the GNU GPL as soon as the next + AFPL version appears. GNU Ghostscript is probably the version + installed on most Samba systems. But it has some deficiencies. + <a class="indexterm" name="id2933472"></a> + Therefore, ESP Ghostscript was developed as an + enhancement over GNU Ghostscript, with lots of bug-fixes, additional + devices and improvements. It is jointly maintained by developers from + CUPS, Gimp-Print, MandrakeSoft, SuSE, RedHat, and Debian. It includes + the “<span class="quote">cups</span>” device (essential to print to non-PS printers from CUPS). + </p></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2933497"></a>PostScript Printer Description (PPD) Specification</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + <a class="indexterm" name="id2933509"></a> + While PostScript in essence is a Page Description + Language (PDL) to represent the page layout in a + device-independent way, real-world print jobs are + always ending up being output on hardware with device-specific + features. To take care of all the differences in hardware and to + allow for innovations, Adobe has specified a syntax and file format + for PostScript Printer Description (PPD) + files. Every PostScript printer ships with one of these files. + </p><p> + PPDs contain all the information about general and special features of the + given printer model: Which different resolutions can it handle? Does + it have a Duplexing Unit? How many paper trays are there? What media + types and sizes does it take? For each item, it also names the special + command string to be sent to the printer (mostly inside the PostScript + file) in order to enable it. + </p><p> + Information from these PPDs is meant to be taken into account by the + printer drivers. Therefore, installed as part of the Windows + PostScript driver for a given printer is the printer's PPD. Where it + makes sense, the PPD features are presented in the drivers' UI dialogs + to display to the user a choice of print options. In the end, the + user selections are somehow written (in the form of special + PostScript, PJL, JCL or vendor-dependent commands) into the PostScript + file created by the driver. + </p><div class="warning" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Warning</h3><p> + <a class="indexterm" name="id2933556"></a> + A PostScript file that was created to contain device-specific commands + for achieving a certain print job output (e.g., duplexed, stapled and + punched) on a specific target machine, may not print as expected, or + may not be printable at all on other models; it also may not be fit + for further processing by software (e.g., by a PDF distilling program). + </p></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2933573"></a>Using Windows-Formatted Vendor PPDs</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + CUPS can handle all spec-compliant PPDs as supplied by the + manufacturers for their PostScript models. Even if a + vendor might not have mentioned our favorite + OS in his manuals and brochures, you can safely trust this: + <span class="emphasis"><em>If you get the Windows NT version of the PPD, you + can use it unchanged in CUPS</em></span> and thus access the full + power of your printer just like a Windows NT user could! + </p><div class="tip" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Tip</h3><p> + To check the spec compliance of any PPD online, go to <ulink url="http://www.cups.org/testppd.php">http://www.cups.org/testppd.php</ulink> + and upload your PPD. You will see the results displayed + immediately. CUPS in all versions after 1.1.19 has a much more strict + internal PPD parsing and checking code enabled; in case of printing + trouble, this online resource should be one of your first pitstops. + </p></div><div class="warning" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Warning</h3><p> + <a class="indexterm" name="id2933620"></a> + <a class="indexterm" name="id2933629"></a> + For real PostScript printers, <span class="emphasis"><em>do not</em></span> use the + <span class="emphasis"><em>Foomatic</em></span> or <span class="emphasis"><em>cupsomatic</em></span> + PPDs from Linuxprinting.org. With these devices, the original + vendor-provided PPDs are always the first choice! + </p></div><div class="tip" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Tip</h3><p> + If you are looking for an original vendor-provided PPD of a specific + device, and you know that an NT4 box (or any other Windows box) on + your LAN has the PostScript driver installed, just use + <b class="command">smbclient //NT4-box/print\$ -U username</b> to + access the Windows directory where all printer driver files are + stored. First look in the <tt class="filename">W32X86/2</tt> subdir for + the PPD you are seeking. + </p></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2933679"></a>CUPS Also Uses PPDs for Non-PostScript Printers</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + CUPS also uses specially crafted PPDs to handle non-PostScript + printers. These PPDs are usually not available from the vendors (and + no, you can't just take the PPD of a PostScript printer with the same + model name and hope it works for the non-PostScript version too). To + understand how these PPDs work for non-PS printers, we first need to + dive deeply into the CUPS filtering and file format conversion + architecture. Stay tuned. + </p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2933709"></a>The CUPS Filtering Architecture</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +The core of the CUPS filtering system is based on +Ghostscript. In addition to Ghostscript, CUPS +uses some other filters of its own. You (or your OS vendor) may have +plugged in even more filters. CUPS handles all data file formats under +the label of various MIME types. Every incoming +printfile is subjected to an initial +auto-typing. The auto-typing determines its given +MIME type. A given MIME type implies zero or more possible filtering +chains relevant to the selected target printer. This section discusses +how MIME types recognition and conversion rules interact. They are +used by CUPS to automatically setup a working filtering chain for any +given input data format. +</p><p> +If CUPS rasterizes a PostScript file natively to +a bitmap, this is done in two stages: +</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>The first stage uses a Ghostscript device named “<span class="quote">cups</span>” +(this is since version 1.1.15) and produces a generic raster format +called “<span class="quote">CUPS raster</span>”. +</p></li><li><p>The second stage uses a “<span class="quote">raster driver</span>” that converts + the generic CUPS raster to a device-specific raster.</p></li></ul></div><p> +Make sure your Ghostscript version has the “<span class="quote">cups</span>” device compiled in +(check with <b class="command">gs -h | grep cups</b>). Otherwise you +may encounter the dreaded <tt class="computeroutput">Unable to convert file +0</tt> in your CUPS error_log file. To have “<span class="quote">cups</span>” as a +device in your Ghostscript, you either need to patch GNU +Ghostscript and re-compile, or use <a class="indexterm" name="id2933802"></a><ulink url="http://www.cups.org/ghostscript.php">ESP Ghostscript</ulink>. The +superior alternative is ESP Ghostscript. It supports not just CUPS, +but 300 other devices too (while GNU Ghostscript supports only about +180). Because of this broad output device support, ESP Ghostscript is +the first choice for non-CUPS spoolers, too. It is now recommended by +Linuxprinting.org for all spoolers. +</p><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2933830"></a> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2933839"></a> +CUPS printers may be setup to use external +rendering paths. One of the most common is provided by the +Foomatic/cupsomatic concept from <ulink url="http://www.linuxprinting.org/">Linuxprinting.org.</ulink> This +uses the classical Ghostscript approach, doing everything in one +step. It does not use the “<span class="quote">cups</span>” device, but one of the many +others. However, even for Foomatic/cupsomatic usage, best results and +<a class="indexterm" name="id2933864"></a> +broadest printer model support is provided by ESP Ghostscript (more +about cupsomatic/Foomatic, particularly the new version called now +<span class="emphasis"><em>foomatic-rip</em></span>, follows below). +</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2933883"></a>MIME Types and CUPS Filters</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2933894"></a> + <a class="indexterm" name="id2933905"></a> +CUPS reads the file <tt class="filename">/etc/cups/mime.types</tt> +(and all other files carrying a <tt class="filename">*.types</tt> suffix +in the same directory) upon startup. These files contain the MIME +type recognition rules that are applied when CUPS runs its +auto-typing routines. The rule syntax is explained in the man page +for <tt class="filename">mime.types</tt> and in the comments section of the +<tt class="filename">mime.types</tt> file itself. A simple rule reads +like this: + +<a class="indexterm" name="id2933946"></a> +</p><pre class="programlisting"> + application/pdf pdf string(0,%PDF) +</pre><p> + +This means if a filename has either a +<tt class="filename">.pdf</tt> suffix or if the magic +string <span class="emphasis"><em>%PDF</em></span> is right at the +beginning of the file itself (offset 0 from the start), then it is +a PDF file (<i class="parameter"><tt>application/pdf</tt></i>). +Another rule is this: + +</p><pre class="programlisting"> + application/postscript ai eps ps string(0,%!) string(0,<04>%!) +</pre><p> + +If the filename has one of the suffixes +<tt class="filename">.ai</tt>, <tt class="filename">.eps</tt>, +<tt class="filename">.ps</tt> or if the file itself starts with one of the +strings <span class="emphasis"><em>%!</em></span> or <span class="emphasis"><em><04>%!</em></span>, it +is a generic PostScript file +(<i class="parameter"><tt>application/postscript</tt></i>). +</p><div class="warning" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Warning</h3><p> +Don't confuse the other mime.types files your system might be using +with the one in the <tt class="filename">/etc/cups/</tt> directory. +</p></div><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p> +There is an important difference between two similar MIME types in +CUPS: one is <i class="parameter"><tt>application/postscript</tt></i>, the other is +<i class="parameter"><tt>application/vnd.cups-postscript</tt></i>. While +<i class="parameter"><tt>application/postscript</tt></i> is meant to be device +independent (job options for the file are still outside the PS file +content, embedded in command line or environment variables by CUPS), +<i class="parameter"><tt>application/vnd.cups-postscript</tt></i> may have the job +options inserted into the PostScript data itself (where +applicable). The transformation of the generic PostScript +(<i class="parameter"><tt>application/postscript</tt></i>) to the device-specific version +(<i class="parameter"><tt>application/vnd.cups-postscript</tt></i>) is the responsibility of the +CUPS <i class="parameter"><tt>pstops</tt></i> filter. pstops uses information +contained in the PPD to do the transformation. +</p></div><p> +CUPS can handle ASCII text, HP-GL, PDF, PostScript, DVI, and +many image formats (GIF. PNG, TIFF, JPEG, Photo-CD, SUN-Raster, +PNM, PBM, SGI-RGB, and more) and their associated MIME types +with its filters. +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2934118"></a>MIME Type Conversion Rules</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2934130"></a> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2934138"></a> +CUPS reads the file <tt class="filename">/etc/cups/mime.convs</tt> +(and all other files named with a <tt class="filename">*.convs</tt> +suffix in the same directory) upon startup. These files contain +lines naming an input MIME type, an output MIME type, a format +conversion filter that can produce the output from the input type +and virtual costs associated with this conversion. One example line +reads like this: + +</p><pre class="programlisting"> + application/pdf application/postscript 33 pdftops +</pre><p> + +This means that the <i class="parameter"><tt>pdftops</tt></i> filter will take +<i class="parameter"><tt>application/pdf</tt></i> as input and produce +<i class="parameter"><tt>application/postscript</tt></i> as output; the virtual +cost of this operation is 33 CUPS-$. The next filter is more +expensive, costing 66 CUPS-$: + +<a class="indexterm" name="id2934198"></a> + +</p><pre class="programlisting"> + application/vnd.hp-HPGL application/postscript 66 hpgltops +</pre><p> + +This is the <i class="parameter"><tt>hpgltops</tt></i>, which processes HP-GL +plotter files to PostScript. + +<a class="indexterm" name="id2934222"></a> + +</p><pre class="programlisting"> + application/octet-stream +</pre><p> + +Here are two more examples: + +<a class="indexterm" name="id2934239"></a> + +</p><pre class="programlisting"> + application/x-shell application/postscript 33 texttops + text/plain application/postscript 33 texttops +</pre><p> + +The last two examples name the <i class="parameter"><tt>texttops</tt></i> filter +to work on <i class="parameter"><tt>text/plain</tt></i> as well as on <i class="parameter"><tt>application/x-shell</tt></i>. (Hint: +This differentiation is needed for the syntax highlighting feature of +<i class="parameter"><tt>texttops</tt></i>). +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2934287"></a>Filtering Overview</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2934298"></a> +There are many more combinations named in <tt class="filename">mime.convs</tt>. However, you +are not limited to use the ones pre-defined there. You can plug in any +filter you like into the CUPS framework. It must meet, or must be made +to meet, some minimal requirements. If you find (or write) a cool +conversion filter of some kind, make sure it complies to what CUPS +needs and put in the right lines in <tt class="filename">mime.types</tt> +and <tt class="filename">mime.convs</tt>, then it will work seamlessly +inside CUPS. +</p><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2934336"></a>Filter requirements</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> +The mentioned “<span class="quote">CUPS requirements</span>” for filters are simple. Take +filenames or <tt class="filename">stdin</tt> as input and write to +<tt class="filename">stdout</tt>. They should take these 5 or 6 arguments: +<span class="emphasis"><em>printer job user title copies options [filename]</em></span> +</p><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">Printer </span></dt><dd><p>The name of the printer queue (normally this is the +name of the filter being run).</p></dd><dt><span class="term">job </span></dt><dd><p>The numeric job ID for the job being +printed.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">user </span></dt><dd><p>The string from the originating-user-name +attribute.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">title </span></dt><dd><p>The string from the job-name attribute.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">copies </span></dt><dd><p>The numeric value from the number-copies +attribute.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">options </span></dt><dd><p>The job options.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">filename </span></dt><dd><p>(Optionally) The print request file (if missing, +filters expected data fed through <tt class="filename">stdin</tt>). In most +cases, it is easy to write a simple wrapper script around existing +filters to make them work with CUPS.</p></dd></dl></div></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2934481"></a>Prefilters</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2934492"></a> +As previously stated, PostScript is the central file format to any UNIX-based +printing system. From PostScript, CUPS generates raster data to feed +non-PostScript printers. +</p><p> +But what happens if you send one of the supported non-PS formats +to print? Then CUPS runs “<span class="quote">pre-filters</span>” on these input formats to +generate PostScript first. There are pre-filters to create PS from +ASCII text, PDF, DVI, or HP-GL. The outcome of these filters is always +of MIME type <i class="parameter"><tt>application/postscript</tt></i> (meaning that +any device-specific print options are not yet embedded into the +PostScript by CUPS, and that the next filter to be called is +pstops). Another pre-filter is running on all supported image formats, +the <i class="parameter"><tt>imagetops</tt></i> filter. Its outcome is always of +MIME type <i class="parameter"><tt>application/vnd.cups-postscript</tt></i> +(not application/postscript), meaning it has the +print options already embedded into the file. +</p><p> + </p><div class="figure"><a name="4small"></a><p class="title"><b>Figure 19.4. Pre-filtering in CUPS to form PostScript.</b></p><div class="mediaobject"><img src="projdoc/imagefiles/4small.png" width="270" alt="Pre-filtering in CUPS to form PostScript."></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2934591"></a>pstops</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +<span class="emphasis"><em>pstops</em></span> is the filter to convert +<i class="parameter"><tt>application/postscript</tt></i> to +<i class="parameter"><tt>application/vnd.cups-postscript</tt></i>. It was said +above that this filter inserts all device-specific print options +(commands to the printer to ask for the duplexing of output, or +stapling and punching it, and so on) into the PostScript file. +</p><p> + </p><div class="figure"><a name="5small"></a><p class="title"><b>Figure 19.5. Adding device-specific print options.</b></p><div class="mediaobject"><img src="projdoc/imagefiles/5small.png" width="270" alt="Adding device-specific print options."></div></div><p> +</p><p> +This is not all. Other tasks performed by it are: +</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p> +Selecting the range of pages to be printed (if you choose to +print only pages “<span class="quote">3, 6, 8-11, 16, 19-21</span>”, or only the odd numbered +ones). +</p></li><li><p> +Putting 2 or more logical pages on one sheet of paper (the +so-called “<span class="quote">number-up</span>” function). +</p></li><li><p>Counting the pages of the job to insert the accounting +information into the <tt class="filename">/var/log/cups/page_log</tt>. +</p></li></ul></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2934715"></a>pstoraster</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +<i class="parameter"><tt>pstoraster</tt></i> is at the core of the CUPS filtering +system. It is responsible for the first stage of the rasterization +process. Its input is of MIME type application/vnd.cups-postscript; +its output is application/vnd.cups-raster. This output format is not +yet meant to be printable. Its aim is to serve as a general purpose +input format for more specialized <span class="emphasis"><em>raster drivers</em></span> +that are able to generate device-specific printer data. +</p><p> + </p><div class="figure"><a name="6small"></a><p class="title"><b>Figure 19.6. PostScript to intermediate raster format.</b></p><div class="mediaobject"><img src="projdoc/imagefiles/6small.png" width="270" alt="PostScript to intermediate raster format."></div></div><p> +</p><p> +CUPS raster is a generic raster format with powerful features. It is +able to include per-page information, color profiles, and more, to be +used by the following downstream raster drivers. Its MIME type is +registered with IANA and its specification is, of course, completely +open. It is designed to make it quite easy and inexpensive for +manufacturers to develop Linux and UNIX raster drivers for their +printer models, should they choose to do so. CUPS always takes care +for the first stage of rasterization so these vendors do not need to care +about Ghostscript complications (in fact, there is currently more +than one vendor financing the development of CUPS raster drivers). +</p><p> + </p><div class="figure"><a name="7small"></a><p class="title"><b>Figure 19.7. CUPS-raster production using Ghostscript.</b></p><div class="mediaobject"><img src="projdoc/imagefiles/7small.png" width="270" alt="CUPS-raster production using Ghostscript."></div></div><p> +</p><p> +CUPS versions before version 1.1.15 were shipping a binary (or source +code) standalone filter, named <i class="parameter"><tt>pstoraster</tt></i>. <i class="parameter"><tt>pstoraster</tt></i> was derived +from GNU Ghostscript 5.50, and could be installed besides and in +addition to any GNU or AFPL Ghostscript package without conflicting. +</p><p> +>From version 1.1.15, this has changed. The functions for this have been +integrated back into Ghostscript (now based on GNU Ghostscript version +7.05). The <i class="parameter"><tt>pstoraster</tt></i> filter is now a simple shell script calling +<b class="command">gs</b> with the <b class="command">-sDEVICE=cups</b> +parameter. If your Ghostscript does not show a success on asking for +<b class="command">gs -h |grep cups</b>, you might not be able to +print. Update your Ghostscript. +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2934912"></a>imagetops and imagetoraster</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +In the section about pre-filters, we mentioned the pre-filter +that generates PostScript from image formats. The <i class="parameter"><tt>imagetoraster</tt></i> +filter is used to convert directly from image to raster, without the +intermediate PostScript stage. It is used more often than the above +mentioned pre-filters. A summarizing flowchart of image file +filtering is shown in <link linkend="small8">. +</p><p> + </p><div class="figure"><a name="small8"></a><p class="title"><b>Figure 19.8. Image format to CUPS-raster format conversion.</b></p><div class="mediaobject"><img src="projdoc/imagefiles/8small.png" width="270" alt="Image format to CUPS-raster format conversion."></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2934991"></a>rasterto [printers specific]</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +CUPS ships with quite different raster drivers processing CUPS +raster. On my system I find in /usr/lib/cups/filter/ these: +<i class="parameter"><tt>rastertoalps</tt></i>, <i class="parameter"><tt>rastertobj</tt></i>, <i class="parameter"><tt>rastertoepson</tt></i>, <i class="parameter"><tt>rastertoescp</tt></i>, +<i class="parameter"><tt>rastertopcl</tt></i>, <i class="parameter"><tt>rastertoturboprint</tt></i>, <i class="parameter"><tt>rastertoapdk</tt></i>, <i class="parameter"><tt>rastertodymo</tt></i>, +<i class="parameter"><tt>rastertoescp</tt></i>, <i class="parameter"><tt>rastertohp</tt></i>, and +<i class="parameter"><tt>rastertoprinter</tt></i>. Don't worry if you have less +than this; some of these are installed by commercial add-ons to CUPS +(like <i class="parameter"><tt>rastertoturboprint</tt></i>), others (like +<i class="parameter"><tt>rastertoprinter</tt></i>) by third-party driver +development projects (such as Gimp-Print) wanting to cooperate as +closely as possible with CUPS. +</p><p> + </p><div class="figure"><a name="small9"></a><p class="title"><b>Figure 19.9. Raster to printer-specific formats.</b></p><div class="mediaobject"><img src="projdoc/imagefiles/9small.png" width="270" alt="Raster to printer-specific formats."></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2935143"></a>CUPS Backends</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +The last part of any CUPS filtering chain is a backend. Backends +are special programs that send the print-ready file to the final +device. There is a separate backend program for any transfer +protocol of sending printjobs over the network, or for every local +interface. Every CUPS print queue needs to have a CUPS “<span class="quote">device-URI</span>” +associated with it. The device URI is the way to encode the backend +used to send the job to its destination. Network device-URIs are using +two slashes in their syntax, local device URIs only one, as you can +see from the following list. Keep in mind that local interface names +may vary much from my examples, if your OS is not Linux: +</p><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">usb </span></dt><dd><p> + This backend sends printfiles to USB-connected printers. An + example for the CUPS device-URI to use is: + <tt class="filename">usb:/dev/usb/lp0</tt>. + </p></dd><dt><span class="term">serial </span></dt><dd><p> + This backend sends printfiles to serially connected printers. + An example for the CUPS device-URI to use is: + <tt class="filename">serial:/dev/ttyS0?baud=11500</tt>. + </p></dd><dt><span class="term">parallel </span></dt><dd><p> + This backend sends printfiles to printers connected to the + parallel port. An example for the CUPS device-URI to use is: + <tt class="filename">parallel:/dev/lp0</tt>. + </p></dd><dt><span class="term">scsi </span></dt><dd><p> + This backend sends printfiles to printers attached to the + SCSI interface. An example for the CUPS device-URI to use is: + <tt class="filename">scsi:/dev/sr1</tt>. + </p></dd><dt><span class="term">lpd </span></dt><dd><p> + This backend sends printfiles to LPR/LPD connected network + printers. An example for the CUPS device-URI to use is: + <tt class="filename">lpd://remote_host_name/remote_queue_name</tt>. + </p></dd><dt><span class="term">AppSocket/HP JetDirect </span></dt><dd><p> + This backend sends printfiles to AppSocket (a.k.a. "HP + JetDirect") connected network printers. An example for the CUPS + device-URI to use is: + <tt class="filename">socket://10.11.12.13:9100</tt>. + </p></dd><dt><span class="term">ipp </span></dt><dd><p> + This backend sends printfiles to IPP connected network + printers (or to other CUPS servers). Examples for CUPS device-URIs + to use are: + <tt class="filename">ipp:://192.193.194.195/ipp</tt> + (for many HP printers) or + <tt class="filename">ipp://remote_cups_server/printers/remote_printer_name</tt>. + </p></dd><dt><span class="term">http </span></dt><dd><p> + This backend sends printfiles to HTTP connected printers. + (The http:// CUPS backend is only a symlink to the ipp:// backend.) + Examples for the CUPS device-URIs to use are: + <tt class="filename">http:://192.193.194.195:631/ipp</tt> + (for many HP printers) or + <tt class="filename">http://remote_cups_server:631/printers/remote_printer_name</tt>. + </p></dd><dt><span class="term">smb </span></dt><dd><p> + This backend sends printfiles to printers shared by a Windows + host. An example for CUPS device-URIs that may be used includes: + </p><p> + </p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td><tt class="filename">smb://workgroup/server/printersharename</tt></td></tr><tr><td><tt class="filename">smb://server/printersharename</tt></td></tr><tr><td><tt class="filename">smb://username:password@workgroup/server/printersharename</tt></td></tr><tr><td><tt class="filename">smb://username:password@server/printersharename</tt></td></tr></table><p> + </p><p> + The smb:// backend is a symlink to the Samba utility + <i class="parameter"><tt>smbspool</tt></i> (does not ship with CUPS). If the + symlink is not present in your CUPS backend directory, have your + root user create it: <b class="command">ln -s `which smbspool' + /usr/lib/cups/backend/smb</b>. + </p></dd></dl></div><p> +It is easy to write your own backends as shell or Perl scripts, if you +need any modification or extension to the CUPS print system. One +reason could be that you want to create “<span class="quote">special</span>” printers that send +the printjobs as email (through a “<span class="quote">mailto:/</span>” backend), convert them to +PDF (through a “<span class="quote">pdfgen:/</span>” backend) or dump them to “<span class="quote">/dev/null</span>”. (In +fact I have the system-wide default printer set up to be connected to +a devnull:/ backend: there are just too many people sending jobs +without specifying a printer, or scripts and programs which do not name +a printer. The system-wide default deletes the job and sends a polite +email back to the $USER asking him to always specify the correct +printer name.) +</p><p> +Not all of the mentioned backends may be present on your system or +usable (depending on your hardware configuration). One test for all +available CUPS backends is provided by the <span class="emphasis"><em>lpinfo</em></span> +utility. Used with the <tt class="option">-v</tt> parameter, it lists +all available backends: +</p><pre class="screen"> +<tt class="prompt">$ </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>lpinfo -v</tt></b> +</pre></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2935508"></a>The Role of <i class="parameter"><tt>cupsomatic/foomatic</tt></i></h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2935523"></a> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2935532"></a> +<i class="parameter"><tt>cupsomatic</tt></i> filters may be the most widely used on CUPS +installations. You must be clear about the fact that these were not +developed by the CUPS people. They are a third party add-on to +CUPS. They utilize the traditional Ghostscript devices to render jobs +for CUPS. When troubleshooting, you should know about the +difference. Here the whole rendering process is done in one stage, +inside Ghostscript, using an appropriate device for the target +printer. <i class="parameter"><tt>cupsomatic</tt></i> uses PPDs that are generated from the Foomatic +Printer & Driver Database at Linuxprinting.org. +</p><p> +You can recognize these PPDs from the line calling the +<i class="parameter"><tt>cupsomatic</tt></i> filter: + +</p><pre class="programlisting"> + *cupsFilter: "application/vnd.cups-postscript 0 cupsomatic" +</pre><p> + +You may find this line among the first 40 or so lines of the PPD +file. If you have such a PPD installed, the printer shows up in the +CUPS Web interface with a <i class="parameter"><tt>foomatic</tt></i> namepart for +the driver description. <i class="parameter"><tt>cupsomatic</tt></i> is a Perl script that runs +Ghostscript with all the complicated command line options +auto-constructed from the selected PPD and command line options give to +the printjob. +</p><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2935609"></a> + However, <i class="parameter"><tt>cupsomatic</tt></i> is now deprecated. Its PPDs (especially the first +generation of them, still in heavy use out there) are not meeting the +Adobe specifications. You might also suffer difficulties when you try +to download them with “<span class="quote">Point'n'Print</span>” to Windows clients. A better +and more powerful successor is now in a stable beta-version: it is called <i class="parameter"><tt>foomatic-rip</tt></i>. To use +<i class="parameter"><tt>foomatic-rip</tt></i> as a filter with CUPS, you need the new-type PPDs. These +have a similar but different line: + +</p><pre class="programlisting"> + *cupsFilter: "application/vnd.cups-postscript 0 foomatic-rip" +</pre><p> + +The PPD generating engine at Linuxprinting.org has been revamped. +The new PPDs comply to the Adobe spec. On top, they also provide a +new way to specify different quality levels (hi-res photo, normal +color, grayscale, and draft) with a single click, whereas before you +could have required five or more different selections (media type, +resolution, inktype and dithering algorithm). There is support for +custom-size media built in. There is support to switch +print-options from page to page in the middle of a job. And the +best thing is the new foomatic-rip now works seamlessly with all +legacy spoolers too (like LPRng, BSD-LPD, PDQ, PPR and so on), providing +for them access to use PPDs for their printing. +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2935673"></a>The Complete Picture</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +If you want to see an overview of all the filters and how they +relate to each other, the complete picture of the puzzle is at the end +of this document. +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2935688"></a><tt class="filename">mime.convs</tt></h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +CUPS auto-constructs all possible filtering chain paths for any given +MIME type, and every printer installed. But how does it decide in +favor or against a specific alternative? (There may often be cases +where there is a choice of two or more possible filtering chains for +the same target printer.) Simple. You may have noticed the figures in +the third column of the mime.convs file. They represent virtual costs +assigned to this filter. Every possible filtering chain will sum up to +a total “<span class="quote">filter cost.</span>” CUPS decides for the most “<span class="quote">inexpensive</span>” route. +</p><div class="tip" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Tip</h3><p> +The setting of <i class="parameter"><tt>FilterLimit 1000</tt></i> in +<tt class="filename">cupsd.conf</tt> will not allow more filters to +run concurrently than will consume a total of 1000 virtual filter +cost. This is an efficient way to limit the load of any CUPS +server by setting an appropriate “<span class="quote">FilterLimit</span>” value. A FilterLimit of +200 allows roughly one job at a time, while a FilterLimit of 1000 allows +approximately five jobs maximum at a time. +</p></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2935752"></a>“<span class="quote">Raw</span>” Printing</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + You can tell CUPS to print (nearly) any file “<span class="quote">raw</span>”. “<span class="quote">Raw</span>” means it + will not be filtered. CUPS will send the file to the printer “<span class="quote">as is</span>” +without bothering if the printer is able to digest it. Users need to +take care themselves that they send sensible data formats only. Raw +printing can happen on any queue if the “<span class="quote"><i class="parameter"><tt>-o raw</tt></i></span>” option is specified +on the command line. You can also set up raw-only queues by simply not +associating any PPD with it. This command: +</p><pre class="screen"> +<tt class="prompt">$ </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>lpadmin -P rawprinter -v socket://11.12.13.14:9100 -E</tt></b> +</pre><p> + sets up a queue named “<span class="quote">rawprinter</span>”, connected via the “<span class="quote">socket</span>” + protocol (a.k.a. “<span class="quote">HP JetDirect</span>”) to the device at IP address +11.12.1.3.14, using port 9100. (If you had added a PPD with +<b class="command">-P /path/to/PPD</b> to this command line, you would +have installed a “<span class="quote">normal</span>” print queue. +</p><p> +CUPS will automatically treat each job sent to a queue as a “<span class="quote">raw</span>” one, +if it can't find a PPD associated with the queue. However, CUPS will +only send known MIME types (as defined in its own mime.types file) and +refuse others. +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2935861"></a>application/octet-stream Printing</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +Any MIME type with no rule in the +<tt class="filename">/etc/cups/mime.types</tt> file is regarded as unknown +or <i class="parameter"><tt>application/octet-stream</tt></i> and will not be +sent. Because CUPS refuses to print unknown MIME types per default, +you will probably have experienced the fact that print jobs originating +from Windows clients were not printed. You may have found an error +message in your CUPS logs like: +</p><p><tt class="computeroutput"> + Unable to convert file 0 to printable format for job +</tt></p><p> +To enable the printing of <i class="parameter"><tt>application/octet-stream</tt></i> files, edit +these two files: +</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p><tt class="filename">/etc/cups/mime.convs</tt></p></li><li><p><tt class="filename">/etc/cups/mime.types</tt></p></li></ul></div><p> +Both contain entries (at the end of the respective files) which must +be uncommented to allow RAW mode operation for +<i class="parameter"><tt>application/octet-stream</tt></i>. In <tt class="filename">/etc/cups/mime.types</tt> +make sure this line is present: + +<a class="indexterm" name="id2935958"></a> + +</p><pre class="programlisting"> +application/octet-stream +</pre><p> + +This line (with no specific auto-typing rule set) makes all files +not otherwise auto-typed a member of <i class="parameter"><tt>application/octet-stream</tt></i>. In +<tt class="filename">/etc/cups/mime.convs</tt>, have this +line: + +</p><pre class="programlisting"> +application/octet-stream application/vnd.cups-raw 0 - +</pre><p> + +<a class="indexterm" name="id2935999"></a> + +This line tells CUPS to use the <span class="emphasis"><em>Null Filter</em></span> +(denoted as “<span class="quote">-</span>”, doing nothing at all) on +<i class="parameter"><tt>application/octet-stream</tt></i>, and tag the result as +<i class="parameter"><tt>application/vnd.cups-raw</tt></i>. This last one is +always a green light to the CUPS scheduler to now hand the file over +to the backend connecting to the printer and sending it over. +</p><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p>Editing the <tt class="filename">mime.convs</tt> and the +<tt class="filename">mime.types</tt> file does not +<span class="emphasis"><em>enforce</em></span> “<span class="quote">raw</span>” printing, it only +<span class="emphasis"><em>allows</em></span> it. +</p></div><p><b>Background. </b> +CUPS being a more security-aware printing system than traditional ones +does not by default allow one to send deliberate (possibly binary) +data to printing devices. (This could be easily abused to launch a +Denial of Service attack on your printer(s), causing at least the loss +of a lot of paper and ink...) “<span class="quote">Unknown</span>” data are regarded by CUPS +as <span class="emphasis"><em>MIME type</em></span> +<span class="emphasis"><em>application/octet-stream</em></span>. While you +<span class="emphasis"><em>can</em></span> send data “<span class="quote">raw</span>”, the MIME type for these must +be one that is known to CUPS and an allowed one. The file +<tt class="filename">/etc/cups/mime.types</tt> defines the “<span class="quote">rules</span>” of how CUPS +recognizes MIME types. The file +<tt class="filename">/etc/cups/mime.convs</tt> decides which file +conversion filter(s) may be applied to which MIME types. +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2936129"></a>PostScript Printer Descriptions (PPDs) for Non-PS Printers</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2936141"></a> +Originally PPDs were meant to be used for PostScript printers +only. Here, they help to send device-specific commands and settings +to the RIP which processes the jobfile. CUPS has extended this +scope for PPDs to cover non-PostScript printers too. This was not +difficult, because it is a standardized file format. In a way +it was logical too: CUPS handles PostScript and uses a PostScript +RIP (Ghostscript) to process the jobfiles. The only difference is: +a PostScript printer has the RIP built-in, for other types of +printers the Ghostscript RIP runs on the host computer. +</p><p> +PPDs for a non-PS printer have a few lines that are unique to +CUPS. The most important one looks similar to this: + +<a class="indexterm" name="id2936166"></a> + +</p><pre class="programlisting"> + *cupsFilter: application/vnd.cups-raster 66 rastertoprinter +</pre><p> + +It is the last piece in the CUPS filtering puzzle. This line tells the +CUPS daemon to use as a last filter <i class="parameter"><tt>rastertoprinter</tt></i>. This filter +should be served as input an <i class="parameter"><tt>application/vnd.cups-raster</tt></i> MIME type +file. Therefore, CUPS should auto-construct a filtering chain, which +delivers as its last output the specified MIME type. This is then +taken as input to the specified <i class="parameter"><tt>rastertoprinter</tt></i> filter. After this +the last filter has done its work (<i class="parameter"><tt>rastertoprinter</tt></i> is a Gimp-Print +filter), the file should go to the backend, which sends it to the +output device. +</p><p> +CUPS by default ships only a few generic PPDs, but they are good for +several hundred printer models. You may not be able to control +different paper trays, or you may get larger margins than your +specific model supports. See <link linkend="cups-ppds"> for summary information. +</p><div class="table"><a name="cups-ppds"></a><p class="title"><b>Table 19.1. PPDs shipped with CUPS</b></p><table summary="PPDs shipped with CUPS" border="1"><colgroup><col align="left"><col align="justify"></colgroup><thead><tr><th align="left">PPD file</th><th align="justify">Printer type</th></tr></thead><tbody><tr><td align="left">deskjet.ppd</td><td align="justify">older HP inkjet printers and compatible</td></tr><tr><td align="left">deskjet2.ppd</td><td align="justify">newer HP inkjet printers and compatible </td></tr><tr><td align="left">dymo.ppd</td><td align="justify">label printers </td></tr><tr><td align="left">epson9.ppd</td><td align="justify">Epson 24pin impact printers and compatible </td></tr><tr><td align="left">epson24.ppd</td><td align="justify">Epson 24pin impact printers and compatible </td></tr><tr><td align="left">okidata9.ppd</td><td align="justify">Okidata 9pin impact printers and compatible </td></tr><tr><td align="left">okidat24.ppd</td><td align="justify">Okidata 24pin impact printers and compatible </td></tr><tr><td align="left">stcolor.ppd</td><td align="justify">older Epson Stylus Color printers </td></tr><tr><td align="left">stcolor2.ppd</td><td align="justify">newer Epson Stylus Color printers </td></tr><tr><td align="left">stphoto.ppd</td><td align="justify">older Epson Stylus Photo printers </td></tr><tr><td align="left">stphoto2.ppd</td><td align="justify">newer Epson Stylus Photo printers </td></tr><tr><td align="left">laserjet.ppd</td><td align="justify">all PCL printers. Further below is a discussion + of several other driver/PPD-packages suitable for use with CUPS. </td></tr></tbody></table></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2936430"></a><span class="emphasis"><em>cupsomatic/foomatic-rip</em></span> Versus <span class="emphasis"><em>native CUPS</em></span> Printing</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2936449"></a> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2936457"></a> +Native CUPS rasterization works in two steps: +</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p> +First is the <i class="parameter"><tt>pstoraster</tt></i> step. It uses the special CUPS +<a class="indexterm" name="id2936483"></a> +device from ESP Ghostscript 7.05.x as its tool. +</p></li><li><p> +Second comes the <i class="parameter"><tt>rasterdriver</tt></i> step. It uses various +device-specific filters; there are several vendors who provide good +quality filters for this step. Some are free software, some are +shareware/non-free and some are proprietary.</p></li></ul></div><p> +Often this produces better quality (and has several more +advantages) than other methods. +</p><p> + </p><div class="figure"><a name="cupsomatic-dia"></a><p class="title"><b>Figure 19.10. cupsomatic/foomatic Processing versus Native CUPS.</b></p><div class="mediaobject"><img src="projdoc/imagefiles/10small.png" width="270" alt="cupsomatic/foomatic Processing versus Native CUPS."></div></div><p> +</p><p> +One other method is the <i class="parameter"><tt>cupsomatic/foomatic-rip</tt></i> +way. Note that <i class="parameter"><tt>cupsomatic</tt></i> is <span class="emphasis"><em>not</em></span> made by the CUPS +developers. It is an independent contribution to printing development, +made by people from Linuxprinting.org <sup>[<a name="id2936587" href="#ftn.id2936587">4</a>]</sup>. +<i class="parameter"><tt>cupsomatic</tt></i> is no longer developed and maintained and is no longer +supported. It has now been replaced by +<i class="parameter"><tt>foomatic-rip</tt></i>. <i class="parameter"><tt>foomatic-rip</tt></i> is a complete re-write +of the old <i class="parameter"><tt>cupsomatic</tt></i> idea, but very much improved and generalized to +other (non-CUPS) spoolers. An upgrade to foomatic-rip is strongly +advised, especially if you are upgrading to a recent version of CUPS, +too. +</p><p> + <a class="indexterm" name="id2936634"></a> + <a class="indexterm" name="id2936642"></a> +Both the <i class="parameter"><tt>cupsomatic</tt></i> (old) and the <i class="parameter"><tt>foomatic-rip</tt></i> (new) methods from +Linuxprinting.org use the traditional Ghostscript print file +processing, doing everything in a single step. It therefore relies on +all the other devices built into Ghostscript. The quality is as +good (or bad) as Ghostscript rendering is in other spoolers. The +advantage is that this method supports many printer models not +supported (yet) by the more modern CUPS method. +</p><p> +Of course, you can use both methods side by side on one system (and +even for one printer, if you set up different queues) and find out +which works best for you. +</p><p> +<i class="parameter"><tt>cupsomatic</tt></i> kidnaps the printfile after the +<i class="parameter"><tt>application/vnd.cups-postscript</tt></i> stage and +deviates it through the CUPS-external, system-wide Ghostscript +installation. Therefore the printfile bypasses the <i class="parameter"><tt>pstoraster</tt></i> filter +(and also bypasses the CUPS-raster-drivers +<i class="parameter"><tt>rastertosomething</tt></i>). After Ghostscript finished its rasterization, +<i class="parameter"><tt>cupsomatic</tt></i> hands the rendered file directly to the CUPS backend. The +flowchart in <link linkend="cupsomatic-dia"> illustrates the difference between native CUPS +rendering and the <i class="parameter"><tt>Foomatic/cupsomatic</tt></i> method. +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2936743"></a>Examples for Filtering Chains</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +Here are a few examples of commonly occurring filtering chains to +illustrate the workings of CUPS. +</p><p> +Assume you want to print a PDF file to an HP JetDirect-connected +PostScript printer, but you want to print the pages 3-5, 7, 11-13 +only, and you want to print them “<span class="quote">two-up</span>” and “<span class="quote">duplex</span>”: +</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Your print options (page selection as required, two-up, +duplex) are passed to CUPS on the command line.</p></li><li><p>The (complete) PDF file is sent to CUPS and autotyped as +<i class="parameter"><tt>application/pdf</tt></i>.</p></li><li><p>The file therefore must first pass the +<i class="parameter"><tt>pdftops</tt></i> pre-filter, which produces PostScript +MIME type <i class="parameter"><tt>application/postscript</tt></i> (a preview here +would still show all pages of the original PDF).</p></li><li><p>The file then passes the <i class="parameter"><tt>pstops</tt></i> +filter that applies the command line options: it selects the pages +2-5, 7 and 11-13, creates an imposed layout “<span class="quote">2 pages on 1 sheet</span>” and +inserts the correct “<span class="quote">duplex</span>” command (as defined in the printer's +PPD) into the new PostScript file; the file is now of PostScript MIME +type +<i class="parameter"><tt>application/vnd.cups-postscript</tt></i>.</p></li><li><p>The file goes to the <i class="parameter"><tt>socket</tt></i> +backend, which transfers the job to the printers.</p></li></ul></div><p> + The resulting filter chain, therefore, is as drawn in <link linkend="pdftosocket">. +</p><div class="figure"><a name="pdftosocket"></a><p class="title"><b>Figure 19.11. PDF to socket chain.</b></p><div class="mediaobject"><img src="projdoc/imagefiles/pdftosocket.png" width="270" alt="PDF to socket chain."></div></div><p> +Assume your want to print the same filter to an USB-connected +Epson Stylus Photo printer installed with the CUPS +<tt class="filename">stphoto2.ppd</tt>. The first few filtering stages +are nearly the same: +</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Your print options (page selection as required, two-up, +duplex) are passed to CUPS on the commandline.</p></li><li><p>The (complete) PDF file is sent to CUPS and autotyped as +<i class="parameter"><tt>application/pdf</tt></i>.</p></li><li><p>The file must first pass the +<i class="parameter"><tt>pdftops</tt></i> pre-filter, which produces PostScript +MIME type <i class="parameter"><tt>application/postscript</tt></i> (a preview here +would still show all pages of the original PDF).</p></li><li><p>The file then passes the “<span class="quote">pstops</span>” filter that applies +the commandline options: it selects the pages 2-5, 7 and 11-13, +creates an imposed layout “<span class="quote">two pages on one sheet</span>” and inserts the +correct “<span class="quote">duplex</span>” command... (Oops this printer and PPD +do not support duplex printing at all so this option will +be ignored) into the new PostScript file; the file is now of PostScript +MIME type +<i class="parameter"><tt>application/vnd.cups-postscript</tt></i>.</p></li><li><p>The file then passes the + +<i class="parameter"><tt>pstoraster</tt></i> stage and becomes MIME type +<i class="parameter"><tt>application/ +cups-raster</tt></i>.</p></li><li><p>Finally, the <i class="parameter"><tt>rastertoepson</tt></i> filter +does its work (as indicated in the printer's PPD), creating the +rinter-specific raster data and embedding any user-selected +print-options into the print data stream.</p></li><li><p>The file goes to the <i class="parameter"><tt>usb</tt></i> backend, +which transfers the job to the printers.</p></li></ul></div><p> + The resulting filter chain therefore is as drawn in <link linkend="pdftoepsonusb">. +</p><div class="figure"><a name="pdftoepsonusb"></a><p class="title"><b>Figure 19.12. PDF to USB chain.</b></p><div class="mediaobject"><img src="projdoc/imagefiles/pdftoepsonusb.png" width="270" alt="PDF to USB chain."></div></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2937128"></a>Sources of CUPS Drivers/PPDs</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +On the Internet you can now find many thousands of CUPS-PPD files +(with their companion filters), in many national languages +supporting more than thousand non-PostScript models. +</p><div class="itemizedlist"><a class="indexterm" name="id2937144"></a><a class="indexterm" name="id2937154"></a><ul type="disc"><li><p><ulink url="http://wwwl.easysw.com/printpro/">ESP +PrintPro</ulink> (commercial, +non-free) is packaged with more than three thousand PPDs, ready for +successful use “<span class="quote">out of the box</span>” on Linux, Mac OS X, IBM-AIX, +HP-UX, Sun-Solaris, SGI-IRIX, Compaq Tru64, Digital UNIX, and some +more commercial Unices (it is written by the CUPS developers +themselves and its sales help finance the further development of +CUPS, as they feed their creators).</p></li><li><p>The <ulink url="http://gimp-print.sourceforge.net/">Gimp-Print-Project +</ulink> (GPL, free software) +provides around 140 PPDs (supporting nearly 400 printers, many driven +to photo quality output), to be used alongside the Gimp-Print CUPS +filters.</p></li><li><p><ulink url="http://www.turboprint.com/">TurboPrint +</ulink> (shareware, non-free) supports +roughly the same amount of printers in excellent +quality.</p></li><li><p><ulink url="http://www-124.ibm.com/developerworks/oss/linux/projects/omni/">OMNI +</ulink> +(LPGL, free) is a package made by IBM, now containing support for more +than 400 printers, stemming from the inheritance of IBM OS/2 Know-How +ported over to Linux (CUPS support is in a beta-stage at +present).</p></li><li><p><ulink url="http://hpinkjet.sourceforge.net/">HPIJS +</ulink> (BSD-style licenses, free) +supports around 150 of HP's own printers and is also providing +excellent print quality now (currently available only via the Foomatic +path).</p></li><li><p><ulink url="http://www.linuxprinting.org/">Foomatic/cupsomatic +</ulink> (LPGL, free) from +Linuxprinting.org are providing PPDs for practically every Ghostscript +filter known to the world (including Omni, Gimp-Print and +HPIJS).</p></li></ul></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2937265"></a>Printing with Interface Scripts</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +CUPS also supports the usage of “<span class="quote">interface scripts</span>” as known from +System V AT&T printing systems. These are often used for PCL +printers, from applications that generate PCL print jobs. Interface +scripts are specific to printer models. They have a similar role as +PPDs for PostScript printers. Interface scripts may inject the Escape +sequences as required into the print data stream, if the user has +chosen to select a certain paper tray, or print landscape, or use A3 +paper, etc. Interfaces scripts are practically unknown in the Linux +realm. On HP-UX platforms they are more often used. You can use any +working interface script on CUPS too. Just install the printer with +the <b class="command">-i</b> option: +</p><pre class="screen"> +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>lpadmin -p pclprinter -v socket://11.12.13.14:9100 \ + -i /path/to/interface-script</tt></b> +</pre><p> +Interface scripts might be the “<span class="quote">unknown animal</span>” to many. However, +with CUPS they provide the easiest way to plug in your own +custom-written filtering script or program into one specific print +queue (some information about the traditional usage of interface scripts is +to be found at <ulink url="http://playground.sun.com/printing/documentation/interface.html">http://playground.sun.com/printing/documentation/interface.html</ulink>). +</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2937358"></a>Network Printing (Purely Windows)</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +Network printing covers a lot of ground. To understand what exactly +goes on with Samba when it is printing on behalf of its Windows +clients, let's first look at a “<span class="quote">purely Windows</span>” setup: Windows clients +with a Windows NT print server. +</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2937377"></a>From Windows Clients to an NT Print Server</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +Windows clients printing to an NT-based print server have two +options. They may: +<a class="indexterm" name="id2937390"></a> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2937399"></a> +</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Execute the driver locally and render the GDI output + (EMF) into the printer-specific format on their own. + </p></li><li><p>Send the GDI output (EMF) to the server, where the +driver is executed to render the printer specific +output.</p></li></ul></div><p> + Both print paths are shown in the flowcharts in the figures below. +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2937434"></a>Driver Execution on the Client</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +In the first case the print server must spool the file as raw, +meaning it shouldn't touch the jobfile and try to convert it in any +way. This is what a traditional UNIX-based print server can do too, and +at a better performance and more reliably than an NT print server. This +is what most Samba administrators probably are familiar with. One +advantage of this setup is that this “<span class="quote">spooling-only</span>” print server may +be used even if no driver(s) for UNIX are available it is sufficient +to have the Windows client drivers available; and installed on the +clients. +</p><p> + </p><div class="figure"><a name="small11"></a><p class="title"><b>Figure 19.13. Print driver execution on the client.</b></p><div class="mediaobject"><img src="projdoc/imagefiles/11small.png" width="270" alt="Print driver execution on the client."></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2937506"></a>Driver Execution on the Server</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2937515"></a> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2937523"></a> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2937532"></a> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2937540"></a> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2937548"></a> +The other path executes the printer driver on the server. The client +transfers print files in EMF format to the server. The server uses the +PostScript, PCL, ESC/P or other driver to convert the EMF file into +the printer-specific language. It is not possible for UNIX to do the +same. Currently, there is no program or method to convert a Windows +client's GDI output on a UNIX server into something a printer could +understand. +</p><p> + </p><div class="figure"><a name="small12"></a><p class="title"><b>Figure 19.14. Print driver execution on the server.</b></p><div class="mediaobject"><img src="projdoc/imagefiles/12small.png" width="270" alt="Print driver execution on the server."></div></div><p> +</p><p> +However, there is something similar possible with CUPS. Read on. +</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2937618"></a>Network Printing (Windows Clients UNIX/Samba Print +Servers)</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +Since UNIX print servers <span class="emphasis"><em>cannot</em></span> execute the Win32 +program code on their platform, the picture is somewhat +different. However, this does not limit your options all that +much. On the contrary, you may have a way here to implement printing +features that are not possible otherwise. +</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2937639"></a>From Windows Clients to a CUPS/Samba Print Server</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +Here is a simple recipe showing how you can take advantage of CUPS' +powerful features for the benefit of your Windows network printing +clients: +</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Let the Windows clients send PostScript to the CUPS +server.</p></li><li><p>Let the CUPS server render the PostScript into device-specific raster format.</p></li></ul></div><p> +This requires the clients to use a PostScript driver (even if the +printer is a non-PostScript model. It also requires that you have a +driver on the CUPS server. +</p><p> +First, to enable CUPS-based rinting through Samba the +following options should be set in your <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file [global] +section: +</p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>printing = cups</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>printcap = cups</tt></i></td></tr></table><p> +When these parameters are specified, all manually set print directives +(like <a class="indexterm" name="id2937719"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>print command</tt></i>, or <a class="indexterm" name="id2937734"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>lppause command</tt></i>) in <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> (as well as +in Samba itself) will be ignored. Instead, Samba will directly +interface with CUPS through its application program interface (API), +as long as Samba has been compiled with CUPS library (libcups) +support. If Samba has not been compiled with CUPS support, and if no +other print commands are set up, then printing will use the +<span class="emphasis"><em>System V</em></span> AT&T command set, with the -oraw +option automatically passing through (if you want your own defined +print commands to work with a Samba that has CUPS support compiled in, +simply use <a class="indexterm" name="id2937772"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>printing</tt></i> = sysv). +</p><p> +</p><div class="figure"><a name="13small"></a><p class="title"><b>Figure 19.15. Printing via CUPS/Samba server.</b></p><div class="mediaobject"><img src="projdoc/imagefiles/13small.png" width="270" alt="Printing via CUPS/Samba server."></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2937834"></a>Samba Receiving Jobfiles and Passing Them to CUPS</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +Samba <span class="emphasis"><em>must</em></span> use its own spool directory (it is set +by a line similar to <a class="indexterm" name="id2937848"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>path</tt></i> = /var/spool/samba, +in the <i class="parameter"><tt>[printers]</tt></i> or +<i class="parameter"><tt>[printername]</tt></i> section of +<tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt>). Samba receives the job in its own +spool space and passes it into the spool directory of CUPS (the CUPS +spooling directory is set by the <i class="parameter"><tt>RequestRoot</tt></i> +directive, in a line that defaults to <i class="parameter"><tt>RequestRoot +/var/spool/cups</tt></i>). CUPS checks the access rights of its +spool dir and resets it to healthy values with every restart. We have +seen quite a few people who had used a common spooling space for Samba +and CUPS, and were struggling for weeks with this “<span class="quote">problem.</span>” +</p><p> +A Windows user authenticates only to Samba (by whatever means is +configured). If Samba runs on the same host as CUPS, you only need to +allow “<span class="quote">localhost</span>” to print. If they run on different machines, you +need to make sure the Samba host gets access to printing on CUPS. +</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2937924"></a>Network PostScript RIP</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +This section discusses the use of CUPS filters on the server configuration where +clients make use of a PostScript driver with CUPS-PPDs. +</p><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2937945"></a> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2937953"></a> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2937961"></a> +PPDs can control all print device options. They are usually provided +by the manufacturer, if you own a PostScript printer, that is. PPD +files (PostScript Printer Descriptions) are always a component of +PostScript printer drivers on MS Windows or Apple Mac OS systems. They +are ASCII files containing user-selectable print options, mapped to +appropriate PostScript, PCL or PJL commands for the target +printer. Printer driver GUI dialogs translate these options +“<span class="quote">on-the-fly</span>” into buttons and drop-down lists for the user to select. +</p><p> +CUPS can load, without any conversions, the PPD file from any Windows +(NT is recommended) PostScript driver and handle the options. There is +a Web browser interface to the print options (select <ulink url="http://localhost:631/printers/">http://localhost:631/printers/</ulink> +and click on one <span class="guibutton">Configure Printer</span> button to see +it), or a command line interface (see <b class="command">man lpoptions</b> +or see if you have <b class="command">lphelp</b> on your system). There are also some +different GUI frontends on Linux/UNIX, which can present PPD options +to users. PPD options are normally meant to be evaluated by the +PostScript RIP on the real PostScript printer. +</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2938025"></a>PPDs for Non-PS Printers on UNIX</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2938037"></a> +CUPS does not limit itself to “<span class="quote">real</span>” PostScript printers in its usage +of PPDs. The CUPS developers have extended the scope of the PPD +concept to also describe available device and driver options for +non-PostScript printers through CUPS-PPDs. +</p><p> +This is logical, as CUPS includes a fully featured PostScript +interpreter (RIP). This RIP is based on Ghostscript. It can process +all received PostScript (and additionally many other file formats) +from clients. All CUPS-PPDs geared to non-PostScript printers contain +an additional line, starting with the keyword +<i class="parameter"><tt>*cupsFilter</tt></i>. This line tells the CUPS print +system which printer-specific filter to use for the interpretation of +the supplied PostScript. Thus CUPS lets all its printers appear as +PostScript devices to its clients, because it can act as a PostScript +RIP for those printers, processing the received PostScript code into a +proper raster print format. +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2938085"></a>PPDs for Non-PS Printers on Windows</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2938096"></a> +CUPS-PPDs can also be used on Windows-Clients, on top of a +“<span class="quote">core</span>” PostScript driver (now recommended is the "CUPS PostScript +Driver for WindowsNT/200x/XP"; you can also use the Adobe one, with +limitations). This feature enables CUPS to do a few tricks no other +spooler can do: +</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Act as a networked PostScript RIP (Raster Image +Processor), handling printfiles from all client platforms in a uniform +way.</p></li><li><p>Act as a central accounting and billing server, since +all files are passed through the pstops filter and are, therefore, +logged in the CUPS <tt class="filename">page_log</tt> file. +<span class="emphasis"><em>Note:</em></span> this cannot happen with “<span class="quote">raw</span>” print jobs, +which always remain unfiltered per definition.</p></li><li><p>Enable clients to consolidate on a single PostScript +driver, even for many different target printers.</p></li></ul></div><p> +Using CUPS PPDs on Windows clients enables these to control +all print job settings just as a UNIX client can do. +</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2938166"></a>Windows Terminal Servers (WTS) as CUPS Clients</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +This setup may be of special interest to people experiencing major +problems in WTS environments. WTS often need a multitude of +non-PostScript drivers installed to run their clients' variety of +different printer models. This often imposes the price of much +increased instability. +</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2938184"></a>Printer Drivers Running in “<span class="quote">Kernel Mode</span>” Cause Many +Problems</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + In Windows NT printer drivers which run in “<span class="quote">Kernel +Mode</span>”, introduces a high risk for the stability of the system +if the driver is not really stable and well-tested. And there are a +lot of bad drivers out there! Especially notorious is the example +of the PCL printer driver that had an additional sound module +running, to notify users via soundcard of their finished jobs. Do I +need to say that this one was also reliably causing “<span class="quote">blue screens +of death</span>” on a regular basis? +</p><p> +PostScript drivers are generally well tested. They are not known +to cause any problems, even though they also run in kernel mode. This +might be because there have been so far only two different PostScript +drivers: the ones from Adobe and the one from Microsoft. Both are +well tested and are as stable as you can imagine on +Windows. The CUPS driver is derived from the Microsoft one. +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2938229"></a>Workarounds Impose Heavy Limitations</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +In many cases, in an attempt to work around this problem, site +administrators have resorted to restricting the allowed drivers installed +on their WTS to one generic PCL and one PostScript driver. This, +however, restricts the clients in the number of printer options +available for them. Often they can't get out more than simplex +prints from one standard paper tray, while their devices could do much +better, if driven by a different driver! +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2938250"></a>CUPS: A “<span class="quote">Magical Stone</span>”?</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2938266"></a> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2938274"></a> +Using a PostScript driver, enabled with a CUPS-PPD, seems to be a very +elegant way to overcome all these shortcomings. There are, depending +on the version of Windows OS you use, up to three different PostScript +drivers available: Adobe, Microsoft and CUPS PostScript drivers. None +of them is known to cause major stability problems on WTS (even if +used with many different PPDs). The clients will be able to (again) +chose paper trays, duplex printing and other settings. However, there +is a certain price for this too: a CUPS server acting as a PostScript +RIP for its clients requires more CPU and RAM than when just acting as +a “<span class="quote">raw spooling</span>” device. Plus, this setup is not yet widely tested, +although the first feedbacks look very promising. +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2938313"></a>PostScript Drivers with No Major Problems Even in Kernel +Mode</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2938329"></a> +More recent printer drivers on W200x and XP no longer run in kernel mode +(unlike Windows NT). However, both operating systems can still +use the NT drivers, running in kernel mode (you can roughly tell which +is which as the drivers in subdirectory “<span class="quote">2</span>” of “<span class="quote">W32X86</span>” are “<span class="quote">old</span>” +ones). As was said before, the Adobe as well as the Microsoft +PostScript drivers are not known to cause any stability problems. The +CUPS driver is derived from the Microsoft one. There is a simple +reason for this: The MS DDK (Device Development Kit) for Windows NT (which +used to be available at no cost to licensees of Visual Studio) +includes the source code of the Microsoft driver, and licensees of +Visual Studio are allowed to use and modify it for their own driver +development efforts. This is what the CUPS people have done. The +license does not allow them to publish the whole of the source code. +However, they have released the “<span class="quote">diff</span>” under the GPL, and if you are +the owner of an “<span class="quote">MS DDK for Windows NT,</span>” you can check the driver yourself. +</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2938378"></a>Configuring CUPS for Driver Download</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +As we have said before, all previously known methods to prepare client +printer drivers on the Samba server for download and Point'n'Print +convenience of Windows workstations are working with CUPS, too. These +methods were described in the previous chapter. In reality, this is a +pure Samba business and only relates to the Samba/Windows client +relationship. +</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2938397"></a><span class="emphasis"><em>cupsaddsmb</em></span>: The Unknown Utility</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2938412"></a> +The <b class="command">cupsaddsmb</b> utility (shipped with all current CUPS versions) is an +alternate method to transfer printer drivers into the Samba +<i class="parameter"><tt>[print$]</tt></i> share. Remember, this share is where +clients expect drivers deposited and setup for download and +installation. It makes the sharing of any (or all) installed CUPS +printers quite easy. <b class="command">cupsaddsmb</b> can use the Adobe PostScript driver as +well as the newly developed CUPS PostScript Driver for +Windows NT/200x/XP. <i class="parameter"><tt>cupsaddsmb</tt></i> does +<span class="emphasis"><em>not</em></span> work with arbitrary vendor printer drivers, +but only with the <span class="emphasis"><em>exact</em></span> driver files that are +named in its man page. +</p><p> +The CUPS printer driver is available from the CUPS download site. Its +package name is <tt class="filename">cups-samba-[version].tar.gz</tt> . It +is preferred over the Adobe drivers since it has a number of +advantages: +</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>It supports a much more accurate page +accounting.</p></li><li><p>It supports banner pages, and page labels on all +printers.</p></li><li><p>It supports the setting of a number of job IPP +attributes (such as job-priority, page-label and +job-billing).</p></li></ul></div><p> +However, currently only Windows NT, 2000 and XP are supported by the +CUPS drivers. You will also need to get the respective part of Adobe driver +if you need to support Windows 95, 98 and ME clients. +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2938514"></a>Prepare Your <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> for <b class="command">cupsaddsmb</b></h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +Prior to running <b class="command">cupsaddsmb</b>, you need the settings in +<tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> as shown in <link linkend="cupsadd-ex">: +</p><div class="example"><a name="cupsadd-ex"></a><p class="title"><b>Example 19.3. smb.conf for cupsaddsmb usage</b></p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td> </td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>[global]</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>load printers = yes</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>printing = cups</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>printcap name = cups</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td> </td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>[printers]</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>comment = All Printers</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>path = /var/spool/samba</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>browseable = no</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>public = yes</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td># setting depends on your requirements</td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>guest ok = yes</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>writable = no</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>printable = yes</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>printer admin = root</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td> </td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>[print$]</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>comment = Printer Drivers</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>path = /etc/samba/drivers</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>browseable = yes</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>guest ok = no</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>read only = yes</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>write list = root</tt></i></td></tr></table></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2938755"></a>CUPS “<span class="quote">PostScript Driver for Windows NT/200x/XP</span>”</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2938770"></a> +CUPS users may get the exact same packages from <ulink url="http://www.cups.org/software.html">http://www.cups.org/software.html</ulink>. +It is a separate package from the CUPS base software files, tagged as +CUPS 1.1.x Windows NT/200x/XP Printer Driver for Samba +(tar.gz, 192k). The filename to download is +<tt class="filename">cups-samba-1.1.x.tar.gz</tt>. Upon untar and unzipping, +it will reveal these files: +</p><pre class="screen"> +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>tar xvzf cups-samba-1.1.19.tar.gz</tt></b> +cups-samba.install +cups-samba.license +cups-samba.readme +cups-samba.remove +cups-samba.ss +</pre><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2938825"></a> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2938836"></a> +These have been packaged with the ESP meta packager software +EPM. The <tt class="filename">*.install</tt> and +<tt class="filename">*.remove</tt> files are simple shell scripts, which +untars the <tt class="filename">*.ss</tt> (the <tt class="filename">*.ss</tt> is +nothing else but a tar-archive, which can be untarred by “<span class="quote">tar</span>” +too). Then it puts the content into +<tt class="filename">/usr/share/cups/drivers/</tt>. This content includes three +files: +</p><pre class="screen"> +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>tar tv cups-samba.ss</tt></b> +cupsdrvr.dll +cupsui.dll +cups.hlp +</pre><p> +The <i class="parameter"><tt>cups-samba.install</tt></i> shell scripts are easy to +handle: +</p><pre class="screen"> +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>./cups-samba.install</tt></b> +[....] +Installing software... +Updating file permissions... +Running post-install commands... +Installation is complete. +</pre><p> +The script should automatically put the driver files into the +<tt class="filename">/usr/share/cups/drivers/</tt> directory. +</p><div class="warning" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Warning</h3><p> +Due to a bug, one recent CUPS release puts the +<tt class="filename">cups.hlp</tt> driver file +into<tt class="filename">/usr/share/drivers/</tt> instead of +<tt class="filename">/usr/share/cups/drivers/</tt>. To work around this, +copy/move the file (after running the +<b class="command">./cups-samba.install</b> script) manually to the +correct place. +</p></div><pre class="screen"> +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>cp /usr/share/drivers/cups.hlp /usr/share/cups/drivers/</tt></b> +</pre><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2939020"></a> +This new CUPS PostScript driver is currently binary-only, but free of +charge. No complete source code is provided (yet). The reason is that +it has been developed with the help of the Microsoft Driver +Developer Kit (DDK) and compiled with Microsoft Visual +Studio 6. Driver developers are not allowed to distribute the whole of +the source code as free software. However, CUPS developers released +the “<span class="quote">diff</span>” in source code under the GPL, so anybody with a license of +Visual Studio and a DDK will be able to compile for him/herself. +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2939044"></a>Recognizing Different Driver Files</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +The CUPS drivers do not support the older Windows 95/98/Me, but only +the Windows NT/2000/XP client. +</p><p>Windows NT, 2000 and XP are supported by:</p><p> + </p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li>cups.hlp</li><li>cupsdrvr.dll</li><li>cupsui.dll</li></ul></div><p> +</p><p> +Adobe drivers are available for the older Windows 95/98/Me as well as +the Windows NT/2000/XP clients. The set of files is different from the +different platforms. +</p><p>Windows 95, 98 and ME are supported by:</p><p> + </p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li>ADFONTS.MFM</li><li>ADOBEPS4.DRV</li><li>ADOBEPS4.HLP</li><li>DEFPRTR2.PPD</li><li>ICONLIB.DLL</li><li>PSMON.DLL</li></ul></div><p> +</p><p>Windows NT, 2000 and XP are supported by:</p><p> +</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li>ADOBEPS5.DLL</li><li>ADOBEPSU.DLL</li><li>ADOBEPSU.HLP</li></ul></div><p> + +</p><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p> +If both the Adobe driver files and the CUPS driver files for the +support of Windows NT/200x/XP are present in FIXME, the Adobe ones will be ignored +and the CUPS ones will be used. If you prefer for whatever reason + to use Adobe-only drivers, move away the three CUPS driver files. The +Windows 9x/Me clients use the Adobe drivers in any case. +</p></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2939174"></a>Acquiring the Adobe Driver Files</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +Acquiring the Adobe driver files seems to be unexpectedly difficult +for many users. They are not available on the Adobe Web site as single +files and the self-extracting and/or self-installing Windows-.exe is +not easy to locate either. Probably you need to use the included +native installer and run the installation process on one client +once. This will install the drivers (and one Generic PostScript +printer) locally on the client. When they are installed, share the +Generic PostScript printer. After this, the client's +<i class="parameter"><tt>[print$]</tt></i> share holds the Adobe files, from +where you can get them with smbclient from the CUPS host. +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2939204"></a>ESP Print Pro PostScript Driver for Windows NT/200x/XP</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2939217"></a> +Users of the ESP Print Pro software are able to install their Samba +drivers package for this purpose with no problem. Retrieve the driver +files from the normal download area of the ESP Print Pro software +at <ulink url="http://www.easysw.com/software.html">http://www.easysw.com/software.html</ulink>. +You need to locate the link labelled “<span class="quote">SAMBA</span>” among the +<span class="guilabel">Download Printer Drivers for ESP Print Pro 4.x</span> +area and download the package. Once installed, you can prepare any +driver by simply highlighting the printer in the Printer Manager GUI +and select <span class="guilabel">Export Driver...</span> from the menu. Of +course you need to have prepared Samba beforehand to handle the +driver files; i.e., setup the <i class="parameter"><tt>[print$]</tt></i> +share, and so on. The ESP Print Pro package includes the CUPS driver files +as well as a (licensed) set of Adobe drivers for the Windows 95/98/Me +client family. +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2939274"></a>Caveats to be Considered</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2939286"></a> +Once you have run the install script (and possibly manually +moved the <tt class="filename">cups.hlp</tt> file to +<tt class="filename">/usr/share/cups/drivers/</tt>), the driver is +ready to be put into Samba's <i class="parameter"><tt>[print$]</tt></i> share (which often maps to +<tt class="filename">/etc/samba/drivers/</tt> and contains a subdirectory +tree with <span class="emphasis"><em>WIN40</em></span> and +<span class="emphasis"><em>W32X86</em></span> branches). You do this by running +<b class="command">cupsaddsmb</b> (see also <b class="command">man cupsaddsmb</b> for +CUPS since release 1.1.16). +</p><div class="tip" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Tip</h3><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2939354"></a> +You may need to put root into the smbpasswd file by running +<b class="command">smbpasswd</b>; this is especially important if you +should run this whole procedure for the first time, and are not +working in an environment where everything is configured for +<span class="emphasis"><em>single sign on</em></span> to a Windows Domain Controller. +</p></div><p> +Once the driver files are in the <i class="parameter"><tt>[print$]</tt></i> share +and are initialized, they are ready to be downloaded and installed by +the Windows NT/200x/XP clients. +</p><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p> +Win 9x/Me clients will not work with the CUPS PostScript driver. For +these you still need to use the <tt class="filename">ADOBE*.*</tt> +drivers as previously stated. +</p></div><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p> +It is not harmful if you still have the +<tt class="filename">ADOBE*.*</tt> driver files from previous +installations in the <tt class="filename">/usr/share/cups/drivers/</tt> +directory. The new <b class="command">cupsaddsmb</b> (from 1.1.16) will +automatically prefer its own drivers if it finds both. +</p></div><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2939442"></a> +Should your Windows clients have had the old <tt class="filename">ADOBE*.*</tt> +files for the Adobe PostScript driver installed, the download and +installation of the new CUPS PostScript driver for Windows NT/200x/XP +will fail at first. You need to wipe the old driver from the clients +first. It is not enough to “<span class="quote">delete</span>” the printer, as the driver files +will still be kept by the clients and re-used if you try to re-install +the printer. To really get rid of the Adobe driver files on the +clients, open the <span class="guilabel">Printers</span> folder (possibly via <span class="guilabel">Start > Settings > Control Panel > Printers</span>), +right-click on the folder background and select <span class="guimenuitem">Server +Properties</span>. When the new dialog opens, select the +<span class="guilabel">Drivers</span> tab. On the list select the driver you +want to delete and click the <span class="guilabel">Delete</span> +button. This will only work if there is not one single printer left +that uses that particular driver. You need to “<span class="quote">delete</span>” all printers +using this driver in the <span class="guilabel">Printers</span> folder first. You will need +Administrator privileges to do this. +</p></div><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2939527"></a> +Once you have successfully downloaded the CUPS PostScript driver to a +client, you can easily switch all printers to this one by proceeding +as described in <link linkend="printing">. Either change +a driver for an existing printer by running the <span class="guilabel">Printer Properties</span> +dialog, or use <b class="command">rpcclient</b> with the +<b class="command">setdriver</b> subcommand. +</p></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2939571"></a>Windows CUPS PostScript Driver Versus Adobe Driver</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +Are you interested in a comparison between the CUPS and the Adobe +PostScript drivers? For our purposes these are the most important +items that weigh in favor of the CUPS ones: +</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>No hassle with the Adobe EULA.</p></li><li><p>No hassle with the question “<span class="quote">Where do I +get the ADOBE*.* driver files from?</span>”</p></li><li><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2939611"></a> +The Adobe drivers (on request of the printer PPD +associated with them) often put a PJL header in front of the main +PostScript part of the print file. Thus, the printfile starts with +<i class="parameter"><tt><1B >%-12345X</tt></i> or +<i class="parameter"><tt><escape>%-12345X</tt></i> instead +of <i class="parameter"><tt>%!PS</tt></i>). This leads to the +CUPS daemon auto-typing the incoming file as a print-ready file, +not initiating a pass through the <i class="parameter"><tt>pstops</tt></i> filter (to speak more +technically, it is not regarded as the generic MIME-type +<a class="indexterm" name="id2939654"></a> +<i class="parameter"><tt>application/postscript</tt></i>, but as +the more special MIME type +<a class="indexterm" name="id2939671"></a> +<i class="parameter"><tt>application/cups.vnd-postscript</tt></i>), +which therefore also leads to the page accounting in +<i class="parameter"><tt>/var/log/cups/page_log</tt></i> not +receiving the exact number of pages; instead the dummy page number +of “<span class="quote">1</span>” is logged in a standard setup).</p></li><li><p>The Adobe driver has more options to misconfigure the +PostScript generated by it (like setting it inadvertently to +<span class="guilabel">Optimize for Speed</span>, instead of +<span class="guilabel">Optimize for Portability</span>, which +could lead to CUPS being unable to process it).</p></li><li><p>The CUPS PostScript driver output sent by Windows +clients to the CUPS server is guaranteed to auto-type +as the generic MIME type <i class="parameter"><tt>application/postscript</tt></i>, +thus passing through the CUPS <i class="parameter"><tt>pstops</tt></i> filter and logging the +correct number of pages in the <tt class="filename">page_log</tt> for +accounting and quota purposes.</p></li><li><p>The CUPS PostScript driver supports the sending of +additional standard (IPP) print options by Windows NT/200x/XP clients. Such +additional print options are: naming the CUPS standard +<span class="emphasis"><em>banner pages</em></span> (or the custom ones, should they be +installed at the time of driver download), using the CUPS +page-label option, setting a +job-priority, and setting the scheduled +time of printing (with the option to support additional +useful IPP job attributes in the future).</p></li><li><p>The CUPS PostScript driver supports the inclusion of +the new <i class="parameter"><tt>*cupsJobTicket</tt></i> comments at the +beginning of the PostScript file (which could be used in the future +for all sort of beneficial extensions on the CUPS side, but which will +not disturb any other applications as they will regard it as a comment +and simply ignore it).</p></li><li><p>The CUPS PostScript driver will be the heart of the +fully fledged CUPS IPP client for Windows NT/200x/XP to be released soon +(probably alongside the first beta release for CUPS +1.2).</p></li></ul></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2939801"></a>Run cupsaddsmb (Quiet Mode)</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2939812"></a> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2939820"></a> +The <b class="command">cupsaddsmb</b> command copies the needed files into your +<i class="parameter"><tt>[print$]</tt></i> share. Additionally, the PPD +associated with this printer is copied from +<tt class="filename">/etc/cups/ppd/</tt> to +<i class="parameter"><tt>[print$]</tt></i>. There the files wait for convenient +Windows client installations via Point'n'Print. Before we can run the +command successfully, we need to be sure that we can authenticate +toward Samba. If you have a small network, you are probably using user-level +security (<a class="indexterm" name="id2939861"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>security</tt></i> = user). +</p><p> +Here is an example of a successfully run <b class="command">cupsaddsmb</b> command: +</p><pre class="screen"> +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>cupsaddsmb -U root infotec_IS2027</tt></b> +Password for root required to access localhost via Samba: <b class="userinput"><tt>['secret']</tt></b> +</pre><p> +To share <span class="emphasis"><em>all</em></span> printers and drivers, use the +<tt class="option">-a</tt> parameter instead of a printer name. Since +<b class="command">cupsaddsmb</b> “<span class="quote">exports</span>” the printer drivers to Samba, it should be +obvious that it only works for queues with a CUPS driver associated. +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2939946"></a>Run cupsaddsmb with Verbose Output</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2939957"></a> +Probably you want to see what's going on. Use the +<tt class="option">-v</tt> parameter to get a more verbose output. The +output below was edited for better readability: all “<span class="quote">\</span>” at the end of +a line indicate that I inserted an artificial line break plus some +indentation here: +</p><div class="warning" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Warning</h3><p> +You will see the root password for the Samba account printed on +screen. +</p></div><p> + +<a class="indexterm" name="id2939988"></a> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2939999"></a> + </p><pre class="screen"> +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>cupsaddsmb -U root -v infotec_2105</tt></b> +Password for root required to access localhost via GANDALF: +Running command: smbclient //localhost/print\$ -N -U'root%secret' \ + -c 'mkdir W32X86; \ + put /var/spool/cups/tmp/3e98bf2d333b5 W32X86/infotec_2105.ppd; \ + put /usr/share/cups/drivers/cupsdrvr.dll W32X86/cupsdrvr.dll; \ + put /usr/share/cups/drivers/cupsui.dll W32X86/cupsui.dll; \ + put /usr/share/cups/drivers/cups.hlp W32X86/cups.hlp' +added interface ip=10.160.51.60 bcast=10.160.51.255 nmask=255.255.252.0 +Domain=[CUPS-PRINT] OS=[UNIX] Server=[Samba 2.2.7a] +NT_STATUS_OBJECT_NAME_COLLISION making remote directory \W32X86 +putting file /var/spool/cups/tmp/3e98bf2d333b5 as \W32X86/infotec_2105.ppd +putting file /usr/share/cups/drivers/cupsdrvr.dll as \W32X86/cupsdrvr.dll +putting file /usr/share/cups/drivers/cupsui.dll as \W32X86/cupsui.dll +putting file /usr/share/cups/drivers/cups.hlp as \W32X86/cups.hlp + +Running command: rpcclient localhost -N -U'root%secret' + -c 'adddriver "Windows NT x86" \ + "infotec_2105:cupsdrvr.dll:infotec_2105.ppd:cupsui.dll:cups.hlp:NULL: \ + RAW:NULL"' +cmd = adddriver "Windows NT x86" \ + "infotec_2105:cupsdrvr.dll:infotec_2105.ppd:cupsui.dll:cups.hlp:NULL: \ + RAW:NULL" +Printer Driver infotec_2105 successfully installed. + +Running command: smbclient //localhost/print\$ -N -U'root%secret' \ +-c 'mkdir WIN40; \ + put /var/spool/cups/tmp/3e98bf2d333b5 WIN40/infotec_2105.PPD; \ + put /usr/share/cups/drivers/ADFONTS.MFM WIN40/ADFONTS.MFM; \ + put /usr/share/cups/drivers/ADOBEPS4.DRV WIN40/ADOBEPS4.DRV; \ + put /usr/share/cups/drivers/ADOBEPS4.HLP WIN40/ADOBEPS4.HLP; \ + put /usr/share/cups/drivers/DEFPRTR2.PPD WIN40/DEFPRTR2.PPD; \ + put /usr/share/cups/drivers/ICONLIB.DLL WIN40/ICONLIB.DLL; \ + put /usr/share/cups/drivers/PSMON.DLL WIN40/PSMON.DLL;' + added interface ip=10.160.51.60 bcast=10.160.51.255 nmask=255.255.252.0 + Domain=[CUPS-PRINT] OS=[UNIX] Server=[Samba 2.2.7a] + NT_STATUS_OBJECT_NAME_COLLISION making remote directory \WIN40 + putting file /var/spool/cups/tmp/3e98bf2d333b5 as \WIN40/infotec_2105.PPD + putting file /usr/share/cups/drivers/ADFONTS.MFM as \WIN40/ADFONTS.MFM + putting file /usr/share/cups/drivers/ADOBEPS4.DRV as \WIN40/ADOBEPS4.DRV + putting file /usr/share/cups/drivers/ADOBEPS4.HLP as \WIN40/ADOBEPS4.HLP + putting file /usr/share/cups/drivers/DEFPRTR2.PPD as \WIN40/DEFPRTR2.PPD + putting file /usr/share/cups/drivers/ICONLIB.DLL as \WIN40/ICONLIB.DLL + putting file /usr/share/cups/drivers/PSMON.DLL as \WIN40/PSMON.DLL + + Running command: rpcclient localhost -N -U'root%secret' \ + -c 'adddriver "Windows 4.0" \ + "infotec_2105:ADOBEPS4.DRV:infotec_2105.PPD:NULL:ADOBEPS4.HLP: \ + PSMON.DLL:RAW:ADOBEPS4.DRV,infotec_2105.PPD,ADOBEPS4.HLP,PSMON.DLL, \ + ADFONTS.MFM,DEFPRTR2.PPD,ICONLIB.DLL"' + cmd = adddriver "Windows 4.0" "infotec_2105:ADOBEPS4.DRV:\ + infotec_2105.PPD:NULL:ADOBEPS4.HLP:PSMON.DLL:RAW:ADOBEPS4.DRV,\ + infotec_2105.PPD,ADOBEPS4.HLP,PSMON.DLL,ADFONTS.MFM,DEFPRTR2.PPD,\ + ICONLIB.DLL" + Printer Driver infotec_2105 successfully installed. + + Running command: rpcclient localhost -N -U'root%secret' \ + -c 'setdriver infotec_2105 infotec_2105' + cmd = setdriver infotec_2105 infotec_2105 + Successfully set infotec_2105 to driver infotec_2105. + +</pre><p> +If you look closely, you'll discover your root password was transferred +unencrypted over the wire, so beware! Also, if you look further, +you'll discover error messages like NT_STATUS_OBJECT_NAME_COLLISION in between. They occur, because the directories WIN40 and W32X86 already existed in the <i class="parameter"><tt>[print$]</tt></i> driver download share (from a previous driver installation). They are harmless here. +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2940175"></a>Understanding cupsaddsmb</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2940187"></a> +What has happened? What did <b class="command">cupsaddsmb</b> do? There are five stages of +the procedure: +</p><div class="orderedlist"><ol type="1"><li><p> + <a class="indexterm" name="id2940218"></a> + Call the CUPS server via IPP and request the +driver files and the PPD file for the named printer.</p></li><li><p>Store the files temporarily in the local +TEMPDIR (as defined in +<tt class="filename">cupsd.conf</tt>).</p></li><li><p>Connect via smbclient to the Samba server's + <i class="parameter"><tt>[print$]</tt></i> share and put the files into the + share's WIN40 (for Windows 9x/Me) and W32X86/ (for Windows NT/200x/XP) subdirectories.</p></li><li><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2940262"></a> + Connect via rpcclient to the Samba server and +execute the <b class="command">adddriver</b> command with the correct +parameters.</p></li><li><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2940287"></a> + Connect via rpcclient to the Samba server a second +time and execute the <b class="command">setdriver</b> command.</p></li></ol></div><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p> +You can run the <b class="command">cupsaddsmb</b> utility with parameters to +specify one remote host as Samba host and a second remote host as CUPS +host. Especially if you want to get a deeper understanding, it is a +good idea to try it and see more clearly what is going on (though in real +life most people will have their CUPS and Samba servers run on the +same host): +</p><pre class="screen"> +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>cupsaddsmb -H sambaserver -h cupsserver -v printer</tt></b> +</pre></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2940352"></a>How to Recognize If cupsaddsmb Completed Successfully</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +You <span class="emphasis"><em>must</em></span> always check if the utility completed +successfully in all fields. You need as a minimum these three messages +among the output: +</p><div class="orderedlist"><ol type="1"><li><p><span class="emphasis"><em>Printer Driver infotec_2105 successfully +installed.</em></span> # (for the W32X86 == Windows NT/200x/XP +architecture).</p></li><li><p><span class="emphasis"><em>Printer Driver infotec_2105 successfully +installed.</em></span> # (for the WIN40 == Windows 9x/Me +architecture).</p></li><li><p><span class="emphasis"><em>Successfully set [printerXPZ] to driver +[printerXYZ].</em></span></p></li></ol></div><p> +These messages are probably not easily recognized in the general +output. If you run <b class="command">cupsaddsmb</b> with the <tt class="option">-a</tt> +parameter (which tries to prepare <span class="emphasis"><em>all</em></span> active CUPS +printer drivers for download), you might miss if individual printers +drivers had problems installing properly. Here a redirection of the +output will help you analyze the results in retrospective. +</p><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p> +It is impossible to see any diagnostic output if you do not run +<b class="command">cupsaddsmb</b> in verbose mode. Therefore, we strongly recommend to not +use the default quiet mode. It will hide any problems from you that +might occur. +</p></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2940450"></a>cupsaddsmb with a Samba PDC</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2940460"></a> +Can't get the standard <b class="command">cupsaddsmb</b> command to run on a Samba PDC? +Are you asked for the password credential all over again and again and +the command just will not take off at all? Try one of these +variations: +</p><pre class="screen"> +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>cupsaddsmb -U MIDEARTH\\root -v printername</tt></b> +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>cupsaddsmb -H SAURON -U MIDEARTH\\root -v printername</tt></b> +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>cupsaddsmb -H SAURON -U MIDEARTH\\root -h cups-server -v printername</tt></b> +</pre><p> +(Note the two backslashes: the first one is required to +“<span class="quote">escape</span>” the second one). +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2940538"></a>cupsaddsmb Flowchart</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2940548"></a> +<link linkend="small14"> shows a chart about the procedures, commandflows and +dataflows of the <b class="command">cupaddsmb</b> command. Note again: cupsaddsmb is +not intended to, and does not work with, raw queues! +</p><p> + </p><div class="figure"><a name="small14"></a><p class="title"><b>Figure 19.16. cupsaddsmb flowchart.</b></p><div class="mediaobject"><img src="projdoc/imagefiles/14small.png" width="270" alt="cupsaddsmb flowchart."></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2940621"></a>Installing the PostScript Driver on a Client</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2940631"></a> +After <b class="command">cupsaddsmb</b> is completed, your driver is prepared for the clients to +use. Here are the steps you must perform to download and install it +via Point'n'Print. From a Windows client, browse to the CUPS/Samba +server: +</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2940659"></a> +Open the <span class="guilabel">Printers</span> +share of Samba in Network Neighborhood.</p></li><li><p>Right-click on the printer in +question.</p></li><li><p>From the opening context-menu select +<span class="guimenuitem">Install...</span> or +<span class="guimenuitem">Connect...</span> (depending on the Windows version you +use).</p></li></ul></div><p> +After a few seconds, there should be a new printer in your +client's <span class="emphasis"><em>local</em></span> <span class="guilabel">Printers</span> folder. On Windows +XP it will follow a naming convention of <span class="emphasis"><em>PrinterName on +SambaServer</em></span>. (In my current case it is "infotec_2105 on +kde-bitshop"). If you want to test it and send your first job from +an application like Winword, the new printer appears in a +<tt class="filename">\\SambaServer\PrinterName</tt> entry in the +drop-down list of available printers. +</p><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2940738"></a> +<b class="command">cupsaddsmb</b> will only reliably work with CUPS version 1.1.15 or higher +and Samba from 2.2.4. If it does not work, or if the automatic printer +driver download to the clients does not succeed, you can still manually +install the CUPS printer PPD on top of the Adobe PostScript driver on +clients. Then point the client's printer queue to the Samba printer +share for a UNC type of connection: +</p><pre class="screen"> +<tt class="prompt">C:\> </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>net use lpt1: \\sambaserver\printershare /user:ntadmin</tt></b> +</pre><p> +should you desire to use the CUPS networked PostScript RIP +functions. (Note that user “<span class="quote">ntadmin</span>” needs to be a valid Samba user +with the required privileges to access the printershare.) This +sets up the printer connection in the traditional +<span class="emphasis"><em>LanMan</em></span> way (not using MS-RPC). +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2940801"></a>Avoiding Critical PostScript Driver Settings on the Client</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +Printing works, but there are still problems. Most jobs print +well, some do not print at all. Some jobs have problems with fonts, +which do not look very good. Some jobs print fast and some are +dead-slow. Many of these problems can be greatly reduced or even +completely eliminated if you follow a few guidelines. Remember, if +your print device is not PostScript-enabled, you are treating your +Ghostscript installation on your CUPS host with the output your client +driver settings produce. Treat it well: +</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Avoid the PostScript Output Option: Optimize +for Speed setting. Use the Optimize for +Portability instead (Adobe PostScript +driver).</p></li><li><p>Don't use the Page Independence: +NO setting. Instead, use Page Independence +YES (CUPS PostScript Driver).</p></li><li><p>Recommended is the True Type Font +Downloading Option: Native True Type over +Automatic and Outline; you +should by all means avoid Bitmap (Adobe +PostScript Driver).</p></li><li><p>Choose True Type Font: Download as Softfont +into Printer over the default Replace by Device +Font (for exotic fonts, you may need to change it back to +get a printout at all) (Adobe).</p></li><li><p>Sometimes you can choose PostScript Language +Level: In case of problems try 2 +instead of 3 (the latest ESP Ghostscript package +handles Level 3 PostScript very well) (Adobe).</p></li><li><p>Say Yes to PostScript +Error Handler (Adobe).</p></li></ul></div></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2940875"></a>Installing PostScript Driver Files Manually Using rpcclient</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +Of course, you can run all the commands that are embedded into the +cupsaddsmb convenience utility yourself, one by one, and hereby upload +and prepare the driver files for future client downloads. +</p><div class="orderedlist"><ol type="1"><li><p>Prepare Samba (A CUPS print queue with the name of the +printer should be there. We are providing the driver +now).</p></li><li><p>Copy all files to + <i class="parameter"><tt>[print$]</tt></i>.</p></li><li><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2940926"></a> +Run <b class="command">rpcclient adddriver</b> +(for each client architecture you want to support).</p></li><li><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2940950"></a> +Run <b class="command">rpcclient +setdriver.</b></p></li></ol></div><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2940972"></a> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2940983"></a> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2940994"></a> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2941005"></a> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2941016"></a> +We are going to do this now. First, read the man page on <i class="parameter"><tt>rpcclient</tt></i> +to get a first idea. Look at all the printing related +subcommands. <b class="command">enumprinters</b>, +<b class="command">enumdrivers</b>, <b class="command">enumports</b>, +<b class="command">adddriver</b>, <b class="command">setdriver</b> are among +the most interesting ones. <i class="parameter"><tt>rpcclient</tt></i> implements an important part of +the MS-RPC protocol. You can use it to query (and command) a Windows NT +(or 200x/XP) PC, too. MS-RPC is used by Windows clients, among other +things, to benefit from the Point'n'Print features. Samba can now +mimic this as well. +</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2941083"></a>A Check of the rpcclient man Page</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + First let's check the <i class="parameter"><tt>rpcclient</tt></i> man page. Here are +two relevant passages: +</p><p> +<b class="command">adddriver <arch> <config></b> Execute an +<b class="command">AddPrinterDriver()</b> RPC to install the printer driver information on +the server. The driver files should already exist in the +directory returned by <b class="command">getdriverdir</b>. Possible +values for <i class="parameter"><tt>arch</tt></i> are the same as those for the +<b class="command">getdriverdir</b> command. The +<i class="parameter"><tt>config</tt></i> parameter is defined as follows: +</p><pre class="screen"> +Long Printer Name:\ +Driver File Name:\ +Data File Name:\ +Config File Name:\ +Help File Name:\ +Language Monitor Name:\ +Default Data Type:\ +Comma Separated list of Files +</pre><p>Any empty fields should be enter as the string “<span class="quote">NULL</span>”. </p><p>Samba does not need to support the concept of Print Monitors +since these only apply to local printers whose driver can make use of +a bi-directional link for communication. This field should be “<span class="quote">NULL</span>”. +On a remote NT print server, the Print Monitor for a driver must +already be installed prior to adding the driver or else the RPC will +fail. +</p><p> +<b class="command">setdriver <printername> <drivername></b> +Execute a <b class="command">SetPrinter()</b> command to update the +printer driver associated with an installed printer. The printer +driver must already be correctly installed on the print server. +</p><p>See also the <b class="command">enumprinters</b> and <b class="command">enumdrivers</b> commands for +obtaining a list of installed printers and drivers. +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2941229"></a>Understanding the rpcclient man Page</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +The <span class="emphasis"><em>exact</em></span> format isn't made too clear by the man +page, since you have to deal with some parameters containing +spaces. Here is a better description for it. We have line-broken the +command and indicated the breaks with “<span class="quote">\</span>”. Usually you would type the +command in one line without the linebreaks: +<a class="indexterm" name="id2941254"></a> +</p><pre class="screen"> + adddriver "Architecture" \ + "LongPrinterName:DriverFile:DataFile:ConfigFile:HelpFile:\ + LanguageMonitorFile:DataType:ListOfFiles,Comma-separated" +</pre><p> +What the man pages denote as a simple <i class="parameter"><tt><config></tt></i> +keyword, in reality consists of eight colon-separated fields. The +last field may take multiple (in some very insane cases, even +20 different additional) files. This might sound confusing at first. +What the man pages names the “<span class="quote">LongPrinterName</span>” in +reality should be called the “<span class="quote">Driver Name</span>”. You can name it +anything you want, as long as you use this name later in the +<b class="command">rpcclient ... setdriver</b> command. For +practical reasons, many name the driver the same as the +printer. +</p><p> +It isn't simple at all. I hear you asking: +“<span class="quote">How do I know which files are "Driver +File</span>”, “<span class="quote">Data File</span>”, “<span class="quote">Config File</span>”, “<span class="quote">Help File</span>” and “<span class="quote">Language +Monitor File" in each case?</span>” For an answer, you may +want to have a look at how a Windows NT box with a shared printer +presents the files to us. Remember, that this whole procedure has +to be developed by the Samba team by overhearing the traffic caused +by Windows computers on the wire. We may as well turn to a Windows +box now and access it from a UNIX workstation. We will query it +with <b class="command">rpcclient</b> to see what it tells us and +try to understand the man page more clearly that we've read just +now. +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2941358"></a>Producing an Example by Querying a Windows Box</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + <a class="indexterm" name="id2941369"></a> + <a class="indexterm" name="id2941380"></a> +We could run <b class="command">rpcclient</b> with a +<b class="command">getdriver</b> or a <b class="command">getprinter</b> +subcommand (in level 3 verbosity) against it. Just sit down at a UNIX or +Linux workstation with the Samba utilities installed, then type the +following command: +</p><pre class="screen"> +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>rpcclient -U'user%secret' NT-SERVER -c 'getdriver printername 3'</tt></b> +</pre><p> +From the result it should become clear which is which. Here is an example from my installation: +</p><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2941447"></a> + </p><pre class="screen"> +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>rpcclient -U'Danka%xxxx' W200xSERVER \ + -c'getdriver "DANKA InfoStream Virtual Printer" 3'</tt></b> + cmd = getdriver "DANKA InfoStream Virtual Printer" 3 + + [Windows NT x86] + Printer Driver Info 3: + Version: [2] + Driver Name: [DANKA InfoStream] + Architecture: [Windows NT x86] + Driver Path: [C:\WINNT\System32\spool\DRIVERS\W32X86\2\PSCRIPT.DLL] + Datafile: [C:\WINNT\System32\spool\DRIVERS\W32X86\2\INFOSTRM.PPD] + Configfile: [C:\WINNT\System32\spool\DRIVERS\W32X86\2\PSCRPTUI.DLL] + Helpfile: [C:\WINNT\System32\spool\DRIVERS\W32X86\2\PSCRIPT.HLP] + + Dependentfiles: [] + Dependentfiles: [] + Dependentfiles: [] + Dependentfiles: [] + Dependentfiles: [] + Dependentfiles: [] + Dependentfiles: [] + + Monitorname: [] + Defaultdatatype: [] + +</pre><p> +Some printer drivers list additional files under the label +<i class="parameter"><tt>Dependentfiles</tt></i> and these would go into the last field +<i class="parameter"><tt>ListOfFiles,Comma-separated</tt></i>. For the CUPS +PostScript drivers, we do not need any (nor would we for the Adobe +PostScript driver), therefore, the field will get a “<span class="quote">NULL</span>” entry. +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2941534"></a>Requirements for adddriver and setdriver to Succeed</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +>From the man page (and from the quoted output +of <b class="command">cupsaddsmb</b> above) it becomes clear that you +need to have certain conditions in order to make the manual uploading +and initializing of the driver files succeed. The two <b class="command">rpcclient</b> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2941564"></a> +subcommands (<b class="command">adddriver</b> and +<b class="command">setdriver</b>) need to encounter the following +preconditions to complete successfully: +</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>You are connected as <a class="indexterm" name="id2941599"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>printer admin</tt></i> or root (this is <span class="emphasis"><em>not</em></span> the “<span class="quote">Printer Operators</span>” group in +NT, but the <span class="emphasis"><em>printer admin</em></span> group as defined in +the <i class="parameter"><tt>[global]</tt></i> section of +<tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt>).</p></li><li><p>Copy all required driver files to +<tt class="filename">\\SAMBA\print$\w32x86</tt> and +<tt class="filename">\\SAMBA\print$\win40</tt> as appropriate. They +will end up in the “<span class="quote">0</span>” respective “<span class="quote">2</span>” subdirectories later. For now, +<span class="emphasis"><em>do not</em></span> put them there, they'll be automatically +used by the <b class="command">adddriver</b> subcommand. (If you use +<b class="command">smbclient</b> to put the driver files into the share, note that you need +to escape the “<span class="quote">$</span>”: <b class="command">smbclient //sambaserver/print\$ -U +root.</b>)</p></li><li><p>The user you're connecting as must be able to write to +the <i class="parameter"><tt>[print$]</tt></i> share and create +subdirectories.</p></li><li><p>The printer you are going to setup for the Windows +clients needs to be installed in CUPS already.</p></li><li><p> + <a class="indexterm" name="id2941729"></a> + <a class="indexterm" name="id2941740"></a> + The CUPS printer must be known to Samba, otherwise the +<b class="command">setdriver</b> subcommand fails with an +NT_STATUS_UNSUCCESSFUL error. To check if the printer is known by +Samba, you may use the <b class="command">enumprinters</b> subcommand to +<b class="command">rpcclient</b>. A long-standing bug prevented a proper update of the +printer list until every smbd process had received a SIGHUP or was +restarted. Remember this in case you've created the CUPS printer just +recently and encounter problems: try restarting +Samba.</p></li></ul></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2941782"></a>Manual Driver Installation in 15 Steps</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +We are going to install a printer driver now by manually executing all +required commands. As this may seem a rather complicated process at +first, we go through the procedure step by step, explaining every +single action item as it comes up. +</p><div class="procedure"><p class="title"><b>Procedure 19.1. Manual Driver Installation</b></p><ol type="1"><li><p class="title"><b>Install the printer on CUPS.</b></p><pre class="screen"> +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>lpadmin -p mysmbtstprn -v socket://10.160.51.131:9100 -E \ + -P canonIR85.ppd</tt></b> +</pre><p> +This installs a printer with the name <i class="parameter"><tt>mysmbtstprn</tt></i> +to the CUPS system. The printer is accessed via a socket +(a.k.a. JetDirect or Direct TCP/IP) connection. You need to be root +for this step. +</p></li><li><p class="title"><b>(Optional) Check if the printer is recognized by Samba.</b></p><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2941868"></a> +</p><pre class="screen"> + <tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>rpcclient -Uroot%xxxx -c 'enumprinters' localhost \ + | grep -C2 mysmbtstprn</tt></b> +flags:[0x800000] +name:[\\kde-bitshop\mysmbtstprn] +description:[\\kde-bitshop\mysmbtstprn,,mysmbtstprn] +comment:[mysmbtstprn] +</pre><p> +This should show the printer in the list. If not, stop and restart +the Samba daemon (smbd), or send a HUP signal: +</p><pre class="screen"> +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>kill -HUP `pidof smbd`</tt></b> +</pre><p>Check again. Troubleshoot and repeat until +successful. Note the “<span class="quote">empty</span>” field between the two commas in the +“<span class="quote">description</span>” line. The driver name would appear here if there was one already. You need to know root's Samba password (as set by the +<b class="command">smbpasswd</b> command) for this step and most of the +following steps. Alternately, you can authenticate as one of the +users from the “<span class="quote">write list</span>” as defined in <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> for +<i class="parameter"><tt>[print$]</tt></i>. +</p></li><li><p class="title"><b>(Optional) Check if Samba knows a driver for the printer.</b></p><p> + <a class="indexterm" name="id2941980"></a> + <a class="indexterm" name="id2941991"></a> + </p><pre class="screen"> +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>rpcclient -Uroot%xxxx -c 'getprinter mysmbtstprn 2' localhost \ + | grep driver </tt></b> +drivername:[] + +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>rpcclient -Uroot%xxxx -c 'getprinter mysmbtstprn 2' localhost \ + | grep -C4 driv</tt></b> +servername:[\\kde-bitshop] +printername:[\\kde-bitshop\mysmbtstprn] +sharename:[mysmbtstprn] +portname:[Samba Printer Port] +drivername:[] +comment:[mysmbtstprn] +location:[] +sepfile:[] +printprocessor:[winprint] + +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>rpcclient -U root%xxxx -c 'getdriver mysmbtstprn' localhost</tt></b> + result was WERR_UNKNOWN_PRINTER_DRIVER + +</pre><p> +None of the three commands shown above should show a driver. +This step was done for the purpose of demonstrating this condition. An +attempt to connect to the printer at this stage will prompt the +message along the lines of: “<span class="quote">The server does not have the required printer +driver installed.</span>” +</p></li><li><p class="title"><b>Put all required driver files into Samba's +[print$].</b></p><pre class="screen"> +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>smbclient //localhost/print\$ -U 'root%xxxx' \ + -c 'cd W32X86; \ + put /etc/cups/ppd/mysmbtstprn.ppd mysmbtstprn.PPD; \ + put /usr/share/cups/drivers/cupsui.dll cupsui.dll; \ + put /usr/share/cups/drivers/cupsdrvr.dll cupsdrvr.dll; \ + put /usr/share/cups/drivers/cups.hlp cups.hlp'</tt></b> +</pre><p> +(This command should be entered in one long single +line. Line-breaks and the line-end indicated by “<span class="quote">\</span>” have been inserted +for readability reasons.) This step is <span class="emphasis"><em>required</em></span> +for the next one to succeed. It makes the driver files physically +present in the <i class="parameter"><tt>[print$]</tt></i> share. However, clients +would still not be able to install them, because Samba does not yet +treat them as driver files. A client asking for the driver would still +be presented with a “<span class="quote">not installed here</span>” message. +</p></li><li><p class="title"><b>Verify where the driver files are now.</b></p><pre class="screen"> +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>ls -l /etc/samba/drivers/W32X86/</tt></b> +total 669 +drwxr-sr-x 2 root ntadmin 532 May 25 23:08 2 +drwxr-sr-x 2 root ntadmin 670 May 16 03:15 3 +-rwxr--r-- 1 root ntadmin 14234 May 25 23:21 cups.hlp +-rwxr--r-- 1 root ntadmin 278380 May 25 23:21 cupsdrvr.dll +-rwxr--r-- 1 root ntadmin 215848 May 25 23:21 cupsui.dll +-rwxr--r-- 1 root ntadmin 169458 May 25 23:21 mysmbtstprn.PPD +</pre><p> +The driver files now are in the W32X86 architecture “<span class="quote">root</span>” of +<i class="parameter"><tt>[print$]</tt></i>. +</p></li><li><p class="title"><b>Tell Samba that these are driver files (<b class="command">adddriver</b>).</b></p><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2942214"></a> +</p><pre class="screen"> +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>rpcclient -Uroot%xxxx -c `adddriver "Windows NT x86" \ + "mydrivername:cupsdrvr.dll:mysmbtstprn.PPD: \ + cupsui.dll:cups.hlp:NULL:RAW:NULL" \ + localhost</tt></b> +Printer Driver mydrivername successfully installed. +</pre><p> +You cannot repeat this step if it fails. It could fail even +as a result of a simple typo. It will most likely have moved a part of +the driver files into the “<span class="quote">2</span>” subdirectory. If this step fails, you +need to go back to the fourth step and repeat it before you can try +this one again. In this step, you need to choose a name for your +driver. It is normally a good idea to use the same name as is used for +the printer name; however, in big installations you may use this driver +for a number of printers that obviously have different names, so the +name of the driver is not fixed. +</p></li><li><p class="title"><b>Verify where the driver files are now.</b></p><pre class="screen"> +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>ls -l /etc/samba/drivers/W32X86/</tt></b> +total 1 +drwxr-sr-x 2 root ntadmin 532 May 25 23:22 2 +drwxr-sr-x 2 root ntadmin 670 May 16 03:15 3 + +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>ls -l /etc/samba/drivers/W32X86/2</tt></b> +total 5039 +[....] +-rwxr--r-- 1 root ntadmin 14234 May 25 23:21 cups.hlp +-rwxr--r-- 1 root ntadmin 278380 May 13 13:53 cupsdrvr.dll +-rwxr--r-- 1 root ntadmin 215848 May 13 13:53 cupsui.dll +-rwxr--r-- 1 root ntadmin 169458 May 25 23:21 mysmbtstprn.PPD +</pre><p> +Notice how step 6 also moved the driver files to the appropriate +subdirectory. Compare this with the situation after step 5. +</p></li><li><p class="title"><b>(Optional) Verify if Samba now recognizes the driver.</b></p><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2942341"></a> +</p><pre class="screen"> +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>rpcclient -Uroot%xxxx -c 'enumdrivers 3' \ + localhost | grep -B2 -A5 mydrivername</tt></b> +Printer Driver Info 3: +Version: [2] +Driver Name: [mydrivername] +Architecture: [Windows NT x86] +Driver Path: [\\kde-bitshop\print$\W32X86\2\cupsdrvr.dll] +Datafile: [\\kde-bitshop\print$\W32X86\2\mysmbtstprn.PPD] +Configfile: [\\kde-bitshop\print$\W32X86\2\cupsui.dll] +Helpfile: [\\kde-bitshop\print$\W32X86\2\cups.hlp] +</pre><p> +Remember, this command greps for the name you chose for the +driver in step 6. This command must succeed before you can proceed. +</p></li><li><p>Tell Samba which printer should use these driver files (<b class="command">setdriver</b>).</p><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2942406"></a> +</p><pre class="screen"> +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>rpcclient -Uroot%xxxx -c 'setdriver mysmbtstprn mydrivername' \ + localhost</tt></b> +Successfully set mysmbtstprn to driver mydrivername +</pre><p> +Since you can bind any printername (print queue) to any driver, this +is a convenient way to setup many queues that use the same +driver. You do not need to repeat all the previous steps for the +setdriver command to succeed. The only preconditions are: +<b class="command">enumdrivers</b> must find the driver and +<b class="command">enumprinters</b> must find the printer. +</p></li><li><p class="title"><b>(Optional) Verify if Samba has recognized this association.</b></p><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2942476"></a> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2942487"></a> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2942498"></a> +</p><pre class="screen"> +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>rpcclient -Uroot%xxxx -c 'getprinter mysmbtstprn 2' localhost \ + | grep driver</tt></b> +drivername:[mydrivername] + +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>rpcclient -Uroot%xxxx -c 'getprinter mysmbtstprn 2' localhost \ + | grep -C4 driv</tt></b> +servername:[\\kde-bitshop] +printername:[\\kde-bitshop\mysmbtstprn] +sharename:[mysmbtstprn] +portname:[Done] +drivername:[mydrivername] +comment:[mysmbtstprn] +location:[] +sepfile:[] +printprocessor:[winprint] + +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>rpcclient -U root%xxxx -c 'getdriver mysmbtstprn' localhost</tt></b> +[Windows NT x86] +Printer Driver Info 3: + Version: [2] + Driver Name: [mydrivername] + Architecture: [Windows NT x86] + Driver Path: [\\kde-bitshop\print$\W32X86\2\cupsdrvr.dll] + Datafile: [\\kde-bitshop\print$\W32X86\2\mysmbtstprn.PPD] + Configfile: [\\kde-bitshop\print$\W32X86\2\cupsui.dll] + Helpfile: [\\kde-bitshop\print$\W32X86\2\cups.hlp] + Monitorname: [] + Defaultdatatype: [RAW] + Monitorname: [] + Defaultdatatype: [RAW] + +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>rpcclient -Uroot%xxxx -c 'enumprinters' localhost \ + | grep mysmbtstprn</tt></b> + name:[\\kde-bitshop\mysmbtstprn] + description:[\\kde-bitshop\mysmbtstprn,mydrivername,mysmbtstprn] + comment:[mysmbtstprn] + +</pre><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2942589"></a> +Compare these results with the ones from steps 2 and 3. Every one of these commands show the driver is installed. Even +the <b class="command">enumprinters</b> command now lists the driver +on the “<span class="quote">description</span>” line. +</p></li><li><p class="title"><b>(Optional) Tickle the driver into a correct +device mode.</b></p><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2942629"></a> +You certainly know how to install the driver on the client. In case +you are not particularly familiar with Windows, here is a short +recipe: Browse the Network Neighborhood, go to the Samba server, and look +for the shares. You should see all shared Samba printers. +Double-click on the one in question. The driver should get +installed and the network connection set up. An alternate way is to +open the <span class="guilabel">Printers (and Faxes)</span> folder, right-click on the printer in +question and select <span class="guilabel">Connect</span> or <span class="guilabel">Install</span>. As a result, a new printer +should have appeared in your client's local <span class="guilabel">Printers (and Faxes)</span> +folder, named something like <span class="guilabel">printersharename on Sambahostname</span>. +</p><p> +It is important that you execute this step as a Samba printer admin +(as defined in <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt>). Here is another method +to do this on Windows XP. It uses a command line, which you may type +into the “<span class="quote">DOS box</span>” (type root's smbpassword when prompted): +</p><pre class="screen"> +<tt class="prompt">C:\> </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>runas /netonly /user:root "rundll32 printui.dll,PrintUIEntry \ + /in /n \\sambaserver\mysmbtstprn"</tt></b> +</pre><p> +Change any printer setting once (like changing <span class="emphasis"><em><span class="guilabel">portrait</span> to + <span class="guilabel">landscape</span></em></span>), click on <span class="guibutton">Apply</span>; change the setting +back. +</p></li><li><p class="title"><b>Install the printer on a client +(Point'n'Print).</b></p><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2942767"></a> + </p><pre class="screen"> +<tt class="prompt">C:\> </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>rundll32 printui.dll,PrintUIEntry /in /n “<span class="quote">\\sambaserver\mysmbtstprn</span>”</tt></b> +</pre><p> +If it does not work it could be a permission problem with the +<i class="parameter"><tt>[print$]</tt></i> share. +</p></li><li><p class="title"><b>(Optional) Print a test page.</b></p><pre class="screen"> +<tt class="prompt">C:\> </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>rundll32 printui.dll,PrintUIEntry /p /n "\\sambaserver\mysmbtstprn"</tt></b> +</pre><p> +Then hit [TAB] five times, [ENTER] twice, [TAB] once and [ENTER] again +and march to the printer. +</p></li><li><p class="title"><b>(Recommended) Study the test page.</b></p><p> +Hmmm.... just kidding! By now you know everything about printer +installations and you do not need to read a word. Just put it in a +frame and bolt it to the wall with the heading "MY FIRST +RPCCLIENT-INSTALLED PRINTER" why not just throw it away! +</p></li><li><p class="title"><b>(Obligatory) Enjoy. Jump. Celebrate your +success.</b></p><pre class="screen"> +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>echo "Cheeeeerioooooo! Success..." >> /var/log/samba/log.smbd</tt></b> +</pre></li></ol></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2942909"></a>Troubleshooting Revisited</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +The setdriver command will fail, if in Samba's mind the queue is not +already there. You had promising messages about the: +</p><pre class="screen"> + Printer Driver ABC successfully installed. +</pre><p> +after the <b class="command">adddriver</b> parts of the procedure? But you are also seeing +a disappointing message like this one? +</p><p><tt class="computeroutput"> + result was NT_STATUS_UNSUCCESSFUL +</tt></p><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2942956"></a> +It is not good enough that you +can see the queue in CUPS, using +the <b class="command">lpstat -p ir85wm</b> command. A +bug in most recent versions of Samba prevents the proper update of +the queuelist. The recognition of newly installed CUPS printers +fails unless you restart Samba or send a HUP to all smbd +processes. To verify if this is the reason why Samba does not +execute the <b class="command">setdriver</b> command successfully, check if Samba “<span class="quote">sees</span>” +the printer: +</p><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2942993"></a> + </p><pre class="screen"> +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>rpcclient transmeta -N -U'root%xxxx' -c 'enumprinters 0'|grep ir85wm</tt></b> + printername:[ir85wm] +</pre><p> +An alternate command could be this: +</p><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2943033"></a> + </p><pre class="screen"> +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>rpcclient transmeta -N -U'root%secret' -c 'getprinter ir85wm' </tt></b> + cmd = getprinter ir85wm + flags:[0x800000] + name:[\\transmeta\ir85wm] + description:[\\transmeta\ir85wm,ir85wm,DPD] + comment:[CUPS PostScript-Treiber for Windows NT/200x/XP] +</pre><p> +By the way, you can use these commands, plus a few more, of course, +to install drivers on remote Windows NT print servers too! +</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2943077"></a>The Printing <tt class="filename">*.tdb</tt> Files</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2943094"></a> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2943102"></a> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2943113"></a> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2943124"></a> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2943136"></a> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2943147"></a> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2943158"></a> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2943169"></a> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2943180"></a> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2943191"></a> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2943202"></a> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2943214"></a> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2943225"></a> +Some mystery is associated with the series of files with a +tdb suffix appearing in every Samba installation. They are +<tt class="filename">connections.tdb</tt>, +<tt class="filename">printing.tdb</tt>, +<tt class="filename">share_info.tdb</tt>, +<tt class="filename">ntdrivers.tdb</tt>, +<tt class="filename">unexpected.tdb</tt>, +<tt class="filename">brlock.tdb</tt>, +<tt class="filename">locking.tdb</tt>, +<tt class="filename">ntforms.tdb</tt>, +<tt class="filename">messages.tdb</tt> , +<tt class="filename">ntprinters.tdb</tt>, +<tt class="filename">sessionid.tdb</tt> and +<tt class="filename">secrets.tdb</tt>. What is their purpose? +</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2943322"></a>Trivial Database Files</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2943333"></a> +A Windows NT (print) server keeps track of all information needed to serve +its duty toward its clients by storing entries in the Windows +registry. Client queries are answered by reading from the registry, +Administrator or user configuration settings that are saved by writing into +the registry. Samba and UNIX obviously do not have such a +Registry. Samba instead keeps track of all client related information in a +series of <tt class="filename">*.tdb</tt> files. (TDB = Trivial Data +Base). These are often located in <tt class="filename">/var/lib/samba/</tt> +or <tt class="filename">/var/lock/samba/</tt>. The printing related files +are <tt class="filename">ntprinters.tdb</tt>, +<tt class="filename">printing.tdb</tt>,<tt class="filename">ntforms.tdb</tt> and +<tt class="filename">ntdrivers.tdb</tt>. +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2943400"></a>Binary Format</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +<tt class="filename">*.tdb</tt> files are not human readable. They are +written in a binary format. “<span class="quote">Why not ASCII?</span>”, you may ask. “<span class="quote">After all, +ASCII configuration files are a good and proven tradition on UNIX.</span>” +The reason for this design decision by the Samba team is mainly +performance. Samba needs to be fast; it runs a separate +<b class="command">smbd</b> process for each client connection, in some +environments many thousands of them. Some of these smbds might need to +write-access the same <tt class="filename">*.tdb</tt> file <span class="emphasis"><em>at the +same time</em></span>. The file format of Samba's +<tt class="filename">*.tdb</tt> files allows for this provision. Many smbd +processes may write to the same <tt class="filename">*.tdb</tt> file at the +same time. This wouldn't be possible with pure ASCII files. +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2943470"></a>Losing <tt class="filename">*.tdb</tt> Files</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +It is very important that all <tt class="filename">*.tdb</tt> files remain +consistent over all write and read accesses. However, it may happen +that these files <span class="emphasis"><em>do</em></span> get corrupted. (A +<b class="command">kill -9 `pidof smbd'</b> while a write access is in +progress could do the damage as well as a power interruption, +etc.). In cases of trouble, a deletion of the old printing-related +<tt class="filename">*.tdb</tt> files may be the only option. After that you need to +re-create all print-related setup or you have made a +backup of the <tt class="filename">*.tdb</tt> files in time. +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2943528"></a>Using <b class="command">tdbbackup</b></h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2943544"></a> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2943558"></a> +Samba ships with a little utility that helps the root user of your +system to backup your <tt class="filename">*.tdb</tt> files. If you run it +with no argument, it prints a usage message: +</p><pre class="screen"> +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>tdbbackup</tt></b> + Usage: tdbbackup [options] <fname...> + + Version:3.0a + -h this help message + -s suffix set the backup suffix + -v verify mode (restore if corrupt) + +</pre><p> +Here is how I backed up my <tt class="filename">printing.tdb</tt> file: +</p><pre class="screen"> +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>ls</tt></b> +. browse.dat locking.tdb ntdrivers.tdb printing.tdb +.. share_info.tdb connections.tdb messages.tdb ntforms.tdb +printing.tdbkp unexpected.tdb brlock.tdb gmon.out namelist.debug +ntprinters.tdb sessionid.tdb + +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>tdbbackup -s .bak printing.tdb</tt></b> + printing.tdb : 135 records + +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>ls -l printing.tdb*</tt></b> + -rw------- 1 root root 40960 May 2 03:44 printing.tdb + -rw------- 1 root root 40960 May 2 03:44 printing.tdb.bak + +</pre></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2943673"></a>CUPS Print Drivers from Linuxprinting.org</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2943683"></a> +CUPS ships with good support for HP LaserJet-type printers. You can +install the generic driver as follows: +</p><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2943698"></a> + </p><pre class="screen"> +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>lpadmin -p laserjet4plus -v parallel:/dev/lp0 -E -m laserjet.ppd</tt></b> +</pre><p> +The <tt class="option">-m</tt> switch will retrieve the +<tt class="filename">laserjet.ppd</tt> from the standard repository for +not-yet-installed-PPDs, which CUPS typically stores in +<tt class="filename">/usr/share/cups/model</tt>. Alternately, you may use +<tt class="option">-P /path/to/your.ppd</tt>. +</p><p> +The generic <tt class="filename">laserjet.ppd,</tt> however, does not support every special option +for every LaserJet-compatible model. It constitutes a sort of “<span class="quote">least common +denominator</span>” of all the models. If for some reason +you must pay for the commercially available ESP Print Pro drivers, your +first move should be to consult the database on <ulink url="http://www.linuxprinting.org/printer_list.cgi">http://www.linuxprinting.org/printer_list.cgi</ulink>. +Linuxprinting.org has excellent recommendations about which driver is +best used for each printer. Its database is kept current by the +tireless work of Till Kamppeter from MandrakeSoft, who is also the +principal author of the <b class="command">foomatic-rip</b> utility. +</p><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2943800"></a> +The former <b class="command">cupsomatic</b> concept is now being replaced by the new +successor, a much +more powerful <b class="command">foomatic-rip</b>. +<b class="command">cupsomatic</b> is no longer maintained. Here is the new URL +to the Foomatic-3.0 database: <ulink url="http://www.linuxprinting.org/driver_list.cgi">http://www.linuxprinting.org/driver_list.cgi</ulink>. +If you upgrade to <b class="command">foomatic-rip</b>, remember to also upgrade to the +new-style PPDs for your Foomatic-driven printers. foomatic-rip will +not work with PPDs generated for the old <b class="command">cupsomatic</b>. The new-style +PPDs are 100% compliant to the Adobe PPD specification. They are +also intended to be used by Samba and the cupsaddsmb utility, to +provide the driver files for the Windows clients! +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2943860"></a>foomatic-rip and Foomatic Explained</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2943871"></a> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2943880"></a> +Nowadays, most Linux distributions rely on the utilities of Linuxprinting.org +to create their printing-related software (which, by the way, works on all +UNIXes and on Mac OS X or Darwin, too). It is not known as well as it +should be, that it also has a very end-user-friendly interface that +allows for an easy update of drivers and PPDs for all supported +models, all spoolers, all operating systems, and all package formats +(because there is none). Its history goes back a few years. +</p><p> +Recently, Foomatic has achieved the astonishing milestone of <ulink url="http://www.linuxprinting.org/printer_list.cgi?make=Anyone">1000 +listed</ulink> printer models. Linuxprinting.org keeps all the +important facts about printer drivers, supported models and which +options are available for the various driver/printer combinations in +its <ulink url="http://www.linuxprinting.org/foomatic.html">Foomatic</ulink> +database. Currently there are <ulink url="http://www.linuxprinting.org/driver_list.cgi">245 drivers</ulink> +in the database. Many drivers support various models, and many models +may be driven by different drivers its your choice! +</p><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2943935"></a>690 “<span class="quote">Perfect</span>” Printers</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> +At present, there are 690 devices dubbed as working perfectly, 181 +mostly, 96 partially, and 46 are paperweights. Keeping in mind +that most of these are non-PostScript models (PostScript printers are +automatically supported by CUPS to perfection, by using +their own manufacturer-provided Windows-PPD), and that a +multifunctional device never qualifies as working perfectly if it +does not also scan and copy and fax under GNU/Linux then this is a +truly astonishing achievement! Three years ago the number was not +more than 500, and Linux or UNIX printing at the time wasn't +anywhere near the quality it is today. +</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2943975"></a>How the Printing HOWTO Started It All</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> +A few years ago <ulink url="http://www2.picante.com:81/~gtaylor/">Grant Taylor</ulink> +started it all. The roots of today's Linuxprinting.org are in the +first <ulink url="http://www.linuxprinting.org/foomatic2.9/howto/">Linux Printing +HOWTO</ulink> that he authored. As a side-project to this document, +which served many Linux users and admins to guide their first steps in +this complicated and delicate setup (to a scientist, printing is +“<span class="quote">applying a structured deposition of distinct patterns of ink or toner +particles on paper substrates</span>”, he started to +build in a little Postgres database with information about the +hardware and driver zoo that made up Linux printing of the time. This +database became the core component of today's Foomatic collection of +tools and data. In the meantime, it has moved to an XML representation +of the data. +</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2944020"></a>Foomatic's Strange Name</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2944031"></a> +“<span class="quote">Why the funny name?</span>” you ask. When it really took off, around spring +2000, CUPS was far less popular than today, and most systems used LPD, +LPRng or even PDQ to print. CUPS shipped with a few generic drivers +(good for a few hundred different printer models). These didn't +support many device-specific options. CUPS also shipped with its own +built-in rasterization filter (<i class="parameter"><tt>pstoraster</tt></i>, derived from +Ghostscript). On the other hand, CUPS provided brilliant support for +<span class="emphasis"><em>controlling</em></span> all printer options through +standardized and well-defined PPD files (PostScript Printers +Description files). Plus, CUPS was designed to be easily extensible. +</p><p> +Taylor already had in his database a respectable compilation +of facts about many more printers and the Ghostscript “<span class="quote">drivers</span>” +they run with. His idea, to generate PPDs from the database information +and use them to make standard Ghostscript filters work within CUPS, +proved to work very well. It also killed several birds with one +stone: +</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>It made all current and future Ghostscript filter +developments available for CUPS.</p></li><li><p>It made available a lot of additional printer models +to CUPS users (because often the traditional Ghostscript way of +printing was the only one available).</p></li><li><p>It gave all the advanced CUPS options (Web interface, +GUI driver configurations) to users wanting (or needing) to use +Ghostscript filters.</p></li></ul></div></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2944109"></a>cupsomatic, pdqomatic, lpdomatic, directomatic</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2944121"></a> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2944129"></a> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2944137"></a> +CUPS worked through a quickly-hacked up filter script named <ulink url="http://www.linuxprinting.org/download.cgi?filename=cupsomatic&show=0">cupsomatic.</ulink> +cupsomatic ran the printfile through Ghostscript, constructing +automatically the rather complicated command line needed. It just +needed to be copied into the CUPS system to make it work. To +configure the way cupsomatic controls the Ghostscript rendering +process, it needs a CUPS-PPD. This PPD is generated directly from the +contents of the database. For CUPS and the respective printer/filter +combo, another Perl script named CUPS-O-Matic did the PPD +generation. After that was working, Taylor implemented within a few +days a similar thing for two other spoolers. Names chosen for the +config-generator scripts were <ulink url="http://www.linuxprinting.org/download.cgi?filename=lpdomatic&show=0">PDQ-O-Matic</ulink> +(for PDQ) and <ulink url="http://www.linuxprinting.org/download.cgi?filename=lpdomatic&show=0">LPD-O-Matic</ulink> +(for you guessed it LPD); the configuration here didn't use PPDs +but other spooler-specific files. +</p><p> +From late summer of that year, <ulink url="http://www.linuxprinting.org/till/">Till Kamppeter</ulink> +started to put work into the database. Kamppeter had been newly employed by +<ulink url="http://www.mandrakesoft.com/">MandrakeSoft</ulink> to +convert its printing system over to CUPS, after they had seen his +<ulink url="http://www.fltk.org/">FLTK</ulink>-based <ulink url="http://cups.sourceforge.net/xpp/">XPP</ulink> (a GUI frontend to +the CUPS lp-command). He added a huge amount of new information and new +printers. He also developed the support for other spoolers, like +<ulink url="http://ppr.sourceforge.net/">PPR</ulink> (via ppromatic), +<ulink url="http://sourceforge.net/projects/lpr/">GNUlpr</ulink> and +<ulink url="http://www.lprng.org/">LPRng</ulink> (both via an extended +lpdomatic) and spoolerless printing (<ulink url="http://www.linuxprinting.org/download.cgi?filename=directomatic&show=0">directomatic</ulink>). +</p><p> +So, to answer your question: “<span class="quote">Foomatic</span>” is the general name for all +the overlapping code and data behind the “<span class="quote">*omatic</span>” scripts. +Foomatic, up to versions 2.0.x, required (ugly) Perl data structures +attached to Linuxprinting.org PPDs for CUPS. It had a different +“<span class="quote">*omatic</span>” script for every spooler, as well as different printer +configuration files. +</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2944302"></a>The <span class="emphasis"><em>Grand Unification</em></span> Achieved</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2944318"></a> +This has all changed in Foomatic versions 2.9 (beta) and released as +“<span class="quote">stable</span>” 3.0. It has now achieved the convergence of all *omatic +scripts and is called the <ulink url="http://www.linuxprinting.org/foomatic2.9/download.cgi?filename=foomatic-rip&show=0">foomatic-rip.</ulink> +This single script is the unification of the previously different +spooler-specific *omatic scripts. foomatic-rip is used by all the +different spoolers alike and because it can read PPDs (both the +original PostScript printer PPDs and the Linuxprinting.org-generated +ones), all of a sudden all supported spoolers can have the power of +PPDs at their disposal. Users only need to plug foomatic-rip into +their system. For users there is improved media type and source +support paper sizes and trays are easier to configure. +</p><p> +Also, the New Generation of Linuxprinting.org PPDs no longer contains +Perl data structures. If you are a distro maintainer and have +used the previous version of Foomatic, you may want to give the new +one a spin, but remember to generate a new-version set of PPDs +via the new <ulink url="http://www.linuxprinting.org/download/foomatic/foomatic-db-engine-3.0.0beta1.tar.gz">foomatic-db-engine!</ulink> +Individual users just need to generate a single new PPD specific to +their model by <ulink url="http://www.linuxprinting.org/kpfeifle/LinuxKongress2002/Tutorial/II.Foomatic-User/II.tutorial-handout-foomatic-user.html">following +the steps</ulink> outlined in the Foomatic tutorial or in this chapter. This new development is truly amazing. +</p><p> +foomatic-rip is a very clever wrapper around the need to run +Ghostscript with a different syntax, options, device selections, and/or filters for each different printer +or spooler. At the same time it can read the PPD associated +with a print queue and modify the print job according to the user +selections. Together with this comes the 100% compliance of the new +Foomatic PPDs with the Adobe spec. Some innovative features of +the Foomatic concept may surprise users. It will support custom paper +sizes for many printers and will support printing on media drawn +from different paper trays within the same job (in both cases, even +where there is no support for this from Windows-based vendor printer +drivers). +</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2944417"></a>Driver Development Outside</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> +Most driver development itself does not happen within +Linuxprinting.org. Drivers are written by independent maintainers. +Linuxprinting.org just pools all the information and stores it in its +database. In addition, it also provides the Foomatic glue to integrate +the many drivers into any modern (or legacy) printing system known to +the world. +</p><p> +Speaking of the different driver development groups, most of +the work is currently done in three projects. These are: +</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p><ulink url="http://www-124.ibm.com/developerworks/oss/linux/projects/omni/">Omni</ulink> + a free software project by IBM that tries to convert their printer +driver knowledge from good-ol' OS/2 times into a modern, modular, +universal driver architecture for Linux/UNIX (still beta). This +currently supports 437 models.</p></li><li><p><ulink url="http://hpinkjet.sf.net/">HPIJS</ulink> +a free software project by HP to provide the support for their own +range of models (very mature, printing in most cases is perfect and +provides true photo quality). This currently supports 369 +models.</p></li><li><p><ulink url="http://gimp-print.sf.net/">Gimp-Print</ulink> a free software +effort, started by Michael Sweet (also lead developer for CUPS), now +directed by Robert Krawitz, which has achieved an amazing level of +photo print quality (many Epson users swear that its quality is +better than the vendor drivers provided by Epson for the Microsoft +platforms). This currently supports 522 models.</p></li></ul></div></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2944507"></a>Forums, Downloads, Tutorials, Howtos also for Mac OS X and Commercial UNIX</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> +Linuxprinting.org today is the one-stop shop to download printer +drivers. Look for printer information and <ulink url="http://www.linuxprinting.org//kpfeifle/LinuxKongress2002/Tutorial/">tutorials</ulink> +or solve printing problems in its popular <ulink url="http://www.linuxprinting.org/newsportal/">forums.</ulink> This forum +it's not just for GNU/Linux users, but admins of <ulink url="http://www.linuxprinting.org/macosx/">commercial UNIX +systems</ulink> are also going there, and the relatively new <ulink url="http://www.linuxprinting.org/newsportal/thread.php3?name=linuxprinting.macosx.general">Mac +OS X forum</ulink> has turned out to be one of the most frequented +forums after only a few weeks. +</p><p> +Linuxprinting.org and the Foomatic driver wrappers around Ghostscript +are now a standard toolchain for printing on all the important +distros. Most of them also have CUPS underneath. While in recent years +most printer data had been added by Kamppeter (who works at Mandrake), many +additional contributions came from engineers with SuSE, RedHat, +Connectiva, Debian, and others. Vendor-neutrality is an important goal +of the Foomatic project. +</p><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p> +Till Kamppeter from MandrakeSoft is doing an excellent job in his +spare time to maintain Linuxprinting.org and Foomatic. So if you use +it often, please send him a note showing your appreciation. +</p></div></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2944580"></a>Foomatic Database-Generated PPDs</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> +The Foomatic database is an amazing piece of ingenuity in itself. Not +only does it keep the printer and driver information, but it is +organized in a way that it can generate PPD files on the fly from +its internal XML-based datasets. While these PPDs are modelled to the +Adobe specification of PostScript Printer Descriptions (PPDs), the +Linuxprinting.org/Foomatic-PPDs do not normally drive PostScript +printers. They are used to describe all the bells and whistles you +could ring or blow on an Epson Stylus inkjet, or a HP Photosmart, or +what-have-you. The main trick is one little additional line, not +envisaged by the PPD specification, starting with the <i class="parameter"><tt>*cupsFilter</tt></i> +keyword. It tells the CUPS daemon how to proceed with the PostScript +print file (old-style Foomatic-PPDs named the +cupsomatic filter script, while the new-style +PPDs are now call foomatic-rip). This filter +script calls Ghostscript on the host system (the recommended variant +is ESP Ghostscript) to do the rendering work. foomatic-rip knows which +filter or internal device setting it should ask from Ghostscript to +convert the PostScript printjob into a raster format ready for the +target device. This usage of PPDs to describe the options of non-PS +printers was the invention of the CUPS developers. The rest is easy. +GUI tools (like KDE's marvelous <ulink url="http://printing.kde.org/overview/kprinter.phtml">kprinter,</ulink> +or the GNOME <ulink url="http://gtklp.sourceforge.net/">gtklp,</ulink> xpp and the CUPS +Web interface) read the PPD as well and use this information to present +the available settings to the user as an intuitive menu selection. +</p></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2944657"></a>foomatic-rip and Foomatic-PPD Download and Installation</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +Here are the steps to install a foomatic-rip driven LaserJet 4 Plus-compatible +printer in CUPS (note that recent distributions of SuSE, UnitedLinux and +Mandrake may ship with a complete package of Foomatic-PPDs plus the +<b class="command">foomatic-rip</b> utility. Going directly to +Linuxprinting.org ensures that you get the latest driver/PPD files): +</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Open your browser at the Linuxprinting.org printer list<ulink url="http://www.linuxprinting.org/printer_list.cgi">page.</ulink> +</p></li><li><p>Check the complete list of printers in the +<ulink url="http://www.linuxprinting.org/printer_list.cgi?make=Anyone">database.</ulink>. +</p></li><li><p>Select your model and click on the link. +</p></li><li><p>You'll arrive at a page listing all drivers working with this +model (for all printers, there will always be <span class="emphasis"><em>one</em></span> +recommended driver. Try this one first). +</p></li><li><p>In our case (HP LaserJet 4 Plus), we'll arrive at the default driver for the +<ulink url="http://www.linuxprinting.org/show_printer.cgi?recnum=HP-LaserJet_4_Plus">HP-LaserJet 4 Plus.</ulink> +</p></li><li><p>The recommended driver is ljet4.</p></li><li><p>Several links are provided here. You should visit them all if you +are not familiar with the Linuxprinting.org database. +</p></li><li><p>There is a link to the database page for the +<ulink url="http://www.linuxprinting.org/show_driver.cgi?driver=ljet4">ljet4.</ulink> +On the driver's page, you'll find important and detailed information +about how to use that driver within the various available +spoolers.</p></li><li><p>Another link may lead you to the homepage of the +driver author or the driver.</p></li><li><p>Important links are the ones that provide hints with +setup instructions for <ulink url="http://www.linuxprinting.org/cups-doc.html">CUPS</ulink>, +<ulink url="http://www.linuxprinting.org/pdq-doc.html">PDQ</ulink>, +<ulink url="http://www.linuxprinting.org/lpd-doc.html">LPD, LPRng and GNUlpr</ulink>) +as well as <ulink url="http://www.linuxprinting.org/ppr-doc.html">PPR</ulink> +or “<span class="quote">spooler-less</span>” <ulink url="http://www.linuxprinting.org/direct-doc.html">printing.</ulink> +</p></li><li><p>You can view the PPD in your browser through this link: +<ulink url="http://www.linuxprinting.org/ppd-o-matic.cgi?driver=ljet4&printer=HP-LaserJet_4_Plus&show=1">http://www.linuxprinting.org/ppd-o-matic.cgi?driver=ljet4&printer=HP-LaserJet_4_Plus&show=1</ulink> +</p></li><li><p>Most importantly, you can also generate and download +the <ulink url="http://www.linuxprinting.org/ppd-o-matic.cgi?driver=ljet4&printer=HP-LaserJet_4_Plus&show=0">PPD.</ulink> +</p></li><li><p>The PPD contains all the information needed to use our +model and the driver; once installed, this works transparently +for the user. Later you'll only need to choose resolution, paper size, +and so on from the Web-based menu, or from the print dialog GUI, or from +the command line.</p></li><li><p>If you ended up on the drivers +<ulink url="http://www.linuxprinting.org/show_driver.cgi?driver=ljet4">page</ulink> +you can choose to use the “<span class="quote">PPD-O-Matic</span>” online PPD generator +program.</p></li><li><p>Select the exact model and check either <span class="guilabel">Download</span> or +<span class="guilabel">Display PPD file</span> and click <span class="guilabel">Generate PPD file</span>.</p></li><li><p>If you save the PPD file from the browser view, please +do not use cut and paste (since it could possibly damage line endings +and tabs, which makes the PPD likely to fail its duty), but use <span class="guimenuitem">Save +as...</span> in your browser's menu. (It is best to use the <span class="guilabel">Download</span> option +directly from the Web page).</p></li><li><p>Another interesting part on each driver page is +the <span class="guimenuitem">Show execution details</span> button. If you +select your printer model and click on that button, +a complete Ghostscript command line will be displayed, enumerating all options +available for that combination of driver and printer model. This is a great way to +“<span class="quote">learn Ghostscript by doing</span>”. It is also an excellent cheat sheet +for all experienced users who need to re-construct a good command line +for that damn printing script, but can't remember the exact +syntax. </p></li><li><p>Some time during your visit to Linuxprinting.org, save +the PPD to a suitable place on your harddisk, say +<tt class="filename">/path/to/my-printer.ppd</tt> (if you prefer to install +your printers with the help of the CUPS Web interface, save the PPD to +the <tt class="filename">/usr/share/cups/model/</tt> path and restart +cupsd).</p></li><li><p>Then install the printer with a suitable command line, +like this: +</p><pre class="screen"> +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>lpadmin -p laserjet4plus -v parallel:/dev/lp0 -E \ + -P path/to/my-printer.ppd</tt></b> +</pre></li><li><p>For all the new-style “<span class="quote">Foomatic-PPDs</span>” +from Linuxprinting.org, you also need a special CUPS filter named +foomatic-rip. +</p></li><li><p>The foomatic-rip Perlscript itself also makes some +interesting <ulink url="http://www.linuxprinting.org/foomatic2.9/download.cgi?filename=foomatic-rip&show=1">reading</ulink> +because it is well documented by Kamppeter's inline comments (even +non-Perl hackers will learn quite a bit about printing by reading +it).</p></li><li><p>Save foomatic-rip either directly in +<tt class="filename">/usr/lib/cups/filter/foomatic-rip</tt> or somewhere in +your $PATH (and remember to make it world-executable). Again, +do not save by copy and paste but use the appropriate link or the +<span class="guimenuitem">Save as...</span> menu item in your browser.</p></li><li><p>If you save foomatic-rip in your $PATH, create a symlink: +</p><pre class="screen"> +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>cd /usr/lib/cups/filter/ ; ln -s `which foomatic-rip'</tt></b> +</pre><p> +</p><p> +CUPS will discover this new available filter at startup after restarting +cupsd.</p></li></ul></div><p> +Once you print to a print queue set up with the Foomatic-PPD, CUPS will +insert the appropriate commands and comments into the resulting +PostScript jobfile. foomatic-rip is able to read and act upon +these and uses some specially encoded Foomatic comments +embedded in the jobfile. These in turn are used to construct +(transparently for you, the user) the complicated Ghostscript command +line telling the printer driver exactly how the resulting raster +data should look and which printer commands to embed into the +data stream. You need: +</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>A “<span class="quote">foomatic+something</span>” PPD but this is not enough +to print with CUPS (it is only <span class="emphasis"><em>one</em></span> important +component).</p></li><li><p>The <i class="parameter"><tt>foomatic-rip</tt></i> filter script (Perl) in +<tt class="filename">/usr/lib/cups/filters/</tt>.</p></li><li><p>Perl to make foomatic-rip run.</p></li><li><p>Ghostscript (because it is doing the main work, +controlled by the PPD/foomatic-rip combo) to produce the raster data +fit for your printer model's consumption.</p></li><li><p>Ghostscript <span class="emphasis"><em>must</em></span> (depending on +the driver/model) contain support for a certain device representing +the selected driver for your model (as shown by <b class="command">gs + -h</b>).</p></li><li><p>foomatic-rip needs a new version of PPDs (PPD versions +produced for cupsomatic do not work with +foomatic-rip).</p></li></ul></div></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2945207"></a>Page Accounting with CUPS</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2945218"></a> +Often there are questions regarding print quotas where Samba users +(that is, Windows clients) should not be able to print beyond a +certain number of pages or data volume per day, week or month. This +feature is dependent on the real print subsystem you're using. +Samba's part is always to receive the job files from the clients +(filtered <span class="emphasis"><em>or</em></span> unfiltered) and hand it over to this +printing subsystem. +</p><p> +Of course one could hack things with one's own scripts. But then +there is CUPS. CUPS supports quotas that can be based on the size of +jobs or on the number of pages or both, and span any time +period you want. +</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2945248"></a>Setting Up Quotas</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2945260"></a> +This is an example command of how root would set a print quota in CUPS, +assuming an existing printer named “<span class="quote">quotaprinter</span>”: +</p><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2945281"></a> + </p><pre class="screen"> +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>lpadmin -p quotaprinter -o job-quota-period=604800 \ + -o job-k-limit=1024 -o job-page-limit=100</tt></b> +</pre><p> +This would limit every single user to print 100 pages or 1024 KB of +data (whichever comes first) within the last 604,800 seconds ( = 1 +week). +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2945318"></a>Correct and Incorrect Accounting</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +For CUPS to count correctly, the printfile needs to pass the CUPS +pstops filter, otherwise it uses a dummy count of “<span class="quote">one</span>”. Some +print files do not pass it (e.g., image files) but then those are mostly one- +page jobs anyway. This also means that proprietary drivers for the +target printer running on the client computers and CUPS/Samba, which +then spool these files as “<span class="quote">raw</span>” (i.e., leaving them untouched, not +filtering them), will be counted as one-pagers too! +</p><p> +You need to send PostScript from the clients (i.e., run a PostScript +driver there) to have the chance to get accounting done. If the +printer is a non-PostScript model, you need to let CUPS do the job to +convert the file to a print-ready format for the target printer. This +is currently working for about a thousand different printer models. +Linuxprinting has a driver +<ulink url="http://www.linuxprinting.org/printer_list.cgi">list.</ulink> +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2945366"></a>Adobe and CUPS PostScript Drivers for Windows Clients</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +Before CUPS 1.1.16, your only option was to use the Adobe PostScript +Driver on the Windows clients. The output of this driver was not +always passed through the <b class="command">pstops</b> filter on the CUPS/Samba side, and +therefore was not counted correctly (the reason is that it often, +depending on the PPD being used, wrote a PJL-header in front of +the real PostScript which caused CUPS to skip <b class="command">pstops</b> and go directly +to the <b class="command">pstoraster</b> stage). +</p><p> +From CUPS 1.1.16 onward, you can use the CUPS PostScript Driver for +Windows NT/200x/XP clients (which is tagged in the download area of +<tt class="filename">http://www.cups.org/</tt> as the <tt class="filename">cups-samba-1.1.16.tar.gz</tt> +package). It does <span class="emphasis"><em>not</em></span> work for Windows 9x/ME clients, but it guarantees: +</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p> <a class="indexterm" name="id2945443"></a> To not write a PJL-header.</p></li><li><p>To still read and support all PJL-options named in the +driver PPD with its own means.</p></li><li><p>That the file will pass through the <b class="command">pstops</b> filter +on the CUPS/Samba server.</p></li><li><p>To page-count correctly the print file.</p></li></ul></div><p> +You can read more about the setup of this combination in the man page +for <b class="command">cupsaddsmb</b> (which is only present with CUPS installed, and only +current from CUPS 1.1.16). +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2945495"></a>The page_log File Syntax</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2945506"></a> +These are the items CUPS logs in the <tt class="filename">page_log</tt> for every +page of a job: +</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Printer name</p></li><li><p>User name</p></li><li><p>Job ID</p></li><li><p>Time of printing</p></li><li><p>The page number</p></li><li><p>The number of copies</p></li><li><p>A billing information string (optional)</p></li><li><p>The host that sent the job (included since version 1.1.19)</p></li></ul></div><p> +Here is an extract of my CUPS server's <tt class="filename">page_log</tt> file to illustrate the +format and included items: +</p><pre class="screen"> +tec_IS2027 kurt 401 [22/Apr/2003:10:28:43 +0100] 1 3 #marketing 10.160.50.13 +tec_IS2027 kurt 401 [22/Apr/2003:10:28:43 +0100] 2 3 #marketing 10.160.50.13 +tec_IS2027 kurt 401 [22/Apr/2003:10:28:43 +0100] 3 3 #marketing 10.160.50.13 +tec_IS2027 kurt 401 [22/Apr/2003:10:28:43 +0100] 4 3 #marketing 10.160.50.13 +Dig9110 boss 402 [22/Apr/2003:10:33:22 +0100] 1 440 finance-dep 10.160.51.33 +</pre><p> +This was job ID <i class="parameter"><tt>401</tt></i>, printed on <i class="parameter"><tt>tec_IS2027</tt></i> +by user <i class="parameter"><tt>kurt</tt></i>, a 64-page job printed in three copies and billed to +<i class="parameter"><tt>#marketing</tt></i>, sent from IP address <tt class="constant">10.160.50.13.</tt> + The next job had ID <i class="parameter"><tt>402</tt></i>, was sent by user <i class="parameter"><tt>boss</tt></i> +from IP address <tt class="constant">10.160.51.33</tt>, printed from one page 440 copies and +is set to be billed to <i class="parameter"><tt>finance-dep</tt></i>. +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2945665"></a>Possible Shortcomings</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +What flaws or shortcomings are there with this quota system? +</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>The ones named above (wrongly logged job in case of +printer hardware failure, and so on).</p></li><li><p>In reality, CUPS counts the job pages that are being +processed in <span class="emphasis"><em>software</em></span> (that is, going through the +RIP) rather than the physical sheets successfully leaving the +printing device. Thus if there is a jam while printing the fifth sheet out +of a thousand and the job is aborted by the printer, the page count will +still show the figure of a thousand for that job.</p></li><li><p>All quotas are the same for all users (no flexibility +to give the boss a higher quota than the clerk) and no support for +groups.</p></li><li><p>No means to read out the current balance or the +“<span class="quote">used-up</span>” number of current quota.</p></li><li><p>A user having used up 99 sheets of a 100 quota will +still be able to send and print a thousand sheet job.</p></li><li><p>A user being denied a job because of a filled-up quota +does not get a meaningful error message from CUPS other than +“<span class="quote">client-error-not-possible</span>”.</p></li></ul></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2945745"></a>Future Developments</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +This is the best system currently available, and there are huge +improvements under development for CUPS 1.2: +</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Page counting will go into the backends (these talk +directly to the printer and will increase the count in sync with the +actual printing process; thus, a jam at the fifth sheet will lead to a +stop in the counting).</p></li><li><p>Quotas will be handled more flexibly.</p></li><li><p>Probably there will be support for users to inquire +about their accounts in advance.</p></li><li><p>Probably there will be support for some other tools +around this topic.</p></li></ul></div></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2945799"></a>Additional Material</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +A printer queue with <span class="emphasis"><em>no</em></span> PPD associated to it is a +“<span class="quote">raw</span>” printer and all files will go directly there as received by the +spooler. The exceptions are file types <i class="parameter"><tt>application/octet-stream</tt></i> +that need passthrough feature enabled. “<span class="quote">Raw</span>” queues do not do any +filtering at all, they hand the file directly to the CUPS backend. +This backend is responsible for sending the data to the device +(as in the “<span class="quote">device URI</span>” notation: <tt class="filename">lpd://, socket://, +smb://, ipp://, http://, parallel:/, serial:/, usb:/</tt>, and so on). +</p><p> +cupsomatic/Foomatic are <span class="emphasis"><em>not</em></span> native CUPS drivers +and they do not ship with CUPS. They are a third party add-on +developed at Linuxprinting.org. As such, they are a brilliant hack to +make all models (driven by Ghostscript drivers/filters in traditional +spoolers) also work via CUPS, with the same (good or bad!) quality as +in these other spoolers. <i class="parameter"><tt>cupsomatic</tt></i> is only a vehicle to execute a +Ghostscript commandline at that stage in the CUPS filtering chain, +where normally the native CUPS <i class="parameter"><tt>pstoraster</tt></i> filter would kick +in. cupsomatic bypasses pstoraster, kidnaps the printfile from CUPS +away and redirects it to go through Ghostscript. CUPS accepts this, +because the associated cupsomatic/foomatic-PPD specifies: + +</p><pre class="programlisting"> + *cupsFilter: "application/vnd.cups-postscript 0 cupsomatic" +</pre><p> + +This line persuades CUPS to hand the file to cupsomatic, once it has +successfully converted it to the MIME type +<i class="parameter"><tt>application/vnd.cups-postscript</tt></i>. This conversion will not happen for +Jobs arriving from Windows that are auto-typed +<i class="parameter"><tt>application/octet-stream</tt></i>, with the according changes in +<tt class="filename">/etc/cups/mime.types</tt> in place. +</p><p> +CUPS is widely configurable and flexible, even regarding its filtering +mechanism. Another workaround in some situations would be to have in +<tt class="filename">/etc/cups/mime.types</tt> entries as follows: + +</p><pre class="programlisting"> + application/postscript application/vnd.cups-raw 0 - + application/vnd.cups-postscript application/vnd.cups-raw 0 - +</pre><p> + +This would prevent all PostScript files from being filtered (rather, +they will through the virtual <span class="emphasis"><em>nullfilter</em></span> +denoted with “<span class="quote">-</span>”). This could only be useful for PS printers. If you +want to print PS code on non-PS printers (provided they support ASCII +text printing), an entry as follows could be useful: + +</p><pre class="programlisting"> + */* application/vnd.cups-raw 0 - +</pre><p> + +and would effectively send <span class="emphasis"><em>all</em></span> files to the +backend without further processing. +</p><p> +You could have the following entry: + +</p><pre class="programlisting"> +application/vnd.cups-postscript application/vnd.cups-raw 0 \ + my_PJL_stripping_filter +</pre><p> + +You will need to write a <i class="parameter"><tt>my_PJL_stripping_filter</tt></i> +(which could be a shell script) that parses the PostScript and removes the +unwanted PJL. This needs to conform to CUPS filter design +(mainly, receive and pass the parameters printername, job-id, +username, jobtitle, copies, print options and possibly the +filename). It is installed as world executable into +<tt class="filename">/usr/lib/cups/filters/</tt> and is called by CUPS +if it encounters a MIME type <i class="parameter"><tt>application/vnd.cups-postscript</tt></i>. +</p><p> +CUPS can handle <i class="parameter"><tt>-o job-hold-until=indefinite</tt></i>. +This keeps the job in the queue on hold. It will only be printed +upon manual release by the printer operator. This is a requirement in +many central reproduction departments, where a few operators manage +the jobs of hundreds of users on some big machine, where no user is +allowed to have direct access (such as when the operators often need +to load the proper paper type before running the 10,000 page job +requested by marketing for the mailing, and so on). +</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2946030"></a>Auto-Deletion or Preservation of CUPS Spool Files</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +Samba print files pass through two spool directories. One is the +incoming directory managed by Samba, (set in the +<a class="indexterm" name="id2946043"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>path</tt></i> = /var/spool/samba +directive in the <i class="parameter"><tt>[printers]</tt></i> section of +<tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt>). The other is the spool directory of +your UNIX print subsystem. For CUPS it is normally +<tt class="filename">/var/spool/cups/</tt>, as set by the <tt class="filename">cupsd.conf</tt> +directive <tt class="filename">RequestRoot /var/spool/cups</tt>. +</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2946094"></a>CUPS Configuration Settings Explained</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +Some important parameter settings in the CUPS configuration file +<tt class="filename">cupsd.conf</tt> are: +</p><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">PreserveJobHistory Yes</span></dt><dd><p> +This keeps some details of jobs in cupsd's mind (well it keeps the +c12345, c12346, and so on, files in the CUPS spool directory, which do a +similar job as the old-fashioned BSD-LPD control files). This is set +to “<span class="quote">Yes</span>” as a default. +</p></dd><dt><span class="term">PreserveJobFiles Yes</span></dt><dd><p> +This keeps the job files themselves in cupsd's mind +(it keeps the d12345, d12346 etc. files in the CUPS spool +directory). This is set to “<span class="quote">No</span>” as the CUPS +default. +</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><span class="emphasis"><em>“<span class="quote">MaxJobs 500</span>”</em></span></span></dt><dd><p> +This directive controls the maximum number of jobs +that are kept in memory. Once the number of jobs reaches the limit, +the oldest completed job is automatically purged from the system to +make room for the new one. If all of the known jobs are still +pending or active, then the new job will be rejected. Setting the +maximum to 0 disables this functionality. The default setting is +0. +</p></dd></dl></div><p> +(There are also additional settings for <i class="parameter"><tt>MaxJobsPerUser</tt></i> and +<i class="parameter"><tt>MaxJobsPerPrinter</tt></i>...) +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2946198"></a>Pre-Conditions</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +For everything to work as announced, you need to have three +things: +</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>A Samba-smbd that is compiled against <tt class="filename">libcups</tt> (check +on Linux by running <b class="userinput"><tt>ldd `which smbd'</tt></b>).</p></li><li><p>A Samba-<tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> setting of + <a class="indexterm" name="id2946246"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>printing</tt></i> = cups.</p></li><li><p>Another Samba-<tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> setting of + <a class="indexterm" name="id2946272"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>printcap</tt></i> = cups.</p></li></ul></div><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p> +In this case, all other manually set printing-related commands (like +<a class="indexterm" name="id2946294"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>print command</tt></i>, +<a class="indexterm" name="id2946308"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>lpq command</tt></i>, +<a class="indexterm" name="id2946321"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>lprm command</tt></i>, +<a class="indexterm" name="id2946335"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>lppause command</tt></i> or +<a class="indexterm" name="id2946349"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>lpresume command</tt></i>) are ignored and they should normally have no +influence whatsoever on your printing. +</p></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2946367"></a>Manual Configuration</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +If you want to do things manually, replace the <a class="indexterm" name="id2946378"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>printing</tt></i> = cups +by <a class="indexterm" name="id2946391"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>printing</tt></i> = bsd. Then your manually set commands may work +(I haven't tested this), and a <a class="indexterm" name="id2946407"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>print command</tt></i> = lp -d %P %s; rm %s" +may do what you need. +</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2946425"></a>Printing from CUPS to Windows Attached Printers</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +>From time to time the question arises, how can you print +<span class="emphasis"><em>to</em></span> a Windows attached printer +<span class="emphasis"><em>from</em></span> Samba? Normally the local connection +from Windows host to printer would be done by USB or parallel +cable, but this does not matter to Samba. From here only an SMB +connection needs to be opened to the Windows host. Of course, this +printer must be shared first. As you have learned by now, CUPS uses +<span class="emphasis"><em>backends</em></span> to talk to printers and other +servers. To talk to Windows shared printers, you need to use the +<tt class="filename">smb</tt> (surprise, surprise!) backend. Check if this +is in the CUPS backend directory. This usually resides in +<tt class="filename">/usr/lib/cups/backend/</tt>. You need to find an <tt class="filename">smb</tt> +file there. It should be a symlink to <tt class="filename">smbspool</tt> +and the file must exist and be executable: +</p><pre class="screen"> +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>ls -l /usr/lib/cups/backend/</tt></b> +total 253 +drwxr-xr-x 3 root root 720 Apr 30 19:04 . +drwxr-xr-x 6 root root 125 Dec 19 17:13 .. +-rwxr-xr-x 1 root root 10692 Feb 16 21:29 canon +-rwxr-xr-x 1 root root 10692 Feb 16 21:29 epson +lrwxrwxrwx 1 root root 3 Apr 17 22:50 http -> ipp +-rwxr-xr-x 1 root root 17316 Apr 17 22:50 ipp +-rwxr-xr-x 1 root root 15420 Apr 20 17:01 lpd +-rwxr-xr-x 1 root root 8656 Apr 20 17:01 parallel +-rwxr-xr-x 1 root root 2162 Mar 31 23:15 pdfdistiller +lrwxrwxrwx 1 root root 25 Apr 30 19:04 ptal -> /usr/sbin/ptal-cups +-rwxr-xr-x 1 root root 6284 Apr 20 17:01 scsi +lrwxrwxrwx 1 root root 17 Apr 2 03:11 smb -> /usr/bin/smbspool +-rwxr-xr-x 1 root root 7912 Apr 20 17:01 socket +-rwxr-xr-x 1 root root 9012 Apr 20 17:01 usb + +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>ls -l `which smbspool`</tt></b> +-rwxr-xr-x 1 root root 563245 Dec 28 14:49 /usr/bin/smbspool +</pre><p> +If this symlink does not exist, create it: +</p><pre class="screen"> +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>ln -s `which smbspool` /usr/lib/cups/backend/smb</tt></b> +</pre><p> +<b class="command">smbspool</b> has been written by Mike Sweet from the CUPS folks. It is +included and ships with Samba. It may also be used with print +subsystems other than CUPS, to spool jobs to Windows printer shares. To +set up printer <i class="replaceable"><tt>winprinter</tt></i> on CUPS, you need to have a driver for +it. Essentially this means to convert the print data on the CUPS/Samba +host to a format that the printer can digest (the Windows host is +unable to convert any files you may send). This also means you should +be able to print to the printer if it were hooked directly at your +Samba/CUPS host. For troubleshooting purposes, this is what you +should do to determine if that part of the process chain is in +order. Then proceed to fix the network connection/authentication to +the Windows host, and so on. +</p><p> +To install a printer with the <i class="parameter"><tt>smb</tt></i> backend on CUPS, use this command: +</p><pre class="screen"> +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>lpadmin -p winprinter -v smb://WINDOWSNETBIOSNAME/printersharename \ + -P /path/to/PPD</tt></b> +</pre><p> +The PPD must be able to direct CUPS to generate +the print data for the target model. For PostScript printers, just use +the PPD that would be used with the Windows NT PostScript driver. But +what can you do if the printer is only accessible with a password? Or +if the printer's host is part of another workgroup? This is provided +for: You can include the required parameters as part of the +<tt class="filename">smb://</tt> device-URI like this: +</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><tt class="filename">smb://WORKGROUP/WINDOWSNETBIOSNAME/printersharename</tt></li><li><tt class="filename">smb://username:password@WORKGROUP/WINDOWSNETBIOSNAME/printersharename</tt></li><li><tt class="filename">smb://username:password@WINDOWSNETBIOSNAME/printersharename</tt></li></ul></div><p> +Note that the device-URI will be visible in the process list of the +Samba server (e.g., when someone uses the <b class="command">ps -aux</b> +command on Linux), even if the username and passwords are sanitized +before they get written into the log files. So this is an inherently +insecure option, however, it is the only one. Don't use it if you want +to protect your passwords. Better share the printer in a way that +does not require a password! Printing will only work if you have a +working netbios name resolution up and running. Note that this is a +feature of CUPS and you do not necessarily need to have smbd running. + +</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2946721"></a>More CUPS-Filtering Chains</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +The following diagrams reveal how CUPS handles print jobs. +</p><div class="figure"><a name="cups1"></a><p class="title"><b>Figure 19.17. Filtering chain 1.</b></p><div class="mediaobject"><img src="projdoc/imagefiles/cups1.png" width="270" alt="Filtering chain 1."></div></div><div class="figure"><a name="cups2"></a><p class="title"><b>Figure 19.18. Filtering chain with cupsomatic</b></p><div class="mediaobject"><img src="projdoc/imagefiles/cups2.png" width="270" alt="Filtering chain with cupsomatic"></div></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2946814"></a>Common Errors</h2></div></div><div></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2946820"></a>Windows 9x/ME Client Can't Install Driver</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>For Windows 9x/ME, clients require the printer names to be eight +characters (or “<span class="quote">8 plus 3 chars suffix</span>”) max; otherwise, the driver files +will not get transferred when you want to download them from +Samba.</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2946839"></a>“<span class="quote">cupsaddsmb</span>” Keeps Asking for Root Password in Never-ending Loop</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>Have you <a class="indexterm" name="id2946853"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>security</tt></i> = user? Have +you used <b class="command">smbpasswd</b> to give root a Samba account? +You can do two things: open another terminal and execute +<b class="command">smbpasswd -a root</b> to create the account and +continue entering the password into the first terminal. Or break +out of the loop by pressing ENTER twice (without trying to type a +password).</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2946889"></a>“<span class="quote">cupsaddsmb</span>” Errors</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + The use of “<span class="quote">cupsaddsmb</span>” gives “<span class="quote">No PPD file for printer...</span>” Message While PPD File Is Present. + What might the problem be? + </p><p>Have you enabled printer sharing on CUPS? This means: +Do you have a <i class="parameter"><tt><Location +/printers>....</Location></tt></i> section in CUPS +server's <tt class="filename">cupsd.conf</tt> that does not deny access to +the host you run “<span class="quote">cupsaddsmb</span>” from? It <span class="emphasis"><em>could</em></span> be +an issue if you use cupsaddsmb remotely, or if you use it with a +<tt class="option">-h</tt> parameter: <b class="userinput"><tt>cupsaddsmb -H + sambaserver -h cupsserver -v printername</tt></b>. +</p><p>Is your +<i class="parameter"><tt>TempDir</tt></i> directive in +<tt class="filename">cupsd.conf</tt> +set to a valid value and is it writeable? +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2946973"></a>Client Can't Connect to Samba Printer</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>Use <b class="command">smbstatus</b> to check which user +you are from Samba's point of view. Do you have the privileges to +write into the <i class="parameter"><tt>[print$]</tt></i> +share?</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2947002"></a>New Account Reconnection from Windows 200x/XP Troubles</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>Once you are connected as the wrong user (for +example, as <tt class="constant">nobody</tt>, which often occurs if you have +<a class="indexterm" name="id2947018"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>map to guest</tt></i> = bad user), Windows Explorer will not accept an +attempt to connect again as a different user. There will not be any byte +transfered on the wire to Samba, but still you'll see a stupid error +message that makes you think Samba has denied access. Use +<b class="command">smbstatus</b> to check for active connections. Kill the +PIDs. You still can't re-connect and you get the dreaded +<tt class="computeroutput">You can't connect with a second account from the same +machine</tt> message, as soon as you are trying. And you +do not see any single byte arriving at Samba (see logs; use “<span class="quote">ethereal</span>”) +indicating a renewed connection attempt. Shut all Explorer Windows. +This makes Windows forget what it has cached in its memory as +established connections. Then reconnect as the right user. The best +method is to use a DOS terminal window and <span class="emphasis"><em>first</em></span> +do <b class="userinput"><tt>net use z: \\GANDALF\print$ /user:root</tt></b>. Check +with <b class="command">smbstatus</b> that you are connected under a +different account. Now open the <span class="guilabel">Printers</span> folder (on the Samba server +in the <span class="guilabel">Network Neighborhood</span>), right-click on the +printer in question and select +<span class="guibutton">Connect...</span></p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2947106"></a>Avoid Being Connected to the Samba Server as the Wrong User</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>You see per <b class="command">smbstatus</b> that you are +connected as user nobody; while you want to be root or +printeradmin. This is probably due to +<a class="indexterm" name="id2947126"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>map to guest</tt></i> = bad user, which silently connects you under the guest account +when you gave (maybe by accident) an incorrect username. Remove +<a class="indexterm" name="id2947142"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>map to guest</tt></i>, if you want to prevent +this.</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2947158"></a>Upgrading to CUPS Drivers from Adobe Drivers</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +This information came from a mailinglist posting regarding problems experienced when +upgrading from Adobe drivers to CUPS drivers on Microsoft Windows NT/200x/XP Clients. +</p><p>First delete all old Adobe-using printers. Then +delete all old Adobe drivers. (On Windows 200x/XP, right-click in +the background of <span class="guilabel">Printers</span> folder, select <span class="guimenuitem">Server Properties...</span>, select +tab <span class="guilabel">Drivers</span> and delete here).</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2947200"></a>Can't Use “<span class="quote">cupsaddsmb</span>” on Samba Server Which Is a PDC</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>Do you use the “<span class="quote">naked</span>” root user name? Try to do it +this way: <b class="userinput"><tt>cupsaddsmb -U <i class="replaceable"><tt>DOMAINNAME</tt></i>\\root -v +<i class="replaceable"><tt>printername</tt></i></tt></b>> (note the two backslashes: the first one is +required to “<span class="quote">escape</span>” the second one).</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2947239"></a>Deleted Windows 200x Printer Driver Is Still Shown</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>Deleting a printer on the client will not delete the +driver too (to verify, right-click on the white background of the +<span class="guilabel">Printers</span> folder, select <span class="guimenuitem">Server Properties</span> and click on the +<span class="guilabel">Drivers</span> tab). These same old drivers will be re-used when you try to +install a printer with the same name. If you want to update to a new +driver, delete the old ones first. Deletion is only possible if no +other printer uses the same driver.</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2947278"></a>Windows 200x/XP "Local Security Policies"</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>Local Security Policies may not +allow the installation of unsigned drivers. “<span class="quote">Local Security Policies</span>” +may not allow the installation of printer drivers at +all.</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2947293"></a>Administrator Cannot Install Printers for All Local Users</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>Windows XP handles SMB printers on a “<span class="quote">per-user</span>” basis. +This means every user needs to install the printer himself. To have a +printer available for everybody, you might want to use the built-in +IPP client capabilities of WinXP. Add a printer with the print path of +<i class="parameter"><tt>http://cupsserver:631/printers/printername</tt></i>. +We're still looking into this one. Maybe a logon script could +automatically install printers for all +users.</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2947323"></a>Print Change Notify Functions on NT-clients</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>For print change, notify functions on NT++ clients. +These need to run the <b class="command">Server</b> service first (renamed to +<b class="command">File & Print Sharing for MS Networks</b> in +XP).</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2947350"></a>WinXP-SP1</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>WinXP-SP1 introduced a Point and Print Restriction Policy (this restriction does not apply to +“<span class="quote">Administrator</span>” or “<span class="quote">Power User</span>” groups of users). In Group Policy +Object Editor, go to <span class="guimenu">User Configuration -> Administrative Templates -> + Control Panel -> Printers</span>. The policy is automatically set to +<tt class="constant">Enabled</tt> and the <tt class="constant">Users can only Point +and Print to machines in their Forest</tt> . You probably need +to change it to <tt class="constant">Disabled</tt> or <tt class="constant">Users can +only Point and Print to these servers</tt> to make +driver downloads from Samba possible. +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2947402"></a>Print Options for All Users Can't Be Set on Windows 200x/XP</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>How are you doing it? I bet the wrong way (it is not +easy to find out, though). There are three different ways to bring +you to a dialog that <span class="emphasis"><em>seems</em></span> to set everything. All +three dialogs <span class="emphasis"><em>look</em></span> the same, yet only one of them +does what you intend. You need to be +Administrator or Print Administrator to do this for all users. Here +is how I do in on XP: +</p><div class="orderedlist"><ol type="A"><li><p>The first wrong way: + +</p><div class="orderedlist"><ol type="I"><li><p>Open the <span class="guilabel">Printers</span> +folder.</p></li><li><p>Right-click on the printer +(<span class="guilabel">remoteprinter on cupshost</span>) and +select in context menu <span class="guimenuitem">Printing +Preferences...</span></p></li><li><p>Look at this dialog closely and remember what it looks +like.</p></li></ol></div><p> +</p></li><li><p>The second wrong way: + +</p><div class="orderedlist"><ol type="I"><li><p>Open the <span class="guilabel">Printers</span> +folder.</p></li><li><p>Right-click on the printer (<span class="guilabel">remoteprinter on +cupshost</span>) and select the context menu +<span class="guimenuitem">Properties</span>.</p></li><li><p>Click on the <span class="guilabel">General</span> +tab.</p></li><li><p>Click on the button <span class="guibutton">Printing +Preferences...</span></p></li><li><p>A new dialog opens. Keep this dialog open and go back +to the parent dialog.</p></li></ol></div><p> +</p></li><li><p>The third, and the correct way: + +</p><div class="orderedlist"><ol type="I"><li><p>Open the <span class="guilabel">Printers</span> +folder.</p></li><li><p>Click on the <span class="guilabel">Advanced</span> +tab. (If everything is “<span class="quote">grayed out,</span>” then you are not logged +in as a user with enough privileges).</p></li><li><p>Click on the <span class="guibutton">Printing +Defaults...</span> button.</p></li><li><p>On any of the two new tabs, click on the +<span class="guibutton">Advanced...</span> +button.</p></li><li><p>A new dialog opens. Compare this one to the other +identical looking one from “<span class="quote">B.5</span>” or A.3".</p></li></ol></div><p> +</p></li></ol></div><p> +Do you see any difference? I don't either. However, only the last +one, which you arrived at with steps “<span class="quote">C.1.-6.</span>”, will save any settings +permanently and be the defaults for new users. If you want all clients +to get the same defaults, you need to conduct these steps <span class="emphasis"><em>as +Administrator</em></span> (<a class="indexterm" name="id2947677"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>printer admin</tt></i> in +<tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt>) <span class="emphasis"><em>before</em></span> a client +downloads the driver (the clients can later set their own +<span class="emphasis"><em>per-user defaults</em></span> by following the +procedures <span class="emphasis"><em>A</em></span> or <span class="emphasis"><em>B</em></span> +above).</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2947717"></a>Most Common Blunders in Driver Settings on Windows Clients</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>Don't use <i class="parameter"><tt>Optimize for +Speed</tt></i>, but use <i class="parameter"><tt>Optimize for +Portability</tt></i> instead (Adobe PS Driver). Don't use +<i class="parameter"><tt>Page Independence: No</tt></i>: always +settle with <i class="parameter"><tt>Page Independence: +Yes</tt></i> (Microsoft PS Driver and CUPS PS Driver for +Windows NT/200x/XP). If there are problems with fonts, use +<i class="parameter"><tt>Download as Softfont into +printer</tt></i> (Adobe PS Driver). For +<span class="guilabel">TrueType Download Options</span> +choose <tt class="constant">Outline</tt>. Use PostScript +Level 2, if you are having trouble with a non-PS printer and if +there is a choice.</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2947779"></a><b class="command">cupsaddsmb</b> Does Not Work with Newly Installed Printer</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>Symptom: The last command of +<b class="command">cupsaddsmb</b> does not complete successfully: +<b class="command">cmd = setdriver printername printername</b> result was +NT_STATUS_UNSUCCESSFUL then possibly the printer was not yet +recognized by Samba. Did it show up in Network +Neighborhood? Did it show up i n <b class="command">rpcclient +hostname -c `enumprinters'</b>? Restart smbd (or send a +<b class="command">kill -HUP</b> to all processes listed by +<b class="command">smbstatus</b> and try +again.</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2947835"></a>Permissions on <tt class="filename">/var/spool/samba/</tt> Get Reset After Each Reboot</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>Have you ever by accident set the CUPS spool directory to +the same location? (<i class="parameter"><tt>RequestRoot /var/spool/samba/</tt></i> in <tt class="filename">cupsd.conf</tt> or +the other way round: <tt class="filename">/var/spool/cups/</tt> is set as +<a class="indexterm" name="id2947875"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>path</tt></i>> in the <i class="parameter"><tt>[printers]</tt></i> +section). These <i class="parameter"><tt>must</tt></i> be different. Set + +<i class="parameter"><tt>RequestRoot /var/spool/cups/</tt></i> in +<tt class="filename">cupsd.conf</tt> and <a class="indexterm" name="id2947919"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>path</tt></i> = +/var/spool/samba in the <i class="parameter"><tt>[printers]</tt></i> +section of <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt>. Otherwise cupsd will +sanitize permissions to its spool directory with each restart and +printing will not work reliably.</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2947951"></a>Print Queue Called “<span class="quote">lp</span>” Mis-handles Print Jobs</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +In this case a print queue called “<span class="quote">lp</span>” intermittently swallows jobs and +spits out completely different ones from what was sent. +</p><p>It is a bad idea to name any printer “<span class="quote">lp</span>”. This +is the traditional UNIX name for the default printer. CUPS may be set +up to do an automatic creation of Implicit Classes. This means, to +group all printers with the same name to a pool of devices, and +load-balancing the jobs across them in a round-robin fashion. Chances +are high that someone else has a printer named “<span class="quote">lp</span>” too. You may +receive his jobs and send your own to his device unwittingly. To have +tight control over the printer names, set <i class="parameter"><tt>BrowseShortNames +No</tt></i>. It will present any printer as <i class="replaceable"><tt>printername@cupshost</tt></i> +and then gives you better control over what may happen in a large +networked environment.</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2948008"></a>Location of Adobe PostScript Driver Files for “<span class="quote">cupsaddsmb</span>”</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>Use <b class="command">smbclient</b> to connect to any +Windows box with a shared PostScript printer: <b class="command">smbclient +//windowsbox/print\$ -U guest</b>. You can navigate to the +<tt class="filename">W32X86/2</tt> subdir to <b class="command">mget ADOBE*</b> +and other files or to <tt class="filename">WIN40/0</tt> to do the same. +Another option is to download the <tt class="filename">*.exe</tt> packaged +files from the Adobe Web site.</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2948065"></a>Overview of the CUPS Printing Processes</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p>A complete overview of the CUPS printing processes can be found in <link linkend="a_small">.</p><div class="figure"><a name="a_small"></a><p class="title"><b>Figure 19.19. CUPS printing overview.</b></p><div class="mediaobject"><img src="projdoc/imagefiles/a_small.png" width="270" alt="CUPS printing overview."></div></div></div><div class="footnotes"><br><hr width="100" align="left"><div class="footnote"><ulink url="http://www.cups.org/cups-help.html"><sup>[<a name="ftn.id2936587" href="#id2936587">4</a>] </sup>http://www.cups.org/cups-help.html</ulink></div></div></div><div class="navfooter"><hr><table width="100%" summary="Navigation footer"><tr><td width="40%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="printing.html">Prev</a> </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="u" href="optional.html">Up</a></td><td width="40%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="VFS.html">Next</a></td></tr><tr><td width="40%" align="left" valign="top">Chapter 18. Classical Printing Support </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="h" href="index.html">Home</a></td><td width="40%" align="right" valign="top"> Chapter 20. Stackable VFS modules</td></tr></table></div></body></html> diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/ClientConfig.html b/docs/htmldocs/ClientConfig.html new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..ce1f591cdd --- /dev/null +++ b/docs/htmldocs/ClientConfig.html @@ -0,0 +1,4 @@ +<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>Chapter 9. MS Windows Network Configuration Guide</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.60.1"><link rel="home" href="index.html" title="SAMBA Project Documentation"><link rel="up" href="type.html" title="Part II. Server Configuration Basics"><link rel="previous" href="StandAloneServer.html" title="Chapter 8. Stand-alone Servers"><link rel="next" href="optional.html" title="Part III. Advanced Configuration"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="navheader"><table width="100%" summary="Navigation header"><tr><th colspan="3" align="center">Chapter 9. MS Windows Network Configuration Guide</th></tr><tr><td width="20%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="StandAloneServer.html">Prev</a> </td><th width="60%" align="center">Part II. Server Configuration Basics</th><td width="20%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="optional.html">Next</a></td></tr></table><hr></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="ClientConfig"></a>Chapter 9. MS Windows Network Configuration Guide</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">John</span> <span class="othername">H.</span> <span class="surname">Terpstra</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org">jht@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="ClientConfig.html#id2897131">Note</a></dt></dl></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2897131"></a>Note</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +This chapter did not make it into this release. +It is planned for the published release of this document. +</p></div></div><div class="navfooter"><hr><table width="100%" summary="Navigation footer"><tr><td width="40%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="StandAloneServer.html">Prev</a> </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="u" href="type.html">Up</a></td><td width="40%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="optional.html">Next</a></td></tr><tr><td width="40%" align="left" valign="top">Chapter 8. Stand-alone Servers </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="h" href="index.html">Home</a></td><td width="40%" align="right" valign="top"> Part III. Advanced Configuration</td></tr></table></div></body></html> diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/DNSDHCP.html b/docs/htmldocs/DNSDHCP.html new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..fa61a0f7f2 --- /dev/null +++ b/docs/htmldocs/DNSDHCP.html @@ -0,0 +1,4 @@ +<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>Chapter 40. DNS and DHCP Configuration Guide</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.60.1"><link rel="home" href="index.html" title="SAMBA Project Documentation"><link rel="up" href="Appendixes.html" title="Part VI. Appendixes"><link rel="previous" href="speed.html" title="Chapter 39. Samba Performance Tuning"><link rel="next" href="Further-Resources.html" title="Chapter 41. Further Resources"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="navheader"><table width="100%" summary="Navigation header"><tr><th colspan="3" align="center">Chapter 40. DNS and DHCP Configuration Guide</th></tr><tr><td width="20%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="speed.html">Prev</a> </td><th width="60%" align="center">Part VI. Appendixes</th><td width="20%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="Further-Resources.html">Next</a></td></tr></table><hr></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="DNSDHCP"></a>Chapter 40. DNS and DHCP Configuration Guide</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">John</span> <span class="othername">H.</span> <span class="surname">Terpstra</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org">jht@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="DNSDHCP.html#id2976885">Note</a></dt></dl></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2976885"></a>Note</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +This chapter did not make it into this release. +It is planned for the published release of this document. +</p></div></div><div class="navfooter"><hr><table width="100%" summary="Navigation footer"><tr><td width="40%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="speed.html">Prev</a> </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="u" href="Appendixes.html">Up</a></td><td width="40%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="Further-Resources.html">Next</a></td></tr><tr><td width="40%" align="left" valign="top">Chapter 39. Samba Performance Tuning </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="h" href="index.html">Home</a></td><td width="40%" align="right" valign="top"> Chapter 41. Further Resources</td></tr></table></div></body></html> diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/FastStart.html b/docs/htmldocs/FastStart.html new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..fb1f5bcc79 --- /dev/null +++ b/docs/htmldocs/FastStart.html @@ -0,0 +1,4 @@ +<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>Chapter 3. Fast Start for the Impatient</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.60.1"><link rel="home" href="index.html" title="SAMBA Project Documentation"><link rel="up" href="introduction.html" title="Part I. General Installation"><link rel="previous" href="install.html" title="Chapter 2. How to Install and Test SAMBA"><link rel="next" href="type.html" title="Part II. Server Configuration Basics"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="navheader"><table width="100%" summary="Navigation header"><tr><th colspan="3" align="center">Chapter 3. Fast Start for the Impatient</th></tr><tr><td width="20%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="install.html">Prev</a> </td><th width="60%" align="center">Part I. General Installation</th><td width="20%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="type.html">Next</a></td></tr></table><hr></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="FastStart"></a>Chapter 3. Fast Start for the Impatient</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">John</span> <span class="othername">H.</span> <span class="surname">Terpstra</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org">jht@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="FastStart.html#id2885815">Note</a></dt></dl></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2885815"></a>Note</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +This chapter did not make it into this release. +It is planned for the published release of this document. +</p></div></div><div class="navfooter"><hr><table width="100%" summary="Navigation footer"><tr><td width="40%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="install.html">Prev</a> </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="u" href="introduction.html">Up</a></td><td width="40%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="type.html">Next</a></td></tr><tr><td width="40%" align="left" valign="top">Chapter 2. How to Install and Test SAMBA </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="h" href="index.html">Home</a></td><td width="40%" align="right" valign="top"> Part II. Server Configuration Basics</td></tr></table></div></body></html> diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/Further-Resources.html b/docs/htmldocs/Further-Resources.html new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..39c13a5ad5 --- /dev/null +++ b/docs/htmldocs/Further-Resources.html @@ -0,0 +1,100 @@ +<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>Chapter 41. Further Resources</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.60.1"><link rel="home" href="index.html" title="SAMBA Project Documentation"><link rel="up" href="Appendixes.html" title="Part VI. Appendixes"><link rel="previous" href="DNSDHCP.html" title="Chapter 40. DNS and DHCP Configuration Guide"><link rel="next" href="ix01.html" title="Index"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="navheader"><table width="100%" summary="Navigation header"><tr><th colspan="3" align="center">Chapter 41. Further Resources</th></tr><tr><td width="20%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="DNSDHCP.html">Prev</a> </td><th width="60%" align="center">Part VI. Appendixes</th><td width="20%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="ix01.html">Next</a></td></tr></table><hr></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="Further-Resources"></a>Chapter 41. Further Resources</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Jelmer</span> <span class="othername">R.</span> <span class="surname">Vernooij</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">The Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jelmer@samba.org">jelmer@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><p class="pubdate">May 1, 2003</p></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="Further-Resources.html#id2976952">Websites</a></dt><dt><a href="Further-Resources.html#id2977349">Related updates from Microsoft</a></dt></dl></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2976952"></a>Websites</h2></div></div><div></div></div><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p> + <ulink url="http://hr.uoregon.edu/davidrl/cifs.txt"> + CIFS: Common Insecurities Fail Scrutiny by Hobbit</ulink> + </p></li><li><p> + <ulink url="http://afr.com/it/2002/10/01/FFXDF43AP6D.html"> + Doing the Samba on Windows by Financial Review + </ulink> + </p></li><li><p> + <ulink url="http://ubiqx.org/cifs/"> + Implementing CIFS by Christopher R. Hertel + </ulink> + </p></li><li><p> + <ulink url="http://samba.anu.edu.au/cifs/docs/what-is-smb.html"> + Just What Is SMB? by Richard Sharpe + </ulink> + </p></li><li><p> + <ulink url="http://www.linux-mag.com/1999-05/samba_01.html"> + Opening Windows Everywhere by Mike Warfield + </ulink> + </p></li><li><p> + <ulink url="http://www.tldp.org/HOWTO/SMB-HOWTO.html"> + SMB HOWTO by David Wood + </ulink> + </p></li><li><p> + <ulink url="http://www.phrack.org/phrack/60/p60-0x0b.txt"> + SMB/CIFS by The Root by ledin + </ulink> + </p></li><li><p> + <ulink url="http://www.linux-mag.com/1999-09/samba_01.html"> + The Story of Samba by Christopher R. Hertel + </ulink> + </p></li><li><p> + <ulink url="http://hr.uoregon.edu/davidrl/samba/"> + The Unofficial Samba HOWTO by David Lechnyr + </ulink> + </p></li><li><p> + <ulink url="http://www.linux-mag.com/2001-05/smb_01.html"> + Understanding the Network Neighborhood by Christopher R. Hertel + </ulink> + </p></li><li><p> + <ulink url="http://www.linux-mag.com/2002-02/samba_01.html"> + Using Samba as a PDC by Andrew Bartlett + </ulink> + </p></li><li><p> + <ulink url="http://ru.samba.org/samba/ftp/docs/Samba24Hc13.pdf"> + PDF version of the Troubleshooting Techniques chapter + from the second edition of Sam's Teach Yourself Samba in 24 Hours + (publishing date of Dec. 12, 2001)</ulink> + </p></li><li><p> + <ulink url="http://ru.samba.org/samba/ftp/slides/"> + Slide presentations by Samba Team members + </ulink> + </p></li><li><p> + <ulink url="http://www.atmarkit.co.jp/flinux/special/samba3/samba3a.html"> + Introduction to Samba-3.0 by Motonobu Takahashi + (written in Japanese). </ulink> + </p></li><li><p> + <ulink url="http://www.linux-mag.com/2001-05/smb_01.html"> + Understanding the Network Neighborhood, by team member + Chris Hertel. This article appeared in the May 2001 issue of + Linux Magazine. + </ulink> + </p></li><li><p> + <ulink url="ftp://ftp.stratus.com/pub/vos/customers/samba/"> + Samba 2.0.x Troubleshooting guide from Paul Green + </ulink> + </p></li><li><p> + <ulink url="http://samba.org/samba/docs/10years.html"> + Ten Years of Samba + </ulink> + </p></li><li><p> + <ulink url="http://tldp.org/HOWTO/Samba-Authenticated-Gateway-HOWTO.html"> + Samba Authenticated Gateway HOWTO + </ulink> + </p></li><li><p> + <ulink url="http://samba.org/samba/docs/SambaIntro.html"> + An Introduction to Samba + </ulink> + </p></li><li><p> + <ulink url="http://www.samba.org/cifs/"> + What is CIFS? + </ulink> + </p></li><li><p> + <ulink url="http://support.microsoft.com/support/kb/articles/q92/5/88.asp"> + WFWG: Password Caching and How It Affects LAN Manager + Security at Microsoft Knowledge Base + </ulink> + </p></li></ul></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2977349"></a>Related updates from Microsoft</h2></div></div><div></div></div><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p> + <ulink url="http://support.microsoft.com/support/kb/articles/q92/5/88.asp"> + Enhanced Encryption for Windows 95 Password Cache + </ulink> + </p></li><li><p> + <ulink url="http://support.microsoft.com/support/kb/articles/q136/4/18.asp"> + Windows '95 File Sharing Updates + </ulink> + </p></li><li><p> + <ulink url="http://support.microsoft.com/support/kb/articles/q136/4/18.asp"> + Windows for Workgroups Sharing Updates + </ulink> + </p></li></ul></div></div></div><div class="navfooter"><hr><table width="100%" summary="Navigation footer"><tr><td width="40%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="DNSDHCP.html">Prev</a> </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="u" href="Appendixes.html">Up</a></td><td width="40%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="ix01.html">Next</a></td></tr><tr><td width="40%" align="left" valign="top">Chapter 40. DNS and DHCP Configuration Guide </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="h" href="index.html">Home</a></td><td width="40%" align="right" valign="top"> Index</td></tr></table></div></body></html> diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/InterdomainTrusts.html b/docs/htmldocs/InterdomainTrusts.html new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..358321dac2 --- /dev/null +++ b/docs/htmldocs/InterdomainTrusts.html @@ -0,0 +1,222 @@ +<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>Chapter 16. Interdomain Trust Relationships</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.60.1"><link rel="home" href="index.html" title="SAMBA Project Documentation"><link rel="up" href="optional.html" title="Part III. Advanced Configuration"><link rel="previous" href="securing-samba.html" title="Chapter 15. Securing Samba"><link rel="next" href="msdfs.html" title="Chapter 17. Hosting a Microsoft Distributed File System tree on Samba"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="navheader"><table width="100%" summary="Navigation header"><tr><th colspan="3" align="center">Chapter 16. Interdomain Trust Relationships</th></tr><tr><td width="20%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="securing-samba.html">Prev</a> </td><th width="60%" align="center">Part III. Advanced Configuration</th><td width="20%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="msdfs.html">Next</a></td></tr></table><hr></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="InterdomainTrusts"></a>Chapter 16. Interdomain Trust Relationships</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">John</span> <span class="othername">H.</span> <span class="surname">Terpstra</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org">jht@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Rafal</span> <span class="surname">Szczesniak</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:mimir@samba.org">mimir@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Jelmer</span> <span class="othername">R.</span> <span class="surname">Vernooij</span></h3><span class="contrib">drawing</span><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">The Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jelmer@samba.org">jelmer@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Stephen</span> <span class="surname">Langasek</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:vorlon@netexpress.net">vorlon@netexpress.net</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><p class="pubdate">April 3, 2003</p></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="InterdomainTrusts.html#id2919130">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="InterdomainTrusts.html#id2919159">Trust Relationship Background</a></dt><dt><a href="InterdomainTrusts.html#id2919243">Native MS Windows NT4 Trusts Configuration</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="InterdomainTrusts.html#id2919270">Creating an NT4 Domain Trust</a></dt><dt><a href="InterdomainTrusts.html#id2919342">Completing an NT4 Domain Trust</a></dt><dt><a href="InterdomainTrusts.html#id2919402">Inter-Domain Trust Facilities</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="InterdomainTrusts.html#id2919600">Configuring Samba NT-Style Domain Trusts</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="InterdomainTrusts.html#samba-trusted-domain">Samba as the Trusted Domain</a></dt><dt><a href="InterdomainTrusts.html#id2919809">Samba as the Trusting Domain</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="InterdomainTrusts.html#id2919952">NT4-Style Domain Trusts with Windows 2000</a></dt><dt><a href="InterdomainTrusts.html#id2920058">Common Errors</a></dt></dl></div><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2919104"></a> +Samba-3 supports NT4-style domain trust relationships. This is a feature that many sites +will want to use if they migrate to Samba-3 from an NT4-style domain and do not want to +adopt Active Directory or an LDAP-based authentication backend. This section explains +some background information regarding trust relationships and how to create them. It is now +possible for Samba-3 to trust NT4 (and vice versa), as well as to create Samba-to-Samba +trusts. +</p><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2919130"></a>Features and Benefits</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +Samba-3 can participate in Samba-to-Samba as well as in Samba-to-MS Windows NT4-style +trust relationships. This imparts to Samba similar scalability as with MS Windows NT4. +</p><p> +Given that Samba-3 has the capability to function with a scalable backend authentication +database such as LDAP, and given its ability to run in Primary as well as Backup Domain Control +modes, the administrator would be well advised to consider alternatives to the use of +Interdomain trusts simply because by the very nature of how this works it is fragile. +That was, after all, a key reason for the development and adoption of Microsoft Active Directory. +</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2919159"></a>Trust Relationship Background</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +MS Windows NT3/4 type security domains employ a non-hierarchical security structure. +The limitations of this architecture as it effects the scalability of MS Windows networking +in large organizations is well known. Additionally, the flat namespace that results from +this design significantly impacts the delegation of administrative responsibilities in +large and diverse organizations. +</p><p> +Microsoft developed Active Directory Service (ADS), based on Kerberos and LDAP, as a means +of circumventing the limitations of the older technologies. Not every organization is ready +or willing to embrace ADS. For small companies the older NT4-style domain security paradigm +is quite adequate, there remains an entrenched user base for whom there is no direct +desire to go through a disruptive change to adopt ADS. +</p><p> +With MS Windows NT, Microsoft introduced the ability to allow differing security domains +to effect a mechanism so users from one domain may be given access rights and privileges +in another domain. The language that describes this capability is couched in terms of +<span class="emphasis"><em>Trusts</em></span>. Specifically, one domain will <span class="emphasis"><em>trust</em></span> the users +from another domain. The domain from which users are available to another security domain is +said to be a trusted domain. The domain in which those users have assigned rights and privileges +is the trusting domain. With NT3.x/4.0 all trust relationships are always in one direction only, +thus if users in both domains are to have privileges and rights in each others' domain, then it is +necessary to establish two relationships, one in each direction. +</p><p> +In an NT4-style MS security domain, all trusts are non-transitive. This means that if there +are three domains (let's call them RED, WHITE and BLUE) where RED and WHITE have a trust +relationship, and WHITE and BLUE have a trust relationship, then it holds that there is no +implied trust between the RED and BLUE domains. Relationships are explicit and not +transitive. +</p><p> +New to MS Windows 2000 ADS security contexts is the fact that trust relationships are two-way +by default. Also, all inter-ADS domain trusts are transitive. In the case of the RED, WHITE and BLUE +domains above, with Windows 2000 and ADS the RED and BLUE domains can trust each other. This is +an inherent feature of ADS domains. Samba-3 implements MS Windows NT4-style Interdomain trusts +and interoperates with MS Windows 200x ADS security domains in similar manner to MS Windows NT4-style domains. +</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2919243"></a>Native MS Windows NT4 Trusts Configuration</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +There are two steps to creating an interdomain trust relationship. To effect a two-way trust +relationship, it is necessary for each domain administrator to create a trust account for the +other domain to use in verifying security credentials. +<a class="indexterm" name="id2919259"></a> +</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2919270"></a>Creating an NT4 Domain Trust</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +For MS Windows NT4, all domain trust relationships are configured using the +<span class="application">Domain User Manager</span>. This is done from the Domain User Manager Policies +entry on the menu bar. From the <span class="guimenu">Policy</span> menu, select +<span class="guimenuitem">Trust Relationships</span>. Next to the lower box labeled +<span class="guilabel">Permitted to Trust this Domain</span> are two buttons, <span class="guibutton">Add</span> +and <span class="guibutton">Remove</span>. The <span class="guibutton">Add</span> button will open a panel in which +to enter the name of the remote domain that will be able to assign access rights to users in +your domain. You will also need to enter a password for this trust relationship, which the +trusting domain will use when authenticating users from the trusted domain. +The password needs to be typed twice (for standard confirmation). +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2919342"></a>Completing an NT4 Domain Trust</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2919354"></a> +A trust relationship will work only when the other (trusting) domain makes the appropriate connections +with the trusted domain. To consummate the trust relationship, the administrator will launch the +Domain User Manager from the menu select <span class="guilabel">Policies</span>, then select +<span class="guilabel">Trust Relationships</span>, click on the <span class="guibutton">Add</span> button +next to the box that is labeled <span class="guilabel">Trusted Domains</span>. A panel will open in which +must be entered the name of the remote domain as well as the password assigned to that trust. +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2919402"></a>Inter-Domain Trust Facilities</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2919413"></a> +A two-way trust relationship is created when two one-way trusts are created, one in each direction. +Where a one-way trust has been established between two MS Windows NT4 domains (let's call them +DomA and DomB), the following facilities are created: +</p><div class="figure"><a name="trusts1"></a><p class="title"><b>Figure 16.1. Trusts overview.</b></p><div class="mediaobject"><img src="projdoc/imagefiles/trusts1.png" width="270" alt="Trusts overview."></div></div><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p> + DomA (completes the trust connection) <i class="parameter"><tt>Trusts</tt></i> DomB. + </p></li><li><p> + DomA is the <i class="parameter"><tt>Trusting</tt></i> domain. + </p></li><li><p> + DomB is the <i class="parameter"><tt>Trusted</tt></i> domain (originates the trust account). + </p></li><li><p> + Users in DomB can access resources in DomA. + </p></li><li><p> + Users in DomA cannot access resources in DomB. + </p></li><li><p> + Global groups from DomB can be used in DomA. + </p></li><li><p> + Global groups from DomA cannot be used in DomB. + </p></li><li><p> + DomB does appear in the logon dialog box on client workstations in DomA. + </p></li><li><p> + DomA does not appear in the logon dialog box on client workstations in DomB. + </p></li></ul></div><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p> + Users/Groups in a trusting domain cannot be granted rights, permissions or access + to a trusted domain. + </p></li><li><p> + The trusting domain can access and use accounts (Users/Global Groups) in the + trusted domain. + </p></li><li><p> + Administrators of the trusted domain can be granted admininstrative rights in the + trusting domain. + </p></li><li><p> + Users in a trusted domain can be given rights and privileges in the trusting + domain. + </p></li><li><p> + Trusted domain Global Groups can be given rights and permissions in the trusting + domain. + </p></li><li><p> + Global Groups from the trusted domain can be made members in Local Groups on + MS Windows Domain Member machines. + </p></li></ul></div></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2919600"></a>Configuring Samba NT-Style Domain Trusts</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +This description is meant to be a fairly short introduction about how to set up a Samba server so +that it can participate in interdomain trust relationships. Trust relationship support in Samba +is at an early stage, so do not be surprised if something does not function as it should. +</p><p> +Each of the procedures described below assumes the peer domain in the trust relationship is +controlled by a Windows NT4 server. However, the remote end could just as well be another +Samba-3 domain. It can be clearly seen, after reading this document, that combining +Samba-specific parts of what's written below leads to trust between domains in a purely Samba +environment. +</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="samba-trusted-domain"></a>Samba as the Trusted Domain</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +In order to set the Samba PDC to be the trusted party of the relationship, you first need +to create a special account for the domain that will be the trusting party. To do that, +you can use the <b class="command">smbpasswd</b> utility. Creating the trusted domain account is +similar to creating a trusted machine account. Suppose, your domain is +called SAMBA, and the remote domain is called RUMBA. The first step +will be to issue this command from your favorite shell: +</p><p> +</p><pre class="screen"> +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt> <b class="userinput"><tt>smbpasswd -a -i rumba</tt></b> +New SMB password: <b class="userinput"><tt>XXXXXXXX</tt></b> +Retype SMB password: <b class="userinput"><tt>XXXXXXXX</tt></b> +Added user rumba$ +</pre><p> + +where <tt class="option">-a</tt> means to add a new account into the +passdb database and <tt class="option">-i</tt> means: “<span class="quote">create this +account with the InterDomain trust flag</span>”. +</p><p> +The account name will be “<span class="quote">rumba$</span>” (the name of the remote domain). +</p><p> +After issuing this command, you will be asked to enter the password for +the account. You can use any password you want, but be aware that Windows NT will +not change this password until seven days following account creation. +After the command returns successfully, you can look at the entry for the new account +(in the standard way as appropriate for your configuration) and see that account's name is +really RUMBA$ and it has the “<span class="quote">I</span>” flag set in the flags field. Now you are ready to confirm +the trust by establishing it from Windows NT Server. +</p><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2919744"></a> +Open <span class="application">User Manager for Domains</span> and from the +<span class="guimenu">Policies</span> menu, select <span class="guimenuitem">Trust Relationships...</span>. +Beside the <span class="guilabel">Trusted domains</span> list box click the +<span class="guimenu">Add...</span> button. You will be prompted for +the trusted domain name and the relationship password. Type in SAMBA, as this is +the name of the remote domain and the password used at the time of account creation. +Click on <span class="guibutton">OK</span> and, if everything went without incident, you will see +the <tt class="computeroutput">Trusted domain relationship successfully +established</tt> message. +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2919809"></a>Samba as the Trusting Domain</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +This time activities are somewhat reversed. Again, we'll assume that your domain +controlled by the Samba PDC is called SAMBA and the NT-controlled domain is called RUMBA. +</p><p> +The very first step is to add an account for the SAMBA domain on RUMBA's PDC. +</p><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2919833"></a> +Launch the <span class="application">Domain User Manager</span>, then from the menu select +<span class="guimenu">Policies</span>, <span class="guimenuitem">Trust Relationships</span>. +Now, next to the <span class="guilabel">Trusted Domains</span> box press the <span class="guibutton">Add</span> +button and type in the name of the trusted domain (SAMBA) and the password to use in securing +the relationship. +</p><p> +The password can be arbitrarily chosen. It is easy to change the password +from the Samba server whenever you want. After confirming the password your account is +ready for use. Now its Samba's turn. +</p><p> +Using your favorite shell while being logged in as root, issue this command: +</p><p> +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>net rpc trustdom establish rumba</tt></b> +</p><p> +You will be prompted for the password you just typed on your Windows NT4 Server box. +An error message <span class="errorname">`NT_STATUS_NOLOGON_INTERDOMAIN_TRUST_ACCOUNT'</span> +that may be reported periodically is of no concern and may safely be ignored. +It means the password you gave is correct and the NT4 Server says the account is ready for +interdomain connection and not for ordinary connection. After that, be patient; +it can take a while (especially in large networks), but eventually you should see +the <tt class="computeroutput">Success</tt> message. Congratulations! Your trust +relationship has just been established. +</p><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p> +You have to run this command as root because you must have write access to +the <tt class="filename">secrets.tdb</tt> file. +</p></div></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2919952"></a>NT4-Style Domain Trusts with Windows 2000</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +Although <span class="application">Domain User Manager</span> is not present in Windows 2000, it is +also possible to establish an NT4-style trust relationship with a Windows 2000 domain +controller running in mixed mode as the trusting server. It should also be possible for +Samba to trust a Windows 2000 server, however, more testing is still needed in this area. +</p><p> +After <link linkend="samba-trusted-domain"> as described above, open <span class="application">Active Directory Domains and +Trusts</span> on the AD controller of the domain whose resources you wish Samba users +to have access to. Remember that since NT4-style trusts are not transitive, if you want +your users to have access to multiple mixed-mode domains in your AD forest, you will need to +repeat this process for each of those domains. With <span class="application">Active Directory Domains +and Trusts</span> open, right-click on the name of the Active Directory domain that +will trust our Samba domain and choose <span class="guimenuitem">Properties</span>, then click on +the <span class="guilabel">Trusts</span> tab. In the upper part of the panel, you will see a list box +labeled <span class="guilabel">Domains trusted by this domain:</span>, and an +<span class="guilabel">Add...</span> button next to it. Press this button and just as with NT4, you +will be prompted for the trusted domain name and the relationship password. Press OK and +after a moment, Active Directory will respond with <tt class="computeroutput">The trusted domain has +been added and the trust has been verified.</tt> Your Samba users can now be +granted acess to resources in the AD domain. +</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2920058"></a>Common Errors</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +Interdomain trust relationships should not be attempted on networks that are unstable +or that suffer regular outages. Network stability and integrity are key concerns with +distributed trusted domains. +</p></div></div><div class="navfooter"><hr><table width="100%" summary="Navigation footer"><tr><td width="40%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="securing-samba.html">Prev</a> </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="u" href="optional.html">Up</a></td><td width="40%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="msdfs.html">Next</a></td></tr><tr><td width="40%" align="left" valign="top">Chapter 15. Securing Samba </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="h" href="index.html">Home</a></td><td width="40%" align="right" valign="top"> Chapter 17. Hosting a Microsoft Distributed File System tree on Samba</td></tr></table></div></body></html> diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/IntroSMB.html b/docs/htmldocs/IntroSMB.html new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..5e3796fdeb --- /dev/null +++ b/docs/htmldocs/IntroSMB.html @@ -0,0 +1,174 @@ +<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>Chapter 1. Introduction to Samba</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.60.1"><link rel="home" href="index.html" title="SAMBA Project Documentation"><link rel="up" href="introduction.html" title="Part I. General Installation"><link rel="previous" href="introduction.html" title="Part I. General Installation"><link rel="next" href="install.html" title="Chapter 2. How to Install and Test SAMBA"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="navheader"><table width="100%" summary="Navigation header"><tr><th colspan="3" align="center">Chapter 1. Introduction to Samba</th></tr><tr><td width="20%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="introduction.html">Prev</a> </td><th width="60%" align="center">Part I. General Installation</th><td width="20%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="install.html">Next</a></td></tr></table><hr></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="IntroSMB"></a>Chapter 1. Introduction to Samba</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">David</span> <span class="surname">Lechnyr</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Unofficial HOWTO<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:david@lechnyr.com">david@lechnyr.com</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><p class="pubdate">April 14, 2003</p></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="IntroSMB.html#id2875896">Background</a></dt><dt><a href="IntroSMB.html#id2875954">Terminology</a></dt><dt><a href="IntroSMB.html#id2876091">Related Projects</a></dt><dt><a href="IntroSMB.html#id2876169">SMB Methodology</a></dt><dt><a href="IntroSMB.html#id2876258">Epilogue</a></dt><dt><a href="IntroSMB.html#id2876344">Miscellaneous</a></dt></dl></div><p>“<span class="quote"> +"If you understand what you're doing, you're not learning anything." +-- Anonymous +</span>”</p><p> +Samba is a file and print server for Windows-based clients using TCP/IP as the underlying +transport protocol. In fact, it can support any SMB/CIFS-enabled client. One of Samba's big +strengths is that you can use it to blend your mix of Windows and Linux machines together +without requiring a separate Windows NT/2000/2003 Server. Samba is actively being developed +by a global team of about 30 active programmers and was originally developed by Andrew Tridgell. +</p><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2875896"></a>Background</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +Once long ago, there was a buzzword referred to as DCE/RPC. This stood for Distributed +Computing Environment/Remote Procedure Calls and conceptually was a good idea. It was +originally developed by Apollo/HP as NCA 1.0 (Network Computing Architecture) and only +ran over UDP. When there was a need to run it over TCP so that it would be compatible +with DECnet 3.0, it was redesigned, submitted to The Open Group, and officially became +known as DCE/RPC. Microsoft came along and decided, rather than pay $20 per seat to +license this technology, to reimplement DCE/RPC themselves as MSRPC. From this, the +concept continued in the form of SMB (Server Message Block, or the "what") using the +NetBIOS (Network Basic Input/Output System, or the "how") compatibility layer. You can +run SMB (i.e., transport) over several different protocols; many different implementations +arose as a result, including NBIPX (NetBIOS over IPX, NwLnkNb, or NWNBLink) and NBT +(NetBIOS over TCP/IP, or NetBT). As the years passed, NBT became the most common form +of implementation until the advance of "Direct-Hosted TCP" -- the Microsoft marketing +term for eliminating NetBIOS entirely and running SMB by itself across TCP port 445 +only. As of yet, direct-hosted TCP has yet to catch on. +</p><p> +Perhaps the best summary of the origins of SMB are voiced in the 1997 article titled, CIFS: +Common Insecurities Fail Scrutiny: +</p><p><span class="emphasis"><em> +Several megabytes of NT-security archives, random whitepapers, RFCs, the CIFS spec, the Samba +stuff, a few MS knowledge-base articles, strings extracted from binaries, and packet dumps have +been dutifully waded through during the information-gathering stages of this project, and there +are *still* many missing pieces... While often tedious, at least the way has been generously +littered with occurrences of clapping hand to forehead and muttering 'crikey, what are they +thinking? +</em></span></p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2875954"></a>Terminology</h2></div></div><div></div></div><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p> + SMB: Acronym for "Server Message Block". This is Microsoft's file and printer sharing protocol. + </p></li><li><p> + CIFS: Acronym for "Common Internet File System". Around 1996, Microsoft apparently + decided that SMB needed the word "Internet" in it, so they changed it to CIFS. + </p></li><li><p> + Direct-Hosted: A method of providing file/printer sharing services over port 445/tcp + only using DNS for name resolution instead of WINS. + </p></li><li><p> + IPC: Acronym for "Inter-Process Communication". A method to communicate specific + information between programs. + </p></li><li><p> + Marshalling: - A method of serializing (i.e., sequential ordering of) variable data + suitable for transmission via a network connection or storing in a file. The source + data can be re-created using a similar process called unmarshalling. + </p></li><li><p> + NetBIOS: Acronym for "Network Basic Input/Output System". This is not a protocol; + it is a method of communication across an existing protocol. This is a standard which + was originally developed for IBM by Sytek in 1983. To exaggerate the analogy a bit, + it can help to think of this in comparison your computer's BIOS -- it controls the + essential functions of your input/output hardware -- whereas NetBIOS controls the + essential functions of your input/output traffic via the network. Again, this is a bit + of an exaggeration but it should help that paradigm shift. What is important to realize + is that NetBIOS is a transport standard, not a protocol. Unfortunately, even technically + brilliant people tend to interchange NetBIOS with terms like NetBEUI without a second + thought; this will cause no end (and no doubt) of confusion. + </p></li><li><p> + NetBEUI: Acronym for the "NetBIOS Extended User Interface". Unlike NetBIOS, NetBEUI + is a protocol, not a standard. It is also not routable, so traffic on one side of a + router will be unable to communicate with the other side. Understanding NetBEUI is + not essential to deciphering SMB; however it helps to point out that it is not the + same as NetBIOS and to improve your score in trivia at parties. NetBEUI was originally + referred to by Microsoft as "NBF", or "The Windows NT NetBEUI Frame protocol driver". + It is not often heard from these days. + </p></li><li><p> + NBT: Acronym for "NetBIOS over TCP"; also known as "NetBT". Allows the continued use + of NetBIOS traffic proxied over TCP/IP. As a result, NetBIOS names are made + to IP addresses and NetBIOS name types are conceptually equivalent to TCP/IP ports. + This is how file and printer sharing are accomplished in Windows 95/98/ME. They + traditionally rely on three ports: NetBIOS Name Service (nbname) via UDP port 137, + NetBIOS Datagram Service (nbdatagram) via UDP port 138, and NetBIOS Session Service + (nbsession) via TCP port 139. All name resolution is done via WINS, NetBIOS broadcasts, + and DNS. NetBIOS over TCP is documented in RFC 1001 (Concepts and methods) and RFC 1002 + (Detailed specifications). + </p></li><li><p> + W2K: Acronym for Windows 2000 Professional or Server + </p></li><li><p> + W3K: Acronym for Windows 2003 Server + </p></li></ul></div><p>If you plan on getting help, make sure to subscribe to the Samba Mailing List (available at +<ulink url="http://www.samba.org/">http://www.samba.org</ulink>). +</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2876091"></a>Related Projects</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +There are currently two network filesystem client projects for Linux that are directly +related to Samba: SMBFS and CIFS VFS. These are both available in the Linux kernel itself. +</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p> + SMBFS (Server Message Block File System) allows you to mount SMB shares (the protocol + that Microsoft Windows and OS/2 Lan Manager use to share files and printers + over local networks) and access them just like any other Unix directory. This is useful + if you just want to mount such filesystems without being a SMBFS server. + </p></li><li><p> + CIFS VFS (Common Internet File System Virtual File System) is the successor to SMBFS, and + is being actively developed for the upcoming version of the Linux kernel. The intent of this module + is to provide advanced network file system functionality including support for dfs (hierarchical + name space), secure per-user session establishment, safe distributed caching (oplock), + optional packet signing, Unicode and other internationalization improvements, and optional + Winbind (nsswitch) integration. + </p></li></ul></div><p> +Again, it's important to note that these are implementations for client filesystems, and have +nothing to do with acting as a file and print server for SMB/CIFS clients. +</p><p> +There are other Open Source CIFS client implementations, such as the +<ulink url="http://jcifs.samba.org/">jCIFS project</ulink> +which provides an SMB client toolkit written in Java. +</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2876169"></a>SMB Methodology</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +Traditionally, SMB uses UDP port 137 (NetBIOS name service, or netbios-ns), +UDP port 138 (NetBIOS datagram service, or netbios-dgm), and TCP port 139 (NetBIOS +session service, or netbios-ssn). Anyone looking at their network with a good +packet sniffer will be amazed at the amount of traffic generated by just opening +up a single file. In general, SMB sessions are established in the following order: +</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p> + "TCP Connection" - establish 3-way handshake (connection) to port 139/tcp + or 445/tcp. + </p></li><li><p> + "NetBIOS Session Request" - using the following "Calling Names": The local + machine's NetBIOS name plus the 16th character 0x00; The server's NetBIOS + name plus the 16th character 0x20 + </p></li><li><p> + "SMB Negotiate Protocol" - determine the protocol dialect to use, which will + be one of the following: PC Network Program 1.0 (Core) - share level security + mode only; Microsoft Networks 1.03 (Core Plus) - share level security + mode only; Lanman1.0 (LAN Manager 1.0) - uses Challenge/Response + Authentication; Lanman2.1 (LAN Manager 2.1) - uses Challenge/Response + Authentication; NT LM 0.12 (NT LM 0.12) - uses Challenge/Response + Authentication + </p></li><li><p> + SMB Session Startup. Passwords are encrypted (or not) according to one of + the following methods: Null (no encryption); Cleartext (no encryption); LM + and NTLM; NTLM; NTLMv2 + </p></li><li><p> + SMB Tree Connect: Connect to a share name (e.g., \\servername\share); Connect + to a service type (e.g., IPC$ named pipe) + </p></li></ul></div><p> +A good way to examine this process in depth is to try out +<ulink url="http://www.securityfriday.com/ToolDownload/SWB/swb_doc.html">SecurityFriday's SWB program</ulink>. +It allows you to walk through the establishment of a SMB/CIFS session step by step. +</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2876258"></a>Epilogue</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p>“<span class="quote"> +What's fundamentally wrong is that nobody ever had any taste when they +did it. Microsoft has been very much into making the user interface look good, +but internally it's just a complete mess. And even people who program for Microsoft +and who have had years of experience, just don't know how it works internally. +Worse, nobody dares change it. Nobody dares to fix bugs because it's such a +mess that fixing one bug might just break a hundred programs that depend on +that bug. And Microsoft isn't interested in anyone fixing bugs -- they're interested +in making money. They don't have anybody who takes pride in Windows 95 as an +operating system. +</span>”</p><p>“<span class="quote"> +People inside Microsoft know it's a bad operating system and they still +continue obviously working on it because they want to get the next version out +because they want to have all these new features to sell more copies of the +system. +</span>”</p><p>“<span class="quote"> +The problem with that is that over time, when you have this kind of approach, +and because nobody understands it, because nobody REALLY fixes bugs (other than +when they're really obvious), the end result is really messy. You can't trust +it because under certain circumstances it just spontaneously reboots or just +halts in the middle of something that shouldn't be strange. Normally it works +fine and then once in a blue moon for some completely unknown reason, it's dead, +and nobody knows why. Not Microsoft, not the experienced user and certainly +not the completely clueless user who probably sits there shivering thinking +"What did I do wrong?" when they didn't do anything wrong at all. +</span>”</p><p>“<span class="quote"> +That's what's really irritating to me." +</span>”</p><p>-- +<ulink url="http://hr.uoregon.edu/davidrl/boot.txt">Linus Torvalds, from an interview with BOOT Magazine, Sept 1998</ulink> +</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2876344"></a>Miscellaneous</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +This chapter is Copyright 2003 David Lechnyr (david at lechnyr dot com). +Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document under the terms +of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.2 or any later version published by the Free +Software Foundation. A copy of the license is available at http://www.gnu.org/licenses/fdl.txt. +</p></div></div><div class="navfooter"><hr><table width="100%" summary="Navigation footer"><tr><td width="40%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="introduction.html">Prev</a> </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="u" href="introduction.html">Up</a></td><td width="40%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="install.html">Next</a></td></tr><tr><td width="40%" align="left" valign="top">Part I. General Installation </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="h" href="index.html">Home</a></td><td width="40%" align="right" valign="top"> Chapter 2. How to Install and Test SAMBA</td></tr></table></div></body></html> diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/NT4Migration.html b/docs/htmldocs/NT4Migration.html new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..878aa5ec22 --- /dev/null +++ b/docs/htmldocs/NT4Migration.html @@ -0,0 +1,201 @@ +<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>Chapter 31. Migration from NT4 PDC to Samba-3 PDC</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.60.1"><link rel="home" href="index.html" title="SAMBA Project Documentation"><link rel="up" href="migration.html" title="Part IV. Migration and Updating"><link rel="previous" href="upgrading-to-3.0.html" title="Chapter 30. Upgrading from Samba-2.x to Samba-3.0.0"><link rel="next" href="SWAT.html" title="Chapter 32. SWAT The Samba Web Administration Tool"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="navheader"><table width="100%" summary="Navigation header"><tr><th colspan="3" align="center">Chapter 31. Migration from NT4 PDC to Samba-3 PDC</th></tr><tr><td width="20%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="upgrading-to-3.0.html">Prev</a> </td><th width="60%" align="center">Part IV. Migration and Updating</th><td width="20%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="SWAT.html">Next</a></td></tr></table><hr></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="NT4Migration"></a>Chapter 31. Migration from NT4 PDC to Samba-3 PDC</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">John</span> <span class="othername">H.</span> <span class="surname">Terpstra</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org">jht@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><p class="pubdate">April 3, 2003</p></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="NT4Migration.html#id2966015">Planning and Getting Started</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="NT4Migration.html#id2966040">Objectives</a></dt><dt><a href="NT4Migration.html#id2966502">Steps in Migration Process</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="NT4Migration.html#id2966757">Migration Options</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="NT4Migration.html#id2966862">Planning for Success</a></dt><dt><a href="NT4Migration.html#id2967145">Samba-3 Implementation Choices</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></div><p> +This is a rough guide to assist those wishing to migrate from NT4 Domain Control to +Samba-3-based Domain Control. +</p><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2966015"></a>Planning and Getting Started</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +In the IT world there is often a saying that all problems are encountered because of +poor planning. The corollary to this saying is that not all problems can be anticipated +and planned for. Then again, good planning will anticipate most show-stopper-type situations. +</p><p> +Those wishing to migrate from MS Windows NT4 Domain Control to a Samba-3 Domain Control +environment would do well to develop a detailed migration plan. So here are a few pointers to +help migration get under way. +</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2966040"></a>Objectives</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +The key objective for most organizations will be to make the migration from MS Windows NT4 +to Samba-3 Domain Control as painless as possible. One of the challenges you may experience +in your migration process may well be one of convincing management that the new environment +should remain in place. Many who have introduced open source technologies have experienced +pressure to return to a Microsoft-based platform solution at the first sign of trouble. +</p><p> +Before attempting a migration to a Samba-3 controlled network, make every possible effort to +gain all-round commitment to the change. Know precisely <span class="emphasis"><em>why</em></span> the change +is important for the organization. Possible motivations to make a change include: +</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Improve network manageability.</p></li><li><p>Obtain better user level functionality.</p></li><li><p>Reduce network operating costs.</p></li><li><p>Reduce exposure caused by Microsoft withdrawal of NT4 support.</p></li><li><p>Avoid MS License 6 implications.</p></li><li><p>Reduce organization's dependency on Microsoft.</p></li></ul></div><p> +Make sure everyone knows that Samba-3 is not MS Windows NT4. Samba-3 offers +an alternative solution that is both different from MS Windows NT4 and offers +advantages compared with it. Gain recognition that Samba-3 lacks many of the +features that Microsoft has promoted as core values in migration from MS Windows NT4 to +MS Windows 2000 and beyond (with or without Active Directory services). +</p><p> +What are the features that Samba-3 cannot provide? +</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Active Directory Server.</p></li><li><p>Group Policy Objects (in Active Directory).</p></li><li><p>Machine Policy Objects.</p></li><li><p>Logon Scripts in Active Directory.</p></li><li><p>Software Application and Access Controls in Active Directory.</p></li></ul></div><p> +The features that Samba-3 does provide and that may be of compelling interest to your site +include: +</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Lower cost of ownership.</p></li><li><p>Global availability of support with no strings attached.</p></li><li><p>Dynamic SMB Servers (can run more than one SMB/CIFS server per UNIX/Linux system).</p></li><li><p>Creation of on-the-fly logon scripts.</p></li><li><p>Creation of on-the-fly Policy Files.</p></li><li><p>Greater stability, reliability, performance and availability.</p></li><li><p>Manageability via an ssh connection.</p></li><li><p>Flexible choices of back-end authentication technologies (tdbsam, ldapsam, mysqlsam).</p></li><li><p>Ability to implement a full single-sign-on architecture.</p></li><li><p>Ability to distribute authentication systems for absolute minimum wide area network bandwidth demand.</p></li></ul></div><p> +Before migrating a network from MS Windows NT4 to Samba-3, consider all necessary factors. Users +should be educated about changes they may experience so the change will be a welcome one +and not become an obstacle to the work they need to do. The following are factors that will +help ensure a successful migration: +</p><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2966252"></a>Domain Layout</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> +Samba-3 can be configured as a Domain Controller, a back-up Domain Controller (probably best called +a secondary controller), a Domain Member, or as a stand-alone Server. The Windows network security +domain context should be sized and scoped before implementation. Particular attention needs to be +paid to the location of the primary Domain Controller (PDC) as well as backup controllers (BDCs). +One way in which Samba-3 differs from Microsoft technology is that if one chooses to use an LDAP +authentication backend, then the same database can be used by several different domains. In a +complex organization, there can be a single LDAP database, which itself can be distributed (have +a master server and multiple slave servers) that can simultaneously serve multiple domains. +</p><p> +>From a design perspective, the number of users per server as well as the number of servers per +domain should be scaled taking into consideration server capacity and network bandwidth. +</p><p> +A physical network segment may house several domains. Each may span multiple network segments. +Where domains span routed network segments, consider and test the performance implications of +the design and layout of a network. A centrally located Domain Controller that is designed to +serve multiple routed network segments may result in severe performance problems. Check the +response time (ping timing) between the remote segment and the PDC. If +it's long (more than 100 ms), +locate a backup controller (BDC) on the remote segment to serve as the local authentication and +access control server. +</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2966306"></a>Server Share and Directory Layout</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> +There are cardinal rules to effective network design that cannot be broken with impunity. +The most important rule: Simplicity is king in every well-controlled network. Every part of +the infrastructure must be managed; the more complex it is, the greater will be the demand +of keeping systems secure and functional. +</p><p> +Keep in mind the nature of how data must be shared. Physical disk space layout should be considered +carefully. Some data must be backed up. The simpler the disk layout the easier it will be to +keep track of backup needs. Identify what backup media will meet your needs; consider backup to tape, +CD-ROM or (DVD-ROM), or other offline storage medium. Plan and implement for minimum +maintenance. Leave nothing to chance in your design; above all, do not leave backups to chance: +Backup, test, and validate every backup, create a disaster recovery plan and prove that it works. +</p><p> +Users should be grouped according to data access control needs. File and directory access +is best controlled via group permissions and the use of the “<span class="quote">sticky bit</span>” on group controlled +directories may substantially avoid file access complaints from Samba share users. +</p><p> +Inexperienced network administrators often attempt elaborate techniques to set access +controls on files, directories, shares, as well as in share definitions. +Keep your design and implementation simple and document your design extensively. Have others +audit your documentation. Do not create a complex mess that your successor will not understand. +Remember, job security through complex design and implementation may cause loss of operations +and downtime to users as the new administrator learns to untangle your knots. Keep access +controls simple and effective and make sure that users will never be interrupted by obtuse +complexity. +</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2966369"></a>Logon Scripts</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> +Logon scripts can help to ensure that all users gain the share and printer connections they need. +</p><p> +Logon scripts can be created on-the-fly so all commands executed are specific to the +rights and privileges granted to the user. The preferred controls should be affected through +group membership so group information can be used to create a custom logon script using +the <a class="indexterm" name="id2966390"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>root preexec</tt></i> parameters to the <i class="parameter"><tt>NETLOGON</tt></i> share. +</p><p> +Some sites prefer to use a tool such as <b class="command">kixstart</b> to establish a controlled +user environment. In any case, you may wish to do a Google search for logon script process controls. +In particular, you may wish to explore the use of the Microsoft KnowledgeBase article KB189105 that +deals with how to add printers without user intervention via the logon script process. +</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2966432"></a>Profile Migration/Creation</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> +User and Group Profiles may be migrated using the tools described in the section titled Desktop Profile +Management. +</p><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2966449"></a> +Profiles may also be managed using the Samba-3 tool <b class="command">profiles</b>. This tool allows +the MS Windows NT-style security identifiers (SIDs) that are stored inside the profile <tt class="filename">NTuser.DAT</tt> file +to be changed to the SID of the Samba-3 domain. +</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2966477"></a>User and Group Accounts</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> +It is possible to migrate all account settings from an MS Windows NT4 domain to Samba-3. Before +attempting to migrate user and group accounts, it is STRONGLY advised to create in Samba-3 the +groups that are present on the MS Windows NT4 domain <span class="emphasis"><em>AND</em></span> to map them to +suitable UNIX/Linux groups. By following this simple advice, all user and group attributes +should migrate painlessly. +</p></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2966502"></a>Steps in Migration Process</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +The approximate migration process is described below. +</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p> +You have an NT4 PDC that has the users, groups, policies and profiles to be migrated. +</p></li><li><p> +Samba-3 set up as a DC with netlogon share, profile share, and so on. Configure the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file +to fucntion as a BDC, i.e., <i class="parameter"><tt>domain master = No</tt></i>. +</p></li></ul></div><div class="procedure"><p class="title"><b>Procedure 31.1. The Account Migration Process</b></p><ol type="1"><li><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2966561"></a> + Create a BDC account in the old NT4 domain for the Samba server using NT Server Manager.</p><ol type="a"><li><p>Samba must not be running.</p></li></ol></li><li><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2966592"></a> + <b class="userinput"><tt>net rpc join -S <i class="replaceable"><tt>NT4PDC</tt></i> -w <i class="replaceable"><tt>DOMNAME</tt></i> -U Administrator%<i class="replaceable"><tt>passwd</tt></i></tt></b></p></li><li><p><b class="userinput"><tt>net rpc vampire -S <i class="replaceable"><tt>NT4PDC</tt></i> -U administrator%<i class="replaceable"><tt>passwd</tt></i></tt></b></p></li><li><p><b class="userinput"><tt>pdbedit -L</tt></b></p><ol type="a"><li><p>Note did the users migrate?</p></li></ol></li><li><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2966676"></a> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2966687"></a> + Now assign each of the UNIX groups to NT groups: + (It may be useful to copy this text to a script called <tt class="filename">initGroups.sh</tt>) + </p><pre class="programlisting"> +#!/bin/bash +#### Keep this as a shell script for future re-use + +# First assign well known domain global groups +net groupmap modify ntgroup="Domain Admins" unixgroup=root rid=512 +net groupmap modify ntgroup="Domain Users" unixgroup=users rid=513 +net groupmap modify ntgroup="Domain Guests" unixgroup=nobody rid=514 + +# Now for our added domain global groups +net groupmap add ntgroup="Designers" unixgroup=designers type=d rid=3200 +net groupmap add ntgroup="Engineers" unixgroup=engineers type=d rid=3210 +net groupmap add ntgroup="QA Team" unixgroup=qateam type=d rid=3220 +</pre><p> + </p></li><li><p><b class="userinput"><tt>net groupmap list</tt></b></p><ol type="a"><li><p>Check that all groups are recognized.</p></li></ol></li></ol></div><p> +Migrate all the profiles, then migrate all policy files. +</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2966757"></a>Migration Options</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +Sites that wish to migrate from MS Windows NT4 Domain Control to a Samba-based solution +generally fit into three basic categories. <link linkend="majtypes"> shows the possibilities. +</p><div class="table"><a name="majtypes"></a><p class="title"><b>Table 31.1. The Three Major Site Types</b></p><table summary="The Three Major Site Types" border="1"><colgroup><col align="left"><col align="justify"></colgroup><thead><tr><th align="left">Number of Users</th><th align="justify">Description</th></tr></thead><tbody><tr><td align="left">< 50</td><td align="justify"><p>Want simple conversion with no pain.</p></td></tr><tr><td align="left">50 - 250</td><td align="justify"><p>Want new features, can manage some in-house complexity.</p></td></tr><tr><td align="left">> 250</td><td align="justify"><p>Solution/Implementation must scale well, complex needs. Cross-departmental decision process. Local expertise in most areas.</p></td></tr></tbody></table></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2966862"></a>Planning for Success</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +There are three basic choices for sites that intend to migrate from MS Windows NT4 +to Samba-3: +</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p> + Simple conversion (total replacement). + </p></li><li><p> + Upgraded conversion (could be one of integration). + </p></li><li><p> + Complete redesign (completely new solution). + </p></li></ul></div><p> +Minimize down-stream problems by: +</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p> + Taking sufficient time. + </p></li><li><p> + Avoiding Panic. + </p></li><li><p> + Testing all assumptions. + </p></li><li><p> + Testing the full roll-out program, including workstation deployment. + </p></li></ul></div><p><link linkend="natconchoices"> lists the conversion choices given the type of migration +being contemplated. +</p><div class="table"><a name="natconchoices"></a><p class="title"><b>Table 31.2. Nature of the Conversion Choices</b></p><table summary="Nature of the Conversion Choices" border="1"><colgroup><col align="justify"><col align="justify"><col align="justify"></colgroup><thead><tr><th align="justify">Simple</th><th align="justify">Upgraded</th><th align="justify">Redesign</th></tr></thead><tbody><tr><td align="justify"><p>Make use of minimal OS specific features.</p></td><td align="justify"><p>Translate NT4 features to new host OS features.</p></td><td align="justify"><p>Decide:</p></td></tr><tr><td align="justify"><p>Move all accounts from NT4 into Samba-3</p></td><td align="justify"><p>Copy and improve</p></td><td align="justify"><p>Authentication regime (database location and access)</p></td></tr><tr><td align="justify"><p>Make least number of operational changes</p></td><td align="justify"><p>Make progressive improvements</p></td><td align="justify"><p>Desktop management methods</p></td></tr><tr><td align="justify"><p>Take least amount of time to migrate</p></td><td align="justify"><p>Minimize user impact</p></td><td align="justify"><p>Better control of Desktops/Users</p></td></tr><tr><td align="justify"><p>Live versus isolated conversion</p></td><td align="justify"><p>Maximize functionality</p></td><td align="justify"><p>Identify Needs for: <span class="emphasis"><em>Manageability, Scalability, Security, Availability</em></span></p></td></tr><tr><td align="justify"><p>Integrate Samba-3 then migrate while users are active, then change of control (swap out)</p></td><td align="justify"><p>Take advantage of lower maintenance opportunity</p></td><td align="justify"><p></p></td></tr></tbody></table></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2967145"></a>Samba-3 Implementation Choices</h3></div></div><div></div></div><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">Authentication Database/Backend</span></dt><dd><p> + Samba-3 can use an external authentication backend: + </p><p> + </p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Winbind (external Samba or NT4/200x server).</p></li><li><p>External server could use Active Directory or NT4 Domain.</p></li><li><p>Can use pam_mkhomedir.so to auto-create home dirs.</p></li><li><p> + Samba-3 can use a local authentication backend: <i class="parameter"><tt>smbpasswd, tdbsam, ldapsam, mysqlsam</tt></i></p></li></ul></div><p> + </p></dd><dt><span class="term">Access Control Points</span></dt><dd><p> + Samba permits Access Control Points to be set: + </p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>On the share itself using Share ACLs.</p></li><li><p>On the file system using UNIX permissions on files and directories.</p><p>Note: Can enable Posix ACLs in file system also.</p></li><li><p>Through Samba share parameters not recommended except as last resort.</p></li></ul></div></dd><dt><span class="term">Policies (migrate or create new ones)</span></dt><dd><p> + Exercise great caution when affecting registry changes, use the right tool and be aware + that changes made through NT4-style <tt class="filename">NTConfig.POL</tt> files can leave + permanent changes. + </p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Using Group Policy Editor (NT4).</p></li><li><p>Watch out for Tattoo effect.</p></li></ul></div></dd><dt><span class="term">User and Group Profiles</span></dt><dd><p> + Platform-specific so use platform tool to change from a Local to a Roaming profile. + Can use new profiles tool to change SIDs (<tt class="filename">NTUser.DAT</tt>). + </p></dd><dt><span class="term">Logon Scripts</span></dt><dd><p> + Know how they work. + </p></dd><dt><span class="term">User and Group Mapping to UNIX/Linux</span></dt><dd><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2967357"></a> + User and Group mapping code is new. Many problems have been experienced as network administrators + who are familiar with Samba-2.2.x migrate to Samba-3. Carefully study the chapters that document + the new password backend behavior and the new group mapping functionality. + </p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>The <i class="parameter"><tt>username map</tt></i> facility may be needed.</p></li><li><p>Use <b class="command">net groupmap</b> to connect NT4 groups to UNIX groups.</p></li><li><p>Use <b class="command">pdbedit</b> to set/change user configuration.</p><p> + When migrating to LDAP backend, it may be easier to dump the initial + LDAP database to LDIF, edit, then reload into LDAP. + </p></li></ul></div></dd><dt><span class="term">OS Specific Scripts/Programs may be Needed</span></dt><dd><p> + Every operating system has its peculiarities. These are the result of engineering decisions + that were based on the experience of the designer, and may have side-effects that were not + anticipated. Limitations that may bite the Windows network administrator include: + </p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Add/Delete Users: Note OS limits on size of name + (Linux 8 chars) NT4 up to 254 chars.</p></li><li><p>Add/Delete Machines: Applied only to Domain Members + (Note: machine names may be limited to 16 characters).</p></li><li><p>Use <b class="command">net groupmap</b> to connect NT4 groups to UNIX groups.</p></li><li><p>Add/Delete Groups: Note OS limits on size and nature. + Linux limit is 16 char, no spaces and no upper case chars (<b class="command">groupadd</b>).</p></li></ul></div></dd><dt><span class="term">Migration Tools</span></dt><dd><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2967505"></a> + Domain Control (NT4 Style) Profiles, Policies, Access Controls, Security + </p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Samba: <b class="command">net, rpcclient, smbpasswd, pdbedit, profiles.</b></p></li><li><p>Windows: <b class="command">NT4 Domain User Manager, Server Manager (NEXUS)</b></p></li></ul></div><p> + </p></dd></dl></div></div></div></div><div class="navfooter"><hr><table width="100%" summary="Navigation footer"><tr><td width="40%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="upgrading-to-3.0.html">Prev</a> </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="u" href="migration.html">Up</a></td><td width="40%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="SWAT.html">Next</a></td></tr><tr><td width="40%" align="left" valign="top">Chapter 30. Upgrading from Samba-2.x to Samba-3.0.0 </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="h" href="index.html">Home</a></td><td width="40%" align="right" valign="top"> Chapter 32. SWAT The Samba Web Administration Tool</td></tr></table></div></body></html> diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/NetworkBrowsing.html b/docs/htmldocs/NetworkBrowsing.html new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..ffe96d2471 --- /dev/null +++ b/docs/htmldocs/NetworkBrowsing.html @@ -0,0 +1,900 @@ +<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>Chapter 10. Network Browsing</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.60.1"><link rel="home" href="index.html" title="SAMBA Project Documentation"><link rel="up" href="optional.html" title="Part III. Advanced Configuration"><link rel="previous" href="optional.html" title="Part III. Advanced Configuration"><link rel="next" href="passdb.html" title="Chapter 11. Account Information Databases"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="navheader"><table width="100%" summary="Navigation header"><tr><th colspan="3" align="center">Chapter 10. Network Browsing</th></tr><tr><td width="20%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="optional.html">Prev</a> </td><th width="60%" align="center">Part III. Advanced Configuration</th><td width="20%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="passdb.html">Next</a></td></tr></table><hr></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="NetworkBrowsing"></a>Chapter 10. Network Browsing</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">John</span> <span class="othername">H.</span> <span class="surname">Terpstra</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org">jht@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Jelmer</span> <span class="othername">R.</span> <span class="surname">Vernooij</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">The Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jelmer@samba.org">jelmer@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><p class="pubdate">July 5, 1998</p></div><div><p class="pubdate">Updated: April 21, 2003</p></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2897285">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2887786">What Is Browsing?</a></dt><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#netdiscuss">Discussion</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2888109">NetBIOS over TCP/IP</a></dt><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2888380">TCP/IP without NetBIOS</a></dt><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#adsdnstech">DNS and Active Directory</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2888743">How Browsing Functions</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#DMB">Configuring WORKGROUP Browsing</a></dt><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2900135">DOMAIN Browsing Configuration</a></dt><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#browse-force-master">Forcing Samba to Be the Master</a></dt><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2900550">Making Samba the Domain Master</a></dt><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2900727">Note about Broadcast Addresses</a></dt><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2900745">Multiple Interfaces</a></dt><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2900780">Use of the Remote Announce Parameter</a></dt><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2900939">Use of the Remote Browse Sync Parameter</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2901016">WINS The Windows Internetworking Name Server</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2901208">WINS Server Configuration</a></dt><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2901481">WINS Replication</a></dt><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2901518">Static WINS Entries</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2901602">Helpful Hints</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2901616">Windows Networking Protocols</a></dt><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2901696">Name Resolution Order</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2901872">Technical Overview of Browsing</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2901926">Browsing Support in Samba</a></dt><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2902057">Problem Resolution</a></dt><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2902187">Cross-Subnet Browsing</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2902960">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2902975">How Can One Flush the Samba NetBIOS Name Cache without Restarting Samba?</a></dt><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2903041">Server Resources Can Not Be Listed</a></dt><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2903097">I get an `Unable to browse the network' error</a></dt><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2903157">Browsing of Shares and Directories is Very Slow</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></div><p> +This document contains detailed information as well as a fast track guide to +implementing browsing across subnets and/or across workgroups (or domains). +WINS is the best tool for resolution of NetBIOS names to IP addresses. WINS is +not involved in browse list handling except by way of name to address resolution. +</p><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p> +MS Windows 2000 and later versions can be configured to operate with no NetBIOS +over TCP/IP. Samba-3 and later versions also support this mode of operation. +When the use of NetBIOS over TCP/IP has been disabled, the primary +means for resolution of MS Windows machine names is via DNS and Active Directory. +The following information assumes that your site is running NetBIOS over TCP/IP. +</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2897285"></a>Features and Benefits</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +Someone once referred to the past in these words “<span class="quote"><span class="emphasis"><em>It was the best of times, +it was the worst of times.</em></span></span>” The more we look back, the more we long for what was and +hope it never returns. +</p><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2897309"></a> +For many MS Windows network administrators, that statement sums up their feelings about +NetBIOS networking precisely. For those who mastered NetBIOS networking, its fickle +nature was just par for the course. For those who never quite managed to tame its +lusty features, NetBIOS is like Paterson's Curse. +</p><p> +For those not familiar with botanical problems in Australia, Paterson's Curse, +<span class="emphasis"><em>Echium plantagineum</em></span>, was introduced to Australia from Europe during the mid-nineteenth +century. Since then it has spread rapidly. The high seed production, with densities of +thousands of seeds per square meter, a seed longevity of more than seven years, and an +ability to germinate at any time of year, given the right conditions, are some of the +features which make it such a persistent weed. +</p><p> +In this chapter we explore vital aspects of Server Message Block (SMB) networking with +a particular focus on SMB as implemented through running NetBIOS (Network Basic +Input/Output System) over TCP/IP. Since Samba does not implement SMB or NetBIOS over +any other protocols, we need to know how to configure our network environment and simply +remember to use nothing but TCP/IP on all our MS Windows network clients. +</p><p> +Samba provides the ability to implement a WINS (Windows Internetworking Name Server) +and implements extensions to Microsoft's implementation of WINS. These extensions +help Samba to effect stable WINS operations beyond the normal scope of MS WINS. +</p><p> +WINS is exclusively a service that applies only to those systems +that run NetBIOS over TCP/IP. MS Windows 200x/XP have the capacity to operate with +support for NetBIOS disabled, in which case WINS is of no relevance. Samba supports this also. +</p><p> +For those networks on which NetBIOS has been disabled (i.e., WINS is not required) +the use of DNS is necessary for host name resolution. +</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2887786"></a>What Is Browsing?</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +To most people browsing means they can see the MS Windows and Samba servers +in the Network Neighborhood, and when the computer icon for a particular server is +clicked, it opens up and shows the shares and printers available on the target server. +</p><p> +What seems so simple is in fact a complex interaction of different technologies. +The technologies (or methods) employed in making all of this work include: +</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li>MS Windows machines register their presence to the network.</li><li>Machines announce themselves to other machines on the network.</li><li>One or more machine on the network collates the local announcements.</li><li>The client machine finds the machine that has the collated list of machines.</li><li>The client machine is able to resolve the machine names to IP addresses.</li><li>The client machine is able to connect to a target machine.</li></ul></div><p> +The Samba application that controls browse list management and name resolution is +called <tt class="filename">nmbd</tt>. The configuration parameters involved in nmbd's operation are: +</p><p>Browsing options: <a class="indexterm" name="id2887863"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>os level</tt></i>(*), + <a class="indexterm" name="id2887876"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>lm announce</tt></i>, + <a class="indexterm" name="id2887890"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>lm interval</tt></i>, + <a class="indexterm" name="id2887904"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>preferred master</tt></i>(*), + <a class="indexterm" name="id2887918"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>local master</tt></i>(*), + <a class="indexterm" name="id2887932"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>domain master</tt></i>(*), + <a class="indexterm" name="id2887946"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>browse list</tt></i>, + <a class="indexterm" name="id2887959"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>enhanced browsing</tt></i>. +</p><p>Name Resolution Method: + <a class="indexterm" name="id2887977"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>name resolve order</tt></i>(*). +</p><p>WINS options: + <a class="indexterm" name="id2887996"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>dns proxy</tt></i>, + <a class="indexterm" name="id2888009"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>wins proxy</tt></i>, + <a class="indexterm" name="id2888023"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>wins server</tt></i>(*), + <a class="indexterm" name="id2888037"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>wins support</tt></i>(*), + <a class="indexterm" name="id2888051"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>wins hook</tt></i>. +</p><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2888069"></a> +For Samba, the WINS Server and WINS Support are mutually exclusive options. Those marked with +an (*) are the only options that commonly may need to be modified. Even if none of these +parameters is set, <tt class="filename">nmbd</tt> will still do its job. +</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="netdiscuss"></a>Discussion</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +All MS Windows networking uses SMB-based messaging. SMB messaging may be implemented with or without NetBIOS. +MS Windows 200x supports NetBIOS over TCP/IP for backwards compatibility. Microsoft appears intent on phasing +out NetBIOS support. +</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2888109"></a>NetBIOS over TCP/IP</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +Samba implements NetBIOS, as does MS Windows NT/200x/XP, by encapsulating it over TCP/IP. +MS Windows products can do likewise. NetBIOS-based networking uses broadcast messaging to +effect browse list management. When running NetBIOS over TCP/IP, this uses UDP-based messaging. +UDP messages can be broadcast or unicast. +</p><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2888131"></a> +Normally, only unicast UDP messaging can be forwarded by routers. The +<a class="indexterm" name="id2888140"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>remote announce</tt></i> parameter to smb.conf helps to project browse announcements +to remote network segments via unicast UDP. Similarly, the +<a class="indexterm" name="id2888156"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>remote browse sync</tt></i> parameter of <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> +implements browse list collation using unicast UDP. +</p><p> +Secondly, in those networks where Samba is the only SMB server technology, +wherever possible <tt class="filename">nmbd</tt> should be configured on one machine as the WINS +server. This makes it easy to manage the browsing environment. If each network +segment is configured with its own Samba WINS server, then the only way to +get cross-segment browsing to work is by using the +<a class="indexterm" name="id2888196"></a> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2888207"></a> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2888215"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>remote announce</tt></i> and the <a class="indexterm" name="id2888229"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>remote browse sync</tt></i> +parameters to your <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file. +</p><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2888255"></a> +If only one WINS server is used for an entire multi-segment network, then +the use of the <a class="indexterm" name="id2888264"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>remote announce</tt></i> and the +<a class="indexterm" name="id2888278"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>remote browse sync</tt></i> parameters should not be necessary. +</p><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2888297"></a> +As of Samba-3 WINS replication is being worked on. The bulk of the code has +been committed, but it still needs maturation. This is not a supported feature +of the Samba-3.0.0 release. Hopefully, this will become a supported feature +of one of the Samba-3 release series. +</p><p> +Right now Samba WINS does not support MS-WINS replication. This means that +when setting up Samba as a WINS server, there must only be one <tt class="filename">nmbd</tt> +configured as a WINS server on the network. Some sites have used multiple Samba WINS +servers for redundancy (one server per subnet) and then used +<a class="indexterm" name="id2888330"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>remote browse sync</tt></i> and <a class="indexterm" name="id2888343"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>remote announce</tt></i> +to effect browse list collation across all segments. Note that this means clients +will only resolve local names, and must be configured to use DNS to resolve names +on other subnets in order to resolve the IP addresses of the servers they can see +on other subnets. This setup is not recommended, but is mentioned as a practical +consideration (i.e., an “<span class="quote">if all else fails</span>” scenario). +</p><p> +Lastly, take note that browse lists are a collection of unreliable broadcast +messages that are repeated at intervals of not more than 15 minutes. This means +that it will take time to establish a browse list and it can take up to 45 +minutes to stabilize, particularly across network segments. +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2888380"></a>TCP/IP without NetBIOS</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2888391"></a> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2888400"></a> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2888408"></a> +All TCP/IP-enabled systems use various forms of host name resolution. The primary +methods for TCP/IP hostname resolution involve either a static file (<tt class="filename">/etc/hosts</tt>) +or the Domain Name System (DNS). DNS is the technology that makes +the Internet usable. DNS-based host name resolution is supported by nearly all +TCP/IP-enabled systems. Only a few embedded TCP/IP systems do not support DNS. +</p><p> +When an MS Windows 200x/XP system attempts to resolve a host name to an IP address +it follows a defined path: +</p><div class="orderedlist"><ol type="1"><li><p> + Checks the <tt class="filename">hosts</tt> file. It is located in + <tt class="filename">C:\Windows NT\System32\Drivers\etc</tt>. + </p></li><li><p> + Does a DNS lookup. + </p></li><li><p> + Checks the NetBIOS name cache. + </p></li><li><p> + Queries the WINS server. + </p></li><li><p> + Does a broadcast name lookup over UDP. + </p></li><li><p> + Looks up entries in LMHOSTS. It is located in + <tt class="filename">C:\Windows NT\System32\Drivers\etc</tt>. + </p></li></ol></div><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2888511"></a> +Windows 200x/XP can register its host name with a Dynamic DNS server. You can +force register with a Dynamic DNS server in Windows 200x/XP using: +<b class="command">ipconfig /registerdns</b>. +</p><p> +With Active Directory (ADS), a correctly functioning DNS server is absolutely +essential. In the absence of a working DNS server that has been correctly configured, +MS Windows clients and servers will be unable to locate each other, so +consequently network services will be severely impaired. +</p><p> +The use of Dynamic DNS is highly recommended with Active Directory, in which case +the use of BIND9 is preferred for its ability to adequately support the SRV (service) +records that are needed for Active Directory. +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="adsdnstech"></a>DNS and Active Directory</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2888564"></a> +Occasionally we hear from UNIX network administrators who want to use a UNIX-based Dynamic +DNS server in place of the Microsoft DNS server. While this might be desirable to some, the +MS Windows 200x DNS server is auto-configured to work with Active Directory. It is possible +to use BIND version 8 or 9, but it will almost certainly be necessary to create service records +so MS Active Directory clients can resolve host names to locate essential network services. +The following are some of the default service records that Active Directory requires: +</p><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">_ldap._tcp.pdc.ms-dcs.<span class="emphasis"><em>Domain</em></span></span></dt><dd><p> + This provides the address of the Windows NT PDC for the Domain. + </p></dd><dt><span class="term">_ldap._tcp.pdc.ms-dcs.<span class="emphasis"><em>DomainTree</em></span></span></dt><dd><p> + Resolves the addresses of Global Catalog servers in the domain. + </p></dd><dt><span class="term">_ldap._tcp.<span class="emphasis"><em>site</em></span>.sites.writable.ms-dcs.<span class="emphasis"><em>Domain</em></span></span></dt><dd><p> + Provides list of Domain Controllers based on sites. + </p></dd><dt><span class="term">_ldap._tcp.writable.ms-dcs.<span class="emphasis"><em>Domain</em></span></span></dt><dd><p> + Enumerates list of Domain Controllers that have the writable copies of the Active Directory datastore. + </p></dd><dt><span class="term">_ldap._tcp.<span class="emphasis"><em>GUID</em></span>.domains.ms-dcs.<span class="emphasis"><em>DomainTree</em></span></span></dt><dd><p> + Entry used by MS Windows clients to locate machines using the Global Unique Identifier. + </p></dd><dt><span class="term">_ldap._tcp.<span class="emphasis"><em>Site</em></span>.gc.ms-dcs.<span class="emphasis"><em>DomainTree</em></span></span></dt><dd><p> + Used by MS Windows clients to locate site configuration dependent Global Catalog server. + </p></dd></dl></div></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2888743"></a>How Browsing Functions</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +MS Windows machines register their NetBIOS names +(i.e., the machine name for each service type in operation) on start-up. +The exact method by which this name registration +takes place is determined by whether or not the MS Windows client/server +has been given a WINS server address, whether or not LMHOSTS lookup +is enabled, or if DNS for NetBIOS name resolution is enabled, etc. +</p><p> +In the case where there is no WINS server, all name registrations as +well as name lookups are done by UDP broadcast. This isolates name +resolution to the local subnet, unless LMHOSTS is used to list all +names and IP addresses. In such situations, Samba provides a means by +which the Samba server name may be forcibly injected into the browse +list of a remote MS Windows network (using the +<a class="indexterm" name="id2888773"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>remote announce</tt></i> parameter). +</p><p> +Where a WINS server is used, the MS Windows client will use UDP +unicast to register with the WINS server. Such packets can be routed +and thus WINS allows name resolution to function across routed networks. +</p><p> +During the startup process an election will take place to create a +Local Master Browser if one does not already exist. On each NetBIOS network +one machine will be elected to function as the Domain Master Browser. This +domain browsing has nothing to do with MS security Domain Control. +Instead, the Domain Master Browser serves the role of contacting each local +master browser (found by asking WINS or from LMHOSTS) and exchanging browse +list contents. This way every master browser will eventually obtain a complete +list of all machines that are on the network. Every 11 to 15 minutes an election +is held to determine which machine will be the master browser. By the nature of +the election criteria used, the machine with the highest uptime, or the +most senior protocol version or other criteria, will win the election +as Domain Master Browser. +</p><p> +Clients wishing to browse the network make use of this list, but also depend +on the availability of correct name resolution to the respective IP +address/addresses. +</p><p> +Any configuration that breaks name resolution and/or browsing intrinsics +will annoy users because they will have to put up with protracted +inability to use the network services. +</p><p> +Samba supports a feature that allows forced synchronization of browse lists across +routed networks using the <a class="indexterm" name="id2888836"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>remote browse sync</tt></i> +parameter in the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file. This causes Samba to contact the local master +browser on a remote network and to request browse list synchronization. This +effectively bridges two networks that are separated by routers. The two remote +networks may use either broadcast-based name resolution or WINS-based name +resolution, but it should be noted that the +<a class="indexterm" name="id2888863"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>remote browse sync</tt></i> parameter provides +browse list synchronization and that is distinct from name to address +resolution. In other words, for cross-subnet browsing to function correctly it is +essential that a name-to-address resolution mechanism be provided. This mechanism +could be via DNS, <tt class="filename">/etc/hosts</tt>, and so on. +</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="DMB"></a>Configuring WORKGROUP Browsing</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +To configure cross-subnet browsing on a network containing machines +in a WORKGROUP, not an NT Domain, you need to set up one +Samba server to be the Domain Master Browser (note that this is not +the same as a Primary Domain Controller, although in an NT Domain the +same machine plays both roles). The role of a Domain Master Browser is +to collate the browse lists from Local Master Browsers on all the +subnets that have a machine participating in the workgroup. Without +one machine configured as a Domain Master Browser, each subnet would +be an isolated workgroup unable to see any machines on another +subnet. It is the presence of a Domain Master Browser that makes +cross-subnet browsing possible for a workgroup. +</p><p> +In a WORKGROUP environment the Domain Master Browser must be a +Samba server, and there must only be one Domain Master Browser per +workgroup name. To set up a Samba server as a Domain Master Browser, +set the following option in the <i class="parameter"><tt>[global]</tt></i> section +of the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file: +</p><p> +</p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>domain master = yes</tt></i></td></tr></table><p> +</p><p> +The Domain Master Browser should preferably be the local master +browser for its own subnet. In order to achieve this, set the following +options in the <i class="parameter"><tt>[global]</tt></i> section of the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> +file as shown in <link linkend="dmbexample">. +</p><p> +</p><div class="example"><a name="dmbexample"></a><p class="title"><b>Example 10.1. Domain Master Browser smb.conf</b></p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td> </td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>[global]</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>domain master = yes</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>local master = yes</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>preferred master = yes</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>os level = 65</tt></i></td></tr></table></div><p> +</p><p> +The Domain Master Browser may be the same machine as the WINS server, if necessary. +</p><p> +Next, you should ensure that each of the subnets contains a machine that can act as +a Local Master Browser for the workgroup. Any MS Windows NT/200x/XP machine should +be able to do this, as will Windows 9x/Me machines (although these tend to get +rebooted more often, so it is not such a good idea to use these). To make a Samba +server a Local Master Browser set the following options in the +<i class="parameter"><tt>[global]</tt></i> section of the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file as +shown in <link linkend="lmbexample">: +</p><p> +</p><div class="example"><a name="lmbexample"></a><p class="title"><b>Example 10.2. Local master browser smb.conf</b></p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td> </td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>[global]</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>domain master = no</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>local master = yes</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>preferred master = yes</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>os level = 65</tt></i></td></tr></table></div><p> +</p><p> +Do not do this for more than one Samba server on each subnet, or they will war with +each other over which is to be the Local Master Browser. +</p><p> +The <a class="indexterm" name="id2899988"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>local master</tt></i> parameter allows Samba to act as a +Local Master Browser. The <a class="indexterm" name="id2900005"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>preferred master</tt></i> causes <b class="command">nmbd</b> +to force a browser election on startup and the <a class="indexterm" name="id2900026"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>os level</tt></i> +parameter sets Samba high enough so it should win any browser elections. +</p><p> +If you have an NT machine on the subnet that you wish to be the Local Master Browser, you can disable Samba from +becoming a Local Master Browser by setting the following options in the <i class="parameter"><tt>[global]</tt></i> section of the +<tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file as shown in <link linkend="nombexample">: +</p><p> +</p><div class="example"><a name="nombexample"></a><p class="title"><b>Example 10.3. smb.conf for not being a Master Browser</b></p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td> </td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>[global]</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>domain master = no</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>local master = no</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>preferred master = no</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>os level = 0</tt></i></td></tr></table></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2900135"></a>DOMAIN Browsing Configuration</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +If you are adding Samba servers to a Windows NT Domain, then you must not set up a Samba server as a Domain Master Browser. +By default, a Windows NT Primary Domain Controller for a domain is also the Domain Master Browser for that domain. Network +browsing may break if a Samba server registers the domain master browser NetBIOS name (<i class="replaceable"><tt>DOMAIN</tt></i><1B>) +with WINS instead of the PDC. +</p><p> +For subnets other than the one containing the Windows NT PDC, you may set up Samba servers as Local Master Browsers as +described. To make a Samba server a Local Master Browser, set the following options in the <i class="parameter"><tt>[global]</tt></i> section +of the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file as shown in <link linkend="remsmb">: +</p><p> +</p><div class="example"><a name="remsmb"></a><p class="title"><b>Example 10.4. Local Master Browser smb.conf</b></p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td> </td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>[global]</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>domain master = no</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>local master = yes</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>preferred master = yes</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>os level = 65</tt></i></td></tr></table></div><p> +</p><p> +If you wish to have a Samba server fight the election with machines on the same subnet you +may set the <a class="indexterm" name="id2900256"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>os level</tt></i> parameter to lower levels. +By doing this you can tune the order of machines that will become Local Master Browsers if +they are running. For more details on this refer to <link linkend="browse-force-master">. +</p><p> +If you have Windows NT machines that are members of the domain on all subnets and you are +sure they will always be running, you can disable Samba from taking part in browser elections +and ever becoming a Local Master Browser by setting the following options in the +<i class="parameter"><tt>[global]</tt></i> section of the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file as shown in <link linkend="xremmb">: +</p><p> +</p><div class="example"><a name="xremmb"></a><p class="title"><b>Example 10.5. smb.conf for not being a master browser</b></p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td> </td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>[global]</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>domain master = no</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>local master = no</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>preferred master = no</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>os level = 0</tt></i></td></tr></table></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="browse-force-master"></a>Forcing Samba to Be the Master</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +Who becomes the master browser is determined by an election process using broadcasts. Each election packet contains a number of parameters +that determine what precedence (bias) a host should have in the election. By default Samba uses a low precedence and thus loses +elections to just about every Windows network server or client. +</p><p> +If you want Samba to win elections, set the <a class="indexterm" name="id2900406"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>os level</tt></i> +global option in <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> to a higher number. It defaults to zero. Using 34 would make it win +all elections every other system (except other samba systems). +</p><p> +An <a class="indexterm" name="id2900432"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>os level</tt></i> of two would make it beat Windows for Workgroups and Windows 9x/Me, but not MS Windows +NT/200x Server. An MS Windows NT/200x Server Domain Controller uses level 32. The maximum os level is 255. +</p><p> +If you want Samba to force an election on startup, set the +<a class="indexterm" name="id2900455"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>preferred master</tt></i> global option in <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> to <tt class="constant">yes</tt>. +Samba will then have a slight advantage over other potential master browsers that are not Perferred Master Browsers. +Use this parameter with care, as if you have two hosts (whether they are Windows 9x/Me or +NT/200x/XP or Samba) on the same local subnet both set with <a class="indexterm" name="id2900485"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>preferred master</tt></i> +to <tt class="constant">yes</tt>, then periodically and continually they will force an election in order +to become the Local Master Browser. +</p><p> +If you want Samba to be a <span class="emphasis"><em>Domain Master Browser</em></span>, then it is recommended that +you also set <a class="indexterm" name="id2900514"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>preferred master</tt></i> to <tt class="constant">yes</tt>, because +Samba will not become a Domain Master Browser for the whole of your LAN or WAN if it is not also a +Local Master Browser on its own broadcast isolated subnet. +</p><p> +It is possible to configure two Samba servers to attempt to become the Domain Master Browser for a domain. The first server that comes +up will be the Domain Master Browser. All other Samba servers will attempt to become the Domain Master Browser every five minutes. They +will find that another Samba server is already the domain master browser and will fail. This provides automatic redundancy, should +the current Domain Master Browser fail. +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2900550"></a>Making Samba the Domain Master</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +The domain master is responsible for collating the browse lists of multiple subnets so browsing can occur between subnets. You can +make Samba act as the Domain Master by setting <a class="indexterm" name="id2900564"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>domain master</tt></i> = yes +in <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt>. By default it will not be a Domain Master. +</p><p> +Do not set Samba to be the Domain Master for a workgroup that has the same name as an NT/200x Domain. +If Samba is configured to be the Domain Master for a workgroup that is present on the same +network as a Windows NT/200x domain that has the same name, network browsing problems will +certainly be experienced. +</p><p> +When Samba is the Domain Master and the Master Browser, it will listen for master +announcements (made roughly every twelve minutes) from Local Master Browsers on +other subnets and then contact them to synchronize browse lists. +</p><p> +If you want Samba to be the domain master, you should also set the +<a class="indexterm" name="id2900610"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>os level</tt></i> high enough to make sure it wins elections, and +set <a class="indexterm" name="id2900625"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>preferred master</tt></i> to <tt class="constant">yes</tt>, to +get Samba to force an election on startup. +</p><p> +All servers (including Samba) and clients should be using a WINS server to resolve NetBIOS names. If your +clients are only using broadcasting to resolve NetBIOS names, then two things will occur: +</p><div class="orderedlist"><ol type="1"><li><p> + Local Master Browsers will be unable to find a Domain Master Browser, as they will be looking only on the local subnet. + </p></li><li><p> + If a client happens to get hold of a domain-wide browse list and a user attempts to access a + host in that list, it will be unable to resolve the NetBIOS name of that host. + </p></li></ol></div><p> +If, however, both Samba and your clients are using a WINS server, then: +</p><div class="orderedlist"><ol type="1"><li><p> + Local master browsers will contact the WINS server and, as long as Samba has registered that it is a Domain Master Browser with the WINS + server, the Local Master Browser will receive Samba's IP address as its Domain Master Browser. + </p></li><li><p> + When a client receives a domain-wide browse list and a user attempts to access a host in that list, it will contact the WINS server to + resolve the NetBIOS name of that host. As long as that host has registered its NetBIOS name with the same WINS server, the user will + be able to see that host. + </p></li></ol></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2900727"></a>Note about Broadcast Addresses</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +If your network uses a 0 based broadcast address (for example, if it ends in a 0) then you will strike problems. Windows for Workgroups +does not seem to support a zeros broadcast and you will probably find that browsing and name lookups will not work. +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2900745"></a>Multiple Interfaces</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +Samba supports machines with multiple network interfaces. If you have multiple interfaces, you will +need to use the <a class="indexterm" name="id2900757"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>interfaces</tt></i> option in <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> to configure them. +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2900780"></a>Use of the Remote Announce Parameter</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +The <a class="indexterm" name="id2900790"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>remote announce</tt></i> parameter of +<tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> can be used to forcibly ensure +that all the NetBIOS names on a network get announced to a remote network. +The syntax of the <a class="indexterm" name="id2900814"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>remote announce</tt></i> parameter is: +</p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>remote announce = a.b.c.d [e.f.g.h] ...</tt></i></td></tr></table><p> +<span class="emphasis"><em>or</em></span> +</p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>remote announce = a.b.c.d/WORKGROUP [e.f.g.h/WORKGROUP] ...</tt></i></td></tr></table><p> + +where: +</p><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term"><i class="replaceable"><tt>a.b.c.d</tt></i> and <i class="replaceable"><tt>e.f.g.h</tt></i></span></dt><dd><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2900884"></a> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2900896"></a> + is either the LMB (Local Master Browser) IP address or the broadcast address of the remote network. + i.e., the LMB is at 192.168.1.10, or the address could be given as 192.168.1.255 where the netmask + is assumed to be 24 bits (255.255.255.0). When the remote announcement is made to the broadcast + address of the remote network, every host will receive our announcements. This is noisy and therefore + undesirable but may be necessary if we do not know the IP address of the remote LMB. + </p></dd><dt><span class="term"><i class="replaceable"><tt>WORKGROUP</tt></i></span></dt><dd><p>is optional and can be either our own workgroup or that of the remote network. If you use the + workgroup name of the remote network, our NetBIOS machine names will end up looking like + they belong to that workgroup. This may cause name resolution problems and should be avoided. + </p></dd></dl></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2900939"></a>Use of the Remote Browse Sync Parameter</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +The <a class="indexterm" name="id2900949"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>remote browse sync</tt></i> parameter of +<tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> is used to announce to another LMB that it must synchronize its NetBIOS name list with our +Samba LMB. This works only if the Samba server that has this option is +simultaneously the LMB on its network segment. +</p><p> +The syntax of the <a class="indexterm" name="id2900978"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>remote browse sync</tt></i> parameter is: + +</p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>remote browse sync = a.b.c.d</tt></i></td></tr></table><p> + +where <i class="replaceable"><tt>a.b.c.d</tt></i> is either the IP address of the +remote LMB or else is the network broadcast address of the remote segment. +</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2901016"></a>WINS The Windows Internetworking Name Server</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +Use of WINS (either Samba WINS or MS Windows NT Server WINS) is highly +recommended. Every NetBIOS machine registers its name together with a +name_type value for each of several types of service it has available. +It registers its name directly as a unique (the type 0x03) name. +It also registers its name if it is running the LanManager compatible +server service (used to make shares and printers available to other users) +by registering the server (the type 0x20) name. +</p><p> +All NetBIOS names are up to 15 characters in length. The name_type variable +is added to the end of the name, thus creating a 16 character name. Any +name that is shorter than 15 characters is padded with spaces to the 15th +character. Thus, all NetBIOS names are 16 characters long (including the +name_type information). +</p><p> +WINS can store these 16-character names as they get registered. A client +that wants to log onto the network can ask the WINS server for a list +of all names that have registered the NetLogon service name_type. This saves +broadcast traffic and greatly expedites logon processing. Since broadcast +name resolution cannot be used across network segments this type of +information can only be provided via WINS or via a statically configured +<tt class="filename">lmhosts</tt> file that must reside on all clients in the +absence of WINS. +</p><p> +WINS also serves the purpose of forcing browse list synchronization by all +LMBs. LMBs must synchronize their browse list with the DMB (Domain Master +Browser) and WINS helps the LMB to identify its DMB. By definition this +will work only within a single workgroup. Note that the Domain Master Browser +has nothing to do with what is referred to as an MS Windows NT Domain. The +later is a reference to a security environment while the DMB refers to the +master controller for browse list information only. +</p><p> +WINS will work correctly only if every client TCP/IP protocol stack +has been configured to use the WINS servers. Any client that has not been +configured to use the WINS server will continue to use only broadcast-based +name registration so WINS may never get to know about it. In any case, +machines that have not registered with a WINS server will fail name to address +lookup attempts by other clients and will therefore cause workstation access +errors. +</p><p> +To configure Samba as a WINS server just add +<a class="indexterm" name="id2901110"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>wins support</tt></i> = yes to the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> +file [global] section. +</p><p> +To configure Samba to register with a WINS server just add +<a class="indexterm" name="id2901137"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>wins server</tt></i> = a.b.c.d +to your <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file <i class="parameter"><tt>[global]</tt></i> section. +</p><div class="important" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Important</h3><p> +Never use both <a class="indexterm" name="id2901170"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>wins support</tt></i> = yes together +with <a class="indexterm" name="id2901185"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>wins server</tt></i> = a.b.c.d +particularly not using its own IP address. Specifying both will cause <span class="application">nmbd</span> to refuse to start! +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2901208"></a>WINS Server Configuration</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +Either a Samba Server or a Windows NT Server machine may be set up +as a WINS server. To configure a Samba Server to be a WINS server you must +add to the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file on the selected Server the following line to +the <i class="parameter"><tt>[global]</tt></i> section: +</p><p> +</p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>wins support = yes</tt></i></td></tr></table><p> +</p><p> +Versions of Samba prior to 1.9.17 had this parameter default to +yes. If you have any older versions of Samba on your network it is +strongly suggested you upgrade to a recent version, or at the very +least set the parameter to “<span class="quote">no</span>” on all these machines. +</p><p> +Machines configured with <a class="indexterm" name="id2901271"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>wins support</tt></i> = yes will keep a list of +all NetBIOS names registered with them, acting as a DNS for NetBIOS names. +</p><p> +It is strongly recommended to set up only one WINS server. Do not set the +<a class="indexterm" name="id2901293"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>wins support</tt></i> = yes option on more than one Samba +server. +</p><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2901313"></a> +To configure Windows NT/200x Server as a WINS server, install and configure +the WINS service. See the Windows NT/200x documentation for details. +Windows NT/200x WINS servers can replicate to each other, allowing more +than one to be set up in a complex subnet environment. As Microsoft +refuses to document the replication protocols, Samba cannot currently +participate in these replications. It is possible in the future that +a Samba-to-Samba WINS replication protocol may be defined, in which +case more than one Samba machine could be set up as a WINS server. +Currently only one Samba server should have the +<a class="indexterm" name="id2901335"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>wins support</tt></i> = yes parameter set. +</p><p> +After the WINS server has been configured, you must ensure that all +machines participating on the network are configured with the address +of this WINS server. If your WINS server is a Samba machine, fill in +the Samba machine IP address in the <span class="guilabel">Primary WINS Server</span> field of +the <span class="guilabel">Control Panel->Network->Protocols->TCP->WINS Server</span> dialogs +in Windows 9x/Me or Windows NT/200x. To tell a Samba server the IP address +of the WINS server, add the following line to the <i class="parameter"><tt>[global]</tt></i> section of +all <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> files: +</p><p> +</p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>wins server = <name or IP address></tt></i></td></tr></table><p> +</p><p> +where <name or IP address> is either the DNS name of the WINS server +machine or its IP address. +</p><p> +This line must not be set in the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file of the Samba +server acting as the WINS server itself. If you set both the +<a class="indexterm" name="id2901432"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>wins support</tt></i> = yes option and the +<a class="indexterm" name="id2901447"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>wins server</tt></i> = <name> option then +<b class="command">nmbd</b> will fail to start. +</p><p> +There are two possible scenarios for setting up cross-subnet browsing. +The first details setting up cross-subnet browsing on a network containing +Windows 9x/Me, Samba and Windows NT/200x machines that are not configured as +part of a Windows NT Domain. The second details setting up cross-subnet +browsing on networks that contain NT Domains. +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2901481"></a>WINS Replication</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2901492"></a> +Samba-3 permits WINS replication through the use of the <tt class="filename">wrepld</tt> utility. +This tool is not currently capable of being used as it is still in active development. +As soon as this tool becomes moderately functional, we will prepare man pages and enhance this +section of the documentation to provide usage and technical details. +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2901518"></a>Static WINS Entries</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +Adding static entries to your Samba WINS server is actually fairly easy. +All you have to do is add a line to <tt class="filename">wins.dat</tt>, typically +located in <tt class="filename">/usr/local/samba/var/locks</tt>. +</p><p> +Entries in <tt class="filename">wins.dat</tt> take the form of: + +</p><pre class="programlisting"> +"NAME#TYPE" TTL ADDRESS+ FLAGS +</pre><p> + +where NAME is the NetBIOS name, TYPE is the NetBIOS type, TTL is the +time-to-live as an absolute time in seconds, ADDRESS+ is one or more +addresses corresponding to the registration and FLAGS are the NetBIOS +flags for the registration. +</p><p> +A typical dynamic entry looks like this: +</p><pre class="programlisting"> +"MADMAN#03" 1055298378 192.168.1.2 66R +</pre><p> + +To make it static, all that has to be done is set the TTL to 0, like this: + +</p><pre class="programlisting"> +"MADMAN#03" 0 192.168.1.2 66R +</pre><p> +</p><p> +Though this method works with early Samba-3 versions, there is a +possibility that it may change in future versions if WINS replication +is added. +</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2901602"></a>Helpful Hints</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +The following hints should be carefully considered as they are stumbling points +for many new network administrators. +</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2901616"></a>Windows Networking Protocols</h3></div></div><div></div></div><div class="warning" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Warning</h3><p> +Do not use more than one protocol on MS Windows machines. +</p></div><p> +A common cause of browsing problems results from installing more than +one protocol on an MS Windows machine. +</p><p> +Every NetBIOS machine takes part in a process of electing the LMB (and DMB) +every 15 minutes. A set of election criteria is used to determine the order +of precedence for winning this election process. A machine running Samba or +Windows NT will be biased so the most suitable machine will predictably +win and thus retain its role. +</p><p> +The election process is “<span class="quote">fought out</span>” so to speak over every NetBIOS network +interface. In the case of a Windows 9x/Me machine that has both TCP/IP and IPX +installed and has NetBIOS enabled over both protocols, the election will be +decided over both protocols. As often happens, if the Windows 9x/Me machine is +the only one with both protocols then the LMB may be won on the NetBIOS +interface over the IPX protocol. Samba will then lose the LMB role as Windows +9x/Me will insist it knows who the LMB is. Samba will then cease to function +as an LMB and thus browse list operation on all TCP/IP-only machines will +fail. +</p><p> +Windows 95, 98, 98se, and Me are referred to generically as Windows 9x/Me. +The Windows NT4, 200x, and XP use common protocols. These are roughly +referred to as the Windows NT family, but it should be recognized that 2000 and +XP/2003 introduce new protocol extensions that cause them to behave +differently from MS Windows NT4. Generally, where a server does not support +the newer or extended protocol, these will fall back to the NT4 protocols. +</p><p> +The safest rule of all to follow is: use only one protocol! +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2901696"></a>Name Resolution Order</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +Resolution of NetBIOS names to IP addresses can take place using a number +of methods. The only ones that can provide NetBIOS name_type information +are: +</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li>WINS the best tool.</li><li>LMHOSTS static and hard to maintain.</li><li>Broadcast uses UDP and cannot resolve names across remote segments.</li></ul></div><p> +Alternative means of name resolution include: +</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li>Static <tt class="filename">/etc/hosts</tt> hard to maintain, and lacks name_type info.</li><li>DNS is a good choice but lacks essential name_type info.</li></ul></div><p> +Many sites want to restrict DNS lookups and avoid broadcast name +resolution traffic. The <i class="parameter"><tt>name resolve order</tt></i> parameter is of great help here. +The syntax of the <i class="parameter"><tt>name resolve order</tt></i> parameter is: +</p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>name resolve order = wins lmhosts bcast host</tt></i></td></tr></table><p> +<span class="emphasis"><em>or</em></span> +</p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>name resolve order = wins lmhosts (eliminates bcast and host)</tt></i></td></tr></table><p> +The default is: +</p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>name resolve order = host lmhost wins bcast</tt></i></td></tr></table><p> +where “<span class="quote">host</span>” refers to the native methods used by the UNIX system +to implement the gethostbyname() function call. This is normally +controlled by <tt class="filename">/etc/host.conf</tt>, <tt class="filename">/etc/nsswitch.conf</tt> and <tt class="filename">/etc/resolv.conf</tt>. +</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2901872"></a>Technical Overview of Browsing</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +SMB networking provides a mechanism by which clients can access a list +of machines in a network, a so-called <a class="indexterm" name="id2901884"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>browse list</tt></i>. This list +contains machines that are ready to offer file and/or print services +to other machines within the network. Thus it does not include +machines that aren't currently able to do server tasks. The browse +list is heavily used by all SMB clients. Configuration of SMB +browsing has been problematic for some Samba users, hence this +document. +</p><p> +MS Windows 2000 and later versions, as with Samba-3 and later versions, can be +configured to not use NetBIOS over TCP/IP. When configured this way, +it is imperative that name resolution (using DNS/LDAP/ADS) be correctly +configured and operative. Browsing will not work if name resolution +from SMB machine names to IP addresses does not function correctly. +</p><p> +Where NetBIOS over TCP/IP is enabled, use of a WINS server is highly +recommended to aid the resolution of NetBIOS (SMB) names to IP addresses. +WINS allows remote segment clients to obtain NetBIOS name_type information +that cannot be provided by any other means of name resolution. +</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2901926"></a>Browsing Support in Samba</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +Samba facilitates browsing. The browsing is supported by <span class="application">nmbd</span> +and is also controlled by options in the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file. +Samba can act as a local browse master for a workgroup and the ability +to support domain logons and scripts is now available. +</p><p> +Samba can also act as a Domain Master Browser for a workgroup. This +means that it will collate lists from Local Master Browsers into a +wide area network server list. In order for browse clients to +resolve the names they may find in this list, it is recommended that +both Samba and your clients use a WINS server. +</p><p> +Do not set Samba to be the Domain Master for a workgroup that has the same +name as an NT Domain. On each wide area network, you must only ever have one +Domain Master Browser per workgroup, regardless of whether it is NT, Samba +or any other type of domain master that is providing this service. +</p><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p> +<b class="command">nmbd</b> can be configured as a WINS server, but it is not +necessary to specifically use Samba as your WINS server. MS Windows +NT4, Server or Advanced Server 200x can be configured as +your WINS server. In a mixed NT/200x server and Samba environment on +a Wide Area Network, it is recommended that you use the Microsoft +WINS server capabilities. In a Samba-only environment, it is +recommended that you use one and only one Samba server as the WINS server. +</p></div><p> +To get browsing to work you need to run nmbd as usual, but will need +to use the <a class="indexterm" name="id2902000"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>workgroup</tt></i> option in <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> +to control what workgroup Samba becomes a part of. +</p><p> +Samba also has a useful option for a Samba server to offer itself for +browsing on another subnet. It is recommended that this option is only +used for “<span class="quote">unusual</span>” purposes: announcements over the Internet, for +example. See <a class="indexterm" name="id2902033"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>remote announce</tt></i> in the +<tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> man page. +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2902057"></a>Problem Resolution</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +If something does not work, the <tt class="filename">log.nmbd</tt> file will help +to track down the problem. Try a <a class="indexterm" name="id2902075"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>log level</tt></i> of 2 or 3 for finding +problems. Also note that the current browse list usually gets stored +in text form in a file called <tt class="filename">browse.dat</tt>. +</p><p> +If it does not work, you should still be able to +type the server name as <tt class="filename">\\SERVER</tt> in <b class="command">filemanager</b>, then +press enter and <b class="command">filemanager</b> should display the list of available shares. +</p><p> +Some people find browsing fails because they do not have the global +<a class="indexterm" name="id2902130"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>guest account</tt></i> set to a valid account. Remember that the +IPC$ connection that lists the shares is done as guest and, thus, you must have a valid guest account. +</p><p> +MS Windows 2000 and later (as with Samba) can be configured to disallow +anonymous (i.e., guest account) access to the IPC$ share. In that case, the +MS Windows 2000/XP/2003 machine acting as an SMB/CIFS client will use the +name of the currently logged-in user to query the IPC$ share. MS Windows +9x/Me clients are not able to do this and thus will not be able to browse +server resources. +</p><p> +The other big problem people have is that their broadcast address, +netmask or IP address is wrong (specified with the <a class="indexterm" name="id2902164"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>interfaces</tt></i> option +in <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt>) +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2902187"></a>Cross-Subnet Browsing</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2902198"></a> +Since the release of Samba 1.9.17 (alpha1), Samba has supported the +replication of browse lists across subnet boundaries. This section +describes how to set this feature up in different settings. +</p><p> +To see browse lists that span TCP/IP subnets (i.e., networks separated +by routers that do not pass broadcast traffic), you must set up at least +one WINS server. The WINS server acts as a DNS for NetBIOS names. This will +allow NetBIOS name-to-IP address translation to be completed by a direct +query of the WINS server. This is done via a directed UDP packet on +port 137 to the WINS server machine. The WINS server avoids the necessity +of default NetBIOS name-to-IP address translation, which is done +using UDP broadcasts from the querying machine. This means that machines +on one subnet will not be able to resolve the names of machines on +another subnet without using a WINS server. +</p><p> +Remember, for browsing across subnets to work correctly, all machines, +be they Windows 95, Windows NT or Samba servers, must have the IP address +of a WINS server given to them by a DHCP server, or by manual configuration +(for Windows 9x/Me and Windows NT/200x/XP, this is in the TCP/IP Properties, under Network +settings); for Samba, this is in the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file. +</p><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2902248"></a>Behavior of Cross-Subnet Browsing</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> +Cross-subnet Browsing is a complicated dance, containing multiple +moving parts. It has taken Microsoft several years to get the code +that achieves this correct, and Samba lags behind in some areas. +Samba is capable of cross-subnet browsing when configured correctly. +</p><p> +Consider a network set up as <link linkend="browsing1">. +</p><div class="figure"><a name="browsing1"></a><p class="title"><b>Figure 10.1. Cross-Subnet Browsing Example.</b></p><div class="mediaobject"><img src="projdoc/imagefiles/browsing1.png" width="270" alt="Cross-Subnet Browsing Example."></div></div><p> +This consists of 3 subnets (1, 2, 3) connected by two routers +(R1, R2) which do not pass broadcasts. Subnet 1 has five machines +on it, subnet 2 has four machines, subnet 3 has four machines. Assume +for the moment that all machines are configured to be in the +same workgroup (for simplicity's sake). Machine N1_C on subnet 1 +is configured as Domain Master Browser (i.e., it will collate the +browse lists for the workgroup). Machine N2_D is configured as +WINS server and all the other machines are configured to register +their NetBIOS names with it. +</p><p> +As these machines are booted up, elections for master browsers +will take place on each of the three subnets. Assume that machine +N1_C wins on subnet 1, N2_B wins on subnet 2, and N3_D wins on +subnet 3. These machines are known as Local Master Browsers for +their particular subnet. N1_C has an advantage in winning as the +Local Master Browser on subnet 1 as it is set up as Domain Master +Browser. +</p><p> +On each of the three networks, machines that are configured to +offer sharing services will broadcast that they are offering +these services. The Local Master Browser on each subnet will +receive these broadcasts and keep a record of the fact that +the machine is offering a service. This list of records is +the basis of the browse list. For this case, assume that +all the machines are configured to offer services, so all machines +will be on the browse list. +</p><p> +For each network, the Local Master Browser on that network is +considered “<span class="quote">authoritative</span>” for all the names it receives via +local broadcast. This is because a machine seen by the Local Master +Browser via a local broadcast must be on the same network as the +Local Master Browser and thus is a “<span class="quote">trusted</span>” +and “<span class="quote">verifiable</span>” resource. Machines on other networks that +the Local Master Browsers learn about when collating their +browse lists have not been directly seen. These records are +called “<span class="quote">non-authoritative.</span>” +</p><p> +At this point the browse lists appear as shown in <link linkend="browsubnet"> (these are +the machines you would see in your network neighborhood if you looked in it on a particular network right now). +</p><p> +</p><div class="table"><a name="browsubnet"></a><p class="title"><b>Table 10.1. Browse Subnet Example 1</b></p><table summary="Browse Subnet Example 1" border="1"><colgroup><col><col><col></colgroup><thead><tr><th align="left">Subnet</th><th align="left">Browse Master</th><th align="left">List</th></tr></thead><tbody><tr><td align="left">Subnet1</td><td align="left">N1_C</td><td align="left">N1_A, N1_B, N1_C, N1_D, N1_E</td></tr><tr><td align="left">Subnet2</td><td align="left">N2_B</td><td align="left">N2_A, N2_B, N2_C, N2_D</td></tr><tr><td align="left">Subnet3</td><td align="left">N3_D</td><td align="left">N3_A, N3_B, N3_C, N3_D</td></tr></tbody></table></div><p> +</p><p> +At this point all the subnets are separate, and no machine is seen across any of the subnets. +</p><p> +Now examine subnet 2. As soon as N2_B has become the Local +Master Browser it looks for a Domain Master Browser with which to synchronize +its browse list. It does this by querying the WINS server +(N2_D) for the IP address associated with the NetBIOS name +WORKGROUP<1B>. This name was registered by the Domain Master +Browser (N1_C) with the WINS server as soon as it was started. +</p><p> +Once N2_B knows the address of the Domain Master Browser, it +tells it that is the Local Master Browser for subnet 2 by +sending a <span class="emphasis"><em>MasterAnnouncement</em></span> packet as a UDP port 138 packet. +It then synchronizes with it by doing a <span class="emphasis"><em>NetServerEnum2</em></span> call. This +tells the Domain Master Browser to send it all the server +names it knows about. Once the Domain Master Browser receives +the <span class="emphasis"><em>MasterAnnouncement</em></span> packet, it schedules a synchronization +request to the sender of that packet. After both synchronizations +are complete the browse lists look as shown in <link linkend="brsbex">: +</p><div class="table"><a name="brsbex"></a><p class="title"><b>Table 10.2. Browse Subnet Example 2</b></p><table summary="Browse Subnet Example 2" border="1"><colgroup><col align="left"><col align="left"><col align="justify"></colgroup><thead><tr><th align="left">Subnet</th><th align="left">Browse Master</th><th align="justify">List</th></tr></thead><tbody><tr><td align="left">Subnet1</td><td align="left">N1_C</td><td align="justify">N1_A, N1_B, N1_C, N1_D, N1_E, +N2_A(*), N2_B(*), N2_C(*), N2_D(*)</td></tr><tr><td align="left">Subnet2</td><td align="left">N2_B</td><td align="justify">N2_A, N2_B, N2_C, N2_D, N1_A(*), +N1_B(*), N1_C(*), N1_D(*), N1_E(*)</td></tr><tr><td align="left">Subnet3</td><td align="left">N3_D</td><td align="justify">N3_A, N3_B, N3_C, N3_D</td></tr></tbody></table></div><p> +Servers with an (*) after them are non-authoritative names. +</p><p> +At this point users looking in their network neighborhood on +subnets 1 or 2 will see all the servers on both, users on +subnet 3 will still only see the servers on their own subnet. +</p><p> +The same sequence of events that occurred for N2_B now occurs +for the Local Master Browser on subnet 3 (N3_D). When it +synchronizes browse lists with the Domain Master Browser (N1_A) +it gets both the server entries on subnet 1, and those on +subnet 2. After N3_D has synchronized with N1_C and vica versa, +the browse lists will appear as shown in <link linkend="brsex2">. +</p><div class="table"><a name="brsex2"></a><p class="title"><b>Table 10.3. Browse Subnet Example 3</b></p><table summary="Browse Subnet Example 3" border="1"><colgroup><col align="left"><col align="left"><col align="justify"></colgroup><thead><tr><th align="left">Subnet</th><th align="left">Browse Master</th><th align="justify">List</th></tr></thead><tbody><tr><td align="left">Subnet1</td><td align="left">N1_C</td><td align="justify">N1_A, N1_B, N1_C, N1_D, N1_E, +N2_A(*), N2_B(*), N2_C(*), N2_D(*), N3_A(*), N3_B(*), N3_C(*), N3_D(*)</td></tr><tr><td align="left">Subnet2</td><td align="left">N2_B</td><td align="justify">N2_A, N2_B, N2_C, N2_D, N1_A(*), +N1_B(*), N1_C(*), N1_D(*), N1_E(*)</td></tr><tr><td align="left">Subnet3</td><td align="left">N3_D</td><td align="justify">N3_A, N3_B, N3_C, N3_D, N1_A(*), +N1_B(*), N1_C(*), N1_D(*), N1_E(*), N2_A(*), N2_B(*), N2_C(*), N2_D(*)</td></tr></tbody></table></div><p> +Servers with an (*) after them are non-authoritative names. +</p><p> +At this point, users looking in their network neighborhood on +subnets 1 or 3 will see all the servers on all subnets, while users on +subnet 2 will still only see the servers on subnets 1 and 2, but not 3. +</p><p> +Finally, the Local Master Browser for subnet 2 (N2_B) will sync again +with the Domain Master Browser (N1_C) and will receive the missing +server entries. Finally, as when a steady state (if no machines +are removed or shut off) has been achieved, the browse lists will appear +as shown in <link linkend="brsex3">. +</p><div class="table"><a name="brsex3"></a><p class="title"><b>Table 10.4. Browse Subnet Example 4</b></p><table summary="Browse Subnet Example 4" border="1"><colgroup><col align="left"><col align="left"><col align="justify"></colgroup><thead><tr><th align="left">Subnet</th><th align="left">Browse Master</th><th align="justify">List</th></tr></thead><tbody><tr><td align="left">Subnet1</td><td align="left">N1_C</td><td align="justify">N1_A, N1_B, N1_C, N1_D, N1_E, +N2_A(*), N2_B(*), N2_C(*), N2_D(*), N3_A(*), N3_B(*), +N3_C(*), N3_D(*)</td></tr><tr><td align="left">Subnet2</td><td align="left">N2_B</td><td align="justify">N2_A, N2_B, N2_C, N2_D, N1_A(*), +N1_B(*), N1_C(*), N1_D(*), N1_E(*), N3_A(*), N3_B(*), +N3_C(*), N3_D(*)</td></tr><tr><td align="left">Subnet3</td><td align="left">N3_D</td><td align="justify">N3_A, N3_B, N3_C, N3_D, N1_A(*), +N1_B(*), N1_C(*), N1_D(*), N1_E(*), N2_A(*), N2_B(*), +N2_C(*), N2_D(*)</td></tr></tbody></table></div><p> +Servers with an (*) after them are non-authoritative names. +</p><p> +Synchronizations between the Domain Master Browser and Local +Master Browsers will continue to occur, but this should remain a +steady state operation. +</p><p> +If either router R1 or R2 fails, the following will occur: +</p><div class="orderedlist"><ol type="1"><li><p> + Names of computers on each side of the inaccessible network fragments + will be maintained for as long as 36 minutes in the network neighborhood + lists. + </p></li><li><p> + Attempts to connect to these inaccessible computers will fail, but the + names will not be removed from the network neighborhood lists. + </p></li><li><p> + If one of the fragments is cut off from the WINS server, it will only + be able to access servers on its local subnet using subnet-isolated + broadcast NetBIOS name resolution. The effects are similar to that of + losing access to a DNS server. + </p></li></ol></div></div></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2902960"></a>Common Errors</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +Many questions are asked on the mailing lists regarding browsing. The majority of browsing +problems originate from incorrect configuration of NetBIOS name resolution. Some are of +particular note. +</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2902975"></a>How Can One Flush the Samba NetBIOS Name Cache without Restarting Samba?</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2902987"></a> +Samba's <b class="command">nmbd</b> process controls all browse list handling. Under normal circumstances it is +safe to restart <b class="command">nmbd</b>. This will effectively flush the Samba NetBIOS name cache and cause it +to be rebuilt. This does not make certain that a rogue machine name will not re-appear +in the browse list. When <b class="command">nmbd</b> is taken out of service, another machine on the network will +become the Browse Master. This new list may still have the rogue entry in it. If you really +want to clear a rogue machine from the list, every machine on the network will need to be +shut down and restarted after all machines are down. Failing a complete restart, the only +other thing you can do is wait until the entry times out and is then flushed from the list. +This may take a long time on some networks (perhaps months). +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2903041"></a>Server Resources Can Not Be Listed</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>“<span class="quote">My Client Reports ‘<span class="quote">This server is not configured to list shared resources</span>’</span>”</p><p> +Your guest account is probably invalid for some reason. Samba uses the +guest account for browsing in <b class="command">smbd</b>. Check that your guest account is +valid. +</p><p>Also see <a class="indexterm" name="id2903074"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>guest account</tt></i> in the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> man page.</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2903097"></a>I get an <span class="errorname">`Unable to browse the network'</span> error</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>This error can have multiple causes: +<a class="indexterm" name="id2903114"></a> + </p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>There is no Local Master Browser. Configure <span class="application">nmbd</span> + or any other machine to serve as Local Master Browser.</p></li><li><p>You cannot log onto the machine that is the local master + browser. Can you logon to it as a guest user? </p></li><li><p>There is no IP connectivity to the Local Master Browser. + Can you reach it by broadcast?</p></li></ul></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2903157"></a>Browsing of Shares and Directories is Very Slow</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>“<span class="quote"> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2903170"></a> +There are only two machines on a test network. One a Samba server, the other a Windows XP machine. +Authentication and logons work perfectly, but when I try to explore shares on the Samba server, the +Windows XP client becomes unrespsonsive. Sometimes it does not respond for some minutes. Eventually, +Windows Explorer will respond and displays files and directories without problem. +display file and directory.</span>” +</p><p>“<span class="quote"> +But, the share is immediately available from a command shell (<b class="command">cmd</b>, followed by +exploration with dos command. Is this a Samba problem or is it a Windows problem? How can I solve this? +</span>”</p><p> +Here are a few possibilities: +</p><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">Bad Networking Hardware</span></dt><dd><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2903224"></a> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2903233"></a> + Most common defective hardware problems center around low cost or defective HUBs, routers, + Network Interface Controllers (NICs) and bad wiring. If one piece of hardware is defective + the whole network may suffer. Bad networking hardware can cause data corruption. Most bad + networking hardware problems are accompanied by an increase in apparent network traffic, + but not all. + </p></dd><dt><span class="term">The Windows XP WebClient</span></dt><dd><p> + A number of sites have reported similar slow network browsing problems and found that when + the WebClient service is turned off, the problem dissapears. This is certainly something + that should be explored as it is a simple solution if it works. + </p></dd><dt><span class="term">Inconsistent WINS Configuration</span></dt><dd><p> + This type of problem is common when one client is configured to use a WINS server (that is + a TCP/IP configuration setting) and there is no WINS server on the network. Alternately, + this will happen is there is a WINS server and Samba is not configured to use it. The use of + WINS is highly recommended if the network is using NetBIOS over TCP/IP protocols. If use + of NetBIOS over TCP/IP is disabled on all clients, Samba should not be configured as a WINS + server neither should it be configured to use one. + </p></dd><dt><span class="term">Incorrect DNS Configuration</span></dt><dd><p> + If use of NetBIOS over TCP/IP is disabled, Active Directory is in use and the DNS server + has been incorrectly configured. Refer <link linkend="adsdnstech"> for more information. + </p></dd></dl></div></div></div></div><div class="navfooter"><hr><table width="100%" summary="Navigation footer"><tr><td width="40%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="optional.html">Prev</a> </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="u" href="optional.html">Up</a></td><td width="40%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="passdb.html">Next</a></td></tr><tr><td width="40%" align="left" valign="top">Part III. Advanced Configuration </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="h" href="index.html">Home</a></td><td width="40%" align="right" valign="top"> Chapter 11. Account Information Databases</td></tr></table></div></body></html> diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/Other-Clients.html b/docs/htmldocs/Other-Clients.html new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..9e3c643103 --- /dev/null +++ b/docs/htmldocs/Other-Clients.html @@ -0,0 +1,160 @@ +<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>Chapter 38. Samba and Other CIFS Clients</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.60.1"><link rel="home" href="index.html" title="SAMBA Project Documentation"><link rel="up" href="Appendixes.html" title="Part VI. Appendixes"><link rel="previous" href="Portability.html" title="Chapter 37. Portability"><link rel="next" href="speed.html" title="Chapter 39. Samba Performance Tuning"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="navheader"><table width="100%" summary="Navigation header"><tr><th colspan="3" align="center">Chapter 38. Samba and Other CIFS Clients</th></tr><tr><td width="20%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="Portability.html">Prev</a> </td><th width="60%" align="center">Part VI. Appendixes</th><td width="20%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="speed.html">Next</a></td></tr></table><hr></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="Other-Clients"></a>Chapter 38. Samba and Other CIFS Clients</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Jelmer</span> <span class="othername">R.</span> <span class="surname">Vernooij</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">The Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jelmer@samba.org">jelmer@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">John</span> <span class="othername">H.</span> <span class="surname">Terpstra</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org">jht@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Dan</span> <span class="surname">Shearer</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:dan@samba.org">dan@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Jim</span> <span class="surname">McDonough</span></h3><span class="contrib">OS/2</span><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">IBM<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jmcd@us.ibm.com">jmcd@us.ibm.com</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><p class="pubdate">5 Mar 2001</p></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="Other-Clients.html#id2975129">Macintosh Clients</a></dt><dt><a href="Other-Clients.html#id2975206">OS2 Client</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="Other-Clients.html#id2975213">Configuring OS/2 Warp Connect or OS/2 Warp 4</a></dt><dt><a href="Other-Clients.html#id2975348">Configuring Other Versions of OS/2</a></dt><dt><a href="Other-Clients.html#id2975411">Printer Driver Download for OS/2 Clients</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="Other-Clients.html#id2975516">Windows for Workgroups</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="Other-Clients.html#id2975524">Latest TCP/IP Stack from Microsoft</a></dt><dt><a href="Other-Clients.html#id2975610">Delete .pwl Files After Password Change</a></dt><dt><a href="Other-Clients.html#id2975641">Configuring Windows for Workgroups Password Handling</a></dt><dt><a href="Other-Clients.html#id2975701">Password Case Sensitivity</a></dt><dt><a href="Other-Clients.html#id2975739">Use TCP/IP as Default Protocol</a></dt><dt><a href="Other-Clients.html#id2975757">Speed Improvement</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="Other-Clients.html#id2975803">Windows 95/98</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="Other-Clients.html#id2975876">Speed Improvement</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="Other-Clients.html#id2975901">Windows 2000 Service Pack 2</a></dt><dt><a href="Other-Clients.html#id2976103">Windows NT 3.1</a></dt></dl></div><p>This chapter contains client-specific information.</p><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2975129"></a>Macintosh Clients</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +Yes. <ulink url="http://www.thursby.com/">Thursby</ulink> has a CIFS Client/Server called <ulink url="http://www.thursby.com/products/dave.html">DAVE.</ulink> +They test it against Windows 95, Windows NT /200x/XP and Samba for +compatibility issues. At the time of this writing, DAVE was at version +4.1. Please refer to Thursby's Web site for more information regarding this +product. +</p><p> +Alternatives There are two free implementations of AppleTalk for +several kinds of UNIX machines and several more commercial ones. +These products allow you to run file services and print services +natively to Macintosh users, with no additional support required on +the Macintosh. The two free implementations are +<ulink url="http://www.umich.edu/~rsug/netatalk/">Netatalk,</ulink> and +<ulink url="http://www.cs.mu.oz.au/appletalk/atalk.html">CAP.</ulink> +What Samba offers MS Windows users, these packages offer to Macs. +For more info on these packages, Samba, and Linux (and other UNIX-based systems), see +<ulink url="http://www.eats.com/linux_mac_win.html">http://www.eats.com/linux_mac_win.html.</ulink> +</p><p>Newer versions of the Macintosh (Mac OS X) include Samba.</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2975206"></a>OS2 Client</h2></div></div><div></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2975213"></a>Configuring OS/2 Warp Connect or OS/2 Warp 4</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>Basically, you need three components:</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li>The File and Print Client (IBM Peer)</li><li>TCP/IP (Internet support) </li><li>The “<span class="quote">NetBIOS over TCP/IP</span>” driver (TCPBEUI)</li></ul></div><p>Installing the first two together with the base operating + system on a blank system is explained in the Warp manual. If Warp + has already been installed, but you now want to install the + networking support, use the “<span class="quote">Selective Install for Networking</span>” + object in the “<span class="quote">System Setup</span>” folder.</p><p>Adding the “<span class="quote">NetBIOS over TCP/IP</span>” driver is not described + in the manual and just barely in the online documentation. Start + <b class="command">MPTS.EXE</b>, click on <span class="guiicon">OK</span>, click on <span class="guimenu">Configure LAPS</span> and click + on <span class="guimenu">IBM OS/2 NETBIOS OVER TCP/IP</span> in <span class="guilabel">Protocols</span>. This line + is then moved to <span class="guilabel">Current Configuration</span>. Select that line, + click on <span class="guimenuitem">Change number</span> and increase it from 0 to 1. Save this + configuration.</p><p>If the Samba server is not on your local subnet, you + can optionally add IP names and addresses of these servers + to the <span class="guimenu">Names List</span>, or specify a WINS server (NetBIOS + Nameserver in IBM and RFC terminology). For Warp Connect, you + may need to download an update for <tt class="constant">IBM Peer</tt> to bring it on + the same level as Warp 4. See the Web page mentioned above.</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2975348"></a>Configuring Other Versions of OS/2</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>This sections deals with configuring OS/2 Warp 3 (not Connect), OS/2 1.2, 1.3 or 2.x.</p><p>You can use the free Microsoft LAN Manager 2.2c Client for OS/2 that is + available from + <ulink url="ftp://ftp.microsoft.com/BusSys/Clients/LANMAN.OS2/"> + ftp://ftp.microsoft.com/BusSys/Clients/LANMAN.OS2/</ulink>. In a nutshell, edit + the file <tt class="filename">\OS2VER</tt> in the root directory of the OS/2 boot partition and add the lines:</p><pre class="programlisting"> + 20=setup.exe + 20=netwksta.sys + 20=netvdd.sys + </pre><p>before you install the client. Also, do not use the included NE2000 driver because it is buggy. + Try the NE2000 or NS2000 driver from <ulink url="ftp://ftp.cdrom.com/pub/os2/network/ndis/"> + ftp://ftp.cdrom.com/pub/os2/network/ndis/</ulink> instead. + </p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2975411"></a>Printer Driver Download for OS/2 Clients</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>Create a share called <i class="parameter"><tt>[PRINTDRV]</tt></i> that is + world-readable. Copy your OS/2 driver files there. The <tt class="filename">.EA_</tt> + files must still be separate, so you will need to use the original install files + and not copy an installed driver from an OS/2 system.</p><p>Install the NT driver first for that printer. Then, add to your <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> a parameter, + <a class="indexterm" name="id2975450"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>os2 driver map</tt></i> = filename. + Next, in the file specified by <i class="replaceable"><tt>filename</tt></i>, map the + name of the NT driver name to the OS/2 driver name as follows:</p><p><i class="parameter"><tt><i class="replaceable"><tt>nt driver name</tt></i> = <i class="replaceable"><tt>os2 driver name</tt></i>.<i class="replaceable"><tt>device name</tt></i></tt></i>, e.g.</p><p><i class="parameter"><tt> + HP LaserJet 5L = LASERJET.HP LaserJet 5L</tt></i></p><p>You can have multiple drivers mapped in this file.</p><p>If you only specify the OS/2 driver name, and not the + device name, the first attempt to download the driver will + actually download the files, but the OS/2 client will tell + you the driver is not available. On the second attempt, it + will work. This is fixed simply by adding the device name + to the mapping, after which it will work on the first attempt. + </p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2975516"></a>Windows for Workgroups</h2></div></div><div></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2975524"></a>Latest TCP/IP Stack from Microsoft</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>Use the latest TCP/IP stack from Microsoft if you use Windows +for Workgroups. The early TCP/IP stacks had lots of bugs.</p><p> +Microsoft has released an incremental upgrade to their TCP/IP 32-bit +VxD drivers. The latest release can be found on their ftp site at +ftp.microsoft.com, located in <tt class="filename">/peropsys/windows/public/tcpip/wfwt32.exe</tt>. +There is an update.txt file there that describes the problems that were +fixed. New files include <tt class="filename">WINSOCK.DLL</tt>, +<tt class="filename">TELNET.EXE</tt>, +<tt class="filename">WSOCK.386</tt>, +<tt class="filename">VNBT.386</tt>, +<tt class="filename">WSTCP.386</tt>, +<tt class="filename">TRACERT.EXE</tt>, +<tt class="filename">NETSTAT.EXE</tt>, and +<tt class="filename">NBTSTAT.EXE</tt>. +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2975610"></a>Delete .pwl Files After Password Change</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +Windows for Workgroups does a lousy job with passwords. When you change passwords on either +the UNIX box or the PC, the safest thing to do is to delete the .pwl files in the Windows +directory. The PC will complain about not finding the files, but will soon get over it, +allowing you to enter the new password. +</p><p> +If you do not do this, you may find that Windows for Workgroups remembers and uses the old +password, even if you told it a new one. +</p><p> +Often Windows for Workgroups will totally ignore a password you give it in a dialog box. +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2975641"></a>Configuring Windows for Workgroups Password Handling</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +There is a program call <tt class="filename">admincfg.exe</tt> +on the last disk (disk 8) of the WFW 3.11 disk set. To install it, +type <b class="userinput"><tt>EXPAND A:\ADMINCFG.EX_ C:\WINDOWS\ADMINCFG.EXE</tt></b>. +Then add an icon for it via the <span class="application">Program Manager</span> <span class="guimenu">New</span> Menu. +This program allows you to control how WFW handles passwords, i.e., +Disable Password Caching and so on. +for use with <a class="indexterm" name="id2975686"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>security</tt></i> = user. +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2975701"></a>Password Case Sensitivity</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>Windows for Workgroups uppercases the password before sending it to the server. +UNIX passwords can be case-sensitive though. Check the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> information on +<a class="indexterm" name="id2975721"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>password level</tt></i> to specify what characters +Samba should try to uppercase when checking.</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2975739"></a>Use TCP/IP as Default Protocol</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>To support print queue reporting, you may find +that you have to use TCP/IP as the default protocol under +Windows for Workgroups. For some reason, if you leave NetBEUI as the default, +it may break the print queue reporting on some systems. +It is presumably a Windows for Workgroups bug.</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2975757"></a>Speed Improvement</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + Note that some people have found that setting <i class="parameter"><tt>DefaultRcvWindow</tt></i> in +the <i class="parameter"><tt>[MSTCP]</tt></i> section of the +<tt class="filename">SYSTEM.INI</tt> file under Windows for Workgroups to 3072 gives a +big improvement. +</p><p> +My own experience with DefaultRcvWindow is that I get a much better +performance with a large value (16384 or larger). Other people have +reported that anything over 3072 slows things down enormously. One +person even reported a speed drop of a factor of 30 when he went from +3072 to 8192. +</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2975803"></a>Windows 95/98</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +When using Windows 95 OEM SR2, the following updates are recommended where Samba +is being used. Please note that the above change will effect you once these +updates have been installed. +</p><p> +There are more updates than the ones mentioned here. You are referred to the +Microsoft Web site for all currently available updates to your specific version +of Windows 95. +</p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td>Kernel Update: KRNLUPD.EXE</td></tr><tr><td>Ping Fix: PINGUPD.EXE</td></tr><tr><td>RPC Update: RPCRTUPD.EXE</td></tr><tr><td>TCP/IP Update: VIPUPD.EXE</td></tr><tr><td>Redirector Update: VRDRUPD.EXE</td></tr></table><p> +Also, if using <span class="application">MS Outlook,</span> it is desirable to +install the <b class="command">OLEUPD.EXE</b> fix. This +fix may stop your machine from hanging for an extended period when exiting +Outlook and you may notice a significant speedup when accessing network +neighborhood services. +</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2975876"></a>Speed Improvement</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +Configure the Windows 95 TCP/IP registry settings to give better +performance. I use a program called <b class="command">MTUSPEED.exe</b> that I got off the +Internet. There are various other utilities of this type freely available. +</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2975901"></a>Windows 2000 Service Pack 2</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +There are several annoyances with Windows 2000 SP2. One of which +only appears when using a Samba server to host user profiles +to Windows 2000 SP2 clients in a Windows domain. This assumes +that Samba is a member of the domain, but the problem will +most likely occur if it is not. +</p><p> +In order to serve profiles successfully to Windows 2000 SP2 +clients (when not operating as a PDC), Samba must have +<a class="indexterm" name="id2975922"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>nt acl support</tt></i> = no +added to the file share which houses the roaming profiles. +If this is not done, then the Windows 2000 SP2 client will +complain about not being able to access the profile (Access +Denied) and create multiple copies of it on disk (DOMAIN.user.001, +DOMAIN.user.002, and so on). See the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> man page +for more details on this option. Also note that the +<a class="indexterm" name="id2975950"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>nt acl support</tt></i> parameter was formally a global parameter in +releases prior to Samba 2.2.2. +</p><p> +<link linkend="minimalprofile"> provides a minimal profile share. +</p><div class="example"><a name="minimalprofile"></a><p class="title"><b>Example 38.1. Minimal profile share</b></p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td> </td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>[profile]</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>path = /export/profile</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>create mask = 0600</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>directory mask = 0700</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>nt acl support = no</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>read only = no</tt></i></td></tr></table></div><p> +The reason for this bug is that the Windows 200x SP2 client copies +the security descriptor for the profile that contains +the Samba server's SID, and not the domain SID. The client +compares the SID for SAMBA\user and realizes it is +different from the one assigned to DOMAIN\user. Hence, the reason +for the <span class="errorname">access denied</span> message. +</p><p> +By disabling the <a class="indexterm" name="id2976065"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>nt acl support</tt></i> parameter, Samba will send +the Windows 200x client a response to the QuerySecurityDescriptor trans2 call, which causes the client +to set a default ACL for the profile. This default ACL includes: +</p><p><span class="emphasis"><em>DOMAIN\user “<span class="quote">Full Control</span>”</em></span>></p><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p>This bug does not occur when using Winbind to +create accounts on the Samba host for Domain users.</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2976103"></a>Windows NT 3.1</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p>If you have problems communicating across routers with Windows +NT 3.1 workstations, read <ulink url="http://support.microsoft.com/default.aspx?scid=kb;Q103765">this Microsoft Knowledge Base article.</ulink> + +</p></div></div><div class="navfooter"><hr><table width="100%" summary="Navigation footer"><tr><td width="40%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="Portability.html">Prev</a> </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="u" href="Appendixes.html">Up</a></td><td width="40%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="speed.html">Next</a></td></tr><tr><td width="40%" align="left" valign="top">Chapter 37. Portability </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="h" href="index.html">Home</a></td><td width="40%" align="right" valign="top"> Chapter 39. Samba Performance Tuning</td></tr></table></div></body></html> diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/PolicyMgmt.html b/docs/htmldocs/PolicyMgmt.html new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..4adc7b6860 --- /dev/null +++ b/docs/htmldocs/PolicyMgmt.html @@ -0,0 +1,294 @@ +<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>Chapter 23. System and Account Policies</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.60.1"><link rel="home" href="index.html" title="SAMBA Project Documentation"><link rel="up" href="optional.html" title="Part III. Advanced Configuration"><link rel="previous" href="AdvancedNetworkManagement.html" title="Chapter 22. Advanced Network Management"><link rel="next" href="ProfileMgmt.html" title="Chapter 24. Desktop Profile Management"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="navheader"><table width="100%" summary="Navigation header"><tr><th colspan="3" align="center">Chapter 23. System and Account Policies</th></tr><tr><td width="20%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="AdvancedNetworkManagement.html">Prev</a> </td><th width="60%" align="center">Part III. Advanced Configuration</th><td width="20%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="ProfileMgmt.html">Next</a></td></tr></table><hr></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="PolicyMgmt"></a>Chapter 23. System and Account Policies</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">John</span> <span class="othername">H.</span> <span class="surname">Terpstra</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org">jht@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><p class="pubdate">April 3 2003</p></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="PolicyMgmt.html#id2953044">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="PolicyMgmt.html#id2953137">Creating and Managing System Policies</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="PolicyMgmt.html#id2953271">Windows 9x/ME Policies</a></dt><dt><a href="PolicyMgmt.html#id2953383">Windows NT4-Style Policy Files</a></dt><dt><a href="PolicyMgmt.html#id2953525">MS Windows 200x/XP Professional Policies</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="PolicyMgmt.html#id2953826">Managing Account/User Policies</a></dt><dt><a href="PolicyMgmt.html#id2953985">Management Tools</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="PolicyMgmt.html#id2954000">Samba Editreg Toolset</a></dt><dt><a href="PolicyMgmt.html#id2954096">Windows NT4/200x</a></dt><dt><a href="PolicyMgmt.html#id2954120">Samba PDC</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="PolicyMgmt.html#id2954165">System Startup and Logon Processing Overview</a></dt><dt><a href="PolicyMgmt.html#id2954310">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="PolicyMgmt.html#id2954324">Policy Does Not Work</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></div><p> +This chapter summarizes the current state of knowledge derived from personal +practice and knowledge from Samba mailing list subscribers. Before reproduction +of posted information, every effort has been made to validate the information given. +Where additional information was uncovered through this validation it is provided +also. +</p><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2953044"></a>Features and Benefits</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +When MS Windows NT 3.5 was introduced, the hot new topic was the ability to implement +Group Policies for users and groups. Then along came MS Windows NT4 and a few sites +started to adopt this capability. How do we know that? By the number of “<span class="quote">booboos</span>” +(or mistakes) administrators made and then requested help to resolve. +</p><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2953070"></a> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2953078"></a> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2953087"></a> +By the time that MS Windows 2000 and Active Directory was released, administrators +got the message: Group Policies are a good thing! They can help reduce administrative +costs and actually make happier users. But adoption of the true +potential of MS Windows 200x Active Directory and Group Policy Objects (GPOs) for users +and machines were picked up on rather slowly. This was obvious from the Samba +mailing list as in 2000 and 2001 when there were few postings regarding GPOs and +how to replicate them in a Samba environment. +</p><p> +Judging by the traffic volume since mid 2002, GPOs have become a standard part of +the deployment in many sites. This chapter reviews techniques and methods that can +be used to exploit opportunities for automation of control over user desktops and +network client workstations. +</p><p> +A tool new to Samba the <b class="command">editreg</b> tool + may become an important part of the future Samba administrators' +arsenal is described in this document. +</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2953137"></a>Creating and Managing System Policies</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +Under MS Windows platforms, particularly those following the release of MS Windows +NT4 and MS Windows 95, it is possible to create a type of file that would be placed +in the NETLOGON share of a Domain Controller. As the client logs onto the network, +this file is read and the contents initiate changes to the registry of the client +machine. This file allows changes to be made to those parts of the registry that +affect users, groups of users, or machines. +</p><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2953161"></a> +For MS Windows 9x/ME, this file must be called <tt class="filename">Config.POL</tt> and may +be generated using a tool called <tt class="filename">poledit.exe</tt>, better known as the +Policy Editor. The policy editor was provided on the Windows 98 installation CD, but +disappeared again with the introduction of MS Windows Me (Millennium Edition). From +comments of MS Windows network administrators, it would appear that this tool became +a part of the MS Windows Me Resource Kit. +</p><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2953195"></a> +MS Windows NT4 Server products include the <span class="emphasis"><em>System Policy Editor</em></span> +under <span class="guimenu">Start -> Programs -> Administrative Tools</span>. +For MS Windows NT4 and later clients, this file must be called <tt class="filename">NTConfig.POL</tt>. +</p><p> +New with the introduction of MS Windows 2000 was the Microsoft Management Console +or MMC. This tool is the new wave in the ever-changing landscape of Microsoft +methods for management of network access and security. Every new Microsoft product +or technology seems to make the old rules obsolete and introduces newer and more +complex tools and methods. To Microsoft's credit, the MMC does appear to +be a step forward, but improved functionality comes at a great price. +</p><p> +Before embarking on the configuration of network and system policies, it is highly +advisable to read the documentation available from Microsoft's Web site regarding +<ulink url="http://www.microsoft.com/ntserver/management/deployment/planguide/prof_policies.asp"> +Implementing Profiles and Policies in Windows NT 4.0</ulink> available from Microsoft. +There are a large number of documents in addition to this old one that should also +be read and understood. Try searching on the Microsoft Web site for “<span class="quote">Group Policies</span>”. +</p><p> +What follows is a brief discussion with some helpful notes. The information provided +here is incomplete you are warned. +</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2953271"></a>Windows 9x/ME Policies</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + You need the Windows 98 Group Policy Editor to set up Group Profiles under Windows 9x/ME. + It can be found on the original full product Windows 98 installation CD under + <tt class="filename">tools/reskit/netadmin/poledit</tt>. Install this using the + Add/Remove Programs facility and then click on <span class="guiicon">Have Disk</span>. + </p><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2953305"></a> + Use the Group Policy Editor to create a policy file that specifies the location of + user profiles and/or <tt class="filename">My Documents</tt>, and so on. Then save these + settings in a file called <tt class="filename">Config.POL</tt> that needs to be placed in the + root of the <i class="parameter"><tt>[NETLOGON]</tt></i> share. If Windows 98 is configured to log onto + the Samba Domain, it will automatically read this file and update the Windows 9x/Me registry + of the machine as it logs on. + </p><p> + Further details are covered in the Windows 98 Resource Kit documentation. + </p><p> + If you do not take the correct steps, then every so often Windows 9x/ME will check the + integrity of the registry and restore its settings from the back-up + copy of the registry it stores on each Windows 9x/ME machine. So, you will + occasionally notice things changing back to the original settings. + </p><p> + Install the group policy handler for Windows 9x/Me to pick up Group Policies. Look on the + Windows 98 CDROM in <tt class="filename">\tools\reskit\netadmin\poledit</tt>. + Install group policies on a Windows 9x/Me client by double-clicking on + <tt class="filename">grouppol.inf</tt>. Log off and on again a couple of times and see + if Windows 98 picks up Group Policies. Unfortunately, this needs to be done on every + Windows 9x/Me machine that uses Group Policies. + </p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2953383"></a>Windows NT4-Style Policy Files</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + To create or edit <tt class="filename">ntconfig.pol</tt> you must use the NT Server + Policy Editor, <b class="command">poledit.exe</b>, which is included with NT4 Server + but not with NT Workstation. There is a Policy Editor on an NT4 + Workstation but it is not suitable for creating domain policies. + Furthermore, although the Windows 95 Policy Editor can be installed on an NT4 + Workstation/Server, it will not work with NT clients. However, the files from + the NT Server will run happily enough on an NT4 Workstation. + </p><p> + You need <tt class="filename">poledit.exe</tt>, <tt class="filename">common.adm</tt> and <tt class="filename">winnt.adm</tt>. + It is convenient to put the two <tt class="filename">*.adm</tt> files in the <tt class="filename">c:\winnt\inf</tt> + directory, which is where the binary will look for them unless told otherwise. This + directory is normally “<span class="quote">hidden.</span>” + </p><p> + The Windows NT policy editor is also included with the Service Pack 3 (and + later) for Windows NT 4.0. Extract the files using <b class="command">servicepackname /x</b>, + that's <b class="command">Nt4sp6ai.exe /x</b> for service pack 6a. The Policy Editor, + <b class="command">poledit.exe</b>, and the associated template files (*.adm) should + be extracted as well. It is also possible to downloaded the policy template + files for Office97 and get a copy of the Policy Editor. Another possible + location is with the Zero Administration Kit available for download from Microsoft. + </p><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2953495"></a>Registry Spoiling</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> + With NT4-style registry-based policy changes, a large number of settings are not + automatically reversed as the user logs off. The settings that were in the + <tt class="filename">NTConfig.POL</tt> file were applied to the client machine registry and apply to the + hive key HKEY_LOCAL_MACHINE are permanent until explicitly reversed. This is known + as tattooing. It can have serious consequences downstream and the administrator must + be extremely careful not to lock out the ability to manage the machine at a later date. + </p></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2953525"></a>MS Windows 200x/XP Professional Policies</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + Windows NT4 system policies allow the setting of registry parameters specific to + users, groups and computers (client workstations) that are members of the NT4-style + domain. Such policy files will work with MS Windows 200x/XP clients also. + </p><p> + New to MS Windows 2000, Microsoft recently introduced a style of group policy that confers + a superset of capabilities compared with NT4-style policies. Obviously, the tool used + to create them is different, and the mechanism for implementing them is much improved. + </p><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2953554"></a> + The older NT4-style registry-based policies are known as <span class="emphasis"><em>Administrative Templates</em></span> + in MS Windows 2000/XP Group Policy Objects (GPOs). The later includes the ability to set various security + configurations, enforce Internet Explorer browser settings, change and redirect aspects of the + users desktop (including the location of <tt class="filename">My Documents</tt> files (directory), as + well as intrinsics of where menu items will appear in the Start menu). An additional new + feature is the ability to make available particular software Windows applications to particular + users and/or groups. + </p><p> + Remember, NT4 policy files are named <tt class="filename">NTConfig.POL</tt> and are stored in the root + of the NETLOGON share on the Domain Controllers. A Windows NT4 user enters a username, password + and selects the domain name to which the logon will attempt to take place. During the logon process, + the client machine reads the <tt class="filename">NTConfig.POL</tt> file from the NETLOGON share on + the authenticating server and modifies the local registry values according to the settings in this file. + </p><p> + Windows 200x GPOs are feature-rich. They are not stored in the NETLOGON share, but rather part of + a Windows 200x policy file is stored in the Active Directory itself and the other part is stored + in a shared (and replicated) volume called the SYSVOL folder. This folder is present on all Active + Directory Domain Controllers. The part that is stored in the Active Directory itself is called the + Group Policy Container (GPC), and the part that is stored in the replicated share called SYSVOL is + known as the Group Policy Template (GPT). + </p><p> + With NT4 clients, the policy file is read and executed only as each user logs onto the network. + MS Windows 200x policies are much more complex GPOs are processed and applied at client machine + startup (machine specific part) and when the user logs onto the network, the user-specific part + is applied. In MS Windows 200x-style policy management, each machine and/or user may be subject + to any number of concurrently applicable (and applied) policy sets (GPOs). Active Directory allows + the administrator to also set filters over the policy settings. No such equivalent capability + exists with NT4-style policy files. + </p><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2953643"></a>Administration of Windows 200x/XP Policies</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2953655"></a> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2953663"></a> + Instead of using the tool called <span class="application">The System Policy Editor</span>, commonly called Poledit (from the + executable name <b class="command">poledit.exe</b>), <span class="acronym">GPOs</span> are created and managed using a + <span class="application">Microsoft Management Console</span> <span class="acronym">(MMC)</span> snap-in as follows:</p><div class="procedure"><ol type="1"><li><p> + Go to the Windows 200x/XP menu <span class="guimenu">Start->Programs->Administrative Tools</span> + and select the MMC snap-in called <span class="guimenuitem">Active Directory Users and Computers</span> + </p></li><li><p> + Select the domain or organizational unit (OU) that you wish to manage, then right-click + to open the context menu for that object, and select the <span class="guibutton">Properties</span>. + </p></li><li><p> + Left-click on the <span class="guilabel">Group Policy</span> tab, then + left-click on the New tab. Type a name + for the new policy you will create. + </p></li><li><p> + Left-click on the <span class="guilabel">Edit</span> tab to commence the steps needed to create the GPO. + </p></li></ol></div><p> + All policy configuration options are controlled through the use of policy administrative + templates. These files have an .adm extension, both in NT4 as well as in Windows 200x/XP. + Beware, however, the .adm files are not interchangeable across NT4 and Windows 200x. + The latter introduces many new features as well as extended definition capabilities. It is + well beyond the scope of this documentation to explain how to program .adm files; for that + the administrator is referred to the Microsoft Windows Resource Kit for your particular + version of MS Windows. + </p><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p> + The MS Windows 2000 Resource Kit contains a tool called gpolmig.exe. This tool can be used + to migrate an NT4 NTConfig.POL file into a Windows 200x style GPO. Be VERY careful how you + use this powerful tool. Please refer to the resource kit manuals for specific usage information. + </p></div></div></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2953826"></a>Managing Account/User Policies</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +Policies can define a specific user's settings or the settings for a group of users. The resulting +policy file contains the registry settings for all users, groups, and computers that will be using +the policy file. Separate policy files for each user, group, or computer are not necessary. +</p><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2953848"></a> +If you create a policy that will be automatically downloaded from validating Domain Controllers, +you should name the file <tt class="filename">NTConfig.POL</tt>. As system administrator, you have the option of renaming the +policy file and, by modifying the Windows NT-based workstation, directing the computer to update +the policy from a manual path. You can do this by either manually changing the registry or by using +the System Policy Editor. This can even be a local path such that each machine has its own policy file, +but if a change is necessary to all machines, it must be made individually to each workstation. +</p><p> +When a Windows NT4/200x/XP machine logs onto the network, the client looks in the NETLOGON share on +the authenticating domain controller for the presence of the NTConfig.POL file. If one exists it is +downloaded, parsed and then applied to the user's part of the registry. +</p><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2953887"></a> +MS Windows 200x/XP clients that log onto an MS Windows Active Directory security domain may additionally +acquire policy settings through Group Policy Objects (GPOs) that are defined and stored in Active Directory +itself. The key benefit of using AS GPOs is that they impose no registry <span class="emphasis"><em>spoiling</em></span> effect. +This has considerable advantage compared with the use of <tt class="filename">NTConfig.POL</tt> (NT4) style policy updates. +</p><p> +In addition to user access controls that may be imposed or applied via system and/or group policies +in a manner that works in conjunction with user profiles, the user management environment under +MS Windows NT4/200x/XP allows per domain as well as per user account restrictions to be applied. +Common restrictions that are frequently used include: +</p><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2953928"></a> +</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li>Logon hours</li><li>Password aging</li><li>Permitted logon from certain machines only</li><li>Account type (local or global)</li><li>User rights</li></ul></div><p> +</p><p> +Samba-3.0.0 doe not yet implement all account controls that are common to MS Windows NT4/200x/XP. +While it is possible to set many controls using the Domain User Manager for MS Windows NT4, only password +expirey is functional today. Most of the remaining controls at this time have only stub routines +that may eventually be completed to provide actual control. Do not be misled by the fact that a +parameter can be set using the NT4 Domain User Manager or in the <tt class="filename">NTConfig.POL</tt>. +</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2953985"></a>Management Tools</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +Anyone who wishes to create or manage Group Policies will need to be familiar with a number of tools. +The following sections describe a few key tools that will help you to create a low maintenance user +environment. +</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2954000"></a>Samba Editreg Toolset</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2954011"></a> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2954020"></a> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2954028"></a> + A new tool called <b class="command">editreg</b> is under development. This tool can be used + to edit registry files (called <tt class="filename">NTUser.DAT</tt>) that are stored in user + and group profiles. <tt class="filename">NTConfig.POL</tt> files have the same structure as the + <tt class="filename">NTUser.DAT</tt> file and can be edited using this tool. <b class="command">editreg</b> + is being built with the intent to enable <tt class="filename">NTConfig.POL</tt> files to be saved in text format and to + permit the building of new <tt class="filename">NTConfig.POL</tt> files with extended capabilities. It is proving difficult + to realize this capability, so do not be surprised if this feature does not materialize. Formal + capabilities will be announced at the time that this tool is released for production use. + </p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2954096"></a>Windows NT4/200x</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + The tools that may be used to configure these types of controls from the MS Windows environment are: + the NT4 User Manager for Domains, the NT4 System and Group Policy Editor, and the Registry Editor (regedt32.exe). + Under MS Windows 200x/XP, this is done using the Microsoft Management Console (MMC) with appropriate + “<span class="quote">snap-ins,</span>” the registry editor, and potentially also the NT4 System and Group Policy Editor. + </p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2954120"></a>Samba PDC</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + With a Samba Domain Controller, the new tools for managing user account and policy information include: + <b class="command">smbpasswd</b>, <b class="command">pdbedit</b>, <b class="command">net</b>, <b class="command">rpcclient</b>. + The administrator should read the man pages for these tools and become familiar with their use. + </p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2954165"></a>System Startup and Logon Processing Overview</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +The following attempts to document the order of processing the system and user policies following a system +reboot and as part of the user logon: +</p><div class="orderedlist"><ol type="1"><li><p> + Network starts, then Remote Procedure Call System Service (RPCSS) and Multiple Universal Naming + Convention Provider (MUP) start. + </p></li><li><p> + Where Active Directory is involved, an ordered list of Group Policy Objects (GPOs) is downloaded + and applied. The list may include GPOs that: +</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Apply to the location of machines in a Directory.</p></li><li><p>Apply only when settings have changed.</p></li><li><p>Depend on configuration of the scope of applicability: local, + site, domain, organizational unit, and so on.</p></li></ul></div><p> + No desktop user interface is presented until the above have been processed. + </p></li><li><p> + Execution of start-up scripts (hidden and synchronous by default). + </p></li><li><p> + A keyboard action to effect start of logon (Ctrl-Alt-Del). + </p></li><li><p> + User credentials are validated, user profile is loaded (depends on policy settings). + </p></li><li><p> + An ordered list of user GPOs is obtained. The list contents depends on what is configured in respect of: + +</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li>Is the user a Domain Member, thus subject to particular policies?</li><li>Loopback enablement, and the state of the loopback policy (Merge or Replace).</li><li>Location of the Active Directory itself.</li><li>Has the list of GPOs changed? No processing is needed if not changed.</li></ul></div><p> + </p></li><li><p> + User Policies are applied from Active Directory. Note: There are several types. + </p></li><li><p> + Logon scripts are run. New to Windows 200x and Active Directory, logon scripts may be obtained based on Group + Policy objects (hidden and executed synchronously). NT4-style logon scripts are then run in a normal + window. + </p></li><li><p> + The User Interface as determined from the GPOs is presented. Note: In a Samba domain (like an NT4 + Domain), machine (system) policies are applied at start-up; user policies are applied at logon. + </p></li></ol></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2954310"></a>Common Errors</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +Policy-related problems can be quite difficult to diagnose and even more difficult to rectify. The following +collection demonstrates only basic issues. +</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2954324"></a>Policy Does Not Work</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +“<span class="quote">We have created the <tt class="filename">Config.POL</tt> file and put it in the <span class="emphasis"><em>NETLOGON</em></span> share. +It has made no difference to our Win XP Pro machines, they just do not see it. It worked fine with Win 98 but does not +work any longer since we upgraded to Win XP Pro. Any hints?</span>” +</p><p> +Policy files are not portable between Windows 9x/Me and MS Windows NT4/200x/XP-based platforms. You need to +use the NT4 Group Policy Editor to create a file called <tt class="filename">NTConfig.POL</tt> so it is in the +correct format for your MS Windows XP Pro clients. +</p></div></div></div><div class="navfooter"><hr><table width="100%" summary="Navigation footer"><tr><td width="40%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="AdvancedNetworkManagement.html">Prev</a> </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="u" href="optional.html">Up</a></td><td width="40%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="ProfileMgmt.html">Next</a></td></tr><tr><td width="40%" align="left" valign="top">Chapter 22. Advanced Network Management </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="h" href="index.html">Home</a></td><td width="40%" align="right" valign="top"> Chapter 24. Desktop Profile Management</td></tr></table></div></body></html> diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/Portability.html b/docs/htmldocs/Portability.html new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..3451a8bd17 --- /dev/null +++ b/docs/htmldocs/Portability.html @@ -0,0 +1,132 @@ +<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>Chapter 37. Portability</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.60.1"><link rel="home" href="index.html" title="SAMBA Project Documentation"><link rel="up" href="Appendixes.html" title="Part VI. Appendixes"><link rel="previous" href="compiling.html" title="Chapter 36. How to Compile Samba"><link rel="next" href="Other-Clients.html" title="Chapter 38. Samba and Other CIFS Clients"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="navheader"><table width="100%" summary="Navigation header"><tr><th colspan="3" align="center">Chapter 37. Portability</th></tr><tr><td width="20%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="compiling.html">Prev</a> </td><th width="60%" align="center">Part VI. Appendixes</th><td width="20%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="Other-Clients.html">Next</a></td></tr></table><hr></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="Portability"></a>Chapter 37. Portability</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Jelmer</span> <span class="othername">R.</span> <span class="surname">Vernooij</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">The Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jelmer@samba.org">jelmer@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">John</span> <span class="othername">H.</span> <span class="surname">Terpstra</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org">jht@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="Portability.html#id2974513">HPUX</a></dt><dt><a href="Portability.html#id2974600">SCO UNIX</a></dt><dt><a href="Portability.html#id2974655">DNIX</a></dt><dt><a href="Portability.html#id2974825">Red Hat Linux</a></dt><dt><a href="Portability.html#id2974869">AIX</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="Portability.html#id2974876">Sequential Read Ahead</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="Portability.html#id2974902">Solaris</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="Portability.html#id2974909">Locking Improvements</a></dt><dt><a href="Portability.html#winbind-solaris9">Winbind on Solaris 9</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></div><p>Samba works on a wide range of platforms but the interface all the +platforms provide is not always compatible. This chapter contains +platform-specific information about compiling and using Samba.</p><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2974513"></a>HPUX</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +HP's implementation of supplementary groups is non-standard (for +historical reasons). There are two group files, <tt class="filename">/etc/group</tt> and +<tt class="filename">/etc/logingroup</tt>; the system maps UIDs to numbers using the former, but +initgroups() reads the latter. Most system admins who know the ropes +symlink <tt class="filename">/etc/group</tt> to <tt class="filename">/etc/logingroup</tt> +(hard link does not work for reasons too obtuse to go into here). initgroups() will complain if one of the +groups you're in in <tt class="filename">/etc/logingroup</tt> has what it considers to be an invalid +ID, which means outside the range <tt class="constant">[0..UID_MAX]</tt>, where <tt class="constant">UID_MAX</tt> is (I think) +60000 currently on HP-UX. This precludes -2 and 65534, the usual <tt class="constant">nobody</tt> +GIDs. +</p><p> +If you encounter this problem, make sure the programs that are failing +to initgroups() are run as users, not in any groups with GIDs outside the +allowed range. +</p><p>This is documented in the HP manual pages under setgroups(2) and passwd(4). +</p><p> +On HP-UX you must use gcc or the HP ANSI compiler. The free compiler +that comes with HP-UX is not ANSI compliant and cannot compile Samba. +</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2974600"></a>SCO UNIX</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +If you run an old version of SCO UNIX, you may need to get important +TCP/IP patches for Samba to work correctly. Without the patch, you may +encounter corrupt data transfers using Samba. +</p><p> +The patch you need is UOD385 Connection Drivers SLS. It is available from +SCO (<ulink url="ftp://ftp.sco.com/">ftp.sco.com</ulink>, directory SLS, +files uod385a.Z and uod385a.ltr.Z). +</p><p> +The information provided here refers to an old version of SCO UNIX. If you require +binaries for more recent SCO UNIX products, please contact SCO to obtain packages that are +ready to install. You should also verify with SCO that your platform is up-to-date for the +binary packages you will install. This is important if you wish to avoid data corruption +problems with your installation. To build Samba for SCO UNIX products may +require significant patching of Samba source code. It is much easier to obtain binary +packages directly from SCO. +</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2974655"></a>DNIX</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +DNIX has a problem with seteuid() and setegid(). These routines are +needed for Samba to work correctly, but they were left out of the DNIX +C library for some reason. +</p><p> +For this reason Samba by default defines the macro NO_EID in the DNIX +section of includes.h. This works around the problem in a limited way, +but it is far from ideal, and some things still will not work right. +</p><p> +To fix the problem properly, you need to assemble the following two +functions and then either add them to your C library or link them into +Samba. Put the following in the file <tt class="filename">setegid.s</tt>: +</p><pre class="programlisting"> + .globl _setegid +_setegid: + moveq #47,d0 + movl #100,a0 + moveq #1,d1 + movl 4(sp),a1 + trap #9 + bccs 1$ + jmp cerror +1$: + clrl d0 + rts +</pre><p> +Put this in the file <tt class="filename">seteuid.s</tt>: +</p><pre class="programlisting"> + .globl _seteuid +_seteuid: + moveq #47,d0 + movl #100,a0 + moveq #0,d1 + movl 4(sp),a1 + trap #9 + bccs 1$ + jmp cerror +1$: + clrl d0 + rts +</pre><p> +After creating the above files, you then assemble them using +</p><pre class="screen"> +<tt class="prompt">$ </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>as seteuid.s</tt></b> +<tt class="prompt">$ </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>as setegid.s</tt></b> +</pre><p> +that should produce the files <tt class="filename">seteuid.o</tt> and +<tt class="filename">setegid.o</tt> +</p><p> +Then you need to add these to the LIBSM line in the DNIX section of +the Samba Makefile. Your LIBSM line will then look something like this: +</p><pre class="programlisting"> +LIBSM = setegid.o seteuid.o -ln +</pre><p> +You should then remove the line: +</p><pre class="programlisting"> +#define NO_EID +</pre><p>from the DNIX section of <tt class="filename">includes.h</tt>.</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2974825"></a>Red Hat Linux</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +By default during installation, some versions of Red Hat Linux add an +entry to <tt class="filename">/etc/hosts</tt> as follows: +</p><pre class="programlisting"> + 127.0.0.1 loopback "hostname"."domainname" +</pre><p> +</p><p> +This causes Samba to loop back onto the loopback interface. +The result is that Samba fails to communicate correctly with +the world and therefore may fail to correctly negotiate who +is the master browse list holder and who is the master browser. +</p><p> +Corrective Action: Delete the entry after the word "loopback" +in the line starting 127.0.0.1. +</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2974869"></a>AIX</h2></div></div><div></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2974876"></a>Sequential Read Ahead</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +Disabling Sequential Read Ahead using <b class="userinput"><tt>vmtune -r 0</tt></b> improves +Samba performance significantly. +</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2974902"></a>Solaris</h2></div></div><div></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2974909"></a>Locking Improvements</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>Some people have been experiencing problems with F_SETLKW64/fcntl +when running Samba on Solaris. The built-in file locking mechanism was +not scalable. Performance would degrade to the point where processes would +get into loops of trying to lock a file. It would try a lock, then fail, +then try again. The lock attempt was failing before the grant was +occurring. So the visible manifestation of this would be a handful of +processes stealing all of the CPU, and when they were trussed they would +be stuck if F_SETLKW64 loops. +</p><p> +Sun released patches for Solaris 2.6, 8, and 9. The patch for Solaris 7 +has not been released yet. +</p><p> +The patch revision for 2.6 is 105181-34, for 8 is 108528-19 and for 9 is 112233-04. +</p><p> +After the install of these patches, it is recommended to reconfigure +and rebuild Samba. +</p><p>Thanks to Joe Meslovich for reporting this.</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="winbind-solaris9"></a>Winbind on Solaris 9</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +Nsswitch on Solaris 9 refuses to use the Winbind NSS module. This behavior +is fixed by Sun in patch 113476-05, which as of March 2003, is not in any +roll-up packages. +</p></div></div></div><div class="navfooter"><hr><table width="100%" summary="Navigation footer"><tr><td width="40%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="compiling.html">Prev</a> </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="u" href="Appendixes.html">Up</a></td><td width="40%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="Other-Clients.html">Next</a></td></tr><tr><td width="40%" align="left" valign="top">Chapter 36. How to Compile Samba </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="h" href="index.html">Home</a></td><td width="40%" align="right" valign="top"> Chapter 38. Samba and Other CIFS Clients</td></tr></table></div></body></html> diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/ProfileMgmt.html b/docs/htmldocs/ProfileMgmt.html new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..9947526194 --- /dev/null +++ b/docs/htmldocs/ProfileMgmt.html @@ -0,0 +1,443 @@ +<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>Chapter 24. Desktop Profile Management</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.60.1"><link rel="home" href="index.html" title="SAMBA Project Documentation"><link rel="up" href="optional.html" title="Part III. Advanced Configuration"><link rel="previous" href="PolicyMgmt.html" title="Chapter 23. System and Account Policies"><link rel="next" href="pam.html" title="Chapter 25. PAM-Based Distributed Authentication"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="navheader"><table width="100%" summary="Navigation header"><tr><th colspan="3" align="center">Chapter 24. Desktop Profile Management</th></tr><tr><td width="20%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="PolicyMgmt.html">Prev</a> </td><th width="60%" align="center">Part III. Advanced Configuration</th><td width="20%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="pam.html">Next</a></td></tr></table><hr></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="ProfileMgmt"></a>Chapter 24. Desktop Profile Management</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">John</span> <span class="othername">H.</span> <span class="surname">Terpstra</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org">jht@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><p class="pubdate">April 3 2003</p></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="ProfileMgmt.html#id2954425">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="ProfileMgmt.html#id2954459">Roaming Profiles</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="ProfileMgmt.html#id2954500">Samba Configuration for Profile Handling</a></dt><dt><a href="ProfileMgmt.html#id2955058">Windows Client Profile Configuration Information</a></dt><dt><a href="ProfileMgmt.html#id2956404">Sharing Profiles between W9x/Me and NT4/200x/XP Workstations</a></dt><dt><a href="ProfileMgmt.html#id2956492">Profile Migration from Windows NT4/200x Server to Samba</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="ProfileMgmt.html#id2956822">Mandatory Profiles</a></dt><dt><a href="ProfileMgmt.html#id2956917">Creating and Managing Group Profiles</a></dt><dt><a href="ProfileMgmt.html#id2956970">Default Profile for Windows Users</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="ProfileMgmt.html#id2956999">MS Windows 9x/Me</a></dt><dt><a href="ProfileMgmt.html#id2957150">MS Windows NT4 Workstation</a></dt><dt><a href="ProfileMgmt.html#id2957772">MS Windows 200x/XP</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="ProfileMgmt.html#id2958338">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="ProfileMgmt.html#id2958351">Configuring Roaming Profiles for a Few Users or Groups</a></dt><dt><a href="ProfileMgmt.html#id2958416">Cannot Use Roaming Profiles</a></dt><dt><a href="ProfileMgmt.html#id2958626">Changing the Default Profile</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2954425"></a>Features and Benefits</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +Roaming profiles are feared by some, hated by a few, loved by many, and a Godsend for +some administrators. +</p><p> +Roaming profiles allow an administrator to make available a consistent user desktop +as the user moves from one machine to another. This chapter provides much information +regarding how to configure and manage roaming profiles. +</p><p> +While roaming profiles might sound like nirvana to some, they are a real and tangible +problem to others. In particular, users of mobile computing tools, where often there may not +be a sustained network connection, are often better served by purely local profiles. +This chapter provides information to help the Samba administrator deal with those +situations. +</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2954459"></a>Roaming Profiles</h2></div></div><div></div></div><div class="warning" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Warning</h3><p> +Roaming profiles support is different for Windows 9x/Me and Windows NT4/200x. +</p></div><p> +Before discussing how to configure roaming profiles, it is useful to see how +Windows 9x/Me and Windows NT4/200x clients implement these features. +</p><p> +Windows 9x/Me clients send a NetUserGetInfo request to the server to get the user's +profiles location. However, the response does not have room for a separate +profiles location field, only the user's home share. This means that Windows 9x/Me +profiles are restricted to being stored in the user's home directory. +</p><p> +Windows NT4/200x clients send a NetSAMLogon RPC request, which contains many fields +including a separate field for the location of the user's profiles. +</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2954500"></a>Samba Configuration for Profile Handling</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +This section documents how to configure Samba for MS Windows client profile support. +</p><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2954513"></a>NT4/200x User Profiles</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> +For example, to support Windows NT4/200x clients, set the followoing in the [global] section of the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file: +</p><p> +</p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>logon path = \\profileserver\profileshare\profilepath\%U\moreprofilepath</tt></i></td></tr></table><p> + +This is typically implemented like: + +</p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>logon path = \\%L\Profiles\%u</tt></i></td></tr></table><p> +where “<span class="quote">%L</span>” translates to the name of the Samba server and “<span class="quote">%u</span>” translates to the user name. +</p><p> +The default for this option is <tt class="filename">\\%N\%U\profile</tt>, namely <tt class="filename">\\sambaserver\username\profile</tt>. +The <tt class="filename">\\N%\%U</tt> service is created automatically by the [homes] service. If you are using +a Samba server for the profiles, you must make the share that is specified in the logon path +browseable. Please refer to the man page for <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> in respect of the different +semantics of “<span class="quote">%L</span>” and “<span class="quote">%N</span>”, as well as “<span class="quote">%U</span>” and “<span class="quote">%u</span>”. +</p><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p> +MS Windows NT/200x clients at times do not disconnect a connection to a server between logons. It is recommended +to not use the <i class="parameter"><tt>homes</tt></i> meta-service name as part of the profile share path. +</p></div></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2954652"></a>Windows 9x/Me User Profiles</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> +To support Windows 9x/Me clients, you must use the <a class="indexterm" name="id2954664"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>logon home</tt></i> +parameter. Samba has been fixed so <b class="userinput"><tt>net use /home</tt></b> now works as well and it, too, relies +on the <b class="command">logon home</b> parameter. +</p><p> +By using the logon home parameter, you are restricted to putting Windows 9x/Me profiles in the user's home +directory. But wait! There is a trick you can use. If you set the following in the +<i class="parameter"><tt>[global]</tt></i> section of your <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file: +</p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>logon home = \\%L\%U\.profiles</tt></i></td></tr></table><p> +then your Windows 9x/Me clients will dutifully put their clients in a subdirectory +of your home directory called <tt class="filename">.profiles</tt> (making them hidden). +</p><p> +Not only that, but <b class="userinput"><tt>net use /home</tt></b> will also work because of a feature in +Windows 9x/Me. It removes any directory stuff off the end of the home directory area +and only uses the server and share portion. That is, it looks like you +specified <tt class="filename">\\%L\%U</tt> for <a class="indexterm" name="id2954767"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>logon home</tt></i>. +</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2954783"></a>Mixed Windows 9x/Me and Windows NT4/200x User Profiles</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> +You can support profiles for Windows 9x and Windows NT clients by setting both the +<a class="indexterm" name="id2954795"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>logon home</tt></i> and <a class="indexterm" name="id2954809"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>logon path</tt></i> parameters. For example: +</p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>logon home = \\%L\%u\.profiles</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>logon path = \\%L\profiles\%u</tt></i></td></tr></table></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2954850"></a>Disabling Roaming Profile Support</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> +A question often asked is: “<span class="quote">How may I enforce use of local profiles?</span>” or +“<span class="quote">How do I disable roaming profiles?</span>” +</p><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2954876"></a> +There are three ways of doing this: +<a class="indexterm" name="id2954885"></a> +</p><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">In <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt></span></dt><dd><p> + Affect the following settings and ALL clients will be forced to use a local profile: + <a class="indexterm" name="id2954920"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>logon home</tt></i> and <a class="indexterm" name="id2954933"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>logon path</tt></i> + </p></dd><dt><span class="term">MS Windows Registry</span></dt><dd><p> + By using the Microsoft Management Console gpedit.msc to instruct your MS Windows XP + machine to use only a local profile. This, of course, modifies registry settings. The full + path to the option is: +</p><pre class="screen"> +Local Computer Policy\ + Computer Configuration\ + Administrative Templates\ + System\ + User Profiles\ + +Disable: Only Allow Local User Profiles +Disable: Prevent Roaming Profile Change from Propagating to the Server +</pre><p> + </p></dd><dt><span class="term">Change of Profile Type:</span></dt><dd><p>From the start menu right-click on <span class="guiicon">My Computer icon</span>, + select <span class="guimenuitem">Properties</span>, click on the <span class="guilabel">User Profiles</span> + tab, select the profile you wish to change from + <span class="guimenu">Roaming</span> type to <span class="guimenu">Local</span>, and click on + <span class="guibutton">Change Type</span>. + </p></dd></dl></div><p> +Consult the MS Windows registry guide for your particular MS Windows version for more information +about which registry keys to change to enforce use of only local user profiles. +</p><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p> +The specifics of how to convert a local profile to a roaming profile, or a roaming profile +to a local one vary according to the version of MS Windows you are running. Consult the Microsoft MS +Windows Resource Kit for your version of Windows for specific information. +</p></div></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2955058"></a>Windows Client Profile Configuration Information</h3></div></div><div></div></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2955066"></a>Windows 9x/Me Profile Setup</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> +When a user first logs in on Windows 9X, the file user.DAT is created, as are folders +<tt class="filename">Start Menu</tt>, <tt class="filename">Desktop</tt>, <tt class="filename">Programs</tt>, and +<tt class="filename">Nethood</tt>. These directories and their contents will be merged with the local +versions stored in <tt class="filename">c:\windows\profiles\username</tt> on subsequent logins, taking the +most recent from each. You will need to use the <i class="parameter"><tt>[global]</tt></i> options +<a class="indexterm" name="id2955121"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>preserve case</tt></i> = yes, +<a class="indexterm" name="id2955136"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>short preserve case</tt></i> = yes and +<a class="indexterm" name="id2955150"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>case sensitive</tt></i> = no +in order to maintain capital letters in shortcuts in any of the profile folders. +</p><p> +The <tt class="filename">user.DAT</tt> file contains all the user's preferences. If you wish to enforce a set of preferences, +rename their <tt class="filename">user.DAT</tt> file to <tt class="filename">user.MAN</tt>, and deny them write access to this file. +</p><div class="orderedlist"><ol type="1"><li><p> + On the Windows 9x/Me machine, go to <span class="guimenu">Control Panel</span> -> + <span class="guimenuitem">Passwords</span> and select the <span class="guilabel">User Profiles</span> tab. + Select the required level of roaming preferences. Press <span class="guibutton">OK</span>, but do not + allow the computer to reboot. + </p></li><li><p> + On the Windows 9x/Me machine, go to <span class="guimenu">Control Panel</span> -> + <span class="guimenuitem">Network</span> -> <span class="guimenuitem">Client for Microsoft Networks</span> + -> <span class="guilabel">Preferences</span>. Select <span class="guilabel">Log on to NT Domain</span>. Then, + ensure that the Primary Logon is <span class="guilabel">Client for Microsoft Networks</span>. Press + <span class="guibutton">OK</span>, and this time allow the computer to reboot. + </p></li></ol></div><p> Under Windows 9x/ME, profiles are downloaded from the Primary Logon. If you have the Primary Logon +as “<span class="quote">Client for Novell Networks</span>”, then the profiles and logon script will be downloaded from +your Novell Server. If you have the Primary Logon as “<span class="quote">Windows Logon</span>”, then the profiles will +be loaded from the local machine a bit against the concept of roaming profiles, it would seem! </p><p> +You will now find that the Microsoft Networks Login box contains <tt class="constant">[user, password, domain]</tt> instead +of just <tt class="constant">[user, password]</tt>. Type in the Samba server's domain name (or any other domain known to exist, +but bear in mind that the user will be authenticated against this domain and profiles downloaded from it, +if that domain logon server supports it), user name and user's password. +</p><p> Once the user has been successfully validated, the Windows 9x/Me machine will inform you that +<tt class="computeroutput">The user has not logged on before</tt> and asks you <tt class="computeroutput">Do you +wish to save the user's preferences?</tt> Select <span class="guibutton">Yes</span>. </p><p> Once the Windows 9x/Me client comes up with the desktop, you should be able to examine the +contents of the directory specified in the <a class="indexterm" name="id2955374"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>logon path</tt></i> on +the Samba server and verify that the <tt class="filename">Desktop</tt>, <tt class="filename">Start Menu</tt>, +<tt class="filename">Programs</tt> and <tt class="filename">Nethood</tt> folders have been created. </p><p> These folders will be cached locally on the client, and updated when the user logs off (if +you haven't made them read-only by then). You will find that if the user creates further folders or +shortcut, that the client will merge the profile contents downloaded with the contents of the profile +directory already on the local client, taking the newest folders and shortcut from each set. </p><p> If you have made the folders/files read-only on the Samba server, then you will get errors from +the Windows 9x/Me machine on logon and logout as it attempts to merge the local and remote profile. +Basically, if you have any errors reported by the Windows 9x/Me machine, check the UNIX file permissions +and ownership rights on the profile directory contents, on the Samba server. </p><p> If you have problems creating user profiles, you can reset the user's local desktop cache, as +shown below. When this user next logs in, the user will be told that he/she is logging in “<span class="quote">for + the first time</span>”. + +<a class="indexterm" name="id2955451"></a> + </p><div class="orderedlist"><ol type="1"><li><p> + Instead of logging in under the [user, password, domain] dialog, press <span class="guibutton">escape</span>. + </p></li><li><p> + Run the <b class="command">regedit.exe</b> program, and look in: + </p><p> + <tt class="filename">HKEY_LOCAL_MACHINE\Windows\CurrentVersion\ProfileList</tt> + </p><p> + You will find an entry for each user of ProfilePath. Note the contents of this key + (likely to be <tt class="filename">c:\windows\profiles\username</tt>), then delete the key + <i class="parameter"><tt>ProfilePath</tt></i> for the required user. + </p></li><li><p> + Exit the registry editor. + </p></li><li><p> + Search for the user's .PWL password-caching file in the <tt class="filename">c:\windows</tt> directory, and delete it. + </p></li><li><p> + Log off the Windows 9x/Me client. + </p></li><li><p> + Check the contents of the profile path (see <a class="indexterm" name="id2955562"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>logon path</tt></i> + described above) and delete the <tt class="filename">user.DAT</tt> or <tt class="filename">user.MAN</tt> + file for the user, making a backup if required. + </p></li></ol></div><div class="warning" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Warning</h3><p> +Before deleting the contents of the directory listed in the <i class="parameter"><tt>ProfilePath</tt></i> +(this is likely to be <tt class="filename">c:\windows\profiles\username)</tt>, ask the owner if they have +any important files stored on their desktop or in their start menu. Delete the contents of the +directory <i class="parameter"><tt>ProfilePath</tt></i> (making a backup if any of the files are needed). +</p><p> +This will have the effect of removing the local (read-only hidden system file) <tt class="filename">user.DAT</tt> +in their profile directory, as well as the local “<span class="quote">desktop,</span>” “<span class="quote">nethood,</span>” +“<span class="quote">start menu,</span>” and “<span class="quote">programs</span>” folders. +</p></div><p> +If all else fails, increase Samba's debug log levels to between 3 and 10, and/or run a packet +sniffer program such as ethereal or <b class="command">netmon.exe</b>, and look for error messages. +</p><p> If you have access to an Windows NT4/200x server, then first set up roaming profiles and/or +netlogons on the Windows NT4/200x server. Make a packet trace, or examine the example packet traces +provided with Windows NT4/200x server, and see what the differences are with the equivalent Samba trace. +</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2955678"></a>Windows NT4 Workstation</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> When a user first logs in to a Windows NT Workstation, the profile NTuser.DAT is created. The profile +location can be now specified through the <a class="indexterm" name="id2955691"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>logon path</tt></i> parameter. +</p><p> There is a parameter that is now available for use with NT Profiles: <a class="indexterm" name="id2955710"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>logon drive</tt></i>. +This should be set to <tt class="filename">H:</tt> or any other drive, and should be used in conjunction with +the new <a class="indexterm" name="id2955733"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>logon home</tt></i> parameter. </p><p> The entry for the NT4 profile is a directory not a file. The NT help on Profiles mentions that a +directory is also created with a .PDS extension. The user, while logging in, must have write permission +to create the full profile path (and the folder with the .PDS extension for those situations where it +might be created.) </p><p> In the profile directory, Windows NT4 creates more folders than Windows 9x/Me. It creates +<tt class="filename">Application Data</tt> and others, as well as <tt class="filename">Desktop</tt>, +<tt class="filename">Nethood</tt>, <tt class="filename">Start Menu,</tt> and <tt class="filename">Programs</tt>. +The profile itself is stored in a file <tt class="filename">NTuser.DAT</tt>. Nothing appears to be stored +in the .PDS directory, and its purpose is currently unknown. </p><p> You can use the <span class="application">System Control Panel</span> to copy a local profile onto +a Samba server (see NT Help on Profiles; it is also capable of firing up the correct location in the +<span class="application">System Control Panel</span> for you). The NT Help file also mentions that renaming +<tt class="filename">NTuser.DAT</tt> to <tt class="filename">NTuser.MAN</tt> turns a profile into a mandatory one. +</p><p> The case of the profile is significant. The file must be called <tt class="filename">NTuser.DAT</tt> +or, for a mandatory profile, <tt class="filename">NTuser.MAN</tt>. </p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2955863"></a>Windows 2000/XP Professional</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> You must first convert the profile from a local profile to a domain profile on the MS Windows +workstation as follows: </p><div class="procedure"><ol type="1"><li><p> Log on as the <span class="emphasis"><em>local</em></span> workstation administrator. </p></li><li><p> Right-click on the <span class="guiicon">My Computer</span> Icon, select + <span class="guimenuitem">Properties</span>.</p></li><li><p> Click on the <span class="guilabel">User Profiles</span> tab.</p></li><li><p> Select the profile you wish to convert (click it once).</p></li><li><p> Click on the <span class="guibutton">Copy To</span> button.</p></li><li><p> In the <span class="guilabel">Permitted to use</span> box, click on the + <span class="guibutton">Change</span> button. </p></li><li><p> Click on the <span class="guilabel">Look in</span> area that lists the machine name. When you click here, it will + open up a selection box. Click on the domain to which the profile must be accessible. </p><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p>You will need to log on if a logon box opens up. + For example, connect as <i class="replaceable"><tt>DOMAIN</tt></i>\root, password: + <i class="replaceable"><tt>mypassword</tt></i>.</p></div></li><li><p> To make the profile capable of being used by anyone, select “<span class="quote">Everyone</span>”. </p></li><li><p> Click on <span class="guibutton">OK</span> and the Selection box will close. </p></li><li><p> Now click on <span class="guibutton">OK</span> to create the profile in the path + you nominated. </p></li></ol></div><p> Done. You now have a profile that can be edited using the Samba <b class="command">profiles</b> tool. +</p><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p> +Under Windows NT/200x, the use of mandatory profiles forces the use of MS Exchange storage of mail +data and keeps it out of the desktop profile. That keeps desktop profiles from becoming unusable. +</p></div><div class="sect4" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h5 class="title"><a name="id2956079"></a>Windows XP Service Pack 1</h5></div></div><div></div></div><p> + There is a security check new to Windows XP (or maybe only Windows XP service pack 1). + It can be disabled via a group policy in the Active Directory. The policy is called: + </p><p> + <tt class="filename">Computer Configuration\Administrative Templates\System\User Profiles\Do not check for + user ownership of Roaming Profile Folders</tt>i + </p><p> + This should be set to <tt class="constant">Enabled</tt>. + </p><p> + Does the new version of Samba have an Active Directory analogue? If so, then you may be able to set the policy through this. + </p><p>If you cannot set group policies in Samba, then you may be able to set the policy locally on + each machine. If you want to try this, then do the following (N.B. I do not know for sure that this + will work in the same way as a domain group policy): + </p><div class="procedure"><ol type="1"><li><p>On the XP workstation, log in with an Administrative account.</p></li><li><p>Click on <span class="guimenu">Start</span> -> <span class="guimenuitem">Run</span>.</p></li><li><p>Type <b class="command">mmc</b>.</p></li><li><p>Click on <span class="guibutton">OK</span>.</p></li><li><p>A Microsoft Management Console should appear.</p></li><li><p>Click on <span class="guimenu">File</span> -> <span class="guimenuitem">Add/Remove Snap-in</span> -> <span class="guimenuitem">Add</span>.</p></li><li><p>Double-click on <span class="guiicon">Group Policy</span>.</p></li><li><p>Click on <span class="guibutton">Finish</span> -> <span class="guibutton">Close</span>.</p></li><li><p>Click on <span class="guibutton">OK</span>.</p></li><li><p>In the “<span class="quote">Console Root</span>” window expand <span class="guiicon">Local Computer Policy</span> -> + <span class="guiicon">Computer Configuration</span> -> <span class="guiicon">Administrative Templates</span> -> <span class="guiicon">System</span> -> <span class="guiicon">User Profiles</span>.</p></li><li><p>Double-click on <span class="guilabel">Do not check for user ownership of Roaming Profile Folders</span>.</p></li><li><p>Select <span class="guilabel">Enabled</span>.</p></li><li><p>Click on <span class="guibutton">OK</span>.</p></li><li><p>Close the whole console. You do not need to save the settings (this refers to the + console settings rather than the policies you have changed).</p></li><li><p>Reboot.</p></li></ol></div></div></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2956404"></a>Sharing Profiles between W9x/Me and NT4/200x/XP Workstations</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> Sharing of desktop profiles between Windows versions is not recommended. Desktop profiles are an +evolving phenomenon and profiles for later versions of MS Windows clients add features that may interfere +with earlier versions of MS Windows clients. Probably the more salient reason to not mix profiles is +that when logging off an earlier version of MS Windows, the older format of profile contents may overwrite +information that belongs to the newer version resulting in loss of profile information content when that +user logs on again with the newer version of MS Windows. </p><p> If you then want to share the same Start Menu/Desktop with W9x/Me, you will need to specify a common +location for the profiles. The <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> parameters that need to be common are <a class="indexterm" name="id2956443"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>logon path</tt></i> and <a class="indexterm" name="id2956457"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>logon home</tt></i>. </p><p> If you have this set up correctly, you will find separate <tt class="filename">user.DAT</tt> and +<tt class="filename">NTuser.DAT</tt> files in the same profile directory. </p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2956492"></a>Profile Migration from Windows NT4/200x Server to Samba</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> There is nothing to stop you from specifying any path that you like for the location of users' profiles. +Therefore, you could specify that the profile be stored on a Samba server, or any other SMB server, +as long as that SMB server supports encrypted passwords. </p><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2956509"></a>Windows NT4 Profile Management Tools</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> Unfortunately, the Resource Kit information is specific to the version of MS Windows NT4/200x. The +correct resource kit is required for each platform. </p><p>Here is a quick guide:</p><div class="procedure"><ol type="1"><li><p> On your NT4 Domain Controller, right click on <span class="guiicon">My Computer</span>, then select the + tab labeled <span class="guilabel">User Profiles</span>. </p></li><li><p> Select a user profile you want to migrate and click on it. </p><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p>I am using the term “<span class="quote">migrate</span>” loosely. You can copy a profile to create a group + profile. You can give the user <i class="parameter"><tt>Everyone</tt></i> rights to the profile you copy this to. That + is what you need to do, since your Samba domain is not a member of a trust relationship with your NT4 + PDC.</p></div></li><li><p>Click on the <span class="guibutton">Copy To</span> button.</p></li><li><p>In the box labeled <span class="guilabel">Copy Profile to</span> add your new path, e.g., + <tt class="filename">c:\temp\foobar</tt></p></li><li><p>Click on <span class="guibutton">Change</span> in the <span class="guilabel">Permitted to use</span> box.</p></li><li><p>Click on the group “<span class="quote">Everyone</span>”, click on <span class="guibutton">OK</span>. This + closes the “<span class="quote">choose user</span>” box.</p></li><li><p>Now click on <span class="guibutton">OK</span>.</p></li></ol></div><p> Follow the above for every profile you need to migrate. </p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2956689"></a>Side Bar Notes</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2956700"></a> +You should obtain the SID of your NT4 domain. You can use smbpasswd to do this. Read the man +page.</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2956712"></a>moveuser.exe</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> The Windows 200x professional resource kit has <b class="command">moveuser.exe</b>. <b class="command">moveuser.exe</b> changes the security of a profile +from one user to another. This allows the account domain to change, and/or the user name to change.</p><p> +This command is like the Samba <b class="command">profiles</b> tool. +</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2956753"></a>Get SID</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2956764"></a> +You can identify the SID by using <b class="command">GetSID.exe</b> from the Windows NT Server 4.0 Resource Kit. </p><p> Windows NT 4.0 stores the local profile information in the registry under the following key: +<tt class="filename">HKEY_LOCAL_MACHINE\SOFTWARE\Microsoft\Windows NT\CurrentVersion\ProfileList</tt> </p><p> Under the ProfileList key, there will be subkeys named with the SIDs of the users who have logged +on to this computer. (To find the profile information for the user whose locally cached profile you want +to move, find the SID for the user with the <b class="command">GetSID.exe</b> utility.) Inside the appropriate user's subkey, +you will see a string value named <i class="parameter"><tt>ProfileImagePath</tt></i>. </p></div></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2956822"></a>Mandatory Profiles</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2956832"></a> +A Mandatory Profile is a profile that the user does not have the ability to overwrite. During the +user's session, it may be possible to change the desktop environment, however, as the user logs out all changes +made will be lost. If it is desired to not allow the user any ability to change the desktop environment, +then this must be done through policy settings. See the previous chapter. </p><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p> +Under NO circumstances should the profile directory (or its contents) be made read-only +as this may render the profile un-usable. Where it is essential to make a profile read-only +within the UNIX file system, this can be done but then you absolutely must use the <b class="command">fake-permissions</b> +VFS module to instruct MS Windows NT/200x/XP clients that the Profile has write permission for the user. See <link linkend="fakeperms">. +</p></div><p> For MS Windows NT4/200x/XP, the above method can also be used to create mandatory profiles. To +convert a group profile into a mandatory profile, simply locate the <tt class="filename">NTUser.DAT</tt> file in the copied profile +and rename it to <tt class="filename">NTUser.MAN</tt>. </p><p> For MS Windows 9x/ME, it is the <tt class="filename">User.DAT</tt> file that must be renamed to +<tt class="filename">User.MAN</tt> to effect a mandatory profile. </p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2956917"></a>Creating and Managing Group Profiles</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2956929"></a> +Most organizations are arranged into departments. There is a nice benefit in this fact since usually +most users in a department require the same desktop applications and the same desktop layout. MS +Windows NT4/200x/XP will allow the use of Group Profiles. A Group Profile is a profile that is created +first using a template (example) user. Then using the profile migration tool (see above), the profile is +assigned access rights for the user group that needs to be given access to the group profile. </p><p> The next step is rather important. Instead of assigning a group profile to users (Using User Manager) +on a “<span class="quote">per user</span>” basis, the group itself is assigned the now modified profile. </p><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p> Be careful with Group Profiles. If the user who is a member of a group also has a personal +profile, then the result will be a fusion (merge) of the two. </p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2956970"></a>Default Profile for Windows Users</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2956982"></a> +MS Windows 9x/Me and NT4/200x/XP will use a default profile for any user for whom a profile +does not already exist. Armed with a knowledge of where the default profile is located on the Windows +workstation, and knowing which registry keys effect the path from which the default profile is created, +it is possible to modify the default profile to one that has been optimized for the site. This has +significant administrative advantages. </p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2956999"></a>MS Windows 9x/Me</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> To enable default per use profiles in Windows 9x/ME, you can either use the <span class="application">Windows +98 System Policy Editor</span> or change the registry directly. </p><p> To enable default per user profiles in Windows 9x/ME, launch the <span class="application">System Policy +Editor</span>, then select <span class="guimenu">File</span> -> <span class="guimenuitem">Open Registry</span>, +next click on the <span class="guiicon">Local Computer</span> icon, click on <span class="guilabel">Windows 98 System</span>, +select <span class="guilabel">User Profiles</span>, and click on the enable box. Remember to save the registry +changes. </p><p> To modify the registry directly, launch the <span class="application">Registry Editor</span> +(<b class="command">regedit.exe</b>) and select the hive <tt class="filename">HKEY_LOCAL_MACHINE\Network\Logon</tt>. Now +add a DWORD type key with the name “<span class="quote">User Profiles,</span>” to +enable user profiles to set the value +to 1; to disable user profiles set it to 0. </p><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2957101"></a>User Profile Handling with Windows 9x/Me</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> When a user logs on to a Windows 9x/Me machine, the local profile path, +<tt class="filename">HKEY_LOCAL_MACHINE\Software\Microsoft\Windows\CurrentVersion\ProfileList</tt>, is checked +for an existing entry for that user. </p><p> If the user has an entry in this registry location, Windows 9x/Me checks for a locally cached +version of the user profile. Windows 9x/Me also checks the user's home directory (or other specified +directory if the location has been modified) on the server for the User Profile. If a profile exists +in both locations, the newer of the two is used. If the User Profile exists on the server, but does not +exist on the local machine, the profile on the server is downloaded and used. If the User Profile only +exists on the local machine, that copy is used. </p><p> If a User Profile is not found in either location, the Default User Profile from the Windows +9x/Me machine is used and copied to a newly created folder for the logged on user. At log off, any +changes that the user made are written to the user's local profile. If the user has a roaming profile, +the changes are written to the user's profile on the server. </p></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2957150"></a>MS Windows NT4 Workstation</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> On MS Windows NT4, the default user profile is obtained from the location +<tt class="filename">%SystemRoot%\Profiles</tt> which in a default installation will translate to +<tt class="filename">C:\Windows NT\Profiles</tt>. Under this directory on a clean install there will be three +(3) directories: <tt class="filename">Administrator</tt>, <tt class="filename">All +Users,</tt> and <tt class="filename">Default +User</tt>. </p><p> The <tt class="filename">All Users</tt> directory contains menu settings that are common across all +system users. The <tt class="filename">Default User</tt> directory contains menu entries that are customizable +per user depending on the profile settings chosen/created. </p><p> When a new user first logs onto an MS Windows NT4 machine, a new profile is created from: </p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>All Users settings.</p></li><li><p>Default User settings (contains the default <tt class="filename">NTUser.DAT</tt> file).</p></li></ul></div><p> When a user logs onto an MS Windows NT4 machine that is a member of a Microsoft security domain, + the following steps are followed in respect of profile handling: + +<a class="indexterm" name="id2957258"></a> +</p><div class="procedure"><ol type="1"><li><p> The users' account information that is obtained during the logon process + contains the location of the users' desktop profile. The profile path may be local to + the machine or it may be located on a network share. If there exists a profile at the + location of the path from the user account, then this profile is copied to the location + <tt class="filename">%SystemRoot%\Profiles\%USERNAME%</tt>. This profile then inherits the settings + in the <tt class="filename">All Users</tt> profile in the <tt class="filename">%SystemRoot%\Profiles</tt> + location. </p></li><li><p> If the user account has a profile path, but at its location a profile does not + exist, then a new profile is created in the <tt class="filename">%SystemRoot%\Profiles\%USERNAME%</tt> + directory from reading the <tt class="filename">Default User</tt> profile. </p></li><li><p> If the NETLOGON share on the authenticating server (logon server) contains + a policy file (<tt class="filename">NTConfig.POL</tt>), then its contents are applied to the + <tt class="filename">NTUser.DAT</tt> which is applied to the <tt class="filename">HKEY_CURRENT_USER</tt> + part of the registry. + </p></li><li><p> When the user logs out, if the profile is set to be a roaming profile it will be + written out to the location of the profile. The <tt class="filename">NTuser.DAT</tt> file is then + recreated from the contents of the <tt class="filename">HKEY_CURRENT_USER</tt> contents. Thus, + should there not exist in the NETLOGON share an <tt class="filename">NTConfig.POL</tt> at the next + logon, the effect of the previous <tt class="filename">NTConfig.POL</tt> will still be held in the + profile. The effect of this is known as tattooing. + </p></li></ol></div><p> MS Windows NT4 profiles may be <span class="emphasis"><em>local</em></span> or <span class="emphasis"><em>roaming</em></span>. A local +profile will stored in the <tt class="filename">%SystemRoot%\Profiles\%USERNAME%</tt> location. A roaming +profile will also remain stored in the same way, unless the following registry key is created as shown: </p><pre class="screen"> HKEY_LOCAL_MACHINE\SYSTEM\Software\Microsoft\Windows NT\CurrentVersion\ +winlogon\"DeleteRoamingCache"=dword:0000000 + </pre><p> +In this case, the local copy (in <tt class="filename">%SystemRoot%\Profiles\%USERNAME%</tt>) will be deleted +on logout.</p><p> Under MS Windows NT4, default locations for common resources like <tt class="filename">My Documents</tt> +may be redirected to a network share by modifying the following registry keys. These changes may be +affected via use of the System Policy Editor. To do so may require that you create your own template +extension for the policy editor to allow this to be done through the GUI. Another way to do this is by +way of first creating a default user profile, then while logged in as that user, run <b class="command">regedt32</b> to edit +the key settings. </p><p> +The Registry Hive key that affects the behavior of folders that are part of the default user +profile are controlled by entries on Windows NT4 is: +</p><pre class="screen"> +HKEY_CURRENT_USER + \Software + \Microsoft + \Windows + \CurrentVersion + \Explorer + \User Shell Folders +</pre><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2957503"></a> +</p><p> The above hive key contains a list of automatically managed folders. The default entries are shown in <link linkend="ProfileLocs">. </p><div class="table"><a name="ProfileLocs"></a><p class="title"><b>Table 24.1. User Shell Folder Registry Keys Default Values</b></p><table summary="User Shell Folder Registry Keys Default Values" border="1"><colgroup><col align="left"><col align="left"></colgroup><thead><tr><th align="left">Name</th><th align="left">Default Value</th></tr></thead><tbody><tr><td align="left">AppData</td><td align="left">%USERPROFILE%\Application Data</td></tr><tr><td align="left">Desktop</td><td align="left">%USERPROFILE%\Desktop</td></tr><tr><td align="left">Favorites</td><td align="left">%USERPROFILE%\Favorites</td></tr><tr><td align="left">NetHood</td><td align="left">%USERPROFILE%\NetHood</td></tr><tr><td align="left">PrintHood</td><td align="left">%USERPROFILE%\PrintHood</td></tr><tr><td align="left">Programs</td><td align="left">%USERPROFILE%\Start Menu\Programs</td></tr><tr><td align="left">Recent</td><td align="left">%USERPROFILE%\Recent</td></tr><tr><td align="left">SendTo</td><td align="left">%USERPROFILE%\SendTo</td></tr><tr><td align="left">Start Menu </td><td align="left">%USERPROFILE%\Start Menu</td></tr><tr><td align="left">Startup</td><td align="left">%USERPROFILE%\Start Menu\Programs\Startup</td></tr></tbody></table></div><p> The registry key that contains the location of the default profile settings is: </p><p> <tt class="filename">HKEY_LOCAL_MACHINE\SOFTWARE\Microsoft\Windows\CurrentVersion\Explorer\ +User Shell Folders</tt> </p><p> The default entries are shown in <link linkend="regkeys">.</p><div class="table"><a name="regkeys"></a><p class="title"><b>Table 24.2. Defaults of Profile Settings Registry Keys</b></p><table summary="Defaults of Profile Settings Registry Keys" border="1"><colgroup><col align="left"><col align="left"></colgroup><tbody><tr><td align="left">Common Desktop</td><td align="left">%SystemRoot%\Profiles\All Users\Desktop</td></tr><tr><td align="left">Common Programs</td><td align="left">%SystemRoot%\Profiles\All Users\Programs</td></tr><tr><td align="left">Common Start Menu</td><td align="left">%SystemRoot%\Profiles\All Users\Start Menu</td></tr><tr><td align="left">Common Startup</td><td align="left">%SystemRoot%\Profiles\All Users\Start Menu\Programs\Startup</td></tr></tbody></table></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2957772"></a>MS Windows 200x/XP</h3></div></div><div></div></div><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2957786"></a> +MS Windows XP Home Edition does use default per user profiles, but cannot participate +in domain security, cannot log onto an NT/ADS-style domain, and thus can obtain the profile only +from itself. While there are benefits in doing this, the beauty of those MS Windows clients that +can participate in domain logon processes allows the administrator to create a global default +profile and enforce it through the use of Group Policy Objects (GPOs). +</p></div><p> When a new user first logs onto an MS Windows 200x/XP machine, the default profile is obtained from +<tt class="filename">C:\Documents and Settings\Default User</tt>. The administrator can modify or change the +contents of this location and MS Windows 200x/XP will gladly use it. This is far from the optimum arrangement +since it will involve copying a new default profile to every MS Windows 200x/XP client workstation. </p><p> When MS Windows 200x/XP participates in a domain security context, and if the default user profile is + not found, then the client will search for a default profile in the NETLOGON share of the authenticating + server. In MS Windows parlance,<tt class="filename">%LOGONSERVER%\NETLOGON\Default User,</tt> and if one +exists there it will copy this to the workstation to the <tt class="filename">C:\Documents and Settings\</tt> +under the Windows login name of the user. </p><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p> This path translates, in Samba parlance, to the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> +<i class="parameter"><tt>[NETLOGON]</tt></i> share. The directory should be created at the root +of this share and must be called <tt class="filename">Default Profile</tt>. </p></div><p> If a default profile does not exist in this location, then MS Windows 200x/XP will use the local +default profile. </p><p> On logging out, the users' desktop profile will be stored to the location specified in the registry +settings that pertain to the user. If no specific policies have been created or passed to the client +during the login process (as Samba does automatically), then the user's profile will be written to the +local machine only under the path <tt class="filename">C:\Documents and Settings\%USERNAME%</tt>. </p><p> Those wishing to modify the default behavior can do so through these three methods: </p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p> Modify the registry keys on the local machine manually and place the new + default profile in the NETLOGON share root. This is not recommended as it is maintenance intensive. + </p></li><li><p> Create an NT4-style NTConfig.POL file that specified this behavior and locate + this file in the root of the NETLOGON share along with the new default profile. </p></li><li><p> Create a GPO that enforces this through Active Directory, and place the new + default profile in the NETLOGON share. </p></li></ul></div><p>The registry hive key that effects the behavior of folders that are part of the default user +profile are controlled by entries on Windows 200x/XP is: </p><p> <tt class="filename">HKEY_CURRENT_USER\Software\Microsoft\Windows\CurrentVersion\Explorer\User Shell +Folders\</tt> </p><p> +The above hive key contains a list of automatically managed folders. The default entries are shown +in <link linkend="defregpthkeys"> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2957980"></a> +</p><div class="table"><a name="defregpthkeys"></a><p class="title"><b>Table 24.3. Defaults of Default User Profile Paths Registry Keys</b></p><table summary="Defaults of Default User Profile Paths Registry Keys" border="1"><colgroup><col align="left"><col align="left"></colgroup><thead><tr><th align="left">Name</th><th align="left">Default Value</th></tr></thead><tbody><tr><td align="left">AppData</td><td align="left">%USERPROFILE%\Application Data</td></tr><tr><td align="left">Cache</td><td align="left">%USERPROFILE%\Local Settings\Temporary Internet Files</td></tr><tr><td align="left">Cookies</td><td align="left">%USERPROFILE%\Cookies</td></tr><tr><td align="left">Desktop</td><td align="left">%USERPROFILE%\Desktop</td></tr><tr><td align="left">Favorites</td><td align="left">%USERPROFILE%\Favorites</td></tr><tr><td align="left">History</td><td align="left">%USERPROFILE%\Local Settings\History</td></tr><tr><td align="left">Local AppData</td><td align="left">%USERPROFILE%\Local Settings\Application Data</td></tr><tr><td align="left">Local Settings</td><td align="left">%USERPROFILE%\Local Settings</td></tr><tr><td align="left">My Pictures</td><td align="left">%USERPROFILE%\My Documents\My Pictures</td></tr><tr><td align="left">NetHood</td><td align="left">%USERPROFILE%\NetHood</td></tr><tr><td align="left">Personal</td><td align="left">%USERPROFILE%\My Documents</td></tr><tr><td align="left">PrintHood</td><td align="left">%USERPROFILE%\PrintHood</td></tr><tr><td align="left">Programs</td><td align="left">%USERPROFILE%\Start Menu\Programs</td></tr><tr><td align="left">Recent</td><td align="left">%USERPROFILE%\Recent</td></tr><tr><td align="left">SendTo</td><td align="left">%USERPROFILE%\SendTo</td></tr><tr><td align="left">Start Menu</td><td align="left">%USERPROFILE%\Start Menu</td></tr><tr><td align="left">Startup</td><td align="left">%USERPROFILE%\Start Menu\Programs\Startup</td></tr><tr><td align="left">Templates</td><td align="left">%USERPROFILE%\Templates</td></tr></tbody></table></div><p> There is also an entry called “<span class="quote">Default</span>” that has no value set. The default entry is +of type <tt class="constant">REG_SZ</tt>, all the others are of type <tt class="constant">REG_EXPAND_SZ</tt>. </p><p> It makes a huge difference to the speed of handling roaming user profiles if all the folders are +stored on a dedicated location on a network server. This means that it will not be necessary to write +the Outlook PST file over the network for every login and logout. </p><p> To set this to a network location, you could use the following examples: </p><p><tt class="filename">%LOGONSERVER%\%USERNAME%\Default Folders</tt></p><p> This would store the folders in the user's home directory under a directory called <tt class="filename">Default +Folders</tt>. You could also use: </p><p><tt class="filename">\\<i class="replaceable"><tt>SambaServer</tt></i>\<i class="replaceable"><tt>FolderShare</tt></i>\%USERNAME%</tt></p><p> +in which case the default folders will be stored in the server named <i class="replaceable"><tt>SambaServer</tt></i> +in the share called <i class="replaceable"><tt>FolderShare</tt></i> under a directory that has the name of the +MS Windows user as seen by the Linux/UNIX file system. </p><p> Please note that once you have created a default profile share, you MUST migrate a user's profile +(default or custom) to it. </p><p> MS Windows 200x/XP profiles may be <span class="emphasis"><em>Local</em></span> or <span class="emphasis"><em>Roaming</em></span>. + A roaming profile will be cached locally unless the following registry key is created: + +<a class="indexterm" name="id2958308"></a> +</p><p> </p><pre class="programlisting"> HKEY_LOCAL_MACHINE\SYSTEM\Software\Microsoft\Windows NT\CurrentVersion\ + winlogon\"DeleteRoamingCache"=dword:00000001</pre><p> +In this case, the local cache copy will be deleted on logout. +</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2958338"></a>Common Errors</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +The following are some typical errors, problems and questions that have been asked on the Samba mailing lists. +</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2958351"></a>Configuring Roaming Profiles for a Few Users or Groups</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +With Samba-2.2.x, the choice you have is to enable or disable roaming profiles support. It is a +global only setting. The default is to have roaming profiles and the default path will locate them in +the user's home directory. +</p><p> +If disabled globally, then no one will have roaming profile ability. If enabled and you want it +to apply only to certain machines, then on those machines on which roaming profile support is not wanted +it is then necessary to disable roaming profile handling in the registry of each such machine. +</p><p> +With Samba-3, you can have a global profile setting in <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> and you can override this by +per-user settings using the Domain User Manager (as with MS Windows NT4/ Win 200xx). </p><p> In any case, you can configure only one profile per user. That profile can be either: </p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li>A profile unique to that user.</li><li>A mandatory profile (one the user cannot change).</li><li>A group profile (really should be mandatory, that is unchangable).</li></ul></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2958416"></a>Cannot Use Roaming Profiles</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> A user requested the following: “<span class="quote"> I do not want Roaming profiles to be implemented. I want +to give users a local profile alone. Please help me, I am totally lost with this error. For the past +two days I tried everything, I googled around but found no useful pointers. Please help me. </span>”</p><p> The choices are: </p><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">Local profiles</span></dt><dd><p> I know of no registry keys that will allow + auto-deletion of LOCAL profiles on log out.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">Roaming profiles</span></dt><dd><p> As a user logs onto the network, a centrally + stored profile is copied to the workstation to form a local profile. This local profile + will persist (remain on the workstation disk) unless a registry key is changed that will + cause this profile to be automatically deleted on logout. </p></dd></dl></div><p>The roaming profile choices are: </p><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">Personal roaming profiles</span></dt><dd><p> These are typically stored in + a profile share on a central (or conveniently located local) server. </p><p> Workstations cache (store) a local copy of the profile. This cached + copy is used when the profile cannot be downloaded at next logon. </p></dd><dt><span class="term">Group profiles</span></dt><dd><p>These are loaded from a central profile + server.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">Mandatory profiles</span></dt><dd><p> Mandatory profiles can be created for + a user as well as for any group that a user is a member of. Mandatory profiles cannot be + changed by ordinary users. Only the administrator can change or reconfigure a mandatory + profile. </p></dd></dl></div><p> A Windows NT4/200x/XP profile can vary in size from 130KB to very large. Outlook PST files are +most often part of the profile and can be many GB in size. On average (in a well controlled environment), +roaming profile size of 2MB is a good rule of thumb to use for planning purposes. In an undisciplined +environment, I have seen up to 2GB profiles. Users tend to complain when it takes an hour to log onto a +workstation but they harvest the fruits of folly (and ignorance). </p><p> The point of all the above is to show that roaming profiles and good controls of how they can be +changed as well as good discipline make up for a problem-free site. </p><p> Microsoft's answer to the PST problem is to store all email in an MS Exchange Server backend. This +removes the need for a PST file. </p><p>Local profiles mean: </p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>If each machine is used by many users, then much local disk storage is needed + for local profiles.</p></li><li><p>Every workstation the user logs into has + its own profile; these can be very different from machine to machine.</p></li></ul></div><p> On the other hand, use of roaming profiles means: </p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>The network administrator can control the desktop environment of all users.</p></li><li><p>Use of mandatory profiles drastically reduces network management overheads.</p></li><li><p>In the long run, users will experience fewer problems.</p></li></ul></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2958626"></a>Changing the Default Profile</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>“<span class="quote">When the client logs onto the Domain Controller, it searches +for a profile to download. Where do I put this default profile?</span>”</p><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2958644"></a> +First, the Samba server needs to be configured as a Domain Controller. This can be done by +setting in <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt>: </p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>security = user</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>os level = 32 (or more)</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>domain logons = Yes</tt></i></td></tr></table><p> There must be a <i class="parameter"><tt>[netlogon]</tt></i> share that is world readable. It is +a good idea to add a logon script to pre-set printer and drive connections. There is also a facility +for automatically synchronizing the workstation time clock with that of the logon server (another good +thing to do). </p><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p> To invoke auto-deletion of roaming profile from the local workstation cache (disk storage), use +the <span class="application">Group Policy Editor</span> to create a file called <tt class="filename">NTConfig.POL</tt> +with the appropriate entries. This file needs to be located in the <i class="parameter"><tt>netlogon</tt></i> +share root directory.</p></div><p> Windows clients need to be members of the domain. Workgroup machines do not use network logons +so they do not interoperate with domain profiles. </p><p> For roaming profiles, add to <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt>: </p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>logon path = \\%N\profiles\%U</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td># Default logon drive is Z:</td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>logon drive = H:</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td># This requires a PROFILES share that is world writable.</td></tr></table></div></div></div><div class="navfooter"><hr><table width="100%" summary="Navigation footer"><tr><td width="40%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="PolicyMgmt.html">Prev</a> </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="u" href="optional.html">Up</a></td><td width="40%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="pam.html">Next</a></td></tr><tr><td width="40%" align="left" valign="top">Chapter 23. System and Account Policies </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="h" href="index.html">Home</a></td><td width="40%" align="right" valign="top"> Chapter 25. PAM-Based Distributed Authentication</td></tr></table></div></body></html> diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/SWAT.html b/docs/htmldocs/SWAT.html new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..d4c8b78dcf --- /dev/null +++ b/docs/htmldocs/SWAT.html @@ -0,0 +1,375 @@ +<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>Chapter 32. SWAT The Samba Web Administration Tool</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.60.1"><link rel="home" href="index.html" title="SAMBA Project Documentation"><link rel="up" href="migration.html" title="Part IV. Migration and Updating"><link rel="previous" href="NT4Migration.html" title="Chapter 31. Migration from NT4 PDC to Samba-3 PDC"><link rel="next" href="troubleshooting.html" title="Part V. Troubleshooting"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="navheader"><table width="100%" summary="Navigation header"><tr><th colspan="3" align="center">Chapter 32. SWAT The Samba Web Administration Tool</th></tr><tr><td width="20%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="NT4Migration.html">Prev</a> </td><th width="60%" align="center">Part IV. Migration and Updating</th><td width="20%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="troubleshooting.html">Next</a></td></tr></table><hr></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="SWAT"></a>Chapter 32. SWAT The Samba Web Administration Tool</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">John</span> <span class="othername">H.</span> <span class="surname">Terpstra</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org">jht@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><p class="pubdate">April 21, 2003</p></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="SWAT.html#id2967624">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="SWAT.html#id2967718">Guidelines and Technical Tips</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="SWAT.html#id2967733">Validate SWAT Installation</a></dt><dt><a href="SWAT.html#xinetd">Enabling SWAT for Use</a></dt><dt><a href="SWAT.html#id2968330">Securing SWAT through SSL</a></dt><dt><a href="SWAT.html#id2968458">Enabling SWAT Internationalization Support</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="SWAT.html#id2968628">Overview and Quick Tour</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="SWAT.html#id2968644">The SWAT Home Page</a></dt><dt><a href="SWAT.html#id2968718">Global Settings</a></dt><dt><a href="SWAT.html#id2968838">Share Settings</a></dt><dt><a href="SWAT.html#id2968902">Printers Settings</a></dt><dt><a href="SWAT.html#id2968967">The SWAT Wizard</a></dt><dt><a href="SWAT.html#id2969040">The Status Page</a></dt><dt><a href="SWAT.html#id2969092">The View Page</a></dt><dt><a href="SWAT.html#id2969115">The Password Change Page</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></div><p> +There are many and varied opinions regarding the usefulness of SWAT. +No matter how hard one tries to produce the perfect configuration tool, it remains +an object of personal taste. SWAT is a tool that will allow Web-based configuration +of Samba. It has a wizard that may help to get Samba configured +quickly, it has context-sensitive help on each <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> parameter, it provides for monitoring of current state +of connection information, and it allows network-wide MS Windows network password +management. +</p><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2967624"></a>Features and Benefits</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +SWAT is a facility that is part of the Samba suite. The main executable is called +<b class="command">swat</b> and is invoked by the inter-networking super daemon. +See <link linkend="xinetd"> for details. +</p><p> +SWAT uses integral samba components to locate parameters supported by the particular +version of Samba. Unlike tools and utilities that are external to Samba, SWAT is always +up to date as known Samba parameters change. SWAT provides context-sensitive help for each +configuration parameter, directly from <b class="command">man</b> page entries. +</p><p> +There are network administrators who believe that it is a good idea to write systems +documentation inside configuration files, and for them SWAT will aways be a nasty tool. SWAT +does not store the configuration file in any intermediate form, rather, it stores only the +parameter settings, so when SWAT writes the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file to disk, it will write only +those parameters that are at other than the default settings. The result is that all comments, +as well as parameters that are no longer supported, will be lost from the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file. +Additionally, the parameters will be written back in internal ordering. +</p><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p> +Before using SWAT, please be warned SWAT will completely replace your <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> with +a fully-optimized file that has been stripped of all comments you might have placed there +and only non-default settings will be written to the file. +</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2967718"></a>Guidelines and Technical Tips</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +This section aims to unlock the dark secrets behind how SWAT may be made to work, +may be made more secure, and how to solve Internationalization support problems. +</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2967733"></a>Validate SWAT Installation</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +The very first step that should be taken before attempting to configure a host +system for SWAT operation is to check that it is installed. This may seem a trivial +point to some, however several Linux distributions do not install SWAT by default, +even though they do ship an installable binary support package containing SWAT +on the distribution media. +</p><p> +When you have configrmed that SWAT is installed it is necessary to validate +that the installation includes the binary <b class="command">swat</b> file as well +as all the supporting text and Web files. A number of operating system distributions +in the past have failed to include the necessary support files, evne though the +<b class="command">swat</b> binary executable file was installed. +</p><p> +Finally, when you are sure that SWAT has been fully installed, please check the SWAT +has been enebled in the control file for the internetworking super-daemon (inetd or xinetd) +that is used on your operating system platform. +</p><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2967782"></a>Locating the <b class="command">swat</b> File</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> +To validate that SWAT is installed, first locate the <b class="command">swat</b> binary +file on the system. It may be found under the following directories: +</p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td><tt class="filename">/usr/local/samba/bin</tt> the default Samba location.</td></tr><tr><td><tt class="filename">/usr/sbin</tt> the default location on most Linux systems.</td></tr><tr><td><tt class="filename">/opt/samba/bin</tt></td></tr></table><p> +</p><p> +The actual location is much dependant on the choice of the operating system vendor, or as determined +by the administrator who compiled and installed Samba. +</p><p> +There are a number methods that may be used to locate the <b class="command">swat</b> binary file. +The following methods may be helpful: +</p><p> +If <b class="command">swat</b> is in your current operating system search path it will be easy to +find it. You can ask what are the command-line options for <b class="command">swat</b> as shown here: +</p><pre class="screen"> +frodo:~ # swat -? +Usage: swat [OPTION...] + -a, --disable-authentication Disable authentication (demo mode) + +Help options: + -?, --help Show this help message + --usage Display brief usage message + +Common samba options: + -d, --debuglevel=DEBUGLEVEL Set debug level + -s, --configfile=CONFIGFILE Use alternative configuration file + -l, --log-basename=LOGFILEBASE Basename for log/debug files + -V, --version Print version +</pre><p> +</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2967911"></a>Locating the SWAT Support Files</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> +Now that you have found that <b class="command">swat</b> is in the search path, it is easy +to identify where the file is located. Here is another simple way this may be done: +</p><pre class="screen"> +frodo:~ # whereis swat +swat: /usr/sbin/swat /usr/share/man/man8/swat.8.gz +</pre><p> +</p><p> +If the above measures fail to locate the <b class="command">swat</b> binary, another approach +is needed. The following may be used: +</p><pre class="screen"> +frodo:/ # find / -name swat -print +/etc/xinetd.d/swat +/usr/sbin/swat +/usr/share/samba/swat +frodo:/ # +</pre><p> +</p><p> +This list shows that there is a control file for <b class="command">xinetd</b>, the internetwork +super-daemon that is installed on this server. The location of the SWAT binary file is +<tt class="filename">/usr/sbin/swat</tt>, and the support files for it are located under the +directory <tt class="filename">/usr/share/samba/swat</tt>. +</p><p> +We must now check where <b class="command">swat</b> expects to find its support files. This can +be done as follows: +</p><pre class="screen"> +frodo:/ # strings /usr/sbin/swat | grep "/swat" +/swat/ +... +/usr/share/samba/swat +frodo:/ # +</pre><p> +</p><p> +The <tt class="filename">/usr/share/samba/swat/</tt> entry shown in this listing is the location of the +support files. You should verify that the support files exist under this directory. A sample +list is as shown: +</p><pre class="screen"> +jht@frodo:/> find /usr/share/samba/swat -print +/usr/share/samba/swat +/usr/share/samba/swat/help +/usr/share/samba/swat/lang +/usr/share/samba/swat/lang/ja +/usr/share/samba/swat/lang/ja/help +/usr/share/samba/swat/lang/ja/help/welcome.html +/usr/share/samba/swat/lang/ja/images +/usr/share/samba/swat/lang/ja/images/home.gif +... +/usr/share/samba/swat/lang/ja/include +/usr/share/samba/swat/lang/ja/include/header.nocss.html +... +/usr/share/samba/swat/lang/tr +/usr/share/samba/swat/lang/tr/help +/usr/share/samba/swat/lang/tr/help/welcome.html +/usr/share/samba/swat/lang/tr/images +/usr/share/samba/swat/lang/tr/images/home.gif +... +/usr/share/samba/swat/lang/tr/include +/usr/share/samba/swat/lang/tr/include/header.html +/usr/share/samba/swat/using_samba +... +/usr/share/samba/swat/images +/usr/share/samba/swat/images/home.gif +... +/usr/share/samba/swat/include +/usr/share/samba/swat/include/footer.html +/usr/share/samba/swat/include/header.html +jht@frodo:/> +</pre><p> +</p><p> +If the files needed are not available it will be necessary to obtain and install them +before SWAT can be used. +</p></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="xinetd"></a>Enabling SWAT for Use</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +SWAT should be installed to run via the network super-daemon. Depending on which system +your UNIX/Linux system has, you will have either an <b class="command">inetd</b>- or +<b class="command">xinetd</b>-based system. +</p><p> +The nature and location of the network super-daemon varies with the operating system +implementation. The control file (or files) can be located in the file +<tt class="filename">/etc/inetd.conf</tt> or in the directory <tt class="filename">/etc/[x]inet[d].d</tt> +or similar. +</p><p> +The control entry for the older style file might be: +<a class="indexterm" name="id2968135"></a> +</p><pre class="programlisting"> + # swat is the Samba Web Administration Tool + swat stream tcp nowait.400 root /usr/sbin/swat swat +</pre><p> +A control file for the newer style xinetd could be: +</p><p> +</p><pre class="programlisting"> +# default: off +# description: SWAT is the Samba Web Admin Tool. Use swat \ +# to configure your Samba server. To use SWAT, \ +# connect to port 901 with your favorite web browser. +service swat +{ + port = 901 + socket_type = stream + wait = no + only_from = localhost + user = root + server = /usr/sbin/swat + log_on_failure += USERID + disable = yes +} +</pre><p> + +</p><p> +Both of the above examples assume that the <b class="command">swat</b> binary has been +located in the <tt class="filename">/usr/sbin</tt> directory. In addition to the above, +SWAT will use a directory access point from which it will load its Help files +as well as other control information. The default location for this on most Linux +systems is in the directory <tt class="filename">/usr/share/samba/swat</tt>. The default +location using Samba defaults will be <tt class="filename">/usr/local/samba/swat</tt>. +</p><p> +Access to SWAT will prompt for a logon. If you log onto SWAT as any non-root user, +the only permission allowed is to view certain aspects of configuration as well as +access to the password change facility. The buttons that will be exposed to the non-root +user are: <span class="guibutton">HOME</span>, <span class="guibutton">STATUS</span>, <span class="guibutton">VIEW</span>, +<span class="guibutton">PASSWORD</span>. The only page that allows +change capability in this case is <span class="guibutton">PASSWORD</span>. +</p><p> +As long as you log onto SWAT as the user <span class="emphasis"><em>root</em></span>, you should obtain +full change and commit ability. The buttons that will be exposed include: +<span class="guibutton">HOME</span>, <span class="guibutton">GLOBALS</span>, <span class="guibutton">SHARES</span>, <span class="guibutton">PRINTERS</span>, +<span class="guibutton">WIZARD</span>, <span class="guibutton">STATUS</span>, <span class="guibutton">VIEW</span>, <span class="guibutton">PASSWORD</span>. +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2968330"></a>Securing SWAT through SSL</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2968341"></a> +Many people have asked about how to setup SWAT with SSL to allow for secure remote +administration of Samba. Here is a method that works, courtesy of Markus Krieger. +</p><p> +Modifications to the SWAT setup are as follows: +</p><div class="procedure"><ol type="1"><li><p> + Install OpenSSL. + </p></li><li><p> + Generate certificate and private key. + +</p><pre class="screen"> +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>/usr/bin/openssl req -new -x509 -days 365 -nodes -config \ + /usr/share/doc/packages/stunnel/stunnel.cnf \ + -out /etc/stunnel/stunnel.pem -keyout /etc/stunnel/stunnel.pem</tt></b> +</pre></li><li><p> + Remove swat-entry from [x]inetd. + </p></li><li><p> + Start <b class="command">stunnel</b>. + +</p><pre class="screen"> +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>stunnel -p /etc/stunnel/stunnel.pem -d 901 \ + -l /usr/local/samba/bin/swat swat </tt></b> +</pre></li></ol></div><p> +Afterward, simply connect to swat by using the URL <ulink url="https://myhost:901">https://myhost:901</ulink>, accept the certificate +and the SSL connection is up. +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2968458"></a>Enabling SWAT Internationalization Support</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +SWAT can be configured to display its messages to match the settings of +the language configurations of your Web browser. It will be passed to SWAT +in the Accept-Language header of the HTTP request. +</p><p> + +</p><p> +To enable this feature: +</p><p> + +</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p> + Install the proper <b class="command">msg</b> files from the Samba + <tt class="filename">source/po</tt> directory into $LIBDIR. + </p></li><li><p> + Set the correct locale value for <a class="indexterm" name="id2968509"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>display charset</tt></i>. + </p></li><li><p> + Set your browser's language setting. + </p></li></ul></div><p> + +</p><p> +The name of msg file is same as the language ID sent by the browser. For +example en means "English", ja means "Japanese", fr means "French. +</p><p> + +</p><p> +If you do not like some of messages, or there are no <b class="command">msg</b> files for +your locale, you can create them simply by copying the <b class="command">en.msg</b> files +to the dirertory for “<span class="quote">your language ID.msg</span>” and filling in proper strings +to each “<span class="quote">msgstr</span>”. For example, in <tt class="filename">it.msg</tt>, the +<b class="command">msg</b> file for the Italian locale, just set: +</p><pre class="screen"> +msgid "Set Default" +msgstr "Imposta Default" +</pre><p> +and so on. If you find a mistake or create a new <b class="command">msg</b> file, please email it +to us so we will include this in the next release of Samba. +</p><p> + +</p><p> +Note that if you enable this feature and the <a class="indexterm" name="id2968601"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>display charset</tt></i> is not +matched to your browser's setting, the SWAT display may be corrupted. In a future version of +Samba, SWAT will always display messages with UTF-8 encoding. You will then not need to set +this <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file parameter. +</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2968628"></a>Overview and Quick Tour</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +SWAT is a tools that many be used to configure Samba, or just to obtain useful links +to important reference materials such as the contents of this book, as well as other +documents that have been found useful for solving Windows networking problems. +</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2968644"></a>The SWAT Home Page</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +The SWAT title page provides access to the latest Samba documentation. The manual page for +each Samba component is accessible from this page, as are the Samba HOWTO-Collection (this +document) as well as the O'Reilly book “<span class="quote">Using Samba.</span>” +</p><p> +Administrators who wish to validate their Samba configuration may obtain useful information +from the man pages for the diagnostic utilities. These are available from the SWAT home page +also. One diagnostic tool that is not mentioned on this page, but that is particularly +useful is <ulink url="http://www.ethereal.com/">ethereal.</ulink> +</p><div class="warning" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Warning</h3><p> +SWAT can be configured to run in <span class="emphasis"><em>demo</em></span> mode. This is not recommended +as it runs SWAT without authentication and with full administrative ability. Allows +changes to <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> as well as general operation with root privileges. The option that +creates this ability is the <tt class="option">-a</tt> flag to swat. <span class="emphasis"><em>Do not use this in a +production environment.</em></span> +</p></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2968718"></a>Global Settings</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +The <span class="guibutton">GLOBALS</span> button will expose a page that allows configuration of the global parameters +in <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt>. There are two levels of exposure of the parameters: +</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p> + <span class="guibutton">Basic</span> exposes common configuration options. + </p></li><li><p> + <span class="guibutton">Advanced</span> exposes configuration options needed in more + complex environments. + </p></li></ul></div><p> +To switch to other than <span class="guibutton">Basic</span> editing ability, click on <span class="guibutton">Advanced</span>. +You may also do this by clicking on the radio button, then click on the <span class="guibutton">Commit Changes</span> button. +</p><p> +After making any changes to configuration parameters, make sure that +you click on the +<span class="guibutton">Commit Changes</span> button before moving to another area, otherwise +your changes will be lost. +</p><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p> +SWAT has context-sensitive help. To find out what each parameter is +for, simply click on the +<span class="guibutton">Help</span> link to the left of the configuration parameter. +</p></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2968838"></a>Share Settings</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +To effect a currently configured share, simply click on the pull down button between the +<span class="guibutton">Choose Share</span> and the <span class="guibutton">Delete Share</span> buttons, +select the share you wish to operate on, then to edit the settings +click on the +<span class="guibutton">Choose Share</span> button. To delete the share, simply press the +<span class="guibutton">Delete Share</span> button. +</p><p> +To create a new share, next to the button labeled <span class="guibutton">Create Share</span> enter +into the text field the name of the share to be created, then click on the +<span class="guibutton">Create Share</span> button. +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2968902"></a>Printers Settings</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +To affect a currently configured printer, simply click on the pull down button between the +<span class="guibutton">Choose Printer</span> and the <span class="guibutton">Delete Printer</span> buttons, +select the printer you wish to operate on, then to edit the settings +click on the +<span class="guibutton">Choose Printer</span> button. To delete the share, simply press the +<span class="guibutton">Delete Printer</span> button. +</p><p> +To create a new printer, next to the button labeled <span class="guibutton">Create Printer</span> enter +into the text field the name of the share to be created, then click on the +<span class="guibutton">Create Printer</span> button. +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2968967"></a>The SWAT Wizard</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +The purpose if the SWAT Wizard is to help the Microsoft-knowledgeable network administrator +to configure Samba with a minimum of effort. +</p><p> +The Wizard page provides a tool for rewriting the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file in fully optimized format. +This will also happen if you press the <span class="guibutton">Commit</span> button. The two differ +since the <span class="guibutton">Rewrite</span> button ignores any changes that may have been made, +while the <span class="guibutton">Commit</span> button causes all changes to be affected. +</p><p> +The <span class="guibutton">Edit</span> button permits the editing (setting) of the minimal set of +options that may be necessary to create a working Samba server. +</p><p> +Finally, there are a limited set of options that will determine what type of server Samba +will be configured for, whether it will be a WINS server, participate as a WINS client, or +operate with no WINS support. By clicking one button, you can elect to expose (or not) user +home directories. +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2969040"></a>The Status Page</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +The status page serves a limited purpose. First, it allows control of the Samba daemons. +The key daemons that create the Samba server environment are: <span class="application">smbd</span>, <span class="application">nmbd</span>, <span class="application">winbindd</span>. +</p><p> +The daemons may be controlled individually or as a total group. Additionally, you may set +an automatic screen refresh timing. As MS Windows clients interact with Samba, new smbd processes +will be continually spawned. The auto-refresh facility will allow you to track the changing +conditions with minimal effort. +</p><p> +Lastly, the Status page may be used to terminate specific smbd client connections in order to +free files that may be locked. +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2969092"></a>The View Page</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +This page allows the administrator to view the optimized <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file and, if you are +particularly masochistic, will permit you also to see all possible global configuration +parameters and their settings. +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2969115"></a>The Password Change Page</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +The Password Change page is a popular tool that allows the creation, deletion, deactivation, +and reactivation of MS Windows networking users on the local machine. Alternately, you can use +this tool to change a local password for a user account. +</p><p> +When logged in as a non-root account, the user will have to provide the old password as well as +the new password (twice). When logged in as <span class="emphasis"><em>root</em></span>, only the new password is +required. +</p><p> +One popular use for this tool is to change user passwords across a range of remote MS Windows +servers. +</p></div></div></div><div class="navfooter"><hr><table width="100%" summary="Navigation footer"><tr><td width="40%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="NT4Migration.html">Prev</a> </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="u" href="migration.html">Up</a></td><td width="40%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="troubleshooting.html">Next</a></td></tr><tr><td width="40%" align="left" valign="top">Chapter 31. Migration from NT4 PDC to Samba-3 PDC </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="h" href="index.html">Home</a></td><td width="40%" align="right" valign="top"> Part V. Troubleshooting</td></tr></table></div></body></html> diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/SambaHA.html b/docs/htmldocs/SambaHA.html new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..7104c8041b --- /dev/null +++ b/docs/htmldocs/SambaHA.html @@ -0,0 +1,4 @@ +<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>Chapter 29. High Availability Options</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.60.1"><link rel="home" href="index.html" title="SAMBA Project Documentation"><link rel="up" href="optional.html" title="Part III. Advanced Configuration"><link rel="previous" href="Backup.html" title="Chapter 28. Samba Backup Techniques"><link rel="next" href="migration.html" title="Part IV. Migration and Updating"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="navheader"><table width="100%" summary="Navigation header"><tr><th colspan="3" align="center">Chapter 29. High Availability Options</th></tr><tr><td width="20%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="Backup.html">Prev</a> </td><th width="60%" align="center">Part III. Advanced Configuration</th><td width="20%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="migration.html">Next</a></td></tr></table><hr></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="SambaHA"></a>Chapter 29. High Availability Options</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">John</span> <span class="othername">H.</span> <span class="surname">Terpstra</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org">jht@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="SambaHA.html#id2963987">Note</a></dt></dl></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2963987"></a>Note</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +This chapter did not make it into this release. +It is planned for the published release of this document. +</p></div></div><div class="navfooter"><hr><table width="100%" summary="Navigation footer"><tr><td width="40%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="Backup.html">Prev</a> </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="u" href="optional.html">Up</a></td><td width="40%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="migration.html">Next</a></td></tr><tr><td width="40%" align="left" valign="top">Chapter 28. Samba Backup Techniques </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="h" href="index.html">Home</a></td><td width="40%" align="right" valign="top"> Part IV. Migration and Updating</td></tr></table></div></body></html> diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/ServerType.html b/docs/htmldocs/ServerType.html new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..77a2937d95 --- /dev/null +++ b/docs/htmldocs/ServerType.html @@ -0,0 +1,330 @@ +<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>Chapter 4. Server Types and Security Modes</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.60.1"><link rel="home" href="index.html" title="SAMBA Project Documentation"><link rel="up" href="type.html" title="Part II. Server Configuration Basics"><link rel="previous" href="type.html" title="Part II. Server Configuration Basics"><link rel="next" href="samba-pdc.html" title="Chapter 5. Domain Control"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="navheader"><table width="100%" summary="Navigation header"><tr><th colspan="3" align="center">Chapter 4. Server Types and Security Modes</th></tr><tr><td width="20%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="type.html">Prev</a> </td><th width="60%" align="center">Part II. Server Configuration Basics</th><td width="20%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="samba-pdc.html">Next</a></td></tr></table><hr></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="ServerType"></a>Chapter 4. Server Types and Security Modes</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Andrew</span> <span class="surname">Tridgell</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:tridge@samba.org">tridge@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Jelmer</span> <span class="othername">R.</span> <span class="surname">Vernooij</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">The Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jelmer@samba.org">jelmer@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">John</span> <span class="othername">H.</span> <span class="surname">Terpstra</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org">jht@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="ServerType.html#id2885999">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="ServerType.html#id2886097">Server Types</a></dt><dt><a href="ServerType.html#id2886186">Samba Security Modes</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="ServerType.html#id2886291">User Level Security</a></dt><dt><a href="ServerType.html#id2886413">Share Level Security</a></dt><dt><a href="ServerType.html#id2886525">Domain Security Mode (User Level Security)</a></dt><dt><a href="ServerType.html#id2886821">ADS Security Mode (User Level Security)</a></dt><dt><a href="ServerType.html#id2886928">Server Security (User Level Security)</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="ServerType.html#id2887204">Password Checking</a></dt><dt><a href="ServerType.html#id2887400">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="ServerType.html#id2887429">What Makes Samba a Server?</a></dt><dt><a href="ServerType.html#id2887468">What Makes Samba a Domain Controller?</a></dt><dt><a href="ServerType.html#id2887504">What Makes Samba a Domain Member?</a></dt><dt><a href="ServerType.html#id2887542">Constantly Losing Connections to Password Server</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></div><p> +This chapter provides information regarding the types of server that Samba may be +configured to be. A Microsoft network administrator who wishes to migrate to or +use Samba will want to know the meaning, within a Samba context, of terms familiar to MS Windows +administrator. This means that it is essential also to define how critical security +modes function before we get into the details of how to configure the server itself. +</p><p> +The chapter provides an overview of the security modes of which Samba is capable +and how they relate to MS Windows servers and clients. +</p><p> +A question often asked is, “<span class="quote">Why would I want to use Samba?</span>” Most chapters contain a section +that highlights features and benefits. We hope that the information provided will help to +answer this question. Be warned though, we want to be fair and reasonable, so not all +features are positive towards Samba. The benefit may be on the side of our competition. +</p><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2885999"></a>Features and Benefits</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +Two men were walking down a dusty road, when one suddenly kicked up a small red stone. It +hurt his toe and lodged in his sandal. He took the stone out and cursed it with a passion +and fury befitting his anguish. The other looked at the stone and said, “<span class="quote">This is a garnet. +I can turn that into a precious gem and some day it will make a princess very happy!</span>” +</p><p> +The moral of this tale: Two men, two very different perspectives regarding the same stone. +Like it or not, Samba is like that stone. Treat it the right way and it can bring great +pleasure, but if you are forced to use it and have no time for its secrets, then it can be +a source of discomfort. +</p><p> +Samba started out as a project that sought to provide interoperability for MS Windows 3.x +clients with a UNIX server. It has grown up a lot since its humble beginnings and now provides +features and functionality fit for large scale deployment. It also has some warts. In sections +like this one we tell of both. +</p><p> +So, what are the benefits of features mentioned in this chapter? +</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p> + Samba-3 can replace an MS Windows NT4 Domain Controller. + </p></li><li><p> + Samba-3 offers excellent interoperability with MS Windows NT4-style + domains as well as natively with Microsoft Active Directory domains. + </p></li><li><p> + Samba-3 permits full NT4-style Interdomain Trusts. + </p></li><li><p> + Samba has security modes that permit more flexible + authentication than is possible with MS Windows NT4 Domain Controllers. + </p></li><li><p> + Samba-3 permits use of multiple account database backends. + </p></li><li><p> + The account (password) database backends can be distributed + and replicated using multiple methods. This gives Samba-3 + greater flexibility than MS Windows NT4 and in many cases a + significantly higher utility than Active Directory domains + with MS Windows 200x. + </p></li></ul></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2886097"></a>Server Types</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2886109"></a> +Administrators of Microsoft networks often refer to three +different type of servers:</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Domain Controller</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="circle"><li>Primary Domain Controller</li><li>Backup Domain Controller</li><li>ADS Domain Controller</li></ul></div></li><li><p>Domain Member Server</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="circle"><li>Active Directory Domain Server</li><li>NT4 Style Domain Domain Server</li></ul></div></li><li><p>Stand-alone Server</p></li></ul></div><p> +The chapters covering Domain Control, Backup Domain Control and Domain Membership provide +pertinent information regarding Samba configuration for each of these server roles. +The reader is strongly encouraged to become intimately familiar with the information +presented. +</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2886186"></a>Samba Security Modes</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2886196"></a> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2886205"></a> +In this section the function and purpose of Samba's security +modes are described. An accurate understanding of how Samba implements each security +mode as well as how to configure MS Windows clients for each mode will significantly +reduce user complaints and administrator heartache. +</p><p> +In the SMB/CIFS networking world, there are only two types of security: <span class="emphasis"><em>User Level</em></span> +and <span class="emphasis"><em>Share Level</em></span>. We refer to these collectively as <span class="emphasis"><em>security levels</em></span>. +In implementing these two security levels, Samba provides flexibilities +that are not available with Microsoft Windows NT4/200x servers. In actual fact, Samba implements +<span class="emphasis"><em>Share Level</em></span> security only one way, but has four ways of implementing +<span class="emphasis"><em>User Level</em></span> security. Collectively, we call the Samba implementations +<span class="emphasis"><em>Security Modes</em></span>. They are known as: <span class="emphasis"><em>SHARE</em></span>, <span class="emphasis"><em>USER</em></span>, +<span class="emphasis"><em>DOMAIN</em></span>, <span class="emphasis"><em>ADS</em></span>, and <span class="emphasis"><em>SERVER</em></span> modes. +They are documented in this chapter. +</p><p> +An SMB server tells the client at startup what security level it is running. There are two options: +Share Level and User Level. Which of these two the client receives affects the way the client then +tries to authenticate itself. It does not directly affect (to any great extent) the way the Samba +server does security. This may sound strange, but it fits in with the client/server approach of SMB. +In SMB everything is initiated and controlled by the client, and the server can only tell the client +what is available and whether an action is allowed. +</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2886291"></a>User Level Security</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +We will describe User Level Security first, as its simpler. +In User Level Security, the client will send a +session setup request directly following protocol negotiation. +This request provides a username and password. The server can either accept or reject that +username/password combination. At this stage the server has no idea what +share the client will eventually try to connect to, so it can't base the +<span class="emphasis"><em>accept/reject</em></span> on anything other than: +</p><div class="orderedlist"><ol type="1"><li><p>the username/password.</p></li><li><p>the name of the client machine.</p></li></ol></div><p> +If the server accepts the username/password then the client expects to be able to +mount shares (using a <span class="emphasis"><em>tree connection</em></span>) without specifying a +password. It expects that all access rights will be as the username/password +specified in the <span class="emphasis"><em>session setup</em></span>. +</p><p> +It is also possible for a client to send multiple <span class="emphasis"><em>session setup</em></span> +requests. When the server responds, it gives the client a <span class="emphasis"><em>uid</em></span> to use +as an authentication tag for that username/password. The client can maintain multiple +authentication contexts in this way (WinDD is an example of an application that does this). +</p><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2886371"></a>Example Configuration</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> +The <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> parameter that sets user level security is: +</p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>security = user</tt></i></td></tr></table><p> +This is the default setting since Samba-2.2.x. +</p></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2886413"></a>Share Level Security</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +In Share Level security, the client authenticates +itself separately for each share. It sends a password along with each +tree connection (share mount). It does not explicitly send a +username with this operation. The client expects a password to be associated +with each share, independent of the user. This means that Samba has to work out what +username the client probably wants to use. It is never explicitly sent the username. +Some commercial SMB servers such as NT actually associate passwords directly with +shares in Share Level security, but Samba always uses the UNIX authentication scheme +where it is a username/password pair that is authenticated, not a share/password pair. +</p><p> +To understand the MS Windows networking parallels, one should think +in terms of MS Windows 9x/Me where one can create a shared folder that provides read-only +or full access, with or without a password. +</p><p> +Many clients send a session setup even if the server is in Share Level security. They +normally send a valid username but no password. Samba records this username in a list +of possible usernames. When the client then does a tree connection it also adds to this list the name +of the share they try to connect to (useful for home directories) and any users +listed in the <a class="indexterm" name="id2886456"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>user</tt></i> parameter in the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file. +The password is then checked in turn against these possible usernames. If a match is found +then the client is authenticated as that user. +</p><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2886481"></a>Example Configuration</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> +The <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> parameter that sets Share Level security is: +</p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>security = share</tt></i></td></tr></table><p> +There are reports that recent MS Windows clients do not like to work +with share mode security servers. You are strongly discouraged from using Share Level security. +</p></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2886525"></a>Domain Security Mode (User Level Security)</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2886538"></a> +When Samba is operating in <a class="indexterm" name="id2886546"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>security</tt></i> = domain mode, +the Samba server has a domain security trust account (a machine account) and causes +all authentication requests to be passed through to the Domain Controllers. +In other words, this configuration makes the Samba server a Domain Member server. +</p><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2886566"></a>Example Configuration</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p><span class="emphasis"><em> +Samba as a Domain Member Server +</em></span></p><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2886583"></a> +This method involves addition of the following parameters in the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file: +</p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>security = domain</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>workgroup = MIDEARTH</tt></i></td></tr></table><p> +In order for this method to work, the Samba server needs to join the MS Windows NT +security domain. This is done as follows: +<a class="indexterm" name="id2886633"></a> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2886644"></a> +</p><div class="procedure"><ol type="1"><li><p>On the MS Windows NT Domain Controller, using + the Server Manager, add a machine account for the Samba server. + </p></li><li><p>On the UNIX/Linux system execute:</p><pre class="screen"><tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>net rpc join -U administrator%password</tt></b></pre></li></ol></div><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p> +Samba-2.2.4 and later can auto-join a Windows NT4-style Domain just by executing: +</p><pre class="screen"> +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>smbpasswd -j <i class="replaceable"><tt>DOMAIN_NAME</tt></i> -r <i class="replaceable"><tt>PDC_NAME</tt></i> \ + -U Administrator%<i class="replaceable"><tt>password</tt></i></tt></b> +</pre><p> + +Samba-3 can do the same by executing: +</p><pre class="screen"> +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>net rpc join -U Administrator%<i class="replaceable"><tt>password</tt></i></tt></b> +</pre><p> +It is not necessary with Samba-3 to specify the <i class="replaceable"><tt>DOMAIN_NAME</tt></i> or the +<i class="replaceable"><tt>PDC_NAME</tt></i> as it figures this out from the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file settings. +</p></div><p> +Use of this mode of authentication does require there to be a standard UNIX account +for each user in order to assign a UID once the account has been authenticated by +the remote Windows DC. This account can be blocked to prevent logons by clients other than +MS Windows through means such as setting an invalid shell in the +<tt class="filename">/etc/passwd</tt> entry. +</p><p> +An alternative to assigning UIDs to Windows users on a Samba member server is +presented in <link linkend="winbind">. +</p><p> +For more information regarding Domain Membership, see <link linkend="domain-member">. +</p></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2886821"></a>ADS Security Mode (User Level Security)</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +Both Samba-2.2, and Samba-3 can join an Active Directory domain. This is +possible if the domain is run in native mode. Active Directory in +native mode perfectly allows NT4-style Domain Members. This is contrary to +popular belief. Active Directory in native mode prohibits only the use of +Backup Domain Controllers running MS Windows NT4. +</p><p> +If you are using Active Directory, starting with Samba-3 you can +join as a native AD member. Why would you want to do that? +Your security policy might prohibit the use of NT-compatible +authentication protocols. All your machines are running Windows 2000 +and above and all use Kerberos. In this case Samba as an NT4-style +domain would still require NT-compatible authentication data. Samba in +AD-member mode can accept Kerberos tickets. +</p><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2886851"></a>Example Configuration</h4></div></div><div></div></div><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>realm = your.kerberos.REALM</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>security = ADS</tt></i></td></tr></table><p> +The following parameter may be required: +</p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>password server = your.kerberos.server</tt></i></td></tr></table><p> +Please refer to <link linkend="domain-member"> and <link linkend="ads-member"> +for more information regarding this configuration option. +</p></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2886928"></a>Server Security (User Level Security)</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +Server Security Mode is left over from the time when Samba was not capable of acting +as a Domain Member server. It is highly recommended not to use this feature. Server +security mode has many drawbacks that include: +</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Potential Account Lockout on MS Windows NT4/200x password servers.</p></li><li><p>Lack of assurance that the password server is the one specified.</p></li><li><p>Does not work with Winbind, which is particularly needed when storing profiles remotely.</p></li><li><p>This mode may open connections to the password server, and keep them open for extended periods.</p></li><li><p>Security on the Samba server breaks badly when the remote password server suddenly shuts down.</p></li><li><p>With this mode there is NO security account in the domain that the password server belongs to for the Samba server.</p></li></ul></div><p> +In Server Security Mode the Samba server reports to the client that it is in User Level +security. The client then does a session setup as described earlier. +The Samba server takes the username/password that the client sends and attempts to login to the +<a class="indexterm" name="id2886997"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>password server</tt></i> by sending exactly the same username/password that +it got from the client. If that server is in User Level Security and accepts the password, +then Samba accepts the client's connection. This allows the Samba server to use another SMB +server as the <a class="indexterm" name="id2887017"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>password server</tt></i>. +</p><p> +You should also note that at the start of all this where the server tells the client +what security level it is in, it also tells the client if it supports encryption. If it +does, it supplies the client with a random cryptkey. The client will then send all +passwords in encrypted form. Samba supports this type of encryption by default. +</p><p> +The parameter <a class="indexterm" name="id2887045"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>security</tt></i> = server means that Samba reports to clients that +it is running in <span class="emphasis"><em>user mode</em></span> but actually passes off all authentication +requests to another <span class="emphasis"><em>user mode</em></span> server. This requires an additional +parameter <a class="indexterm" name="id2887070"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>password server</tt></i> that points to the real authentication server. +The real authentication server can be another Samba server, or it can be a Windows NT server, +the latter being natively capable of encrypted password support. +</p><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p> +When Samba is running in <span class="emphasis"><em>Server Security Mode</em></span> it is essential that +the parameter <span class="emphasis"><em>password server</em></span> is set to the precise NetBIOS machine +name of the target authentication server. Samba cannot determine this from NetBIOS name +lookups because the choice of the target authentication server is arbitrary and cannot +be determined from a domain name. In essence, a Samba server that is in +<span class="emphasis"><em>Server Security Mode</em></span> is operating in what used to be known as +workgroup mode. +</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2887114"></a>Example Configuration</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p><span class="emphasis"><em> +Using MS Windows NT as an Authentication Server +</em></span></p><p> +This method involves the additions of the following parameters in the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file: +</p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>encrypt passwords = Yes</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>security = server</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>password server = "NetBIOS_name_of_a_DC"</tt></i></td></tr></table><p> +There are two ways of identifying whether or not a username and password pair is valid. +One uses the reply information provided as part of the authentication messaging +process, the other uses just an error code. +</p><p> +The downside of this mode of configuration is the fact that for security reasons Samba +will send the password server a bogus username and a bogus password and if the remote +server fails to reject the username and password pair then an alternative mode of +identification of validation is used. Where a site uses password lock out after a +certain number of failed authentication attempts this will result in user lockouts. +</p><p> +Use of this mode of authentication requires a standard UNIX account for the user. +This account can be blocked to prevent logons by non-SMB/CIFS clients. +</p></div></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2887204"></a>Password Checking</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +MS Windows clients may use encrypted passwords as part of a challenge/response +authentication model (a.k.a. NTLMv1 and NTLMv2) or alone, or cleartext strings for simple +password-based authentication. It should be realized that with the SMB protocol, +the password is passed over the network either in plain-text or encrypted, but +not both in the same authentication request. +</p><p> +When encrypted passwords are used, a password that has been entered by the user +is encrypted in two ways: +</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>An MD4 hash of the unicode of the password + string. This is known as the NT hash. + </p></li><li><p>The password is converted to upper case, + and then padded or truncated to 14 bytes. This string is + then appended with 5 bytes of NULL characters and split to + form two 56-bit DES keys to encrypt a “<span class="quote">magic</span>” 8-byte value. + The resulting 16 bytes form the LanMan hash. + </p></li></ul></div><p> +MS Windows 95 pre-service pack 1, MS Windows NT versions 3.x and version 4.0 +pre-service pack 3 will use either mode of password authentication. All +versions of MS Windows that follow these versions no longer support plain +text passwords by default. +</p><p> +MS Windows clients have a habit of dropping network mappings that have been idle +for 10 minutes or longer. When the user attempts to use the mapped drive +connection that has been dropped, the client re-establishes the connection using +a cached copy of the password. +</p><p> +When Microsoft changed the default password mode, support was dropped for caching +of the plain-text password. This means that when the registry parameter is changed +to re-enable use of plain-text passwords it appears to work, but when a dropped +service connection mapping attempts to revalidate, this will fail if the remote +authentication server does not support encrypted passwords. It is definitely not +a good idea to re-enable plain-text password support in such clients. +</p><p> +The following parameters can be used to work around the issue of Windows 9x/Me clients +upper-casing usernames and passwords before transmitting them to the SMB server +when using cleartext authentication: +</p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>password level = integer</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>username level = integer</tt></i></td></tr></table><p> +By default Samba will convert to lower case the username before attempting to lookup the user +in the database of local system accounts. Because UNIX usernames conventionally +only contain lower-case characters, the <a class="indexterm" name="id2887327"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>username level</tt></i> parameter +is rarely needed. +</p><p> +However, passwords on UNIX systems often make use of mixed-case characters. +This means that in order for a user on a Windows 9x/Me client to connect to a Samba +server using cleartext authentication, the <a class="indexterm" name="id2887350"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>password level</tt></i> +must be set to the maximum number of upper case letters that <span class="emphasis"><em>could</em></span> +appear in a password. Note that if the server OS uses the traditional DES version +of crypt(), a <a class="indexterm" name="id2887371"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>password level</tt></i> of 8 will result in case +insensitive passwords as seen from Windows users. This will also result in longer +login times as Samba has to compute the permutations of the password string and +try them one by one until a match is located (or all combinations fail). +</p><p> +The best option to adopt is to enable support for encrypted passwords wherever +Samba is used. Most attempts to apply the registry change to re-enable plain-text +passwords will eventually lead to user complaints and unhappiness. +</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2887400"></a>Common Errors</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +We all make mistakes. It is okay to make mistakes, as long as they are made in the right places +and at the right time. A mistake that causes lost productivity is seldom tolerated, however a mistake +made in a developmental test lab is expected. +</p><p> +Here we look at common mistakes and misapprehensions that have been the subject of discussions +on the Samba mailing lists. Many of these are avoidable by doing your homework before attempting +a Samba implementation. Some are the result of a misunderstanding of the English language. The +English language, which has many phrases that are potentially vague and may be highly confusing +to those for whom English is not their native tongue. +</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2887429"></a>What Makes Samba a Server?</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +To some the nature of the Samba <span class="emphasis"><em>security</em></span> mode is obvious, but entirely +wrong all the same. It is assumed that <a class="indexterm" name="id2887445"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>security</tt></i> = server means that Samba +will act as a server. Not so! This setting means that Samba will <span class="emphasis"><em>try</em></span> +to use another SMB server as its source for user authentication alone. +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2887468"></a>What Makes Samba a Domain Controller?</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +The <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> parameter <a class="indexterm" name="id2887486"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>security</tt></i> = domain does not really make Samba behave +as a Domain Controller. This setting means we want Samba to be a Domain Member. +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2887504"></a>What Makes Samba a Domain Member?</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +Guess! So many others do. But whatever you do, do not think that <a class="indexterm" name="id2887516"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>security</tt></i> = user +makes Samba act as a Domain Member. Read the manufacturer's manual before the warranty expires. See +<link linkend="domain-member"> for more information. +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2887542"></a>Constantly Losing Connections to Password Server</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + “<span class="quote"> +Why does server_validate() simply give up rather than re-establish its connection to the +password server? Though I am not fluent in the SMB protocol, perhaps the cluster server +process passes along to its client workstation the session key it receives from the password +server, which means the password hashes submitted by the client would not work on a subsequent +connection whose session key would be different. So server_validate() must give up.</span>” +</p><p> +Indeed. That's why <a class="indexterm" name="id2887570"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>security</tt></i> = server +is at best a nasty hack. Please use <a class="indexterm" name="id2887584"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>security</tt></i> = domain; +<a class="indexterm" name="id2887597"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>security</tt></i> = server mode is also known as pass-through authentication. +</p></div></div></div><div class="navfooter"><hr><table width="100%" summary="Navigation footer"><tr><td width="40%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="type.html">Prev</a> </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="u" href="type.html">Up</a></td><td width="40%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="samba-pdc.html">Next</a></td></tr><tr><td width="40%" align="left" valign="top">Part II. Server Configuration Basics </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="h" href="index.html">Home</a></td><td width="40%" align="right" valign="top"> Chapter 5. Domain Control</td></tr></table></div></body></html> diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/StandAloneServer.html b/docs/htmldocs/StandAloneServer.html new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..78f219911c --- /dev/null +++ b/docs/htmldocs/StandAloneServer.html @@ -0,0 +1,119 @@ +<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>Chapter 8. Stand-alone Servers</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.60.1"><link rel="home" href="index.html" title="SAMBA Project Documentation"><link rel="up" href="type.html" title="Part II. Server Configuration Basics"><link rel="previous" href="domain-member.html" title="Chapter 7. Domain Membership"><link rel="next" href="ClientConfig.html" title="Chapter 9. MS Windows Network Configuration Guide"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="navheader"><table width="100%" summary="Navigation header"><tr><th colspan="3" align="center">Chapter 8. Stand-alone Servers</th></tr><tr><td width="20%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="domain-member.html">Prev</a> </td><th width="60%" align="center">Part II. Server Configuration Basics</th><td width="20%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="ClientConfig.html">Next</a></td></tr></table><hr></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="StandAloneServer"></a>Chapter 8. Stand-alone Servers</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">John</span> <span class="othername">H.</span> <span class="surname">Terpstra</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org">jht@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="StandAloneServer.html#id2896324">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="StandAloneServer.html#id2896363">Background</a></dt><dt><a href="StandAloneServer.html#id2896435">Example Configuration</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="StandAloneServer.html#RefDocServer">Reference Documentation Server</a></dt><dt><a href="StandAloneServer.html#SimplePrintServer">Central Print Serving</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="StandAloneServer.html#id2897068">Common Errors</a></dt></dl></div><p> +Stand-alone Servers are independent of Domain Controllers on the network. +They are not Domain Members and function more like workgroup servers. In many +cases a Stand-alone Server is configured with a minimum of security control +with the intent that all data served will be readily accessible to all users. +</p><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2896324"></a>Features and Benefits</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +Stand-alone Servers can be as secure or as insecure as needs dictate. They can +have simple or complex configurations. Above all, despite the hoopla about +Domain Security they remain a common installation. +</p><p> +If all that is needed is a server for read-only files, or for +printers alone, it may not make sense to effect a complex installation. +For example: A drafting office needs to store old drawings and reference +standards. Noone can write files to the server as it is legislatively +important that all documents remain unaltered. A share mode read-only Stand-alone +Server is an ideal solution. +</p><p> +Another situation that warrants simplicity is an office that has many printers +that are queued off a single central server. Everyone needs to be able to print +to the printers, there is no need to effect any access controls and no files will +be served from the print server. Again, a share mode Stand-alone Server makes +a great solution. +</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2896363"></a>Background</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +The term <span class="emphasis"><em>Stand-alone Server</em></span> means that it +will provide local authentication and access control for all resources +that are available from it. In general this means that there will be a +local user database. In more technical terms, it means resources +on the machine will be made available in either SHARE mode or in +USER mode. +</p><p> +No special action is needed other than to create user accounts. Stand-alone +servers do not provide network logon services. This means that machines that +use this server do not perform a domain logon to it. Whatever logon facility +the workstations are subject to is independent of this machine. It is, however, +necessary to accommodate any network user so the logon name they use will +be translated (mapped) locally on the Stand-alone Server to a locally known +user name. There are several ways this can be done. +</p><p> +Samba tends to blur the distinction a little in respect of what is +a Stand-alone Server. This is because the authentication database may be +local or on a remote server, even if from the SMB protocol perspective +the Samba server is not a member of a domain security context. +</p><p> +Through the use of Pluggable Authentication Modules (PAM) and the name service switcher (NSSWITCH), +which maintains the UNIX-user database) the source of authentication may reside on +another server. We would be inclined to call this the authentication server. +This means that the Samba server may use the local UNIX/Linux system password database +(<tt class="filename">/etc/passwd</tt> or <tt class="filename">/etc/shadow</tt>), may use a +local smbpasswd file, or may use an LDAP backend, or even via PAM and Winbind another CIFS/SMB server +for authentication. +</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2896435"></a>Example Configuration</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +The examples, <link linkend="simplynice">, and link linkend="SimplePrintServer"/>, +are designed to inspire simplicity. It is too easy to attempt a high level of creativity +and to introduce too much complexity in server and network design. +</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="RefDocServer"></a>Reference Documentation Server</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +Configuration of a read-only data server that everyone can access is very simple. +<link linkend="simplynice"> is the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file that will do this. Assume that all the reference documents +are stored in the directory <tt class="filename">/export</tt>, and the documents are owned by a user other than +nobody. No home directories are shared, and there are no users in the <tt class="filename">/etc/passwd</tt> +UNIX system database. This is a simple system to administer. +</p><div class="example"><a name="simplynice"></a><p class="title"><b>Example 8.1. smb.conf for Reference Documentation Server</b></p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td># Global parameters</td></tr><tr><td> </td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>[global]</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>workgroup = MIDEARTH</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>netbios name = GANDALF</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>security = SHARE</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>passdb backend = guest</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>wins server = 192.168.1.1</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td> </td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>[data]</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>comment = Data</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>path = /export</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>guest only = Yes</tt></i></td></tr></table></div><p> +In <link linkend="simplynice"> above, the machine name is set to GANDALF, the workgroup is set to the name +of the local workgroup (MIDEARTH) so the machine will appear together with systems with +which users are familiar. The only password backend required is the “<span class="quote">guest</span>” backend to allow default +unprivileged account names to be used. As there is a WINS server on this networki, we of obviously make use of it. +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="SimplePrintServer"></a>Central Print Serving</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +Configuration of a simple print server is easy if you have all the right tools +on your system. +</p><div class="orderedlist"><p class="title"><b> Assumptions:</b></p><ol type="1"><li><p> + The print server must require no administration. + </p></li><li><p> + The print spooling and processing system on our print server will be CUPS. + (Please refer to <link linkend="CUPS-printing"> for more information). + </p></li><li><p> + The print server will service only network printers. The network administrator + will correctly configure the CUPS environment to support the printers. + </p></li><li><p> + All workstations will use only postscript drivers. The printer driver + of choice is the one shipped with the Windows OS for the Apple Color LaserWriter. + </p></li></ol></div><p> +In this example our print server will spool all incoming print jobs to +<tt class="filename">/var/spool/samba</tt> until the job is ready to be submitted by +Samba to the CUPS print processor. Since all incoming connections will be as +the anonymous (guest) user, two things will be required: +</p><div class="itemizedlist"><p class="title"><b>Enabling Anonymous Printing</b></p><ul type="disc"><li><p> + The UNIX/Linux system must have a <b class="command">guest</b> account. + The default for this is usually the account <b class="command">nobody</b>. + To find the correct name to use for your version of Samba, do the + following: +</p><pre class="screen"> +<tt class="prompt">$ </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>testparm -s -v | grep "guest account"</tt></b> +</pre><p> + Make sure that this account exists in your system password + database (<tt class="filename">/etc/passwd</tt>). + </p></li><li><p> + The directory into which Samba will spool the file must have write + access for the guest account. The following commands will ensure that + this directory is available for use: +</p><pre class="screen"> +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>mkdir /var/spool/samba</tt></b> +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>chown nobody.nobody /var/spool/samba</tt></b> +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>chmod a+rwt /var/spool/samba</tt></b> +</pre><p> + </p></li></ul></div><p> +The contents of the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file is shown in <link linkend="AnonPtrSvr">. +</p><p> +</p><div class="example"><a name="AnonPtrSvr"></a><p class="title"><b>Example 8.2. smb.conf for Anonymous Printing</b></p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td># Global parameters</td></tr><tr><td> </td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>[global]</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>workgroup = MIDEARTH</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>netbios name = GANDALF</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>security = SHARE</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>passdb backend = guest</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>printing = cups</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>printcap name = cups</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td> </td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>[printers]</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>comment = All Printers</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>path = /var/spool/samba</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>printer admin = root</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>guest ok = Yes</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>printable = Yes</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>use client driver = Yes</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>browseable = No</tt></i></td></tr></table></div><p> +</p><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2897019"></a> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2897030"></a> +On CUPS-enabled systems there is a facility to pass raw data directly to the printer without +intermediate processing via CUPS print filters. Where use of this mode of operation is desired, +it is necessary to configure a raw printing device. It is also necessary to enable the raw mime +handler in the <tt class="filename">/etc/mime.conv</tt> and <tt class="filename">/etc/mime.types</tt> +files. Refer to <link linkend="cups-raw">. +</p></div></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2897068"></a>Common Errors</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +The greatest mistake so often made is to make a network configuration too complex. +It pays to use the simplest solution that will meet the needs of the moment. +</p></div></div><div class="navfooter"><hr><table width="100%" summary="Navigation footer"><tr><td width="40%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="domain-member.html">Prev</a> </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="u" href="type.html">Up</a></td><td width="40%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="ClientConfig.html">Next</a></td></tr><tr><td width="40%" align="left" valign="top">Chapter 7. Domain Membership </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="h" href="index.html">Home</a></td><td width="40%" align="right" valign="top"> Chapter 9. MS Windows Network Configuration Guide</td></tr></table></div></body></html> diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/VFS.html b/docs/htmldocs/VFS.html new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..cedacd4e07 --- /dev/null +++ b/docs/htmldocs/VFS.html @@ -0,0 +1,112 @@ +<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>Chapter 20. Stackable VFS modules</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.60.1"><link rel="home" href="index.html" title="SAMBA Project Documentation"><link rel="up" href="optional.html" title="Part III. Advanced Configuration"><link rel="previous" href="CUPS-printing.html" title="Chapter 19. CUPS Printing Support"><link rel="next" href="winbind.html" title="Chapter 21. Winbind: Use of Domain Accounts"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="navheader"><table width="100%" summary="Navigation header"><tr><th colspan="3" align="center">Chapter 20. Stackable VFS modules</th></tr><tr><td width="20%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="CUPS-printing.html">Prev</a> </td><th width="60%" align="center">Part III. Advanced Configuration</th><td width="20%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="winbind.html">Next</a></td></tr></table><hr></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="VFS"></a>Chapter 20. Stackable VFS modules</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Jelmer</span> <span class="othername">R.</span> <span class="surname">Vernooij</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">The Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jelmer@samba.org">jelmer@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">John</span> <span class="othername">H.</span> <span class="surname">Terpstra</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org">jht@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Tim</span> <span class="surname">Potter</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:tpot@samba.org">tpot@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Simo</span> <span class="surname">Sorce</span></h3><span class="contrib">original vfs_skel README</span></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Alexander</span> <span class="surname">Bokovoy</span></h3><span class="contrib">original vfs_netatalk docs</span></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Stefan</span> <span class="surname">Metzmacher</span></h3><span class="contrib">Update for multiple modules</span></div></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="VFS.html#id2948269">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="VFS.html#id2948287">Discussion</a></dt><dt><a href="VFS.html#id2948540">Included Modules</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="VFS.html#id2948547">audit</a></dt><dt><a href="VFS.html#id2948583">extd_audit</a></dt><dt><a href="VFS.html#fakeperms">fake_perms</a></dt><dt><a href="VFS.html#id2948756">recycle</a></dt><dt><a href="VFS.html#id2948986">netatalk</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="VFS.html#id2949031">VFS Modules Available Elsewhere</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="VFS.html#id2949053">DatabaseFS</a></dt><dt><a href="VFS.html#id2949115">vscan</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2948269"></a>Features and Benefits</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +Since Samba-3, there is support for stackable VFS (Virtual File System) modules. +Samba passes each request to access the UNIX file system through the loaded VFS modules. +This chapter covers all the modules that come with the Samba source and references to +some external modules. +</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2948287"></a>Discussion</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +If not supplied with your platform distribution binary Samba package you may have problems +compiling these modules, as shared libraries are compiled and linked in different ways +on different systems. They currently have been tested against GNU/Linux and IRIX. +</p><p> +To use the VFS modules, create a share similar to the one below. The +important parameter is the <a class="indexterm" name="id2948308"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>vfs objects</tt></i> parameter where +you can list one or more VFS modules by name. For example, to log all access +to files and put deleted files in a recycle bin, see <link linkend="vfsrecyc">. + +</p><div class="example"><a name="vfsrecyc"></a><p class="title"><b>Example 20.1. smb.conf with VFS modules</b></p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td> </td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>[audit]</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>comment = Audited /data directory</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>path = /data</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>vfs objects = audit recycle</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>writeable = yes</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>browseable = yes</tt></i></td></tr></table></div><p> +</p><p> +The modules are used in the order in which they are specified. +</p><p> +Samba will attempt to load modules from the <tt class="filename">/lib</tt> directory in the root directory of the +Samba installation (usually <tt class="filename">/usr/lib/samba/vfs</tt> or <tt class="filename">/usr/local/samba/lib/vfs +</tt>). +</p><p> +Some modules can be used twice for the same share. +This can be done using a configuration similar to the one shown in <link linkend="multimodule">. + +</p><div class="example"><a name="multimodule"></a><p class="title"><b>Example 20.2. smb.conf with multiple VFS modules</b></p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td> </td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>[test]</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>comment = VFS TEST</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>path = /data</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>writeable = yes</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>browseable = yes</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>vfs objects = example:example1 example example:test</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>example1: parameter = 1</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>example: parameter = 5</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>test: parameter = 7</tt></i></td></tr></table></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2948540"></a>Included Modules</h2></div></div><div></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2948547"></a>audit</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + A simple module to audit file access to the syslog + facility. The following operations are logged: + </p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li>share</li><li>connect/disconnect</li><li>directory opens/create/remove</li><li>file open/close/rename/unlink/chmod</li></ul></div><p> + </p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2948583"></a>extd_audit</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + This module is identical with the <b class="command">audit</b> module above except + that it sends audit logs to both syslog as well as the <b class="command">smbd</b> log files. The + <a class="indexterm" name="id2948610"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>log level</tt></i> for this module is set in the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file. + </p><p> + Valid settings and the information that will be recorded are shown in <link linkend="xtdaudit">. + </p><div class="table"><a name="xtdaudit"></a><p class="title"><b>Table 20.1. Extended Auditing Log Information</b></p><table summary="Extended Auditing Log Information" border="1"><colgroup><col><col></colgroup><thead><tr><th align="center">Log Level</th><th align="center">Log Details - File and Directory Operations</th></tr></thead><tbody><tr><td align="center">0</td><td align="left">Creation / Deletion</td></tr><tr><td align="center">1</td><td align="left">Create / Delete / Rename / Permission Changes</td></tr><tr><td align="center">2</td><td align="left">Create / Delete / Rename / Perm Change / Open / Close</td></tr></tbody></table></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="fakeperms"></a>fake_perms</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + This module was created to allow Roaming Profile files and directories to be set (on the Samba server + under UNIX) as read only. This module will, if installed on the Profiles share, report to the client + that the Profile files and directories are writable. This satisfies the client even though the files + will never be overwritten as the client logs out or shuts down. + </p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2948756"></a>recycle</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + A Recycle Bin-like module. Where used, unlink calls will be intercepted and files moved + to the recycle directory instead of being deleted. This gives the same effect as the + <span class="guiicon">Recycle Bin</span> on Windows computers. + </p><p> + The <span class="guiicon">Recycle Bin</span> will not appear in <span class="application">Windows Explorer</span> views of the network file system + (share) nor on any mapped drive. Instead, a directory called <tt class="filename">.recycle</tt> will be + automatically created when the first file is deleted. Users can recover files from the + <tt class="filename">.recycle</tt> directory. If the <i class="parameter"><tt>recycle:keeptree</tt></i> has been + specified, deleted files will be found in a path identical with that from which the file was deleted. + </p><p>Supported options for the <b class="command">recycle</b> module are as follow: + </p><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">recycle:repository</span></dt><dd><p> + Relative path of the directory where deleted files should be moved. + </p></dd><dt><span class="term">recycle:keeptree</span></dt><dd><p> + Specifies whether the directory structure should be kept or if the files in the directory that is being + deleted should be kept seperately in the recycle bin. + </p></dd><dt><span class="term">recycle:versions</span></dt><dd><p> + If this option is set, two files + with the same name that are deleted will both + be kept in the recycle bin. Newer deleted versions + of a file will be called “<span class="quote">Copy #x of <i class="replaceable"><tt>filename</tt></i></span>”. + </p></dd><dt><span class="term">recycle:touch</span></dt><dd><p> + Specifies whether a file's access date should be touched when the file is moved to the recycle bin. + </p></dd><dt><span class="term">recycle:maxsize</span></dt><dd><p> + Files that are larger than the number of bytes specified by this parameter will not be put into the recycle bin. + </p></dd><dt><span class="term">recycle:exclude</span></dt><dd><p> + List of files that should not be put into the recycle bin when deleted, but deleted in the regular way. + </p></dd><dt><span class="term">recycle:exclude_dir</span></dt><dd><p> + Contains a list of directories. When files from these directories are + deleted, they are not put into the + recycle bin but are deleted in the + regular way. + </p></dd><dt><span class="term">recycle:noversions</span></dt><dd><p> + Opposite of <i class="parameter"><tt>recycle:versions</tt></i>. If both options are specified, this one takes precedence. + </p></dd></dl></div><p> + </p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2948986"></a>netatalk</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + A netatalk module will ease co-existence of Samba and netatalk file sharing services. + </p><p>Advantages compared to the old netatalk module: + </p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Does not care about creating .AppleDouble forks, just keeps them in sync.</p></li><li><p>If a share in <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> does not contain .AppleDouble item in hide or veto list, it will be added automatically.</p></li></ul></div><p> + </p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2949031"></a>VFS Modules Available Elsewhere</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +This section contains a listing of various other VFS modules that +have been posted but do not currently reside in the Samba CVS +tree for one reason or another (e.g., it is easy for the maintainer +to have his or her own CVS tree). +</p><p> +No statements about the stability or functionality of any module +should be implied due to its presence here. +</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2949053"></a>DatabaseFS</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + URL: <ulink url="http://www.css.tayloru.edu/~elorimer/databasefs/index.php">http://www.css.tayloru.edu/~elorimer/databasefs/index.php</ulink> + </p><p>By <ulink url="mailto:elorimer@css.tayloru.edu">Eric Lorimer.</ulink></p><p> + I have created a VFS module that implements a fairly complete read-only + filesystem. It presents information from a database as a filesystem in + a modular and generic way to allow different databases to be used + (originally designed for organizing MP3s under directories such as + “<span class="quote">Artists,</span>” “<span class="quote">Song Keywords,</span>” and so on. I have since easily + applied it to a student + roster database.) The directory structure is stored in the + database itself and the module makes no assumptions about the database + structure beyond the table it requires to run. + </p><p> + Any feedback would be appreciated: comments, suggestions, patches, + and so on. If nothing else, hopefully it might prove useful for someone + else who wishes to create a virtual filesystem. + </p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2949115"></a>vscan</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>URL: <ulink url="http://www.openantivirus.org/">http://www.openantivirus.org/</ulink></p><p> + <tt class="filename">samba-vscan</tt> is a proof-of-concept module for Samba, which + uses the VFS (virtual file system) features of Samba 2.2.x/3.0 + alphaX. Of course, Samba has to be compiled with VFS support. + <tt class="filename">samba-vscan</tt> supports various virus scanners and is maintained + by Rainer Link. + </p></div></div></div><div class="navfooter"><hr><table width="100%" summary="Navigation footer"><tr><td width="40%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="CUPS-printing.html">Prev</a> </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="u" href="optional.html">Up</a></td><td width="40%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="winbind.html">Next</a></td></tr><tr><td width="40%" align="left" valign="top">Chapter 19. CUPS Printing Support </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="h" href="index.html">Home</a></td><td width="40%" align="right" valign="top"> Chapter 21. Winbind: Use of Domain Accounts</td></tr></table></div></body></html> diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/bugreport.html b/docs/htmldocs/bugreport.html new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..0e963269d5 --- /dev/null +++ b/docs/htmldocs/bugreport.html @@ -0,0 +1,117 @@ +<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>Chapter 35. Reporting Bugs</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.60.1"><link rel="home" href="index.html" title="SAMBA Project Documentation"><link rel="up" href="troubleshooting.html" title="Part V. Troubleshooting"><link rel="previous" href="problems.html" title="Chapter 34. Analyzing and Solving Samba Problems"><link rel="next" href="Appendixes.html" title="Part VI. Appendixes"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="navheader"><table width="100%" summary="Navigation header"><tr><th colspan="3" align="center">Chapter 35. Reporting Bugs</th></tr><tr><td width="20%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="problems.html">Prev</a> </td><th width="60%" align="center">Part V. Troubleshooting</th><td width="20%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="Appendixes.html">Next</a></td></tr></table><hr></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="bugreport"></a>Chapter 35. Reporting Bugs</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">John</span> <span class="othername">H.</span> <span class="surname">Terpstra</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org">jht@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Jelmer</span> <span class="othername">R.</span> <span class="surname">Vernooij</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">The Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jelmer@samba.org">jelmer@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Andrew</span> <span class="surname">Tridgell</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:tridge@samba.org">tridge@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><p class="pubdate"> 27 June 1997 </p></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="bugreport.html#id2972309">Introduction</a></dt><dt><a href="bugreport.html#id2972372">General Information</a></dt><dt><a href="bugreport.html#id2972408">Debug Levels</a></dt><dt><a href="bugreport.html#id2972617">Internal Errors</a></dt><dt><a href="bugreport.html#id2972752">Attaching to a Running Process</a></dt><dt><a href="bugreport.html#id2972799">Patches</a></dt></dl></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2972309"></a>Introduction</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p>Please report bugs using Samba's +<ulink url="https://bugzilla.samba.org/">Bugzilla</ulink> facilities and +take the time to read this file before you submit a bug +report. Also, check to see if it has changed between releases, as we +may be changing the bug reporting mechanism at some point. +</p><p> +Please do as much as you can yourself to help track down the +bug. Samba is maintained by a dedicated group of people who volunteer +their time, skills and efforts. We receive far more mail than +we can possibly answer, so you have a much higher chance of a response +and a fix if you send us a “<span class="quote">developer friendly</span>” bug report that lets +us fix it fast. +</p><p> +Do not assume that if you post the bug to the comp.protocols.smb +newsgroup or the mailing list that we will read it. If you suspect that your +problem is not a bug but a configuration problem, it is better to send +it to the Samba mailing list, as there are thousands of other users on +that list who may be able to help you. +</p><p> +You may also like to look though the recent mailing list archives, +which are conveniently accessible on the Samba Web pages +at <ulink url="http://samba.org/samba/">http://samba.org/samba/</ulink>. +</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2972372"></a>General Information</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +Before submitting a bug report, check your config for silly +errors. Look in your log files for obvious messages that tell +you've misconfigured something. Run testparm to check your config +file for correct syntax. +</p><p> + Have you looked through <link linkend="diagnosis">? This is extremely important. +</p><p> +If you include part of a log file with your bug report, then be sure to +annotate it with exactly what you were doing on the client at the +time and exactly what the results were. +</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2972408"></a>Debug Levels</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +If the bug has anything to do with Samba behaving incorrectly as a +server (like refusing to open a file), then the log files will probably +be quite useful. Depending on the problem, a log level of between 3 and +10 showing the problem may be appropriate. A higher level gives more +detail, but may use too much disk space. +</p><p> +To set the debug level, use the <a class="indexterm" name="id2972430"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>log level</tt></i> in your +<tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt>. You may also find it useful to set the log +level higher for just one machine and keep separate logs for each machine. +To do this, add the following lines to your main <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file: +</p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>log level = 10</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>log file = /usr/local/samba/lib/log.%m</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>include = /usr/local/samba/lib/smb.conf.%m</tt></i></td></tr></table><p> +and create a file <tt class="filename">/usr/local/samba/lib/smb.conf.<i class="replaceable"><tt>machine</tt></i></tt> where +<i class="replaceable"><tt>machine</tt></i> is the name of the client you wish to debug. In that file +put any <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> commands you want, for example +<a class="indexterm" name="id2972521"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>log level</tt></i> may be useful. This also allows you to +experiment with different security systems, protocol levels and so on, on just +one machine. +</p><p> +The <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> entry <a class="indexterm" name="id2972548"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>log level</tt></i> +is synonymous with the parameter <a class="indexterm" name="id2972562"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>debuglevel</tt></i> that has +been used in older versions of Samba and is being retained for backward +compatibility of <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> files. +</p><p> +As the <a class="indexterm" name="id2972588"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>log level</tt></i> value is increased, you will record +a significantly greater level of debugging information. For most +debugging operations, you may not need a setting higher than +<tt class="constant">3</tt>. Nearly +all bugs can be tracked at a setting of <tt class="constant">10</tt>, but be +prepared for a large volume of log data. +</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2972617"></a>Internal Errors</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +If you get the message “<span class="quote"><span class="errorname">INTERNAL ERROR</span></span>” in your log files, +it means that Samba got an unexpected signal while running. It is probably a +segmentation fault and almost certainly means a bug in Samba (unless +you have faulty hardware or system software). +</p><p> +If the message came from smbd, it will probably be accompanied by +a message that details the last SMB message received by smbd. This +information is often useful in tracking down the problem so please +include it in your bug report. +</p><p> +You should also detail how to reproduce the problem, if +possible. Please make this reasonably detailed. +</p><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2972657"></a> +You may also find that a core file appeared in a <tt class="filename">corefiles</tt> +subdirectory of the directory where you keep your Samba log +files. This file is the most useful tool for tracking down the bug. To +use it, you do this: +<a class="indexterm" name="id2972676"></a> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2972684"></a> +</p><pre class="screen"> +<tt class="prompt">$ </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>gdb smbd core</tt></b> +</pre><p> +adding appropriate paths to smbd and core so gdb can find them. If you +do not have gdb, try <b class="userinput"><tt>dbx</tt></b>. Then within the debugger, +use the command <b class="command">where</b> to give a stack trace of where the +problem occurred. Include this in your report. +</p><p> +If you know any assembly language, do a <b class="command">disass</b> of the routine +where the problem occurred (if its in a library routine, then +disassemble the routine that called it) and try to work out exactly +where the problem is by looking at the surrounding code. Even if you +do not know assembly, including this information in the bug report can be +useful. +</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2972752"></a>Attaching to a Running Process</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +Unfortunately, some UNIXes (in particular some recent Linux kernels) +refuse to dump a core file if the task has changed uid (which smbd +does often). To debug with this sort of system, you could try to attach +to the running process using +<b class="userinput"><tt>gdb smbd <i class="replaceable"><tt>PID</tt></i></tt></b> where you get +<i class="replaceable"><tt>PID</tt></i> from <span class="application">smbstatus</span>. +Then use <b class="command">c</b> to continue and try to cause the core dump +using the client. The debugger should catch the fault and tell you +where it occurred. +</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2972799"></a>Patches</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2972810"></a> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2972818"></a> +The best sort of bug report is one that includes a fix! If you send us +patches, please use <b class="userinput"><tt>diff -u</tt></b> format if your version of +diff supports it, otherwise use <b class="userinput"><tt>diff -c4</tt></b>. Make sure +you do the diff against a clean version of the source and let me know +exactly what version you used. +</p></div></div><div class="navfooter"><hr><table width="100%" summary="Navigation footer"><tr><td width="40%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="problems.html">Prev</a> </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="u" href="troubleshooting.html">Up</a></td><td width="40%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="Appendixes.html">Next</a></td></tr><tr><td width="40%" align="left" valign="top">Chapter 34. Analyzing and Solving Samba Problems </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="h" href="index.html">Home</a></td><td width="40%" align="right" valign="top"> Part VI. Appendixes</td></tr></table></div></body></html> diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/compiling.html b/docs/htmldocs/compiling.html new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..17aed45b4c --- /dev/null +++ b/docs/htmldocs/compiling.html @@ -0,0 +1,220 @@ +<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>Chapter 36. How to Compile Samba</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.60.1"><link rel="home" href="index.html" title="SAMBA Project Documentation"><link rel="up" href="Appendixes.html" title="Part VI. Appendixes"><link rel="previous" href="Appendixes.html" title="Part VI. Appendixes"><link rel="next" href="Portability.html" title="Chapter 37. Portability"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="navheader"><table width="100%" summary="Navigation header"><tr><th colspan="3" align="center">Chapter 36. How to Compile Samba</th></tr><tr><td width="20%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="Appendixes.html">Prev</a> </td><th width="60%" align="center">Part VI. Appendixes</th><td width="20%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="Portability.html">Next</a></td></tr></table><hr></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="compiling"></a>Chapter 36. How to Compile Samba</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Jelmer</span> <span class="othername">R.</span> <span class="surname">Vernooij</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">The Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jelmer@samba.org">jelmer@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">John</span> <span class="othername">H.</span> <span class="surname">Terpstra</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org">jht@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Andrew</span> <span class="surname">Tridgell</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:tridge@samba.org">tridge@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><p class="pubdate"> 22 May 2001 </p></div><div><p class="pubdate"> 18 March 2003 </p></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="compiling.html#id2972995">Access Samba Source Code via CVS</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="compiling.html#id2973003">Introduction</a></dt><dt><a href="compiling.html#id2973049">CVS Access to samba.org</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="compiling.html#id2973311">Accessing the Samba Sources via rsync and ftp</a></dt><dt><a href="compiling.html#id2973389">Verifying Samba's PGP Signature</a></dt><dt><a href="compiling.html#id2973553">Building the Binaries</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="compiling.html#id2973768">Compiling Samba with Active Directory Support</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="compiling.html#id2973958">Starting the smbd and nmbd</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="compiling.html#id2974066">Starting from inetd.conf</a></dt><dt><a href="compiling.html#id2974312">Alternative: Starting smbd as a Daemon</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></div><p> +You can obtain the Samba source from the +<ulink url="http://samba.org/">Samba Website.</ulink> To obtain a development version, +you can download Samba from CVS or using <b class="command">rsync</b>. +</p><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2972995"></a>Access Samba Source Code via CVS</h2></div></div><div></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2973003"></a>Introduction</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2973014"></a> +Samba is developed in an open environment. Developers use +Concurrent Versioning System (CVS) to “<span class="quote">checkin</span>” (also known as +“<span class="quote">commit</span>”) new source code. Samba's various CVS branches can +be accessed via anonymous CVS using the instructions +detailed in this chapter. +</p><p> +This chapter is a modified version of the instructions found at +<ulink url="http://samba.org/samba/cvs.html">http://samba.org/samba/cvs.html</ulink> +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2973049"></a>CVS Access to samba.org</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +The machine samba.org runs a publicly accessible CVS +repository for access to the source code of several packages, +including Samba, rsync, distcc, ccache, and jitterbug. There are two main ways +of accessing the CVS server on this host: +</p><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2973065"></a>Access via CVSweb</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2973076"></a> +You can access the source code via your favorite WWW browser. This allows you to access +the contents of individual files in the repository and also to look at the revision +history and commit logs of individual files. You can also ask for a diff +listing between any two versions on the repository. +</p><p> +Use the URL: +<ulink url="http://samba.org/cgi-bin/CVSweb">http://samba.org/cgi-bin/CVSweb</ulink> +</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2973106"></a>Access via CVS</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> +You can also access the source code via a +normal CVS client. This gives you much more control over what you can +do with the repository and allows you to checkout whole source trees +and keep them up-to-date via normal CVS commands. This is the +preferred method of access if you are a developer and not +just a casual browser. +</p><p> +To download the latest CVS source code, point your +browser at the URL : +<ulink url="http://www.cyclic.com/">http://www.cyclic.com/</ulink>. +and click on the “<span class="quote">How to get CVS</span>” link. CVS is free software under +the GNU GPL (as is Samba). Note that there are several graphical CVS clients +that provide a graphical interface to the sometimes mundane CVS commands. +Links to theses clients are also available from the Cyclic Web site. +</p><p> +To gain access via anonymous CVS, use the following steps. +For this example it is assumed that you want a copy of the +Samba source code. For the other source code repositories +on this system just substitute the correct package name. +</p><div class="procedure"><p class="title"><b>Procedure 36.1. Retrieving Samba using CVS</b></p><ol type="1"><li><p> + Install a recent copy of CVS. All you really need is a + copy of the CVS client binary. + </p></li><li><p> + Run the command: + </p><p> + <b class="userinput"><tt>cvs -d :pserver:cvs@samba.org:/cvsroot login</tt></b> + </p></li><li><p> + When it asks you for a password, type <b class="userinput"><tt>cvs</tt></b>. + </p></li><li><p> + Run the command + </p><p> + <b class="userinput"><tt>cvs -d :pserver:CVS@samba.org:/cvsroot co samba</tt></b>. + </p><p> + This will create a directory called <tt class="filename">samba</tt> containing the + latest Samba source code (i.e., the HEAD tagged CVS branch). This + currently corresponds to the 3.0 development tree. + </p><p> + CVS branches other then HEAD can be obtained by using the + <tt class="option">-r</tt> and defining a tag name. A list of branch tag names + can be found on the “<span class="quote">Development</span>” page of the Samba Web site. A common + request is to obtain the latest 3.0 release code. This could be done by + using the following command: + </p><p> + <b class="userinput"><tt>cvs -d :pserver:cvs@samba.org:/cvsroot co -r SAMBA_3_0 samba</tt></b>. + </p></li><li><p> + Whenever you want to merge in the latest code changes, use + the following command from within the Samba directory: + </p><p> + <b class="userinput"><tt>cvs update -d -P</tt></b> + </p></li></ol></div></div></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2973311"></a>Accessing the Samba Sources via rsync and ftp</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> + <a class="indexterm" name="id2973323"></a> + <a class="indexterm" name="id2973331"></a> + <i class="parameter"><tt>pserver.samba.org</tt></i> also exports unpacked copies of most parts of the CVS + tree at <ulink url="ftp://pserver.samba.org/pub/unpacked">ftp://pserver.samba.org/pub/unpacked</ulink> and also via anonymous rsync at + <ulink url="rsync://pserver.samba.org/ftp/unpacked/">rsync://pserver.samba.org/ftp/unpacked/</ulink>. I recommend using rsync rather than ftp. + See <ulink url="http://rsync.samba.org/">the rsync homepage</ulink> for more info on rsync. + </p><p> + The disadvantage of the unpacked trees is that they do not support automatic + merging of local changes like CVS does. <b class="command">rsync</b> access is most convenient + for an initial install. + </p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2973389"></a>Verifying Samba's PGP Signature</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2973401"></a> +It is strongly recommended that you verify the PGP signature for any source file before +installing it. Even if you're not downloading from a mirror site, verifying PGP signatures +should be a standard reflex. Many people today use the GNU GPG toolset in place of PGP. +GPG can substitute for PGP. +</p><p> +With that said, go ahead and download the following files: +</p><pre class="screen"> +<tt class="prompt">$ </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>wget http://us1.samba.org/samba/ftp/samba-2.2.8a.tar.asc</tt></b> +<tt class="prompt">$ </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>wget http://us1.samba.org/samba/ftp/samba-pubkey.asc</tt></b> +</pre><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2973459"></a> +The first file is the PGP signature for the Samba source file; the other is the Samba public +PGP key itself. Import the public PGP key with: +</p><pre class="screen"> +<tt class="prompt">$ </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>gpg --import samba-pubkey.asc</tt></b> +</pre><p> +and verify the Samba source code integrity with: +</p><pre class="screen"> +<tt class="prompt">$ </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>gzip -d samba-2.2.8a.tar.gz</tt></b> +<tt class="prompt">$ </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>gpg --verify samba-2.2.8a.tar.asc</tt></b> +</pre><p> +If you receive a message like, “<span class="quote">Good signature from Samba Distribution Verification Key...</span>” +then all is well. The warnings about trust relationships can be ignored. An +example of what you would not want to see would be: +</p><pre class="screen"> + gpg: BAD signature from “<span class="quote">Samba Distribution Verification Key</span>” +</pre></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2973553"></a>Building the Binaries</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2973564"></a> + To build the binaries, first run the program <b class="userinput"><tt>./configure + </tt></b> in the source directory. This should automatically + configure Samba for your operating system. If you have unusual + needs, then you may wish to run</p><pre class="screen"><tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>./configure --help +</tt></b></pre><p>first to see what special options you can enable. Now execute <b class="userinput"><tt>./configure</tt></b> with any arguments it might need:</p><pre class="screen"><tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>./configure <i class="replaceable"><tt>[... arguments ...]</tt></i></tt></b></pre><p>Executing</p><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2973641"></a> + </p><pre class="screen"><tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>make</tt></b></pre><p>will create the binaries. Once it is successfully + compiled you can use</p><pre class="screen"><tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>make install</tt></b></pre><p>to install the binaries and manual pages. You can + separately install the binaries and/or man pages using</p><pre class="screen"><tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>make installbin +</tt></b></pre><p>and</p><pre class="screen"><tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>make installman + </tt></b></pre><p>Note that if you are upgrading from a previous version + of Samba you might like to know that the old versions of + the binaries will be renamed with an “<span class="quote">.old</span>” extension. You + can go back to the previous version with</p><pre class="screen"><tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>make revert +</tt></b></pre><p>if you find this version a disaster!</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2973768"></a>Compiling Samba with Active Directory Support</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>In order to compile Samba with ADS support, you need to have installed + on your system:</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>The MIT or Heimdal kerberos development libraries + (either install from the sources or use a package).</p></li><li><p>The OpenLDAP development libraries.</p></li></ul></div><p>If your kerberos libraries are in a non-standard location, then + remember to add the configure option + <tt class="option">--with-krb5=<i class="replaceable"><tt>DIR</tt></i></tt>.</p><p>After you run configure, make sure that + <tt class="filename">include/config.h</tt> it generates contain lines like + this:</p><pre class="programlisting"> +#define HAVE_KRB5 1 +#define HAVE_LDAP 1 +</pre><p>If it does not, configure did not find your KRB5 libraries or + your LDAP libraries. Look in <tt class="filename">config.log</tt> to figure + out why and fix it.</p><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2973849"></a>Installing the Required Packages for Debian</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p>On Debian, you need to install the following packages:</p><p> + </p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li>libkrb5-dev</li><li>krb5-user</li></ul></div><p> + </p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2973878"></a>Installing the Required Packages for Red Hat Linux</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p>On Red Hat Linux, this means you should have at least: </p><p> + </p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li>krb5-workstation (for kinit)</li><li>krb5-libs (for linking with)</li><li>krb5-devel (because you are compiling from source)</li></ul></div><p> + </p><p>in addition to the standard development environment.</p><p>If these files are not installed on your system, you should check the installation + CDs to find which has them and install the files using your tool of choice. If in doubt + about what tool to use, refer to the Red Hat Linux documentation.</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2973928"></a>SuSE Linux Package Requirements</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p>SuSE Linux installs Heimdal packages that may be required to allow you to build + binary packages. You should verify that the development libraries have been installed on + your system. + </p><p>SuSE Linux Samba RPMs support Kerberos. Please refer to the documentation for + your SuSE Linux system for information regading SuSE Linux specific configuration. + Additionally, SuSE are very active in the maintenance of Samba packages that provide + the maximum capabilities that are available. You should consider using SuSE provided + packages where they are available. + </p></div></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2973958"></a>Starting the <span class="application">smbd</span> and <span class="application">nmbd</span></h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> + <a class="indexterm" name="id2973982"></a> + You must choose to start <span class="application">smbd</span> and <span class="application">nmbd</span> either + as daemons or from <span class="application">inetd</span>. Don't try + to do both! Either you can put them in <tt class="filename"> + inetd.conf</tt> and have them started on demand + by <span class="application">inetd</span> or <span class="application">xinetd</span>, + or you can start them as + daemons either from the command line or in <tt class="filename"> + /etc/rc.local</tt>. See the man pages for details + on the command line options. Take particular care to read + the bit about what user you need to have to start + Samba. In many cases, you must be root.</p><p>The main advantage of starting <span class="application">smbd</span> + and <span class="application">nmbd</span> using the recommended daemon method + is that they will respond slightly more quickly to an initial connection + request.</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2974066"></a>Starting from inetd.conf</h3></div></div><div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2974074"></a><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p>The following will be different if + you use NIS, NIS+ or LDAP to distribute services maps.</p></div><p>Look at your <tt class="filename">/etc/services</tt>. + What is defined at port 139/tcp? If nothing is defined, + then add a line like this:</p><pre class="programlisting">netbios-ssn 139/tcp</pre><p>Similarly for 137/udp, you should have an entry like:</p><pre class="programlisting">netbios-ns 137/udp</pre><p>Next, edit your <tt class="filename">/etc/inetd.conf</tt> + and add two lines like this:</p><pre class="programlisting"> + netbios-ssn stream tcp nowait root /usr/local/samba/bin/smbd smbd + netbios-ns dgram udp wait root /usr/local/samba/bin/nmbd nmbd + </pre><p>The exact syntax of <tt class="filename">/etc/inetd.conf</tt> + varies between UNIXes. Look at the other entries in inetd.conf + for a guide. </p><p> + <a class="indexterm" name="id2974166"></a> + Some distributions use xinetd instead of inetd. Consult the + xinetd manual for configuration information.</p><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p>Some UNIXes already have entries like netbios_ns + (note the underscore) in <tt class="filename">/etc/services</tt>. + You must edit <tt class="filename">/etc/services</tt> or + <tt class="filename">/etc/inetd.conf</tt> to make them consistent. + </p></div><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p> + <a class="indexterm" name="id2974210"></a> + On many systems you may need to use the + <a class="indexterm" name="id2974219"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>interfaces</tt></i> option in <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> to specify the IP + address and netmask of your interfaces. Run + <span class="application">ifconfig</span> + as root if you do not know what the broadcast is for your + net. <span class="application">nmbd</span> tries to determine it at run + time, but fails on some UNIXes. + </p></div><div class="warning" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Warning</h3><p>Many UNIXes only accept around five + parameters on the command line in <tt class="filename">inetd.conf</tt>. + This means you shouldn't use spaces between the options and + arguments, or you should use a script and start the script + from <b class="command">inetd</b>.</p></div><p>Restart <span class="application">inetd</span>, perhaps just send + it a HUP. </p><pre class="screen"> + <tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>killall -HUP inetd</tt></b> + </pre></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2974312"></a>Alternative: Starting <span class="application">smbd</span> as a Daemon</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + <a class="indexterm" name="id2974330"></a> + To start the server as a daemon, you should create + a script something like this one, perhaps calling + it <tt class="filename">startsmb</tt>.</p><pre class="programlisting"> + #!/bin/sh + /usr/local/samba/bin/smbd -D + /usr/local/samba/bin/nmbd -D + </pre><p>Make it executable with <b class="command">chmod + +x startsmb</b></p><p>You can then run <b class="command">startsmb</b> by + hand or execute it from <tt class="filename">/etc/rc.local</tt>. + </p><p>To kill it, send a kill signal to the processes + <span class="application">nmbd</span> and <span class="application">smbd</span>.</p><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p>If you use the SVR4 style init system, + you may like to look at the <tt class="filename">examples/svr4-startup</tt> + script to make Samba fit into that system.</p></div></div></div></div><div class="navfooter"><hr><table width="100%" summary="Navigation footer"><tr><td width="40%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="Appendixes.html">Prev</a> </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="u" href="Appendixes.html">Up</a></td><td width="40%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="Portability.html">Next</a></td></tr><tr><td width="40%" align="left" valign="top">Part VI. Appendixes </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="h" href="index.html">Home</a></td><td width="40%" align="right" valign="top"> Chapter 37. Portability</td></tr></table></div></body></html> diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/diagnosis.html b/docs/htmldocs/diagnosis.html new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..3b76bc41c0 --- /dev/null +++ b/docs/htmldocs/diagnosis.html @@ -0,0 +1,311 @@ +<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>Chapter 33. The Samba Checklist</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.60.1"><link rel="home" href="index.html" title="SAMBA Project Documentation"><link rel="up" href="troubleshooting.html" title="Part V. Troubleshooting"><link rel="previous" href="troubleshooting.html" title="Part V. Troubleshooting"><link rel="next" href="problems.html" title="Chapter 34. Analyzing and Solving Samba Problems"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="navheader"><table width="100%" summary="Navigation header"><tr><th colspan="3" align="center">Chapter 33. The Samba Checklist</th></tr><tr><td width="20%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="troubleshooting.html">Prev</a> </td><th width="60%" align="center">Part V. Troubleshooting</th><td width="20%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="problems.html">Next</a></td></tr></table><hr></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="diagnosis"></a>Chapter 33. The Samba Checklist</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Andrew</span> <span class="surname">Tridgell</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:tridge@samba.org">tridge@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Jelmer</span> <span class="othername">R.</span> <span class="surname">Vernooij</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">The Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jelmer@samba.org">jelmer@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Dan</span> <span class="surname">Shearer</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:dan@samba.org">dan@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><p class="pubdate">Wed Jan 15</p></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="diagnosis.html#id2969273">Introduction</a></dt><dt><a href="diagnosis.html#id2969311">Assumptions</a></dt><dt><a href="diagnosis.html#id2969546">The Tests</a></dt></dl></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2969273"></a>Introduction</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +This file contains a list of tests you can perform to validate your +Samba server. It also tells you what the likely cause of the problem +is if it fails any one of these steps. If it passes all these tests, +then it is probably working fine. +</p><p> +You should do all the tests, in the order shown. We have tried to +carefully choose them so later tests only use capabilities verified in +the earlier tests. However, do not stop at the first error as there +have been some instances when continuing with the tests has helped +to solve a problem. +</p><p> +If you send one of the Samba mailing lists an email saying, “<span class="quote">it does not work</span>” +and you have not followed this test procedure, you should not be surprised +if your email is ignored. +</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2969311"></a>Assumptions</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +In all of the tests, it is assumed you have a Samba server called +BIGSERVER and a PC called ACLIENT both in workgroup TESTGROUP. +</p><p> +The procedure is similar for other types of clients. +</p><p> +It is also assumed you know the name of an available share in your +<tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt>. I will assume this share is called <i class="parameter"><tt>tmp</tt></i>. +You can add a <i class="parameter"><tt>tmp</tt></i> share like this by adding the +lines shown in <link linkend="tmpshare">. +</p><div class="example"><a name="tmpshare"></a><p class="title"><b>Example 33.1. smb.conf with [tmp] share</b></p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td> </td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>[tmp]</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>comment = temporary files </tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>path = /tmp</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>read only = yes</tt></i></td></tr></table></div><p> +</p><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p> +These tests assume version 3.0.0 or later of the Samba suite. +Some commands shown did not exist in earlier versions. +</p></div><p> +Please pay attention to the error messages you receive. If any error message +reports that your server is being unfriendly, you should first check that your +IP name resolution is correctly set up. Make sure your <tt class="filename">/etc/resolv.conf</tt> +file points to name servers that really do exist. +</p><p> +Also, if you do not have DNS server access for name resolution, please check +that the settings for your <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file results in <b class="command">dns proxy = no</b>. The +best way to check this is with <b class="command">testparm smb.conf</b>. +</p><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2969474"></a> +It is helpful to monitor the log files during testing by using the +<b class="command">tail -F log_file_name</b> in a separate +terminal console (use ctrl-alt-F1 through F6 or multiple terminals in X). +Relevant log files can be found (for default installations) in +<tt class="filename">/usr/local/samba/var</tt>. Also, connection logs from +machines can be found here or possibly in <tt class="filename">/var/log/samba</tt>, +depending on how or if you specified logging in your <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file. +</p><p> +If you make changes to your <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file while going through these test, +remember to restart <span class="application">smbd</span> and <span class="application">nmbd</span>. +</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2969546"></a>The Tests</h2></div></div><div></div></div><div class="procedure"><p class="title"><b>Procedure 33.1. Diagnosing your Samba server</b></p><ol type="1"><li><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2969570"></a> +In the directory in which you store your <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file, run the command +<b class="command">testparm smb.conf</b>. If it reports any errors, then your <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> +configuration file is faulty. +</p><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p> +Your <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file may be located in: <tt class="filename">/etc/samba</tt> +or in <tt class="filename">/usr/local/samba/lib</tt>. +</p></div></li><li><p> +Run the command <b class="command">ping BIGSERVER</b> from the PC and +<b class="command">ping ACLIENT</b> from the UNIX box. If you do not get a valid response, +then your TCP/IP software is not correctly installed. +</p><p> +You will need to start a “<span class="quote">dos prompt</span>” window on the PC to run ping. +</p><p> +If you get a message saying “<span class="quote"><span class="errorname">host not found</span></span>” or similar, then your DNS +software or <tt class="filename">/etc/hosts</tt> file is not correctly setup. +It is possible to run Samba without DNS entries for the server and client, but it is assumed +you do have correct entries for the remainder of these tests. +</p><p> +Another reason why ping might fail is if your host is running firewall +software. You will need to relax the rules to let in the workstation +in question, perhaps by allowing access from another subnet (on Linux +this is done via the appropriate firewall maintenance commands <b class="command">ipchains</b> +or <b class="command">iptables</b>). +</p><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p> +Modern Linux distributions install ipchains/iptables by default. +This is a common problem that is often overlooked. +</p></div><p> +If you wish to check what firewall rules may be present in a system under test, simply run +<b class="command">iptables -L -v</b> or if <i class="parameter"><tt>ipchains</tt></i>-based firewall rules are in use, +<b class="command">ipchains -L -v</b>. +</p><p> +Here is a sample listing from a system that has an external ethernet interface (eth1) on which Samba +is not active, and an internal (private network) interface (eth0) on which Samba is active: +</p><pre class="screen"> +frodo:~ # iptables -L -v +Chain INPUT (policy DROP 98496 packets, 12M bytes) + pkts bytes target prot opt in out source destination + 187K 109M ACCEPT all -- lo any anywhere anywhere + 892K 125M ACCEPT all -- eth0 any anywhere anywhere +1399K 1380M ACCEPT all -- eth1 any anywhere anywhere \ + state RELATED,ESTABLISHED + +Chain FORWARD (policy DROP 0 packets, 0 bytes) + pkts bytes target prot opt in out source destination + 978K 1177M ACCEPT all -- eth1 eth0 anywhere anywhere \ + state RELATED,ESTABLISHED + 658K 40M ACCEPT all -- eth0 eth1 anywhere anywhere + 0 0 LOG all -- any any anywhere anywhere \ + LOG level warning + +Chain OUTPUT (policy ACCEPT 2875K packets, 1508M bytes) + pkts bytes target prot opt in out source destination + +Chain reject_func (0 references) + pkts bytes target prot opt in out source destinat +</pre><p> +</p></li><li><p> +Run the command: <b class="command">smbclient -L BIGSERVER</b> +on the UNIX box. You should get back a list of available shares. +</p><p> +If you get an error message containing the string “<span class="quote">Bad password</span>”, then +you probably have either an incorrect <i class="parameter"><tt>hosts allow</tt></i>, +<i class="parameter"><tt>hosts deny</tt></i> or <i class="parameter"><tt>valid users</tt></i> line in your +<tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt>, or your guest account is not valid. Check what your guest account is using <span class="application">testparm</span> and +temporarily remove any <i class="parameter"><tt>hosts allow</tt></i>, <i class="parameter"><tt>hosts deny</tt></i>, +<i class="parameter"><tt>valid users</tt></i> or <i class="parameter"><tt>invalid users</tt></i> lines. +</p><p> +If you get a message “<span class="quote"><span class="errorname">connection refused</span></span>” response, then the <b class="command">smbd</b> server may +not be running. If you installed it in <tt class="filename">inetd.conf</tt>, then you probably edited +that file incorrectly. If you installed it as a daemon, then check that +it is running, and check that the netbios-ssn port is in a LISTEN +state using <b class="command">netstat -a</b>. +</p><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2969931"></a> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2969939"></a> +Some UNIX/Linux systems use <b class="command">xinetd</b> in place of +<b class="command">inetd</b>. Check your system documentation for the location +of the control files for your particular system implementation of +the network super daemon. +</p></div><p> +If you get a message saying “<span class="quote"><span class="errorname">session request failed</span></span>”, the server refused the +connection. If it says “<span class="quote">Your server software is being unfriendly</span>”, then +it's probably because you have invalid command line parameters to <span class="application">smbd</span>, +or a similar fatal problem with the initial startup of <span class="application">smbd</span>. Also +check your config file (<tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt>) for syntax errors with <span class="application">testparm</span> +and that the various directories where Samba keeps its log and lock +files exist. +</p><p> +There are a number of reasons for which smbd may refuse or decline +a session request. The most common of these involve one or more of +the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file entries as shown in <link linkend="modif1">. +</p><p> +</p><div class="example"><a name="modif1"></a><p class="title"><b>Example 33.2. Configuration for only allowing connections from a certain subnet</b></p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td> </td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>[globals]</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td>...</td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>hosts deny = ALL</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>hosts allow = xxx.xxx.xxx.xxx/yy</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>interfaces = eth0</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>bind interfaces only = Yes</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td>...</td></tr></table></div><p> +</p><p> +In the above, no allowance has been made for any session requests that +will automatically translate to the loopback adapter address 127.0.0.1. +To solve this problem, change these lines as shown in <link linkend="modif2">. +</p><p> +</p><div class="example"><a name="modif2"></a><p class="title"><b>Example 33.3. Configuration for allowing connections from a certain subnet and localhost</b></p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td> </td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>[globals]</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td>...</td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>hosts deny = ALL</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>hosts allow = xxx.xxx.xxx.xxx/yy 127.</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>interfaces = eth0 lo</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td>...</td></tr></table></div><p> +</p><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2970193"></a> +Another common cause of these two errors is having something already running +<a class="indexterm" name="id2970203"></a> +on port <tt class="constant">139</tt>, such as Samba (<span class="application">smbd</span> is running from <span class="application">inetd</span> already) or +something like Digital's Pathworks. Check your <tt class="filename">inetd.conf</tt> file before trying +to start <span class="application">smbd</span> as a daemon it can avoid a lot of frustration! +</p><p> +And yet another possible cause for failure of this test is when the subnet mask +and/or broadcast address settings are incorrect. Please check that the +network interface IP Address/Broadcast Address/Subnet Mask settings are +correct and that Samba has correctly noted these in the <tt class="filename">log.nmbd</tt> file. +</p></li><li><p> +Run the command: <b class="command">nmblookup -B BIGSERVER __SAMBA__</b>. +You should get back the IP address of your Samba server. +</p><p> +If you do not, then nmbd is incorrectly installed. Check your <tt class="filename">inetd.conf</tt> +if you run it from there, or that the daemon is running and listening to udp port 137. +</p><p> +One common problem is that many inetd implementations can't take many +parameters on the command line. If this is the case, then create a +one-line script that contains the right parameters and run that from +inetd. +</p></li><li><p> +Run the command: <b class="command">nmblookup -B ACLIENT `*'</b> +</p><p> +You should get the PC's IP address back. If you do not then the client +software on the PC isn't installed correctly, or isn't started, or you +got the name of the PC wrong. +</p><p> +If ACLIENT does not resolve via DNS then use the IP address of the +client in the above test. +</p></li><li><p> +Run the command: <b class="command">nmblookup -d 2 '*'</b> +</p><p> +This time we are trying the same as the previous test but are trying +it via a broadcast to the default broadcast address. A number of +NetBIOS/TCP/IP hosts on the network should respond, although Samba may +not catch all of the responses in the short time it listens. You +should see the “<span class="quote"><span class="errorname">got a positive name query response</span></span>” +messages from several hosts. +</p><p> +If this does not give a similar result to the previous test, then +nmblookup isn't correctly getting your broadcast address through its +automatic mechanism. In this case you should experiment with the +<a class="indexterm" name="id2970377"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>interfaces</tt></i> option in <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> to manually configure your IP +address, broadcast and netmask. +</p><p> +If your PC and server aren't on the same subnet, then you will need to use the +<tt class="option">-B</tt> option to set the broadcast address to that of the PCs subnet. +</p><p> +This test will probably fail if your subnet mask and broadcast address are +not correct. (Refer to TEST 3 notes above). +</p></li><li><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2970428"></a> +Run the command: <b class="command">smbclient //BIGSERVER/TMP</b>. You should +then be prompted for a password. You should use the password of the account +with which you are logged into the UNIX box. If you want to test with +another account, then add the <tt class="option">-U accountname</tt> option to the end of +the command line. For example, <b class="command">smbclient //bigserver/tmp -Ujohndoe</b>. +</p><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p> +It is possible to specify the password along with the username as follows: +<b class="command">smbclient //bigserver/tmp -Ujohndoe%secret</b>. +</p></div><p> +Once you enter the password, you should get the <tt class="prompt">smb></tt> prompt. If you +do not, then look at the error message. If it says “<span class="quote"><span class="errorname">invalid network +name</span></span>”, then the service <i class="parameter"><tt>tmp</tt></i> is not correctly setup in your <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt>. +</p><p> +If it says “<span class="quote"><span class="errorname">bad password</span></span>”, then the likely causes are: +</p><div class="orderedlist"><ol type="1"><li><p> + You have shadow passwords (or some other password system) but didn't + compile in support for them in <span class="application">smbd</span>. + </p></li><li><p> + Your <a class="indexterm" name="id2970549"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>valid users</tt></i> configuration is incorrect. + </p></li><li><p> + You have a mixed case password and you haven't enabled the <a class="indexterm" name="id2970572"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>password level</tt></i> option at a high enough level. + </p></li><li><p> + The <a class="indexterm" name="id2970595"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>path</tt></i> line in <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> is incorrect. Check it with <span class="application">testparm</span>. + </p></li><li><p> + You enabled password encryption but didn't map UNIX to Samba users. Run: + <b class="command">smbpasswd -a username</b> + </p></li></ol></div><p> +Once connected, you should be able to use the commands <b class="command">dir</b>, <b class="command">get</b>, +<b class="command">put</b> and so on. Type <b class="command">help command</b> for instructions. You should +especially check that the amount of free disk space shown is correct when you type <b class="command">dir</b>. +</p></li><li><p> +On the PC, type the command <b class="command">net view \\BIGSERVER</b>. You will +need to do this from within a dos prompt window. You should get back a +list of shares available on the server. +</p><p> +If you get a message “<span class="quote"><span class="errorname">network name not found</span></span>” or similar error, then netbios +name resolution is not working. This is usually caused by a problem in <b class="command">nmbd</b>. +To overcome it, you could do one of the following (you only need to choose one of them): +</p><div class="orderedlist"><ol type="1"><li><p> + Fixup the <span class="application">nmbd</span> installation. +</p></li><li><p> + Add the IP address of BIGSERVER to the <b class="command">wins server</b> box in the + advanced TCP/IP setup on the PC. +</p></li><li><p> + Enable Windows name resolution via DNS in the advanced section of the TCP/IP setup. +</p></li><li><p> + Add BIGSERVER to your lmhosts file on the PC. +</p></li></ol></div><p> +If you get a message “<span class="quote"><span class="errorname">invalid network name</span></span>” or +“<span class="quote"><span class="errorname">bad password error</span></span>”, then apply the +same fixes as for the <b class="command">smbclient -L</b> test above. In +particular, make sure your <b class="command">hosts allow</b> line is correct (see the man pages). +</p><p> +Also, do not overlook that fact that when the workstation requests the +connection to the Samba server, it will attempt to connect using the +name with which you logged onto your Windows machine. You need to make +sure that an account exists on your Samba server with that exact same +name and password. +</p><p> +If you get a message “<span class="quote"><span class="errorname">specified computer is not receiving requests</span></span>” or similar, +it probably means that the host is not contactable via TCP services. +Check to see if the host is running TCP wrappers, and if so add an entry in +the <tt class="filename">hosts.allow</tt> file for your client (or subnet, and so on.) +</p></li><li><p> +Run the command <b class="command">net use x: \\BIGSERVER\TMP</b>. You should +be prompted for a password, then you should get a <tt class="computeroutput">command completed +successfully</tt> message. If not, then your PC software is incorrectly +installed or your <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> is incorrect. Make sure your <i class="parameter"><tt>hosts allow</tt></i> +and other config lines in <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> are correct. +</p><p> +It's also possible that the server can't work out what user name to connect you as. +To see if this is the problem, add the line +<a class="indexterm" name="id2970891"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>user</tt></i> = username to the +<i class="parameter"><tt>[tmp]</tt></i> section of +<tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> where <i class="parameter"><tt>username</tt></i> is the +username corresponding to the password you typed. If you find this +fixes things, you may need the username mapping option. +</p><p> +It might also be the case that your client only sends encrypted passwords +and you have <a class="indexterm" name="id2970934"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>encrypt passwords</tt></i> = no in <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt>. +Change this to "yes" to fix this. +</p></li><li><p> +Run the command <b class="command">nmblookup -M <i class="parameter"><tt>testgroup</tt></i></b> where +<i class="parameter"><tt>testgroup</tt></i> is the name of the workgroup that your Samba server and +Windows PCs belong to. You should get back the IP address of the +master browser for that workgroup. +</p><p> +If you do not, then the election process has failed. Wait a minute to +see if it is just being slow, then try again. If it still fails after +that, then look at the browsing options you have set in <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt>. Make +sure you have <a class="indexterm" name="id2971004"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>preferred master</tt></i> = yes to ensure that +an election is held at startup. +</p></li><li><p> +>From file manager, try to browse the server. Your Samba server should +appear in the browse list of your local workgroup (or the one you +specified in <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt>). You should be able to double click on the name +of the server and get a list of shares. If you get the error message “<span class="quote">invalid password</span>”, + you are probably running Windows NT and it +is refusing to browse a server that has no encrypted password +capability and is in User Level Security mode. In this case, either set +<a class="indexterm" name="id2971052"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>security</tt></i> = server and +<a class="indexterm" name="id2971066"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>password server</tt></i> = Windows_NT_Machine in your +<tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file, or make sure <a class="indexterm" name="id2971087"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>encrypt passwords</tt></i> is +set to “<span class="quote">yes</span>”. +</p></li></ol></div></div></div><div class="navfooter"><hr><table width="100%" summary="Navigation footer"><tr><td width="40%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="troubleshooting.html">Prev</a> </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="u" href="troubleshooting.html">Up</a></td><td width="40%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="problems.html">Next</a></td></tr><tr><td width="40%" align="left" valign="top">Part V. Troubleshooting </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="h" href="index.html">Home</a></td><td width="40%" align="right" valign="top"> Chapter 34. Analyzing and Solving Samba Problems</td></tr></table></div></body></html> diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/domain-member.html b/docs/htmldocs/domain-member.html new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..2d73b7c616 --- /dev/null +++ b/docs/htmldocs/domain-member.html @@ -0,0 +1,609 @@ +<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>Chapter 7. Domain Membership</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.60.1"><link rel="home" href="index.html" title="SAMBA Project Documentation"><link rel="up" href="type.html" title="Part II. Server Configuration Basics"><link rel="previous" href="samba-bdc.html" title="Chapter 6. Backup Domain Control"><link rel="next" href="StandAloneServer.html" title="Chapter 8. Stand-alone Servers"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="navheader"><table width="100%" summary="Navigation header"><tr><th colspan="3" align="center">Chapter 7. Domain Membership</th></tr><tr><td width="20%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="samba-bdc.html">Prev</a> </td><th width="60%" align="center">Part II. Server Configuration Basics</th><td width="20%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="StandAloneServer.html">Next</a></td></tr></table><hr></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="domain-member"></a>Chapter 7. Domain Membership</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">John</span> <span class="othername">H.</span> <span class="surname">Terpstra</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org">jht@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Jeremy</span> <span class="surname">Allison</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jra@samba.org">jra@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Gerald</span> <span class="othername">(Jerry)</span> <span class="surname">Carter</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jerry@samba.org">jerry@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Andrew</span> <span class="surname">Tridgell</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:tridge@samba.org">tridge@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Jelmer</span> <span class="othername">R.</span> <span class="surname">Vernooij</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">The Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jelmer@samba.org">jelmer@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Guenther</span> <span class="surname">Deschner</span></h3><span class="contrib">LDAP updates</span><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">SuSE<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:gd@suse.de">gd@suse.de</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="domain-member.html#id2893185">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="domain-member.html#machine-trust-accounts">MS Windows Workstation/Server Machine Trust Accounts</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="domain-member.html#id2893524">Manual Creation of Machine Trust Accounts</a></dt><dt><a href="domain-member.html#id2893846">Managing Domain Machine Accounts using NT4 Server Manager</a></dt><dt><a href="domain-member.html#id2894113">On-the-Fly Creation of Machine Trust Accounts</a></dt><dt><a href="domain-member.html#id2894194">Making an MS Windows Workstation or Server a Domain Member</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="domain-member.html#domain-member-server">Domain Member Server</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="domain-member.html#id2894418">Joining an NT4-type Domain with Samba-3</a></dt><dt><a href="domain-member.html#id2894926">Why Is This Better Than security = server?</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="domain-member.html#ads-member">Samba ADS Domain Membership</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="domain-member.html#id2895131">Configure smb.conf</a></dt><dt><a href="domain-member.html#id2895267">Configure /etc/krb5.conf</a></dt><dt><a href="domain-member.html#ads-create-machine-account">Create the Computer Account</a></dt><dt><a href="domain-member.html#ads-test-server">Testing Server Setup</a></dt><dt><a href="domain-member.html#ads-test-smbclient">Testing with smbclient</a></dt><dt><a href="domain-member.html#id2895840">Notes</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="domain-member.html#id2895877">Sharing User ID Mappings between Samba Domain Members</a></dt><dt><a href="domain-member.html#id2896009">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="domain-member.html#id2896038">Cannot Add Machine Back to Domain</a></dt><dt><a href="domain-member.html#id2896072">Adding Machine to Domain Fails</a></dt><dt><a href="domain-member.html#id2896237">I Can't Join a Windows 2003 PDC</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></div><p> +Domain Membership is a subject of vital concern. Samba must be able to +participate as a member server in a Microsoft Domain Security context, and +Samba must be capable of providing Domain machine member trust accounts, +otherwise it would not be able to offer a viable option for many users. +</p><p> +This chapter covers background information pertaining to Domain Membership, +the Samba configuration for it, and MS Windows client procedures for joining a +domain. Why is this necessary? Because both are areas in which there exists +within the current MS Windows networking world and particularly in the +UNIX/Linux networking and administration world, a considerable level of +misinformation, incorrect understanding and a lack of knowledge. Hopefully +this chapter will fill the voids. +</p><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2893185"></a>Features and Benefits</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +MS Windows workstations and servers that want to participate in Domain Security need to +be made Domain Members. Participating in Domain Security is often called +<span class="emphasis"><em>Single Sign On</em></span> or <span class="acronym">SSO</span> for short. This +chapter describes the process that must be followed to make a workstation +(or another server be it an <span class="application">MS Windows NT4 / 200x</span> +server) or a Samba server a member of an MS Windows Domain Security context. +</p><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2893226"></a> +Samba-3 can join an MS Windows NT4-style domain as a native member server, an +MS Windows Active Directory Domain as a native member server, or a Samba Domain +Control network. Domain Membership has many advantages: +</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2893250"></a> + MS Windows workstation users get the benefit of SSO. + </p></li><li><p> + Domain user access rights and file ownership/access controls can be set + from the single Domain Security Account Manager (SAM) database + (works with Domain Member servers as well as with MS Windows workstations + that are Domain Members). + </p></li><li><p> + Only <span class="application">MS Windows NT4/200x/XP Professional</span> + workstations that are Domain Members can use network logon facilities. + </p></li><li><p> + Domain Member workstations can be better controlled through the use of + Policy files (<tt class="filename">NTConfig.POL</tt>) and Desktop Profiles. + </p></li><li><p> + Through the use of logon scripts, users can be given transparent access to network + applications that run off application servers. + </p></li><li><p> + Network administrators gain better application and user access management + abilities because there is no need to maintain user accounts on any network + client or server, other than the central Domain database + (either NT4/Samba SAM style Domain, NT4 Domain that is backended with an + LDAP directory, or via an Active Directory infrastructure). + </p></li></ul></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="machine-trust-accounts"></a>MS Windows Workstation/Server Machine Trust Accounts</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2893338"></a> +A Machine Trust Account is an account that is used to authenticate a client +machine (rather than a user) to the Domain Controller server. In Windows terminology, +this is known as a “<span class="quote">Computer Account.</span>” The purpose of the machine account +is to prevent a rogue user and Domain Controller from colluding to gain access to a +domain member workstation. +</p><p> +The password of a Machine Trust Account acts as the shared secret for +secure communication with the Domain Controller. This is a security +feature to prevent an unauthorized machine with the same NetBIOS name +from joining the domain and gaining access to domain user/group +accounts. Windows NT/200x/XP Professional clients use machine trust +accounts, but Windows 9x/Me/XP Home clients do not. Hence, a +Windows 9x/Me/XP Home client is never a true member of a Domain +because it does not possess a Machine Trust Account, and, thus, has no +shared secret with the Domain Controller. +</p><p> +A Windows NT4 PDC stores each Machine Trust Account in the Windows Registry. +The introduction of MS Windows 2000 saw the introduction of Active Directory, +the new repository for Machine Trust Accounts. A Samba PDC, however, stores +each Machine Trust Account in two parts, +as follows: + +</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p> + A Domain Security Account (stored in the + <a class="indexterm" name="id2893387"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>passdb backend</tt></i> that has been configured in the + <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file. The precise nature of the account information that is + stored depends on the type of backend database that has been chosen. + </p><p> + The older format of this data is the <tt class="filename">smbpasswd</tt> database + that contains the UNIX login ID, the UNIX user identifier (UID), and the + LanMan and NT encrypted passwords. There is also some other information in + this file that we do not need to concern ourselves with here. + </p><p> + The two newer database types are called ldapsam, and + tdbsam. Both store considerably more data than the + older <tt class="filename">smbpasswd</tt> file did. The extra information + enables new user account controls to be implemented. + </p></li><li><p> + A corresponding UNIX account, typically stored in + <tt class="filename">/etc/passwd</tt>. Work is in progress to allow a + simplified mode of operation that does not require UNIX user accounts, but + this may not be a feature of the early releases of Samba-3. + </p></li></ul></div><p> +</p><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2893465"></a> +There are three ways to create Machine Trust Accounts: +</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p> + Manual creation from the UNIX/Linux command line. Here, both the Samba and + corresponding UNIX account are created by hand. + </p></li><li><p> + <a class="indexterm" name="id2893494"></a> + Using the MS Windows NT4 Server Manager, either from an NT4 Domain Member + server, or using the Nexus toolkit available from the Microsoft Web site. + This tool can be run from any MS Windows machine as long as the user is + logged on as the administrator account. + </p></li><li><p> + “<span class="quote">On-the-fly</span>” creation. The Samba Machine Trust Account is automatically + created by Samba at the time the client is joined to the domain. + (For security, this is the recommended method.) The corresponding UNIX + account may be created automatically or manually. + </p></li></ul></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2893524"></a>Manual Creation of Machine Trust Accounts</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +The first step in manually creating a Machine Trust Account is to manually +create the corresponding UNIX account in <tt class="filename">/etc/passwd</tt>. +This can be done using <b class="command">vipw</b> or another “<span class="quote">add user</span>” command +that is normally used to create new UNIX accounts. The following is an example for +a Linux-based Samba server: +</p><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2893561"></a> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2893570"></a> +</p><pre class="screen"> +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>/usr/sbin/useradd -g machines -d /dev/null -c <i class="replaceable"><tt>"machine nickname"</tt></i> \ + -s /bin/false <i class="replaceable"><tt>machine_name</tt></i>$ </tt></b> + +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>passwd -l <i class="replaceable"><tt>machine_name</tt></i>$</tt></b> +</pre><p> +</p><p>In the above example above there is an existing system group “<span class="quote">machines</span>” which is used +as the primary group for all machine accounts. In the following examples the “<span class="quote">machines</span>” group has +numeric GID equal 100.</p><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2893643"></a> +On *BSD systems, this can be done using the <b class="command">chpass</b> utility: +</p><p> +</p><pre class="screen"> +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>chpass -a \ +'<i class="replaceable"><tt>machine_name</tt></i>$:*:101:100::0:0:Windows <i class="replaceable"><tt>machine_name</tt></i>:/dev/null:/sbin/nologin'</tt></b> +</pre><p> +</p><p> +The <tt class="filename">/etc/passwd</tt> entry will list the machine name +with a “<span class="quote">$</span>” appended, will not have a password, will have a null shell and no +home directory. For example, a machine named “<span class="quote">doppy</span>” would have an +<tt class="filename">/etc/passwd</tt> entry like this: +</p><pre class="programlisting"> +doppy$:x:505:100:<i class="replaceable"><tt>machine_nickname</tt></i>:/dev/null:/bin/false +</pre><p> +Above, <i class="replaceable"><tt>machine_nickname</tt></i> can be any +descriptive name for the client, i.e., BasementComputer. +<i class="replaceable"><tt>machine_name</tt></i> absolutely must be the NetBIOS +name of the client to be joined to the domain. The “<span class="quote">$</span>” must be +appended to the NetBIOS name of the client or Samba will not recognize +this as a Machine Trust Account. +</p><p> +Now that the corresponding UNIX account has been created, the next step is to create +the Samba account for the client containing the well-known initial +Machine Trust Account password. This can be done using the +<b class="command">smbpasswd</b> command +as shown here: +</p><p> +</p><pre class="screen"> +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>smbpasswd -a -m <i class="replaceable"><tt>machine_name</tt></i></tt></b> +</pre><p> +</p><p> +where <i class="replaceable"><tt>machine_name</tt></i> is the machine's NetBIOS +name. The RID of the new machine account is generated from the UID of +the corresponding UNIX account. +</p><div class="warning" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Join the client to the domain immediately</h3><p> +Manually creating a Machine Trust Account using this method is the +equivalent of creating a Machine Trust Account on a Windows NT PDC using +<a class="indexterm" name="id2893821"></a> +the <span class="application">Server Manager</span>. From the time at which the +account is created to the time the client joins the domain and +changes the password, your domain is vulnerable to an intruder joining +your domain using a machine with the same NetBIOS name. A PDC inherently +trusts members of the domain and will serve out a large degree of user +information to such clients. You have been warned! +</p></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2893846"></a>Managing Domain Machine Accounts using NT4 Server Manager</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +A working <a class="indexterm" name="id2893857"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>add machine script</tt></i> script is essential +for machine trust accounts to be automatically created. This applies no matter whether +one uses automatic account creation, or if one wishes to use the NT4 Domain Server Manager. +</p><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2893879"></a> +If the machine from which you are trying to manage the domain is an +<span class="application">MS Windows NT4 workstation or MS Windows 200x/XP Professional</span>, +the tool of choice is the package called <b class="command">SRVTOOLS.EXE</b>. +When executed in the target directory it will unpack <b class="command">SrvMgr.exe</b> +and <b class="command">UsrMgr.exe</b> (both are domain management tools for MS Windows NT4 workstation). +</p><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2893924"></a> +If your workstation is a <span class="application">Microsoft Windows 9x/Me</span> family product + you should download the <b class="command">Nexus.exe</b> package from the Microsoft web site. +When executed from the target directory this will unpack the same tools but for use on +this platform. +</p><p> +Further information about these tools may be obtained from the following locations: +</p><p> +</p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td><ulink url="http://support.microsoft.com/default.aspx?scid=kb;en-us;173673">http://support.microsoft.com/default.aspx?scid=kb;en-us;173673</ulink></td></tr><tr><td><ulink url="http://support.microsoft.com/default.aspx?scid=kb;en-us;172540">http://support.microsoft.com/default.aspx?scid=kb;en-us;172540</ulink></td></tr></table><p> +</p><p> +Launch the <b class="command">srvmgr.exe</b> (Server Manager for Domains) and follow these steps: +</p><div class="procedure"><p class="title"><b>Procedure 7.1. Server Manager Account Machine Account Management</b></p><ol type="1"><li><p> + From the menu select <span class="guimenu">Computer</span>. + </p></li><li><p> + Click <span class="guimenuitem">Select Domain</span>. + </p></li><li><p> + Click the name of the domain you wish to administer in the + <span class="guilabel">Select Domain</span> panel and then click + <span class="guibutton">OK</span>. + </p></li><li><p> + Again from the menu select <span class="guimenu">Computer</span>. + </p></li><li><p> + Select <span class="guimenuitem">Add to Domain</span>. + </p></li><li><p> + In the dialog box, click the radio button to + <span class="guilabel">Add NT Workstation of Server</span>, then + enter the machine name in the field provided, and click the + <span class="guibutton">Add</span> button. + </p></li></ol></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2894113"></a>On-the-Fly Creation of Machine Trust Accounts</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +The second (and recommended) way of creating Machine Trust Accounts is +simply to allow the Samba server to create them as needed when the client +is joined to the domain. +</p><p>Since each Samba Machine Trust Account requires a corresponding UNIX account, a method +for automatically creating the UNIX account is usually supplied; this requires configuration of the +add machine script option in <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt>. This method is not required, however, corresponding UNIX +accounts may also be created manually. +</p><p> +Here is an example for a Red Hat Linux system. +</p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td> </td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>[global]</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td># <...remainder of parameters...></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>add machine script = /usr/sbin/useradd -d /dev/null -g 100 \</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt> -s /bin/false -M %u</tt></i></td></tr></table></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2894194"></a>Making an MS Windows Workstation or Server a Domain Member</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +The procedure for making an MS Windows workstation or server a member of the domain varies +with the version of Windows. +</p><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2894206"></a>Windows 200x/XP Professional Client</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> + When the user elects to make the client a Domain Member, Windows 200x prompts for + an account and password that has privileges to create machine accounts in the domain. + A Samba Administrator Account (i.e., a Samba account that has <tt class="constant">root</tt> privileges on the + Samba server) must be entered here; the operation will fail if an ordinary user + account is given. + </p><p> + For security reasons, the password for this Administrator Account should be set + to a password that is other than that used for the root user in <tt class="filename">/etc/passwd</tt>. + </p><p> + The name of the account that is used to create Domain Member machine accounts can be + anything the network administrator may choose. If it is other than <tt class="constant">root</tt> + then this is easily mapped to <tt class="constant">root</tt> in the file named in the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> parameter + <a class="indexterm" name="id2894264"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>username map</tt></i> = /etc/samba/smbusers. + </p><p> + The session key of the Samba Administrator Account acts as an encryption key for setting the password of the machine trust + account. The Machine Trust Account will be created on-the-fly, or updated if it already exists. + </p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2894288"></a>Windows NT4 Client</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> + If the Machine Trust Account was created manually, on the + Identification Changes menu enter the domain name, but do not + check the box <span class="guilabel">Create a Computer Account in the Domain</span>. + In this case, the existing Machine Trust Account is used to join the machine + to the domain. + </p><p> + If the Machine Trust Account is to be created on-the-fly, on the Identification Changes menu enter the domain + name and check the box <span class="guilabel">Create a Computer Account in the Domain</span>. In this case, joining + the domain proceeds as above for Windows 2000 (i.e., you must supply a Samba Administrator Account when + prompted). + </p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2894329"></a>Samba Client</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p>Joining a Samba client to a domain is documented in + <link linkend="domain-member-server">. + </p></div></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="domain-member-server"></a>Domain Member Server</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +This mode of server operation involves the Samba machine being made a member +of a domain security context. This means by definition that all user +authentication will be done from a centrally defined authentication regime. +The authentication regime may come from an NT3/4-style (old domain technology) +server, or it may be provided from an Active Directory server (ADS) running on +MS Windows 2000 or later. +</p><p> +<span class="emphasis"><em> +Of course it should be clear that the authentication backend itself could be +from any distributed directory architecture server that is supported by Samba. +This can be LDAP (from OpenLDAP), or Sun's iPlanet, or NetWare Directory +Server, and so on. +</em></span> +</p><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3> +When Samba is configured to use an LDAP, or other identity management and/or +directory service, it is Samba that continues to perform user and machine +authentication. It should be noted that the LDAP server does not perform +authentication handling in place of what Samba is designed to do. +</div><p> +Please refer to <link linkend="samba-pdc">, for more information regarding +how to create a domain machine account for a Domain Member server as well as for +information on how to enable the Samba Domain Member machine to join the domain +and be fully trusted by it. +</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2894418"></a>Joining an NT4-type Domain with Samba-3</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p><link linkend="assumptions"> lists names that have been used in the remainder of this chapter.</p><div class="table"><a name="assumptions"></a><p class="title"><b>Table 7.1. Assumptions</b></p><table summary="Assumptions" border="1"><colgroup><col align="right"><col align="left"></colgroup><tbody><tr><td align="right">NetBIOS name:</td><td align="left">SERV1</td></tr><tr><td align="right">Windows 200x/NT domain name:</td><td align="left">MIDEARTH</td></tr><tr><td align="right">Domain's PDC NetBIOS name:</td><td align="left">DOMPDC</td></tr><tr><td align="right">Domain's BDC NetBIOS names:</td><td align="left">DOMBDC1 and DOMBDC2</td></tr></tbody></table></div><p> +First, you must edit your <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file to tell Samba it should now use domain security. +</p><p> + Change (or add) your + <a class="indexterm" name="id2894532"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>security</tt></i> line in the [global] section +of your <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> to read: +</p><p> +</p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>security = domain</tt></i></td></tr></table><p> +</p><p> +Next change the <a class="indexterm" name="id2894576"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>workgroup</tt></i> line in the <i class="parameter"><tt>[global]</tt></i> +section to read: +</p><p> +</p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>workgroup = MIDEARTH</tt></i></td></tr></table><p> +</p><p> +This is the name of the domain we are joining. +</p><p> +You must also have the parameter <a class="indexterm" name="id2894625"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>encrypt passwords</tt></i> +set to <tt class="constant">yes</tt> in order for your users to authenticate to the NT PDC. +This is the defaulty setting if this parameter is not specified. There is no need to specify this +parameter, but if it is specified in the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file, it must be set to <tt class="constant">Yes</tt>. +</p><p> +Finally, add (or modify) a <a class="indexterm" name="id2894664"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>password server</tt></i> line in the [global] +section to read: +</p><p> +</p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>password server = DOMPDC DOMBDC1 DOMBDC2</tt></i></td></tr></table><p> +</p><p> +These are the primary and backup Domain Controllers Samba +will attempt to contact in order to authenticate users. Samba will +try to contact each of these servers in order, so you may want to +rearrange this list in order to spread out the authentication load +among Domain Controllers. +</p><p> +Alternately, if you want smbd to automatically determine +the list of Domain Controllers to use for authentication, you may +set this line to be: +</p><p> +</p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>password server = *</tt></i></td></tr></table><p> +</p><p> +This method allows Samba to use exactly the same mechanism that NT does. The +method either uses broadcast-based name resolution, performs a WINS database +lookup in order to find a Domain Controller against which to authenticate, +or locates the Domain Controller using DNS name resolution. +</p><p> +To join the domain, run this command: +</p><p> +</p><pre class="screen"> +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>net join -S DOMPDC -U<i class="replaceable"><tt>Administrator%password</tt></i></tt></b> +</pre><p> +</p><p> +If the <tt class="option">-S DOMPDC</tt> argument is not given, the domain name will be obtained from <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt>. +</p><p> +The machine is joining the domain DOM, and the PDC for that domain (the only machine +that has write access to the domain SAM database) is DOMPDC, therefore use the <tt class="option">-S</tt> +option. The <i class="replaceable"><tt>Administrator%password</tt></i> is the login name and +password for an account that has the necessary privilege to add machines to the +domain. If this is successful, you will see the message in your terminal window the +text shown below. Where the older NT4 style domain architecture is used: +</p><pre class="screen"> +<tt class="computeroutput">Joined domain DOM.</tt> +</pre><p> +</p><p> +Where Active Directory is used: +</p><pre class="screen"> +<tt class="computeroutput">Joined SERV1 to realm MYREALM.</tt> +</pre><p> +</p><p> +Refer to the <b class="command">net</b> man page for further information. +</p><p> +This process joins the server to the domain without having to create the machine +trust account on the PDC beforehand. +</p><p> +This command goes through the machine account password change protocol, then writes +the new (random) machine account password for this Samba server into a file in the +same directory in which a smbpasswd file would be normally stored: +</p><pre class="screen"> +<tt class="filename">/usr/local/samba/private/secrets.tdb</tt> +or +<tt class="filename">/etc/samba/secrets.tdb</tt>. +</pre><p> +</p><p> +This file is created and owned by root and is not readable by any other user. It is +the key to the Domain-level security for your system, and should be treated as carefully +as a shadow password file. +</p><p> +Finally, restart your Samba daemons and get ready for clients to begin using domain +security. The way you can restart your Samba daemons depends on your distribution, +but in most cases the following will suffice: +</p><pre class="screen"> +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt>/etc/init.d/samba restart +</pre><p> +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2894926"></a>Why Is This Better Than <i class="parameter"><tt>security = server</tt></i>?</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +Currently, domain security in Samba does not free you from +having to create local UNIX users to represent the users attaching +to your server. This means that if Domain user <tt class="constant">DOM\fred +</tt> attaches to your Domain Security Samba server, there needs +to be a local UNIX user fred to represent that user in the UNIX +file system. This is similar to the older Samba security mode +<a class="indexterm" name="id2894953"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>security</tt></i> = server, +where Samba would pass through the authentication request to a Windows +NT server in the same way as a Windows 95 or Windows 98 server would. +</p><p> +Please refer to <link linkend="winbind">, for information on a system +to automatically assign UNIX UIDs and GIDs to Windows NT Domain users and groups. +</p><p> +The advantage to Domain-level security is that the +authentication in Domain-level security is passed down the authenticated +RPC channel in exactly the same way that an NT server would do it. This +means Samba servers now participate in domain trust relationships in +exactly the same way NT servers do (i.e., you can add Samba servers into +a resource domain and have the authentication passed on from a resource +domain PDC to an account domain PDC). +</p><p> +In addition, with <a class="indexterm" name="id2894999"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>security</tt></i> = server, every Samba +daemon on a server has to keep a connection open to the +authenticating server for as long as that daemon lasts. This can drain +the connection resources on a Microsoft NT server and cause it to run +out of available connections. With <a class="indexterm" name="id2895018"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>security</tt></i> = domain, +however, the Samba daemons connect to the PDC/BDC only for as long +as is necessary to authenticate the user and then drop the connection, +thus conserving PDC connection resources. +</p><p> +And finally, acting in the same manner as an NT server +authenticating to a PDC means that as part of the authentication +reply, the Samba server gets the user identification information such +as the user SID, the list of NT groups the user belongs to, and so on. +</p><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p> +Much of the text of this document was first published in the Web magazine +<ulink url="http://www.linuxworld.com">LinuxWorld</ulink> as the article <ulink url="http://www.linuxworld.com/linuxworld/lw-1998-10/lw-10-samba.html">http://www.linuxworld.com/linuxworld/lw-1998-10/lw-10-samba.html</ulink> +<span class="emphasis"><em>Doing the NIS/NT Samba</em></span>. +</p></div></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="ads-member"></a>Samba ADS Domain Membership</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2895091"></a> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2895100"></a> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2895111"></a> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2895119"></a> +This is a rough guide to setting up Samba-3 with Kerberos authentication against a +Windows 200x KDC. A familiarity with Kerberos is assumed. +</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2895131"></a>Configure <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt></h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +You must use at least the following three options in <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt>: +</p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>realm = your.kerberos.REALM</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>security = ADS</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td># The following parameter need only be specified if present.</td></tr><tr><td># The default setting is not present is Yes.</td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>encrypt passwords = yes</tt></i></td></tr></table><p> +In case samba cannot correctly identify the appropriate ADS server using the realm name, use the +<a class="indexterm" name="id2895201"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>password server</tt></i> option in <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt>: +</p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>password server = your.kerberos.server</tt></i></td></tr></table><p> +</p><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p> +You do <span class="emphasis"><em>not</em></span> need a smbpasswd file, and older clients will be authenticated as +if <a class="indexterm" name="id2895249"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>security</tt></i> = domain, although it will not do any harm and +allows you to have local users not in the domain. +</p></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2895267"></a>Configure <tt class="filename">/etc/krb5.conf</tt></h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2895283"></a> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2895292"></a> +With both MIT and Heimdal Kerberos, this is unnecessary, and may be detrimental. All ADS +domains will automatically create SRV records in the DNS zone <i class="parameter"><tt>_kerberos.REALM.NAME</tt></i> for +each KDC in the realm. MIT's, as well as Heimdal's, KRB5 libraries default to checking +for these records, so they will automatically find the KDCs. In addition, +<tt class="filename">krb5.conf</tt> only allows specifying a single KDC, even there if there is more +than one. Using the DNS lookup allows the KRB5 libraries to use whichever KDCs are available. +</p><p> +When manually configuring <tt class="filename">krb5.conf</tt>, the minimal configuration is: +</p><pre class="programlisting"> +[libdefaults] + default_realm = YOUR.KERBEROS.REALM + + [realms] + YOUR.KERBEROS.REALM = { + kdc = your.kerberos.server + } +</pre><p> +When using Heimdal versions before 0.6 use the following configuration settings: +</p><pre class="screen"> +[libdefaults] + default_realm = YOUR.KERBEROS.REALM + default_etypes = des-cbc-crc des-cbc-md5 + default_etypes_des = des-cbc-crc des-cbc-md5 + + [realms] + YOUR.KERBEROS.REALM = { + kdc = your.kerberos.server + } +</pre><p> +</p><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2895372"></a> +Test your config by doing a <b class="userinput"><tt>kinit +<i class="replaceable"><tt>USERNAME</tt></i>@<i class="replaceable"><tt>REALM</tt></i></tt></b> and +making sure that your password is accepted by the Win2000 KDC. +</p><p> +With Heimdal versions earlier than 0.6.x you only can use newly created accounts +in ADS or accounts that have had the password changed once after migration, or +in case of <tt class="constant">Administrator</tt> after installation. At the +moment, a Windows 2003 KDC can only be used with a Heimdal releases later than 0.6 +(and no default etypes in krb5.conf). Unfortunatly this whole area is still +in a state of flux. +</p><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p> +The realm must be in uppercase or you will get “<span class="quote"><span class="errorname">Cannot find KDC for +requested realm while getting initial credentials</span></span>” error (Kerberos +is case-sensitive!). +</p></div><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p> +Time between the two servers must be synchronized. You will get a +“<span class="quote"><span class="errorname">kinit(v5): Clock skew too great while getting initial credentials</span></span>” +if the time difference is more than five minutes. +</p></div><p> +Clock skew limits are configurable in the Kerberos protocols. The default setting is +five minutes. +</p><p> +You also must ensure that you can do a reverse DNS lookup on the IP +address of your KDC. Also, the name that this reverse lookup maps to +must either be the NetBIOS name of the KDC (i.e., the hostname with no +domain attached) or it can alternately be the NetBIOS name followed by the realm. +</p><p> +The easiest way to ensure you get this right is to add a +<tt class="filename">/etc/hosts</tt> entry mapping the IP address of your KDC to +its NetBIOS name. If you do not get this correct then you will get a +<span class="errorname">local error</span> when you try to join the realm. +</p><p> +If all you want is Kerberos support in <span class="application">smbclient</span> then you can skip +directly to <link linkend="ads-test-smbclient"> now. +<link linkend="ads-create-machine-account"> and <link linkend="ads-test-server"> +are needed only if you want Kerberos support for <span class="application">smbd</span> and <span class="application">winbindd</span>. +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="ads-create-machine-account"></a>Create the Computer Account</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +As a user who has write permission on the Samba private directory (usually root), run: +</p><pre class="screen"> +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt> <b class="userinput"><tt>net ads join -U Administrator%password</tt></b> +</pre><p> +</p><p> +When making a Windows client a member of an ADS domain within a complex organization, you +may want to create the machine account within a particular organizational unit. Samba-3 permits +this to be done using the following syntax: +</p><pre class="screen"> +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt> <b class="userinput"><tt>kinit Administrator@your.kerberos.REALM</tt></b> +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt> <b class="userinput"><tt>net ads join “<span class="quote">organizational_unit</span>”</tt></b> +</pre><p> +</p><p> +For example, you may want to create the machine account in a container called “<span class="quote">Servers</span>” +under the organizational directory “<span class="quote">Computers\BusinessUnit\Department</span>” like this: +</p><pre class="screen"> +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt> <b class="userinput"><tt>net ads join "Computers\BusinessUnit\Department\Servers"</tt></b> +</pre><p> +</p><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2895653"></a>Possible Errors</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term"><span class="errorname">ADS support not compiled in</span></span></dt><dd><p>Samba must be reconfigured (remove config.cache) and recompiled + (make clean all install) after the Kerberos libiraries and headers files are installed. + </p></dd><dt><span class="term"><span class="errorname">net ads join prompts for user name</span></span></dt><dd><p>You need to login to the domain using <b class="userinput"><tt>kinit + <i class="replaceable"><tt>USERNAME</tt></i>@<i class="replaceable"><tt>REALM</tt></i></tt></b>. + <i class="replaceable"><tt>USERNAME</tt></i> must be a user who has rights to add a machine + to the domain. </p></dd><dt><span class="term">Unsupported encryption/or checksum types</span></dt><dd><p> + Make sure that the <tt class="filename">/etc/krb5.conf</tt> is correctly configured + for the type and version of Kerberos installed on the system. + </p></dd></dl></div><p> +</p></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="ads-test-server"></a>Testing Server Setup</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +If the join was successful, you will see a new computer account with the +NetBIOS name of your Samba server in Active Directory (in the “<span class="quote">Computers</span>” +folder under Users and Computers. +</p><p> +On a Windows 2000 client, try <b class="userinput"><tt>net use * \\server\share</tt></b>. You should +be logged in with Kerberos without needing to know a password. If this fails then run +<b class="userinput"><tt>klist tickets</tt></b>. Did you get a ticket for the server? Does it have +an encryption type of DES-CBC-MD5? +</p><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3> +Samba can use both DES-CBC-MD5 encryption as well as ARCFOUR-HMAC-MD5 encoding. +</div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="ads-test-smbclient"></a>Testing with <span class="application">smbclient</span></h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2895811"></a> +On your Samba server try to login to a Win2000 server or your Samba +server using <span class="application">smbclient</span> and Kerberos. Use <span class="application">smbclient</span> as usual, but +specify the <tt class="option">-k</tt> option to choose Kerberos authentication. +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2895840"></a>Notes</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +You must change administrator password at least once after DC +install, to create the right encryption types. +</p><p> +Windows 200x does not seem to create the <i class="parameter"><tt>_kerberos._udp</tt></i> and <i class="parameter"><tt>_ldap._tcp</tt></i> in +the default DNS setup. Perhaps this will be fixed later in service packs. +</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2895877"></a>Sharing User ID Mappings between Samba Domain Members</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +Samba maps UNIX users and groups (identified by UIDs and GIDs) to Windows users and groups (identified by SIDs). +These mappings are done by the <i class="parameter"><tt>idmap</tt></i> subsystem of Samba. +</p><p> +In some cases it is useful to share these mappings between Samba Domain Members, +so <span class="emphasis"><em>name->id</em></span> mapping is identical on all machines. +This may be needed in particular when sharing files over both CIFS and NFS. +</p><p>To use the <span class="emphasis"><em>LDAP</em></span> <i class="parameter"><tt>ldap idmap suffix</tt></i>, set:</p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>ldap idmap suffix = ou=Idmap,dc=quenya,dc=org</tt></i></td></tr></table><p>See the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> man page entry for the <a class="indexterm" name="id2895952"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>ldap idmap suffix</tt></i> +parameter for further information.</p><p> +Do not forget to specify also the <a class="indexterm" name="id2895971"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>ldap admin dn</tt></i> +and to make certain to set the LDAP administrative password into the <tt class="filename">secrets.tdb</tt> using: +</p><pre class="screen"> +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt> smbpasswd -w ldap-admin-password +</pre></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2896009"></a>Common Errors</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +In the process of adding/deleting/re-adding Domain Member machine accounts, there are +many traps for the unwary player and many “<span class="quote">little</span>” things that can go wrong. +It is particularly interesting how often subscribers on the Samba mailing list have concluded +after repeated failed attempts to add a machine account that it is necessary to “<span class="quote">re-install</span>” +MS Windows on the machine. In truth, it is seldom necessary to reinstall because of this type +of problem. The real solution is often quite simple and with an understanding of how MS Windows +networking functions, it is easy to overcome. +</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2896038"></a>Cannot Add Machine Back to Domain</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +“<span class="quote">A Windows workstation was re-installed. The original domain machine +account was deleted and added immediately. The workstation will not join the domain if I use +the same machine name. Attempts to add the machine fail with a message that the machine already +exists on the network I know it does not. Why is this failing?</span>” +</p><p> +The original name is still in the NetBIOS name cache and must expire after machine account +deletion before adding that same name as a Domain Member again. The best advice is to delete +the old account and then add the machine with a new name. +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2896072"></a>Adding Machine to Domain Fails</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +“<span class="quote">Adding a Windows 200x or XP Professional machine to the Samba PDC Domain fails with a +message that, <span class="errorname">`The machine could not be added at this time, there is a network problem. +Please try again later.'</span> Why?</span>” +</p><p> +You should check that there is an <a class="indexterm" name="id2896099"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>add machine script</tt></i> in your <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> +file. If there is not, please add one that is appropriate for your OS platform. If a script +has been defined, you will need to debug its operation. Increase the <a class="indexterm" name="id2896124"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>log level</tt></i> +in the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file to level 10, then try to rejoin the domain. Check the logs to see which +operation is failing. +</p><p> +Possible causes include: +</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p> + The script does not actually exist, or could not be located in the path specified. + </p><p> + <span class="emphasis"><em>Corrective action:</em></span> Fix it. Make sure when run manually + that the script will add both the UNIX system account and the Samba SAM account. + </p></li><li><p> + The machine could not be added to the UNIX system accounts file <tt class="filename">/etc/passwd</tt>. + </p><p> + <span class="emphasis"><em>Corrective action:</em></span> Check that the machine name is a legal UNIX + system account name. If the UNIX utility <b class="command">useradd</b> is called, + then make sure that the machine name you are trying to add can be added using this + tool. <b class="command">Useradd</b> on some systems will not allow any upper case characters + nor will it allow spaces in the name. + </p></li></ul></div><p> +The <a class="indexterm" name="id2896217"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>add machine script</tt></i> does not create the +machine account in the Samba backend database, it is there only to create a UNIX system +account to which the Samba backend database account can be mapped. +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2896237"></a>I Can't Join a Windows 2003 PDC</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>Windows 2003 requires SMB signing. Client side SMB signing has been implemented in Samba-3.0. + Set <a class="indexterm" name="id2896249"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>client use spnego</tt></i> = yes when communicating + with a Windows 2003 server.</p></div></div></div><div class="navfooter"><hr><table width="100%" summary="Navigation footer"><tr><td width="40%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="samba-bdc.html">Prev</a> </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="u" href="type.html">Up</a></td><td width="40%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="StandAloneServer.html">Next</a></td></tr><tr><td width="40%" align="left" valign="top">Chapter 6. Backup Domain Control </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="h" href="index.html">Home</a></td><td width="40%" align="right" valign="top"> Chapter 8. Stand-alone Servers</td></tr></table></div></body></html> diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/groupmapping.html b/docs/htmldocs/groupmapping.html new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..da8cf8f4b1 --- /dev/null +++ b/docs/htmldocs/groupmapping.html @@ -0,0 +1,250 @@ +<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>Chapter 12. Group Mapping MS Windows and UNIX</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.60.1"><link rel="home" href="index.html" title="SAMBA Project Documentation"><link rel="up" href="optional.html" title="Part III. Advanced Configuration"><link rel="previous" href="passdb.html" title="Chapter 11. Account Information Databases"><link rel="next" href="AccessControls.html" title="Chapter 13. File, Directory and Share Access Controls"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="navheader"><table width="100%" summary="Navigation header"><tr><th colspan="3" align="center">Chapter 12. Group Mapping MS Windows and UNIX</th></tr><tr><td width="20%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="passdb.html">Prev</a> </td><th width="60%" align="center">Part III. Advanced Configuration</th><td width="20%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="AccessControls.html">Next</a></td></tr></table><hr></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="groupmapping"></a>Chapter 12. Group Mapping MS Windows and UNIX</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">John</span> <span class="othername">H.</span> <span class="surname">Terpstra</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org">jht@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Jean François</span> <span class="surname">Micouleau</span></h3></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Gerald</span> <span class="othername">(Jerry)</span> <span class="surname">Carter</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jerry@samba.org">jerry@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="groupmapping.html#id2909181">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="groupmapping.html#id2909551">Discussion</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="groupmapping.html#id2909853">Default Users, Groups and Relative Identifiers</a></dt><dt><a href="groupmapping.html#id2910488">Example Configuration</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="groupmapping.html#id2910567">Configuration Scripts</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="groupmapping.html#id2910581">Sample smb.conf Add Group Script</a></dt><dt><a href="groupmapping.html#id2910716">Script to Configure Group Mapping</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="groupmapping.html#id2910824">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="groupmapping.html#id2910839">Adding Groups Fails</a></dt><dt><a href="groupmapping.html#id2910907">Adding MS Windows Groups to MS Windows Groups Fails</a></dt><dt><a href="groupmapping.html#id2910933">Adding Domain Users to the Power Users Group</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></div><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2909098"></a> + Starting with Samba-3, new group mapping functionality is available to create associations + between Windows group SIDs and UNIX groups. The <b class="command">groupmap</b> subcommand + included with the <span class="application">net</span> tool can be used to manage these associations. + </p><p> + The new facility for mapping NT Groups to UNIX system groups allows the administrator to decide + which NT Domain Groups are to be exposed to MS Windows clients. Only those NT Groups that map + to a UNIX group that has a value other than the default (<tt class="constant">-1</tt>) will be exposed + in group selection lists in tools that access domain users and groups. + </p><div class="warning" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Warning</h3><p> + <a class="indexterm" name="id2909148"></a> + The <i class="parameter"><tt>domain admin group</tt></i> parameter has been removed in Samba-3 and should no longer + be specified in <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt>. This parameter was used to give the listed users membership in the + <tt class="constant">Domain Admins</tt> Windows group which gave local admin rights on their workstations + (in default configurations). + </p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2909181"></a>Features and Benefits</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> + Samba allows the administrator to create MS Windows NT4/200x group accounts and to + arbitrarily associate them with UNIX/Linux group accounts. + </p><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2909199"></a> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2909207"></a> + Group accounts can be managed using the MS Windows NT4 or MS Windows 200x/XP Professional MMC tools. + Appropriate interface scripts should be provided in <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> if it is desired that UNIX/Linux system + accounts should be automatically created when these tools are used. In the absence of these scripts, and + so long as <b class="command">winbindd</b> is running, Samba group accounts that are created using these + tools will be allocated UNIX UIDs/GIDs from the ID range specified by the + <a class="indexterm" name="id2909237"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>idmap uid</tt></i>/<a class="indexterm" name="id2909250"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>idmap gid</tt></i> + parameters in the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file. + </p><div class="figure"><a name="idmap-sid2gid"></a><p class="title"><b>Figure 12.1. IDMAP: group SID to GID resolution.</b></p><div class="mediaobject"><img src="projdoc/imagefiles/idmap-sid2gid.png" width="270" alt="IDMAP: group SID to GID resolution."></div></div><div class="figure"><a name="idmap-gid2sid"></a><p class="title"><b>Figure 12.2. IDMAP: GID resolution to matching SID.</b></p><div class="mediaobject"><img src="projdoc/imagefiles/idmap-gid2sid.png" width="270" alt="IDMAP: GID resolution to matching SID."></div></div><p> + In both cases, when winbindd is not running, only locally resolvable groups can be recognized. Please refer to + <link linkend="idmap-sid2gid"> and <link linkend="idmap-gid2sid">. The <b class="command">net groupmap</b> is + used to establish UNIX group to NT SID mappings as shown in <link linkend="idmap-store-gid2sid">. + </p><div class="figure"><a name="idmap-store-gid2sid"></a><p class="title"><b>Figure 12.3. IDMAP storing group mappings.</b></p><div class="mediaobject"><img src="projdoc/imagefiles/idmap-store-gid2sid.png" width="270" alt="IDMAP storing group mappings."></div></div><p> + <a class="indexterm" name="id2909453"></a> + <a class="indexterm" name="id2909460"></a> + Administrators should be aware that where <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> group interface scripts make + direct calls to the UNIX/Linux system tools (the shadow utilities, <b class="command">groupadd</b>, + <b class="command">groupdel</b>, and <b class="command">groupmod</b>), the resulting UNIX/Linux group names will be subject + to any limits imposed by these tools. If the tool does not allow upper case characters + or space characters, then the creation of an MS Windows NT4/200x style group of + <span class="emphasis"><em>Engineering Managers</em></span> will attempt to create an identically named + UNIX/Linux group, an attempt that will of course fail. + </p><p> + <a class="indexterm" name="id2909513"></a> + <a class="indexterm" name="id2909521"></a> + There are several possible work-arounds for the operating system tools limitation. One + method is to use a script that generates a name for the UNIX/Linux system group that + fits the operating system limits, and that then just passes the UNIX/Linux group ID (GID) + back to the calling Samba interface. This will provide a dynamic work-around solution. + </p><p> + Another work-around is to manually create a UNIX/Linux group, then manually create the + MS Windows NT4/200x group on the Samba server and then use the <b class="command">net groupmap</b> + tool to connect the two to each other. + </p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2909551"></a>Discussion</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> + When installing <span class="application">MS Windows NT4/200x</span> on a computer, the installation + program creates default users and groups, notably the <tt class="constant">Administrators</tt> group, + and gives that group privileges necessary privileges to perform essential system tasks, + such as the ability to change the date and time or to kill (or close) any process running on the + local machine. + </p><p> + <a class="indexterm" name="id2909584"></a> + The <tt class="constant">Administrator</tt> user is a member of the <tt class="constant">Administrators</tt> group, and thus inherits + <tt class="constant">Administrators</tt> group privileges. If a <tt class="constant">joe</tt> user is created to be a member of the + <tt class="constant">Administrators</tt> group, <tt class="constant">joe</tt> has exactly the same rights as the user, + <tt class="constant">Administrator</tt>. + </p><p> + When an MS Windows NT4/200x/XP machine is made a Domain Member, the “<span class="quote">Domain Admins</span>” group of the + PDC is added to the local <tt class="constant">Administrators</tt> group of the workstation. Every member of the + <tt class="constant">Domain Administrators</tt> group inherits the rights of the local <tt class="constant">Administrators</tt> group when + logging on the workstation. + </p><p> + The following steps describe how to make Samba PDC users members of the <tt class="constant">Domain Admins</tt> group? + </p><div class="orderedlist"><ol type="1"><li><p> + Create a UNIX group (usually in <tt class="filename">/etc/group</tt>), let's call it <tt class="constant">domadm</tt>. + </p></li><li><p> + Add to this group the users that must be “<span class="quote">Administrators</span>”. For example, + if you want <tt class="constant">joe, john</tt> and <tt class="constant">mary</tt> to be administrators, + your entry in <tt class="filename">/etc/group</tt> will look like this: + </p><pre class="programlisting"> + domadm:x:502:joe,john,mary + </pre><p> + </p></li><li><p> + Map this domadm group to the “<span class="quote">Domain Admins</span>” group by running the command: + </p><p> + </p><pre class="screen"> + <tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>net groupmap add ntgroup=“<span class="quote">Domain Admins</span>” UNIXgroup=domadm</tt></b> + </pre><p> + </p><p> + <a class="indexterm" name="id2909766"></a> + The quotes around “<span class="quote">Domain Admins</span>” are necessary due to the space in the group name. + Also make sure to leave no white-space surrounding the equal character (=). + </p></li></ol></div><p> + Now <tt class="constant">joe, john</tt> and <tt class="constant">mary</tt> are domain administrators. + </p><p> + <a class="indexterm" name="id2909799"></a> + It is possible to map any arbitrary UNIX group to any Windows NT4/200x group as well as + making any UNIX group a Windows domain group. For example, if you wanted to include a + UNIX group (e.g., acct) in an ACL on a local file or printer on a Domain Member machine, + you would flag that group as a domain group by running the following on the Samba PDC: + </p><p> +</p><pre class="screen"> +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>net groupmap add rid=1000 ntgroup="Accounting" UNIXgroup=acct</tt></b> +</pre><p> + </p><p> + Be aware that the RID parameter is a unsigned 32-bit integer that should + normally start at 1000. However, this RID must not overlap with any RID assigned + to a user. Verification for this is done differently depending on the passdb backend + you are using. Future versions of the tools may perform the verification automatically, + but for now the burden is on you. + </p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2909853"></a>Default Users, Groups and Relative Identifiers</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2909865"></a> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2909875"></a> + When first installed, Microsoft Windows NT4/200x/XP are preconfigured with certain User, Group, and + Alias entities. Each has a well-known Relative Identifier (RID). These must be preserved for continued + integrity of operation. Samba must be provisioned with certain essential Domain Groups that require + the appropriate RID value. When Samba-3 is configured to use <tt class="constant">tdbsam</tt> the essential + Domain Groups are automatically created. It is the LDAP administrators' responsibility to create + (provision) the default NT Groups. + </p><p> + Each essential Domain Group must be assigned its respective well-kown RID. The default Users, Groups, + Aliases, and RIDs are shown in <link linkend="WKURIDS">. + </p><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3> + When the <i class="parameter"><tt>passdb backend</tt></i> uses LDAP (<tt class="constant">ldapsam</tt>) it is the + admininstrators' responsibility to create the essential Domain Groups, and to assign each its default RID. + </div><p> + It is permissible to create any Domain Group that may be necessary, just make certain that the essential + Domain Groups (well known) have been created and assigned its default RID. Other groups you create may + be assigned any arbitrary RID you care to use. + </p><p> + Be sure to map each Domain Group to a UNIX system group. That is the only way to ensure that the group + will be available for use as an NT Domain Group. + </p><p> + </p><div class="table"><a name="WKURIDS"></a><p class="title"><b>Table 12.1. Well-Known User Default RIDs</b></p><table summary="Well-Known User Default RIDs" border="1"><colgroup><col align="left"><col align="left"><col align="left"><col align="center"></colgroup><thead><tr><th align="left">Well-Known Entity</th><th align="left">RID</th><th align="left">Type</th><th align="center">Essential</th></tr></thead><tbody><tr><td align="left">Domain Administrator</td><td align="left">500</td><td align="left">User</td><td align="center">No</td></tr><tr><td align="left">Domain Guest</td><td align="left">501</td><td align="left">User</td><td align="center">No</td></tr><tr><td align="left">Domain KRBTGT</td><td align="left">502</td><td align="left">User</td><td align="center">No</td></tr><tr><td align="left">Domain Admins</td><td align="left">512</td><td align="left">Group</td><td align="center">Yes</td></tr><tr><td align="left">Domain Users</td><td align="left">513</td><td align="left">Group</td><td align="center">Yes</td></tr><tr><td align="left">Domain Guests</td><td align="left">514</td><td align="left">Group</td><td align="center">Yes</td></tr><tr><td align="left">Domain Computers</td><td align="left">515</td><td align="left">Group</td><td align="center">No</td></tr><tr><td align="left">Domain Controllers</td><td align="left">516</td><td align="left">Group</td><td align="center">No</td></tr><tr><td align="left">Domain Certificate Admins</td><td align="left">517</td><td align="left">Group</td><td align="center">No</td></tr><tr><td align="left">Domain Schema Admins</td><td align="left">518</td><td align="left">Group</td><td align="center">No</td></tr><tr><td align="left">Domain Enterprise Admins</td><td align="left">519</td><td align="left">Group</td><td align="center">No</td></tr><tr><td align="left">Domain Policy Admins</td><td align="left">520</td><td align="left">Group</td><td align="center">No</td></tr><tr><td align="left">Builtin Admins</td><td align="left">544</td><td align="left">Alias</td><td align="center">No</td></tr><tr><td align="left">Builtin users</td><td align="left">545</td><td align="left">Alias</td><td align="center">No</td></tr><tr><td align="left">Builtin Guests</td><td align="left">546</td><td align="left">Alias</td><td align="center">No</td></tr><tr><td align="left">Builtin Power Users</td><td align="left">547</td><td align="left">Alias</td><td align="center">No</td></tr><tr><td align="left">Builtin Account Operators</td><td align="left">548</td><td align="left">Alias</td><td align="center">No</td></tr><tr><td align="left">Builtin System Operators</td><td align="left">549</td><td align="left">Alias</td><td align="center">No</td></tr><tr><td align="left">Builtin Print Operators</td><td align="left">550</td><td align="left">Alias</td><td align="center">No</td></tr><tr><td align="left">Builtin Backup Operators</td><td align="left">551</td><td align="left">Alias</td><td align="center">No</td></tr><tr><td align="left">Builtin Replicator</td><td align="left">552</td><td align="left">Alias</td><td align="center">No</td></tr><tr><td align="left">Builtin RAS Servers</td><td align="left">553</td><td align="left">Alias</td><td align="center">No</td></tr></tbody></table></div><p> + </p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2910488"></a>Example Configuration</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + You can list the various groups in the mapping database by executing + <b class="command">net groupmap list</b>. Here is an example: + </p><a class="indexterm" name="id2910510"></a><p> +</p><pre class="screen"> +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt> <b class="userinput"><tt>net groupmap list</tt></b> +Domain Admins (S-1-5-21-2547222302-1596225915-2414751004-512) -> domadmin +Domain Users (S-1-5-21-2547222302-1596225915-2414751004-513) -> domuser +Domain Guests (S-1-5-21-2547222302-1596225915-2414751004-514) -> domguest +</pre><p> + </p><p> + For complete details on <b class="command">net groupmap</b>, refer to the net(8) man page. + </p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2910567"></a>Configuration Scripts</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> + Everyone needs tools. Some of us like to create our own, others prefer to use canned tools + (i.e., prepared by someone else for general use). + </p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2910581"></a>Sample <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> Add Group Script</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + A script to create complying group names for use by the Samba group interfaces + is provided in <link linkend="smbgrpadd.sh">. + </p><a class="indexterm" name="id2910610"></a><p> +</p><div class="example"><a name="smbgrpadd.sh"></a><p class="title"><b>Example 12.1. smbgrpadd.sh</b></p><pre class="programlisting"> + +#!/bin/bash + +# Add the group using normal system groupadd tool. +groupadd smbtmpgrp00 + +thegid=`cat /etc/group | grep smbtmpgrp00 | cut -d ":" -f3` + +# Now change the name to what we want for the MS Windows networking end +cp /etc/group /etc/group.bak +cat /etc/group.bak | sed s/smbtmpgrp00/$1/g > /etc/group + +# Now return the GID as would normally happen. +echo $thegid +exit 0 +</pre></div><p> +</p><p> + The <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> entry for the above script would be something like that in <link linkend="smbgrpadd">. +</p><div class="example"><a name="smbgrpadd"></a><p class="title"><b>Example 12.2. Configuration of smb.conf for the add group script.</b></p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td> </td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>[global]</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td>...</td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>add group script = /path_to_tool/smbgrpadd.sh %g</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td>...</td></tr></table></div><p> + </p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2910716"></a>Script to Configure Group Mapping</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + In our example we have created a UNIX/Linux group called <span class="emphasis"><em>ntadmin</em></span>. + Our script will create the additional groups <span class="emphasis"><em>Orks</em></span>, <span class="emphasis"><em>Elves</em></span>, and <span class="emphasis"><em>Gnomes</em></span>. + It is a good idea to save this shell script for later re-use just in case you ever need to rebuild your mapping database. + For the sake of concenience we elect to save this script as a file called <tt class="filename">initGroups.sh</tt>. + This script is given in <link linkend="set-group-map">. + </p><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2910771"></a> +</p><div class="example"><a name="set-group-map"></a><p class="title"><b>Example 12.3. Script to Set Group Mapping</b></p><pre class="programlisting"> +#!/bin/bash + +net groupmap modify ntgroup="Domain Admins" unixgroup=ntadmin +net groupmap modify ntgroup="Domain Users" unixgroup=users +net groupmap modify ntgroup="Domain Guests" unixgroup=nobody + +groupadd Orks +groupadd Elves +groupadd Gnomes + +net groupmap add ntgroup="Orks" unixgroup=Orks type=d +net groupmap add ntgroup="Elves" unixgroup=Elves type=d +net groupmap add ntgroup="Gnomes" unixgroup=Gnomes type=d +</pre></div><p> +</p><p> + Of course it is expected that the administrator will modify this to suit local needs. + For information regarding the use of the <b class="command">net groupmap</b> tool please + refer to the man page. + </p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2910824"></a>Common Errors</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +At this time there are many little surprises for the unwary administrator. In a real sense +it is imperative that every step of automated control scripts must be carefully tested +manually before putting them into active service. +</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2910839"></a>Adding Groups Fails</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + This is a common problem when the <b class="command">groupadd</b> is called directly + by the Samba interface script for the <a class="indexterm" name="id2910858"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>add group script</tt></i> in + the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file. + </p><p> + The most common cause of failure is an attempt to add an MS Windows group account + that has either an upper case character and/or a space character in it. + </p><p> + There are three possible work-arounds. First, use only group names that comply + with the limitations of the UNIX/Linux <b class="command">groupadd</b> system tool. + Second, it involves the use of the script mentioned earlier in this chapter, and + third is the option is to manually create a UNIX/Linux group account that can substitute + for the MS Windows group name, then use the procedure listed above to map that group + to the MS Windows group. + </p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2910907"></a>Adding MS Windows Groups to MS Windows Groups Fails</h3></div></div><div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2910916"></a><p> + Samba-3 does not support nested groups from the MS Windows control environment. + </p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2910933"></a>Adding <span class="emphasis"><em>Domain Users</em></span> to the <span class="emphasis"><em>Power Users</em></span> Group</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>“<span class="quote"> + What must I do to add Domain Users to the Power Users group? + </span>”</p><a class="indexterm" name="id2910956"></a><p> + The Power Users group is a group that is local to each Windows 200x/XP Professional workstation. + You cannot add the Domain Users group to the Power Users group automatically, it must be done on + each workstation by logging in as the local workstation <span class="emphasis"><em>administrator</em></span> and + then using the following procedure: + </p><div class="procedure"><ol type="1"><li><p> + Click <span class="guimenu">Start -> Control Panel -> Users and Passwords</span>. + </p></li><li><p> + Click the <span class="guimenuitem">Advanced</span> tab. + </p></li><li><p> + Click the <span class="guibutton">Advanced</span> button. + </p></li><li><p> + Click <tt class="constant">Groups</tt>. + </p></li><li><p> + Double click <tt class="constant">Power Users</tt>. This will launch the panel to add users or groups + to the local machine <tt class="constant">Power Uses</tt> group. + </p></li><li><p> + Click the <span class="guibutton">Add</span> button. + </p></li><li><p> + Select the domain from which the <tt class="constant">Domain Users</tt> group is to be added. + </p></li><li><p> + Double click the <tt class="constant">Domain Users</tt> group. + </p></li><li><p> + Click the <span class="guibutton">Ok</span> button. If a logon box is presented during this process + please remember to enter the connect as <tt class="constant">DOMAIN\UserName</tt>. i.e., For the + domain <tt class="constant">MIDEARTH</tt> and the user <tt class="constant">root</tt> enter + <tt class="constant">MIDEARTH\root</tt>. + </p></li></ol></div></div></div></div><div class="navfooter"><hr><table width="100%" summary="Navigation footer"><tr><td width="40%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="passdb.html">Prev</a> </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="u" href="optional.html">Up</a></td><td width="40%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="AccessControls.html">Next</a></td></tr><tr><td width="40%" align="left" valign="top">Chapter 11. Account Information Databases </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="h" href="index.html">Home</a></td><td width="40%" align="right" valign="top"> Chapter 13. File, Directory and Share Access Controls</td></tr></table></div></body></html> diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/index.html b/docs/htmldocs/index.html new file mode 100755 index 0000000000..c996a93dc7 --- /dev/null +++ b/docs/htmldocs/index.html @@ -0,0 +1,40 @@ +<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>SAMBA Project Documentation</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.60.1"><meta name="description" content=" +This book is a collection of HOWTOs added to Samba documentation over the years. +Samba is always under development, and so is its' documentation. This release of the +documentation represents a major revision or layout as well as contents. +The most recent version of this document can be found at +http://www.samba.org/ +on the "Documentation" page. Please send updates to +Jelmer Vernooij, +John H. Terpstra or +Gerald (Jerry) Carter. + +The Samba-Team would like to express sincere thanks to the many people who have with +or without their knowledge contributed to this update. The size and scope of this +project would not have been possible without significant community contribution. A not +insignificant number of ideas for inclusion (if not content itself) has been obtained +from a number of Unofficial HOWTOs - to each such author a big "Thank-you" is also offered. +Please keep publishing your Unofficial HOWTOs - they are a source of inspiration and +application knowledge that is most to be desired by many Samba users and administrators. +"><link rel="home" href="index.html" title="SAMBA Project Documentation"><link rel="next" href="pr01.html" title="Legal Notice"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="navheader"><table width="100%" summary="Navigation header"><tr><th colspan="3" align="center">SAMBA Project Documentation</th></tr><tr><td width="20%" align="left"> </td><th width="60%" align="center"> </th><td width="20%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="pr01.html">Next</a></td></tr></table><hr></div><div class="book" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h1 class="title"><a name="Samba-HOWTO-Collection"></a>SAMBA Project Documentation</h1></div><div><div class="authorgroup"><h4 class="editedby">Edited by</h4><h3 class="editor"><span class="firstname">Jelmer</span> <span class="othername">R.</span> <span class="surname">Vernooij</span></h3><h3 class="editor"><span class="firstname">John</span> <span class="othername">H.</span> <span class="surname">Terpstra</span></h3><h3 class="editor"><span class="firstname">Gerald</span> <span class="othername">(Jerry)</span> <span class="surname">Carter</span></h3></div></div><div><p class="pubdate">Monday April 21, 2003</p></div><div><div class="abstract"><p class="title"><b>Abstract</b></p><p> +This book is a collection of HOWTOs added to Samba documentation over the years. +Samba is always under development, and so is its' documentation. This release of the +documentation represents a major revision or layout as well as contents. +The most recent version of this document can be found at +<ulink url="http://www.samba.org/">http://www.samba.org/</ulink> +on the "Documentation" page. Please send updates to +<ulink url="mailto:jelmer@samba.org">Jelmer Vernooij</ulink>, +<ulink url="mailto:jht@samba.org">John H. Terpstra</ulink> or +<ulink url="mailto:jerry@samba.org">Gerald (Jerry) Carter</ulink>. +</p><p> +The Samba-Team would like to express sincere thanks to the many people who have with +or without their knowledge contributed to this update. The size and scope of this +project would not have been possible without significant community contribution. A not +insignificant number of ideas for inclusion (if not content itself) has been obtained +from a number of Unofficial HOWTOs - to each such author a big "Thank-you" is also offered. +Please keep publishing your Unofficial HOWTOs - they are a source of inspiration and +application knowledge that is most to be desired by many Samba users and administrators. +</p></div></div></div><div></div><hr></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="pr01.html">Legal Notice</a></dt><dt><a href="pr02.html">Attributions</a></dt><dt>I. <a href="introduction.html">General Installation</a></dt><dd><dl><dt>1. <a href="IntroSMB.html">Introduction to Samba</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="IntroSMB.html#id2875896">Background</a></dt><dt><a href="IntroSMB.html#id2875954">Terminology</a></dt><dt><a href="IntroSMB.html#id2876091">Related Projects</a></dt><dt><a href="IntroSMB.html#id2876169">SMB Methodology</a></dt><dt><a href="IntroSMB.html#id2876258">Epilogue</a></dt><dt><a href="IntroSMB.html#id2876344">Miscellaneous</a></dt></dl></dd><dt>2. <a href="install.html">How to Install and Test SAMBA</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="install.html#id2876533">Obtaining and Installing Samba</a></dt><dt><a href="install.html#id2876568">Configuring Samba (smb.conf)</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="install.html#id2876606">Configuration file syntax</a></dt><dt><a href="install.html#id2876766">Example Configuration</a></dt><dt><a href="install.html#id2885184">SWAT</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="install.html#id2885250">List Shares Available on the Server</a></dt><dt><a href="install.html#id2885315">Connect with a UNIX Client</a></dt><dt><a href="install.html#id2885433">Connect from a Remote SMB Client</a></dt><dt><a href="install.html#id2885526">What If Things Don't Work?</a></dt><dt><a href="install.html#id2885557">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="install.html#id2885570">Large Number of smbd Processes</a></dt><dt><a href="install.html#id2885679">Error Message: open_oplock_ipc</a></dt><dt><a href="install.html#id2885717">The network name cannot be found</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>3. <a href="FastStart.html">Fast Start for the Impatient</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="FastStart.html#id2885815">Note</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>II. <a href="type.html">Server Configuration Basics</a></dt><dd><dl><dt>4. <a href="ServerType.html">Server Types and Security Modes</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="ServerType.html#id2885999">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="ServerType.html#id2886097">Server Types</a></dt><dt><a href="ServerType.html#id2886186">Samba Security Modes</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="ServerType.html#id2886291">User Level Security</a></dt><dt><a href="ServerType.html#id2886413">Share Level Security</a></dt><dt><a href="ServerType.html#id2886525">Domain Security Mode (User Level Security)</a></dt><dt><a href="ServerType.html#id2886821">ADS Security Mode (User Level Security)</a></dt><dt><a href="ServerType.html#id2886928">Server Security (User Level Security)</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="ServerType.html#id2887204">Password Checking</a></dt><dt><a href="ServerType.html#id2887400">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="ServerType.html#id2887429">What Makes Samba a Server?</a></dt><dt><a href="ServerType.html#id2887468">What Makes Samba a Domain Controller?</a></dt><dt><a href="ServerType.html#id2887504">What Makes Samba a Domain Member?</a></dt><dt><a href="ServerType.html#id2887542">Constantly Losing Connections to Password Server</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>5. <a href="samba-pdc.html">Domain Control</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="samba-pdc.html#id2870050">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="samba-pdc.html#id2870321">Basics of Domain Control</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="samba-pdc.html#id2870336">Domain Controller Types</a></dt><dt><a href="samba-pdc.html#id2889080">Preparing for Domain Control</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="samba-pdc.html#id2889458">Domain Control Example Configuration</a></dt><dt><a href="samba-pdc.html#id2889951">Samba ADS Domain Control</a></dt><dt><a href="samba-pdc.html#id2889989">Domain and Network Logon Configuration</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="samba-pdc.html#id2890004">Domain Network Logon Service</a></dt><dt><a href="samba-pdc.html#id2890439">Security Mode and Master Browsers</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="samba-pdc.html#id2890570">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="samba-pdc.html#id2890577">$ Cannot Be Included in Machine Name</a></dt><dt><a href="samba-pdc.html#id2890661">Joining Domain Fails Because of Existing Machine Account</a></dt><dt><a href="samba-pdc.html#id2890722">The System Cannot Log You On (C000019B)</a></dt><dt><a href="samba-pdc.html#id2890822">The Machine Trust Account Is Not Accessible</a></dt><dt><a href="samba-pdc.html#id2890899">Account Disabled</a></dt><dt><a href="samba-pdc.html#id2890932">Domain Controller Unavailable</a></dt><dt><a href="samba-pdc.html#id2890954">Cannot Log onto Domain Member Workstation After Joining Domain</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>6. <a href="samba-bdc.html">Backup Domain Control</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="samba-bdc.html#id2891162">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="samba-bdc.html#id2891552">Essential Background Information</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="samba-bdc.html#id2891580">MS Windows NT4-style Domain Control</a></dt><dt><a href="samba-bdc.html#id2891874">LDAP Configuration Notes</a></dt><dt><a href="samba-bdc.html#id2892094">Active Directory Domain Control</a></dt><dt><a href="samba-bdc.html#id2892115">What Qualifies a Domain Controller on the Network?</a></dt><dt><a href="samba-bdc.html#id2892157">How does a Workstation find its Domain Controller?</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="samba-bdc.html#id2892268">Backup Domain Controller Configuration</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="samba-bdc.html#id2892538">Example Configuration</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="samba-bdc.html#id2892768">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="samba-bdc.html#id2892791">Machine Accounts Keep Expiring</a></dt><dt><a href="samba-bdc.html#id2892845">Can Samba Be a Backup Domain Controller to an NT4 PDC?</a></dt><dt><a href="samba-bdc.html#id2892880">How Do I Replicate the smbpasswd File?</a></dt><dt><a href="samba-bdc.html#id2892948">Can I Do This All with LDAP?</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>7. <a href="domain-member.html">Domain Membership</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="domain-member.html#id2893185">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="domain-member.html#machine-trust-accounts">MS Windows Workstation/Server Machine Trust Accounts</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="domain-member.html#id2893524">Manual Creation of Machine Trust Accounts</a></dt><dt><a href="domain-member.html#id2893846">Managing Domain Machine Accounts using NT4 Server Manager</a></dt><dt><a href="domain-member.html#id2894113">On-the-Fly Creation of Machine Trust Accounts</a></dt><dt><a href="domain-member.html#id2894194">Making an MS Windows Workstation or Server a Domain Member</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="domain-member.html#domain-member-server">Domain Member Server</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="domain-member.html#id2894418">Joining an NT4-type Domain with Samba-3</a></dt><dt><a href="domain-member.html#id2894926">Why Is This Better Than security = server?</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="domain-member.html#ads-member">Samba ADS Domain Membership</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="domain-member.html#id2895131">Configure smb.conf</a></dt><dt><a href="domain-member.html#id2895267">Configure /etc/krb5.conf</a></dt><dt><a href="domain-member.html#ads-create-machine-account">Create the Computer Account</a></dt><dt><a href="domain-member.html#ads-test-server">Testing Server Setup</a></dt><dt><a href="domain-member.html#ads-test-smbclient">Testing with smbclient</a></dt><dt><a href="domain-member.html#id2895840">Notes</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="domain-member.html#id2895877">Sharing User ID Mappings between Samba Domain Members</a></dt><dt><a href="domain-member.html#id2896009">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="domain-member.html#id2896038">Cannot Add Machine Back to Domain</a></dt><dt><a href="domain-member.html#id2896072">Adding Machine to Domain Fails</a></dt><dt><a href="domain-member.html#id2896237">I Can't Join a Windows 2003 PDC</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>8. <a href="StandAloneServer.html">Stand-alone Servers</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="StandAloneServer.html#id2896324">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="StandAloneServer.html#id2896363">Background</a></dt><dt><a href="StandAloneServer.html#id2896435">Example Configuration</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="StandAloneServer.html#RefDocServer">Reference Documentation Server</a></dt><dt><a href="StandAloneServer.html#SimplePrintServer">Central Print Serving</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="StandAloneServer.html#id2897068">Common Errors</a></dt></dl></dd><dt>9. <a href="ClientConfig.html">MS Windows Network Configuration Guide</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="ClientConfig.html#id2897131">Note</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>III. <a href="optional.html">Advanced Configuration</a></dt><dd><dl><dt>10. <a href="NetworkBrowsing.html">Network Browsing</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2897285">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2887786">What Is Browsing?</a></dt><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#netdiscuss">Discussion</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2888109">NetBIOS over TCP/IP</a></dt><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2888380">TCP/IP without NetBIOS</a></dt><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#adsdnstech">DNS and Active Directory</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2888743">How Browsing Functions</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#DMB">Configuring WORKGROUP Browsing</a></dt><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2900135">DOMAIN Browsing Configuration</a></dt><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#browse-force-master">Forcing Samba to Be the Master</a></dt><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2900550">Making Samba the Domain Master</a></dt><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2900727">Note about Broadcast Addresses</a></dt><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2900745">Multiple Interfaces</a></dt><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2900780">Use of the Remote Announce Parameter</a></dt><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2900939">Use of the Remote Browse Sync Parameter</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2901016">WINS The Windows Internetworking Name Server</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2901208">WINS Server Configuration</a></dt><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2901481">WINS Replication</a></dt><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2901518">Static WINS Entries</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2901602">Helpful Hints</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2901616">Windows Networking Protocols</a></dt><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2901696">Name Resolution Order</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2901872">Technical Overview of Browsing</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2901926">Browsing Support in Samba</a></dt><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2902057">Problem Resolution</a></dt><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2902187">Cross-Subnet Browsing</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2902960">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2902975">How Can One Flush the Samba NetBIOS Name Cache without Restarting Samba?</a></dt><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2903041">Server Resources Can Not Be Listed</a></dt><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2903097">I get an `Unable to browse the network' error</a></dt><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2903157">Browsing of Shares and Directories is Very Slow</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>11. <a href="passdb.html">Account Information Databases</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="passdb.html#id2903592">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="passdb.html#id2903640">Backward Compatibility Backends</a></dt><dt><a href="passdb.html#id2903800">New Backends</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="passdb.html#passdbtech">Technical Information</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="passdb.html#id2904193">Important Notes About Security</a></dt><dt><a href="passdb.html#id2904429">Mapping User Identifiers between MS Windows and UNIX</a></dt><dt><a href="passdb.html#idmapbackend">Mapping Common UIDs/GIDs on Distributed Machines</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="passdb.html#acctmgmttools">Account Management Tools</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="passdb.html#id2904747">The smbpasswd Command</a></dt><dt><a href="passdb.html#pdbeditthing">The pdbedit Command</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="passdb.html#id2905334">Password Backends</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="passdb.html#id2905385">Plaintext</a></dt><dt><a href="passdb.html#id2905425">smbpasswd Encrypted Password Database</a></dt><dt><a href="passdb.html#id2905552">tdbsam</a></dt><dt><a href="passdb.html#id2905605">ldapsam</a></dt><dt><a href="passdb.html#id2907687">MySQL</a></dt><dt><a href="passdb.html#XMLpassdb">XML</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="passdb.html#id2908781">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="passdb.html#id2908788">Users Cannot Logon</a></dt><dt><a href="passdb.html#id2908830">Users Being Added to the Wrong Backend Database</a></dt><dt><a href="passdb.html#id2908922">Configuration of auth methods</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>12. <a href="groupmapping.html">Group Mapping MS Windows and UNIX</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="groupmapping.html#id2909181">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="groupmapping.html#id2909551">Discussion</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="groupmapping.html#id2909853">Default Users, Groups and Relative Identifiers</a></dt><dt><a href="groupmapping.html#id2910488">Example Configuration</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="groupmapping.html#id2910567">Configuration Scripts</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="groupmapping.html#id2910581">Sample smb.conf Add Group Script</a></dt><dt><a href="groupmapping.html#id2910716">Script to Configure Group Mapping</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="groupmapping.html#id2910824">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="groupmapping.html#id2910839">Adding Groups Fails</a></dt><dt><a href="groupmapping.html#id2910907">Adding MS Windows Groups to MS Windows Groups Fails</a></dt><dt><a href="groupmapping.html#id2910933">Adding Domain Users to the Power Users Group</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>13. <a href="AccessControls.html">File, Directory and Share Access Controls</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="AccessControls.html#id2911341">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="AccessControls.html#id2911525">File System Access Controls</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="AccessControls.html#id2911543">MS Windows NTFS Comparison with UNIX File Systems</a></dt><dt><a href="AccessControls.html#id2911956">Managing Directories</a></dt><dt><a href="AccessControls.html#id2912050">File and Directory Access Control</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="AccessControls.html#id2912290">Share Definition Access Controls</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="AccessControls.html#id2912329">User and Group-Based Controls</a></dt><dt><a href="AccessControls.html#id2912779">File and Directory Permissions-Based Controls</a></dt><dt><a href="AccessControls.html#id2913187">Miscellaneous Controls</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="AccessControls.html#id2913585">Access Controls on Shares</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="AccessControls.html#id2913670">Share Permissions Management</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="AccessControls.html#id2913978">MS Windows Access Control Lists and UNIX Interoperability</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="AccessControls.html#id2913986">Managing UNIX Permissions Using NT Security Dialogs</a></dt><dt><a href="AccessControls.html#id2914042">Viewing File Security on a Samba Share</a></dt><dt><a href="AccessControls.html#id2914124">Viewing File Ownership</a></dt><dt><a href="AccessControls.html#id2914264">Viewing File or Directory Permissions</a></dt><dt><a href="AccessControls.html#id2914515">Modifying File or Directory Permissions</a></dt><dt><a href="AccessControls.html#id2914698">Interaction with the Standard Samba create mask Parameters</a></dt><dt><a href="AccessControls.html#id2915106">Interaction with the Standard Samba File Attribute Mapping</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="AccessControls.html#id2915195">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="AccessControls.html#id2915209">Users Cannot Write to a Public Share</a></dt><dt><a href="AccessControls.html#id2915635">File Operations Done as root with force user Set</a></dt><dt><a href="AccessControls.html#id2915690">MS Word with Samba Changes Owner of File</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>14. <a href="locking.html">File and Record Locking</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="locking.html#id2915945">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="locking.html#id2916001">Discussion</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="locking.html#id2916148">Opportunistic Locking Overview</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="locking.html#id2916856">Samba Opportunistic Locking Control</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="locking.html#id2916978">Example Configuration</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="locking.html#id2917407">MS Windows Opportunistic Locking and Caching Controls</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="locking.html#id2917632">Workstation Service Entries</a></dt><dt><a href="locking.html#id2917660">Server Service Entries</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="locking.html#id2917740">Persistent Data Corruption</a></dt><dt><a href="locking.html#id2917769">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="locking.html#id2917850">locking.tdb Error Messages</a></dt><dt><a href="locking.html#id2917884">Problems Saving Files in MS Office on Windows XP</a></dt><dt><a href="locking.html#id2917904">Long Delays Deleting Files Over Network with XP SP1</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="locking.html#id2917935">Additional Reading</a></dt></dl></dd><dt>15. <a href="securing-samba.html">Securing Samba</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="securing-samba.html#id2918114">Introduction</a></dt><dt><a href="securing-samba.html#id2918159">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="securing-samba.html#id2918244">Technical Discussion of Protective Measures and Issues</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="securing-samba.html#id2918263">Using Host-Based Protection</a></dt><dt><a href="securing-samba.html#id2918364">User-Based Protection</a></dt><dt><a href="securing-samba.html#id2918424">Using Interface Protection</a></dt><dt><a href="securing-samba.html#id2918507">Using a Firewall</a></dt><dt><a href="securing-samba.html#id2918564">Using IPC$ Share-Based Denials </a></dt><dt><a href="securing-samba.html#id2918648">NTLMv2 Security</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="securing-samba.html#id2918707">Upgrading Samba</a></dt><dt><a href="securing-samba.html#id2918731">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="securing-samba.html#id2918750">Smbclient Works on Localhost, but the Network Is Dead</a></dt><dt><a href="securing-samba.html#id2918774">Why Can Users Access Home Directories of Other Users?</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>16. <a href="InterdomainTrusts.html">Interdomain Trust Relationships</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="InterdomainTrusts.html#id2919130">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="InterdomainTrusts.html#id2919159">Trust Relationship Background</a></dt><dt><a href="InterdomainTrusts.html#id2919243">Native MS Windows NT4 Trusts Configuration</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="InterdomainTrusts.html#id2919270">Creating an NT4 Domain Trust</a></dt><dt><a href="InterdomainTrusts.html#id2919342">Completing an NT4 Domain Trust</a></dt><dt><a href="InterdomainTrusts.html#id2919402">Inter-Domain Trust Facilities</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="InterdomainTrusts.html#id2919600">Configuring Samba NT-Style Domain Trusts</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="InterdomainTrusts.html#samba-trusted-domain">Samba as the Trusted Domain</a></dt><dt><a href="InterdomainTrusts.html#id2919809">Samba as the Trusting Domain</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="InterdomainTrusts.html#id2919952">NT4-Style Domain Trusts with Windows 2000</a></dt><dt><a href="InterdomainTrusts.html#id2920058">Common Errors</a></dt></dl></dd><dt>17. <a href="msdfs.html">Hosting a Microsoft Distributed File System tree on Samba</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="msdfs.html#id2920158">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="msdfs.html#id2920447">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="msdfs.html#id2920488">MSDFS UNIX Path Is Case-Critical</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>18. <a href="printing.html">Classical Printing Support</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="printing.html#id2920666">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2920765">Technical Introduction</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="printing.html#id2920831">Client to Samba Print Job Processing</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2920903">Printing Related Configuration Parameters</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="printing.html#id2920998">Simple Print Configuration</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="printing.html#id2921211">Verifing Configuration with testparm</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2921327">Rapid Configuration Validation</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="printing.html#id2921667">Extended Printing Configuration</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="printing.html#id2922020">Detailed Explanation Settings</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="printing.html#id2924414">Printing Developments Since Samba-2.2</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="printing.html#id2924566">Point'n'Print Client Drivers on Samba Servers</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2924710">The Obsoleted [printer$] Section</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2924810">Creating the [print$] Share</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2925021">[print$] Section Parameters</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2925355">The [print$] Share Directory</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="printing.html#id2925525">Installing Drivers into [print$]</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="printing.html#id2925644">Add Printer Wizard Driver Installation</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#inst-rpc">Installing Print Drivers Using rpcclient</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="printing.html#id2927518">Client Driver Installation Procedure</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="printing.html#id2927537">First Client Driver Installation</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2927769">Setting Device Modes on New Printers</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2928112">Additional Client Driver Installation</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2928220">Always Make First Client Connection as root or printer admin</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="printing.html#id2928404">Other Gotchas</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="printing.html#id2928430">Setting Default Print Options for Client Drivers</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2928854">Supporting Large Numbers of Printers</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2929151">Adding New Printers with the Windows NT APW</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2929458">Error Message: Cannot connect under a different Name</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2929564">Take Care When Assembling Driver Files</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2929923">Samba and Printer Ports</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2930008">Avoiding Common Client Driver Misconfiguration</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="printing.html#id2930033">The Imprints Toolset</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="printing.html#id2930071">What is Imprints?</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2930113">Creating Printer Driver Packages</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2930132">The Imprints Server</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2930153">The Installation Client</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="printing.html#id2930314">Adding Network Printers without User Interaction</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2930639">The addprinter Command</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2930686">Migration of Classical Printing to Samba</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2930861">Publishing Printer Information in Active Directory or LDAP</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2930884">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="printing.html#id2930892">I Give My Root Password but I Do Not Get Access</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2930943">My Print Jobs Get Spooled into the Spooling Directory, but Then Get Lost</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>19. <a href="CUPS-printing.html">CUPS Printing Support</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2931072">Introduction</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2931079">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2931130">Overview</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2931182">Basic CUPS Support Configuration</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2931276">Linking smbd with libcups.so</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2931526">Simple smb.conf Settings for CUPS</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2931722">More Complex CUPS smb.conf Settings</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2932089">Advanced Configuration</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2932110">Central Spooling vs. Peer-to-Peer Printing</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2932163">Raw Print Serving Vendor Drivers on Windows Clients</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2932223">Installation of Windows Client Drivers</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#cups-raw">Explicitly Enable raw Printing for application/octet-stream</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2932552">Driver Upload Methods</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2932699">Advanced Intelligent Printing with PostScript Driver Download</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#gdipost">GDI on Windows -- PostScript on UNIX</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2932876">Windows Drivers, GDI and EMF</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2933049">UNIX Printfile Conversion and GUI Basics</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#post-and-ghost">PostScript and Ghostscript</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2933354">Ghostscript the Software RIP for Non-PostScript Printers</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2933497">PostScript Printer Description (PPD) Specification</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2933573">Using Windows-Formatted Vendor PPDs</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2933679">CUPS Also Uses PPDs for Non-PostScript Printers</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2933709">The CUPS Filtering Architecture</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2933883">MIME Types and CUPS Filters</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2934118">MIME Type Conversion Rules</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2934287">Filtering Overview</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2934481">Prefilters</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2934591">pstops</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2934715">pstoraster</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2934912">imagetops and imagetoraster</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2934991">rasterto [printers specific]</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2935143">CUPS Backends</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2935508">The Role of cupsomatic/foomatic</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2935673">The Complete Picture</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2935688">mime.convs</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2935752">Raw Printing</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2935861">application/octet-stream Printing</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2936129">PostScript Printer Descriptions (PPDs) for Non-PS Printers</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2936430">cupsomatic/foomatic-rip Versus native CUPS Printing</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2936743">Examples for Filtering Chains</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2937128">Sources of CUPS Drivers/PPDs</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2937265">Printing with Interface Scripts</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2937358">Network Printing (Purely Windows)</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2937377">From Windows Clients to an NT Print Server</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2937434">Driver Execution on the Client</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2937506">Driver Execution on the Server</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2937618">Network Printing (Windows Clients UNIX/Samba Print +Servers)</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2937639">From Windows Clients to a CUPS/Samba Print Server</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2937834">Samba Receiving Jobfiles and Passing Them to CUPS</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2937924">Network PostScript RIP</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2938025">PPDs for Non-PS Printers on UNIX</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2938085">PPDs for Non-PS Printers on Windows</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2938166">Windows Terminal Servers (WTS) as CUPS Clients</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2938184">Printer Drivers Running in Kernel Mode Cause Many +Problems</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2938229">Workarounds Impose Heavy Limitations</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2938250">CUPS: A Magical Stone?</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2938313">PostScript Drivers with No Major Problems Even in Kernel +Mode</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2938378">Configuring CUPS for Driver Download</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2938397">cupsaddsmb: The Unknown Utility</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2938514">Prepare Your smb.conf for cupsaddsmb</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2938755">CUPS PostScript Driver for Windows NT/200x/XP</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2939044">Recognizing Different Driver Files</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2939174">Acquiring the Adobe Driver Files</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2939204">ESP Print Pro PostScript Driver for Windows NT/200x/XP</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2939274">Caveats to be Considered</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2939571">Windows CUPS PostScript Driver Versus Adobe Driver</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2939801">Run cupsaddsmb (Quiet Mode)</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2939946">Run cupsaddsmb with Verbose Output</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2940175">Understanding cupsaddsmb</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2940352">How to Recognize If cupsaddsmb Completed Successfully</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2940450">cupsaddsmb with a Samba PDC</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2940538">cupsaddsmb Flowchart</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2940621">Installing the PostScript Driver on a Client</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2940801">Avoiding Critical PostScript Driver Settings on the Client</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2940875">Installing PostScript Driver Files Manually Using rpcclient</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2941083">A Check of the rpcclient man Page</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2941229">Understanding the rpcclient man Page</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2941358">Producing an Example by Querying a Windows Box</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2941534">Requirements for adddriver and setdriver to Succeed</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2941782">Manual Driver Installation in 15 Steps</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2942909">Troubleshooting Revisited</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2943077">The Printing *.tdb Files</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2943322">Trivial Database Files</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2943400">Binary Format</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2943470">Losing *.tdb Files</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2943528">Using tdbbackup</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2943673">CUPS Print Drivers from Linuxprinting.org</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2943860">foomatic-rip and Foomatic Explained</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2944657">foomatic-rip and Foomatic-PPD Download and Installation</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2945207">Page Accounting with CUPS</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2945248">Setting Up Quotas</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2945318">Correct and Incorrect Accounting</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2945366">Adobe and CUPS PostScript Drivers for Windows Clients</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2945495">The page_log File Syntax</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2945665">Possible Shortcomings</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2945745">Future Developments</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2945799">Additional Material</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2946030">Auto-Deletion or Preservation of CUPS Spool Files</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2946094">CUPS Configuration Settings Explained</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2946198">Pre-Conditions</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2946367">Manual Configuration</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2946425">Printing from CUPS to Windows Attached Printers</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2946721">More CUPS-Filtering Chains</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2946814">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2946820">Windows 9x/ME Client Can't Install Driver</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2946839">cupsaddsmb Keeps Asking for Root Password in Never-ending Loop</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2946889">cupsaddsmb Errors</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2946973">Client Can't Connect to Samba Printer</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2947002">New Account Reconnection from Windows 200x/XP Troubles</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2947106">Avoid Being Connected to the Samba Server as the Wrong User</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2947158">Upgrading to CUPS Drivers from Adobe Drivers</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2947200">Can't Use cupsaddsmb on Samba Server Which Is a PDC</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2947239">Deleted Windows 200x Printer Driver Is Still Shown</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2947278">Windows 200x/XP "Local Security Policies"</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2947293">Administrator Cannot Install Printers for All Local Users</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2947323">Print Change Notify Functions on NT-clients</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2947350">WinXP-SP1</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2947402">Print Options for All Users Can't Be Set on Windows 200x/XP</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2947717">Most Common Blunders in Driver Settings on Windows Clients</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2947779">cupsaddsmb Does Not Work with Newly Installed Printer</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2947835">Permissions on /var/spool/samba/ Get Reset After Each Reboot</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2947951">Print Queue Called lp Mis-handles Print Jobs</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2948008">Location of Adobe PostScript Driver Files for cupsaddsmb</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2948065">Overview of the CUPS Printing Processes</a></dt></dl></dd><dt>20. <a href="VFS.html">Stackable VFS modules</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="VFS.html#id2948269">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="VFS.html#id2948287">Discussion</a></dt><dt><a href="VFS.html#id2948540">Included Modules</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="VFS.html#id2948547">audit</a></dt><dt><a href="VFS.html#id2948583">extd_audit</a></dt><dt><a href="VFS.html#fakeperms">fake_perms</a></dt><dt><a href="VFS.html#id2948756">recycle</a></dt><dt><a href="VFS.html#id2948986">netatalk</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="VFS.html#id2949031">VFS Modules Available Elsewhere</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="VFS.html#id2949053">DatabaseFS</a></dt><dt><a href="VFS.html#id2949115">vscan</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>21. <a href="winbind.html">Winbind: Use of Domain Accounts</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="winbind.html#id2949352">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="winbind.html#id2949476">Introduction</a></dt><dt><a href="winbind.html#id2949558">What Winbind Provides</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="winbind.html#id2949633">Target Uses</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="winbind.html#id2949664">How Winbind Works</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="winbind.html#id2949693">Microsoft Remote Procedure Calls</a></dt><dt><a href="winbind.html#id2949726">Microsoft Active Directory Services</a></dt><dt><a href="winbind.html#id2949752">Name Service Switch</a></dt><dt><a href="winbind.html#id2949887">Pluggable Authentication Modules</a></dt><dt><a href="winbind.html#id2949965">User and Group ID Allocation</a></dt><dt><a href="winbind.html#id2949998">Result Caching</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="winbind.html#id2950035">Installation and Configuration</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="winbind.html#id2950042">Introduction</a></dt><dt><a href="winbind.html#id2950108">Requirements</a></dt><dt><a href="winbind.html#id2950191">Testing Things Out</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="winbind.html#id2951948">Conclusion</a></dt><dt><a href="winbind.html#id2951967">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="winbind.html#id2952021">NSCD Problem Warning</a></dt><dt><a href="winbind.html#id2952067">Winbind Is Not Resolving Users and Groups</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>22. <a href="AdvancedNetworkManagement.html">Advanced Network Management</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="AdvancedNetworkManagement.html#id2952277">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="AdvancedNetworkManagement.html#id2952308">Remote Server Administration</a></dt><dt><a href="AdvancedNetworkManagement.html#id2952449">Remote Desktop Management</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="AdvancedNetworkManagement.html#id2952467">Remote Management from NoMachine.Com</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="AdvancedNetworkManagement.html#id2952700">Network Logon Script Magic</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="AdvancedNetworkManagement.html#id2952929">Adding Printers without User Intervention</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>23. <a href="PolicyMgmt.html">System and Account Policies</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="PolicyMgmt.html#id2953044">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="PolicyMgmt.html#id2953137">Creating and Managing System Policies</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="PolicyMgmt.html#id2953271">Windows 9x/ME Policies</a></dt><dt><a href="PolicyMgmt.html#id2953383">Windows NT4-Style Policy Files</a></dt><dt><a href="PolicyMgmt.html#id2953525">MS Windows 200x/XP Professional Policies</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="PolicyMgmt.html#id2953826">Managing Account/User Policies</a></dt><dt><a href="PolicyMgmt.html#id2953985">Management Tools</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="PolicyMgmt.html#id2954000">Samba Editreg Toolset</a></dt><dt><a href="PolicyMgmt.html#id2954096">Windows NT4/200x</a></dt><dt><a href="PolicyMgmt.html#id2954120">Samba PDC</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="PolicyMgmt.html#id2954165">System Startup and Logon Processing Overview</a></dt><dt><a href="PolicyMgmt.html#id2954310">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="PolicyMgmt.html#id2954324">Policy Does Not Work</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>24. <a href="ProfileMgmt.html">Desktop Profile Management</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="ProfileMgmt.html#id2954425">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="ProfileMgmt.html#id2954459">Roaming Profiles</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="ProfileMgmt.html#id2954500">Samba Configuration for Profile Handling</a></dt><dt><a href="ProfileMgmt.html#id2955058">Windows Client Profile Configuration Information</a></dt><dt><a href="ProfileMgmt.html#id2956404">Sharing Profiles between W9x/Me and NT4/200x/XP Workstations</a></dt><dt><a href="ProfileMgmt.html#id2956492">Profile Migration from Windows NT4/200x Server to Samba</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="ProfileMgmt.html#id2956822">Mandatory Profiles</a></dt><dt><a href="ProfileMgmt.html#id2956917">Creating and Managing Group Profiles</a></dt><dt><a href="ProfileMgmt.html#id2956970">Default Profile for Windows Users</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="ProfileMgmt.html#id2956999">MS Windows 9x/Me</a></dt><dt><a href="ProfileMgmt.html#id2957150">MS Windows NT4 Workstation</a></dt><dt><a href="ProfileMgmt.html#id2957772">MS Windows 200x/XP</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="ProfileMgmt.html#id2958338">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="ProfileMgmt.html#id2958351">Configuring Roaming Profiles for a Few Users or Groups</a></dt><dt><a href="ProfileMgmt.html#id2958416">Cannot Use Roaming Profiles</a></dt><dt><a href="ProfileMgmt.html#id2958626">Changing the Default Profile</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>25. <a href="pam.html">PAM-Based Distributed Authentication</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="pam.html#id2958910">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="pam.html#id2959235">Technical Discussion</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="pam.html#id2959266">PAM Configuration Syntax</a></dt><dt><a href="pam.html#id2960262">Example System Configurations</a></dt><dt><a href="pam.html#id2960612">smb.conf PAM Configuration</a></dt><dt><a href="pam.html#id2960701">Remote CIFS Authentication Using winbindd.so</a></dt><dt><a href="pam.html#id2960824">Password Synchronization Using pam_smbpass.so</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="pam.html#id2961283">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="pam.html#id2961296">pam_winbind Problem</a></dt><dt><a href="pam.html#id2961406">Winbind Is Not Resolving Users and Groups</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>26. <a href="integrate-ms-networks.html">Integrating MS Windows Networks with Samba</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="integrate-ms-networks.html#id2961659">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="integrate-ms-networks.html#id2961683">Background Information</a></dt><dt><a href="integrate-ms-networks.html#id2961747">Name Resolution in a Pure UNIX/Linux World</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="integrate-ms-networks.html#id2961804">/etc/hosts</a></dt><dt><a href="integrate-ms-networks.html#id2961955">/etc/resolv.conf</a></dt><dt><a href="integrate-ms-networks.html#id2961999">/etc/host.conf</a></dt><dt><a href="integrate-ms-networks.html#id2962064">/etc/nsswitch.conf</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="integrate-ms-networks.html#id2962179">Name Resolution as Used within MS Windows Networking</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="integrate-ms-networks.html#id2962531">The NetBIOS Name Cache</a></dt><dt><a href="integrate-ms-networks.html#id2962597">The LMHOSTS File</a></dt><dt><a href="integrate-ms-networks.html#id2962844">HOSTS File</a></dt><dt><a href="integrate-ms-networks.html#id2962877">DNS Lookup</a></dt><dt><a href="integrate-ms-networks.html#id2962910">WINS Lookup</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="integrate-ms-networks.html#id2963026">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="integrate-ms-networks.html#id2963041">Pinging Works Only in One Way</a></dt><dt><a href="integrate-ms-networks.html#id2963083">Very Slow Network Connections</a></dt><dt><a href="integrate-ms-networks.html#id2963134">Samba Server Name Change Problem</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>27. <a href="unicode.html">Unicode/Charsets</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="unicode.html#id2963374">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="unicode.html#id2963419">What Are Charsets and Unicode?</a></dt><dt><a href="unicode.html#id2963499">Samba and Charsets</a></dt><dt><a href="unicode.html#id2963627">Conversion from Old Names</a></dt><dt><a href="unicode.html#id2963643">Japanese Charsets</a></dt><dt><a href="unicode.html#id2963781">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="unicode.html#id2963788">CP850.so Can't Be Found</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>28. <a href="Backup.html">Samba Backup Techniques</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="Backup.html#id2963903">Note</a></dt><dt><a href="Backup.html#id2963917">Features and Benefits</a></dt></dl></dd><dt>29. <a href="SambaHA.html">High Availability Options</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="SambaHA.html#id2963987">Note</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>IV. <a href="migration.html">Migration and Updating</a></dt><dd><dl><dt>30. <a href="upgrading-to-3.0.html">Upgrading from Samba-2.x to Samba-3.0.0</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="upgrading-to-3.0.html#id2964134">Quick Migration Guide</a></dt><dt><a href="upgrading-to-3.0.html#id2964257">New Features in Samba-3</a></dt><dt><a href="upgrading-to-3.0.html#id2964410">Configuration Parameter Changes</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="upgrading-to-3.0.html#id2964433">Removed Parameters</a></dt><dt><a href="upgrading-to-3.0.html#id2964564">New Parameters</a></dt><dt><a href="upgrading-to-3.0.html#id2964983">Modified Parameters (Changes in Behavior):</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="upgrading-to-3.0.html#id2965064">New Functionality</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="upgrading-to-3.0.html#id2965071">Databases</a></dt><dt><a href="upgrading-to-3.0.html#id2965324">Changes in Behavior</a></dt><dt><a href="upgrading-to-3.0.html#id2965395">Charsets</a></dt><dt><a href="upgrading-to-3.0.html#id2965417">Passdb Backends and Authentication</a></dt><dt><a href="upgrading-to-3.0.html#id2965577">LDAP</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>31. <a href="NT4Migration.html">Migration from NT4 PDC to Samba-3 PDC</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="NT4Migration.html#id2966015">Planning and Getting Started</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="NT4Migration.html#id2966040">Objectives</a></dt><dt><a href="NT4Migration.html#id2966502">Steps in Migration Process</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="NT4Migration.html#id2966757">Migration Options</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="NT4Migration.html#id2966862">Planning for Success</a></dt><dt><a href="NT4Migration.html#id2967145">Samba-3 Implementation Choices</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>32. <a href="SWAT.html">SWAT The Samba Web Administration Tool</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="SWAT.html#id2967624">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="SWAT.html#id2967718">Guidelines and Technical Tips</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="SWAT.html#id2967733">Validate SWAT Installation</a></dt><dt><a href="SWAT.html#xinetd">Enabling SWAT for Use</a></dt><dt><a href="SWAT.html#id2968330">Securing SWAT through SSL</a></dt><dt><a href="SWAT.html#id2968458">Enabling SWAT Internationalization Support</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="SWAT.html#id2968628">Overview and Quick Tour</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="SWAT.html#id2968644">The SWAT Home Page</a></dt><dt><a href="SWAT.html#id2968718">Global Settings</a></dt><dt><a href="SWAT.html#id2968838">Share Settings</a></dt><dt><a href="SWAT.html#id2968902">Printers Settings</a></dt><dt><a href="SWAT.html#id2968967">The SWAT Wizard</a></dt><dt><a href="SWAT.html#id2969040">The Status Page</a></dt><dt><a href="SWAT.html#id2969092">The View Page</a></dt><dt><a href="SWAT.html#id2969115">The Password Change Page</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>V. <a href="troubleshooting.html">Troubleshooting</a></dt><dd><dl><dt>33. <a href="diagnosis.html">The Samba Checklist</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="diagnosis.html#id2969273">Introduction</a></dt><dt><a href="diagnosis.html#id2969311">Assumptions</a></dt><dt><a href="diagnosis.html#id2969546">The Tests</a></dt></dl></dd><dt>34. <a href="problems.html">Analyzing and Solving Samba Problems</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="problems.html#id2971255">Diagnostics Tools</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="problems.html#id2971276">Debugging with Samba Itself</a></dt><dt><a href="problems.html#id2971441">Tcpdump</a></dt><dt><a href="problems.html#id2971477">Ethereal</a></dt><dt><a href="problems.html#id2971621">The Windows Network Monitor</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="problems.html#id2971938">Useful URLs</a></dt><dt><a href="problems.html#id2971978">Getting Mailing List Help</a></dt><dt><a href="problems.html#id2972155">How to Get Off the Mailing Lists</a></dt></dl></dd><dt>35. <a href="bugreport.html">Reporting Bugs</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="bugreport.html#id2972309">Introduction</a></dt><dt><a href="bugreport.html#id2972372">General Information</a></dt><dt><a href="bugreport.html#id2972408">Debug Levels</a></dt><dt><a href="bugreport.html#id2972617">Internal Errors</a></dt><dt><a href="bugreport.html#id2972752">Attaching to a Running Process</a></dt><dt><a href="bugreport.html#id2972799">Patches</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>VI. <a href="Appendixes.html">Appendixes</a></dt><dd><dl><dt>36. <a href="compiling.html">How to Compile Samba</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="compiling.html#id2972995">Access Samba Source Code via CVS</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="compiling.html#id2973003">Introduction</a></dt><dt><a href="compiling.html#id2973049">CVS Access to samba.org</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="compiling.html#id2973311">Accessing the Samba Sources via rsync and ftp</a></dt><dt><a href="compiling.html#id2973389">Verifying Samba's PGP Signature</a></dt><dt><a href="compiling.html#id2973553">Building the Binaries</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="compiling.html#id2973768">Compiling Samba with Active Directory Support</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="compiling.html#id2973958">Starting the smbd and nmbd</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="compiling.html#id2974066">Starting from inetd.conf</a></dt><dt><a href="compiling.html#id2974312">Alternative: Starting smbd as a Daemon</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>37. <a href="Portability.html">Portability</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="Portability.html#id2974513">HPUX</a></dt><dt><a href="Portability.html#id2974600">SCO UNIX</a></dt><dt><a href="Portability.html#id2974655">DNIX</a></dt><dt><a href="Portability.html#id2974825">Red Hat Linux</a></dt><dt><a href="Portability.html#id2974869">AIX</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="Portability.html#id2974876">Sequential Read Ahead</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="Portability.html#id2974902">Solaris</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="Portability.html#id2974909">Locking Improvements</a></dt><dt><a href="Portability.html#winbind-solaris9">Winbind on Solaris 9</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>38. <a href="Other-Clients.html">Samba and Other CIFS Clients</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="Other-Clients.html#id2975129">Macintosh Clients</a></dt><dt><a href="Other-Clients.html#id2975206">OS2 Client</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="Other-Clients.html#id2975213">Configuring OS/2 Warp Connect or OS/2 Warp 4</a></dt><dt><a href="Other-Clients.html#id2975348">Configuring Other Versions of OS/2</a></dt><dt><a href="Other-Clients.html#id2975411">Printer Driver Download for OS/2 Clients</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="Other-Clients.html#id2975516">Windows for Workgroups</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="Other-Clients.html#id2975524">Latest TCP/IP Stack from Microsoft</a></dt><dt><a href="Other-Clients.html#id2975610">Delete .pwl Files After Password Change</a></dt><dt><a href="Other-Clients.html#id2975641">Configuring Windows for Workgroups Password Handling</a></dt><dt><a href="Other-Clients.html#id2975701">Password Case Sensitivity</a></dt><dt><a href="Other-Clients.html#id2975739">Use TCP/IP as Default Protocol</a></dt><dt><a href="Other-Clients.html#id2975757">Speed Improvement</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="Other-Clients.html#id2975803">Windows 95/98</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="Other-Clients.html#id2975876">Speed Improvement</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="Other-Clients.html#id2975901">Windows 2000 Service Pack 2</a></dt><dt><a href="Other-Clients.html#id2976103">Windows NT 3.1</a></dt></dl></dd><dt>39. <a href="speed.html">Samba Performance Tuning</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="speed.html#id2976235">Comparisons</a></dt><dt><a href="speed.html#id2976281">Socket Options</a></dt><dt><a href="speed.html#id2976372">Read Size</a></dt><dt><a href="speed.html#id2976422">Max Xmit</a></dt><dt><a href="speed.html#id2976477">Log Level</a></dt><dt><a href="speed.html#id2976507">Read Raw</a></dt><dt><a href="speed.html#id2976592">Write Raw</a></dt><dt><a href="speed.html#id2976655">Slow Logins</a></dt><dt><a href="speed.html#id2976683">Client Tuning</a></dt><dt><a href="speed.html#id2976707">Samba Performance Problem Due to Changing Linux Kernel</a></dt><dt><a href="speed.html#id2976766">Corrupt tdb Files</a></dt></dl></dd><dt>40. <a href="DNSDHCP.html">DNS and DHCP Configuration Guide</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="DNSDHCP.html#id2976885">Note</a></dt></dl></dd><dt>41. <a href="Further-Resources.html">Further Resources</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="Further-Resources.html#id2976952">Websites</a></dt><dt><a href="Further-Resources.html#id2977349">Related updates from Microsoft</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt><a href="ix01.html">Index</a></dt></dl></div><div class="list-of-figures"><p><b>List of Figures</b></p><dl><dt>5.1. <a href="samba-pdc.html#domain-example">An Example Domain.</a></dt><dt>10.1. <a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#browsing1">Cross-Subnet Browsing Example.</a></dt><dt>11.1. <a href="passdb.html#idmap-sid2uid">IDMAP: Resolution of SIDs to UIDs.</a></dt><dt>11.2. <a href="passdb.html#idmap-uid2sid">IDMAP: Resolution of UIDs to SIDs.</a></dt><dt>12.1. <a href="groupmapping.html#idmap-sid2gid">IDMAP: group SID to GID resolution.</a></dt><dt>12.2. <a href="groupmapping.html#idmap-gid2sid">IDMAP: GID resolution to matching SID.</a></dt><dt>12.3. <a href="groupmapping.html#idmap-store-gid2sid">IDMAP storing group mappings.</a></dt><dt>13.1. <a href="AccessControls.html#access1">Overview of UNIX permissions field.</a></dt><dt>16.1. <a href="InterdomainTrusts.html#trusts1">Trusts overview.</a></dt><dt>19.1. <a href="CUPS-printing.html#1small">Windows printing to a local printer.</a></dt><dt>19.2. <a href="CUPS-printing.html#2small">Printing to a PostScript printer.</a></dt><dt>19.3. <a href="CUPS-printing.html#3small">Ghostscript as a RIP for non-postscript printers.</a></dt><dt>19.4. <a href="CUPS-printing.html#4small">Pre-filtering in CUPS to form PostScript.</a></dt><dt>19.5. <a href="CUPS-printing.html#5small">Adding device-specific print options.</a></dt><dt>19.6. <a href="CUPS-printing.html#6small">PostScript to intermediate raster format.</a></dt><dt>19.7. <a href="CUPS-printing.html#7small">CUPS-raster production using Ghostscript.</a></dt><dt>19.8. <a href="CUPS-printing.html#small8">Image format to CUPS-raster format conversion.</a></dt><dt>19.9. <a href="CUPS-printing.html#small9">Raster to printer-specific formats.</a></dt><dt>19.10. <a href="CUPS-printing.html#cupsomatic-dia">cupsomatic/foomatic Processing versus Native CUPS.</a></dt><dt>19.11. <a href="CUPS-printing.html#pdftosocket">PDF to socket chain.</a></dt><dt>19.12. <a href="CUPS-printing.html#pdftoepsonusb">PDF to USB chain.</a></dt><dt>19.13. <a href="CUPS-printing.html#small11">Print driver execution on the client.</a></dt><dt>19.14. <a href="CUPS-printing.html#small12">Print driver execution on the server.</a></dt><dt>19.15. <a href="CUPS-printing.html#13small">Printing via CUPS/Samba server.</a></dt><dt>19.16. <a href="CUPS-printing.html#small14">cupsaddsmb flowchart.</a></dt><dt>19.17. <a href="CUPS-printing.html#cups1">Filtering chain 1.</a></dt><dt>19.18. <a href="CUPS-printing.html#cups2">Filtering chain with cupsomatic</a></dt><dt>19.19. <a href="CUPS-printing.html#a_small">CUPS printing overview.</a></dt><dt>34.1. <a href="problems.html#ethereal1">Starting a capture.</a></dt><dt>34.2. <a href="problems.html#ethereal2">Main ethereal data window.</a></dt></dl></div><div class="list-of-tables"><p><b>List of Tables</b></p><dl><dt>6.1. <a href="samba-bdc.html#pdc-bdc-table">Domain Backend Account Distribution Options</a></dt><dt>7.1. <a href="domain-member.html#assumptions">Assumptions</a></dt><dt>10.1. <a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#browsubnet">Browse Subnet Example 1</a></dt><dt>10.2. <a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#brsbex">Browse Subnet Example 2</a></dt><dt>10.3. <a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#brsex2">Browse Subnet Example 3</a></dt><dt>10.4. <a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#brsex3">Browse Subnet Example 4</a></dt><dt>11.1. <a href="passdb.html#attribobjclPartA">Attributes in the sambaSamAccount objectclass (LDAP) Part A</a></dt><dt>11.2. <a href="passdb.html#attribobjclPartB">Attributes in the sambaSamAccount objectclass (LDAP) Part B</a></dt><dt>11.3. <a href="passdb.html#ldappwsync">Possible ldap passwd sync values</a></dt><dt>11.4. <a href="passdb.html#mysqlpbe">Basic smb.conf options for MySQL passdb backend</a></dt><dt>11.5. <a href="passdb.html#moremysqlpdbe">MySQL field names for MySQL passdb backend</a></dt><dt>12.1. <a href="groupmapping.html#WKURIDS">Well-Known User Default RIDs</a></dt><dt>13.1. <a href="AccessControls.html#id2911975">Managing Directories with UNIX and Windows</a></dt><dt>13.2. <a href="AccessControls.html#ugbc">User and Group Based Controls</a></dt><dt>13.3. <a href="AccessControls.html#fdpbc">File and Directory Permission Based Controls</a></dt><dt>13.4. <a href="AccessControls.html#mcoc">Other Controls</a></dt><dt>18.1. <a href="printing.html#printOptions">Default Printing Settings</a></dt><dt>19.1. <a href="CUPS-printing.html#cups-ppds">PPDs shipped with CUPS</a></dt><dt>20.1. <a href="VFS.html#xtdaudit">Extended Auditing Log Information</a></dt><dt>24.1. <a href="ProfileMgmt.html#ProfileLocs">User Shell Folder Registry Keys Default Values</a></dt><dt>24.2. <a href="ProfileMgmt.html#regkeys">Defaults of Profile Settings Registry Keys</a></dt><dt>24.3. <a href="ProfileMgmt.html#defregpthkeys">Defaults of Default User Profile Paths Registry Keys</a></dt><dt>25.1. <a href="pam.html#smbpassoptions">Options recognized by pam_smbpass</a></dt><dt>26.1. <a href="integrate-ms-networks.html#uniqnetbiosnames">Unique NetBIOS Names</a></dt><dt>26.2. <a href="integrate-ms-networks.html#netbiosnamesgrp">Group Names</a></dt><dt>30.1. <a href="upgrading-to-3.0.html#tdbfiledesc">TDB File Descriptions</a></dt><dt>31.1. <a href="NT4Migration.html#majtypes">The Three Major Site Types</a></dt><dt>31.2. <a href="NT4Migration.html#natconchoices">Nature of the Conversion Choices</a></dt></dl></div><div class="list-of-examples"><p><b>List of Examples</b></p><dl><dt>2.1. <a href="install.html#smbconfminimal">A minimal smb.conf</a></dt><dt>2.2. <a href="install.html#simple-example">Another simple smb.conf File</a></dt><dt>5.1. <a href="samba-pdc.html#pdc-example">smb.conf for being a PDC</a></dt><dt>5.2. <a href="samba-pdc.html#PDC-config">smb.conf for being a PDC</a></dt><dt>6.1. <a href="samba-bdc.html#minimalPDC">Minimal smb.conf for a PDC in Use With a BDC LDAP Server on PDC.</a></dt><dt>6.2. <a href="samba-bdc.html#mulitldapcfg">Multiple LDAP Servers in smb.conf</a></dt><dt>6.3. <a href="samba-bdc.html#minim-bdc">Minimal setup for being a BDC</a></dt><dt>8.1. <a href="StandAloneServer.html#simplynice">smb.conf for Reference Documentation Server</a></dt><dt>8.2. <a href="StandAloneServer.html#AnonPtrSvr">smb.conf for Anonymous Printing</a></dt><dt>10.1. <a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#dmbexample">Domain Master Browser smb.conf</a></dt><dt>10.2. <a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#lmbexample">Local master browser smb.conf</a></dt><dt>10.3. <a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#nombexample">smb.conf for not being a Master Browser</a></dt><dt>10.4. <a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#remsmb">Local Master Browser smb.conf</a></dt><dt>10.5. <a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#xremmb">smb.conf for not being a master browser</a></dt><dt>11.1. <a href="passdb.html#idmapbackendexample">Example configuration with the LDAP idmap backend</a></dt><dt>11.2. <a href="passdb.html#confldapex">Configuration with LDAP</a></dt><dt>11.3. <a href="passdb.html#mysqlsam">Example configuration for the MySQL passdb backend</a></dt><dt>12.1. <a href="groupmapping.html#smbgrpadd.sh">smbgrpadd.sh</a></dt><dt>12.2. <a href="groupmapping.html#smbgrpadd">Configuration of smb.conf for the add group script.</a></dt><dt>12.3. <a href="groupmapping.html#set-group-map">Script to Set Group Mapping</a></dt><dt>13.1. <a href="AccessControls.html#id2912202">Example File</a></dt><dt>14.1. <a href="locking.html#far1">Share with some files oplocked</a></dt><dt>14.2. <a href="locking.html#far3">Configuration with oplock break contention limit</a></dt><dt>17.1. <a href="msdfs.html#dfscfg">smb.conf with DFS configured</a></dt><dt>18.1. <a href="printing.html#simpleprc">Simple configuration with BSD printing</a></dt><dt>18.2. <a href="printing.html#extbsdpr">Extended BSD Printing Configuration</a></dt><dt>18.3. <a href="printing.html#prtdollar">[print\$] example</a></dt><dt>19.1. <a href="CUPS-printing.html#cups-exam-simple">Simplest printing-related smb.conf</a></dt><dt>19.2. <a href="CUPS-printing.html#overridesettings">Overriding global CUPS settings for one printer</a></dt><dt>19.3. <a href="CUPS-printing.html#cupsadd-ex">smb.conf for cupsaddsmb usage</a></dt><dt>20.1. <a href="VFS.html#vfsrecyc">smb.conf with VFS modules</a></dt><dt>20.2. <a href="VFS.html#multimodule">smb.conf with multiple VFS modules</a></dt><dt>21.1. <a href="winbind.html#winbindcfg">smb.conf for Winbind set-up</a></dt><dt>33.1. <a href="diagnosis.html#tmpshare">smb.conf with [tmp] share</a></dt><dt>33.2. <a href="diagnosis.html#modif1">Configuration for only allowing connections from a certain subnet</a></dt><dt>33.3. <a href="diagnosis.html#modif2">Configuration for allowing connections from a certain subnet and localhost</a></dt><dt>38.1. <a href="Other-Clients.html#minimalprofile">Minimal profile share</a></dt></dl></div></div><div class="navfooter"><hr><table width="100%" summary="Navigation footer"><tr><td width="40%" align="left"> </td><td width="20%" align="center"> </td><td width="40%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="pr01.html">Next</a></td></tr><tr><td width="40%" align="left" valign="top"> </td><td width="20%" align="center"> </td><td width="40%" align="right" valign="top"> Legal Notice</td></tr></table></div></body></html> diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/install.html b/docs/htmldocs/install.html new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..5b9d658984 --- /dev/null +++ b/docs/htmldocs/install.html @@ -0,0 +1,130 @@ +<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>Chapter 2. How to Install and Test SAMBA</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.60.1"><link rel="home" href="index.html" title="SAMBA Project Documentation"><link rel="up" href="introduction.html" title="Part I. General Installation"><link rel="previous" href="IntroSMB.html" title="Chapter 1. Introduction to Samba"><link rel="next" href="FastStart.html" title="Chapter 3. Fast Start for the Impatient"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="navheader"><table width="100%" summary="Navigation header"><tr><th colspan="3" align="center">Chapter 2. How to Install and Test SAMBA</th></tr><tr><td width="20%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="IntroSMB.html">Prev</a> </td><th width="60%" align="center">Part I. General Installation</th><td width="20%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="FastStart.html">Next</a></td></tr></table><hr></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="install"></a>Chapter 2. How to Install and Test SAMBA</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Andrew</span> <span class="surname">Tridgell</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:tridge@samba.org">tridge@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Jelmer</span> <span class="othername">R.</span> <span class="surname">Vernooij</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">The Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jelmer@samba.org">jelmer@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">John</span> <span class="othername">H.</span> <span class="surname">Terpstra</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org">jht@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Karl</span> <span class="surname">Auer</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:kauer@biplane.com.au">kauer@biplane.com.au</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Dan</span> <span class="surname">Shearer</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:dan@samba.org">dan@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="install.html#id2876533">Obtaining and Installing Samba</a></dt><dt><a href="install.html#id2876568">Configuring Samba (smb.conf)</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="install.html#id2876606">Configuration file syntax</a></dt><dt><a href="install.html#id2876766">Example Configuration</a></dt><dt><a href="install.html#id2885184">SWAT</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="install.html#id2885250">List Shares Available on the Server</a></dt><dt><a href="install.html#id2885315">Connect with a UNIX Client</a></dt><dt><a href="install.html#id2885433">Connect from a Remote SMB Client</a></dt><dt><a href="install.html#id2885526">What If Things Don't Work?</a></dt><dt><a href="install.html#id2885557">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="install.html#id2885570">Large Number of smbd Processes</a></dt><dt><a href="install.html#id2885679">Error Message: open_oplock_ipc</a></dt><dt><a href="install.html#id2885717">The network name cannot be found</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2876533"></a>Obtaining and Installing Samba</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> + Binary packages of Samba are included in almost any Linux or + UNIX distribution. There are also some packages available at + <ulink url="http://samba.org/">the Samba homepage</ulink>. Refer to + the manual of your operating system for details on installing packages + for your specific operating system. + </p><p>If you need to compile Samba from source, check + <link linkend="compiling">.</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2876568"></a>Configuring Samba (smb.conf)</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> + Samba's configuration is stored in the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file, which + usually resides in <tt class="filename">/etc/samba/smb.conf</tt> + or <tt class="filename">/usr/local/samba/lib/smb.conf</tt>. You can either + edit this file yourself or do it using one of the many graphical + tools that are available, such as the Web-based interface SWAT, that + is included with Samba. + </p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2876606"></a>Configuration file syntax</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>The <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file uses the same syntax as the various old + .ini files in Windows 3.1: Each file consists of various sections, + which are started by putting the section name between brackets ([]) + on a new line. Each contains zero or more key/value-pairs seperated by an + equality sign (=). The file is just a plain-text file, so you can + open and edit it with your favorite editing tool.</p><p>Each section in the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file represents a share + on the Samba server. The section “<span class="quote">global</span>” is special, since it + contains settings that apply to the whole Samba server and not + to one share in particular.</p><p><link linkend="smbconfminimal"> contains a very minimal <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt>. + <a class="indexterm" name="id2876667"></a> +</p><div class="example"><a name="smbconfminimal"></a><p class="title"><b>Example 2.1. A minimal smb.conf</b></p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td> </td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>[global]</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>workgroup = WKG</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>netbios name = MYNAME</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td> </td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>[share1]</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>path = /tmp</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td> </td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>[share2]</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>path = /my_shared_folder</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>comment = Some random files</tt></i></td></tr></table></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2876766"></a>Example Configuration</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + There are sample configuration files in the examples subdirectory in the + distribution. It is suggested you read them carefully so you can see how the options + go together in practice. See the man page for all the options. + It might be worthwhile to start out with the smb.conf.default + configuration file and adapt it to your needs. It contains plenty of + comments. + </p><p> + The simplest useful configuration file would contain something like shown in + <link linkend="simple-example">. + </p><p> + <a class="indexterm" name="id2876804"></a> + </p><div class="example"><a name="simple-example"></a><p class="title"><b>Example 2.2. Another simple smb.conf File</b></p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td> </td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>[global]</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>workgroup = MIDEARTH</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td> </td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>[homes]</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>guest ok = no</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>read only = no</tt></i></td></tr></table></div><p> + </p><p> + This will allow connections by anyone with an account on the server, using either + their login name or <i class="parameter"><tt>homes</tt></i> as the service name. + (Note: The workgroup that Samba should appear in must also be set. The default + workgroup name is WORKGROUP.) + </p><p> + Make sure you put the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file in the correct place. + </p><p> + For more information about security settings for the + <i class="parameter"><tt>[homes]</tt></i> share please refer to + <link linkend="securing-samba">. + </p><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2876922"></a>Test Your Config File with <b class="command">testparm</b></h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> + It's important to validate the contents of the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file using the <span class="application">testparm</span> program. + If testparm runs correctly, it will list the loaded services. If not, it will give an error message. + Make sure it runs correctly and that the services look reasonable before proceeding. Enter the command: + </p><pre class="screen"> + <tt class="prompt">root# </tt> testparm /etc/samba/smb.conf + </pre><p>Testparm will parse your configuration file and report + any unknown parameters or incorrect syntax. </p><p> + Always run testparm again whenever the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file is changed! + </p></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2885184"></a>SWAT</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + <a class="indexterm" name="id2885194"></a> + SWAT is a Web-based interface that can be used to facilitate the configuration of Samba. + SWAT might not be available in the Samba package that shipped with your platform, + but in a separate package. Please read the SWAT manpage + on compiling, installing and configuring SWAT from source. + </p><p> + To launch SWAT, just run your favorite Web browser and point it to + <ulink url="http://localhost:901/">http://localhost:901/</ulink>. + Replace <i class="replaceable"><tt>localhost</tt></i> with the name of the computer on which + Samba is running if that is a different computer than your browser. + </p><p> + SWAT can be used from a browser on any IP-connected machine, but be aware that connecting from a remote + machine leaves your connection open to password sniffing as passwords will be sent over the wire in the clear. + </p><p>More information about SWAT can be found in <link linkend="SWAT">.</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2885250"></a>List Shares Available on the Server</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> + To list shares that are available from the configured Samba server execute the + following command: + </p><pre class="screen"> +<tt class="prompt">$ </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>smbclient -L <i class="replaceable"><tt>yourhostname</tt></i></tt></b> +</pre><p>You should see a list of shares available on your server. If you do not, then + something is incorrectly configured. This method can also be used to see what shares + are available on other SMB servers, such as Windows 2000.</p><p>If you choose user-level security you may find that Samba requests a password + before it will list the shares. See the <b class="command">smbclient</b> man page for details. + You can force it to list the shares without a password by adding the option + <tt class="option">-N</tt> to the command line. </p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2885315"></a>Connect with a UNIX Client</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> + Enter the following command: +</p><pre class="screen"> +<tt class="prompt">$ </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>smbclient <i class="replaceable"><tt> //yourhostname/aservice</tt></i></tt></b> +</pre><p>Typically <i class="replaceable"><tt>yourhostname</tt></i> is the name of the host on which <span class="application">smbd</span> + has been installed. The <i class="replaceable"><tt>aservice</tt></i> is any service that has been defined in the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> + file. Try your user name if you just have a <i class="parameter"><tt>[homes]</tt></i> section in the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file.</p><p>Example: If the UNIX host is called <i class="replaceable"><tt>bambi</tt></i> and a valid login name + is <i class="replaceable"><tt>fred</tt></i>, you would type:</p><pre class="screen"> +<tt class="prompt">$ </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>smbclient //<i class="replaceable"><tt>bambi</tt></i>/<i class="replaceable"><tt>fred</tt></i></tt></b> +</pre></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2885433"></a>Connect from a Remote SMB Client</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p>Now that Samba is working correctly locally, you can try to + access it from other clients. Within a few minutes, the Samba host + should be listed in the Network Neighborhood on all Windows + clients of its subnet. Try browsing the server from another client + or 'mounting' it.</p><p>Mounting disks from a DOS, Windows or OS/2 client can be done by running a command such as:</p><pre class="screen"> +<tt class="prompt">C:\> </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>net use d: \\servername\service</tt></b> +</pre><p>Try printing, e.g.</p><p> +</p><pre class="screen"> +<tt class="prompt">C:\> </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>net use lpt1: \\servername\spoolservice</tt></b> +</pre><p> +</p><pre class="screen"><tt class="prompt">C:\> </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>print filename</tt></b> +</pre></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2885526"></a>What If Things Don't Work?</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p>You might want to read <link linkend="diagnosis">. + If you are still stuck, refer to <link linkend="problems">. + Samba has been successfully installed at thousands of sites worldwide. + It is unlikely that your particular problem is unique, so it might be + productive to perform an Internet search to see if someone else has encountered + your problem and has found a way to overcome it.</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2885557"></a>Common Errors</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +The following questions and issues are raised repeatedly on the Samba mailing list. +</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2885570"></a>Large Number of smbd Processes</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +Samba consists of three core programs: <span class="application">nmbd</span>, <span class="application">smbd</span>, and <span class="application">winbindd</span>. <span class="application">nmbd</span> is the name server message daemon, +<span class="application">smbd</span> is the server message daemon, and <span class="application">winbindd</span> is the daemon that handles communication with Domain Controllers. +</p><p> +If Samba is <span class="emphasis"><em>not</em></span> running as a WINS server, then there will be one single instance of + <span class="application">nmbd</span> running on your system. If it is running as a WINS server then there will be +two instances one to handle the WINS requests. +</p><p> +<span class="application">smbd</span> handles all connection requests. It spawns a new process for each client +connection made. That is why you may see so many of them, one per client connection. +</p><p> +<span class="application">winbindd</span> will run as one or two daemons, depending on whether or not it is being +run in <span class="emphasis"><em>split mode</em></span> (in which case there will be two instances). +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2885679"></a>Error Message: open_oplock_ipc</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>An error message is observed in the log files when <span class="application">smbd</span> is started: “<span class="quote">open_oplock_ipc: Failed to get local UDP socket + for address 100007f. Error was Cannot assign requested.</span>”</p><p>Your loopback device isn't working correctly. Make sure it is configured correctly. The loopback + device is an internal (virtual) network device with the IP address <span class="emphasis"><em>127.0.0.1</em></span>. + Read your OS documentation for details on how to configure the loopback on your system.</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2885717"></a>“<span class="quote"><span class="errorname">The network name cannot be found</span></span>”</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + This error can be caused by one of these misconfigurations: + </p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>You specified an nonexisting path + for the share in <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt>.</p></li><li><p>The user you are trying to access the share with does not + have sufficient permissions to access the path for + the share. Both read (r) and access (x) should be possible.</p></li><li><p>The share you are trying to access does not exist.</p></li></ul></div></div></div></div><div class="navfooter"><hr><table width="100%" summary="Navigation footer"><tr><td width="40%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="IntroSMB.html">Prev</a> </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="u" href="introduction.html">Up</a></td><td width="40%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="FastStart.html">Next</a></td></tr><tr><td width="40%" align="left" valign="top">Chapter 1. Introduction to Samba </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="h" href="index.html">Home</a></td><td width="40%" align="right" valign="top"> Chapter 3. Fast Start for the Impatient</td></tr></table></div></body></html> diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/integrate-ms-networks.html b/docs/htmldocs/integrate-ms-networks.html new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..2e75885499 --- /dev/null +++ b/docs/htmldocs/integrate-ms-networks.html @@ -0,0 +1,427 @@ +<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>Chapter 26. Integrating MS Windows Networks with Samba</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.60.1"><link rel="home" href="index.html" title="SAMBA Project Documentation"><link rel="up" href="optional.html" title="Part III. Advanced Configuration"><link rel="previous" href="pam.html" title="Chapter 25. PAM-Based Distributed Authentication"><link rel="next" href="unicode.html" title="Chapter 27. Unicode/Charsets"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="navheader"><table width="100%" summary="Navigation header"><tr><th colspan="3" align="center">Chapter 26. Integrating MS Windows Networks with Samba</th></tr><tr><td width="20%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="pam.html">Prev</a> </td><th width="60%" align="center">Part III. Advanced Configuration</th><td width="20%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="unicode.html">Next</a></td></tr></table><hr></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="integrate-ms-networks"></a>Chapter 26. Integrating MS Windows Networks with Samba</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">John</span> <span class="othername">H.</span> <span class="surname">Terpstra</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org">jht@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><p class="pubdate"> (Jan 01 2001) </p></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="integrate-ms-networks.html#id2961659">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="integrate-ms-networks.html#id2961683">Background Information</a></dt><dt><a href="integrate-ms-networks.html#id2961747">Name Resolution in a Pure UNIX/Linux World</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="integrate-ms-networks.html#id2961804">/etc/hosts</a></dt><dt><a href="integrate-ms-networks.html#id2961955">/etc/resolv.conf</a></dt><dt><a href="integrate-ms-networks.html#id2961999">/etc/host.conf</a></dt><dt><a href="integrate-ms-networks.html#id2962064">/etc/nsswitch.conf</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="integrate-ms-networks.html#id2962179">Name Resolution as Used within MS Windows Networking</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="integrate-ms-networks.html#id2962531">The NetBIOS Name Cache</a></dt><dt><a href="integrate-ms-networks.html#id2962597">The LMHOSTS File</a></dt><dt><a href="integrate-ms-networks.html#id2962844">HOSTS File</a></dt><dt><a href="integrate-ms-networks.html#id2962877">DNS Lookup</a></dt><dt><a href="integrate-ms-networks.html#id2962910">WINS Lookup</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="integrate-ms-networks.html#id2963026">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="integrate-ms-networks.html#id2963041">Pinging Works Only in One Way</a></dt><dt><a href="integrate-ms-networks.html#id2963083">Very Slow Network Connections</a></dt><dt><a href="integrate-ms-networks.html#id2963134">Samba Server Name Change Problem</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></div><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2961626"></a> +This section deals with NetBIOS over TCP/IP name to IP address resolution. If +your MS Windows clients are not configured to use NetBIOS over TCP/IP, then this +section does not apply to your installation. If your installation +involves the use of +NetBIOS over TCP/IP then this section may help you to resolve networking problems. +</p><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p> +NetBIOS over TCP/IP has nothing to do with NetBEUI. NetBEUI is NetBIOS +over Logical Link Control (LLC). On modern networks it is highly advised +to not run NetBEUI at all. Note also there is no such thing as +NetBEUI over TCP/IP the existence of such a protocol is a complete +and utter misapprehension. +</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2961659"></a>Features and Benefits</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +Many MS Windows network administrators have never been exposed to basic TCP/IP +networking as it is implemented in a UNIX/Linux operating system. Likewise, many UNIX and +Linux administrators have not been exposed to the intricacies of MS Windows TCP/IP-based +networking (and may have no desire to be either). +</p><p> +This chapter gives a short introduction to the basics of how a name can be resolved to +its IP address for each operating system environment. +</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2961683"></a>Background Information</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +Since the introduction of MS Windows 2000, it is possible to run MS Windows networking +without the use of NetBIOS over TCP/IP. NetBIOS over TCP/IP uses UDP port 137 for NetBIOS +name resolution and uses TCP port 139 for NetBIOS session services. When NetBIOS over +TCP/IP is disabled on MS Windows 2000 and later clients, then only the TCP port 445 will be +used and the UDP port 137 and TCP port 139 will not. +</p><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p> +When using Windows 2000 or later clients, if NetBIOS over TCP/IP is not disabled, then +the client will use UDP port 137 (NetBIOS Name Service, also known as the Windows Internet +Name Service or WINS), TCP port 139 and TCP port 445 (for actual file and print traffic). +</p></div><p> +When NetBIOS over TCP/IP is disabled, the use of DNS is essential. Most installations that +disable NetBIOS over TCP/IP today use MS Active Directory Service (ADS). ADS requires +<a class="indexterm" name="id2961722"></a> +Dynamic DNS with Service Resource Records (SRV RR) and with Incremental Zone Transfers (IXFR). +<a class="indexterm" name="id2961735"></a> +Use of DHCP with ADS is recommended as a further means of maintaining central control +over the client workstation network configuration. +</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2961747"></a>Name Resolution in a Pure UNIX/Linux World</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +The key configuration files covered in this section are: +</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p><tt class="filename">/etc/hosts</tt></p></li><li><p><tt class="filename">/etc/resolv.conf</tt></p></li><li><p><tt class="filename">/etc/host.conf</tt></p></li><li><p><tt class="filename">/etc/nsswitch.conf</tt></p></li></ul></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2961804"></a><tt class="filename">/etc/hosts</tt></h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +This file contains a static list of IP addresses and names. +</p><pre class="programlisting"> +127.0.0.1 localhost localhost.localdomain +192.168.1.1 bigbox.quenya.org bigbox alias4box +</pre><p> +The purpose of <tt class="filename">/etc/hosts</tt> is to provide a +name resolution mechanism so uses do not need to remember +IP addresses. +</p><p> +Network packets that are sent over the physical network transport +layer communicate not via IP addresses but rather using the Media +Access Control address, or MAC address. IP addresses are currently +32 bits in length and are typically presented as four (4) decimal +numbers that are separated by a dot (or period). For example, 168.192.1.1. +</p><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2961857"></a> +MAC Addresses use 48 bits (or 6 bytes) and are typically represented +as two-digit hexadecimal numbers separated by colons: 40:8e:0a:12:34:56. +</p><p> +Every network interface must have a MAC address. Associated with +a MAC address may be one or more IP addresses. There is no +relationship between an IP address and a MAC address; all such assignments +are arbitrary or discretionary in nature. At the most basic level, all +network communications take place using MAC addressing. Since MAC +addresses must be globally unique and generally remain fixed for +any particular interface, the assignment of an IP address makes sense +from a network management perspective. More than one IP address can +be assigned per MAC address. One address must be the primary IP +address +this is the address that will be returned in the ARP reply. +</p><p> +When a user or a process wants to communicate with another machine, +the protocol implementation ensures that the “<span class="quote">machine name</span>” or “<span class="quote">host +name</span>” is resolved to an IP address in a manner that is controlled +by the TCP/IP configuration control files. The file +<tt class="filename">/etc/hosts</tt> is one such file. +</p><p> +When the IP address of the destination interface has been +determined, a protocol called ARP/RARP is used to identify +the MAC address of the target interface. ARP stands for Address +Resolution Protocol and is a broadcast-oriented method that +uses User Datagram Protocol (UDP) to send a request to all +interfaces on the local network segment using the all 1s MAC +address. Network interfaces are programmed to respond to two +MAC addresses only; their own unique address and the address +ff:ff:ff:ff:ff:ff. The reply packet from an ARP request will +contain the MAC address and the primary IP address for each +interface. +</p><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2961931"></a> +The <tt class="filename">/etc/hosts</tt> file is foundational to all +UNIX/Linux TCP/IP installations and as a minimum will contain +the localhost and local network interface IP addresses and the +primary names by which they are known within the local machine. +This file helps to prime the pump so a basic level of name +resolution can exist before any other method of name resolution +becomes available. +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2961955"></a><tt class="filename">/etc/resolv.conf</tt></h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +This file tells the name resolution libraries: +</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>The name of the domain to which the machine + belongs. + </p></li><li><p>The name(s) of any domains that should be + automatically searched when trying to resolve unqualified + host names to their IP address. + </p></li><li><p>The name or IP address of available Domain + Name Servers that may be asked to perform name-to-address + translation lookups. + </p></li></ul></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2961999"></a><tt class="filename">/etc/host.conf</tt></h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2962014"></a> +<tt class="filename">/etc/host.conf</tt> is the primary means by +which the setting in <tt class="filename">/etc/resolv.conf</tt> may be effected. It is a +critical configuration file. This file controls the order by +which name resolution may proceed. The typical structure is: +</p><pre class="programlisting"> +order hosts,bind +multi on +</pre><p> +then both addresses should be returned. Please refer to the +man page for <tt class="filename">host.conf</tt> for further details. +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2962064"></a><tt class="filename">/etc/nsswitch.conf</tt></h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2962078"></a> +This file controls the actual name resolution targets. The +file typically has resolver object specifications as follows: +</p><pre class="programlisting"> +# /etc/nsswitch.conf +# +# Name Service Switch configuration file. +# + +passwd: compat +# Alternative entries for password authentication are: +# passwd: compat files nis ldap winbind +shadow: compat +group: compat + +hosts: files nis dns +# Alternative entries for host name resolution are: +# hosts: files dns nis nis+ hesiod db compat ldap wins +networks: nis files dns + +ethers: nis files +protocols: nis files +rpc: nis files +services: nis files +</pre><p> +Of course, each of these mechanisms requires that the appropriate +facilities and/or services are correctly configured. +</p><p> +It should be noted that unless a network request/message must be +sent, TCP/IP networks are silent. All TCP/IP communications assume a +principal of speaking only when necessary. +</p><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2962123"></a> +Starting with version 2.2.0, Samba has Linux support for extensions to +the name service switch infrastructure so Linux clients will +be able to obtain resolution of MS Windows NetBIOS names to IP +Addresses. To gain this functionality, Samba needs to be compiled +with appropriate arguments to the make command (i.e., <b class="userinput"><tt>make +nsswitch/libnss_wins.so</tt></b>). The resulting library should +then be installed in the <tt class="filename">/lib</tt> directory and +the <i class="parameter"><tt>wins</tt></i> parameter needs to be added to the “<span class="quote">hosts:</span>” line in +the <tt class="filename">/etc/nsswitch.conf</tt> file. At this point, it +will be possible to ping any MS Windows machine by its NetBIOS +machine name, as long as that machine is within the workgroup to +which both the Samba machine and the MS Windows machine belong. +</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2962179"></a>Name Resolution as Used within MS Windows Networking</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +MS Windows networking is predicated about the name each machine +is given. This name is known variously (and inconsistently) as +the “<span class="quote">computer name,</span>” “<span class="quote">machine name,</span>” “<span class="quote">networking name,</span>” “<span class="quote">netbios name,</span>” +or “<span class="quote">SMB name.</span>” All terms mean the same thing with the exception of +“<span class="quote">netbios name</span>” that can also apply to the name of the workgroup or the +domain name. The terms “<span class="quote">workgroup</span>” and “<span class="quote">domain</span>” are really just a +simple name with which the machine is associated. All NetBIOS names +are exactly 16 characters in length. The 16<sup>th</sup> character is reserved. +It is used to store a one-byte value that indicates service level +information for the NetBIOS name that is registered. A NetBIOS machine +name is, therefore, registered for each service type that is provided by +the client/server. +</p><p> +<link linkend="uniqnetbiosnames"> and <link linkend="netbiosnamesgrp"> list typical NetBIOS name/service type registrations. +</p><div class="table"><a name="uniqnetbiosnames"></a><p class="title"><b>Table 26.1. Unique NetBIOS Names</b></p><table summary="Unique NetBIOS Names" border="1"><colgroup><col align="left"><col align="justify"></colgroup><tbody><tr><td align="left">MACHINENAME<00></td><td align="justify">Server Service is running on MACHINENAME</td></tr><tr><td align="left">MACHINENAME<03></td><td align="justify">Generic Machine Name (NetBIOS name)</td></tr><tr><td align="left">MACHINENAME<20></td><td align="justify">LanMan Server service is running on MACHINENAME</td></tr><tr><td align="left">WORKGROUP<1b></td><td align="justify">Domain Master Browser</td></tr></tbody></table></div><div class="table"><a name="netbiosnamesgrp"></a><p class="title"><b>Table 26.2. Group Names</b></p><table summary="Group Names" border="1"><colgroup><col align="left"><col align="justify"></colgroup><tbody><tr><td align="left">WORKGROUP<03></td><td align="justify">Generic Name registered by all members of WORKGROUP</td></tr><tr><td align="left">WORKGROUP<1c></td><td align="justify">Domain Controllers / Netlogon Servers</td></tr><tr><td align="left">WORKGROUP<1d></td><td align="justify">Local Master Browsers</td></tr><tr><td align="left">WORKGROUP<1e></td><td align="justify">Internet Name Resolvers</td></tr></tbody></table></div><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2962414"></a> +It should be noted that all NetBIOS machines register their own +names as per the above. This is in vast contrast to TCP/IP +installations where traditionally the system administrator will +determine in the <tt class="filename">/etc/hosts</tt> or in the DNS database what names +are associated with each IP address. +</p><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2962438"></a> +One further point of clarification should be noted. The <tt class="filename">/etc/hosts</tt> +file and the DNS records do not provide the NetBIOS name type information +that MS Windows clients depend on to locate the type of service that may +be needed. An example of this is what happens when an MS Windows client +wants to locate a domain logon server. It finds this service and the IP +address of a server that provides it by performing a lookup (via a +NetBIOS broadcast) for enumeration of all machines that have +registered the name type *<1c>. A logon request is then sent to each +IP address that is returned in the enumerated list of IP addresses. +Whichever machine first replies, it then ends up providing the logon services. +</p><p> +The name “<span class="quote">workgroup</span>” or “<span class="quote">domain</span>” really can be confusing since these +have the added significance of indicating what is the security +architecture of the MS Windows network. The term “<span class="quote">workgroup</span>” indicates +that the primary nature of the network environment is that of a +peer-to-peer design. In a WORKGROUP, all machines are responsible for +their own security, and generally such security is limited to the use of +just a password (known as Share Level security). In most situations +with peer-to-peer networking, the users who control their own machines +will simply opt to have no security at all. It is possible to have +User Level Security in a WORKGROUP environment, thus requiring the use +of a user name and a matching password. +</p><p> +MS Windows networking is thus predetermined to use machine names +for all local and remote machine message passing. The protocol used is +called Server Message Block (SMB) and this is implemented using +the NetBIOS protocol (Network Basic Input Output System). NetBIOS can +be encapsulated using LLC (Logical Link Control) protocol in which case +the resulting protocol is called NetBEUI (Network Basic Extended User +Interface). NetBIOS can also be run over IPX (Internetworking Packet +Exchange) protocol as used by Novell NetWare, and it can be run +over TCP/IP protocols in which case the resulting protocol is called +NBT or NetBT, the NetBIOS over TCP/IP. +</p><p> +MS Windows machines use a complex array of name resolution mechanisms. +Since we are primarily concerned with TCP/IP, this demonstration is +limited to this area. +</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2962531"></a>The NetBIOS Name Cache</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +All MS Windows machines employ an in-memory buffer in which is +stored the NetBIOS names and IP addresses for all external +machines that machine has communicated with over the +past 10-15 minutes. It is more efficient to obtain an IP address +for a machine from the local cache than it is to go through all the +configured name resolution mechanisms. +</p><p> +If a machine whose name is in the local name cache has been shut +down before the name had been expired and flushed from the cache, then +an attempt to exchange a message with that machine will be subject +to time-out delays. Its name is in the cache, so a name resolution +lookup will succeed, but the machine cannot respond. This can be +frustrating for users but is a characteristic of the protocol. +</p><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2962566"></a> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2962574"></a> +The MS Windows utility that allows examination of the NetBIOS +name cache is called “<span class="quote">nbtstat</span>”. The Samba equivalent of this +is called <b class="command">nmblookup</b>. +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2962597"></a>The LMHOSTS File</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2962608"></a> +This file is usually located in MS Windows NT 4.0 or Windows 200x/XP in the directory +<tt class="filename">C:\WINNT\SYSTEM32\DRIVERS\ETC</tt> and contains the IP Address +and the machine name in matched pairs. The <tt class="filename">LMHOSTS</tt> file +performs NetBIOS name to IP address mapping. +</p><p> +It typically looks like this: +</p><pre class="programlisting"> +# Copyright (c) 1998 Microsoft Corp. +# +# This is a sample LMHOSTS file used by the Microsoft Wins Client (NetBIOS +# over TCP/IP) stack for Windows98 +# +# This file contains the mappings of IP addresses to NT computernames +# (NetBIOS) names. Each entry should be kept on an individual line. +# The IP address should be placed in the first column followed by the +# corresponding computername. The address and the computername +# should be separated by at least one space or tab. The "#" character +# is generally used to denote the start of a comment (see the exceptions +# below). +# +# This file is compatible with Microsoft LAN Manager 2.x TCP/IP lmhosts +# files and offers the following extensions: +# +# #PRE +# #DOM:<domain> +# #INCLUDE <filename> +# #BEGIN_ALTERNATE +# #END_ALTERNATE +# \0xnn (non-printing character support) +# +# Following any entry in the file with the characters "#PRE" will cause +# the entry to be preloaded into the name cache. By default, entries are +# not preloaded, but are parsed only after dynamic name resolution fails. +# +# Following an entry with the "#DOM:<domain>" tag will associate the +# entry with the domain specified by <domain>. This effects how the +# browser and logon services behave in TCP/IP environments. To preload +# the host name associated with #DOM entry, it is necessary to also add a +# #PRE to the line. The <domain> is always preloaded although it will not +# be shown when the name cache is viewed. +# +# Specifying "#INCLUDE <filename>" will force the RFC NetBIOS (NBT) +# software to seek the specified <filename> and parse it as if it were +# local. <filename> is generally a UNC-based name, allowing a +# centralized lmhosts file to be maintained on a server. +# It is ALWAYS necessary to provide a mapping for the IP address of the +# server prior to the #INCLUDE. This mapping must use the #PRE directive. +# In addition the share "public" in the example below must be in the +# LanManServer list of "NullSessionShares" in order for client machines to +# be able to read the lmhosts file successfully. This key is under +# \machine\system\currentcontrolset\services\lanmanserver\ +# parameters\nullsessionshares +# in the registry. Simply add "public" to the list found there. +# +# The #BEGIN_ and #END_ALTERNATE keywords allow multiple #INCLUDE +# statements to be grouped together. Any single successful include +# will cause the group to succeed. +# +# Finally, non-printing characters can be embedded in mappings by +# first surrounding the NetBIOS name in quotations, then using the +# \0xnn notation to specify a hex value for a non-printing character. +# +# The following example illustrates all of these extensions: +# +# 102.54.94.97 rhino #PRE #DOM:networking #net group's DC +# 102.54.94.102 "appname \0x14" #special app server +# 102.54.94.123 popular #PRE #source server +# 102.54.94.117 localsrv #PRE #needed for the include +# +# #BEGIN_ALTERNATE +# #INCLUDE \\localsrv\public\lmhosts +# #INCLUDE \\rhino\public\lmhosts +# #END_ALTERNATE +# +# In the above example, the "appname" server contains a special +# character in its name, the "popular" and "localsrv" server names are +# preloaded, and the "rhino" server name is specified so it can be used +# to later #INCLUDE a centrally maintained lmhosts file if the "localsrv" +# system is unavailable. +# +# Note that the whole file is parsed including comments on each lookup, +# so keeping the number of comments to a minimum will improve performance. +# Therefore it is not advisable to simply add lmhosts file entries onto the +# end of this file. +</pre></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2962844"></a>HOSTS File</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +This file is usually located in MS Windows NT 4.0 or Windows 200x/XP in +the directory <tt class="filename">C:\WINNT\SYSTEM32\DRIVERS\ETC</tt> and contains +the IP Address and the IP hostname in matched pairs. It can be +used by the name resolution infrastructure in MS Windows, depending +on how the TCP/IP environment is configured. This file is in +every way the equivalent of the UNIX/Linux <tt class="filename">/etc/hosts</tt> file. +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2962877"></a>DNS Lookup</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2962888"></a> +This capability is configured in the TCP/IP setup area in the network +configuration facility. If enabled, an elaborate name resolution sequence +is followed, the precise nature of which is dependant on how the NetBIOS +Node Type parameter is configured. A Node Type of 0 means that +NetBIOS broadcast (over UDP broadcast) is used if the name +that is the subject of a name lookup is not found in the NetBIOS name +cache. If that fails then DNS, HOSTS and LMHOSTS are checked. If set to +Node Type 8, then a NetBIOS Unicast (over UDP Unicast) is sent to the +WINS Server to obtain a lookup before DNS, HOSTS, LMHOSTS, or broadcast +lookup is used. +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2962910"></a>WINS Lookup</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2962921"></a> +A WINS (Windows Internet Name Server) service is the equivalent of the +rfc1001/1002 specified NBNS (NetBIOS Name Server). A WINS server stores +the names and IP addresses that are registered by a Windows client +if the TCP/IP setup has been given at least one WINS Server IP Address. +</p><p> +To configure Samba to be a WINS server, the following parameter needs +to be added to the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file: +</p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>wins support = Yes</tt></i></td></tr></table><p> +To configure Samba to use a WINS server, the following parameters are +needed in the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file: +</p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>wins support = No</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>wins server = xxx.xxx.xxx.xxx</tt></i></td></tr></table><p> +where <i class="replaceable"><tt>xxx.xxx.xxx.xxx</tt></i> is the IP address +of the WINS server. +</p><p>For information about setting up Samba as a WINS server, read +<link linkend="NetworkBrowsing">.</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2963026"></a>Common Errors</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +TCP/IP network configuration problems find every network administrator sooner or later. +The cause can be anything from keyboard mishaps, forgetfulness, simple mistakes, and +carelessness. Of course, no one is ever deliberately careless! +</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2963041"></a>Pinging Works Only in One Way</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + “<span class="quote">I can ping my Samba server from Windows, but I cannot ping my Windows + machine from the Samba server.</span>” + </p><p> + <span class="emphasis"><em>Answer:</em></span> The Windows machine was at IP Address 192.168.1.2 with netmask 255.255.255.0, the + Samba server (Linux) was at IP Address 192.168.1.130 with netmask 255.255.255.128. + The machines were on a local network with no external connections. + </p><p> + Due to inconsistent netmasks, the Windows machine was on network 192.168.1.0/24, while + the Samba server was on network 192.168.1.128/25 logically a different network. + </p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2963083"></a>Very Slow Network Connections</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + A common cause of slow network response includes: + </p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Client is configured to use DNS and the DNS server is down.</p></li><li><p>Client is configured to use remote DNS server, but the + remote connection is down.</p></li><li><p>Client is configured to use a WINS server, but there is no WINS server.</p></li><li><p>Client is not configured to use a WINS server, but there is a WINS server.</p></li><li><p>Firewall is filtering our DNS or WINS traffic.</p></li></ul></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2963134"></a>Samba Server Name Change Problem</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + “<span class="quote">The name of the Samba server was changed, Samba was restarted, Samba server cannot be + pinged by new name from MS Windows NT4 Workstation, but it does still respond to ping using + the old name. Why?</span>” + </p><p> + From this description, three things are obvious: + </p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>WINS is not in use, only broadcast-based name resolution is used.</p></li><li><p>The Samba server was renamed and restarted within the last 10-15 minutes.</p></li><li><p>The old Samba server name is still in the NetBIOS name cache on the MS Windows NT4 Workstation.</p></li></ul></div><p> + To find what names are present in the NetBIOS name cache on the MS Windows NT4 machine, + open a <b class="command">cmd</b> shell and then: + </p><p> +</p><pre class="screen"> +<tt class="prompt">C:\> </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>nbtstat -n</tt></b> + + NetBIOS Local Name Table + + Name Type Status +------------------------------------------------ +FRODO <03> UNIQUE Registered +ADMINSTRATOR <03> UNIQUE Registered +FRODO <00> UNIQUE Registered +SARDON <00> GROUP Registered +FRODO <20> UNIQUE Registered +FRODO <1F> UNIQUE Registered + + +<tt class="prompt">C:\> </tt>nbtstat -c + + NetBIOS Remote Cache Name Table + + Name Type Host Address Life [sec] +-------------------------------------------------------------- +GANDALF <20> UNIQUE 192.168.1.1 240 + +<tt class="prompt">C:\> </tt> +</pre><p> + </p><p> + In the above example, GANDALF is the Samba server and FRODO is the MS Windows NT4 Workstation. + The first listing shows the contents of the Local Name Table (i.e., Identity information on + the MS Windows workstation) and the second shows the NetBIOS name in the NetBIOS name cache. + The name cache contains the remote machines known to this workstation. + </p></div></div></div><div class="navfooter"><hr><table width="100%" summary="Navigation footer"><tr><td width="40%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="pam.html">Prev</a> </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="u" href="optional.html">Up</a></td><td width="40%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="unicode.html">Next</a></td></tr><tr><td width="40%" align="left" valign="top">Chapter 25. PAM-Based Distributed Authentication </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="h" href="index.html">Home</a></td><td width="40%" align="right" valign="top"> Chapter 27. Unicode/Charsets</td></tr></table></div></body></html> diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/introduction.html b/docs/htmldocs/introduction.html new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..16c243214d --- /dev/null +++ b/docs/htmldocs/introduction.html @@ -0,0 +1,3 @@ +<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>Part I. General Installation</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.60.1"><link rel="home" href="index.html" title="SAMBA Project Documentation"><link rel="up" href="index.html" title="SAMBA Project Documentation"><link rel="previous" href="pr02.html" title="Attributions"><link rel="next" href="IntroSMB.html" title="Chapter 1. Introduction to Samba"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="navheader"><table width="100%" summary="Navigation header"><tr><th colspan="3" align="center">Part I. General Installation</th></tr><tr><td width="20%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="pr02.html">Prev</a> </td><th width="60%" align="center"> </th><td width="20%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="IntroSMB.html">Next</a></td></tr></table><hr></div><div class="part" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h1 class="title"><a name="introduction"></a>General Installation</h1></div></div><div></div></div><div class="partintro" lang="en"><div><div><div><h1 class="title"><a name="id2875813"></a>Preparing Samba for Configuration</h1></div></div><div></div></div><p>This section of the Samba-HOWTO-Collection contains general info on how to install samba +and how to configure the parts of samba you will most likely need. +PLEASE read this.</p><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt>1. <a href="IntroSMB.html">Introduction to Samba</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="IntroSMB.html#id2875896">Background</a></dt><dt><a href="IntroSMB.html#id2875954">Terminology</a></dt><dt><a href="IntroSMB.html#id2876091">Related Projects</a></dt><dt><a href="IntroSMB.html#id2876169">SMB Methodology</a></dt><dt><a href="IntroSMB.html#id2876258">Epilogue</a></dt><dt><a href="IntroSMB.html#id2876344">Miscellaneous</a></dt></dl></dd><dt>2. <a href="install.html">How to Install and Test SAMBA</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="install.html#id2876533">Obtaining and Installing Samba</a></dt><dt><a href="install.html#id2876568">Configuring Samba (smb.conf)</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="install.html#id2876606">Configuration file syntax</a></dt><dt><a href="install.html#id2876766">Example Configuration</a></dt><dt><a href="install.html#id2885184">SWAT</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="install.html#id2885250">List Shares Available on the Server</a></dt><dt><a href="install.html#id2885315">Connect with a UNIX Client</a></dt><dt><a href="install.html#id2885433">Connect from a Remote SMB Client</a></dt><dt><a href="install.html#id2885526">What If Things Don't Work?</a></dt><dt><a href="install.html#id2885557">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="install.html#id2885570">Large Number of smbd Processes</a></dt><dt><a href="install.html#id2885679">Error Message: open_oplock_ipc</a></dt><dt><a href="install.html#id2885717">The network name cannot be found</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>3. <a href="FastStart.html">Fast Start for the Impatient</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="FastStart.html#id2885815">Note</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></div></div></div><div class="navfooter"><hr><table width="100%" summary="Navigation footer"><tr><td width="40%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="pr02.html">Prev</a> </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="u" href="index.html">Up</a></td><td width="40%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="IntroSMB.html">Next</a></td></tr><tr><td width="40%" align="left" valign="top">Attributions </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="h" href="index.html">Home</a></td><td width="40%" align="right" valign="top"> Chapter 1. Introduction to Samba</td></tr></table></div></body></html> diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/ix01.html b/docs/htmldocs/ix01.html new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..b428191507 --- /dev/null +++ b/docs/htmldocs/ix01.html @@ -0,0 +1,2 @@ +<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>Index</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.60.1"><link rel="home" href="index.html" title="SAMBA Project Documentation"><link rel="up" href="index.html" title="SAMBA Project Documentation"><link rel="previous" href="Further-Resources.html" title="Chapter 41. Further Resources"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="navheader"><table width="100%" summary="Navigation header"><tr><th colspan="3" align="center">Index</th></tr><tr><td width="20%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="Further-Resources.html">Prev</a> </td><th width="60%" align="center"> </th><td width="20%" align="right"> </td></tr></table><hr></div><div class="index"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="id2977419"></a>Index</h2></div></div><div></div></div><div class="index"><div class="indexdiv"><h3>Symbols</h3><dl><dt>"Printers" folder, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2939274">Caveats to be Considered</a>, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2940621">Installing the PostScript Driver on a Client</a>, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2941782">Manual Driver Installation in 15 Steps</a></dt><dt>"raw" printing, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2932163">Raw Print Serving Vendor Drivers on Windows Clients</a></dt><dt>/etc/cups/mime.convs, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#cups-raw">Explicitly Enable raw Printing for application/octet-stream</a></dt><dt>/etc/cups/mime.types, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#cups-raw">Explicitly Enable raw Printing for application/octet-stream</a></dt><dt>/etc/host.conf, <a href="integrate-ms-networks.html#id2961999">/etc/host.conf</a></dt><dt>/etc/hosts, <a href="integrate-ms-networks.html#id2961804">/etc/hosts</a></dt><dt>/etc/krb5.conf, <a href="domain-member.html#id2895267">Configure /etc/krb5.conf</a></dt><dt>/etc/nsswitch.conf, <a href="integrate-ms-networks.html#id2962064">/etc/nsswitch.conf</a></dt><dt>8.3 file names, <a href="AccessControls.html#id2911543">MS Windows NTFS Comparison with UNIX File Systems</a></dt></dl></div><div class="indexdiv"><h3>A</h3><dl><dt>Account Controls, <a href="PolicyMgmt.html#id2953826">Managing Account/User Policies</a></dt><dt>ACLs, <a href="AccessControls.html">File, Directory and Share Access Controls</a></dt><dd><dl><dt>File System, <a href="AccessControls.html#id2912050">File and Directory Access Control</a></dt><dt>POSIX, <a href="AccessControls.html">File, Directory and Share Access Controls</a>, <a href="AccessControls.html#id2911341">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt>share, <a href="AccessControls.html#id2911341">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt>Windows, <a href="AccessControls.html#id2911341">Features and Benefits</a></dt></dl></dd><dt>Active Directory, <a href="domain-member.html#ads-member">Samba ADS Domain Membership</a></dt><dt>add group script, <a href="groupmapping.html#id2910839">Adding Groups Fails</a></dt><dt>add machine script, <a href="samba-pdc.html#id2890822">The Machine Trust Account Is Not Accessible</a>, <a href="domain-member.html#id2893846">Managing Domain Machine Accounts using NT4 Server Manager</a>, <a href="domain-member.html#id2896072">Adding Machine to Domain Fails</a></dt><dt>add printer command, <a href="printing.html#id2929151">Adding New Printers with the Windows NT APW</a></dt><dt>add printer wizard, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2932552">Driver Upload Methods</a></dt><dt>add user script, <a href="passdb.html#id2904429">Mapping User Identifiers between MS Windows and UNIX</a></dt><dt>admin users, <a href="AccessControls.html#id2912329">User and Group-Based Controls</a>, <a href="AccessControls.html#id2915635">File Operations Done as root with force user Set</a></dt><dt>Administrator, <a href="groupmapping.html#id2909551">Discussion</a></dt><dt>ADS (see Active Directory)</dt><dt>application/cups.vnd-postscript, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2939571">Windows CUPS PostScript Driver Versus Adobe Driver</a></dt><dt>application/octet-stream, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#cups-raw">Explicitly Enable raw Printing for application/octet-stream</a>, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2934118">MIME Type Conversion Rules</a>, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2935861">application/octet-stream Printing</a></dt><dt>application/pdf, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2933883">MIME Types and CUPS Filters</a>, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2934118">MIME Type Conversion Rules</a></dt><dt>application/postscript, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2939571">Windows CUPS PostScript Driver Versus Adobe Driver</a></dt><dt>application/vnd.cups-raster, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2936129">PostScript Printer Descriptions (PPDs) for Non-PS Printers</a></dt><dt>application/vnd.cups-raw, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#cups-raw">Explicitly Enable raw Printing for application/octet-stream</a></dt><dt>auth methods, <a href="passdb.html#id2908922">Configuration of auth methods</a>, <a href="upgrading-to-3.0.html#id2965417">Passdb Backends and Authentication</a></dt></dl></div><div class="indexdiv"><h3>B</h3><dl><dt>bad hardware, <a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2903157">Browsing of Shares and Directories is Very Slow</a></dt><dt>brlock.tdb, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2943077">The Printing *.tdb Files</a></dt><dd><dl><dt>(see also TDB)</dt></dl></dd><dt>browsable, <a href="printing.html#id2920998">Simple Print Configuration</a></dt><dt>browse list, <a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2887786">What Is Browsing?</a>, <a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2901872">Technical Overview of Browsing</a></dt><dt>browseable, <a href="printing.html#id2920998">Simple Print Configuration</a>, <a href="printing.html#ptrsect">The [printers] Section</a>, <a href="printing.html#id2923024">Any [my_printer_name] Section</a>, <a href="printing.html#id2925021">[print$] Section Parameters</a></dt><dt>browsing problems, <a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2903097">I get an `Unable to browse the network' error</a></dt></dl></div><div class="indexdiv"><h3>C</h3><dl><dt>case sensitive, <a href="AccessControls.html#id2913187">Miscellaneous Controls</a>, <a href="ProfileMgmt.html#id2955066">Windows 9x/Me Profile Setup</a></dt><dt>chpass, <a href="domain-member.html#id2893524">Manual Creation of Machine Trust Accounts</a></dt><dt>client use spnego, <a href="domain-member.html#id2896237">I Can't Join a Windows 2003 PDC</a></dt><dt>comment, <a href="printing.html#ptrsect">The [printers] Section</a>, <a href="printing.html#id2923024">Any [my_printer_name] Section</a>, <a href="printing.html#id2925021">[print$] Section Parameters</a></dt><dt>Config.POL, <a href="PolicyMgmt.html#id2953137">Creating and Managing System Policies</a></dt><dt>configure, <a href="compiling.html#id2973553">Building the Binaries</a></dt><dt>connections.tdb, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2943077">The Printing *.tdb Files</a></dt><dd><dl><dt>(see also TDB)</dt></dl></dd><dt>core files, <a href="bugreport.html#id2972617">Internal Errors</a></dt><dt>create mask, <a href="AccessControls.html#id2912779">File and Directory Permissions-Based Controls</a>, <a href="AccessControls.html#id2914698">Interaction with the Standard Samba create mask Parameters</a></dt><dt>csc policy, <a href="AccessControls.html#id2913187">Miscellaneous Controls</a></dt><dt>CUPS</dt><dd><dl><dt>Page Accounting, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2945207">Page Accounting with CUPS</a></dt><dt>quotas, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2945248">Setting Up Quotas</a></dt></dl></dd><dt>CUPS-PPD, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2944109">cupsomatic, pdqomatic, lpdomatic, directomatic</a></dt><dt>cupsaddsmb, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2932552">Driver Upload Methods</a>, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2938397">cupsaddsmb: The Unknown Utility</a>, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2939274">Caveats to be Considered</a>, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2939801">Run cupsaddsmb (Quiet Mode)</a>, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2939946">Run cupsaddsmb with Verbose Output</a>, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2940175">Understanding cupsaddsmb</a>, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2940450">cupsaddsmb with a Samba PDC</a>, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2940538">cupsaddsmb Flowchart</a></dt><dt>cupsomatic, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2933573">Using Windows-Formatted Vendor PPDs</a>, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2933709">The CUPS Filtering Architecture</a>, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2935508">The Role of cupsomatic/foomatic</a>, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2936430">cupsomatic/foomatic-rip Versus native CUPS Printing</a>, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2944109">cupsomatic, pdqomatic, lpdomatic, directomatic</a></dt><dt>CVS, <a href="compiling.html#id2973003">Introduction</a></dt><dd><dl><dt>web, <a href="compiling.html#id2973065">Access via CVSweb</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></div><div class="indexdiv"><h3>D</h3><dl><dt>daemon, <a href="compiling.html#id2974312">Alternative: Starting smbd as a Daemon</a></dt><dt>DDK, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2938313">PostScript Drivers with No Major Problems Even in Kernel +Mode</a>, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2938755">CUPS PostScript Driver for Windows NT/200x/XP</a></dt><dt>debug, <a href="bugreport.html#id2972617">Internal Errors</a></dt><dt>debug level, <a href="problems.html#id2971276">Debugging with Samba Itself</a>, <a href="speed.html#id2976477">Log Level</a></dt><dt>debuglevel, <a href="bugreport.html#id2972408">Debug Levels</a></dt><dt>default case, <a href="AccessControls.html#id2913187">Miscellaneous Controls</a></dt><dt>default profile, <a href="ProfileMgmt.html#id2956970">Default Profile for Windows Users</a>, <a href="ProfileMgmt.html#id2958626">Changing the Default Profile</a></dt><dt>delete printer command, <a href="printing.html#id2929151">Adding New Printers with the Windows NT APW</a></dt><dt>delete roaming profiles, <a href="ProfileMgmt.html#id2957772">MS Windows 200x/XP</a></dt><dt>DHCP, <a href="integrate-ms-networks.html#id2961683">Background Information</a></dt><dt>diff, <a href="bugreport.html#id2972799">Patches</a></dt><dt>directory mask, <a href="AccessControls.html#id2912779">File and Directory Permissions-Based Controls</a></dt><dt>directory security mask, <a href="AccessControls.html#id2914698">Interaction with the Standard Samba create mask Parameters</a></dt><dt>Directory Separators, <a href="AccessControls.html#id2911543">MS Windows NTFS Comparison with UNIX File Systems</a></dt><dt>display charset, <a href="unicode.html#id2963499">Samba and Charsets</a>, <a href="SWAT.html#id2968458">Enabling SWAT Internationalization Support</a></dt><dt>DNS, <a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2888380">TCP/IP without NetBIOS</a>, <a href="integrate-ms-networks.html#id2962877">DNS Lookup</a></dt><dd><dl><dt>Active Directory, <a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#adsdnstech">DNS and Active Directory</a></dt><dt>Dynamic, <a href="integrate-ms-networks.html#id2961683">Background Information</a></dt></dl></dd><dt>dns proxy, <a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2887786">What Is Browsing?</a></dt><dt>domain admin group, <a href="groupmapping.html">Group Mapping MS Windows and UNIX</a></dt><dt>Domain Admins group, <a href="groupmapping.html#id2909551">Discussion</a></dt><dt>domain logons, <a href="samba-pdc.html#id2889080">Preparing for Domain Control</a></dt><dt>domain master, <a href="samba-pdc.html#id2890004">Domain Network Logon Service</a>, <a href="samba-bdc.html#id2892538">Example Configuration</a>, <a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2887786">What Is Browsing?</a>, <a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2900550">Making Samba the Domain Master</a></dt><dt>Domain Member, <a href="ServerType.html#id2886525">Domain Security Mode (User Level Security)</a></dt><dd><dl><dt>joining, <a href="ServerType.html#id2886566">Example Configuration</a></dt></dl></dd><dt>domain security, <a href="samba-pdc.html#id2870050">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt>Domain Users group, <a href="groupmapping.html#id2910933">Adding Domain Users to the Power Users Group</a></dt><dt>dont descend, <a href="AccessControls.html#id2913187">Miscellaneous Controls</a></dt><dt>dos charset, <a href="unicode.html#id2963499">Samba and Charsets</a>, <a href="unicode.html#id2963643">Japanese Charsets</a>, <a href="unicode.html#id2963788">CP850.so Can't Be Found</a></dt><dt>dos filemode, <a href="AccessControls.html#id2912779">File and Directory Permissions-Based Controls</a></dt><dt>dos filetime resolution, <a href="AccessControls.html#id2913187">Miscellaneous Controls</a></dt><dt>dos filetimes, <a href="AccessControls.html#id2913187">Miscellaneous Controls</a></dt><dt>Drive Identification, <a href="AccessControls.html#id2911543">MS Windows NTFS Comparison with UNIX File Systems</a></dt></dl></div><div class="indexdiv"><h3>E</h3><dl><dt>editreg, <a href="PolicyMgmt.html#id2954000">Samba Editreg Toolset</a></dt><dt>EMF, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2932876">Windows Drivers, GDI and EMF</a>, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2937377">From Windows Clients to an NT Print Server</a>, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2937506">Driver Execution on the Server</a></dt><dt>encrypt passwords, <a href="domain-member.html#id2894418">Joining an NT4-type Domain with Samba-3</a>, <a href="passdb.html#id2905425">smbpasswd Encrypted Password Database</a>, <a href="pam.html#id2960612">smb.conf PAM Configuration</a>, <a href="upgrading-to-3.0.html#id2964134">Quick Migration Guide</a>, <a href="diagnosis.html#id2969546">The Tests</a></dt><dt>encrypted passwords, <a href="passdb.html#id2903592">Features and Benefits</a>, <a href="passdb.html#passdbtech">Technical Information</a>, <a href="passdb.html#id2908611">Using Plaintext Passwords or Encrypted Password</a></dt><dt>enhanced browsing, <a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2887786">What Is Browsing?</a></dt><dt>enumports command, <a href="printing.html#id2929923">Samba and Printer Ports</a></dt><dt>EPM (see ESP meta packager)</dt><dt>ESC/P, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2937506">Driver Execution on the Server</a></dt><dt>ESP</dt><dd><dl><dt>Ghostscript, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2933709">The CUPS Filtering Architecture</a>, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2936430">cupsomatic/foomatic-rip Versus native CUPS Printing</a></dt><dt>meta packager, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2938755">CUPS PostScript Driver for Windows NT/200x/XP</a></dt><dt>Print Pro, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2937128">Sources of CUPS Drivers/PPDs</a>, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2939204">ESP Print Pro PostScript Driver for Windows NT/200x/XP</a></dt></dl></dd><dt>Event Viewer, <a href="AdvancedNetworkManagement.html#id2952308">Remote Server Administration</a></dt><dt>Extended Attributes, <a href="AccessControls.html">File, Directory and Share Access Controls</a></dt></dl></div><div class="indexdiv"><h3>F</h3><dl><dt>fake oplocks, <a href="AccessControls.html#id2913187">Miscellaneous Controls</a></dt><dt>File Naming Conventions, <a href="AccessControls.html#id2911543">MS Windows NTFS Comparison with UNIX File Systems</a></dt><dt>File System, <a href="AccessControls.html#id2911543">MS Windows NTFS Comparison with UNIX File Systems</a></dt><dd><dl><dt>case sensitivity, <a href="AccessControls.html#id2911543">MS Windows NTFS Comparison with UNIX File Systems</a></dt><dt>feature comparison, <a href="AccessControls.html#id2911543">MS Windows NTFS Comparison with UNIX File Systems</a></dt><dt>UNIX, <a href="AccessControls.html#id2911543">MS Windows NTFS Comparison with UNIX File Systems</a></dt><dt>Windows, <a href="AccessControls.html#id2911543">MS Windows NTFS Comparison with UNIX File Systems</a></dt></dl></dd><dt>flush name cache, <a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2902975">How Can One Flush the Samba NetBIOS Name Cache without Restarting Samba?</a></dt><dt>foomatic, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2933573">Using Windows-Formatted Vendor PPDs</a>, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2933709">The CUPS Filtering Architecture</a>, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2935508">The Role of cupsomatic/foomatic</a>, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2936430">cupsomatic/foomatic-rip Versus native CUPS Printing</a>, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2943860">foomatic-rip and Foomatic Explained</a>, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2944020">Foomatic's Strange Name</a></dt><dt>foomatic-rip, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2936430">cupsomatic/foomatic-rip Versus native CUPS Printing</a>, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2943673">CUPS Print Drivers from Linuxprinting.org</a>, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2943860">foomatic-rip and Foomatic Explained</a>, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2944302">The Grand Unification Achieved</a></dt><dt>force create mode, <a href="AccessControls.html#id2912779">File and Directory Permissions-Based Controls</a>, <a href="AccessControls.html#id2914698">Interaction with the Standard Samba create mask Parameters</a></dt><dt>force directory mode, <a href="AccessControls.html#id2912779">File and Directory Permissions-Based Controls</a>, <a href="AccessControls.html#id2914698">Interaction with the Standard Samba create mask Parameters</a></dt><dt>force directory security mode, <a href="AccessControls.html#id2912779">File and Directory Permissions-Based Controls</a>, <a href="AccessControls.html#id2914698">Interaction with the Standard Samba create mask Parameters</a></dt><dt>force group, <a href="AccessControls.html#id2912329">User and Group-Based Controls</a></dt><dt>force security mode, <a href="AccessControls.html#id2912779">File and Directory Permissions-Based Controls</a>, <a href="AccessControls.html#id2914698">Interaction with the Standard Samba create mask Parameters</a></dt><dt>force user, <a href="AccessControls.html#id2912329">User and Group-Based Controls</a>, <a href="AccessControls.html#id2915635">File Operations Done as root with force user Set</a>, <a href="locking.html#id2916637">Beware of Force User</a></dt><dt>ftp, <a href="compiling.html#id2973311">Accessing the Samba Sources via rsync and ftp</a></dt></dl></div><div class="indexdiv"><h3>G</h3><dl><dt>gdb, <a href="bugreport.html#id2972617">Internal Errors</a></dt><dt>GDI, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#gdipost">GDI on Windows -- PostScript on UNIX</a>, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2932876">Windows Drivers, GDI and EMF</a>, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2937377">From Windows Clients to an NT Print Server</a>, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2937506">Driver Execution on the Server</a></dt><dt>genlogon.pl, <a href="AdvancedNetworkManagement.html#id2952700">Network Logon Script Magic</a></dt><dt>GhostScript, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#post-and-ghost">PostScript and Ghostscript</a>, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2933354">Ghostscript the Software RIP for Non-PostScript Printers</a></dt><dd><dl><dt>(see also PostScript)</dt></dl></dd><dt>Ghostscript</dt><dd><dl><dt>ESP (see ESP GhostScript)</dt></dl></dd><dt>GID, <a href="groupmapping.html#id2909181">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt>GPG, <a href="compiling.html#id2973389">Verifying Samba's PGP Signature</a></dt><dt>GPOs, <a href="PolicyMgmt.html#id2953044">Features and Benefits</a>, <a href="PolicyMgmt.html#id2953525">MS Windows 200x/XP Professional Policies</a>, <a href="PolicyMgmt.html#id2953643">Administration of Windows 200x/XP Policies</a>, <a href="PolicyMgmt.html#id2953826">Managing Account/User Policies</a>, <a href="ProfileMgmt.html#id2957772">MS Windows 200x/XP</a></dt><dt>group policies, <a href="PolicyMgmt.html#id2953044">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt>group policy objects (see GPOs)</dt><dt>group profiles, <a href="ProfileMgmt.html#id2956917">Creating and Managing Group Profiles</a></dt><dt>groupadd, <a href="groupmapping.html#id2909181">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt>groupdel, <a href="groupmapping.html#id2909181">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt>groups</dt><dd><dl><dt>domain, <a href="groupmapping.html#id2909551">Discussion</a></dt><dt>mapping, <a href="groupmapping.html">Group Mapping MS Windows and UNIX</a></dt><dt>nested, <a href="groupmapping.html#id2910907">Adding MS Windows Groups to MS Windows Groups Fails</a></dt></dl></dd><dt>guest account, <a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2902057">Problem Resolution</a>, <a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2903041">Server Resources Can Not Be Listed</a>, <a href="printing.html#ptrsect">The [printers] Section</a></dt><dt>guest ok, <a href="AccessControls.html#id2912329">User and Group-Based Controls</a>, <a href="printing.html#ptrsect">The [printers] Section</a>, <a href="printing.html#id2923024">Any [my_printer_name] Section</a>, <a href="printing.html#id2925021">[print$] Section Parameters</a></dt></dl></div><div class="indexdiv"><h3>H</h3><dl><dt>hide dot files, <a href="AccessControls.html#id2913187">Miscellaneous Controls</a></dt><dt>hide files, <a href="AccessControls.html#id2913187">Miscellaneous Controls</a></dt><dt>hide unreadable, <a href="AccessControls.html#id2912779">File and Directory Permissions-Based Controls</a></dt><dt>hide unwriteable files, <a href="AccessControls.html#id2912779">File and Directory Permissions-Based Controls</a></dt><dt>host msdfs, <a href="msdfs.html#id2920158">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt>hosts allow, <a href="securing-samba.html#id2918263">Using Host-Based Protection</a>, <a href="printing.html#id2923024">Any [my_printer_name] Section</a></dt><dt>hosts deny, <a href="securing-samba.html#id2918263">Using Host-Based Protection</a>, <a href="printing.html#id2923024">Any [my_printer_name] Section</a></dt></dl></div><div class="indexdiv"><h3>I</h3><dl><dt>idmap backend, <a href="samba-bdc.html#id2892538">Example Configuration</a></dt><dt>idmap gid, <a href="groupmapping.html#id2909181">Features and Benefits</a>, <a href="winbind.html#id2952067">Winbind Is Not Resolving Users and Groups</a>, <a href="pam.html#id2961406">Winbind Is Not Resolving Users and Groups</a></dt><dt>idmap uid, <a href="groupmapping.html#id2909181">Features and Benefits</a>, <a href="winbind.html#id2952067">Winbind Is Not Resolving Users and Groups</a>, <a href="pam.html#id2961406">Winbind Is Not Resolving Users and Groups</a></dt><dt>ifconfig, <a href="compiling.html#id2974066">Starting from inetd.conf</a></dt><dt>imprints, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2932552">Driver Upload Methods</a></dt><dt>inetd, <a href="diagnosis.html#id2969546">The Tests</a>, <a href="compiling.html#id2973958">Starting the smbd and nmbd</a>, <a href="compiling.html#id2974066">Starting from inetd.conf</a></dt><dt>initGroups.sh, <a href="groupmapping.html#id2910716">Script to Configure Group Mapping</a>, <a href="NT4Migration.html#id2966502">Steps in Migration Process</a></dt><dt>Interdomain Trusts, <a href="InterdomainTrusts.html">Interdomain Trust Relationships</a></dt><dd><dl><dt>Completing, <a href="InterdomainTrusts.html#id2919342">Completing an NT4 Domain Trust</a></dt><dt>creating, <a href="InterdomainTrusts.html#id2919243">Native MS Windows NT4 Trusts Configuration</a></dt><dt>Facilities, <a href="InterdomainTrusts.html#id2919402">Inter-Domain Trust Facilities</a></dt></dl></dd><dt>interfaces, <a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2900745">Multiple Interfaces</a>, <a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2902057">Problem Resolution</a>, <a href="diagnosis.html#id2969546">The Tests</a>, <a href="compiling.html#id2974066">Starting from inetd.conf</a></dt><dt>invalid users, <a href="AccessControls.html#id2912329">User and Group-Based Controls</a></dt><dt>IPP, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2940175">Understanding cupsaddsmb</a></dt></dl></div><div class="indexdiv"><h3>K</h3><dl><dt>KDC, <a href="domain-member.html#ads-member">Samba ADS Domain Membership</a></dt><dt>Kerberos, <a href="domain-member.html#ads-member">Samba ADS Domain Membership</a></dt><dd><dl><dt>/etc/krb5.conf, <a href="domain-member.html#id2895267">Configure /etc/krb5.conf</a></dt></dl></dd><dt>kinit, <a href="domain-member.html#id2895267">Configure /etc/krb5.conf</a></dt></dl></div><div class="indexdiv"><h3>L</h3><dl><dt>ldap admin dn, <a href="samba-bdc.html#id2892268">Backup Domain Controller Configuration</a>, <a href="domain-member.html#id2895877">Sharing User ID Mappings between Samba Domain Members</a>, <a href="passdb.html#id2906239">Configuring Samba</a></dt><dt>ldap delete dn, <a href="passdb.html#id2906239">Configuring Samba</a></dt><dt>ldap filter, <a href="passdb.html#id2906239">Configuring Samba</a></dt><dt>ldap group suffix, <a href="passdb.html#id2906239">Configuring Samba</a></dt><dt>ldap idmap suffix, <a href="samba-bdc.html#id2892268">Backup Domain Controller Configuration</a>, <a href="domain-member.html#id2895877">Sharing User ID Mappings between Samba Domain Members</a>, <a href="passdb.html#id2906239">Configuring Samba</a></dt><dt>ldap machine suffix, <a href="passdb.html#id2906239">Configuring Samba</a></dt><dt>ldap passwd sync, <a href="passdb.html#id2906239">Configuring Samba</a>, <a href="passdb.html#id2907513">Password Synchronization</a></dt><dt>ldap ssl, <a href="passdb.html#id2906239">Configuring Samba</a>, <a href="passdb.html#id2906746">Security and sambaSamAccount</a></dt><dt>ldap suffix, <a href="samba-bdc.html#id2892268">Backup Domain Controller Configuration</a>, <a href="passdb.html#id2906239">Configuring Samba</a></dt><dt>ldap user suffix, <a href="passdb.html#id2906239">Configuring Samba</a></dt><dt>libnss_wins.so, <a href="integrate-ms-networks.html#id2962064">/etc/nsswitch.conf</a></dt><dt>Links</dt><dd><dl><dt>hard, <a href="AccessControls.html#id2911543">MS Windows NTFS Comparison with UNIX File Systems</a></dt><dt>soft, <a href="AccessControls.html#id2911543">MS Windows NTFS Comparison with UNIX File Systems</a></dt></dl></dd><dt>Linuxprinting.org, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2943673">CUPS Print Drivers from Linuxprinting.org</a></dt><dt>lm announce, <a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2887786">What Is Browsing?</a></dt><dt>lm interval, <a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2887786">What Is Browsing?</a></dt><dt>LMB (see Local Master Browser)</dt><dt>LMHOSTS, <a href="integrate-ms-networks.html#id2962597">The LMHOSTS File</a></dt><dt>load printers, <a href="printing.html#id2921327">Rapid Configuration Validation</a>, <a href="printing.html#id2922033">The [global] Section</a></dt><dt>local master, <a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2887786">What Is Browsing?</a>, <a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#DMB">Configuring WORKGROUP Browsing</a></dt><dt>Local Master Browser, <a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2888109">NetBIOS over TCP/IP</a>, <a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2900780">Use of the Remote Announce Parameter</a></dt><dt>locking, <a href="locking.html#id2916001">Discussion</a></dt><dt>locking.tdb, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2943077">The Printing *.tdb Files</a></dt><dd><dl><dt>(see also TDB)</dt></dl></dd><dt>log files</dt><dd><dl><dt>monitoring, <a href="diagnosis.html#id2969311">Assumptions</a></dt></dl></dd><dt>log level, <a href="domain-member.html#id2896072">Adding Machine to Domain Fails</a>, <a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2902057">Problem Resolution</a>, <a href="VFS.html#id2948583">extd_audit</a>, <a href="bugreport.html#id2972408">Debug Levels</a></dt><dt>logon drive, <a href="ProfileMgmt.html#id2955678">Windows NT4 Workstation</a></dt><dt>logon home, <a href="passdb.html#id2906904">LDAP Special Attributes for sambaSamAccounts</a>, <a href="ProfileMgmt.html#id2954652">Windows 9x/Me User Profiles</a>, <a href="ProfileMgmt.html#id2954783">Mixed Windows 9x/Me and Windows NT4/200x User Profiles</a>, <a href="ProfileMgmt.html#id2954850">Disabling Roaming Profile Support</a>, <a href="ProfileMgmt.html#id2955678">Windows NT4 Workstation</a>, <a href="ProfileMgmt.html#id2956404">Sharing Profiles between W9x/Me and NT4/200x/XP Workstations</a></dt><dt>logon path, <a href="passdb.html#id2906904">LDAP Special Attributes for sambaSamAccounts</a>, <a href="ProfileMgmt.html#id2954783">Mixed Windows 9x/Me and Windows NT4/200x User Profiles</a>, <a href="ProfileMgmt.html#id2954850">Disabling Roaming Profile Support</a>, <a href="ProfileMgmt.html#id2955066">Windows 9x/Me Profile Setup</a>, <a href="ProfileMgmt.html#id2955678">Windows NT4 Workstation</a>, <a href="ProfileMgmt.html#id2956404">Sharing Profiles between W9x/Me and NT4/200x/XP Workstations</a></dt><dt>logon script, <a href="passdb.html#id2906904">LDAP Special Attributes for sambaSamAccounts</a></dt><dt>lpadmin, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2943673">CUPS Print Drivers from Linuxprinting.org</a>, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2945248">Setting Up Quotas</a></dt><dt>lppause command, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2931276">Linking smbd with libcups.so</a>, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2937639">From Windows Clients to a CUPS/Samba Print Server</a>, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2946198">Pre-Conditions</a></dt><dt>lpq cache time, <a href="printing.html#id2922033">The [global] Section</a></dt><dt>lpq command, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2931276">Linking smbd with libcups.so</a>, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2946198">Pre-Conditions</a></dt><dt>lpresume command, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2931276">Linking smbd with libcups.so</a>, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2946198">Pre-Conditions</a></dt><dt>lprm command, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2931276">Linking smbd with libcups.so</a>, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2946198">Pre-Conditions</a></dt><dt>lpstat, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2942909">Troubleshooting Revisited</a></dt></dl></div><div class="indexdiv"><h3>M</h3><dl><dt>MAC Addresses, <a href="integrate-ms-networks.html#id2961804">/etc/hosts</a></dt><dt>Machine Trust Accounts, <a href="samba-pdc.html#id2870050">Features and Benefits</a>, <a href="samba-bdc.html#id2892791">Machine Accounts Keep Expiring</a>, <a href="domain-member.html#machine-trust-accounts">MS Windows Workstation/Server Machine Trust Accounts</a></dt><dd><dl><dt>creating, <a href="domain-member.html#machine-trust-accounts">MS Windows Workstation/Server Machine Trust Accounts</a></dt></dl></dd><dt>make, <a href="compiling.html#id2973553">Building the Binaries</a></dt><dt>mandatory profiles, <a href="ProfileMgmt.html#id2956822">Mandatory Profiles</a></dt><dt>mangling method, <a href="unicode.html#id2963643">Japanese Charsets</a></dt><dt>map to guest, <a href="printing.html#id2925021">[print$] Section Parameters</a>, <a href="printing.html#id2929151">Adding New Printers with the Windows NT APW</a>, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2947002">New Account Reconnection from Windows 200x/XP Troubles</a>, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2947106">Avoid Being Connected to the Samba Server as the Wrong User</a></dt><dt>max xmit, <a href="speed.html#id2976422">Max Xmit</a></dt><dt>messages.tdb, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2943077">The Printing *.tdb Files</a></dt><dd><dl><dt>(see also TDB)</dt></dl></dd><dt>MIME, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2933883">MIME Types and CUPS Filters</a>, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2934118">MIME Type Conversion Rules</a>, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2934287">Filtering Overview</a>, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2935861">application/octet-stream Printing</a></dt><dd><dl><dt>filters, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2933883">MIME Types and CUPS Filters</a></dt><dt>raw, <a href="StandAloneServer.html#SimplePrintServer">Central Print Serving</a>, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#cups-raw">Explicitly Enable raw Printing for application/octet-stream</a></dt></dl></dd><dt>minimal configuration, <a href="install.html#id2876606">Configuration file syntax</a></dt><dt>msdfs root, <a href="msdfs.html#id2920158">Features and Benefits</a></dt></dl></div><div class="indexdiv"><h3>N</h3><dl><dt>name resolve order, <a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2887786">What Is Browsing?</a></dt><dt>nbtstat, <a href="integrate-ms-networks.html#id2962531">The NetBIOS Name Cache</a></dt><dt>net</dt><dd><dl><dt>groupmap, <a href="groupmapping.html#id2910488">Example Configuration</a>, <a href="NT4Migration.html#id2966502">Steps in Migration Process</a></dt><dt>rpc, <a href="ServerType.html#id2886566">Example Configuration</a>, <a href="samba-bdc.html#id2891162">Features and Benefits</a>, <a href="NT4Migration.html#id2966502">Steps in Migration Process</a></dt></dl></dd><dt>NetBIOS, <a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2897285">Features and Benefits</a>, <a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2888380">TCP/IP without NetBIOS</a>, <a href="integrate-ms-networks.html">Integrating MS Windows Networks with Samba</a>, <a href="integrate-ms-networks.html#id2962179">Name Resolution as Used within MS Windows Networking</a></dt><dt>NetBIOS-less, <a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2888380">TCP/IP without NetBIOS</a></dt><dt>Nexus.exe, <a href="samba-pdc.html#id2870050">Features and Benefits</a>, <a href="domain-member.html#id2893846">Managing Domain Machine Accounts using NT4 Server Manager</a>, <a href="AdvancedNetworkManagement.html#id2952308">Remote Server Administration</a></dt><dt>nmblookup, <a href="integrate-ms-networks.html#id2962531">The NetBIOS Name Cache</a></dt><dt>NoMachine.Com, <a href="AdvancedNetworkManagement.html#id2952467">Remote Management from NoMachine.Com</a></dt><dt>nt acl support, <a href="AccessControls.html#id2912779">File and Directory Permissions-Based Controls</a>, <a href="AccessControls.html#id2914124">Viewing File Ownership</a>, <a href="AccessControls.html#id2914264">Viewing File or Directory Permissions</a>, <a href="AccessControls.html#id2914515">Modifying File or Directory Permissions</a>, <a href="Other-Clients.html#id2975901">Windows 2000 Service Pack 2</a></dt><dt>NTConfig.POL, <a href="PolicyMgmt.html#id2953271">Windows 9x/ME Policies</a>, <a href="PolicyMgmt.html#id2953826">Managing Account/User Policies</a>, <a href="PolicyMgmt.html#id2954000">Samba Editreg Toolset</a>, <a href="ProfileMgmt.html#id2957150">MS Windows NT4 Workstation</a></dt><dt>ntdrivers.tdb, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2943077">The Printing *.tdb Files</a></dt><dd><dl><dt>(see also TDB)</dt></dl></dd><dt>ntforms.tdb, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2943077">The Printing *.tdb Files</a></dt><dd><dl><dt>(see also TDB)</dt></dl></dd><dt>NTFS, <a href="AccessControls.html#id2911543">MS Windows NTFS Comparison with UNIX File Systems</a></dt><dt>ntprinters.tdb, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2943077">The Printing *.tdb Files</a></dt><dd><dl><dt>(see also TDB)</dt></dl></dd><dt>NTUser.DAT, <a href="PolicyMgmt.html#id2954000">Samba Editreg Toolset</a></dt></dl></div><div class="indexdiv"><h3>O</h3><dl><dt>obey pam restrictions, <a href="pam.html#id2960612">smb.conf PAM Configuration</a></dt><dt>only user, <a href="AccessControls.html#id2912329">User and Group-Based Controls</a>, <a href="securing-samba.html#id2918774">Why Can Users Access Home Directories of Other Users?</a></dt><dt>oplock break wait time, <a href="locking.html#id2916729">Advanced Samba Opportunistic Locking Parameters</a>, <a href="locking.html#id2917088">Disabling Kernel Oplocks</a></dt><dt>oplock contention limit, <a href="locking.html#id2916729">Advanced Samba Opportunistic Locking Parameters</a></dt><dt>os level, <a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2887786">What Is Browsing?</a>, <a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#DMB">Configuring WORKGROUP Browsing</a>, <a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2900135">DOMAIN Browsing Configuration</a>, <a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#browse-force-master">Forcing Samba to Be the Master</a>, <a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2900550">Making Samba the Domain Master</a></dt><dt>os2 driver map, <a href="Other-Clients.html#id2975411">Printer Driver Download for OS/2 Clients</a></dt></dl></div><div class="indexdiv"><h3>P</h3><dl><dt>page_log, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2945495">The page_log File Syntax</a></dt><dt>passdb backend, <a href="domain-member.html#machine-trust-accounts">MS Windows Workstation/Server Machine Trust Accounts</a>, <a href="passdb.html">Account Information Databases</a>, <a href="passdb.html#passdbtech">Technical Information</a>, <a href="passdb.html#pdbeditthing">The pdbedit Command</a>, <a href="passdb.html#id2906239">Configuring Samba</a>, <a href="passdb.html#id2907797">Configuring</a>, <a href="passdb.html#id2908788">Users Cannot Logon</a>, <a href="passdb.html#id2908922">Configuration of auth methods</a>, <a href="pam.html#id2960701">Remote CIFS Authentication Using winbindd.so</a>, <a href="upgrading-to-3.0.html#id2964134">Quick Migration Guide</a>, <a href="upgrading-to-3.0.html#id2965417">Passdb Backends and Authentication</a></dt><dt>password level, <a href="ServerType.html#id2887204">Password Checking</a>, <a href="diagnosis.html#id2969546">The Tests</a>, <a href="Other-Clients.html#id2975701">Password Case Sensitivity</a>, <a href="speed.html#id2976655">Slow Logins</a></dt><dt>password server, <a href="ServerType.html#id2886928">Server Security (User Level Security)</a>, <a href="samba-pdc.html#id2890439">Security Mode and Master Browsers</a>, <a href="domain-member.html#id2894418">Joining an NT4-type Domain with Samba-3</a>, <a href="domain-member.html#id2895131">Configure smb.conf</a>, <a href="diagnosis.html#id2969546">The Tests</a></dt><dt>patch, <a href="bugreport.html#id2972799">Patches</a></dt><dt>path, <a href="printing.html#ptrsect">The [printers] Section</a>, <a href="printing.html#id2923024">Any [my_printer_name] Section</a>, <a href="printing.html#id2923371">Print Commands</a>, <a href="printing.html#id2924810">Creating the [print$] Share</a>, <a href="printing.html#id2925021">[print$] Section Parameters</a>, <a href="printing.html#id2925355">The [print$] Share Directory</a>, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2937834">Samba Receiving Jobfiles and Passing Them to CUPS</a>, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2946030">Auto-Deletion or Preservation of CUPS Spool Files</a>, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2947835">Permissions on /var/spool/samba/ Get Reset After Each Reboot</a>, <a href="diagnosis.html#id2969546">The Tests</a></dt><dt>PCL, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#gdipost">GDI on Windows -- PostScript on UNIX</a>, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2932876">Windows Drivers, GDI and EMF</a>, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2933049">UNIX Printfile Conversion and GUI Basics</a>, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2937506">Driver Execution on the Server</a>, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2937924">Network PostScript RIP</a></dt><dt>pdbedit, <a href="passdb.html#id2903800">New Backends</a>, <a href="passdb.html#acctmgmttools">Account Management Tools</a>, <a href="passdb.html#pdbeditthing">The pdbedit Command</a>, <a href="passdb.html#XMLpassdb">XML</a>, <a href="upgrading-to-3.0.html#id2965417">Passdb Backends and Authentication</a>, <a href="NT4Migration.html#id2966502">Steps in Migration Process</a>, <a href="NT4Migration.html#id2967145">Samba-3 Implementation Choices</a></dt><dt>PDF, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2932876">Windows Drivers, GDI and EMF</a>, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2933497">PostScript Printer Description (PPD) Specification</a></dt><dt>pdf, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2934118">MIME Type Conversion Rules</a></dt><dt>PDL, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#gdipost">GDI on Windows -- PostScript on UNIX</a>, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#post-and-ghost">PostScript and Ghostscript</a></dt><dt>permissions</dt><dd><dl><dt>file/directory ACLs, <a href="AccessControls.html#id2913986">Managing UNIX Permissions Using NT Security Dialogs</a></dt><dt>share, <a href="AccessControls.html#id2912290">Share Definition Access Controls</a></dt><dt>share ACLs, <a href="AccessControls.html#id2913585">Access Controls on Shares</a></dt><dt>UNIX file and directory, <a href="AccessControls.html#id2911341">Features and Benefits</a></dt></dl></dd><dt>PGP, <a href="compiling.html#id2973389">Verifying Samba's PGP Signature</a></dt><dt>PJL, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2937924">Network PostScript RIP</a>, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2939571">Windows CUPS PostScript Driver Versus Adobe Driver</a>, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2945366">Adobe and CUPS PostScript Drivers for Windows Clients</a></dt><dt>point 'n' print, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2932223">Installation of Windows Client Drivers</a>, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2932552">Driver Upload Methods</a>, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2935508">The Role of cupsomatic/foomatic</a>, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2939801">Run cupsaddsmb (Quiet Mode)</a>, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2940621">Installing the PostScript Driver on a Client</a>, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2941782">Manual Driver Installation in 15 Steps</a></dt><dt>PostScript, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2932699">Advanced Intelligent Printing with PostScript Driver Download</a>, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#gdipost">GDI on Windows -- PostScript on UNIX</a>, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2932876">Windows Drivers, GDI and EMF</a>, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2933049">UNIX Printfile Conversion and GUI Basics</a>, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#post-and-ghost">PostScript and Ghostscript</a>, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2934481">Prefilters</a>, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2937506">Driver Execution on the Server</a>, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2937924">Network PostScript RIP</a>, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2938250">CUPS: A Magical Stone?</a>, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2938755">CUPS PostScript Driver for Windows NT/200x/XP</a></dt><dd><dl><dt>(see also Ghostscript)</dt><dt>RIP, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#post-and-ghost">PostScript and Ghostscript</a></dt></dl></dd><dt>PPD, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#post-and-ghost">PostScript and Ghostscript</a>, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2933497">PostScript Printer Description (PPD) Specification</a>, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2936129">PostScript Printer Descriptions (PPDs) for Non-PS Printers</a>, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2938025">PPDs for Non-PS Printers on UNIX</a>, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2938085">PPDs for Non-PS Printers on Windows</a>, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2938250">CUPS: A Magical Stone?</a>, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2940621">Installing the PostScript Driver on a Client</a></dt><dd><dl><dt>CUPS (see CUPS-PPD)</dt></dl></dd><dt>preferred master, <a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2887786">What Is Browsing?</a>, <a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#DMB">Configuring WORKGROUP Browsing</a>, <a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#browse-force-master">Forcing Samba to Be the Master</a>, <a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2900550">Making Samba the Domain Master</a>, <a href="diagnosis.html#id2969546">The Tests</a></dt><dt>preserve case, <a href="ProfileMgmt.html#id2955066">Windows 9x/Me Profile Setup</a></dt><dt>print command, <a href="printing.html#id2922033">The [global] Section</a>, <a href="printing.html#id2923428">Default UNIX System Printing Commands</a>, <a href="printing.html#id2924063">Custom Print Commands</a>, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2931276">Linking smbd with libcups.so</a>, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2937639">From Windows Clients to a CUPS/Samba Print Server</a>, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2946198">Pre-Conditions</a>, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2946367">Manual Configuration</a></dt><dt>printable, <a href="printing.html#ptrsect">The [printers] Section</a>, <a href="printing.html#id2923024">Any [my_printer_name] Section</a></dt><dt>printcap, <a href="printing.html#id2923428">Default UNIX System Printing Commands</a>, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2931182">Basic CUPS Support Configuration</a>, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2931276">Linking smbd with libcups.so</a>, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2931722">More Complex CUPS smb.conf Settings</a>, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2946198">Pre-Conditions</a></dt><dt>printcap name, <a href="printing.html#id2922033">The [global] Section</a></dt><dt>printer admin, <a href="printing.html#id2922033">The [global] Section</a>, <a href="printing.html#id2923024">Any [my_printer_name] Section</a>, <a href="printing.html#id2925021">[print$] Section Parameters</a>, <a href="printing.html#id2925644">Add Printer Wizard Driver Installation</a>, <a href="printing.html#id2927537">First Client Driver Installation</a>, <a href="printing.html#id2927769">Setting Device Modes on New Printers</a>, <a href="printing.html#id2928220">Always Make First Client Connection as root or printer admin</a>, <a href="printing.html#id2928430">Setting Default Print Options for Client Drivers</a>, <a href="printing.html#id2929151">Adding New Printers with the Windows NT APW</a>, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2931722">More Complex CUPS smb.conf Settings</a>, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2941534">Requirements for adddriver and setdriver to Succeed</a>, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2947402">Print Options for All Users Can't Be Set on Windows 200x/XP</a></dt><dt>printing, <a href="printing.html#id2922033">The [global] Section</a>, <a href="printing.html#id2923428">Default UNIX System Printing Commands</a>, <a href="printing.html#id2924063">Custom Print Commands</a>, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2931182">Basic CUPS Support Configuration</a>, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2931276">Linking smbd with libcups.so</a>, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2931722">More Complex CUPS smb.conf Settings</a>, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2937639">From Windows Clients to a CUPS/Samba Print Server</a>, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2946198">Pre-Conditions</a>, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2946367">Manual Configuration</a></dt><dt>printing.tdb, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2943077">The Printing *.tdb Files</a></dt><dd><dl><dt>(see also TDB)</dt></dl></dd><dt>PrintPro (see ESP Print Pro)</dt><dt>public, <a href="printing.html#ptrsect">The [printers] Section</a></dt></dl></div><div class="indexdiv"><h3>Q</h3><dl><dt>queue resume command, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2931276">Linking smbd with libcups.so</a></dt><dt>queuepause command, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2931276">Linking smbd with libcups.so</a></dt></dl></div><div class="indexdiv"><h3>R</h3><dl><dt>raw printing, <a href="StandAloneServer.html#SimplePrintServer">Central Print Serving</a>, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#cups-raw">Explicitly Enable raw Printing for application/octet-stream</a></dt><dt>read list, <a href="AccessControls.html#id2912329">User and Group-Based Controls</a></dt><dt>read only, <a href="AccessControls.html#id2913187">Miscellaneous Controls</a>, <a href="printing.html#ptrsect">The [printers] Section</a>, <a href="printing.html#id2925021">[print$] Section Parameters</a></dt><dt>read raw, <a href="speed.html#id2976507">Read Raw</a></dt><dt>read size, <a href="speed.html#id2976372">Read Size</a></dt><dt>Relative Identifier (see RID)</dt><dt>remote announce, <a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2888109">NetBIOS over TCP/IP</a>, <a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2888743">How Browsing Functions</a>, <a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2900780">Use of the Remote Announce Parameter</a>, <a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2901926">Browsing Support in Samba</a></dt><dt>remote browse sync, <a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2888109">NetBIOS over TCP/IP</a>, <a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2888743">How Browsing Functions</a>, <a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2900939">Use of the Remote Browse Sync Parameter</a></dt><dt>replication, <a href="samba-pdc.html#id2870050">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dd><dl><dt>browse lists, <a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2902187">Cross-Subnet Browsing</a></dt><dt>SAM, <a href="samba-pdc.html#id2870336">Domain Controller Types</a>, <a href="samba-bdc.html#id2891162">Features and Benefits</a>, <a href="samba-bdc.html#id2891580">MS Windows NT4-style Domain Control</a>, <a href="samba-bdc.html#id2892268">Backup Domain Controller Configuration</a>, <a href="samba-bdc.html#id2892845">Can Samba Be a Backup Domain Controller to an NT4 PDC?</a>, <a href="samba-bdc.html#id2892880">How Do I Replicate the smbpasswd File?</a></dt><dt>WINS, <a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2888109">NetBIOS over TCP/IP</a>, <a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2901208">WINS Server Configuration</a>, <a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2901481">WINS Replication</a></dt></dl></dd><dt>RID, <a href="groupmapping.html#id2909853">Default Users, Groups and Relative Identifiers</a></dt><dt>roaming profiles, <a href="ProfileMgmt.html#id2954850">Disabling Roaming Profile Support</a></dt><dt>root preexec, <a href="NT4Migration.html#id2966369">Logon Scripts</a></dt><dt>rpcclient</dt><dd><dl><dt>adddriver, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2939946">Run cupsaddsmb with Verbose Output</a>, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2940175">Understanding cupsaddsmb</a>, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2940875">Installing PostScript Driver Files Manually Using rpcclient</a>, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2941229">Understanding the rpcclient man Page</a>, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2941534">Requirements for adddriver and setdriver to Succeed</a>, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2941782">Manual Driver Installation in 15 Steps</a></dt><dt>enumdrivers, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2940875">Installing PostScript Driver Files Manually Using rpcclient</a>, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2941782">Manual Driver Installation in 15 Steps</a></dt><dt>enumports, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2940875">Installing PostScript Driver Files Manually Using rpcclient</a></dt><dt>enumprinters, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2940875">Installing PostScript Driver Files Manually Using rpcclient</a>, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2941534">Requirements for adddriver and setdriver to Succeed</a>, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2941782">Manual Driver Installation in 15 Steps</a>, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2942909">Troubleshooting Revisited</a></dt><dt>getdriver, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2941358">Producing an Example by Querying a Windows Box</a>, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2941782">Manual Driver Installation in 15 Steps</a></dt><dt>getprinter, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2941358">Producing an Example by Querying a Windows Box</a>, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2941782">Manual Driver Installation in 15 Steps</a>, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2942909">Troubleshooting Revisited</a></dt><dt>setdriver, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2939274">Caveats to be Considered</a>, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2939946">Run cupsaddsmb with Verbose Output</a>, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2940175">Understanding cupsaddsmb</a>, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2940875">Installing PostScript Driver Files Manually Using rpcclient</a>, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2941534">Requirements for adddriver and setdriver to Succeed</a>, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2941782">Manual Driver Installation in 15 Steps</a></dt></dl></dd><dt>rsync, <a href="compiling.html#id2973311">Accessing the Samba Sources via rsync and ftp</a></dt><dt>rundll32, <a href="AdvancedNetworkManagement.html#id2952929">Adding Printers without User Intervention</a></dt></dl></div><div class="indexdiv"><h3>S</h3><dl><dt>SAM, <a href="samba-pdc.html#id2870050">Features and Benefits</a>, <a href="samba-pdc.html#id2870336">Domain Controller Types</a>, <a href="domain-member.html#id2893185">Features and Benefits</a>, <a href="winbind.html#id2949998">Result Caching</a></dt><dt>SAM backend</dt><dd><dl><dt>LDAP, <a href="samba-bdc.html#id2891162">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt>ldapsam, <a href="samba-bdc.html#id2891162">Features and Benefits</a>, <a href="passdb.html#id2903592">Features and Benefits</a>, <a href="passdb.html#idmapbackend">Mapping Common UIDs/GIDs on Distributed Machines</a>, <a href="passdb.html#id2905605">ldapsam</a></dt><dt>ldapsam_compat, <a href="passdb.html#id2903592">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt>mysqlsam, <a href="passdb.html#id2903592">Features and Benefits</a>, <a href="passdb.html#id2907687">MySQL</a></dt><dt>non-LDAP, <a href="samba-bdc.html#id2891162">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt>smbpasswd, <a href="passdb.html#id2903592">Features and Benefits</a>, <a href="passdb.html#id2905425">smbpasswd Encrypted Password Database</a></dt><dt>tdbsam, <a href="samba-bdc.html#id2891162">Features and Benefits</a>, <a href="passdb.html#id2903592">Features and Benefits</a>, <a href="passdb.html#id2905552">tdbsam</a></dt><dt>xmlsam, <a href="passdb.html#id2903592">Features and Benefits</a>, <a href="passdb.html#idmapbackend">Mapping Common UIDs/GIDs on Distributed Machines</a>, <a href="passdb.html#XMLpassdb">XML</a></dt></dl></dd><dt>schannel, <a href="samba-pdc.html#id2890954">Cannot Log onto Domain Member Workstation After Joining Domain</a></dt><dt>secrets.tdb, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2943077">The Printing *.tdb Files</a></dt><dd><dl><dt>(see also TDB)</dt></dl></dd><dt>security, <a href="ServerType.html#id2886186">Samba Security Modes</a>, <a href="ServerType.html#id2886525">Domain Security Mode (User Level Security)</a>, <a href="ServerType.html#id2886928">Server Security (User Level Security)</a>, <a href="ServerType.html#id2887429">What Makes Samba a Server?</a>, <a href="ServerType.html#id2887468">What Makes Samba a Domain Controller?</a>, <a href="ServerType.html#id2887504">What Makes Samba a Domain Member?</a>, <a href="ServerType.html#id2887542">Constantly Losing Connections to Password Server</a>, <a href="samba-pdc.html#id2889080">Preparing for Domain Control</a>, <a href="samba-pdc.html#id2890439">Security Mode and Master Browsers</a>, <a href="domain-member.html#id2894418">Joining an NT4-type Domain with Samba-3</a>, <a href="domain-member.html#id2894926">Why Is This Better Than security = server?</a>, <a href="domain-member.html#id2895131">Configure smb.conf</a>, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2939801">Run cupsaddsmb (Quiet Mode)</a>, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2946839">cupsaddsmb Keeps Asking for Root Password in Never-ending Loop</a>, <a href="upgrading-to-3.0.html#id2965417">Passdb Backends and Authentication</a>, <a href="diagnosis.html#id2969546">The Tests</a>, <a href="Other-Clients.html#id2975641">Configuring Windows for Workgroups Password Handling</a></dt><dt>security mask, <a href="AccessControls.html#id2912779">File and Directory Permissions-Based Controls</a>, <a href="AccessControls.html#id2914698">Interaction with the Standard Samba create mask Parameters</a></dt><dt>Security Mode, <a href="ServerType.html#id2886186">Samba Security Modes</a></dt><dt>Server Manager, <a href="domain-member.html#machine-trust-accounts">MS Windows Workstation/Server Machine Trust Accounts</a>, <a href="domain-member.html#id2893524">Manual Creation of Machine Trust Accounts</a>, <a href="AdvancedNetworkManagement.html#id2952308">Remote Server Administration</a></dt><dt>Server Type, <a href="ServerType.html#id2886097">Server Types</a></dt><dd><dl><dt>Domain Member, <a href="ServerType.html#id2886566">Example Configuration</a>, <a href="samba-bdc.html#id2892538">Example Configuration</a>, <a href="domain-member.html#id2893185">Features and Benefits</a></dt></dl></dd><dt>sessionid.tdb, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2943077">The Printing *.tdb Files</a></dt><dd><dl><dt>(see also TDB)</dt></dl></dd><dt>share_info.tdb, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2943077">The Printing *.tdb Files</a></dt><dd><dl><dt>(see also TDB)</dt></dl></dd><dt>short preserve case, <a href="AccessControls.html#id2913187">Miscellaneous Controls</a>, <a href="ProfileMgmt.html#id2955066">Windows 9x/Me Profile Setup</a></dt><dt>Short-Cuts, <a href="AccessControls.html#id2911543">MS Windows NTFS Comparison with UNIX File Systems</a></dt><dt>show add printer wizard, <a href="printing.html#id2922033">The [global] Section</a>, <a href="printing.html#id2929151">Adding New Printers with the Windows NT APW</a></dt><dt>SID, <a href="samba-pdc.html#id2870050">Features and Benefits</a>, <a href="samba-pdc.html#id2890722">The System Cannot Log You On (C000019B)</a>, <a href="samba-bdc.html#id2892268">Backup Domain Controller Configuration</a>, <a href="passdb.html#passdbtech">Technical Information</a>, <a href="groupmapping.html#id2909181">Features and Benefits</a>, <a href="ProfileMgmt.html#id2956689">Side Bar Notes</a>, <a href="ProfileMgmt.html#id2956753">Get SID</a>, <a href="NT4Migration.html#id2966432">Profile Migration/Creation</a></dt><dt>signing, <a href="samba-pdc.html#id2890954">Cannot Log onto Domain Member Workstation After Joining Domain</a></dt><dt>simple configuration, <a href="install.html#id2876766">Example Configuration</a></dt><dt>Single Sign On, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2939274">Caveats to be Considered</a></dt><dt>slow browsing, <a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2903157">Browsing of Shares and Directories is Very Slow</a></dt><dt>smbclient, <a href="domain-member.html#ads-test-smbclient">Testing with smbclient</a>, <a href="diagnosis.html#id2969546">The Tests</a></dt><dt>smbgrpadd.sh, <a href="groupmapping.html#id2910581">Sample smb.conf Add Group Script</a></dt><dt>socket options, <a href="speed.html#id2976281">Socket Options</a></dt><dt>spooling</dt><dd><dl><dt>central, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2932110">Central Spooling vs. Peer-to-Peer Printing</a></dt><dt>peer-to-peer, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2932110">Central Spooling vs. Peer-to-Peer Printing</a></dt></dl></dd><dt>spooling-only, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2932163">Raw Print Serving Vendor Drivers on Windows Clients</a></dt><dt>SRVTOOLS.EXE, <a href="domain-member.html#id2893846">Managing Domain Machine Accounts using NT4 Server Manager</a>, <a href="AdvancedNetworkManagement.html#id2952308">Remote Server Administration</a></dt><dt>strict locking, <a href="locking.html#id2916001">Discussion</a></dt><dt>swat, <a href="install.html#id2885184">SWAT</a></dt><dd><dl><dt>enable, <a href="SWAT.html#xinetd">Enabling SWAT for Use</a></dt><dt>security, <a href="SWAT.html#id2968330">Securing SWAT through SSL</a></dt></dl></dd><dt>System Policy Editor, <a href="PolicyMgmt.html#id2953137">Creating and Managing System Policies</a>, <a href="PolicyMgmt.html#id2953643">Administration of Windows 200x/XP Policies</a></dt></dl></div><div class="indexdiv"><h3>T</h3><dl><dt>TDB, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2943077">The Printing *.tdb Files</a>, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2943322">Trivial Database Files</a></dt><dd><dl><dt>backing up (see tdbbackup)</dt></dl></dd><dt>tdbbackup, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2943528">Using tdbbackup</a></dt><dt>template homedir, <a href="winbind.html#id2951551">Linux/FreeBSD-specific PAM configuration</a></dt><dt>testparm, <a href="diagnosis.html#id2969546">The Tests</a></dt><dt>text/plain, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2934118">MIME Type Conversion Rules</a></dt><dt>total print jobs, <a href="printing.html#id2922033">The [global] Section</a></dt></dl></div><div class="indexdiv"><h3>U</h3><dl><dt>UDP, <a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2888109">NetBIOS over TCP/IP</a></dt><dt>UID, <a href="groupmapping.html#id2909181">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt>unexpected.tdb, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2943077">The Printing *.tdb Files</a></dt><dd><dl><dt>(see also TDB)</dt></dl></dd><dt>unix charset, <a href="unicode.html#id2963499">Samba and Charsets</a></dt><dt>UNIX charset, <a href="unicode.html#id2963643">Japanese Charsets</a></dt><dt>use client driver, <a href="printing.html#id2922033">The [global] Section</a></dt><dt>user, <a href="ServerType.html#id2886413">Share Level Security</a>, <a href="diagnosis.html#id2969546">The Tests</a></dt><dt>User Accounts</dt><dd><dl><dt>Adding/Deleting, <a href="passdb.html#id2904747">The smbpasswd Command</a>, <a href="passdb.html#pdbeditthing">The pdbedit Command</a>, <a href="passdb.html#id2906668">Accounts and Groups Management</a></dt></dl></dd><dt>User Management, <a href="passdb.html#id2904747">The smbpasswd Command</a>, <a href="passdb.html#pdbeditthing">The pdbedit Command</a>, <a href="passdb.html#id2906668">Accounts and Groups Management</a></dt><dt>User Manager, <a href="InterdomainTrusts.html#samba-trusted-domain">Samba as the Trusted Domain</a>, <a href="InterdomainTrusts.html#id2919809">Samba as the Trusting Domain</a>, <a href="AdvancedNetworkManagement.html#id2952308">Remote Server Administration</a></dt><dt>useradd, <a href="domain-member.html#id2893524">Manual Creation of Machine Trust Accounts</a></dt><dt>username, <a href="AccessControls.html#id2912329">User and Group-Based Controls</a></dt><dt>username level, <a href="ServerType.html#id2887204">Password Checking</a></dt><dt>username map, <a href="domain-member.html#id2894206">Windows 200x/XP Professional Client</a></dt><dt>users, <a href="securing-samba.html#id2918774">Why Can Users Access Home Directories of Other Users?</a></dt></dl></div><div class="indexdiv"><h3>V</h3><dl><dt>valid users, <a href="AccessControls.html#id2912329">User and Group-Based Controls</a>, <a href="diagnosis.html#id2969546">The Tests</a></dt><dt>veto files, <a href="AccessControls.html#id2913187">Miscellaneous Controls</a></dt><dt>vfs objects, <a href="VFS.html#id2948287">Discussion</a></dt><dt>vipw, <a href="domain-member.html#id2893524">Manual Creation of Machine Trust Accounts</a></dt></dl></div><div class="indexdiv"><h3>W</h3><dl><dt>WebClient, <a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2903157">Browsing of Shares and Directories is Very Slow</a></dt><dt>winbind separator, <a href="winbind.html#id2950807">Starting and Testing the winbindd Daemon</a></dt><dt>winbindd, <a href="samba-bdc.html#id2892538">Example Configuration</a></dt><dt>windows registry settings</dt><dd><dl><dt>default profile locations, <a href="ProfileMgmt.html#id2957150">MS Windows NT4 Workstation</a>, <a href="ProfileMgmt.html#id2957772">MS Windows 200x/XP</a></dt><dt>profile path, <a href="ProfileMgmt.html#id2955066">Windows 9x/Me Profile Setup</a></dt><dt>roaming profiles, <a href="ProfileMgmt.html#id2954850">Disabling Roaming Profile Support</a></dt></dl></dd><dt>WINS, <a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2887786">What Is Browsing?</a>, <a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2888109">NetBIOS over TCP/IP</a>, <a href="integrate-ms-networks.html#id2962910">WINS Lookup</a></dt><dt>wins hook, <a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2887786">What Is Browsing?</a></dt><dt>wins proxy, <a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2887786">What Is Browsing?</a></dt><dt>wins server, <a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2887786">What Is Browsing?</a>, <a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2901016">WINS The Windows Internetworking Name Server</a>, <a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2901208">WINS Server Configuration</a></dt><dt>wins support, <a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2887786">What Is Browsing?</a>, <a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2901016">WINS The Windows Internetworking Name Server</a>, <a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2901208">WINS Server Configuration</a></dt><dt>workgroup, <a href="samba-pdc.html#id2890439">Security Mode and Master Browsers</a>, <a href="domain-member.html#id2894418">Joining an NT4-type Domain with Samba-3</a>, <a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2901926">Browsing Support in Samba</a></dt><dt>write list, <a href="AccessControls.html#id2912329">User and Group-Based Controls</a>, <a href="printing.html#id2925021">[print$] Section Parameters</a></dt><dt>write raw, <a href="speed.html#id2976592">Write Raw</a></dt><dt>writeable, <a href="printing.html#ptrsect">The [printers] Section</a>, <a href="printing.html#id2923024">Any [my_printer_name] Section</a></dt><dt>WYSIWYG, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2932876">Windows Drivers, GDI and EMF</a></dt></dl></div><div class="indexdiv"><h3>X</h3><dl><dt>X Window System, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2932876">Windows Drivers, GDI and EMF</a>, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2933049">UNIX Printfile Conversion and GUI Basics</a></dt><dt>xinetd, <a href="compiling.html#id2974066">Starting from inetd.conf</a> (see inetd)</dt><dt>Xprint, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2932876">Windows Drivers, GDI and EMF</a>, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2933049">UNIX Printfile Conversion and GUI Basics</a></dt></dl></div></div></div><div class="navfooter"><hr><table width="100%" summary="Navigation footer"><tr><td width="40%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="Further-Resources.html">Prev</a> </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="u" href="index.html">Up</a></td><td width="40%" align="right"> </td></tr><tr><td width="40%" align="left" valign="top">Chapter 41. Further Resources </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="h" href="index.html">Home</a></td><td width="40%" align="right" valign="top"> </td></tr></table></div></body></html> diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/locking.html b/docs/htmldocs/locking.html new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..5210c015c0 --- /dev/null +++ b/docs/htmldocs/locking.html @@ -0,0 +1,635 @@ +<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>Chapter 14. File and Record Locking</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.60.1"><link rel="home" href="index.html" title="SAMBA Project Documentation"><link rel="up" href="optional.html" title="Part III. Advanced Configuration"><link rel="previous" href="AccessControls.html" title="Chapter 13. File, Directory and Share Access Controls"><link rel="next" href="securing-samba.html" title="Chapter 15. Securing Samba"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="navheader"><table width="100%" summary="Navigation header"><tr><th colspan="3" align="center">Chapter 14. File and Record Locking</th></tr><tr><td width="20%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="AccessControls.html">Prev</a> </td><th width="60%" align="center">Part III. Advanced Configuration</th><td width="20%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="securing-samba.html">Next</a></td></tr></table><hr></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="locking"></a>Chapter 14. File and Record Locking</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Jeremy</span> <span class="surname">Allison</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jra@samba.org">jra@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Jelmer</span> <span class="othername">R.</span> <span class="surname">Vernooij</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">The Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jelmer@samba.org">jelmer@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">John</span> <span class="othername">H.</span> <span class="surname">Terpstra</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org">jht@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Eric</span> <span class="surname">Roseme</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">HP Oplocks Usage Recommendations Whitepaper<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:eric.roseme@hp.com">eric.roseme@hp.com</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="locking.html#id2915945">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="locking.html#id2916001">Discussion</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="locking.html#id2916148">Opportunistic Locking Overview</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="locking.html#id2916856">Samba Opportunistic Locking Control</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="locking.html#id2916978">Example Configuration</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="locking.html#id2917407">MS Windows Opportunistic Locking and Caching Controls</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="locking.html#id2917632">Workstation Service Entries</a></dt><dt><a href="locking.html#id2917660">Server Service Entries</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="locking.html#id2917740">Persistent Data Corruption</a></dt><dt><a href="locking.html#id2917769">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="locking.html#id2917850">locking.tdb Error Messages</a></dt><dt><a href="locking.html#id2917884">Problems Saving Files in MS Office on Windows XP</a></dt><dt><a href="locking.html#id2917904">Long Delays Deleting Files Over Network with XP SP1</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="locking.html#id2917935">Additional Reading</a></dt></dl></div><p> +One area that causes trouble for many network administrators is locking. +The extent of the problem is readily evident from searches over the Internet. +</p><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2915945"></a>Features and Benefits</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +Samba provides all the same locking semantics that MS Windows clients expect +and that MS Windows NT4/200x servers also provide. +</p><p> +The term <span class="emphasis"><em>locking</em></span> has exceptionally broad meaning and covers +a range of functions that are all categorized under this one term. +</p><p> +Opportunistic locking is a desirable feature when it can enhance the +perceived performance of applications on a networked client. However, the +opportunistic locking protocol is not robust and, therefore, can +encounter problems when invoked beyond a simplistic configuration or +on extended slow or faulty networks. In these cases, operating +system management of opportunistic locking and/or recovering from +repetitive errors can offset the perceived performance advantage that +it is intended to provide. +</p><p> +The MS Windows network administrator needs to be aware that file and record +locking semantics (behavior) can be controlled either in Samba or by way of registry +settings on the MS Windows client. +</p><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p> +Sometimes it is necessary to disable locking control settings on both the Samba +server as well as on each MS Windows client! +</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2916001"></a>Discussion</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +There are two types of locking that need to be performed by an SMB server. +The first is <span class="emphasis"><em>record locking</em></span> that allows a client to lock +a range of bytes in a open file. The second is the <span class="emphasis"><em>deny modes</em></span> +that are specified when a file is open. +</p><p> +Record locking semantics under UNIX are very different from record locking under +Windows. Versions of Samba before 2.2 have tried to use the native fcntl() UNIX +system call to implement proper record locking between different Samba clients. +This cannot be fully correct for several reasons. The simplest is the fact +that a Windows client is allowed to lock a byte range up to 2^32 or 2^64, +depending on the client OS. The UNIX locking only supports byte ranges up to 2^31. +So it is not possible to correctly satisfy a lock request above 2^31. There are +many more differences, too many to be listed here. +</p><p> +Samba 2.2 and above implements record locking completely independent of the +underlying UNIX system. If a byte range lock that the client requests happens +to fall into the range of 0-2^31, Samba hands this request down to the UNIX system. +All other locks cannot be seen by UNIX, anyway. +</p><p> +Strictly speaking, an SMB server should check for locks before every read and write call on +a file. Unfortunately with the way fcntl() works, this can be slow and may overstress +the <b class="command">rpc.lockd</b>. This is almost always unnecessary as clients are supposed to +independently make locking calls before reads and writes if locking is +important to them. By default, Samba only makes locking calls when explicitly asked +to by a client, but if you set <a class="indexterm" name="id2916068"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>strict locking</tt></i> = yes, it +will make lock checking calls on <span class="emphasis"><em>every</em></span> read and write call. +</p><p> +You can also disable byte range locking completely by using +<a class="indexterm" name="id2916093"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>locking</tt></i> = no. +This is useful for those shares that do not support locking or do not need it +(such as CDROMs). In this case, Samba fakes the return codes of locking calls to +tell clients that everything is okay. +</p><p> +The second class of locking is the <span class="emphasis"><em>deny modes</em></span>. These +are set by an application when it opens a file to determine what types of +access should be allowed simultaneously with its open. A client may ask for +<tt class="constant">DENY_NONE</tt>, <tt class="constant">DENY_READ</tt>, +<tt class="constant">DENY_WRITE</tt>, or <tt class="constant">DENY_ALL</tt>. There are also special compatibility +modes called <tt class="constant">DENY_FCB</tt> and <tt class="constant">DENY_DOS</tt>. +</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2916148"></a>Opportunistic Locking Overview</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +Opportunistic locking (Oplocks) is invoked by the Windows file system +(as opposed to an API) via registry entries (on the server and the client) +for the purpose of enhancing network performance when accessing a file +residing on a server. Performance is enhanced by caching the file +locally on the client that allows: +</p><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">Read-ahead:</span></dt><dd><p> + The client reads the local copy of the file, eliminating network latency. + </p></dd><dt><span class="term">Write caching:</span></dt><dd><p> + The client writes to the local copy of the file, eliminating network latency. + </p></dd><dt><span class="term">Lock caching:</span></dt><dd><p> + The client caches application locks locally, eliminating network latency. + </p></dd></dl></div><p> +The performance enhancement of oplocks is due to the opportunity of +exclusive access to the file even if it is opened with deny-none +because Windows monitors the file's status for concurrent access from +other processes. +</p><div class="variablelist"><p class="title"><b>Windows defines 4 kinds of Oplocks:</b></p><dl><dt><span class="term">Level1 Oplock</span></dt><dd><p> + The redirector sees that the file was opened with deny + none (allowing concurrent access), verifies that no + other process is accessing the file, checks that + oplocks are enabled, then grants deny-all/read-write/exclusive + access to the file. The client now performs + operations on the cached local file. + </p><p> + If a second process attempts to open the file, the open + is deferred while the redirector “<span class="quote">breaks</span>” the original + oplock. The oplock break signals the caching client to + write the local file back to the server, flush the + local locks and discard read-ahead data. The break is + then complete, the deferred open is granted, and the + multiple processes can enjoy concurrent file access as + dictated by mandatory or byte-range locking options. + However, if the original opening process opened the + file with a share mode other than deny-none, then the + second process is granted limited or no access, despite + the oplock break. + </p></dd><dt><span class="term">Level2 Oplock</span></dt><dd><p> + Performs like a Level1 oplock, except caching is only + operative for reads. All other operations are performed + on the server disk copy of the file. + </p></dd><dt><span class="term">Filter Oplock</span></dt><dd><p> + Does not allow write or delete file access. + </p></dd><dt><span class="term">Batch Oplock</span></dt><dd><p> + Manipulates file openings and closings and allows caching + of file attributes. + </p></dd></dl></div><p> +An important detail is that oplocks are invoked by the file system, not +an application API. Therefore, an application can close an oplocked +file, but the file system does not relinquish the oplock. When the +oplock break is issued, the file system then simply closes the file in +preparation for the subsequent open by the second process. +</p><p> +<span class="emphasis"><em>Opportunistic locking</em></span> is actually an improper name for this feature. +The true benefit of this feature is client-side data caching, and +oplocks is merely a notification mechanism for writing data back to the +networked storage disk. The limitation of opportunistic locking is the +reliability of the mechanism to process an oplock break (notification) +between the server and the caching client. If this exchange is faulty +(usually due to timing out for any number of reasons), then the +client-side caching benefit is negated. +</p><p> +The actual decision that a user or administrator should consider is +whether it is sensible to share among multiple users data that will +be cached locally on a client. In many cases the answer is no. +Deciding when to cache or not cache data is the real question, and thus +“<span class="quote">opportunistic locking</span>” should be treated as a toggle for client-side +caching. Turn it “<span class="quote">on</span>” when client-side caching is desirable and +reliable. Turn it “<span class="quote">off</span>” when client-side caching is redundant, +unreliable or counter-productive. +</p><p> +Opportunistic locking is by default set to “<span class="quote">on</span>” by Samba on all +configured shares, so careful attention should be given to each case to +determine if the potential benefit is worth the potential for delays. +The following recommendations will help to characterize the environment +where opportunistic locking may be effectively configured. +</p><p> +Windows opportunistic locking is a lightweight performance-enhancing +feature. It is not a robust and reliable protocol. Every +implementation of opportunistic locking should be evaluated as a +tradeoff between perceived performance and reliability. Reliability +decreases as each successive rule above is not enforced. Consider a +share with oplocks enabled, over a wide area network, to a client on a +South Pacific atoll, on a high-availability server, serving a +mission-critical multi-user corporate database during a tropical +storm. This configuration will likely encounter problems with oplocks. +</p><p> +Oplocks can be beneficial to perceived client performance when treated +as a configuration toggle for client-side data caching. If the data +caching is likely to be interrupted, then oplock usage should be +reviewed. Samba enables opportunistic locking by default on all +shares. Careful attention should be given to the client usage of +shared data on the server, the server network reliability and the +opportunistic locking configuration of each share. +In mission critical high availability environments, data integrity is +often a priority. Complex and expensive configurations are implemented +to ensure that if a client loses connectivity with a file server, a +failover replacement will be available immediately to provide +continuous data availability. +</p><p> +Windows client failover behavior is more at risk of application +interruption than other platforms because it is dependent upon an +established TCP transport connection. If the connection is interrupted + as in a file server failover a new session must be established. +It is rare for Windows client applications to be coded to recover +correctly from a transport connection loss, therefore, most applications +will experience some sort of interruption at worst, abort and +require restarting. +</p><p> +If a client session has been caching writes and reads locally due to +opportunistic locking, it is likely that the data will be lost when the +application restarts or recovers from the TCP interrupt. When the TCP +connection drops, the client state is lost. When the file server +recovers, an oplock break is not sent to the client. In this case, the +work from the prior session is lost. Observing this scenario with +oplocks disabled and with the client writing data to the file server +real-time, the failover will provide the data on disk as it +existed at the time of the disconnect. +</p><p> +In mission-critical high-availability environments, careful attention +should be given to opportunistic locking. Ideally, comprehensive +testing should be done with all affected applications with oplocks +enabled and disabled. +</p><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2916474"></a>Exclusively Accessed Shares</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> +Opportunistic locking is most effective when it is confined to shares +that are exclusively accessed by a single user, or by only one user at +a time. Because the true value of opportunistic locking is the local +client caching of data, any operation that interrupts the caching +mechanism will cause a delay. +</p><p> +Home directories are the most obvious examples of where the performance +benefit of opportunistic locking can be safely realized. +</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2916498"></a>Multiple-Accessed Shares or Files</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> +As each additional user accesses a file in a share with opportunistic +locking enabled, the potential for delays and resulting perceived poor +performance increases. When multiple users are accessing a file on a +share that has oplocks enabled, the management impact of sending and +receiving oplock breaks and the resulting latency while other clients +wait for the caching client to flush data offset the performance gains +of the caching user. +</p><p> +As each additional client attempts to access a file with oplocks set, +the potential performance improvement is negated and eventually results +in a performance bottleneck. +</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2916527"></a>UNIX or NFS Client-Accessed Files</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> +Local UNIX and NFS clients access files without a mandatory +file-locking mechanism. Thus, these client platforms are incapable of +initiating an oplock break request from the server to a Windows client +that has a file cached. Local UNIX or NFS file access can therefore +write to a file that has been cached by a Windows client, which +exposes the file to likely data corruption. +</p><p> +If files are shared between Windows clients, and either local UNIX +or NFS users, turn opportunistic locking off. +</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2916553"></a>Slow and/or Unreliable Networks</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> +The biggest potential performance improvement for opportunistic locking +occurs when the client-side caching of reads and writes delivers the +most differential over sending those reads and writes over the wire. +This is most likely to occur when the network is extremely slow, +congested, or distributed (as in a WAN). However, network latency also +has a high impact on the reliability of the oplock break +mechanism, and thus increases the likelihood of encountering oplock +problems that more than offset the potential perceived performance +gain. Of course, if an oplock break never has to be sent, then this is +the most advantageous scenario to utilize opportunistic locking. +</p><p> +If the network is slow, unreliable, or a WAN, then do not configure +opportunistic locking if there is any chance of multiple users +regularly opening the same file. +</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2916586"></a>Multi-User Databases</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> +Multi-user databases clearly pose a risk due to their very nature +they are typically heavily accessed by numerous users at random +intervals. Placing a multi-user database on a share with opportunistic +locking enabled will likely result in a locking management bottleneck +on the Samba server. Whether the database application is developed +in-house or a commercially available product, ensure that the share +has opportunistic locking disabled. +</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2916611"></a>PDM Data Shares</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> +Process Data Management (PDM) applications such as IMAN, Enovia and +Clearcase are increasing in usage with Windows client platforms, and +therefore SMB datastores. PDM applications manage multi-user +environments for critical data security and access. The typical PDM +environment is usually associated with sophisticated client design +applications that will load data locally as demanded. In addition, the +PDM application will usually monitor the data-state of each client. +In this case, client-side data caching is best left to the local +application and PDM server to negotiate and maintain. It is +appropriate to eliminate the client OS from any caching tasks, and the +server from any oplock management, by disabling opportunistic locking on +the share. +</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2916637"></a>Beware of Force User</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> +Samba includes an <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> parameter called <a class="indexterm" name="id2916656"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>force user</tt></i> that changes +the user accessing a share from the incoming user to whatever user is +defined by the smb.conf variable. If opportunistic locking is enabled +on a share, the change in user access causes an oplock break to be sent +to the client, even if the user has not explicitly loaded a file. In +cases where the network is slow or unreliable, an oplock break can +become lost without the user even accessing a file. This can cause +apparent performance degradation as the client continually reconnects +to overcome the lost oplock break. +</p><p> +Avoid the combination of the following: +</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p> + <a class="indexterm" name="id2916692"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>force user</tt></i> in the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> share configuration. + </p></li><li><p> + Slow or unreliable networks + </p></li><li><p> + Opportunistic locking enabled + </p></li></ul></div></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2916729"></a>Advanced Samba Opportunistic Locking Parameters</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> +Samba provides opportunistic locking parameters that allow the +administrator to adjust various properties of the oplock mechanism to +account for timing and usage levels. These parameters provide good +versatility for implementing oplocks in environments where they would +likely cause problems. The parameters are: +<a class="indexterm" name="id2916746"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>oplock break wait time</tt></i>, +<a class="indexterm" name="id2916760"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>oplock contention limit</tt></i>. +</p><p> +For most users, administrators and environments, if these parameters +are required, then the better option is to simply turn oplocks off. +The Samba SWAT help text for both parameters reads: “<span class="quote">Do not change +this parameter unless you have read and understood the Samba oplock code.</span>” +This is good advice. +</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2916790"></a>Mission-Critical High-Availability</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> +In mission-critical high-availability environments, data integrity is +often a priority. Complex and expensive configurations are implemented +to ensure that if a client loses connectivity with a file server, a +failover replacement will be available immediately to provide +continuous data availability. +</p><p> +Windows client failover behavior is more at risk of application +interruption than other platforms because it is dependant upon an +established TCP transport connection. If the connection is interrupted + as in a file server failover a new session must be established. +It is rare for Windows client applications to be coded to recover +correctly from a transport connection loss, therefore, most applications +will experience some sort of interruption at worst, abort and +require restarting. +</p><p> +If a client session has been caching writes and reads locally due to +opportunistic locking, it is likely that the data will be lost when the +application restarts, or recovers from the TCP interrupt. When the TCP +connection drops, the client state is lost. When the file server +recovers, an oplock break is not sent to the client. In this case, the +work from the prior session is lost. Observing this scenario with +oplocks disabled, and the client was writing data to the file server +real-time, then the failover will provide the data on disk as it +existed at the time of the disconnect. +</p><p> +In mission-critical high-availability environments, careful attention +should be given to opportunistic locking. Ideally, comprehensive +testing should be done with all effected applications with oplocks +enabled and disabled. +</p></div></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2916856"></a>Samba Opportunistic Locking Control</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +Opportunistic locking is a unique Windows file locking feature. It is +not really file locking, but is included in most discussions of Windows +file locking, so is considered a de facto locking feature. +Opportunistic locking is actually part of the Windows client file +caching mechanism. It is not a particularly robust or reliable feature +when implemented on the variety of customized networks that exist in +enterprise computing. +</p><p> +Like Windows, Samba implements opportunistic locking as a server-side +component of the client caching mechanism. Because of the lightweight +nature of the Windows feature design, effective configuration of +opportunistic locking requires a good understanding of its limitations, +and then applying that understanding when configuring data access for +each particular customized network and client usage state. +</p><p> +Opportunistic locking essentially means that the client is allowed to download and cache +a file on their hard drive while making changes; if a second client wants to access the +file, the first client receives a break and must synchronize the file back to the server. +This can give significant performance gains in some cases; some programs insist on +synchronizing the contents of the entire file back to the server for a single change. +</p><p> +Level1 Oplocks (also known as just plain “<span class="quote">oplocks</span>”) is another term for opportunistic locking. +</p><p> +Level2 Oplocks provides opportunistic locking for a file that will be treated as +<span class="emphasis"><em>read only</em></span>. Typically this is used on files that are read-only or +on files that the client has no initial intention to write to at time of opening the file. +</p><p> +Kernel Oplocks are essentially a method that allows the Linux kernel to co-exist with +Samba's oplocked files, although this has provided better integration of MS Windows network +file locking with the underlying OS, SGI IRIX and Linux are the only two OSs that are +oplock-aware at this time. +</p><p> +Unless your system supports kernel oplocks, you should disable oplocks if you are +accessing the same files from both UNIX/Linux and SMB clients. Regardless, oplocks should +always be disabled if you are sharing a database file (e.g., Microsoft Access) between +multiple clients, as any break the first client receives will affect synchronization of +the entire file (not just the single record), which will result in a noticeable performance +impairment and, more likely, problems accessing the database in the first place. Notably, +Microsoft Outlook's personal folders (*.pst) react quite badly to oplocks. If in doubt, +disable oplocks and tune your system from that point. +</p><p> +If client-side caching is desirable and reliable on your network, you will benefit from +turning on oplocks. If your network is slow and/or unreliable, or you are sharing your +files among other file sharing mechanisms (e.g., NFS) or across a WAN, or multiple people +will be accessing the same files frequently, you probably will not benefit from the overhead +of your client sending oplock breaks and will instead want to disable oplocks for the share. +</p><p> +Another factor to consider is the perceived performance of file access. If oplocks provide no +measurable speed benefit on your network, it might not be worth the hassle of dealing with them. +</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2916978"></a>Example Configuration</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +In the following section we examine two distinct aspects of Samba locking controls. +</p><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2916991"></a>Disabling Oplocks</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> +You can disable oplocks on a per-share basis with the following: +</p><p> +</p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td> </td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>[acctdata]</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>oplocks = False</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>level2 oplocks = False</tt></i></td></tr></table><p> +</p><p> +The default oplock type is Level1. Level2 oplocks are enabled on a per-share basis +in the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file. +</p><p> +Alternately, you could disable oplocks on a per-file basis within the share: +</p><p> + </p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>veto oplock files = /*.mdb/*.MDB/*.dbf/*.DBF/</tt></i></td></tr></table><p> +</p><p> +If you are experiencing problems with oplocks as apparent from Samba's log entries, +you may want to play it safe and disable oplocks and Level2 oplocks. +</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2917088"></a>Disabling Kernel Oplocks</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> +Kernel oplocks is an <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> parameter that notifies Samba (if +the UNIX kernel has the capability to send a Windows client an oplock +break) when a UNIX process is attempting to open the file that is +cached. This parameter addresses sharing files between UNIX and +Windows with oplocks enabled on the Samba server: the UNIX process +can open the file that is Oplocked (cached) by the Windows client and +the smbd process will not send an oplock break, which exposes the file +to the risk of data corruption. If the UNIX kernel has the ability to +send an oplock break, then the kernel oplocks parameter enables Samba +to send the oplock break. Kernel oplocks are enabled on a per-server +basis in the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file. +</p><p> +</p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>kernel oplocks = yes</tt></i></td></tr></table><p> +The default is no. +</p><p> +Veto opLocks is an <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> parameter that identifies specific files for +which oplocks are disabled. When a Windows client opens a file that +has been configured for veto oplocks, the client will not be granted +the oplock, and all operations will be executed on the original file on +disk instead of a client-cached file copy. By explicitly identifying +files that are shared with UNIX processes and disabling oplocks for +those files, the server-wide Oplock configuration can be enabled to +allow Windows clients to utilize the performance benefit of file +caching without the risk of data corruption. Veto Oplocks can be +enabled on a per-share basis, or globally for the entire server, in the +<tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file as shown in <link linkend="far1">. +</p><p> +</p><div class="example"><a name="far1"></a><p class="title"><b>Example 14.1. Share with some files oplocked</b></p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td> </td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>[global]</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>veto oplock files = /filename.htm/*.txt/</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td> </td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>[share_name]</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>veto oplock files = /*.exe/filename.ext/</tt></i></td></tr></table></div><p> +</p><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2917246"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>oplock break wait time</tt></i> is an <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> parameter +that adjusts the time interval for Samba to reply to an oplock break request. Samba recommends: +“<span class="quote">Do not change this parameter unless you have read and understood the Samba oplock code.</span>” +Oplock break Wait Time can only be configured globally in the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file as shown below. +</p><p> + </p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>oplock break wait time = 0 (default)</tt></i></td></tr></table><p> +</p><p> +<span class="emphasis"><em>Oplock break contention limit</em></span> is an <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> parameter that limits the +response of the Samba server to grant an oplock if the configured +number of contending clients reaches the limit specified by the parameter. Samba recommends +“<span class="quote">Do not change this parameter unless you have read and understood the Samba oplock code.</span>” +Oplock break Contention Limit can be enable on a per-share basis, or globally for +the entire server, in the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file as shown in <link linkend="far3">. +</p><p> +</p><div class="example"><a name="far3"></a><p class="title"><b>Example 14.2. Configuration with oplock break contention limit</b></p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td> </td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>[global]</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>oplock break contention limit = 2 (default)</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td> </td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>[share_name]</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>oplock break contention limit = 2 (default)</tt></i></td></tr></table></div><p> +</p></div></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2917407"></a>MS Windows Opportunistic Locking and Caching Controls</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +There is a known issue when running applications (like Norton Anti-Virus) on a Windows 2000/ XP +workstation computer that can affect any application attempting to access shared database files +across a network. This is a result of a default setting configured in the Windows 2000/XP +operating system known as <span class="emphasis"><em>opportunistic locking</em></span>. When a workstation +attempts to access shared data files located on another Windows 2000/XP computer, +the Windows 2000/XP operating system will attempt to increase performance by locking the +files and caching information locally. When this occurs, the application is unable to +properly function, which results in an “<span class="quote">Access Denied</span>” + error message being displayed during network operations. +</p><p> +All Windows operating systems in the NT family that act as database servers for data files +(meaning that data files are stored there and accessed by other Windows PCs) may need to +have opportunistic locking disabled in order to minimize the risk of data file corruption. +This includes Windows 9x/Me, Windows NT, Windows 200x, and Windows XP. +</p><p> +If you are using a Windows NT family workstation in place of a server, you must also +disable opportunistic locking (oplocks) on that workstation. For example, if you use a +PC with the Windows NT Workstation operating system instead of Windows NT Server, and you +have data files located on it that are accessed from other Windows PCs, you may need to +disable oplocks on that system. +</p><p> +The major difference is the location in the Windows registry where the values for disabling +oplocks are entered. Instead of the LanManServer location, the LanManWorkstation location +may be used. +</p><p> +You can verify (change or add, if necessary) this registry value using the Windows +Registry Editor. When you change this registry value, you will have to reboot the PC +to ensure that the new setting goes into effect. +</p><p> +The location of the client registry entry for opportunistic locking has changed in +Windows 2000 from the earlier location in Microsoft Windows NT. +</p><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p> +Windows 2000 will still respect the EnableOplocks registry value used to disable oplocks +in earlier versions of Windows. +</p></div><p> +You can also deny the granting of opportunistic locks by changing the following registry entries: +</p><p> +</p><pre class="programlisting"> + HKEY_LOCAL_MACHINE\System\ + CurrentControlSet\Services\MRXSmb\Parameters\ + + OplocksDisabled REG_DWORD 0 or 1 + Default: 0 (not disabled) +</pre><p> +</p><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p> +The OplocksDisabled registry value configures Windows clients to either request or not +request opportunistic locks on a remote file. To disable oplocks, the value of + OplocksDisabled must be set to 1. +</p></div><p> +</p><pre class="programlisting"> + HKEY_LOCAL_MACHINE\System\ + CurrentControlSet\Services\LanmanServer\Parameters + + EnableOplocks REG_DWORD 0 or 1 + Default: 1 (Enabled by Default) + + EnableOpLockForceClose REG_DWORD 0 or 1 + Default: 0 (Disabled by Default) +</pre><p> +</p><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p> +The EnableOplocks value configures Windows-based servers (including Workstations sharing +files) to allow or deny opportunistic locks on local files. +</p></div><p> +To force closure of open oplocks on close or program exit, EnableOpLockForceClose must be set to 1. +</p><p> +An illustration of how Level2 oplocks work: +</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p> + Station 1 opens the file requesting oplock. + </p></li><li><p> + Since no other station has the file open, the server grants station 1 exclusive oplock. + </p></li><li><p> + Station 2 opens the file requesting oplock. + </p></li><li><p> + Since station 1 has not yet written to the file, the server asks station 1 to break + to Level2 oplock. + </p></li><li><p> + Station 1 complies by flushing locally buffered lock information to the server. + </p></li><li><p> + Station 1 informs the server that it has Broken to Level2 Oplock (alternately, + station 1 could have closed the file). + </p></li><li><p> + The server responds to station 2's open request, granting it Level2 oplock. + Other stations can likewise open the file and obtain Level2 oplock. + </p></li><li><p> + Station 2 (or any station that has the file open) sends a write request SMB. + The server returns the write response. + </p></li><li><p> + The server asks all stations that have the file open to break to none, meaning no + station holds any oplock on the file. Because the workstations can have no cached + writes or locks at this point, they need not respond to the break-to-none advisory; + all they need do is invalidate locally cashed read-ahead data. + </p></li></ul></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2917632"></a>Workstation Service Entries</h3></div></div><div></div></div><pre class="programlisting"> + \HKEY_LOCAL_MACHINE\System\ + CurrentControlSet\Services\LanmanWorkstation\Parameters + + UseOpportunisticLocking REG_DWORD 0 or 1 + Default: 1 (true) +</pre><p> +This indicates whether the redirector should use opportunistic-locking (oplock) performance +enhancement. This parameter should be disabled only to isolate problems. +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2917660"></a>Server Service Entries</h3></div></div><div></div></div><pre class="programlisting"> + \HKEY_LOCAL_MACHINE\System\ + CurrentControlSet\Services\LanmanServer\Parameters + + EnableOplocks REG_DWORD 0 or 1 + Default: 1 (true) +</pre><p> +This specifies whether the server allows clients to use oplocks on files. Oplocks are a +significant performance enhancement, but have the potential to cause lost cached +data on some networks, particularly wide area networks. +</p><pre class="programlisting"> + MinLinkThroughput REG_DWORD 0 to infinite bytes per second + Default: 0 +</pre><p> +This specifies the minimum link throughput allowed by the server before it disables +raw and opportunistic locks for this connection. +</p><pre class="programlisting"> + MaxLinkDelay REG_DWORD 0 to 100,000 seconds + Default: 60 +</pre><p> +This specifies the maximum time allowed for a link delay. If delays exceed this number, +the server disables raw I/O and opportunistic locking for this connection. +</p><pre class="programlisting"> + OplockBreakWait REG_DWORD 10 to 180 seconds + Default: 35 +</pre><p> +This specifies the time that the server waits for a client to respond to an oplock break +request. Smaller values can allow detection of crashed clients more quickly but can +potentially cause loss of cached data. +</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2917740"></a>Persistent Data Corruption</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +If you have applied all of the settings discussed in this chapter but data corruption problems +and other symptoms persist, here are some additional things to check out. +</p><p> +We have credible reports from developers that faulty network hardware, such as a single +faulty network card, can cause symptoms similar to read caching and data corruption. +If you see persistent data corruption even after repeated reindexing, you may have to +rebuild the data files in question. This involves creating a new data file with the +same definition as the file to be rebuilt and transferring the data from the old file +to the new one. There are several known methods for doing this that can be found in +our Knowledge Base. +</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2917769"></a>Common Errors</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +In some sites, locking problems surface as soon as a server is installed; in other sites +locking problems may not surface for a long time. Almost without exception, when a locking +problem does surface it will cause embarrassment and potential data corruption. +</p><p> +Over the past few years there have been a number of complaints on the Samba mailing lists +that have claimed that Samba caused data corruption. Three causes have been identified +so far: +</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p> + Incorrect configuration of opportunistic locking (incompatible with the application + being used. This is a common problem even where MS Windows NT4 or MS Windows + 200x-based servers were in use. It is imperative that the software application vendors' + instructions for configuration of file locking should be followed. If in doubt, + disable oplocks on both the server and the client. Disabling of all forms of file + caching on the MS Windows client may be necessary also. + </p></li><li><p> + Defective network cards, cables, or HUBs/Switched. This is generally a more + prevalent factor with low cost networking hardware, although occasionally there + have also been problems with incompatibilities in more up-market hardware. + </p></li><li><p> + There have been some random reports of Samba log files being written over data + files. This has been reported by very few sites (about five in the past three years) + and all attempts to reproduce the problem have failed. The Samba Team has been + unable to catch this happening and thus has not been able to isolate any particular + cause. Considering the millions of systems that use Samba, for the sites that have + been affected by this as well as for the Samba Team this is a frustrating and + a vexing challenge. If you see this type of thing happening, please create a bug + report on Samba <ulink url="https://bugzilla.samba.org">Bugzilla</ulink> without delay. + Make sure that you give as much information as you possibly can help isolate the + cause and to allow replication of the problem (an essential step in problem isolation and correction). + </p></li></ul></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2917850"></a>locking.tdb Error Messages</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + “<span class="quote"> + We are seeing lots of errors in the Samba logs, like: +<pre class="programlisting"> +tdb(/usr/local/samba_2.2.7/var/locks/locking.tdb): rec_read bad magic + 0x4d6f4b61 at offset=36116 +</pre> + + What do these mean? + </span>” + </p><p> + This error indicated a corrupted tdb. Stop all instances of smbd, delete locking.tdb, and restart smbd. + </p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2917884"></a>Problems Saving Files in MS Office on Windows XP</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>This is a bug in Windows XP. More information can be + found in <ulink url="http://support.microsoft.com/?id=812937">Microsoft Knowledge Base article 812937.</ulink></p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2917904"></a>Long Delays Deleting Files Over Network with XP SP1</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>“<span class="quote">It sometimes takes approximately 35 seconds to delete files over the network after XP SP1 has been applied.</span>”</p><p>This is a bug in Windows XP. More information can be found in <ulink url="http://support.microsoft.com/?id=811492"> + Microsoft Knowledge Base article 811492.</ulink></p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2917935"></a>Additional Reading</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +You may want to check for an updated version of this white paper on our Web site from +time to time. Many of our white papers are updated as information changes. For those papers, +the last edited date is always at the top of the paper. +</p><p> +Section of the Microsoft MSDN Library on opportunistic locking: +</p><p> +Opportunistic Locks, Microsoft Developer Network (MSDN), Windows Development > +Windows Base Services > Files and I/O > SDK Documentation > File Storage > File Systems +> About File Systems > Opportunistic Locks, Microsoft Corporation. +<ulink url="http://msdn.microsoft.com/library/en-us/fileio/storage_5yk3.asp">http://msdn.microsoft.com/library/en-us/fileio/storage_5yk3.asp</ulink> +</p><p> + Microsoft Knowledge Base Article Q224992 “<span class="quote">Maintaining Transactional Integrity +with OPLOCKS</span>”, +Microsoft Corporation, April 1999, <ulink url="http://support.microsoft.com/default.aspx?scid=kb;en-us;Q224992">http://support.microsoft.com/default.aspx?scid=kb;en-us;Q224992</ulink>. +</p><p> +Microsoft Knowledge Base Article Q296264 “<span class="quote">Configuring Opportunistic Locking in Windows 2000</span>”, +Microsoft Corporation, April 2001, <ulink url="http://support.microsoft.com/default.aspx?scid=kb;en-us;Q296264">http://support.microsoft.com/default.aspx?scid=kb;en-us;Q296264</ulink>. +</p><p> +Microsoft Knowledge Base Article Q129202 “<span class="quote">PC Ext: Explanation of Opportunistic Locking on Windows NT</span>”, +Microsoft Corporation, April 1995, <ulink url="http://support.microsoft.com/default.aspx?scid=kb;en-us;Q129202">http://support.microsoft.com/default.aspx?scid=kb;en-us;Q129202</ulink>. +</p></div></div><div class="navfooter"><hr><table width="100%" summary="Navigation footer"><tr><td width="40%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="AccessControls.html">Prev</a> </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="u" href="optional.html">Up</a></td><td width="40%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="securing-samba.html">Next</a></td></tr><tr><td width="40%" align="left" valign="top">Chapter 13. File, Directory and Share Access Controls </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="h" href="index.html">Home</a></td><td width="40%" align="right" valign="top"> Chapter 15. Securing Samba</td></tr></table></div></body></html> diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/migration.html b/docs/htmldocs/migration.html new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..27a4e01348 --- /dev/null +++ b/docs/htmldocs/migration.html @@ -0,0 +1 @@ +<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>Part IV. Migration and Updating</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.60.1"><link rel="home" href="index.html" title="SAMBA Project Documentation"><link rel="up" href="index.html" title="SAMBA Project Documentation"><link rel="previous" href="SambaHA.html" title="Chapter 29. High Availability Options"><link rel="next" href="upgrading-to-3.0.html" title="Chapter 30. Upgrading from Samba-2.x to Samba-3.0.0"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="navheader"><table width="100%" summary="Navigation header"><tr><th colspan="3" align="center">Part IV. Migration and Updating</th></tr><tr><td width="20%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="SambaHA.html">Prev</a> </td><th width="60%" align="center"> </th><td width="20%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="upgrading-to-3.0.html">Next</a></td></tr></table><hr></div><div class="part" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h1 class="title"><a name="migration"></a>Migration and Updating</h1></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt>30. <a href="upgrading-to-3.0.html">Upgrading from Samba-2.x to Samba-3.0.0</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="upgrading-to-3.0.html#id2964134">Quick Migration Guide</a></dt><dt><a href="upgrading-to-3.0.html#id2964257">New Features in Samba-3</a></dt><dt><a href="upgrading-to-3.0.html#id2964410">Configuration Parameter Changes</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="upgrading-to-3.0.html#id2964433">Removed Parameters</a></dt><dt><a href="upgrading-to-3.0.html#id2964564">New Parameters</a></dt><dt><a href="upgrading-to-3.0.html#id2964983">Modified Parameters (Changes in Behavior):</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="upgrading-to-3.0.html#id2965064">New Functionality</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="upgrading-to-3.0.html#id2965071">Databases</a></dt><dt><a href="upgrading-to-3.0.html#id2965324">Changes in Behavior</a></dt><dt><a href="upgrading-to-3.0.html#id2965395">Charsets</a></dt><dt><a href="upgrading-to-3.0.html#id2965417">Passdb Backends and Authentication</a></dt><dt><a href="upgrading-to-3.0.html#id2965577">LDAP</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>31. <a href="NT4Migration.html">Migration from NT4 PDC to Samba-3 PDC</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="NT4Migration.html#id2966015">Planning and Getting Started</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="NT4Migration.html#id2966040">Objectives</a></dt><dt><a href="NT4Migration.html#id2966502">Steps in Migration Process</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="NT4Migration.html#id2966757">Migration Options</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="NT4Migration.html#id2966862">Planning for Success</a></dt><dt><a href="NT4Migration.html#id2967145">Samba-3 Implementation Choices</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>32. <a href="SWAT.html">SWAT The Samba Web Administration Tool</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="SWAT.html#id2967624">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="SWAT.html#id2967718">Guidelines and Technical Tips</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="SWAT.html#id2967733">Validate SWAT Installation</a></dt><dt><a href="SWAT.html#xinetd">Enabling SWAT for Use</a></dt><dt><a href="SWAT.html#id2968330">Securing SWAT through SSL</a></dt><dt><a href="SWAT.html#id2968458">Enabling SWAT Internationalization Support</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="SWAT.html#id2968628">Overview and Quick Tour</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="SWAT.html#id2968644">The SWAT Home Page</a></dt><dt><a href="SWAT.html#id2968718">Global Settings</a></dt><dt><a href="SWAT.html#id2968838">Share Settings</a></dt><dt><a href="SWAT.html#id2968902">Printers Settings</a></dt><dt><a href="SWAT.html#id2968967">The SWAT Wizard</a></dt><dt><a href="SWAT.html#id2969040">The Status Page</a></dt><dt><a href="SWAT.html#id2969092">The View Page</a></dt><dt><a href="SWAT.html#id2969115">The Password Change Page</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd></dl></div></div><div class="navfooter"><hr><table width="100%" summary="Navigation footer"><tr><td width="40%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="SambaHA.html">Prev</a> </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="u" href="index.html">Up</a></td><td width="40%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="upgrading-to-3.0.html">Next</a></td></tr><tr><td width="40%" align="left" valign="top">Chapter 29. High Availability Options </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="h" href="index.html">Home</a></td><td width="40%" align="right" valign="top"> Chapter 30. Upgrading from Samba-2.x to Samba-3.0.0</td></tr></table></div></body></html> diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/msdfs.html b/docs/htmldocs/msdfs.html new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..139bfff550 --- /dev/null +++ b/docs/htmldocs/msdfs.html @@ -0,0 +1,88 @@ +<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>Chapter 17. Hosting a Microsoft Distributed File System tree on Samba</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.60.1"><link rel="home" href="index.html" title="SAMBA Project Documentation"><link rel="up" href="optional.html" title="Part III. Advanced Configuration"><link rel="previous" href="InterdomainTrusts.html" title="Chapter 16. Interdomain Trust Relationships"><link rel="next" href="printing.html" title="Chapter 18. Classical Printing Support"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="navheader"><table width="100%" summary="Navigation header"><tr><th colspan="3" align="center">Chapter 17. Hosting a Microsoft Distributed File System tree on Samba</th></tr><tr><td width="20%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="InterdomainTrusts.html">Prev</a> </td><th width="60%" align="center">Part III. Advanced Configuration</th><td width="20%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="printing.html">Next</a></td></tr></table><hr></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="msdfs"></a>Chapter 17. Hosting a Microsoft Distributed File System tree on Samba</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Shirish</span> <span class="surname">Kalele</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team & Veritas Software<br></span><div class="address"><p><br> + <tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:samba@samba.org">samba@samba.org</a>></tt><br> + </p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">John</span> <span class="othername">H.</span> <span class="surname">Terpstra</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org">jht@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><p class="pubdate">12 Jul 2000</p></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="msdfs.html#id2920158">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="msdfs.html#id2920447">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="msdfs.html#id2920488">MSDFS UNIX Path Is Case-Critical</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2920158"></a>Features and Benefits</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> + The Distributed File System (DFS) provides a means of separating the logical + view of files and directories that users see from the actual physical locations + of these resources on the network. It allows for higher availability, smoother + storage expansion, load balancing, and so on. + </p><p> + For information about DFS, refer to the +<ulink url="http://www.microsoft.com/NTServer/nts/downloads/winfeatures/NTSDistrFile/AdminGuide.asp">Microsoft documentation</ulink>. + This document explains how to host a DFS tree on a UNIX machine (for DFS-aware + clients to browse) using Samba. + </p><p> + To enable SMB-based DFS for Samba, configure it with the <tt class="option">--with-msdfs</tt> + option. Once built, a Samba server can be made a DFS server by setting the global + Boolean <a class="indexterm" name="id2920201"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>host msdfs</tt></i> + parameter in the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file. You designate a share as a DFS + root using the Share Level Boolean <a class="indexterm" name="id2920223"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>msdfs root</tt></i> parameter. A DFS root directory on Samba hosts DFS + links in the form of symbolic links that point to other servers. For example, a symbolic link + <tt class="filename">junction->msdfs:storage1\share1</tt> in the share directory acts + as the DFS junction. When DFS-aware clients attempt to access the junction link, + they are redirected to the storage location (in this case, <i class="parameter"><tt>\\storage1\share1</tt></i>). + </p><p> + DFS trees on Samba work with all DFS-aware clients ranging from Windows 95 to 200x. + <link linkend="dfscfg"> shows how to setup a DFS tree on a Samba server. + In the <tt class="filename">/export/dfsroot</tt> directory, you set up your DFS links to + other servers on the network. +</p><pre class="screen"> +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>cd /export/dfsroot</tt></b> +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>chown root /export/dfsroot</tt></b> +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>chmod 755 /export/dfsroot</tt></b> +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>ln -s msdfs:storageA\\shareA linka</tt></b> +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>ln -s msdfs:serverB\\share,serverC\\share linkb</tt></b> +</pre><p> +</p><p> +</p><div class="example"><a name="dfscfg"></a><p class="title"><b>Example 17.1. smb.conf with DFS configured</b></p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td> </td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>[global]</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>netbios name = GANDALF</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>host msdfs = yes</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td> </td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>[dfs]</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>path = /export/dfsroot</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>msdfs root = yes</tt></i></td></tr></table></div><p> +</p><p>You should set up the permissions and ownership of + the directory acting as the DFS root so that only designated + users can create, delete or modify the msdfs links. Also note + that symlink names should be all lowercase. This limitation exists + to have Samba avoid trying all the case combinations to get at + the link name. Finally, set up the symbolic links to point to the + network shares you want and start Samba.</p><p>Users on DFS-aware clients can now browse the DFS tree + on the Samba server at \\samba\dfs. Accessing + links linka or linkb (which appear as directories to the client) + takes users directly to the appropriate shares on the network.</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2920447"></a>Common Errors</h2></div></div><div></div></div><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Windows clients need to be rebooted + if a previously mounted non-DFS share is made a DFS + root or vice versa. A better way is to introduce a + new share and make it the DFS root.</p></li><li><p>Currently, there's a restriction that msdfs + symlink names should all be lowercase.</p></li><li><p>For security purposes, the directory + acting as the root of the DFS tree should have ownership + and permissions set so only designated users can + modify the symbolic links in the directory.</p></li></ul></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2920488"></a>MSDFS UNIX Path Is Case-Critical</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + A network administrator sent advice to the Samba mailing list + after a long sessions trying to determine why DFS was not working. + His advice is worth noting. + </p><p>“<span class="quote"> + I spent some time trying to figure out why my particular + dfs root wasn't working. I noted in the documenation that + the symlink should be in all lowercase. It should be + amended that the entire path to the symlink should all be + in lowercase as well. + </span>”</p><p> + For example, I had a share defined as such: + + </p><pre class="screen"> + [pub] + path = /export/home/Shares/public_share + msdfs root = yes + </pre><p> + + and I could not make my Windows 9x/Me (with the dfs client installed) + follow this symlink: + + </p><pre class="screen"> + damage1 -> msdfs:damage\test-share + </pre><p> + </p><p> + Running a debug level of 10 reveals: + + </p><pre class="programlisting"> + [2003/08/20 11:40:33, 5] msdfs/msdfs.c:is_msdfs_link(176) + is_msdfs_link: /export/home/shares/public_share/* does not exist. + </pre><p> + + Curious. So I changed the directory name from .../Shares/... to + .../shares/... (along with my service definition) and it worked! + </p></div></div></div><div class="navfooter"><hr><table width="100%" summary="Navigation footer"><tr><td width="40%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="InterdomainTrusts.html">Prev</a> </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="u" href="optional.html">Up</a></td><td width="40%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="printing.html">Next</a></td></tr><tr><td width="40%" align="left" valign="top">Chapter 16. Interdomain Trust Relationships </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="h" href="index.html">Home</a></td><td width="40%" align="right" valign="top"> Chapter 18. Classical Printing Support</td></tr></table></div></body></html> diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/optional.html b/docs/htmldocs/optional.html new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..af8b99a5f3 --- /dev/null +++ b/docs/htmldocs/optional.html @@ -0,0 +1,6 @@ +<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>Part III. Advanced Configuration</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.60.1"><link rel="home" href="index.html" title="SAMBA Project Documentation"><link rel="up" href="index.html" title="SAMBA Project Documentation"><link rel="previous" href="ClientConfig.html" title="Chapter 9. MS Windows Network Configuration Guide"><link rel="next" href="NetworkBrowsing.html" title="Chapter 10. Network Browsing"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="navheader"><table width="100%" summary="Navigation header"><tr><th colspan="3" align="center">Part III. Advanced Configuration</th></tr><tr><td width="20%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="ClientConfig.html">Prev</a> </td><th width="60%" align="center"> </th><td width="20%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="NetworkBrowsing.html">Next</a></td></tr></table><hr></div><div class="part" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h1 class="title"><a name="optional"></a>Advanced Configuration</h1></div></div><div></div></div><div class="partintro" lang="en"><div><div><div><h1 class="title"><a name="id2897160"></a>Valuable Nuts and Bolts Information</h1></div></div><div></div></div><p> +Samba has several features that you might want or might not want to use. The chapters in this part each cover specific Samba features. +</p><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt>10. <a href="NetworkBrowsing.html">Network Browsing</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2897285">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2887786">What Is Browsing?</a></dt><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#netdiscuss">Discussion</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2888109">NetBIOS over TCP/IP</a></dt><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2888380">TCP/IP without NetBIOS</a></dt><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#adsdnstech">DNS and Active Directory</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2888743">How Browsing Functions</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#DMB">Configuring WORKGROUP Browsing</a></dt><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2900135">DOMAIN Browsing Configuration</a></dt><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#browse-force-master">Forcing Samba to Be the Master</a></dt><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2900550">Making Samba the Domain Master</a></dt><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2900727">Note about Broadcast Addresses</a></dt><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2900745">Multiple Interfaces</a></dt><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2900780">Use of the Remote Announce Parameter</a></dt><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2900939">Use of the Remote Browse Sync Parameter</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2901016">WINS The Windows Internetworking Name Server</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2901208">WINS Server Configuration</a></dt><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2901481">WINS Replication</a></dt><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2901518">Static WINS Entries</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2901602">Helpful Hints</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2901616">Windows Networking Protocols</a></dt><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2901696">Name Resolution Order</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2901872">Technical Overview of Browsing</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2901926">Browsing Support in Samba</a></dt><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2902057">Problem Resolution</a></dt><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2902187">Cross-Subnet Browsing</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2902960">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2902975">How Can One Flush the Samba NetBIOS Name Cache without Restarting Samba?</a></dt><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2903041">Server Resources Can Not Be Listed</a></dt><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2903097">I get an `Unable to browse the network' error</a></dt><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2903157">Browsing of Shares and Directories is Very Slow</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>11. <a href="passdb.html">Account Information Databases</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="passdb.html#id2903592">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="passdb.html#id2903640">Backward Compatibility Backends</a></dt><dt><a href="passdb.html#id2903800">New Backends</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="passdb.html#passdbtech">Technical Information</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="passdb.html#id2904193">Important Notes About Security</a></dt><dt><a href="passdb.html#id2904429">Mapping User Identifiers between MS Windows and UNIX</a></dt><dt><a href="passdb.html#idmapbackend">Mapping Common UIDs/GIDs on Distributed Machines</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="passdb.html#acctmgmttools">Account Management Tools</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="passdb.html#id2904747">The smbpasswd Command</a></dt><dt><a href="passdb.html#pdbeditthing">The pdbedit Command</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="passdb.html#id2905334">Password Backends</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="passdb.html#id2905385">Plaintext</a></dt><dt><a href="passdb.html#id2905425">smbpasswd Encrypted Password Database</a></dt><dt><a href="passdb.html#id2905552">tdbsam</a></dt><dt><a href="passdb.html#id2905605">ldapsam</a></dt><dt><a href="passdb.html#id2907687">MySQL</a></dt><dt><a href="passdb.html#XMLpassdb">XML</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="passdb.html#id2908781">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="passdb.html#id2908788">Users Cannot Logon</a></dt><dt><a href="passdb.html#id2908830">Users Being Added to the Wrong Backend Database</a></dt><dt><a href="passdb.html#id2908922">Configuration of auth methods</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>12. <a href="groupmapping.html">Group Mapping MS Windows and UNIX</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="groupmapping.html#id2909181">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="groupmapping.html#id2909551">Discussion</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="groupmapping.html#id2909853">Default Users, Groups and Relative Identifiers</a></dt><dt><a href="groupmapping.html#id2910488">Example Configuration</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="groupmapping.html#id2910567">Configuration Scripts</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="groupmapping.html#id2910581">Sample smb.conf Add Group Script</a></dt><dt><a href="groupmapping.html#id2910716">Script to Configure Group Mapping</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="groupmapping.html#id2910824">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="groupmapping.html#id2910839">Adding Groups Fails</a></dt><dt><a href="groupmapping.html#id2910907">Adding MS Windows Groups to MS Windows Groups Fails</a></dt><dt><a href="groupmapping.html#id2910933">Adding Domain Users to the Power Users Group</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>13. <a href="AccessControls.html">File, Directory and Share Access Controls</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="AccessControls.html#id2911341">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="AccessControls.html#id2911525">File System Access Controls</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="AccessControls.html#id2911543">MS Windows NTFS Comparison with UNIX File Systems</a></dt><dt><a href="AccessControls.html#id2911956">Managing Directories</a></dt><dt><a href="AccessControls.html#id2912050">File and Directory Access Control</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="AccessControls.html#id2912290">Share Definition Access Controls</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="AccessControls.html#id2912329">User and Group-Based Controls</a></dt><dt><a href="AccessControls.html#id2912779">File and Directory Permissions-Based Controls</a></dt><dt><a href="AccessControls.html#id2913187">Miscellaneous Controls</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="AccessControls.html#id2913585">Access Controls on Shares</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="AccessControls.html#id2913670">Share Permissions Management</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="AccessControls.html#id2913978">MS Windows Access Control Lists and UNIX Interoperability</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="AccessControls.html#id2913986">Managing UNIX Permissions Using NT Security Dialogs</a></dt><dt><a href="AccessControls.html#id2914042">Viewing File Security on a Samba Share</a></dt><dt><a href="AccessControls.html#id2914124">Viewing File Ownership</a></dt><dt><a href="AccessControls.html#id2914264">Viewing File or Directory Permissions</a></dt><dt><a href="AccessControls.html#id2914515">Modifying File or Directory Permissions</a></dt><dt><a href="AccessControls.html#id2914698">Interaction with the Standard Samba create mask Parameters</a></dt><dt><a href="AccessControls.html#id2915106">Interaction with the Standard Samba File Attribute Mapping</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="AccessControls.html#id2915195">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="AccessControls.html#id2915209">Users Cannot Write to a Public Share</a></dt><dt><a href="AccessControls.html#id2915635">File Operations Done as root with force user Set</a></dt><dt><a href="AccessControls.html#id2915690">MS Word with Samba Changes Owner of File</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>14. <a href="locking.html">File and Record Locking</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="locking.html#id2915945">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="locking.html#id2916001">Discussion</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="locking.html#id2916148">Opportunistic Locking Overview</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="locking.html#id2916856">Samba Opportunistic Locking Control</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="locking.html#id2916978">Example Configuration</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="locking.html#id2917407">MS Windows Opportunistic Locking and Caching Controls</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="locking.html#id2917632">Workstation Service Entries</a></dt><dt><a href="locking.html#id2917660">Server Service Entries</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="locking.html#id2917740">Persistent Data Corruption</a></dt><dt><a href="locking.html#id2917769">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="locking.html#id2917850">locking.tdb Error Messages</a></dt><dt><a href="locking.html#id2917884">Problems Saving Files in MS Office on Windows XP</a></dt><dt><a href="locking.html#id2917904">Long Delays Deleting Files Over Network with XP SP1</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="locking.html#id2917935">Additional Reading</a></dt></dl></dd><dt>15. <a href="securing-samba.html">Securing Samba</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="securing-samba.html#id2918114">Introduction</a></dt><dt><a href="securing-samba.html#id2918159">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="securing-samba.html#id2918244">Technical Discussion of Protective Measures and Issues</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="securing-samba.html#id2918263">Using Host-Based Protection</a></dt><dt><a href="securing-samba.html#id2918364">User-Based Protection</a></dt><dt><a href="securing-samba.html#id2918424">Using Interface Protection</a></dt><dt><a href="securing-samba.html#id2918507">Using a Firewall</a></dt><dt><a href="securing-samba.html#id2918564">Using IPC$ Share-Based Denials </a></dt><dt><a href="securing-samba.html#id2918648">NTLMv2 Security</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="securing-samba.html#id2918707">Upgrading Samba</a></dt><dt><a href="securing-samba.html#id2918731">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="securing-samba.html#id2918750">Smbclient Works on Localhost, but the Network Is Dead</a></dt><dt><a href="securing-samba.html#id2918774">Why Can Users Access Home Directories of Other Users?</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>16. <a href="InterdomainTrusts.html">Interdomain Trust Relationships</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="InterdomainTrusts.html#id2919130">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="InterdomainTrusts.html#id2919159">Trust Relationship Background</a></dt><dt><a href="InterdomainTrusts.html#id2919243">Native MS Windows NT4 Trusts Configuration</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="InterdomainTrusts.html#id2919270">Creating an NT4 Domain Trust</a></dt><dt><a href="InterdomainTrusts.html#id2919342">Completing an NT4 Domain Trust</a></dt><dt><a href="InterdomainTrusts.html#id2919402">Inter-Domain Trust Facilities</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="InterdomainTrusts.html#id2919600">Configuring Samba NT-Style Domain Trusts</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="InterdomainTrusts.html#samba-trusted-domain">Samba as the Trusted Domain</a></dt><dt><a href="InterdomainTrusts.html#id2919809">Samba as the Trusting Domain</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="InterdomainTrusts.html#id2919952">NT4-Style Domain Trusts with Windows 2000</a></dt><dt><a href="InterdomainTrusts.html#id2920058">Common Errors</a></dt></dl></dd><dt>17. <a href="msdfs.html">Hosting a Microsoft Distributed File System tree on Samba</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="msdfs.html#id2920158">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="msdfs.html#id2920447">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="msdfs.html#id2920488">MSDFS UNIX Path Is Case-Critical</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>18. <a href="printing.html">Classical Printing Support</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="printing.html#id2920666">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2920765">Technical Introduction</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="printing.html#id2920831">Client to Samba Print Job Processing</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2920903">Printing Related Configuration Parameters</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="printing.html#id2920998">Simple Print Configuration</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="printing.html#id2921211">Verifing Configuration with testparm</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2921327">Rapid Configuration Validation</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="printing.html#id2921667">Extended Printing Configuration</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="printing.html#id2922020">Detailed Explanation Settings</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="printing.html#id2924414">Printing Developments Since Samba-2.2</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="printing.html#id2924566">Point'n'Print Client Drivers on Samba Servers</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2924710">The Obsoleted [printer$] Section</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2924810">Creating the [print$] Share</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2925021">[print$] Section Parameters</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2925355">The [print$] Share Directory</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="printing.html#id2925525">Installing Drivers into [print$]</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="printing.html#id2925644">Add Printer Wizard Driver Installation</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#inst-rpc">Installing Print Drivers Using rpcclient</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="printing.html#id2927518">Client Driver Installation Procedure</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="printing.html#id2927537">First Client Driver Installation</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2927769">Setting Device Modes on New Printers</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2928112">Additional Client Driver Installation</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2928220">Always Make First Client Connection as root or printer admin</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="printing.html#id2928404">Other Gotchas</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="printing.html#id2928430">Setting Default Print Options for Client Drivers</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2928854">Supporting Large Numbers of Printers</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2929151">Adding New Printers with the Windows NT APW</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2929458">Error Message: Cannot connect under a different Name</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2929564">Take Care When Assembling Driver Files</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2929923">Samba and Printer Ports</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2930008">Avoiding Common Client Driver Misconfiguration</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="printing.html#id2930033">The Imprints Toolset</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="printing.html#id2930071">What is Imprints?</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2930113">Creating Printer Driver Packages</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2930132">The Imprints Server</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2930153">The Installation Client</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="printing.html#id2930314">Adding Network Printers without User Interaction</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2930639">The addprinter Command</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2930686">Migration of Classical Printing to Samba</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2930861">Publishing Printer Information in Active Directory or LDAP</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2930884">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="printing.html#id2930892">I Give My Root Password but I Do Not Get Access</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2930943">My Print Jobs Get Spooled into the Spooling Directory, but Then Get Lost</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>19. <a href="CUPS-printing.html">CUPS Printing Support</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2931072">Introduction</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2931079">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2931130">Overview</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2931182">Basic CUPS Support Configuration</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2931276">Linking smbd with libcups.so</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2931526">Simple smb.conf Settings for CUPS</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2931722">More Complex CUPS smb.conf Settings</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2932089">Advanced Configuration</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2932110">Central Spooling vs. Peer-to-Peer Printing</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2932163">Raw Print Serving Vendor Drivers on Windows Clients</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2932223">Installation of Windows Client Drivers</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#cups-raw">Explicitly Enable raw Printing for application/octet-stream</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2932552">Driver Upload Methods</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2932699">Advanced Intelligent Printing with PostScript Driver Download</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#gdipost">GDI on Windows -- PostScript on UNIX</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2932876">Windows Drivers, GDI and EMF</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2933049">UNIX Printfile Conversion and GUI Basics</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#post-and-ghost">PostScript and Ghostscript</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2933354">Ghostscript the Software RIP for Non-PostScript Printers</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2933497">PostScript Printer Description (PPD) Specification</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2933573">Using Windows-Formatted Vendor PPDs</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2933679">CUPS Also Uses PPDs for Non-PostScript Printers</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2933709">The CUPS Filtering Architecture</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2933883">MIME Types and CUPS Filters</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2934118">MIME Type Conversion Rules</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2934287">Filtering Overview</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2934481">Prefilters</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2934591">pstops</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2934715">pstoraster</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2934912">imagetops and imagetoraster</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2934991">rasterto [printers specific]</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2935143">CUPS Backends</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2935508">The Role of cupsomatic/foomatic</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2935673">The Complete Picture</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2935688">mime.convs</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2935752">Raw Printing</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2935861">application/octet-stream Printing</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2936129">PostScript Printer Descriptions (PPDs) for Non-PS Printers</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2936430">cupsomatic/foomatic-rip Versus native CUPS Printing</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2936743">Examples for Filtering Chains</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2937128">Sources of CUPS Drivers/PPDs</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2937265">Printing with Interface Scripts</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2937358">Network Printing (Purely Windows)</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2937377">From Windows Clients to an NT Print Server</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2937434">Driver Execution on the Client</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2937506">Driver Execution on the Server</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2937618">Network Printing (Windows Clients UNIX/Samba Print +Servers)</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2937639">From Windows Clients to a CUPS/Samba Print Server</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2937834">Samba Receiving Jobfiles and Passing Them to CUPS</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2937924">Network PostScript RIP</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2938025">PPDs for Non-PS Printers on UNIX</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2938085">PPDs for Non-PS Printers on Windows</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2938166">Windows Terminal Servers (WTS) as CUPS Clients</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2938184">Printer Drivers Running in Kernel Mode Cause Many +Problems</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2938229">Workarounds Impose Heavy Limitations</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2938250">CUPS: A Magical Stone?</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2938313">PostScript Drivers with No Major Problems Even in Kernel +Mode</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2938378">Configuring CUPS for Driver Download</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2938397">cupsaddsmb: The Unknown Utility</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2938514">Prepare Your smb.conf for cupsaddsmb</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2938755">CUPS PostScript Driver for Windows NT/200x/XP</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2939044">Recognizing Different Driver Files</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2939174">Acquiring the Adobe Driver Files</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2939204">ESP Print Pro PostScript Driver for Windows NT/200x/XP</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2939274">Caveats to be Considered</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2939571">Windows CUPS PostScript Driver Versus Adobe Driver</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2939801">Run cupsaddsmb (Quiet Mode)</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2939946">Run cupsaddsmb with Verbose Output</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2940175">Understanding cupsaddsmb</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2940352">How to Recognize If cupsaddsmb Completed Successfully</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2940450">cupsaddsmb with a Samba PDC</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2940538">cupsaddsmb Flowchart</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2940621">Installing the PostScript Driver on a Client</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2940801">Avoiding Critical PostScript Driver Settings on the Client</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2940875">Installing PostScript Driver Files Manually Using rpcclient</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2941083">A Check of the rpcclient man Page</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2941229">Understanding the rpcclient man Page</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2941358">Producing an Example by Querying a Windows Box</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2941534">Requirements for adddriver and setdriver to Succeed</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2941782">Manual Driver Installation in 15 Steps</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2942909">Troubleshooting Revisited</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2943077">The Printing *.tdb Files</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2943322">Trivial Database Files</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2943400">Binary Format</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2943470">Losing *.tdb Files</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2943528">Using tdbbackup</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2943673">CUPS Print Drivers from Linuxprinting.org</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2943860">foomatic-rip and Foomatic Explained</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2944657">foomatic-rip and Foomatic-PPD Download and Installation</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2945207">Page Accounting with CUPS</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2945248">Setting Up Quotas</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2945318">Correct and Incorrect Accounting</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2945366">Adobe and CUPS PostScript Drivers for Windows Clients</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2945495">The page_log File Syntax</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2945665">Possible Shortcomings</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2945745">Future Developments</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2945799">Additional Material</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2946030">Auto-Deletion or Preservation of CUPS Spool Files</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2946094">CUPS Configuration Settings Explained</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2946198">Pre-Conditions</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2946367">Manual Configuration</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2946425">Printing from CUPS to Windows Attached Printers</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2946721">More CUPS-Filtering Chains</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2946814">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2946820">Windows 9x/ME Client Can't Install Driver</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2946839">cupsaddsmb Keeps Asking for Root Password in Never-ending Loop</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2946889">cupsaddsmb Errors</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2946973">Client Can't Connect to Samba Printer</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2947002">New Account Reconnection from Windows 200x/XP Troubles</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2947106">Avoid Being Connected to the Samba Server as the Wrong User</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2947158">Upgrading to CUPS Drivers from Adobe Drivers</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2947200">Can't Use cupsaddsmb on Samba Server Which Is a PDC</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2947239">Deleted Windows 200x Printer Driver Is Still Shown</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2947278">Windows 200x/XP "Local Security Policies"</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2947293">Administrator Cannot Install Printers for All Local Users</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2947323">Print Change Notify Functions on NT-clients</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2947350">WinXP-SP1</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2947402">Print Options for All Users Can't Be Set on Windows 200x/XP</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2947717">Most Common Blunders in Driver Settings on Windows Clients</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2947779">cupsaddsmb Does Not Work with Newly Installed Printer</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2947835">Permissions on /var/spool/samba/ Get Reset After Each Reboot</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2947951">Print Queue Called lp Mis-handles Print Jobs</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2948008">Location of Adobe PostScript Driver Files for cupsaddsmb</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2948065">Overview of the CUPS Printing Processes</a></dt></dl></dd><dt>20. <a href="VFS.html">Stackable VFS modules</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="VFS.html#id2948269">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="VFS.html#id2948287">Discussion</a></dt><dt><a href="VFS.html#id2948540">Included Modules</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="VFS.html#id2948547">audit</a></dt><dt><a href="VFS.html#id2948583">extd_audit</a></dt><dt><a href="VFS.html#fakeperms">fake_perms</a></dt><dt><a href="VFS.html#id2948756">recycle</a></dt><dt><a href="VFS.html#id2948986">netatalk</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="VFS.html#id2949031">VFS Modules Available Elsewhere</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="VFS.html#id2949053">DatabaseFS</a></dt><dt><a href="VFS.html#id2949115">vscan</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>21. <a href="winbind.html">Winbind: Use of Domain Accounts</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="winbind.html#id2949352">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="winbind.html#id2949476">Introduction</a></dt><dt><a href="winbind.html#id2949558">What Winbind Provides</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="winbind.html#id2949633">Target Uses</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="winbind.html#id2949664">How Winbind Works</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="winbind.html#id2949693">Microsoft Remote Procedure Calls</a></dt><dt><a href="winbind.html#id2949726">Microsoft Active Directory Services</a></dt><dt><a href="winbind.html#id2949752">Name Service Switch</a></dt><dt><a href="winbind.html#id2949887">Pluggable Authentication Modules</a></dt><dt><a href="winbind.html#id2949965">User and Group ID Allocation</a></dt><dt><a href="winbind.html#id2949998">Result Caching</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="winbind.html#id2950035">Installation and Configuration</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="winbind.html#id2950042">Introduction</a></dt><dt><a href="winbind.html#id2950108">Requirements</a></dt><dt><a href="winbind.html#id2950191">Testing Things Out</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="winbind.html#id2951948">Conclusion</a></dt><dt><a href="winbind.html#id2951967">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="winbind.html#id2952021">NSCD Problem Warning</a></dt><dt><a href="winbind.html#id2952067">Winbind Is Not Resolving Users and Groups</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>22. <a href="AdvancedNetworkManagement.html">Advanced Network Management</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="AdvancedNetworkManagement.html#id2952277">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="AdvancedNetworkManagement.html#id2952308">Remote Server Administration</a></dt><dt><a href="AdvancedNetworkManagement.html#id2952449">Remote Desktop Management</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="AdvancedNetworkManagement.html#id2952467">Remote Management from NoMachine.Com</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="AdvancedNetworkManagement.html#id2952700">Network Logon Script Magic</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="AdvancedNetworkManagement.html#id2952929">Adding Printers without User Intervention</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>23. <a href="PolicyMgmt.html">System and Account Policies</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="PolicyMgmt.html#id2953044">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="PolicyMgmt.html#id2953137">Creating and Managing System Policies</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="PolicyMgmt.html#id2953271">Windows 9x/ME Policies</a></dt><dt><a href="PolicyMgmt.html#id2953383">Windows NT4-Style Policy Files</a></dt><dt><a href="PolicyMgmt.html#id2953525">MS Windows 200x/XP Professional Policies</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="PolicyMgmt.html#id2953826">Managing Account/User Policies</a></dt><dt><a href="PolicyMgmt.html#id2953985">Management Tools</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="PolicyMgmt.html#id2954000">Samba Editreg Toolset</a></dt><dt><a href="PolicyMgmt.html#id2954096">Windows NT4/200x</a></dt><dt><a href="PolicyMgmt.html#id2954120">Samba PDC</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="PolicyMgmt.html#id2954165">System Startup and Logon Processing Overview</a></dt><dt><a href="PolicyMgmt.html#id2954310">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="PolicyMgmt.html#id2954324">Policy Does Not Work</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>24. <a href="ProfileMgmt.html">Desktop Profile Management</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="ProfileMgmt.html#id2954425">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="ProfileMgmt.html#id2954459">Roaming Profiles</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="ProfileMgmt.html#id2954500">Samba Configuration for Profile Handling</a></dt><dt><a href="ProfileMgmt.html#id2955058">Windows Client Profile Configuration Information</a></dt><dt><a href="ProfileMgmt.html#id2956404">Sharing Profiles between W9x/Me and NT4/200x/XP Workstations</a></dt><dt><a href="ProfileMgmt.html#id2956492">Profile Migration from Windows NT4/200x Server to Samba</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="ProfileMgmt.html#id2956822">Mandatory Profiles</a></dt><dt><a href="ProfileMgmt.html#id2956917">Creating and Managing Group Profiles</a></dt><dt><a href="ProfileMgmt.html#id2956970">Default Profile for Windows Users</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="ProfileMgmt.html#id2956999">MS Windows 9x/Me</a></dt><dt><a href="ProfileMgmt.html#id2957150">MS Windows NT4 Workstation</a></dt><dt><a href="ProfileMgmt.html#id2957772">MS Windows 200x/XP</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="ProfileMgmt.html#id2958338">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="ProfileMgmt.html#id2958351">Configuring Roaming Profiles for a Few Users or Groups</a></dt><dt><a href="ProfileMgmt.html#id2958416">Cannot Use Roaming Profiles</a></dt><dt><a href="ProfileMgmt.html#id2958626">Changing the Default Profile</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>25. <a href="pam.html">PAM-Based Distributed Authentication</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="pam.html#id2958910">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="pam.html#id2959235">Technical Discussion</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="pam.html#id2959266">PAM Configuration Syntax</a></dt><dt><a href="pam.html#id2960262">Example System Configurations</a></dt><dt><a href="pam.html#id2960612">smb.conf PAM Configuration</a></dt><dt><a href="pam.html#id2960701">Remote CIFS Authentication Using winbindd.so</a></dt><dt><a href="pam.html#id2960824">Password Synchronization Using pam_smbpass.so</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="pam.html#id2961283">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="pam.html#id2961296">pam_winbind Problem</a></dt><dt><a href="pam.html#id2961406">Winbind Is Not Resolving Users and Groups</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>26. <a href="integrate-ms-networks.html">Integrating MS Windows Networks with Samba</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="integrate-ms-networks.html#id2961659">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="integrate-ms-networks.html#id2961683">Background Information</a></dt><dt><a href="integrate-ms-networks.html#id2961747">Name Resolution in a Pure UNIX/Linux World</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="integrate-ms-networks.html#id2961804">/etc/hosts</a></dt><dt><a href="integrate-ms-networks.html#id2961955">/etc/resolv.conf</a></dt><dt><a href="integrate-ms-networks.html#id2961999">/etc/host.conf</a></dt><dt><a href="integrate-ms-networks.html#id2962064">/etc/nsswitch.conf</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="integrate-ms-networks.html#id2962179">Name Resolution as Used within MS Windows Networking</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="integrate-ms-networks.html#id2962531">The NetBIOS Name Cache</a></dt><dt><a href="integrate-ms-networks.html#id2962597">The LMHOSTS File</a></dt><dt><a href="integrate-ms-networks.html#id2962844">HOSTS File</a></dt><dt><a href="integrate-ms-networks.html#id2962877">DNS Lookup</a></dt><dt><a href="integrate-ms-networks.html#id2962910">WINS Lookup</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="integrate-ms-networks.html#id2963026">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="integrate-ms-networks.html#id2963041">Pinging Works Only in One Way</a></dt><dt><a href="integrate-ms-networks.html#id2963083">Very Slow Network Connections</a></dt><dt><a href="integrate-ms-networks.html#id2963134">Samba Server Name Change Problem</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>27. <a href="unicode.html">Unicode/Charsets</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="unicode.html#id2963374">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="unicode.html#id2963419">What Are Charsets and Unicode?</a></dt><dt><a href="unicode.html#id2963499">Samba and Charsets</a></dt><dt><a href="unicode.html#id2963627">Conversion from Old Names</a></dt><dt><a href="unicode.html#id2963643">Japanese Charsets</a></dt><dt><a href="unicode.html#id2963781">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="unicode.html#id2963788">CP850.so Can't Be Found</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>28. <a href="Backup.html">Samba Backup Techniques</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="Backup.html#id2963903">Note</a></dt><dt><a href="Backup.html#id2963917">Features and Benefits</a></dt></dl></dd><dt>29. <a href="SambaHA.html">High Availability Options</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="SambaHA.html#id2963987">Note</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></div></div></div><div class="navfooter"><hr><table width="100%" summary="Navigation footer"><tr><td width="40%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="ClientConfig.html">Prev</a> </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="u" href="index.html">Up</a></td><td width="40%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="NetworkBrowsing.html">Next</a></td></tr><tr><td width="40%" align="left" valign="top">Chapter 9. MS Windows Network Configuration Guide </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="h" href="index.html">Home</a></td><td width="40%" align="right" valign="top"> Chapter 10. Network Browsing</td></tr></table></div></body></html> diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/pam.html b/docs/htmldocs/pam.html new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..f41a9bc5c8 --- /dev/null +++ b/docs/htmldocs/pam.html @@ -0,0 +1,560 @@ +<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>Chapter 25. PAM-Based Distributed Authentication</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.60.1"><link rel="home" href="index.html" title="SAMBA Project Documentation"><link rel="up" href="optional.html" title="Part III. Advanced Configuration"><link rel="previous" href="ProfileMgmt.html" title="Chapter 24. Desktop Profile Management"><link rel="next" href="integrate-ms-networks.html" title="Chapter 26. Integrating MS Windows Networks with Samba"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="navheader"><table width="100%" summary="Navigation header"><tr><th colspan="3" align="center">Chapter 25. PAM-Based Distributed Authentication</th></tr><tr><td width="20%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="ProfileMgmt.html">Prev</a> </td><th width="60%" align="center">Part III. Advanced Configuration</th><td width="20%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="integrate-ms-networks.html">Next</a></td></tr></table><hr></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="pam"></a>Chapter 25. PAM-Based Distributed Authentication</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">John</span> <span class="othername">H.</span> <span class="surname">Terpstra</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org">jht@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Stephen</span> <span class="surname">Langasek</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:vorlon@netexpress.net">vorlon@netexpress.net</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><p class="pubdate">May 31, 2003</p></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="pam.html#id2958910">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="pam.html#id2959235">Technical Discussion</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="pam.html#id2959266">PAM Configuration Syntax</a></dt><dt><a href="pam.html#id2960262">Example System Configurations</a></dt><dt><a href="pam.html#id2960612">smb.conf PAM Configuration</a></dt><dt><a href="pam.html#id2960701">Remote CIFS Authentication Using winbindd.so</a></dt><dt><a href="pam.html#id2960824">Password Synchronization Using pam_smbpass.so</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="pam.html#id2961283">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="pam.html#id2961296">pam_winbind Problem</a></dt><dt><a href="pam.html#id2961406">Winbind Is Not Resolving Users and Groups</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></div><p> +This chapter should help you to deploy Winbind-based authentication on any PAM-enabled +UNIX/Linux system. Winbind can be used to enable User-Level application access authentication +from any MS Windows NT Domain, MS Windows 200x Active Directory-based +domain, or any Samba-based domain environment. It will also help you to configure PAM-based local host access +controls that are appropriate to your Samba configuration. +</p><p> +In addition to knowing how to configure Winbind into PAM, you will learn generic PAM management +possibilities and in particular how to deploy tools like <tt class="filename">pam_smbpass.so</tt> to your advantage. +</p><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p> +The use of Winbind requires more than PAM configuration alone. +Please refer to <link linkend="winbind">, for further information regarding Winbind. +</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2958910"></a>Features and Benefits</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +A number of UNIX systems (e.g., Sun Solaris), as well as the xxxxBSD family and Linux, +now utilize the Pluggable Authentication Modules (PAM) facility to provide all authentication, +authorization and resource control services. Prior to the introduction of PAM, a decision +to use an alternative to the system password database (<tt class="filename">/etc/passwd</tt>) +would require the provision of alternatives for all programs that provide security services. +Such a choice would involve provision of alternatives to programs such as: <b class="command">login</b>, +<b class="command">passwd</b>, <b class="command">chown</b>, and so on. +</p><p> +PAM provides a mechanism that disconnects these security programs from the underlying +authentication/authorization infrastructure. PAM is configured by making appropriate modifications to one file +<tt class="filename">/etc/pam.conf</tt> (Solaris), or by editing individual control files that are +located in <tt class="filename">/etc/pam.d</tt>. +</p><p> +On PAM-enabled UNIX/Linux systems, it is an easy matter to configure the system to use any +authentication backend so long as the appropriate dynamically loadable library modules +are available for it. The backend may be local to the system, or may be centralized on a +remote server. +</p><p> +PAM support modules are available for: +</p><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term"><tt class="filename">/etc/passwd</tt></span></dt><dd><p> + There are several PAM modules that interact with this standard UNIX user + database. The most common are called: <tt class="filename">pam_unix.so</tt>, <tt class="filename">pam_unix2.so</tt>, <tt class="filename">pam_pwdb.so</tt> + and <tt class="filename">pam_userdb.so</tt>. + </p></dd><dt><span class="term">Kerberos</span></dt><dd><p> + The <tt class="filename">pam_krb5.so</tt> module allows the use of any Kerberos compliant server. + This tool is used to access MIT Kerberos, Heimdal Kerberos, and potentially + Microsoft Active Directory (if enabled). + </p></dd><dt><span class="term">LDAP</span></dt><dd><p> + The <tt class="filename">pam_ldap.so</tt> module allows the use of any LDAP v2 or v3 compatible backend + server. Commonly used LDAP backend servers include: OpenLDAP v2.0 and v2.1, + Sun ONE iDentity server, Novell eDirectory server, Microsoft Active Directory. + </p></dd><dt><span class="term">NetWare Bindery</span></dt><dd><p> + The <tt class="filename">pam_ncp_auth.so</tt> module allows authentication off any bindery-enabled + NetWare Core Protocol-based server. + </p></dd><dt><span class="term">SMB Password</span></dt><dd><p> + This module, called <tt class="filename">pam_smbpass.so</tt>, will allow user authentication off + the passdb backend that is configured in the Samba <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file. + </p></dd><dt><span class="term">SMB Server</span></dt><dd><p> + The <tt class="filename">pam_smb_auth.so</tt> module is the original MS Windows networking authentication + tool. This module has been somewhat outdated by the Winbind module. + </p></dd><dt><span class="term">Winbind</span></dt><dd><p> + The <tt class="filename">pam_winbind.so</tt> module allows Samba to obtain authentication from any + MS Windows Domain Controller. It can just as easily be used to authenticate + users for access to any PAM-enabled application. + </p></dd><dt><span class="term">RADIUS</span></dt><dd><p> + There is a PAM RADIUS (Remote Access Dial-In User Service) authentication + module. In most cases, administrators will need to locate the source code + for this tool and compile and install it themselves. RADIUS protocols are + used by many routers and terminal servers. + </p></dd></dl></div><p> +Of the above, Samba provides the <tt class="filename">pam_smbpasswd.so</tt> and the <tt class="filename">pam_winbind.so</tt> modules alone. +</p><p> +Once configured, these permit a remarkable level of flexibility in the location and use +of distributed Samba Domain Controllers that can provide wide area network bandwidth +efficient authentication services for PAM-capable systems. In effect, this allows the +deployment of centrally managed and maintained distributed authentication from a +single-user account database. +</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2959235"></a>Technical Discussion</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +PAM is designed to provide the system administrator with a great deal of flexibility in +configuration of the privilege granting applications of their system. The local +configuration of system security controlled by PAM is contained in one of two places: +either the single system file, <tt class="filename">/etc/pam.conf</tt>, or the +<tt class="filename">/etc/pam.d/</tt> directory. +</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2959266"></a>PAM Configuration Syntax</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +In this section we discuss the correct syntax of and generic options respected by entries to these files. +PAM-specific tokens in the configuration file are case insensitive. The module paths, however, are case +sensitive since they indicate a file's name and reflect the case +dependence of typical file systems. +The case-sensitivity of the arguments to any given module is defined for each module in turn. +</p><p> +In addition to the lines described below, there are two special characters provided for the convenience +of the system administrator: comments are preceded by a “<span class="quote">#</span>” and extend to the next end-of-line; also, +module specification lines may be extended with a “<span class="quote">\</span>” escaped newline. +</p><p> +If the PAM authentication module (loadable link library file) is located in the +default location, then it is not necessary to specify the path. In the case of +Linux, the default location is <tt class="filename">/lib/security</tt>. If the module +is located outside the default, then the path must be specified as: +</p><p> +</p><pre class="programlisting"> +auth required /other_path/pam_strange_module.so +</pre><p> +</p><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2959332"></a>Anatomy of <tt class="filename">/etc/pam.d</tt> Entries</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> +The remaining information in this subsection was taken from the documentation of the Linux-PAM +project. For more information on PAM, see +<ulink url="http://ftp.kernel.org/pub/linux/libs/pam/">The Official Linux-PAM home page.</ulink> +</p><p> +A general configuration line of the <tt class="filename">/etc/pam.conf</tt> file has the following form: +</p><p> +</p><pre class="programlisting"> +service-name module-type control-flag module-path args +</pre><p> +</p><p> +Below, we explain the meaning of each of these tokens. The second (and more recently adopted) +way of configuring Linux-PAM is via the contents of the <tt class="filename">/etc/pam.d/</tt> directory. +Once we have explained the meaning of the above tokens, we will describe this method. +</p><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">service-name</span></dt><dd><p> + The name of the service associated with this entry. Frequently, the service name is the conventional + name of the given application. For example, <b class="command">ftpd</b>, <b class="command">rlogind</b> and + <b class="command">su</b>, and so on. + </p><p> + There is a special service-name reserved for defining a default authentication mechanism. It has + the name <i class="parameter"><tt>OTHER</tt></i> and may be specified in either lower- or upper-case characters. + Note, when there is a module specified for a named service, the <i class="parameter"><tt>OTHER</tt></i> + entries are ignored. + </p></dd><dt><span class="term">module-type</span></dt><dd><p> + One of (currently) four types of module. The four types are as follows: + </p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p> + <i class="parameter"><tt>auth:</tt></i> This module type provides two aspects of authenticating the user. + It establishes that the user is who he claims to be by instructing the application + to prompt the user for a password or other means of identification. Secondly, the module can + grant group membership (independently of the <tt class="filename">/etc/groups</tt> file discussed + above) or other privileges through its credential granting properties. + </p></li><li><p> + <i class="parameter"><tt>account:</tt></i> This module performs non-authentication-based account management. + It is typically used to restrict/permit access to a service based on the time of day, currently + available system resources (maximum number of users) or perhaps the location of the applicant + user “<span class="quote">root</span>” login only on the console. + </p></li><li><p> + <i class="parameter"><tt>session:</tt></i> Primarily, this module is associated with doing things that need + to be done for the user before and after they can be given service. Such things include the logging + of information concerning the opening and closing of some data exchange with a user, mounting + directories, and so on. + </p></li><li><p> + <i class="parameter"><tt>password:</tt></i> This last module type is required for updating the authentication + token associated with the user. Typically, there is one module for each “<span class="quote">challenge/response</span>” + -based authentication <i class="parameter"><tt>(auth)</tt></i> module type. + </p></li></ul></div></dd><dt><span class="term">control-flag</span></dt><dd><p> + The control-flag is used to indicate how the PAM library will react to the success or failure of the + module it is associated with. Since modules can be stacked (modules of the same type execute in series, + one after another), the control-flags determine the relative importance of each module. The application + is not made aware of the individual success or failure of modules listed in the + <tt class="filename">/etc/pam.conf</tt> file. Instead, it receives a summary success or fail response from + the Linux-PAM library. The order of execution of these modules is that of the entries in the + <tt class="filename">/etc/pam.conf</tt> file; earlier entries are executed before later ones. + As of Linux-PAM v0.60, this control-flag can be defined with one of two syntaxes. + </p><p> + The simpler (and historical) syntax for the control-flag is a single keyword defined to indicate the + severity of concern associated with the success or failure of a specific module. There are four such + keywords: <i class="parameter"><tt>required, requisite, sufficient and optional</tt></i>. + </p><p> + The Linux-PAM library interprets these keywords in the following manner: + </p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p> + <i class="parameter"><tt>required:</tt></i> This indicates that the success of the module is required for the + module-type facility to succeed. Failure of this module will not be apparent to the user until all + of the remaining modules (of the same module-type) have been executed. + </p></li><li><p> + <i class="parameter"><tt>requisite:</tt></i> Like required, however, in the case that such a module returns a + failure, control is directly returned to the application. The return value is that associated with + the first required or requisite module to fail. This flag can be used to protect against the + possibility of a user getting the opportunity to enter a password over an unsafe medium. It is + conceivable that such behavior might inform an attacker of valid accounts on a system. This + possibility should be weighed against the not insignificant concerns of exposing a sensitive + password in a hostile environment. + </p></li><li><p> + <i class="parameter"><tt>sufficient:</tt></i> The success of this module is deemed <i class="parameter"><tt>sufficient</tt></i> to satisfy + the Linux-PAM library that this module-type has succeeded in its purpose. In the event that no + previous required module has failed, no more “<span class="quote">stacked</span>” modules of this type are invoked. + (In this case, subsequent required modules are not invoked). A failure of this module is not deemed + as fatal to satisfying the application that this module-type has succeeded. + </p></li><li><p> + <i class="parameter"><tt>optional:</tt></i> As its name suggests, this control-flag marks the module as not + being critical to the success or failure of the user's application for service. In general, + Linux-PAM ignores such a module when determining if the module stack will succeed or fail. + However, in the absence of any definite successes or failures of previous or subsequent stacked + modules, this module will determine the nature of the response to the application. One example of + this latter case, is when the other modules return something like PAM_IGNORE. + </p></li></ul></div><p> + The more elaborate (newer) syntax is much more specific and gives the administrator a great deal of control + over how the user is authenticated. This form of the control flag is delimited with square brackets and + consists of a series of <i class="parameter"><tt>value=action</tt></i> tokens: + </p><pre class="programlisting"> +[value1=action1 value2=action2 ...] +</pre><p> + Here, <i class="parameter"><tt>value1</tt></i> is one of the following return values: +</p><pre class="screen"> +<i class="parameter"><tt>success; open_err; symbol_err; service_err; system_err; buf_err;</tt></i> +<i class="parameter"><tt>perm_denied; auth_err; cred_insufficient; authinfo_unavail;</tt></i> +<i class="parameter"><tt>user_unknown; maxtries; new_authtok_reqd; acct_expired; session_err;</tt></i> +<i class="parameter"><tt>cred_unavail; cred_expired; cred_err; no_module_data; conv_err;</tt></i> +<i class="parameter"><tt>authtok_err; authtok_recover_err; authtok_lock_busy;</tt></i> +<i class="parameter"><tt>authtok_disable_aging; try_again; ignore; abort; authtok_expired;</tt></i> +<i class="parameter"><tt>module_unknown; bad_item;</tt></i> and <i class="parameter"><tt>default</tt></i>. +</pre><p> +</p><p> + The last of these <i class="parameter"><tt>(default)</tt></i> can be used to set the action for those return values that are not explicitly defined. + </p><p> + The <i class="parameter"><tt>action1</tt></i> can be a positive integer or one of the following tokens: + <i class="parameter"><tt>ignore; ok; done; bad; die;</tt></i> and <i class="parameter"><tt>reset</tt></i>. + A positive integer, J, when specified as the action, can be used to indicate that the next J modules of the + current module-type will be skipped. In this way, the administrator can develop a moderately sophisticated + stack of modules with a number of different paths of execution. Which path is taken can be determined by the + reactions of individual modules. + </p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p> + <i class="parameter"><tt>ignore:</tt></i> When used with a stack of modules, the module's return status will not + contribute to the return code the application obtains. + </p></li><li><p> + <i class="parameter"><tt>bad:</tt></i> This action indicates that the return code should be thought of as indicative + of the module failing. If this module is the first in the stack to fail, its status value will be used + for that of the whole stack. + </p></li><li><p> + <i class="parameter"><tt>die:</tt></i> Equivalent to bad with the side effect of terminating the module stack and + PAM immediately returning to the application. + </p></li><li><p> + <i class="parameter"><tt>ok:</tt></i> This tells PAM that the administrator thinks this return code should + contribute directly to the return code of the full stack of modules. In other words, if the former + state of the stack would lead to a return of PAM_SUCCESS, the module's return code will override + this value. Note, if the former state of the stack holds some value that is indicative of a modules + failure, this <i class="parameter"><tt>ok</tt></i> value will not be used to override that value. + </p></li><li><p> + <i class="parameter"><tt>done:</tt></i> Equivalent to <i class="parameter"><tt>ok</tt></i> with the side effect of terminating the module stack and + PAM immediately returning to the application. + </p></li><li><p> + <i class="parameter"><tt>reset:</tt></i> Clears all memory of the state of the module stack and starts again with + the next stacked module. + </p></li></ul></div><p> + Each of the four keywords: <i class="parameter"><tt>required; requisite; sufficient;</tt></i> and <i class="parameter"><tt>optional</tt></i>, + have an equivalent expression in terms of the [...] syntax. They are as follows: + </p><p> + </p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p> + <i class="parameter"><tt>required</tt></i> is equivalent to <i class="parameter"><tt>[success=ok new_authtok_reqd=ok ignore=ignore default=bad]</tt></i>. + </p></li><li><p> + <i class="parameter"><tt>requisite</tt></i> is equivalent to <i class="parameter"><tt>[success=ok new_authtok_reqd=ok ignore=ignore default=die]</tt></i>. + </p></li><li><p> + <i class="parameter"><tt>sufficient</tt></i> is equivalent to <i class="parameter"><tt>[success=done new_authtok_reqd=done default=ignore]</tt></i>. + </p></li><li><p> + <i class="parameter"><tt>optional</tt></i> is equivalent to <i class="parameter"><tt>[success=ok new_authtok_reqd=ok default=ignore]</tt></i>. + </p></li></ul></div><p> + </p><p> + Just to get a feel for the power of this new syntax, here is a taste of what you can do with it. With Linux-PAM-0.63, + the notion of client plug-in agents was introduced. This is something that makes it possible for PAM to support + machine-machine authentication using the transport protocol inherent to the client/server application. With the + <i class="parameter"><tt>[ ... value=action ... ]</tt></i> control syntax, it is possible for an application to be configured + to support binary prompts with compliant clients, but to gracefully fall over into an alternative authentication + mode for older, legacy applications. + </p></dd><dt><span class="term">module-path</span></dt><dd><p> + The path-name of the dynamically loadable object file; the pluggable module itself. If the first character of the + module path is “<span class="quote">/</span>”, it is assumed to be a complete path. If this is not the case, the given module path is appended + to the default module path: <tt class="filename">/lib/security</tt> (but see the notes above). + </p><p> + The arguments are a list of tokens that are passed to the module when it is invoked, much like arguments to a typical + Linux shell command. Generally, valid arguments are optional and are specific to any given module. Invalid arguments + are ignored by a module, however, when encountering an invalid argument, the module is required to write an error + to syslog(3). For a list of generic options, see the next section. + </p><p> + If you wish to include spaces in an argument, you should surround that argument with square brackets. For example: + </p><pre class="programlisting"> +squid auth required pam_mysql.so user=passwd_query passwd=mada \ +db=eminence [query=select user_name from internet_service where \ +user_name=“<span class="quote">%u</span>” and password=PASSWORD(“<span class="quote">%p</span>”) and service=“<span class="quote">web_proxy</span>”] +</pre><p> + When using this convention, you can include “<span class="quote">[</span>” characters inside the string, and if you wish to have a “<span class="quote">]</span>” + character inside the string that will survive the argument parsing, you should use “<span class="quote">\[</span>”. In other words: + </p><pre class="programlisting"> +[..[..\]..] --> ..[..].. +</pre><p> + Any line in one of the configuration files that is not formatted correctly will generally tend (erring on the + side of caution) to make the authentication process fail. A corresponding error is written to the system log files + with a call to syslog(3). + </p></dd></dl></div></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2960262"></a>Example System Configurations</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +The following is an example <tt class="filename">/etc/pam.d/login</tt> configuration file. +This example had all options uncommented and is probably not usable +because it stacks many conditions before allowing successful completion +of the login process. Essentially all conditions can be disabled +by commenting them out, except the calls to <tt class="filename">pam_pwdb.so</tt>. +</p><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2960294"></a>PAM: Original Login Config</h4></div></div><div></div></div><pre class="programlisting"> +#%PAM-1.0 +# The PAM configuration file for the “<span class="quote">login</span>” service +# +auth required pam_securetty.so +auth required pam_nologin.so +# auth required pam_dialup.so +# auth optional pam_mail.so +auth required pam_pwdb.so shadow md5 +# account requisite pam_time.so +account required pam_pwdb.so +session required pam_pwdb.so +# session optional pam_lastlog.so +# password required pam_cracklib.so retry=3 +password required pam_pwdb.so shadow md5 +</pre></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2960324"></a>PAM: Login Using <tt class="filename">pam_smbpass</tt></h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> +PAM allows use of replaceable modules. Those available on a sample system include: +</p><p><tt class="prompt">$</tt><b class="userinput"><tt>/bin/ls /lib/security</tt></b> +</p><pre class="programlisting"> +pam_access.so pam_ftp.so pam_limits.so +pam_ncp_auth.so pam_rhosts_auth.so pam_stress.so +pam_cracklib.so pam_group.so pam_listfile.so +pam_nologin.so pam_rootok.so pam_tally.so +pam_deny.so pam_issue.so pam_mail.so +pam_permit.so pam_securetty.so pam_time.so +pam_dialup.so pam_lastlog.so pam_mkhomedir.so +pam_pwdb.so pam_shells.so pam_UNIX.so +pam_env.so pam_ldap.so pam_motd.so +pam_radius.so pam_smbpass.so pam_UNIX_acct.so +pam_wheel.so pam_UNIX_auth.so pam_UNIX_passwd.so +pam_userdb.so pam_warn.so pam_UNIX_session.so +</pre><p> +The following example for the login program replaces the use of +the <tt class="filename">pam_pwdb.so</tt> module that uses the system +password database (<tt class="filename">/etc/passwd</tt>, +<tt class="filename">/etc/shadow</tt>, <tt class="filename">/etc/group</tt>) with +the module <tt class="filename">pam_smbpass.so</tt>, which uses the Samba +database which contains the Microsoft MD4 encrypted password +hashes. This database is stored in either +<tt class="filename">/usr/local/samba/private/smbpasswd</tt>, +<tt class="filename">/etc/samba/smbpasswd</tt>, or in +<tt class="filename">/etc/samba.d/smbpasswd</tt>, depending on the +Samba implementation for your UNIX/Linux system. The +<tt class="filename">pam_smbpass.so</tt> module is provided by +Samba version 2.2.1 or later. It can be compiled by specifying the +<tt class="option">--with-pam_smbpass</tt> options when running Samba's +<b class="command">configure</b> script. For more information +on the <tt class="filename">pam_smbpass</tt> module, see the documentation +in the <tt class="filename">source/pam_smbpass</tt> directory of the Samba +source distribution. +</p><pre class="programlisting"> +#%PAM-1.0 +# The PAM configuration file for the “<span class="quote">login</span>” service +# +auth required pam_smbpass.so nodelay +account required pam_smbpass.so nodelay +session required pam_smbpass.so nodelay +password required pam_smbpass.so nodelay +</pre><p> +The following is the PAM configuration file for a particular +Linux system. The default condition uses <tt class="filename">pam_pwdb.so</tt>. +</p><pre class="programlisting"> +#%PAM-1.0 +# The PAM configuration file for the “<span class="quote">samba</span>” service +# +auth required pam_pwdb.so nullok nodelay shadow audit +account required pam_pwdb.so audit nodelay +session required pam_pwdb.so nodelay +password required pam_pwdb.so shadow md5 +</pre><p> +In the following example, the decision has been made to use the +<b class="command">smbpasswd</b> database even for basic Samba authentication. Such a +decision could also be made for the <b class="command">passwd</b> program and would +thus allow the <b class="command">smbpasswd</b> passwords to be changed using the +<b class="command">passwd</b> program: +</p><pre class="programlisting"> +#%PAM-1.0 +# The PAM configuration file for the “<span class="quote">samba</span>” service +# +auth required pam_smbpass.so nodelay +account required pam_pwdb.so audit nodelay +session required pam_pwdb.so nodelay +password required pam_smbpass.so nodelay smbconf=/etc/samba.d/smb.conf +</pre><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p>PAM allows stacking of authentication mechanisms. It is +also possible to pass information obtained within one PAM module through +to the next module in the PAM stack. Please refer to the documentation for +your particular system implementation for details regarding the specific +capabilities of PAM in this environment. Some Linux implementations also +provide the <tt class="filename">pam_stack.so</tt> module that allows all +authentication to be configured in a single central file. The +<tt class="filename">pam_stack.so</tt> method has some devoted followers +on the basis that it allows for easier administration. As with all issues in +life though, every decision makes trade-offs, so you may want to examine the +PAM documentation for further helpful information. +</p></div></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2960612"></a><tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> PAM Configuration</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + There is an option in <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> called <a class="indexterm" name="id2960633"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>obey pam restrictions</tt></i>. +The following is from the online help for this option in SWAT; +</p><p> +When Samba is configured to enable PAM support (i.e., <tt class="option">--with-pam</tt>), this parameter will +control whether or not Samba should obey PAM's account and session management directives. The default behavior +is to use PAM for cleartext authentication only and to ignore any account or session management. Samba always +ignores PAM for authentication in the case of <a class="indexterm" name="id2960663"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>encrypt passwords</tt></i> = yes. +The reason is that PAM modules cannot support the challenge/response authentication mechanism needed in the presence of SMB +password encryption. +</p><p>Default: <a class="indexterm" name="id2960684"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>obey pam restrictions</tt></i> = no</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2960701"></a>Remote CIFS Authentication Using <tt class="filename">winbindd.so</tt></h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +All operating systems depend on the provision of users credentials acceptable to the platform. +UNIX requires the provision of a user identifier (UID) as well as a group identifier (GID). +These are both simple integer type numbers that are obtained from a password backend such +as <tt class="filename">/etc/passwd</tt>. +</p><p> +Users and groups on a Windows NT server are assigned a relative ID (RID) which is unique for +the domain when the user or group is created. To convert the Windows NT user or group into +a UNIX user or group, a mapping between RIDs and UNIX user and group IDs is required. This +is one of the jobs that winbind performs. +</p><p> +As Winbind users and groups are resolved from a server, user and group IDs are allocated +from a specified range. This is done on a first come, first served basis, although all +existing users and groups will be mapped as soon as a client performs a user or group +enumeration command. The allocated UNIX IDs are stored in a database file under the Samba +lock directory and will be remembered. +</p><p> +The astute administrator will realize from this that the combination of <tt class="filename">pam_smbpass.so</tt>, +<b class="command">winbindd</b> and a distributed <a class="indexterm" name="id2960770"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>passdb backend</tt></i>, +such as <i class="parameter"><tt>ldap</tt></i>, will allow the establishment of a centrally managed, distributed user/password +database that can also be used by all PAM-aware (e.g., Linux) programs and applications. This arrangement can have +particularly potent advantages compared with the use of Microsoft Active Directory Service (ADS) in so far as +the reduction of wide area network authentication traffic. +</p><div class="warning" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Warning</h3><p> +The RID to UNIX ID database is the only location where the user and group mappings are +stored by <b class="command">winbindd</b>. If this file is deleted or corrupted, there is no way for <b class="command">winbindd</b> +to determine which user and group IDs correspond to Windows NT user and group RIDs. +</p></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2960824"></a>Password Synchronization Using <tt class="filename">pam_smbpass.so</tt></h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +<tt class="filename">pam_smbpass</tt> is a PAM module that can be used on conforming systems to +keep the <tt class="filename">smbpasswd</tt> (Samba password) database in sync with the UNIX +password file. PAM (Pluggable Authentication Modules) is an API supported +under some UNIX operating systems, such as Solaris, HPUX and Linux, that provides a +generic interface to authentication mechanisms. +</p><p> +This module authenticates a local <tt class="filename">smbpasswd</tt> user database. If you require +support for authenticating against a remote SMB server, or if you are +concerned about the presence of SUID root binaries on your system, it is +recommended that you use <tt class="filename">pam_winbind</tt> instead. +</p><p> +Options recognized by this module are shown in <link linkend="smbpassoptions">. +</p><div class="table"><a name="smbpassoptions"></a><p class="title"><b>Table 25.1. Options recognized by <i class="parameter"><tt>pam_smbpass</tt></i></b></p><table summary="Options recognized by pam_smbpass" border="1"><colgroup><col align="left"><col align="justify"></colgroup><tbody><tr><td align="left">debug</td><td align="justify">log more debugging info.</td></tr><tr><td align="left">audit</td><td align="justify">like debug, but also logs unknown usernames.</td></tr><tr><td align="left">use_first_pass</td><td align="justify">do not prompt the user for passwords; take them from PAM_ items instead.</td></tr><tr><td align="left">try_first_pass</td><td align="justify">try to get the password from a previous PAM module fall back to prompting the user.</td></tr><tr><td align="left">use_authtok</td><td align="justify">like try_first_pass, but *fail* if the new PAM_AUTHTOK has not been previously set (intended for stacking password modules only).</td></tr><tr><td align="left">not_set_pass</td><td align="justify">do not make passwords used by this module available to other modules.</td></tr><tr><td align="left">nodelay</td><td align="justify">do not insert ~1 second delays on authentication failure.</td></tr><tr><td align="left">nullok</td><td align="justify">null passwords are allowed.</td></tr><tr><td align="left">nonull</td><td align="justify">null passwords are not allowed. Used to override the Samba configuration.</td></tr><tr><td align="left">migrate</td><td align="justify">only meaningful in an “<span class="quote">auth</span>” context; used to update smbpasswd file with a password used for successful authentication.</td></tr><tr><td align="left">smbconf=<i class="replaceable"><tt>file</tt></i></td><td align="justify">specify an alternate path to the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file.</td></tr></tbody></table></div><p> +</p><p> +The following are examples of the use of <tt class="filename">pam_smbpass.so</tt> in the format of Linux +<tt class="filename">/etc/pam.d/</tt> files structure. Those wishing to implement this +tool on other platforms will need to adapt this appropriately. +</p><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2961083"></a>Password Synchronization Configuration</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> +A sample PAM configuration that shows the use of pam_smbpass to make +sure <tt class="filename">private/smbpasswd</tt> is kept in sync when <tt class="filename">/etc/passwd (/etc/shadow)</tt> +is changed. Useful when an expired password might be changed by an +application (such as <b class="command">ssh</b>). +</p><pre class="programlisting"> +#%PAM-1.0 +# password-sync +# +auth requisite pam_nologin.so +auth required pam_UNIX.so +account required pam_UNIX.so +password requisite pam_cracklib.so retry=3 +password requisite pam_UNIX.so shadow md5 use_authtok try_first_pass +password required pam_smbpass.so nullok use_authtok try_first_pass +session required pam_UNIX.so +</pre></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2961136"></a>Password Migration Configuration</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> +A sample PAM configuration that shows the use of <tt class="filename">pam_smbpass</tt> to migrate +from plaintext to encrypted passwords for Samba. Unlike other methods, +this can be used for users who have never connected to Samba shares: +password migration takes place when users <b class="command">ftp</b> in, login using <b class="command">ssh</b>, pop +their mail, and so on. +</p><pre class="programlisting"> +#%PAM-1.0 +# password-migration +# +auth requisite pam_nologin.so +# pam_smbpass is called IF pam_UNIX succeeds. +auth requisite pam_UNIX.so +auth optional pam_smbpass.so migrate +account required pam_UNIX.so +password requisite pam_cracklib.so retry=3 +password requisite pam_UNIX.so shadow md5 use_authtok try_first_pass +password optional pam_smbpass.so nullok use_authtok try_first_pass +session required pam_UNIX.so +</pre></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2961191"></a>Mature Password Configuration</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> +A sample PAM configuration for a mature <tt class="filename">smbpasswd</tt> installation. +<tt class="filename">private/smbpasswd</tt> is fully populated, and we consider it an error if +the SMB password does not exist or does not match the UNIX password. +</p><pre class="programlisting"> +#%PAM-1.0 +# password-mature +# +auth requisite pam_nologin.so +auth required pam_UNIX.so +account required pam_UNIX.so +password requisite pam_cracklib.so retry=3 +password requisite pam_UNIX.so shadow md5 use_authtok try_first_pass +password required pam_smbpass.so use_authtok use_first_pass +session required pam_UNIX.so +</pre></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2961236"></a>Kerberos Password Integration Configuration</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> +A sample PAM configuration that shows <i class="parameter"><tt>pam_smbpass</tt></i> used together with +<i class="parameter"><tt>pam_krb5</tt></i>. This could be useful on a Samba PDC that is also a member of +a Kerberos realm. +</p><pre class="programlisting"> +#%PAM-1.0 +# kdc-pdc +# +auth requisite pam_nologin.so +auth requisite pam_krb5.so +auth optional pam_smbpass.so migrate +account required pam_krb5.so +password requisite pam_cracklib.so retry=3 +password optional pam_smbpass.so nullok use_authtok try_first_pass +password required pam_krb5.so use_authtok try_first_pass +session required pam_krb5.so +</pre></div></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2961283"></a>Common Errors</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +PAM can be fickle and sensitive to configuration glitches. Here we look at a few cases from +the Samba mailing list. +</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2961296"></a>pam_winbind Problem</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + A user reported: I have the following PAM configuration: + </p><p> +</p><pre class="programlisting"> +auth required /lib/security/pam_securetty.so +auth sufficient /lib/security/pam_winbind.so +auth sufficient /lib/security/pam_UNIX.so use_first_pass nullok +auth required /lib/security/pam_stack.so service=system-auth +auth required /lib/security/pam_nologin.so +account required /lib/security/pam_stack.so service=system-auth +account required /lib/security/pam_winbind.so +password required /lib/security/pam_stack.so service=system-auth +</pre><p> +</p><p> + When I open a new console with [ctrl][alt][F1], I can't log in with my user “<span class="quote">pitie</span>”. + I have tried with user “<span class="quote">scienceu+pitie</span>” also. + </p><p> + <span class="emphasis"><em>Answer:</em></span> The problem may lie with your inclusion of <i class="parameter"><tt>pam_stack.so + service=system-auth</tt></i>. That file often contains a lot of stuff that may + duplicate what you are already doing. Try commenting out the <i class="parameter"><tt>pam_stack</tt></i> lines + for <i class="parameter"><tt>auth</tt></i> and <i class="parameter"><tt>account</tt></i> and see if things work. If they do, look at + <tt class="filename">/etc/pam.d/system-auth</tt> and copy only what you need from it into your + <tt class="filename">/etc/pam.d/login</tt> file. Alternately, if you want all services to use + Winbind, you can put the Winbind-specific stuff in <tt class="filename">/etc/pam.d/system-auth</tt>. + </p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2961406"></a>Winbind Is Not Resolving Users and Groups</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + “<span class="quote"> + My <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file is correctly configured. I have specified + <a class="indexterm" name="id2961428"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>idmap uid</tt></i> = 12000, + and <a class="indexterm" name="id2961442"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>idmap gid</tt></i> = 3000-3500 + and <b class="command">winbind</b> is running. When I do the following it all works fine. + </span>” + </p><pre class="screen"> +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>wbinfo -u</tt></b> +MIDEARTH+maryo +MIDEARTH+jackb +MIDEARTH+ameds +... +MIDEARTH+root + +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>wbinfo -g</tt></b> +MIDEARTH+Domain Users +MIDEARTH+Domain Admins +MIDEARTH+Domain Guests +... +MIDEARTH+Accounts + +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>getent passwd</tt></b> +root:x:0:0:root:/root:/bin/bash +bin:x:1:1:bin:/bin:/bin/bash +... +maryo:x:15000:15003:Mary Orville:/home/MIDEARTH/maryo:/bin/false +</pre><p> + “<span class="quote"> + But this command fails: + </span>” +</p><pre class="screen"> +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>chown maryo a_file</tt></b> +chown: 'maryo': invalid user +</pre><p> + “<span class="quote">This is driving me nuts! What can be wrong?</span>” + </p><p> + <span class="emphasis"><em>Answer:</em></span> Your system is likely running <b class="command">nscd</b>, the name service + caching daemon. Shut it down, do not restart it! You will find your problem resolved. + </p></div></div></div><div class="navfooter"><hr><table width="100%" summary="Navigation footer"><tr><td width="40%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="ProfileMgmt.html">Prev</a> </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="u" href="optional.html">Up</a></td><td width="40%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="integrate-ms-networks.html">Next</a></td></tr><tr><td width="40%" align="left" valign="top">Chapter 24. Desktop Profile Management </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="h" href="index.html">Home</a></td><td width="40%" align="right" valign="top"> Chapter 26. Integrating MS Windows Networks with Samba</td></tr></table></div></body></html> diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/passdb.html b/docs/htmldocs/passdb.html new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..fbfcd560da --- /dev/null +++ b/docs/htmldocs/passdb.html @@ -0,0 +1,883 @@ +<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>Chapter 11. Account Information Databases</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.60.1"><link rel="home" href="index.html" title="SAMBA Project Documentation"><link rel="up" href="optional.html" title="Part III. Advanced Configuration"><link rel="previous" href="NetworkBrowsing.html" title="Chapter 10. Network Browsing"><link rel="next" href="groupmapping.html" title="Chapter 12. Group Mapping MS Windows and UNIX"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="navheader"><table width="100%" summary="Navigation header"><tr><th colspan="3" align="center">Chapter 11. Account Information Databases</th></tr><tr><td width="20%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="NetworkBrowsing.html">Prev</a> </td><th width="60%" align="center">Part III. Advanced Configuration</th><td width="20%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="groupmapping.html">Next</a></td></tr></table><hr></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="passdb"></a>Chapter 11. Account Information Databases</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Jelmer</span> <span class="othername">R.</span> <span class="surname">Vernooij</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">The Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jelmer@samba.org">jelmer@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">John</span> <span class="othername">H.</span> <span class="surname">Terpstra</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org">jht@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Gerald</span> <span class="othername">(Jerry)</span> <span class="surname">Carter</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jerry@samba.org">jerry@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Jeremy</span> <span class="surname">Allison</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jra@samba.org">jra@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Guenther</span> <span class="surname">Deschner</span></h3><span class="contrib">LDAP updates</span><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">SuSE<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:gd@suse.de">gd@suse.de</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Olivier (lem)</span> <span class="surname">Lemaire</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">IDEALX<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:olem@IDEALX.org">olem@IDEALX.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><p class="pubdate">May 24, 2003</p></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="passdb.html#id2903592">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="passdb.html#id2903640">Backward Compatibility Backends</a></dt><dt><a href="passdb.html#id2903800">New Backends</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="passdb.html#passdbtech">Technical Information</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="passdb.html#id2904193">Important Notes About Security</a></dt><dt><a href="passdb.html#id2904429">Mapping User Identifiers between MS Windows and UNIX</a></dt><dt><a href="passdb.html#idmapbackend">Mapping Common UIDs/GIDs on Distributed Machines</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="passdb.html#acctmgmttools">Account Management Tools</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="passdb.html#id2904747">The smbpasswd Command</a></dt><dt><a href="passdb.html#pdbeditthing">The pdbedit Command</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="passdb.html#id2905334">Password Backends</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="passdb.html#id2905385">Plaintext</a></dt><dt><a href="passdb.html#id2905425">smbpasswd Encrypted Password Database</a></dt><dt><a href="passdb.html#id2905552">tdbsam</a></dt><dt><a href="passdb.html#id2905605">ldapsam</a></dt><dt><a href="passdb.html#id2907687">MySQL</a></dt><dt><a href="passdb.html#XMLpassdb">XML</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="passdb.html#id2908781">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="passdb.html#id2908788">Users Cannot Logon</a></dt><dt><a href="passdb.html#id2908830">Users Being Added to the Wrong Backend Database</a></dt><dt><a href="passdb.html#id2908922">Configuration of auth methods</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></div><p> +Samba-3 implements a new capability to work concurrently with multiple account backends. +The possible new combinations of password backends allows Samba-3 a degree of flexibility +and scalability that previously could be achieved only with MS Windows Active Directory. +This chapter describes the new functionality and how to get the most out of it. +</p><p> +In the development of Samba-3, a number of requests were received to provide the +ability to migrate MS Windows NT4 SAM accounts to Samba-3 without the need to provide +matching UNIX/Linux accounts. We called this the <span class="emphasis"><em>Non-UNIX Accounts (NUA)</em></span> +capability. The intent was that an administrator could decide to use the <span class="emphasis"><em>tdbsam</em></span> +backend and by simply specifying <a class="indexterm" name="id2903560"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>passdb backend</tt></i> = tdbsam_nua, +this would allow Samba-3 to implement a solution that did not use UNIX accounts per se. Late +in the development cycle, the team doing this work hit upon some obstacles that prevents this +solution from being used. Given the delays with the Samba-3 release, a decision was made to not +deliver this functionality until a better method of recognizing NT Group SIDs from NT User +SIDs could be found. This feature may return during the life cycle for the Samba-3 series. +</p><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p> +Samba-3 does not support Non-UNIX Account (NUA) operation for user accounts. +Samba-3 does support NUA operation for machine accounts. +</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2903592"></a>Features and Benefits</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +Samba-3 provides for complete backward compatibility with Samba-2.2.x functionality +as follows: +<a class="indexterm" name="id2903606"></a> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2903617"></a> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2903628"></a> +</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2903640"></a>Backward Compatibility Backends</h3></div></div><div></div></div><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">Plain Text</span></dt><dd><p> + This option uses nothing but the UNIX/Linux <tt class="filename">/etc/passwd</tt> + style backend. On systems that have Pluggable Authentication Modules (PAM) + support, all PAM modules are supported. The behavior is just as it was with + Samba-2.2.x, and the protocol limitations imposed by MS Windows clients + apply likewise. Please refer to <link linkend="passdbtech"> for more information + regarding the limitations of Plain Text password usage. + </p></dd><dt><span class="term">smbpasswd</span></dt><dd><p> + This option allows continued use of the <tt class="filename">smbpasswd</tt> + file that maintains a plain ASCII (text) layout that includes the MS Windows + LanMan and NT encrypted passwords as well as a field that stores some + account information. This form of password backend does not store any of + the MS Windows NT/200x SAM (Security Account Manager) information required to + provide the extended controls that are needed for more comprehensive + interoperation with MS Windows NT4/200x servers. + </p><p> + This backend should be used only for backward compatibility with older + versions of Samba. It may be deprecated in future releases. + </p></dd><dt><span class="term">ldapsam_compat (Samba-2.2 LDAP Compatibility)</span></dt><dd><p> + There is a password backend option that allows continued operation with + an existing OpenLDAP backend that uses the Samba-2.2.x LDAP schema extension. + This option is provided primarily as a migration tool, although there is + no reason to force migration at this time. This tool will eventually + be deprecated. + </p></dd></dl></div></div><p> +Samba-3 introduces a number of new password backend capabilities. +<a class="indexterm" name="id2903755"></a> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2903766"></a> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2903777"></a> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2903788"></a> +</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2903800"></a>New Backends</h3></div></div><div></div></div><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">tdbsam</span></dt><dd><p> + This backend provides a rich database backend for local servers. This + backend is not suitable for multiple Domain Controllers (i.e., PDC + one + or more BDC) installations. + </p><p> + The <span class="emphasis"><em>tdbsam</em></span> password backend stores the old <span class="emphasis"><em> + smbpasswd</em></span> information plus the extended MS Windows NT / 200x + SAM information into a binary format TDB (trivial database) file. + The inclusion of the extended information makes it possible for Samba-3 + to implement the same account and system access controls that are possible + with MS Windows NT4/200x-based systems. + </p><p> + The inclusion of the <span class="emphasis"><em>tdbsam</em></span> capability is a direct + response to user requests to allow simple site operation without the overhead + of the complexities of running OpenLDAP. It is recommended to use this only + for sites that have fewer than 250 users. For larger sites or implementations, + the use of OpenLDAP or of Active Directory integration is strongly recommended. + </p></dd><dt><span class="term">ldapsam</span></dt><dd><p> + This provides a rich directory backend for distributed account installation. + </p><p> + Samba-3 has a new and extended LDAP implementation that requires configuration + of OpenLDAP with a new format Samba schema. The new format schema file is + included in the <tt class="filename">examples/LDAP</tt> directory of the Samba distribution. + </p><p> + The new LDAP implementation significantly expands the control abilities that + were possible with prior versions of Samba. It is now possible to specify + “<span class="quote">per user</span>” profile settings, home directories, account access controls, and + much more. Corporate sites will see that the Samba Team has listened to their + requests both for capability and to allow greater scalability. + </p></dd><dt><span class="term">mysqlsam (MySQL based backend)</span></dt><dd><p> + It is expected that the MySQL-based SAM will be very popular in some corners. + This database backend will be of considerable interest to sites that want to + leverage existing MySQL technology. + </p></dd><dt><span class="term">xmlsam (XML based datafile)</span></dt><dd><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2903946"></a> + Allows the account and password data to be stored in an XML format + data file. This backend cannot be used for normal operation, it can only + be used in conjunction with <b class="command">pdbedit</b>'s pdb2pdb + functionality. The DTD that is used might be subject to changes in the future. + </p><p> + The <i class="parameter"><tt>xmlsam</tt></i> option can be useful for account migration between database + backends or backups. Use of this tool will allow the data to be edited before migration + into another backend format. + </p></dd></dl></div></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="passdbtech"></a>Technical Information</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> + Old Windows clients send plain text passwords over the wire. Samba can check these + passwords by encrypting them and comparing them to the hash stored in the UNIX user database. + </p><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2904009"></a> + Newer Windows clients send encrypted passwords (so-called Lanman and NT hashes) over + the wire, instead of plain text passwords. The newest clients will send only encrypted + passwords and refuse to send plain text passwords, unless their registry is tweaked. + </p><p> + These passwords can't be converted to UNIX-style encrypted passwords. Because of that, + you can't use the standard UNIX user database, and you have to store the Lanman and NT + hashes somewhere else. + </p><p> + In addition to differently encrypted passwords, Windows also stores certain data for each + user that is not stored in a UNIX user database. For example, workstations the user may logon from, + the location where the user's profile is stored, and so on. Samba retrieves and stores this + information using a <a class="indexterm" name="id2904039"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>passdb backend</tt></i>. Commonly available backends are LDAP, plain text + file, and MySQL. For more information, see the man page for <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> regarding the + <a class="indexterm" name="id2904062"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>passdb backend</tt></i> parameter. + </p><div class="figure"><a name="idmap-sid2uid"></a><p class="title"><b>Figure 11.1. IDMAP: Resolution of SIDs to UIDs.</b></p><div class="mediaobject"><img src="projdoc/imagefiles/idmap-sid2uid.png" width="270" alt="IDMAP: Resolution of SIDs to UIDs."></div></div><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2904123"></a> + The resolution of SIDs to UIDs is fundamental to correct operation of Samba. In both cases shown, if winbindd is not running, or cannot + be contacted, then only local SID/UID resolution is possible. See <link linkend="idmap-sid2uid"> and + <link linkend="idmap-uid2sid">. + </p><div class="figure"><a name="idmap-uid2sid"></a><p class="title"><b>Figure 11.2. IDMAP: Resolution of UIDs to SIDs.</b></p><div class="mediaobject"><img src="projdoc/imagefiles/idmap-uid2sid.png" width="270" alt="IDMAP: Resolution of UIDs to SIDs."></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2904193"></a>Important Notes About Security</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + The UNIX and SMB password encryption techniques seem similar on the surface. This + similarity is, however, only skin deep. The UNIX scheme typically sends cleartext + passwords over the network when logging in. This is bad. The SMB encryption scheme + never sends the cleartext password over the network but it does store the 16 byte + hashed values on disk. This is also bad. Why? Because the 16 byte hashed values + are a “<span class="quote">password equivalent.</span>” You cannot derive the user's password from them, but + they could potentially be used in a modified client to gain access to a server. + This would require considerable technical knowledge on behalf of the attacker but + is perfectly possible. You should thus treat the datastored in whatever passdb + backend you use (smbpasswd file, LDAP, MYSQL) as though it contained the cleartext + passwords of all your users. Its contents must be kept secret and the file should + be protected accordingly. + </p><p> + Ideally, we would like a password scheme that involves neither plain text passwords + on the network nor on disk. Unfortunately, this is not available as Samba is stuck with + having to be compatible with other SMB systems (Windows NT, Windows for Workgroups, Windows 9x/Me). + </p><p> + Windows NT 4.0 Service Pack 3 changed the default setting so plaintext passwords + are disabled from being sent over the wire. This mandates either the use of encrypted + password support or editing the Windows NT registry to re-enable plaintext passwords. + </p><p> + The following versions of Microsoft Windows do not support full domain security protocols, + although they may log onto a domain environment: + </p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li>MS DOS Network client 3.0 with the basic network redirector installed.</li><li>Windows 95 with the network redirector update installed.</li><li>Windows 98 [Second Edition].</li><li>Windows Me.</li></ul></div><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p> + MS Windows XP Home does not have facilities to become a Domain Member and it cannot participate in domain logons. + </p></div><p> + The following versions of MS Windows fully support domain security protocols. + </p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li>Windows NT 3.5x.</li><li>Windows NT 4.0.</li><li>Windows 2000 Professional.</li><li>Windows 200x Server/Advanced Server.</li><li>Windows XP Professional.</li></ul></div><p> + All current releases of Microsoft SMB/CIFS clients support authentication via the + SMB Challenge/Response mechanism described here. Enabling cleartext authentication + does not disable the ability of the client to participate in encrypted authentication. + Instead, it allows the client to negotiate either plain text or encrypted password + handling. + </p><p> + MS Windows clients will cache the encrypted password alone. Where plain text passwords + are re-enabled through the appropriate registry change, the plain text password is never + cached. This means that in the event that a network connections should become disconnected + (broken), only the cached (encrypted) password will be sent to the resource server to + effect an auto-reconnect. If the resource server does not support encrypted passwords the + auto-reconnect will fail. Use of encrypted passwords is strongly advised. + </p><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2904338"></a>Advantages of Encrypted Passwords</h4></div></div><div></div></div><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Plaintext passwords are not passed across + the network. Someone using a network sniffer cannot just + record passwords going to the SMB server.</p></li><li><p>Plaintext passwords are not stored anywhere in + memory or on disk.</p></li><li><p>Windows NT does not like talking to a server + that does not support encrypted passwords. It will refuse + to browse the server if the server is also in User Level + security mode. It will insist on prompting the user for the + password on each connection, which is very annoying. The + only things you can do to stop this is to use SMB encryption. + </p></li><li><p>Encrypted password support allows automatic share + (resource) reconnects.</p></li><li><p>Encrypted passwords are essential for PDC/BDC + operation.</p></li></ul></div></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2904393"></a>Advantages of Non-Encrypted Passwords</h4></div></div><div></div></div><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Plaintext passwords are not kept + on disk, and are not cached in memory. </p></li><li><p>Uses same password file as other UNIX + services such as Login and FTP.</p></li><li><p>Use of other services (such as Telnet and FTP) that + send plain text passwords over the network, so sending them for SMB + is not such a big deal.</p></li></ul></div></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2904429"></a>Mapping User Identifiers between MS Windows and UNIX</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + Every operation in UNIX/Linux requires a user identifier (UID), just as in + MS Windows NT4/200x this requires a Security Identifier (SID). Samba provides + two means for mapping an MS Windows user to a UNIX/Linux UID. + </p><p> + First, all Samba SAM (Security Account Manager database) accounts require + a UNIX/Linux UID that the account will map to. As users are added to the account + information database, Samba will call the <a class="indexterm" name="id2904452"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>add user script</tt></i> + interface to add the account to the Samba host OS. In essence all accounts in + the local SAM require a local user account. + </p><p> + The second way to effect Windows SID to UNIX UID mapping is via the + <span class="emphasis"><em>idmap uid</em></span> and <span class="emphasis"><em>idmap gid</em></span> parameters in <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt>. + Please refer to the man page for information about these parameters. + These parameters are essential when mapping users from a remote SAM server. + </p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="idmapbackend"></a>Mapping Common UIDs/GIDs on Distributed Machines</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + Samba-3 has a special facility that makes it possible to maintain identical UIDs and GIDs + on all servers in a distributed network. A distributed network is one where there exists + a PDC, one or more BDCs and/or one or more Domain Member servers. Why is this important? + This is important if files are being shared over more than one protocol (e.g., NFS) and where + users are copying files across UNIX/Linux systems using tools such as <b class="command">rsync</b>. + </p><p> + The special facility is enabled using a parameter called <i class="parameter"><tt>idmap backend</tt></i>. + The default setting for this parameter is an empty string. Technically it is possible to use + an LDAP based idmap backend for UIDs and GIDs, but it makes most sense when this is done for + network configurations that also use LDAP for the SAM backend. A sample use is shown in + <link linkend="idmapbackendexample">. + </p><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2904556"></a> +</p><div class="example"><a name="idmapbackendexample"></a><p class="title"><b>Example 11.1. Example configuration with the LDAP idmap backend</b></p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td> </td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>[global]</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>idmap backend = ldapsam:ldap://ldap-server.quenya.org:636</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>idmap backend = ldapsam:ldaps://ldap-server.quenya.org</tt></i></td></tr></table></div><p> + </p><p> + A network administrator who wants to make significant use of LDAP backends will sooner or later be + exposed to the excellent work done by PADL Software. PADL <ulink url="http://www.padl.com">http://www.padl.com</ulink> have + produced and released to open source an array of tools that might be of interest. These tools include: + </p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p> + <span class="emphasis"><em>nss_ldap:</em></span> An LDAP Name Service Switch module to provide native + name service support for AIX, Linux, Solaris, and other operating systems. This tool + can be used for centralized storage and retrieval of UIDs/GIDs. + </p></li><li><p> + <span class="emphasis"><em>pam_ldap:</em></span> A PAM module that provides LDAP integration for UNIX/Linux + system access authentication. + </p></li><li><p> + <span class="emphasis"><em>idmap_ad:</em></span> An IDMAP backend that supports the Microsoft Services for + UNIX RFC 2307 schema available from their web + <ulink url="http://www.padl.com/download/xad_oss_plugins.tar.gz">site</ulink>. + </p></li></ul></div></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="acctmgmttools"></a>Account Management Tools</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2904718"></a> +Samba provides two tools for management of user and machine accounts. These tools are +called <b class="command">smbpasswd</b> and <b class="command">pdbedit</b>. A third tool is under +development but is not expected to ship in time for Samba-3.0.0. The new tool will be a TCL/TK +GUI tool that looks much like the MS Windows NT4 Domain User Manager. Hopefully this will +be announced in time for the Samba-3.0.1 release. +</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2904747"></a>The <span class="emphasis"><em>smbpasswd</em></span> Command</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + The smbpasswd utility is similar to the <b class="command">passwd</b> + or <b class="command">yppasswd</b> programs. It maintains the two 32 byte password + fields in the passdb backend. + </p><p> + <b class="command">smbpasswd</b> works in a client-server mode where it contacts the + local smbd to change the user's password on its behalf. This has enormous benefits. + </p><p> + <b class="command">smbpasswd</b> has the capability to change passwords on Windows NT + servers (this only works when the request is sent to the NT Primary Domain Controller + if changing an NT Domain user's password). + </p><p> + <b class="command">smbpasswd</b> can be used to: +<a class="indexterm" name="id2904816"></a> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2904824"></a> + + </p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><span class="emphasis"><em>add</em></span> user or machine accounts.</li><li><span class="emphasis"><em>delete</em></span> user or machine accounts.</li><li><span class="emphasis"><em>enable</em></span> user or machine accounts.</li><li><span class="emphasis"><em>disable</em></span> user or machine accounts.</li><li><span class="emphasis"><em>set to NULL</em></span> user passwords.</li><li><span class="emphasis"><em>manage interdomain trust accounts.</em></span></li></ul></div><p> + To run smbpasswd as a normal user just type: + </p><p> +</p><pre class="screen"> +<tt class="prompt">$ </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>smbpasswd</tt></b> +<tt class="prompt">Old SMB password: </tt><b class="userinput"><tt><i class="replaceable"><tt>secret</tt></i></tt></b> +</pre><p> + For <i class="replaceable"><tt>secret</tt></i>, type old value here or press return if + there is no old password. +</p><pre class="screen"> +<tt class="prompt">New SMB Password: </tt><b class="userinput"><tt><i class="replaceable"><tt>new secret</tt></i></tt></b> +<tt class="prompt">Repeat New SMB Password: </tt><b class="userinput"><tt><i class="replaceable"><tt>new secret</tt></i></tt></b> +</pre><p> + </p><p> + If the old value does not match the current value stored for that user, or the two + new values do not match each other, then the password will not be changed. + </p><p> + When invoked by an ordinary user, the command will only allow the user to change his or her own + SMB password. + </p><p> + When run by root, <b class="command">smbpasswd</b> may take an optional argument specifying + the user name whose SMB password you wish to change. When run as root, <b class="command">smbpasswd</b> + does not prompt for or check the old password value, thus allowing root to set passwords + for users who have forgotten their passwords. + </p><p> + <b class="command">smbpasswd</b> is designed to work in the way familiar to UNIX + users who use the <b class="command">passwd</b> or <b class="command">yppasswd</b> commands. + While designed for administrative use, this tool provides essential User Level + password change capabilities. + </p><p> + For more details on using <b class="command">smbpasswd</b>, refer to the man page (the + definitive reference). + </p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="pdbeditthing"></a>The <span class="emphasis"><em>pdbedit</em></span> Command</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2905062"></a> + <b class="command">pdbedit</b> is a tool that can be used only by root. It is used to + manage the passdb backend. <b class="command">pdbedit</b> can be used to: +<a class="indexterm" name="id2905085"></a> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2905094"></a> + + </p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li>add, remove or modify user accounts.</li><li>list user accounts.</li><li>migrate user accounts.</li></ul></div><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2905127"></a> + The <b class="command">pdbedit</b> tool is the only one that can manage the account + security and policy settings. It is capable of all operations that smbpasswd can + do as well as a super set of them. + </p><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2905150"></a> + One particularly important purpose of the <b class="command">pdbedit</b> is to allow + the migration of account information from one passdb backend to another. See the + <link linkend="XMLpassdb"> password backend section of this chapter. + </p><p> + The following is an example of the user account information that is stored in + a tdbsam password backend. This listing was produced by running: + </p><pre class="screen"> +<tt class="prompt">$ </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>pdbedit -Lv met</tt></b> +UNIX username: met +NT username: +Account Flags: [UX ] +User SID: S-1-5-21-1449123459-1407424037-3116680435-2004 +Primary Group SID: S-1-5-21-1449123459-1407424037-3116680435-1201 +Full Name: Melissa E Terpstra +Home Directory: \\frodo\met\Win9Profile +HomeDir Drive: H: +Logon Script: scripts\logon.bat +Profile Path: \\frodo\Profiles\met +Domain: MIDEARTH +Account desc: +Workstations: melbelle +Munged dial: +Logon time: 0 +Logoff time: Mon, 18 Jan 2038 20:14:07 GMT +Kickoff time: Mon, 18 Jan 2038 20:14:07 GMT +Password last set: Sat, 14 Dec 2002 14:37:03 GMT +Password can change: Sat, 14 Dec 2002 14:37:03 GMT +Password must change: Mon, 18 Jan 2038 20:14:07 GMT +</pre><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2905222"></a> + The <b class="command">pdbedit</b> tool allows migration of authentication (account) + databases from one backend to another. For example: To migrate accounts from an + old <tt class="filename">smbpasswd</tt> database to a <i class="parameter"><tt>tdbsam</tt></i> + backend: + </p><div class="procedure"><ol type="1"><li><p> + Set the <a class="indexterm" name="id2905264"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>passdb backend</tt></i> = tdbsam, smbpasswd. + </p></li><li><p> + Execute: +</p><pre class="screen"> +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>pdbedit -i smbpassed -e tdbsam</tt></b> +</pre><p> + </p></li><li><p> + Now remove the <i class="parameter"><tt>smbpasswd</tt></i> from the passdb backend + configuration in <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt>. + </p></li></ol></div></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2905334"></a>Password Backends</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +Samba offers the greatest flexibility in backend account database design of any SMB/CIFS server +technology available today. The flexibility is immediately obvious as one begins to explore this +capability. +</p><p> +It is possible to specify not only multiple different password backends, but even multiple +backends of the same type. For example, to use two different tdbsam databases: +</p><p> +</p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>passdb backend = tdbsam:/etc/samba/passdb.tdb \</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>tdbsam:/etc/samba/old-passdb.tdb</tt></i></td></tr></table><p> +</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2905385"></a>Plaintext</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + Older versions of Samba retrieved user information from the UNIX user database + and eventually some other fields from the file <tt class="filename">/etc/samba/smbpasswd</tt> + or <tt class="filename">/etc/smbpasswd</tt>. When password encryption is disabled, no + SMB specific data is stored at all. Instead all operations are conducted via the way + that the Samba host OS will access its <tt class="filename">/etc/passwd</tt> database. + Linux systems For example, all operations are done via PAM. + </p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2905425"></a>smbpasswd Encrypted Password Database</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2905439"></a> + Traditionally, when configuring <a class="indexterm" name="id2905450"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>encrypt passwords</tt></i> = yes in Samba's <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file, user account + information such as username, LM/NT password hashes, password change times, and account + flags have been stored in the <tt class="filename">smbpasswd(5)</tt> file. There are several + disadvantages to this approach for sites with large numbers of users (counted + in the thousands). + </p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p> + The first problem is that all lookups must be performed sequentially. Given that + there are approximately two lookups per domain logon (one for a normal + session connection such as when mapping a network drive or printer), this + is a performance bottleneck for large sites. What is needed is an indexed approach + such as used in databases. + </p></li><li><p> + The second problem is that administrators who desire to replicate a smbpasswd file + to more than one Samba server were left to use external tools such as + <b class="command">rsync(1)</b> and <b class="command">ssh(1)</b> and wrote custom, + in-house scripts. + </p></li><li><p> + Finally, the amount of information that is stored in an smbpasswd entry leaves + no room for additional attributes such as a home directory, password expiration time, + or even a Relative Identifier (RID). + </p></li></ul></div><p> + As a result of these deficiencies, a more robust means of storing user attributes + used by smbd was developed. The API which defines access to user accounts + is commonly referred to as the samdb interface (previously this was called the passdb + API, and is still so named in the Samba CVS trees). + </p><p> + Samba provides an enhanced set of passdb backends that overcome the deficiencies + of the smbpasswd plain text database. These are tdbsam, ldapsam and xmlsam. + Of these, ldapsam will be of most interest to large corporate or enterprise sites. + </p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2905552"></a>tdbsam</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2905563"></a> + Samba can store user and machine account data in a “<span class="quote">TDB</span>” (Trivial Database). + Using this backend does not require any additional configuration. This backend is + recommended for new installations that do not require LDAP. + </p><p> + As a general guide, the Samba Team does not recommend using the tdbsam backend for sites + that have 250 or more users. Additionally, tdbsam is not capable of scaling for use + in sites that require PDB/BDC implementations that require replication of the account + database. Clearly, for reason of scalability, the use of ldapsam should be encouraged. + </p><p> + The recommendation of a 250 user limit is purely based on the notion that this + would generally involve a site that has routed networks, possibly spread across + more than one physical location. The Samba Team has not at this time established + the performance based scalability limits of the tdbsam architecture. + </p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2905605"></a>ldapsam</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2905616"></a> + There are a few points to stress that the ldapsam does not provide. The LDAP + support referred to in this documentation does not include: + </p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>A means of retrieving user account information from + an Windows 200x Active Directory server.</p></li><li><p>A means of replacing /etc/passwd.</p></li></ul></div><p> + The second item can be accomplished by using LDAP NSS and PAM modules. LGPL + versions of these libraries can be obtained from + <ulink url="http://www.padl.com/">PADL Software</ulink>. + More information about the configuration of these packages may be found at + <ulink url="http://safari.oreilly.com/?XmlId=1-56592-491-6"> + LDAP, System Administration; Gerald Carter by O'Reilly; Chapter 6: Replacing NIS."</ulink> + </p><p> + This document describes how to use an LDAP directory for storing Samba user + account information traditionally stored in the smbpasswd(5) file. It is + assumed that the reader already has a basic understanding of LDAP concepts + and has a working directory server already installed. For more information + on LDAP architectures and directories, please refer to the following sites: + </p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p><ulink url="http://www.openldap.org/">OpenLDAP</ulink></p></li><li><p><ulink url="http://iplanet.netscape.com/directory">Sun iPlanet Directory Server</ulink></p></li></ul></div><p> + Two additional Samba resources which may prove to be helpful are: + </p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>The <ulink url="http://www.unav.es/cti/ldap-smb/ldap-smb-3-howto.html">Samba-PDC-LDAP-HOWTO</ulink> + maintained by Ignacio Coupeau.</p></li><li><p>The NT migration scripts from <ulink url="http://samba.idealx.org/">IDEALX</ulink> that are + geared to manage users and group in such a Samba-LDAP Domain Controller configuration. + </p></li></ul></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2905753"></a>Supported LDAP Servers</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> + The LDAP ldapsam code has been developed and tested using the OpenLDAP 2.0 and 2.1 server and + client libraries. The same code should work with Netscape's Directory Server and client SDK. + However, there are bound to be compile errors and bugs. These should not be hard to fix. + Please submit fixes via the process outlined in <link linkend="bugreport">. + </p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2905778"></a>Schema and Relationship to the RFC 2307 posixAccount</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> + Samba-3.0 includes the necessary schema file for OpenLDAP 2.0 in + <tt class="filename">examples/LDAP/samba.schema</tt>. The sambaSamAccount objectclass is given here: + </p><p> +</p><pre class="programlisting"> +objectclass (1.3.6.1.4.1.7165.2.2.6 NAME 'sambaSamAccount' SUP top AUXILIARY + DESC 'Samba-3.0 Auxiliary SAM Account' + MUST ( uid $ sambaSID ) + MAY ( cn $ sambaLMPassword $ sambaNTPassword $ sambaPwdLastSet $ + sambaLogonTime $ sambaLogoffTime $ sambaKickoffTime $ + sambaPwdCanChange $ sambaPwdMustChange $ sambaAcctFlags $ + displayName $ sambaHomePath $ sambaHomeDrive $ sambaLogonScript $ + sambaProfilePath $ description $ sambaUserWorkstations $ + sambaPrimaryGroupSID $ sambaDomainName )) +</pre><p> +</p><p> + The <tt class="filename">samba.schema</tt> file has been formatted for OpenLDAP 2.0/2.1. + The Samba Team owns the OID space used by the above schema and recommends its use. + If you translate the schema to be used with Netscape DS, please submit the modified + schema file as a patch to <ulink url="mailto:jerry@samba.org">jerry@samba.org</ulink>. + </p><p> + Just as the smbpasswd file is meant to store information that provides information additional to a + user's <tt class="filename">/etc/passwd</tt> entry, so is the sambaSamAccount object + meant to supplement the UNIX user account information. A sambaSamAccount is a + <tt class="constant">AUXILIARY</tt> objectclass so it can be used to augment existing + user account information in the LDAP directory, thus providing information needed + for Samba account handling. However, there are several fields (e.g., uid) that overlap + with the posixAccount objectclass outlined in RFC2307. This is by design. + </p><p> + In order to store all user account information (UNIX and Samba) in the directory, + it is necessary to use the sambaSamAccount and posixAccount objectclasses in + combination. However, smbd will still obtain the user's UNIX account + information via the standard C library calls (e.g., getpwnam(), et al). + This means that the Samba server must also have the LDAP NSS library installed + and functioning correctly. This division of information makes it possible to + store all Samba account information in LDAP, but still maintain UNIX account + information in NIS while the network is transitioning to a full LDAP infrastructure. + </p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2905890"></a>OpenLDAP Configuration</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> + To include support for the sambaSamAccount object in an OpenLDAP directory + server, first copy the samba.schema file to slapd's configuration directory. + The samba.schema file can be found in the directory <tt class="filename">examples/LDAP</tt> + in the Samba source distribution. + </p><p> +</p><pre class="screen"> +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>cp samba.schema /etc/openldap/schema/</tt></b> +</pre><p> +</p><p> + Next, include the <tt class="filename">samba.schema</tt> file in <tt class="filename">slapd.conf</tt>. + The sambaSamAccount object contains two attributes that depend on other schema + files. The <i class="parameter"><tt>uid</tt></i> attribute is defined in <tt class="filename">cosine.schema</tt> and + the <i class="parameter"><tt>displayName</tt></i> attribute is defined in the <tt class="filename">inetorgperson.schema</tt> + file. Both of these must be included before the <tt class="filename">samba.schema</tt> file. + </p><p> +</p><pre class="programlisting"> +## /etc/openldap/slapd.conf + +## schema files (core.schema is required by default) +include /etc/openldap/schema/core.schema + +## needed for sambaSamAccount +include /etc/openldap/schema/cosine.schema +include /etc/openldap/schema/inetorgperson.schema +include /etc/openldap/schema/samba.schema +include /etc/openldap/schema/nis.schema +.... +</pre><p> +</p><p> + It is recommended that you maintain some indices on some of the most useful attributes, + as in the following example, to speed up searches made on sambaSamAccount objectclasses + (and possibly posixAccount and posixGroup as well): + </p><p> +</p><pre class="programlisting"> +# Indices to maintain +## required by OpenLDAP +index objectclass eq + +index cn pres,sub,eq +index sn pres,sub,eq +## required to support pdb_getsampwnam +index uid pres,sub,eq +## required to support pdb_getsambapwrid() +index displayName pres,sub,eq + +## uncomment these if you are storing posixAccount and +## posixGroup entries in the directory as well +##index uidNumber eq +##index gidNumber eq +##index memberUid eq + +index sambaSID eq +index sambaPrimaryGroupSID eq +index sambaDomainName eq +index default sub +</pre><p> +</p><p> + Create the new index by executing: + </p><p> +</p><pre class="screen"> +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt>./sbin/slapindex -f slapd.conf +</pre><p> +</p><p> + Remember to restart slapd after making these changes: + </p><p> +</p><pre class="screen"> +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>/etc/init.d/slapd restart</tt></b> +</pre><p> +</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2906098"></a>Initialize the LDAP Database</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> + Before you can add accounts to the LDAP database you must create the account containers + that they will be stored in. The following LDIF file should be modified to match your + needs (DNS entries, and so on): + </p><p> +</p><pre class="programlisting"> +# Organization for Samba Base +dn: dc=quenya,dc=org +objectclass: dcObject +objectclass: organization +dc: quenya +o: Quenya Org Network +description: The Samba-3 Network LDAP Example + +# Organizational Role for Directory Management +dn: cn=Manager,dc=quenya,dc=org +objectclass: organizationalRole +cn: Manager +description: Directory Manager + +# Setting up container for users +dn: ou=People,dc=quenya,dc=org +objectclass: top +objectclass: organizationalUnit +ou: People + +# Setting up admin handle for People OU +dn: cn=admin,ou=People,dc=quenya,dc=org +cn: admin +objectclass: top +objectclass: organizationalRole +objectclass: simpleSecurityObject +userPassword: {SSHA}c3ZM9tBaBo9autm1dL3waDS21+JSfQVz + +# Setting up container for groups +dn: ou=Groups,dc=quenya,dc=org +objectclass: top +objectclass: organizationalUnit +ou: People + +# Setting up admin handle for Groups OU +dn: cn=admin,ou=Groups,dc=quenya,dc=org +cn: admin +objectclass: top +objectclass: organizationalRole +objectclass: simpleSecurityObject +userPassword: {SSHA}c3ZM9tBaBo9autm1dL3waDS21+JSfQVz + +# Setting up container for computers +dn: ou=Computers,dc=quenya,dc=org +objectclass: top +objectclass: organizationalUnit +ou: People + +# Setting up admin handle for Computers OU +dn: cn=admin,ou=Computers,dc=quenya,dc=org +cn: admin +objectclass: top +objectclass: organizationalRole +objectclass: simpleSecurityObject +userPassword: {SSHA}c3ZM9tBaBo9autm1dL3waDS21+JSfQVz +</pre><p> +</p><p> + The userPassword shown above should be generated using <b class="command">slappasswd</b>. + </p><p> + The following command will then load the contents of the LDIF file into the LDAP + database. + </p><p> +</p><pre class="screen"> +<tt class="prompt">$ </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>slapadd -v -l initldap.dif</tt></b> +</pre><p> +</p><p> + Do not forget to secure your LDAP server with an adequate access control list + as well as an admin password. + </p><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p> + Before Samba can access the LDAP server you need to store the LDAP admin password + into the Samba-3 <tt class="filename">secrets.tdb</tt> database by: +</p><pre class="screen"> +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>smbpasswd -w <i class="replaceable"><tt>secret</tt></i></tt></b> +</pre><p> + </p></div></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2906239"></a>Configuring Samba</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> + The following parameters are available in smb.conf only if your + version of Samba was built with LDAP support. Samba automatically builds with LDAP support if the + LDAP libraries are found. + </p><p>LDAP related smb.conf options: + <a class="indexterm" name="id2906257"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>passdb backend</tt></i> = ldapsam:url, + <a class="indexterm" name="id2906272"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>ldap admin dn</tt></i>, + <a class="indexterm" name="id2906286"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>ldap delete dn</tt></i>, + <a class="indexterm" name="id2906300"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>ldap filter</tt></i>, + <a class="indexterm" name="id2906313"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>ldap group suffix</tt></i>, + <a class="indexterm" name="id2906327"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>ldap idmap suffix</tt></i>, + <a class="indexterm" name="id2906341"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>ldap machine suffix</tt></i>, + <a class="indexterm" name="id2906355"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>ldap passwd sync</tt></i>, + <a class="indexterm" name="id2906369"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>ldap ssl</tt></i>, + <a class="indexterm" name="id2906383"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>ldap suffix</tt></i>, + <a class="indexterm" name="id2906396"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>ldap user suffix</tt></i>, + </p><p> + These are described in the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> man + page and so will not be repeated here. However, a sample <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file for + use with an LDAP directory could appear as shown in <link linkend="confldapex">. + </p><p> +</p><div class="example"><a name="confldapex"></a><p class="title"><b>Example 11.2. Configuration with LDAP</b></p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td> </td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>[global]</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>security = user</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>encrypt passwords = yes</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>netbios name = MORIA</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>workgroup = NOLDOR</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td># ldap related parameters</td></tr><tr><td># define the DN to use when binding to the directory servers</td></tr><tr><td># The password for this DN is not stored in smb.conf. Rather it</td></tr><tr><td># must be set by using 'smbpasswd -w <i class="replaceable"><tt>secretpw</tt></i>' to store the</td></tr><tr><td># passphrase in the secrets.tdb file. If the "ldap admin dn" values</td></tr><tr><td># change, this password will need to be reset.</td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>ldap admin dn = "cn=Manager,ou=People,dc=quenya,dc=org"</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td># Define the SSL option when connecting to the directory</td></tr><tr><td># ('off', 'start tls', or 'on' (default))</td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>ldap ssl = start tls</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td># syntax: passdb backend = ldapsam:ldap://server-name[:port]</td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>passdb backend = ldapsam:ldap://frodo.quenya.org</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td># smbpasswd -x delete the entire dn-entry</td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>ldap delete dn = no</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td># the machine and user suffix added to the base suffix</td></tr><tr><td># wrote WITHOUT quotes. NULL suffixes by default</td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>ldap user suffix = ou=People</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>ldap group suffix = ou=Groups</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>ldap machine suffix = ou=Computers</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td># Trust UNIX account information in LDAP</td></tr><tr><td># (see the smb.conf manpage for details)</td></tr><tr><td># specify the base DN to use when searching the directory</td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>ldap suffix = ou=People,dc=quenya,dc=org</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td># generally the default ldap search filter is ok</td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>ldap filter = (&(uid=%u)(objectclass=sambaSamAccount))</tt></i></td></tr></table></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2906668"></a>Accounts and Groups Management</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2906680"></a> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2906689"></a> + + As user accounts are managed through the sambaSamAccount objectclass, you should + modify your existing administration tools to deal with sambaSamAccount attributes. + </p><p> + Machine accounts are managed with the sambaSamAccount objectclass, just + like users accounts. However, it is up to you to store those accounts + in a different tree of your LDAP namespace. You should use + “<span class="quote">ou=Groups,dc=quenya,dc=org</span>” to store groups and + “<span class="quote">ou=People,dc=quenya,dc=org</span>” to store users. Just configure your + NSS and PAM accordingly (usually, in the <tt class="filename">/etc/openldap/sldap.conf</tt> + configuration file). + </p><p> + In Samba-3, the group management system is based on POSIX + groups. This means that Samba makes use of the posixGroup objectclass. + For now, there is no NT-like group system management (global and local + groups). Samba-3 knows only about <tt class="constant">Domain Groups</tt> + and, unlike MS Windows 2000 and Active Directory, Samba-3 does not + support nested groups. + </p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2906746"></a>Security and sambaSamAccount</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> + There are two important points to remember when discussing the security + of sambaSamAccount entries in the directory. + </p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p><span class="emphasis"><em>Never</em></span> retrieve the lmPassword or + ntPassword attribute values over an unencrypted LDAP session.</p></li><li><p><span class="emphasis"><em>Never</em></span> allow non-admin users to + view the lmPassword or ntPassword attribute values.</p></li></ul></div><p> + These password hashes are cleartext equivalents and can be used to impersonate + the user without deriving the original cleartext strings. For more information + on the details of LM/NT password hashes, refer to the + <link linkend="passdb"> section of this chapter. + </p><p> + To remedy the first security issue, the <a class="indexterm" name="id2906805"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>ldap ssl</tt></i> <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> parameter defaults + to require an encrypted session (<a class="indexterm" name="id2906827"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>ldap ssl</tt></i> = on) using + the default port of <tt class="constant">636</tt> + when contacting the directory server. When using an OpenLDAP server, it + is possible to use the use the StartTLS LDAP extended operation in the place of + LDAPS. In either case, you are strongly discouraged to disable this security + (<a class="indexterm" name="id2906849"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>ldap ssl</tt></i> = off). + </p><p> + Note that the LDAPS protocol is deprecated in favor of the LDAPv3 StartTLS + extended operation. However, the OpenLDAP library still provides support for + the older method of securing communication between clients and servers. + </p><p> + The second security precaution is to prevent non-administrative users from + harvesting password hashes from the directory. This can be done using the + following ACL in <tt class="filename">slapd.conf</tt>: + </p><p> +</p><pre class="programlisting"> +## allow the "ldap admin dn" access, but deny everyone else +access to attrs=lmPassword,ntPassword + by dn="cn=Samba Admin,ou=People,dc=quenya,dc=org" write + by * none +</pre><p> +</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2906904"></a>LDAP Special Attributes for sambaSamAccounts</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> + The sambaSamAccount objectclass is composed of the attributes shown in <link linkend="attribobjclPartA">, and <link linkend="attribobjclPartB">. + </p><p> + </p><div class="table"><a name="attribobjclPartA"></a><p class="title"><b>Table 11.1. Attributes in the sambaSamAccount objectclass (LDAP) Part A</b></p><table summary="Attributes in the sambaSamAccount objectclass (LDAP) Part A" border="1"><colgroup><col align="left"><col align="justify"></colgroup><tbody><tr><td align="left"><tt class="constant">sambaLMPassword</tt></td><td align="justify">The LANMAN password 16-byte hash stored as a character + representation of a hexadecimal string.</td></tr><tr><td align="left"><tt class="constant">sambaNTPassword</tt></td><td align="justify">The NT password hash 16-byte stored as a character + representation of a hexadecimal string.</td></tr><tr><td align="left"><tt class="constant">sambaPwdLastSet</tt></td><td align="justify">The integer time in seconds since 1970 when the + <tt class="constant">sambaLMPassword</tt> and <tt class="constant">sambaNTPassword</tt> attributes were last set. + </td></tr><tr><td align="left"><tt class="constant">sambaAcctFlags</tt></td><td align="justify">String of 11 characters surrounded by square brackets [] + representing account flags such as U (user), W (workstation), X (no password expiration), + I (Domain trust account), H (Home dir required), S (Server trust account), + and D (disabled).</td></tr><tr><td align="left"><tt class="constant">sambaLogonTime</tt></td><td align="justify">Integer value currently unused</td></tr><tr><td align="left"><tt class="constant">sambaLogoffTime</tt></td><td align="justify">Integer value currently unused</td></tr><tr><td align="left"><tt class="constant">sambaKickoffTime</tt></td><td align="justify">Specifies the time (UNIX time format) when the user + will be locked down and cannot login any longer. If this attribute is ommited, then the account will never expire. + If you use this attribute together with `shadowExpire' of the `shadowAccount' objectClass, will enable accounts to + expire completly on an exact date.</td></tr><tr><td align="left"><tt class="constant">sambaPwdCanChange</tt></td><td align="justify">Specifies the time (UNIX time format) from which on the user is allowed to + change his password. If attribute is not set, the user will be free to change his password whenever he wants.</td></tr><tr><td align="left"><tt class="constant">sambaPwdMustChange</tt></td><td align="justify">Specifies the time (UNIX time format) since when the user is + forced to change his password. If this value is set to `0', the user will have to change his password at first login. + If this attribute is not set, then the password will never expire.</td></tr><tr><td align="left"><tt class="constant">sambaHomeDrive</tt></td><td align="justify">Specifies the drive letter to which to map the + UNC path specified by sambaHomePath. The drive letter must be specified in the form “<span class="quote">X:</span>” + where X is the letter of the drive to map. Refer to the “<span class="quote">logon drive</span>” parameter in the + smb.conf(5) man page for more information.</td></tr><tr><td align="left"><tt class="constant">sambaLogonScript</tt></td><td align="justify">The sambaLogonScript property specifies the path of + the user's logon script, .CMD, .EXE, or .BAT file. The string can be null. The path + is relative to the netlogon share. Refer to the <a class="indexterm" name="id2907136"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>logon script</tt></i> parameter in the + <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> man page for more information.</td></tr><tr><td align="left"><tt class="constant">sambaProfilePath</tt></td><td align="justify">Specifies a path to the user's profile. + This value can be a null string, a local absolute path, or a UNC path. Refer to the + <a class="indexterm" name="id2907170"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>logon path</tt></i> parameter in the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> man page for more information.</td></tr><tr><td align="left"><tt class="constant">sambaHomePath</tt></td><td align="justify">The sambaHomePath property specifies the path of + the home directory for the user. The string can be null. If sambaHomeDrive is set and specifies + a drive letter, sambaHomePath should be a UNC path. The path must be a network + UNC path of the form <tt class="filename">\\server\share\directory</tt>. This value can be a null string. + Refer to the <b class="command">logon home</b> parameter in the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> man page for more information. + </td></tr></tbody></table></div><p> + </p><p> + </p><div class="table"><a name="attribobjclPartB"></a><p class="title"><b>Table 11.2. Attributes in the sambaSamAccount objectclass (LDAP) Part B</b></p><table summary="Attributes in the sambaSamAccount objectclass (LDAP) Part B" border="1"><colgroup><col align="left"><col align="justify"></colgroup><tbody><tr><td align="left"><tt class="constant">sambaUserWorkstations</tt></td><td align="justify">Here you can give a comma-seperated list of machines + on which the user is allowed to login. You may observe problems when you try to connect to an Samba Domain Member. + Bacause Domain Members are not in this list, the Domain Controllers will reject them. Where this attribute is ommited, + the default implies no restrictions. + </td></tr><tr><td align="left"><tt class="constant">sambaSID</tt></td><td align="justify">The security identifier(SID) of the user. + The Windows equivalent of UNIX UIDs.</td></tr><tr><td align="left"><tt class="constant">sambaPrimaryGroupSID</tt></td><td align="justify">The Security IDentifier (SID) of the primary group + of the user.</td></tr><tr><td align="left"><tt class="constant">sambaDomainName</tt></td><td align="justify">Domain the user is part of.</td></tr></tbody></table></div><p> + </p><p> + The majority of these parameters are only used when Samba is acting as a PDC of + a domain (refer to <link linkend="samba-pdc">, for details on + how to configure Samba as a Primary Domain Controller). The following four attributes + are only stored with the sambaSamAccount entry if the values are non-default values: + </p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li>sambaHomePath</li><li>sambaLogonScript</li><li>sambaProfilePath</li><li>sambaHomeDrive</li></ul></div><p> + These attributes are only stored with the sambaSamAccount entry if + the values are non-default values. For example, assume MORIA has now been + configured as a PDC and that <a class="indexterm" name="id2907374"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>logon home</tt></i> = \\%L\%u was defined in + its <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file. When a user named “<span class="quote">becky</span>” logons to the domain, + the <a class="indexterm" name="id2907399"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>logon home</tt></i> string is expanded to \\MORIA\becky. + If the smbHome attribute exists in the entry “<span class="quote">uid=becky,ou=People,dc=samba,dc=org</span>”, + this value is used. However, if this attribute does not exist, then the value + of the <a class="indexterm" name="id2907421"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>logon home</tt></i> parameter is used in its place. Samba + will only write the attribute value to the directory entry if the value is + something other than the default (e.g., <tt class="filename">\\MOBY\becky</tt>). + </p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2907447"></a>Example LDIF Entries for a sambaSamAccount</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> + The following is a working LDIF that demonstrates the use of the SambaSamAccount objectclass: + </p><p> + </p><pre class="programlisting"> + dn: uid=guest2, ou=People,dc=quenya,dc=org + sambaLMPassword: 878D8014606CDA29677A44EFA1353FC7 + sambaPwdMustChange: 2147483647 + sambaPrimaryGroupSID: S-1-5-21-2447931902-1787058256-3961074038-513 + sambaNTPassword: 552902031BEDE9EFAAD3B435B51404EE + sambaPwdLastSet: 1010179124 + sambaLogonTime: 0 + objectClass: sambaSamAccount + uid: guest2 + sambaKickoffTime: 2147483647 + sambaAcctFlags: [UX ] + sambaLogoffTime: 2147483647 + sambaSID: S-1-5-21-2447931902-1787058256-3961074038-5006 + sambaPwdCanChange: 0 + </pre><p> + </p><p> + The following is an LDIF entry for using both the sambaSamAccount and + posixAccount objectclasses: + </p><p> + </p><pre class="programlisting"> + dn: uid=gcarter, ou=People,dc=quenya,dc=org + sambaLogonTime: 0 + displayName: Gerald Carter + sambaLMPassword: 552902031BEDE9EFAAD3B435B51404EE + sambaPrimaryGroupSID: S-1-5-21-2447931902-1787058256-3961074038-1201 + objectClass: posixAccount + objectClass: sambaSamAccount + sambaAcctFlags: [UX ] + userPassword: {crypt}BpM2ej8Rkzogo + uid: gcarter + uidNumber: 9000 + cn: Gerald Carter + loginShell: /bin/bash + logoffTime: 2147483647 + gidNumber: 100 + sambaKickoffTime: 2147483647 + sambaPwdLastSet: 1010179230 + sambaSID: S-1-5-21-2447931902-1787058256-3961074038-5004 + homeDirectory: /home/moria/gcarter + sambaPwdCanChange: 0 + sambaPwdMustChange: 2147483647 + sambaNTPassword: 878D8014606CDA29677A44EFA1353FC7 +</pre><p> + </p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2907513"></a>Password Synchronization</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> + Samba-3 and later can update the non-samba (LDAP) password stored with an account. When + using pam_ldap, this allows changing both UNIX and Windows passwords at once. + </p><p>The <a class="indexterm" name="id2907531"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>ldap passwd sync</tt></i> options can have the values shown in + <link linkend="ldappwsync">.</p><div class="table"><a name="ldappwsync"></a><p class="title"><b>Table 11.3. Possible <span class="emphasis"><em>ldap passwd sync</em></span> values</b></p><table summary="Possible ldap passwd sync values" border="1"><colgroup><col align="left"><col align="justify"></colgroup><thead><tr><th align="left">Value</th><th align="center">Description</th></tr></thead><tbody><tr><td align="left">yes</td><td align="justify"><p>When the user changes his password, update + <tt class="constant">ntPassword</tt>, <tt class="constant">lmPassword</tt> + and the <tt class="constant">password</tt> fields.</p></td></tr><tr><td align="left">no</td><td align="justify"><p>Only update <tt class="constant">ntPassword</tt> and <tt class="constant">lmPassword</tt>.</p></td></tr><tr><td align="left">only</td><td align="justify"><p>Only update the LDAP password and let the LDAP server worry about the other fields. + This option is only available on some LDAP servers. Only when the LDAP server + supports LDAP_EXOP_X_MODIFY_PASSWD.</p></td></tr></tbody></table></div><p>More information can be found in the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> manpage.</p></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2907687"></a>MySQL</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2907698"></a> + Every so often someone will come along with a great new idea. Storing user accounts in a + SQL backend is one of them. Those who want to do this are in the best position to know what the + specific benefits are to them. This may sound like a cop-out, but in truth we cannot attempt + to document every little detail why certain things of marginal utility to the bulk of + Samba users might make sense to the rest. In any case, the following instructions should help + the determined SQL user to implement a working system. + </p><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2907730"></a>Creating the Database</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> + You can set up your own table and specify the field names to pdb_mysql (see below + for the column names) or use the default table. The file <tt class="filename">examples/pdb/mysql/mysql.dump</tt> + contains the correct queries to create the required tables. Use the command: + +</p><pre class="screen"> +<tt class="prompt">$ </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>mysql -u<i class="replaceable"><tt>username</tt></i> -h<i class="replaceable"><tt>hostname</tt></i> -p<i class="replaceable"><tt>password</tt></i> \ + <i class="replaceable"><tt>databasename</tt></i> < <tt class="filename">/path/to/samba/examples/pdb/mysql/mysql.dump</tt></tt></b> +</pre><p> + </p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2907797"></a>Configuring</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p>This plugin lacks some good documentation, but here is some brief infoormation. Add the following to the + <a class="indexterm" name="id2907808"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>passdb backend</tt></i> variable in your <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt>: +</p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>passdb backend = [other-plugins] mysql:identifier [other-plugins]</tt></i></td></tr></table><p> + </p><p>The identifier can be any string you like, as long as it does not collide with + the identifiers of other plugins or other instances of pdb_mysql. If you + specify multiple pdb_mysql.so entries in <a class="indexterm" name="id2907852"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>passdb backend</tt></i>, you also need to + use different identifiers. + </p><p> + Additional options can be given through the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file in the <i class="parameter"><tt>[global]</tt></i> section. + Refer to <link linkend="mysqlpbe">. + </p><div class="table"><a name="mysqlpbe"></a><p class="title"><b>Table 11.4. Basic smb.conf options for MySQL passdb backend</b></p><table summary="Basic smb.conf options for MySQL passdb backend" border="1"><colgroup><col align="left"><col align="justify"></colgroup><thead><tr><th align="left">Field</th><th align="justify">Contents</th></tr></thead><tbody><tr><td align="left">mysql host</td><td align="justify">Host name, defaults to `localhost'</td></tr><tr><td align="left">mysql password</td><td align="justify"> </td></tr><tr><td align="left">mysql user</td><td align="justify">Defaults to `samba'</td></tr><tr><td align="left">mysql database</td><td align="justify">Defaults to `samba'</td></tr><tr><td align="left">mysql port</td><td align="justify">Defaults to 3306</td></tr><tr><td align="left">table</td><td align="justify">Name of the table containing the users</td></tr></tbody></table></div><div class="warning" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Warning</h3><p> + Since the password for the MySQL user is stored in the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file, you should make the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file + readable only to the user who runs Samba. This is considered a security bug and will soon be fixed. + </p></div><p>Names of the columns are given in <link linkend="moremysqlpdbe">. The default column names can be found in the example table dump. + </p><p> + </p><div class="table"><a name="moremysqlpdbe"></a><p class="title"><b>Table 11.5. MySQL field names for MySQL passdb backend</b></p><table summary="MySQL field names for MySQL passdb backend" border="1"><colgroup><col align="left"><col align="left"><col align="justify"></colgroup><thead><tr><th align="left">Field</th><th align="left">Type</th><th align="justify">Contents</th></tr></thead><tbody><tr><td align="left">logon time column</td><td align="left">int(9)</td><td align="justify">UNIX time stamp of last logon of user</td></tr><tr><td align="left">logoff time column</td><td align="left">int(9)</td><td align="justify">UNIX time stamp of last logoff of user</td></tr><tr><td align="left">kickoff time column</td><td align="left">int(9)</td><td align="justify">UNIX time stamp of moment user should be kicked off workstation (not enforced)</td></tr><tr><td align="left">pass last set time column</td><td align="left">int(9)</td><td align="justify">UNIX time stamp of moment password was last set</td></tr><tr><td align="left">pass can change time column</td><td align="left">int(9)</td><td align="justify">UNIX time stamp of moment from which password can be changed</td></tr><tr><td align="left">pass must change time column</td><td align="left">int(9)</td><td align="justify">UNIX time stamp of moment on which password must be changed</td></tr><tr><td align="left">username column</td><td align="left">varchar(255)</td><td align="justify">UNIX username</td></tr><tr><td align="left">domain column</td><td align="left">varchar(255)</td><td align="justify">NT domain user belongs to</td></tr><tr><td align="left">nt username column</td><td align="left">varchar(255)</td><td align="justify">NT username</td></tr><tr><td align="left">fullname column</td><td align="left">varchar(255)</td><td align="justify">Full name of user</td></tr><tr><td align="left">home dir column</td><td align="left">varchar(255)</td><td align="justify">UNIX homedir path</td></tr><tr><td align="left">dir drive column</td><td align="left">varchar(2)</td><td align="justify">Directory drive path (e.g., “<span class="quote">H:</span>”)</td></tr><tr><td align="left">logon script column</td><td align="left">varchar(255)</td><td align="justify">Batch file to run on client side when logging on</td></tr><tr><td align="left">profile path column</td><td align="left">varchar(255)</td><td align="justify">Path of profile</td></tr><tr><td align="left">acct desc column</td><td align="left">varchar(255)</td><td align="justify">Some ASCII NT user data</td></tr><tr><td align="left">workstations column</td><td align="left">varchar(255)</td><td align="justify">Workstations user can logon to (or NULL for all)</td></tr><tr><td align="left">unknown string column</td><td align="left">varchar(255)</td><td align="justify">Unknown string</td></tr><tr><td align="left">munged dial column</td><td align="left">varchar(255)</td><td align="justify">Unknown</td></tr><tr><td align="left">user sid column</td><td align="left">varchar(255)</td><td align="justify">NT user SID</td></tr><tr><td align="left">group sid column</td><td align="left">varchar(255)</td><td align="justify">NT group SID</td></tr><tr><td align="left">lanman pass column</td><td align="left">varchar(255)</td><td align="justify">Encrypted lanman password</td></tr><tr><td align="left">nt pass column</td><td align="left">varchar(255)</td><td align="justify">Encrypted nt passwd</td></tr><tr><td align="left">plain pass column</td><td align="left">varchar(255)</td><td align="justify">Plaintext password</td></tr><tr><td align="left">acct ctrl column</td><td align="left">int(9)</td><td align="justify">NT user data</td></tr><tr><td align="left">unknown 3 column</td><td align="left">int(9)</td><td align="justify">Unknown</td></tr><tr><td align="left">logon divs column</td><td align="left">int(9)</td><td align="justify">Unknown</td></tr><tr><td align="left">hours len column</td><td align="left">int(9)</td><td align="justify">Unknown</td></tr><tr><td align="left">bad password count column</td><td align="left">int(5)</td><td align="justify">Number of failed password tries before disabling an account</td></tr><tr><td align="left">logon count column</td><td align="left">int(5)</td><td align="justify">Number of logon attempts</td></tr><tr><td align="left">unknown 6 column</td><td align="left">int(9)</td><td align="justify">Unknown</td></tr></tbody></table></div><p> + </p><p> + You can put a colon (:) after the name of each column, which + should specify the column to update when updating the table. You can also + specify nothing behind the colon. Then the field data will not be updated. Setting a column name to <i class="parameter"><tt>NULL</tt></i> means the field should not be used. + </p><p>An example configuration can be found in <link linkend="mysqlsam">. + </p><div class="example"><a name="mysqlsam"></a><p class="title"><b>Example 11.3. Example configuration for the MySQL passdb backend</b></p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td> </td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>[global]</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>passdb backend = mysql:foo</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>foo:mysql user = samba</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>foo:mysql password = abmas</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>foo:mysql database = samba</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td># domain name is static and can't be changed</td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>foo:domain column = 'MYWORKGROUP':</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td># The fullname column comes from several other columns</td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>foo:fullname column = CONCAT(firstname,' ',surname):</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td># Samba should never write to the password columns</td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>foo:lanman pass column = lm_pass:</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>foo:nt pass column = nt_pass:</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td># The unknown 3 column is not stored</td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>foo:unknown 3 column = NULL</tt></i></td></tr></table></div></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2908611"></a>Using Plaintext Passwords or Encrypted Password</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2908623"></a> + I strongly discourage the use of plaintext passwords, however, you can use them. + </p><p> + If you would like to use plaintext passwords, set + `identifier:lanman pass column' and `identifier:nt pass column' to + `NULL' (without the quotes) and `identifier:plain pass column' to the + name of the column containing the plaintext passwords. + </p><p> + If you use encrypted passwords, set the 'identifier:plain pass + column' to 'NULL' (without the quotes). This is the default. + </p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2908650"></a>Getting Non-Column Data from the Table</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> + It is possible to have not all data in the database by making some `constant'. + </p><p> + For example, you can set `identifier:fullname column' to + something like <b class="command">CONCAT(Firstname,' ',Surname)</b> + </p><p> + Or, set `identifier:workstations column' to: + <b class="command">NULL</b></p><p>See the MySQL documentation for more language constructs.</p></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="XMLpassdb"></a>XML</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2908711"></a> + This module requires libxml2 to be installed.</p><p>The usage of pdb_xml is fairly straightforward. To export data, use: + </p><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2908732"></a> + <tt class="prompt">$ </tt> <b class="userinput"><tt>pdbedit -e xml:filename</tt></b> + </p><p> + (where filename is the name of the file to put the data in) + </p><p> + To import data, use: + <tt class="prompt">$ </tt> <b class="userinput"><tt>pdbedit -i xml:filename</tt></b> + </p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2908781"></a>Common Errors</h2></div></div><div></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2908788"></a>Users Cannot Logon</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>“<span class="quote">I've installed Samba, but now I can't log on with my UNIX account! </span>”</p><p>Make sure your user has been added to the current Samba <a class="indexterm" name="id2908806"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>passdb backend</tt></i>. Read the section <link linkend="acctmgmttools"> for details.</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2908830"></a>Users Being Added to the Wrong Backend Database</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + A few complaints have been received from users that just moved to Samba-3. The following + <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file entries were causing problems, new accounts were being added to the old + smbpasswd file, not to the tdbsam passdb.tdb file: + </p><p> + </p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td> </td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>[global]</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td>...</td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>passdb backend = smbpasswd, tdbsam</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td>...</td></tr></table><p> + </p><p> + Samba will add new accounts to the first entry in the <span class="emphasis"><em>passdb backend</em></span> + parameter entry. If you want to update to the tdbsam, then change the entry to: + </p><p> +</p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>passdb backend = tdbsam, smbpasswd</tt></i></td></tr></table><p> + </p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2908922"></a>Configuration of <i class="parameter"><tt>auth methods</tt></i></h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + When explicitly setting an <a class="indexterm" name="id2908940"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>auth methods</tt></i> parameter, + <i class="parameter"><tt>guest</tt></i> must be specified as the first entry on the line, + for example, <a class="indexterm" name="id2908962"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>auth methods</tt></i> = guest sam. + </p><p> + This is the exact opposite of the requirement for the <a class="indexterm" name="id2908981"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>passdb backend</tt></i> + option, where it must be the <span class="emphasis"><em>LAST</em></span> parameter on the line. + </p></div></div></div><div class="navfooter"><hr><table width="100%" summary="Navigation footer"><tr><td width="40%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="NetworkBrowsing.html">Prev</a> </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="u" href="optional.html">Up</a></td><td width="40%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="groupmapping.html">Next</a></td></tr><tr><td width="40%" align="left" valign="top">Chapter 10. Network Browsing </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="h" href="index.html">Home</a></td><td width="40%" align="right" valign="top"> Chapter 12. Group Mapping MS Windows and UNIX</td></tr></table></div></body></html> diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/pr01.html b/docs/htmldocs/pr01.html new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..f0ce4c3d3d --- /dev/null +++ b/docs/htmldocs/pr01.html @@ -0,0 +1,5 @@ +<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>Legal Notice</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.60.1"><link rel="home" href="index.html" title="SAMBA Project Documentation"><link rel="up" href="index.html" title="SAMBA Project Documentation"><link rel="previous" href="index.html" title="SAMBA Project Documentation"><link rel="next" href="pr02.html" title="Attributions"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="navheader"><table width="100%" summary="Navigation header"><tr><th colspan="3" align="center">Legal Notice</th></tr><tr><td width="20%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="index.html">Prev</a> </td><th width="60%" align="center"> </th><td width="20%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="pr02.html">Next</a></td></tr></table><hr></div><div class="preface" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="id2817733"></a>Legal Notice</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +This documentation is distributed under the GNU General Public License (GPL) +version 2. A copy of the license is included with the Samba source +distribution. A copy can be found on-line at <ulink url="http://www.fsf.org/licenses/gpl.txt">http://www.fsf.org/licenses/gpl.txt</ulink> +</p></div><div class="navfooter"><hr><table width="100%" summary="Navigation footer"><tr><td width="40%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="index.html">Prev</a> </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="u" href="index.html">Up</a></td><td width="40%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="pr02.html">Next</a></td></tr><tr><td width="40%" align="left" valign="top">SAMBA Project Documentation </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="h" href="index.html">Home</a></td><td width="40%" align="right" valign="top"> Attributions</td></tr></table></div></body></html> diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/pr02.html b/docs/htmldocs/pr02.html new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..080c1c2075 --- /dev/null +++ b/docs/htmldocs/pr02.html @@ -0,0 +1 @@ +<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>Attributions</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.60.1"><link rel="home" href="index.html" title="SAMBA Project Documentation"><link rel="up" href="index.html" title="SAMBA Project Documentation"><link rel="previous" href="pr01.html" title="Legal Notice"><link rel="next" href="introduction.html" title="Part I. General Installation"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="navheader"><table width="100%" summary="Navigation header"><tr><th colspan="3" align="center">Attributions</th></tr><tr><td width="20%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="pr01.html">Prev</a> </td><th width="60%" align="center"> </th><td width="20%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="introduction.html">Next</a></td></tr></table><hr></div><div class="preface" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="id2817756"></a>Attributions</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p><link linkend="IntroSMB"></p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>David Lechnyr <<ulink url="mailto:david@lechnyr.com">david@lechnyr.com</ulink>></p></li></ul></div><p><link linkend="install"></p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Andrew Tridgell <<ulink url="mailto:tridge@samba.org">tridge@samba.org</ulink>></p></li><li><p>Jelmer R. Vernooij <<ulink url="mailto:jelmer@samba.org">jelmer@samba.org</ulink>></p></li><li><p>John H. Terpstra <<ulink url="mailto:jht@samba.org">jht@samba.org</ulink>></p></li><li><p>Karl Auer <<ulink url="mailto:kauer@biplane.com.au">kauer@biplane.com.au</ulink>></p></li><li><p>Dan Shearer <<ulink url="mailto:dan@samba.org">dan@samba.org</ulink>></p></li></ul></div><p><link linkend="FastStart"></p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>John H. Terpstra <<ulink url="mailto:jht@samba.org">jht@samba.org</ulink>></p></li></ul></div><p><link linkend="ServerType"></p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Andrew Tridgell <<ulink url="mailto:tridge@samba.org">tridge@samba.org</ulink>></p></li><li><p>Jelmer R. Vernooij <<ulink url="mailto:jelmer@samba.org">jelmer@samba.org</ulink>></p></li><li><p>John H. Terpstra <<ulink url="mailto:jht@samba.org">jht@samba.org</ulink>></p></li></ul></div><p><link linkend="samba-pdc"></p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>John H. Terpstra <<ulink url="mailto:jht@samba.org">jht@samba.org</ulink>></p></li><li><p>Gerald (Jerry) Carter <<ulink url="mailto:jerry@samba.org">jerry@samba.org</ulink>></p></li><li><p>David Bannon <<ulink url="mailto:dbannon@samba.org">dbannon@samba.org</ulink>></p></li><li><p>Guenther Deschner <<ulink url="mailto:gd@suse.de">gd@suse.de</ulink>> (LDAP updates) </p></li></ul></div><p><link linkend="samba-bdc"></p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>John H. Terpstra <<ulink url="mailto:jht@samba.org">jht@samba.org</ulink>></p></li><li><p>Volker Lendecke <<ulink url="mailto:Volker.Lendecke@SerNet.DE">Volker.Lendecke@SerNet.DE</ulink>></p></li><li><p>Guenther Deschner <<ulink url="mailto:gd@suse.de">gd@suse.de</ulink>> (LDAP updates) </p></li></ul></div><p><link linkend="domain-member"></p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>John H. Terpstra <<ulink url="mailto:jht@samba.org">jht@samba.org</ulink>></p></li><li><p>Jeremy Allison <<ulink url="mailto:jra@samba.org">jra@samba.org</ulink>></p></li><li><p>Gerald (Jerry) Carter <<ulink url="mailto:jerry@samba.org">jerry@samba.org</ulink>></p></li><li><p>Andrew Tridgell <<ulink url="mailto:tridge@samba.org">tridge@samba.org</ulink>></p></li><li><p>Jelmer R. Vernooij <<ulink url="mailto:jelmer@samba.org">jelmer@samba.org</ulink>></p></li><li><p>Guenther Deschner <<ulink url="mailto:gd@suse.de">gd@suse.de</ulink>> (LDAP updates) </p></li></ul></div><p><link linkend="StandAloneServer"></p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>John H. Terpstra <<ulink url="mailto:jht@samba.org">jht@samba.org</ulink>></p></li></ul></div><p><link linkend="ClientConfig"></p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>John H. Terpstra <<ulink url="mailto:jht@samba.org">jht@samba.org</ulink>></p></li></ul></div><p><link linkend="NetworkBrowsing"></p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>John H. Terpstra <<ulink url="mailto:jht@samba.org">jht@samba.org</ulink>></p></li><li><p>Jelmer R. Vernooij <<ulink url="mailto:jelmer@samba.org">jelmer@samba.org</ulink>></p></li></ul></div><p><link linkend="passdb"></p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Jelmer R. Vernooij <<ulink url="mailto:jelmer@samba.org">jelmer@samba.org</ulink>></p></li><li><p>John H. Terpstra <<ulink url="mailto:jht@samba.org">jht@samba.org</ulink>></p></li><li><p>Gerald (Jerry) Carter <<ulink url="mailto:jerry@samba.org">jerry@samba.org</ulink>></p></li><li><p>Jeremy Allison <<ulink url="mailto:jra@samba.org">jra@samba.org</ulink>></p></li><li><p>Guenther Deschner <<ulink url="mailto:gd@suse.de">gd@suse.de</ulink>> (LDAP updates) </p></li><li><p>Olivier (lem) Lemaire <<ulink url="mailto:olem@IDEALX.org">olem@IDEALX.org</ulink>></p></li></ul></div><p><link linkend="groupmapping"></p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>John H. Terpstra <<ulink url="mailto:jht@samba.org">jht@samba.org</ulink>></p></li><li><p>Jean François Micouleau</p></li><li><p>Gerald (Jerry) Carter <<ulink url="mailto:jerry@samba.org">jerry@samba.org</ulink>></p></li></ul></div><p><link linkend="AccessControls"></p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>John H. Terpstra <<ulink url="mailto:jht@samba.org">jht@samba.org</ulink>></p></li><li><p>Jeremy Allison <<ulink url="mailto:jra@samba.org">jra@samba.org</ulink>></p></li><li><p>Jelmer R. Vernooij <<ulink url="mailto:jelmer@samba.org">jelmer@samba.org</ulink>> (drawing) </p></li></ul></div><p><link linkend="locking"></p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Jeremy Allison <<ulink url="mailto:jra@samba.org">jra@samba.org</ulink>></p></li><li><p>Jelmer R. Vernooij <<ulink url="mailto:jelmer@samba.org">jelmer@samba.org</ulink>></p></li><li><p>John H. Terpstra <<ulink url="mailto:jht@samba.org">jht@samba.org</ulink>></p></li><li><p>Eric Roseme <<ulink url="mailto:eric.roseme@hp.com">eric.roseme@hp.com</ulink>></p></li></ul></div><p><link linkend="securing-samba"></p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Andrew Tridgell <<ulink url="mailto:tridge@samba.org">tridge@samba.org</ulink>></p></li><li><p>John H. Terpstra <<ulink url="mailto:jht@samba.org">jht@samba.org</ulink>></p></li></ul></div><p><link linkend="InterdomainTrusts"></p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>John H. Terpstra <<ulink url="mailto:jht@samba.org">jht@samba.org</ulink>></p></li><li><p>Rafal Szczesniak <<ulink url="mailto:mimir@samba.org">mimir@samba.org</ulink>></p></li><li><p>Jelmer R. Vernooij <<ulink url="mailto:jelmer@samba.org">jelmer@samba.org</ulink>> (drawing) </p></li><li><p>Stephen Langasek <<ulink url="mailto:vorlon@netexpress.net">vorlon@netexpress.net</ulink>></p></li></ul></div><p><link linkend="msdfs"></p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Shirish Kalele <<ulink url="mailto:samba@samba.org">samba@samba.org</ulink>></p></li><li><p>John H. Terpstra <<ulink url="mailto:jht@samba.org">jht@samba.org</ulink>></p></li></ul></div><p><link linkend="printing"></p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Kurt Pfeifle <<ulink url="mailto:kpfeifle@danka.de">kpfeifle@danka.de</ulink>></p></li><li><p>Gerald (Jerry) Carter <<ulink url="mailto:jerry@samba.org">jerry@samba.org</ulink>></p></li><li><p>John H. Terpstra <<ulink url="mailto:jht@samba.org">jht@samba.org</ulink>></p></li></ul></div><p><link linkend="CUPS-printing"></p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Kurt Pfeifle <<ulink url="mailto:kpfeifle@danka.de">kpfeifle@danka.de</ulink>></p></li><li><p>Ciprian Vizitiu <<ulink url="mailto:CVizitiu@gbif.org">CVizitiu@gbif.org</ulink>> (drawings) </p></li><li><p>Jelmer R. Vernooij <<ulink url="mailto:jelmer@samba.org">jelmer@samba.org</ulink>> (drawings) </p></li></ul></div><p><link linkend="VFS"></p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Jelmer R. Vernooij <<ulink url="mailto:jelmer@samba.org">jelmer@samba.org</ulink>></p></li><li><p>John H. Terpstra <<ulink url="mailto:jht@samba.org">jht@samba.org</ulink>></p></li><li><p>Tim Potter <<ulink url="mailto:tpot@samba.org">tpot@samba.org</ulink>></p></li><li><p>Simo Sorce (original vfs_skel README) </p></li><li><p>Alexander Bokovoy (original vfs_netatalk docs) </p></li><li><p>Stefan Metzmacher (Update for multiple modules) </p></li></ul></div><p><link linkend="winbind"></p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Tim Potter <<ulink url="mailto:tpot@linuxcare.com.au">tpot@linuxcare.com.au</ulink>></p></li><li><p>Andrew Tridgell <<ulink url="mailto:tridge@samba.org">tridge@samba.org</ulink>></p></li><li><p>Naag Mummaneni <<ulink url="mailto:getnag@rediffmail.com">getnag@rediffmail.com</ulink>> (Notes for Solaris) </p></li><li><p>John Trostel <<ulink url="mailto:jtrostel@snapserver.com">jtrostel@snapserver.com</ulink>></p></li><li><p>Jelmer R. Vernooij <<ulink url="mailto:jelmer@samba.org">jelmer@samba.org</ulink>></p></li><li><p>John H. Terpstra <<ulink url="mailto:jht@samba.org">jht@samba.org</ulink>></p></li></ul></div><p><link linkend="AdvancedNetworkManagement"></p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>John H. Terpstra <<ulink url="mailto:jht@samba.org">jht@samba.org</ulink>></p></li></ul></div><p><link linkend="PolicyMgmt"></p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>John H. Terpstra <<ulink url="mailto:jht@samba.org">jht@samba.org</ulink>></p></li></ul></div><p><link linkend="ProfileMgmt"></p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>John H. Terpstra <<ulink url="mailto:jht@samba.org">jht@samba.org</ulink>></p></li></ul></div><p><link linkend="pam"></p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>John H. Terpstra <<ulink url="mailto:jht@samba.org">jht@samba.org</ulink>></p></li><li><p>Stephen Langasek <<ulink url="mailto:vorlon@netexpress.net">vorlon@netexpress.net</ulink>></p></li></ul></div><p><link linkend="integrate-ms-networks"></p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>John H. Terpstra <<ulink url="mailto:jht@samba.org">jht@samba.org</ulink>></p></li></ul></div><p><link linkend="unicode"></p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Jelmer R. Vernooij <<ulink url="mailto:jelmer@samba.org">jelmer@samba.org</ulink>></p></li><li><p>John H. Terpstra <<ulink url="mailto:jht@samba.org">jht@samba.org</ulink>></p></li><li><p>TAKAHASHI Motonobu <<ulink url="mailto:monyo@home.monyo.com">monyo@home.monyo.com</ulink>></p></li></ul></div><p><link linkend="Backup"></p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>John H. Terpstra <<ulink url="mailto:jht@samba.org">jht@samba.org</ulink>></p></li></ul></div><p><link linkend="SambaHA"></p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>John H. Terpstra <<ulink url="mailto:jht@samba.org">jht@samba.org</ulink>></p></li></ul></div><p><link linkend="upgrading-to-3.0"></p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Jelmer R. Vernooij <<ulink url="mailto:jelmer@samba.org">jelmer@samba.org</ulink>></p></li><li><p>John H. Terpstra <<ulink url="mailto:jht@samba.org">jht@samba.org</ulink>></p></li><li><p>Gerald (Jerry) Carter <<ulink url="mailto:jerry@samba.org">jerry@samba.org</ulink>></p></li></ul></div><p><link linkend="NT4Migration"></p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>John H. Terpstra <<ulink url="mailto:jht@samba.org">jht@samba.org</ulink>></p></li></ul></div><p><link linkend="SWAT"></p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>John H. Terpstra <<ulink url="mailto:jht@samba.org">jht@samba.org</ulink>></p></li></ul></div><p><link linkend="diagnosis"></p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Andrew Tridgell <<ulink url="mailto:tridge@samba.org">tridge@samba.org</ulink>></p></li><li><p>Jelmer R. Vernooij <<ulink url="mailto:jelmer@samba.org">jelmer@samba.org</ulink>></p></li><li><p>Dan Shearer <<ulink url="mailto:dan@samba.org">dan@samba.org</ulink>></p></li></ul></div><p><link linkend="problems"></p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Gerald (Jerry) Carter <<ulink url="mailto:jerry@samba.org">jerry@samba.org</ulink>></p></li><li><p>Jelmer R. Vernooij <<ulink url="mailto:jelmer@samba.org">jelmer@samba.org</ulink>></p></li><li><p>David Bannon <<ulink url="mailto:dbannon@samba.org">dbannon@samba.org</ulink>></p></li><li><p>Dan Shearer <<ulink url="mailto:dan@samba.org">dan@samba.org</ulink>></p></li></ul></div><p><link linkend="bugreport"></p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>John H. Terpstra <<ulink url="mailto:jht@samba.org">jht@samba.org</ulink>></p></li><li><p>Jelmer R. Vernooij <<ulink url="mailto:jelmer@samba.org">jelmer@samba.org</ulink>></p></li><li><p>Andrew Tridgell <<ulink url="mailto:tridge@samba.org">tridge@samba.org</ulink>></p></li></ul></div><p><link linkend="compiling"></p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Jelmer R. Vernooij <<ulink url="mailto:jelmer@samba.org">jelmer@samba.org</ulink>></p></li><li><p>John H. Terpstra <<ulink url="mailto:jht@samba.org">jht@samba.org</ulink>></p></li><li><p>Andrew Tridgell <<ulink url="mailto:tridge@samba.org">tridge@samba.org</ulink>></p></li></ul></div><p><link linkend="Portability"></p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Jelmer R. Vernooij <<ulink url="mailto:jelmer@samba.org">jelmer@samba.org</ulink>></p></li><li><p>John H. Terpstra <<ulink url="mailto:jht@samba.org">jht@samba.org</ulink>></p></li></ul></div><p><link linkend="Other-Clients"></p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Jelmer R. Vernooij <<ulink url="mailto:jelmer@samba.org">jelmer@samba.org</ulink>></p></li><li><p>John H. Terpstra <<ulink url="mailto:jht@samba.org">jht@samba.org</ulink>></p></li><li><p>Dan Shearer <<ulink url="mailto:dan@samba.org">dan@samba.org</ulink>></p></li><li><p>Jim McDonough <<ulink url="mailto:jmcd@us.ibm.com">jmcd@us.ibm.com</ulink>> (OS/2) </p></li></ul></div><p><link linkend="speed"></p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Paul Cochrane <<ulink url="mailto:paulc@dth.scot.nhs.uk">paulc@dth.scot.nhs.uk</ulink>></p></li><li><p>Jelmer R. Vernooij <<ulink url="mailto:jelmer@samba.org">jelmer@samba.org</ulink>></p></li><li><p>John H. Terpstra <<ulink url="mailto:jht@samba.org">jht@samba.org</ulink>></p></li></ul></div><p><link linkend="DNSDHCP"></p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>John H. Terpstra <<ulink url="mailto:jht@samba.org">jht@samba.org</ulink>></p></li></ul></div><p><link linkend="Further-Resources"></p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Jelmer R. Vernooij <<ulink url="mailto:jelmer@samba.org">jelmer@samba.org</ulink>></p></li></ul></div></div><div class="navfooter"><hr><table width="100%" summary="Navigation footer"><tr><td width="40%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="pr01.html">Prev</a> </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="u" href="index.html">Up</a></td><td width="40%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="introduction.html">Next</a></td></tr><tr><td width="40%" align="left" valign="top">Legal Notice </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="h" href="index.html">Home</a></td><td width="40%" align="right" valign="top"> Part I. General Installation</td></tr></table></div></body></html> diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/printing.html b/docs/htmldocs/printing.html new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..5e7bf473c0 --- /dev/null +++ b/docs/htmldocs/printing.html @@ -0,0 +1,1864 @@ +<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>Chapter 18. Classical Printing Support</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.60.1"><link rel="home" href="index.html" title="SAMBA Project Documentation"><link rel="up" href="optional.html" title="Part III. Advanced Configuration"><link rel="previous" href="msdfs.html" title="Chapter 17. Hosting a Microsoft Distributed File System tree on Samba"><link rel="next" href="CUPS-printing.html" title="Chapter 19. CUPS Printing Support"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="navheader"><table width="100%" summary="Navigation header"><tr><th colspan="3" align="center">Chapter 18. Classical Printing Support</th></tr><tr><td width="20%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="msdfs.html">Prev</a> </td><th width="60%" align="center">Part III. Advanced Configuration</th><td width="20%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="CUPS-printing.html">Next</a></td></tr></table><hr></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="printing"></a>Chapter 18. Classical Printing Support</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Kurt</span> <span class="surname">Pfeifle</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname"> Danka Deutschland GmbH <br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:kpfeifle@danka.de">kpfeifle@danka.de</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Gerald</span> <span class="othername">(Jerry)</span> <span class="surname">Carter</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jerry@samba.org">jerry@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">John</span> <span class="othername">H.</span> <span class="surname">Terpstra</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org">jht@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><p class="pubdate">May 31, 2003</p></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="printing.html#id2920666">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2920765">Technical Introduction</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="printing.html#id2920831">Client to Samba Print Job Processing</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2920903">Printing Related Configuration Parameters</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="printing.html#id2920998">Simple Print Configuration</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="printing.html#id2921211">Verifing Configuration with testparm</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2921327">Rapid Configuration Validation</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="printing.html#id2921667">Extended Printing Configuration</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="printing.html#id2922020">Detailed Explanation Settings</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="printing.html#id2924414">Printing Developments Since Samba-2.2</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="printing.html#id2924566">Point'n'Print Client Drivers on Samba Servers</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2924710">The Obsoleted [printer$] Section</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2924810">Creating the [print$] Share</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2925021">[print$] Section Parameters</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2925355">The [print$] Share Directory</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="printing.html#id2925525">Installing Drivers into [print$]</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="printing.html#id2925644">Add Printer Wizard Driver Installation</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#inst-rpc">Installing Print Drivers Using rpcclient</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="printing.html#id2927518">Client Driver Installation Procedure</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="printing.html#id2927537">First Client Driver Installation</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2927769">Setting Device Modes on New Printers</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2928112">Additional Client Driver Installation</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2928220">Always Make First Client Connection as root or printer admin</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="printing.html#id2928404">Other Gotchas</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="printing.html#id2928430">Setting Default Print Options for Client Drivers</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2928854">Supporting Large Numbers of Printers</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2929151">Adding New Printers with the Windows NT APW</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2929458">Error Message: Cannot connect under a different Name</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2929564">Take Care When Assembling Driver Files</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2929923">Samba and Printer Ports</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2930008">Avoiding Common Client Driver Misconfiguration</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="printing.html#id2930033">The Imprints Toolset</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="printing.html#id2930071">What is Imprints?</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2930113">Creating Printer Driver Packages</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2930132">The Imprints Server</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2930153">The Installation Client</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="printing.html#id2930314">Adding Network Printers without User Interaction</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2930639">The addprinter Command</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2930686">Migration of Classical Printing to Samba</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2930861">Publishing Printer Information in Active Directory or LDAP</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2930884">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="printing.html#id2930892">I Give My Root Password but I Do Not Get Access</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2930943">My Print Jobs Get Spooled into the Spooling Directory, but Then Get Lost</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2920666"></a>Features and Benefits</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +Printing is often a mission-critical service for the users. Samba can +provide this service reliably and seamlessly for a client network +consisting of Windows workstations. +</p><p> +A Samba print service may be run on a Stand-alone or Domain Member server, +side by side with file serving functions, or on a dedicated print server. +It can be made as tight or as loosely secured as needs dictate. Configurations +may be simple or complex. Available authentication schemes are essentially +the same as described for file services in previous chapters. Overall, +Samba's printing support is now able to replace an NT or Windows 2000 +print server full-square, with additional benefits in many cases. Clients +may download and install drivers and printers through their familiar +“<span class="quote">Point'n'Print</span>” mechanism. Printer installations executed by +“<span class="quote">Logon Scripts</span>” are no problem. Administrators can upload and +manage drivers to be used by clients through the familiar “<span class="quote">Add Printer +Wizard</span>”. As an additional benefit, driver and printer management may +be run from the command line or through scripts, making it more efficient +in case of large numbers of printers. If a central accounting of print jobs +(tracking every single page and supplying the raw data for all sorts of +statistical reports) is required, this function is best supported by +the newer Common UNIX Printing System (CUPS) +as the print subsystem underneath the Samba hood. +</p><p> +This chapter deals with the foundations of Samba printing as they +are implemented by the more traditional UNIX (BSD- and System V-style) +printing systems. Many things covered in this chapter apply also to CUPS. +If you use CUPS, you may be tempted +to jump to the next chapter but you will certainly miss a few things if +you do. It is recommended that you read this chapter as well as <link linkend="CUPS-printing">. +</p><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p> +Most of the following examples have been verified on Windows XP +Professional clients. Where this document describes the responses to +commands given, bear in mind that Windows 200x/XP clients are quite +similar, but may differ in minor details. Windows NT is somewhat different +again. +</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2920765"></a>Technical Introduction</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +Samba's printing support always relies on the installed print subsystem +of the UNIX OS it runs on. Samba is a “<span class="quote">middleman.</span>” It takes +print files from Windows (or other SMB) clients and passes them to the real +printing system for further processing, therefore, it needs to communicate with +both sides: the Windows print clients and the UNIX printing system. Hence, we +must differentiate between the various client OS types, each of which behave +differently, as well as the various UNIX print subsystems, which themselves +have different features and are accessed differently. +</p><p> +This deals with the traditional way of UNIX printing. The next chapter +covers in great detail the more modern <span class="emphasis"><em>Common UNIX Printing +System</em></span> (CUPS). +</p><div class="important" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Important</h3><p>CUPS users, be warned: do not just jump on to the next +chapter. You might miss important information only found here! +</p></div><p> +It is apparent from postings on the Samba mailing list that print configuration +is one of the most problematic aspects of Samba administration today. Many +new Samba administrators have the impression that Samba performs some sort +of print processing. Rest assured, Samba does not peform any type of print +processing. It does not do any form of print filtering. +</p><p> +Samba obtains from its clients a data stream (print job) that it spools to a +local spool area. When the entire print job has been received, Samba invokes +a local UNIX/Linux print command and passes the spooled file to it. It is +up to the local system printing subsystems to correctly process the print +job and to submit it to the printer. +</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2920831"></a>Client to Samba Print Job Processing</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +Successful printing from a Windows client via a Samba print server to a UNIX +printer involves six (potentially seven) stages: +</p><div class="orderedlist"><ol type="1"><li><p>Windows opens a connection to the printer share.</p></li><li><p>Samba must authenticate the user.</p></li><li><p>Windows sends a copy of the print file over the network +into Samba's spooling area.</p></li><li><p>Windows closes the connection.</p></li><li><p>Samba invokes the print command to hand the file over +to the UNIX print subsystem's spooling area.</p></li><li><p>The UNIX print subsystem processes the print job.</p></li><li><p>The print file may need to be explicitly deleted +from the Samba spooling area. This item depends on your print spooler +configuration settings.</p></li></ol></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2920903"></a>Printing Related Configuration Parameters</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +There are a number of configuration parameters to control Samba's +printing behavior. Please refer to the man page for <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> for an +overview of these. As with other parameters, there are Global Level +(tagged with a <span class="emphasis"><em>G</em></span> in the listings) and Service Level +(<span class="emphasis"><em>S</em></span>) parameters. +</p><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">Global Parameters</span></dt><dd><p> These <span class="emphasis"><em>may not</em></span> go into + individual share definitions. If they go in by error, + the <b class="command">testparm</b> utility can discover this + (if you run it) and tell you so. + </p></dd><dt><span class="term">Service Level Parameters</span></dt><dd><p> These may be specified in the + <i class="parameter"><tt>[global]</tt></i> section of <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt>. + In this case they define the default behavior of all individual + or service level shares (provided they do not have a different + setting defined for the same parameter, thus overriding the + global default). + </p></dd></dl></div></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2920998"></a>Simple Print Configuration</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +<link linkend="simpleprc"> shows a simple printing configuration. +If you compare this with your own, you may find +additional parameters that have been pre-configured by your OS +vendor. Below is a discussion and explanation of the +parameters. This example does not use many parameters. +However, in many environments these are enough to provide a valid +<tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file that enables all clients to print. +</p><p> +</p><div class="example"><a name="simpleprc"></a><p class="title"><b>Example 18.1. Simple configuration with BSD printing</b></p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td> </td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>[global]</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>printing = bsd</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>load printers = yes</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td> </td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>[printers]</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>path = /var/spool/samba</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>printable = yes</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>public = yes</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>writable = no</tt></i></td></tr></table></div><p> +This is only an example configuration. Samba assigns default values to +all configuration parameters. The defaults are conservative +and sensible. When a parameter is specified in the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file, this +overwrites the default value. The <b class="command">testparm</b> utility when +run as root is capable of reporting all setting, both default as well as +<tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file settings. <b class="command">Testparm</b> gives warnings for all +misconfigured settings. The complete output is easily 340 lines and more, +so you may want to pipe it through a pager program. +</p><p> +The syntax for the configuration file is easy to grasp. You should +know that is not very picky about its syntax. As has been explained +elsewhere in this document, Samba tolerates some spelling errors (such +as <a class="indexterm" name="id2921166"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>browsable</tt></i> instead of +<a class="indexterm" name="id2921181"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>browseable</tt></i>), and spelling is +case-insensitive. It is permissible to use <i class="parameter"><tt>Yes/No</tt></i> +or <i class="parameter"><tt>True/False</tt></i> for Boolean settings. Lists of names +may be separated by commas, spaces or tabs. +</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2921211"></a>Verifing Configuration with <b class="command">testparm</b></h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +To see all (or at least most) printing-related settings in Samba, including +the implicitly used ones, try the command outlined below. This command greps +for all occurrences of <tt class="constant">lp, print, spool, driver, ports</tt> +and <tt class="constant">[</tt> in testparms output. This provides a convenient +overview of the running <b class="command">smbd</b> print configuration. This +command does not show individually created printer shares or the spooling +paths they may use. Here is the output of my Samba setup, with settings +shown in <link linkend="simpleprc">: +</p><pre class="screen"> +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>testparm -s -v | egrep "(lp|print|spool|driver|ports|\[)"</tt></b> + Load smb config files from /etc/samba/smb.conf + Processing section "[homes]" + Processing section "[printers]" + + [global] + smb ports = 445 139 + lpq cache time = 10 + total print jobs = 0 + load printers = Yes + printcap name = /etc/printcap + disable spoolss = No + enumports command = + addprinter command = + deleteprinter command = + show add printer wizard = Yes + os2 driver map = + printer admin = + min print space = 0 + max print jobs = 1000 + printable = No + printing = bsd + print command = lpr -r -P'%p' %s + lpq command = lpq -P'%p' + lprm command = lprm -P'%p' %j + lppause command = + lpresume command = + printer name = + use client driver = No + + [homes] + + [printers] + path = /var/spool/samba + printable = Yes +</pre><p> +</p><p> +You can easily verify which settings were implicitly added by Samba's +default behavior. <span class="emphasis"><em>Remember: it may +be important in your future dealings with Samba.</em></span> +</p><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p> testparm in Samba-3 behaves differently from that in 2.2.x: used +without the “<span class="quote">-v</span>” switch it only shows you the settings actually +written into! To see the complete +configuration used, add the “<span class="quote">-v</span>” parameter to testparm.</p></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2921327"></a>Rapid Configuration Validation</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +Should you need to troubleshoot at any stage, please always come back +to this point first and verify if <b class="command">testparm</b> shows the parameters you +expect. To give you a warning from personal experience, +try to just comment out the <a class="indexterm" name="id2921350"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>load printers</tt></i> +parameter. If your 2.2.x system behaves like mine, you'll see this: +</p><pre class="screen"> +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt>grep "load printers" /etc/samba/smb.conf + # load printers = Yes + # This setting is commented out!! + +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt>testparm -v /etc/samba/smb.conf | egrep "(load printers)" + load printers = Yes +</pre><p> +I assumed that commenting out of this setting should prevent Samba from +publishing my printers, but it still did. It took some time to figure out +the reason. But I am no longer fooled ... at least not by this. +</p><pre class="screen"> +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>grep -A1 "load printers" /etc/samba/smb.conf</tt></b> + load printers = No + # The above setting is what I want! + # load printers = Yes + # This setting is commented out! + +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>testparm -s -v smb.conf.simpleprinting | egrep "(load printers)"</tt></b> + load printers = No + +</pre><p> +Only when the parameter is explicitly set to +<a class="indexterm" name="id2921441"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>load printers</tt></i> = No +would Samba conform with my intentions. So, my strong advice is: +</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Never rely on commented out parameters.</p></li><li><p>Always set parameters explicitly as you intend them to +behave.</p></li><li><p>Use <b class="command">testparm</b> to uncover hidden +settings that might not reflect your intentions.</p></li></ul></div><p> +The following is the most minimal configuration file: +</p><pre class="screen"> +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>cat /etc/samba/smb.conf-minimal</tt></b> + [printers] +</pre><p> +This example should show that you can use testparm to test any Samba +configuration file. Actually, we encourage you <span class="emphasis"><em>not</em></span> +to change your working system (unless you know exactly what you are +doing). Don't rely on the assumption that changes will only take effect after +you re-start smbd! This is not the case. Samba re-reads it every 60 seconds +and on each new client connection. You might have to face changes for your +production clients that you didn't intend to apply. You will now +note a few more interesting things; <b class="command">testparm</b> is useful to +identify what the Samba print configuration would be if you used this minimalistic +configuration. Here is what you can expect to find: +</p><pre class="screen"> +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>testparm -v smb.conf-minimal | egrep "(print|lpq|spool|driver|ports|[)"</tt></b> + Processing section "[printers]" + WARNING: [printers] service MUST be printable! + No path in service printers - using /tmp + + lpq cache time = 10 + total print jobs = 0 + load printers = Yes + printcap name = /etc/printcap + disable spoolss = No + enumports command = + addprinter command = + deleteprinter command = + show add printer wizard = Yes + os2 driver map = + printer admin = + min print space = 0 + max print jobs = 1000 + printable = No + printing = bsd + print command = lpr -r -P%p %s + lpq command = lpq -P%p + printer name = + use client driver = No + + [printers] + printable = Yes + +</pre><p> +testparm issued two warnings: +</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>We did not specify the <i class="parameter"><tt>[printers]</tt></i> section as printable.</p></li><li><p>We did not tell Samba which spool directory to use.</p></li></ul></div><p> +However, this was not fatal and Samba will default to values that will +work. Please, do not rely on this and do not use this example. This was +included to encourage you to be careful to design and specify your setup to do +precisely what you require. The outcome on your system may vary for some +parameters given, since Samba may have been built with different compile-time +options. <span class="emphasis"><em>Warning:</em></span> do not put a comment sign +<span class="emphasis"><em>at the end</em></span> of a valid line. It will cause the parameter +to be ignored (just as if you had put the comment sign at the front). At first +I regarded this as a bug in my Samba versions. But the man page clearly says: +“<span class="quote">Internal whitespace in a parameter value is retained verbatim.</span>” +This means that a line consisting of, for example: +</p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td># This defines LPRng as the printing system</td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>printing = lprng</tt></i></td></tr></table><p> +will regard the whole of the string after the +“<span class="quote"><tt class="constant">=</tt></span>” sign as the value you want to +define. This is an invalid value that will be ignored and a default +value will be +used in its place. +</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2921667"></a>Extended Printing Configuration</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +In <link linkend="extbsdpr"> we show a more verbose example configuration +for print-related settings in a BSD-style printing environment. What follows +is a discussion and explanation of the various parameters. We chose to +use BSD-style printing here because it is still the most commonly used +system on legacy UNIX/Linux installations. New installations predominantly +use CUPS, which is discussed in a separate chapter. <link linkend="extbsdpr"> explicitly +names many parameters that do not need to be specified because they are set +by default. You could use a much leaner <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file. Alternately, you can use +<b class="command">testparm</b> or <b class="command">SWAT</b> to optimize the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> +file to remove all parameters that are set at default. +</p><div class="example"><a name="extbsdpr"></a><p class="title"><b>Example 18.2. Extended BSD Printing Configuration</b></p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td> </td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>[global]</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>printing = bsd</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>load printers = yes</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>show add printer wizard = yes</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>printcap name = /etc/printcap</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>printer admin = @ntadmin, root</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>total print jobs = 100</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>lpq cache time = 20</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>use client driver = no</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td> </td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>[printers]</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>comment = All Printers</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>printable = yes</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>path = /var/spool/samba</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>browseable = no</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>guest ok = yes</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>public = yes</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>read only = yes</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>writable = no </tt></i></td></tr><tr><td> </td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>[my_printer_name]</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>comment = Printer with Restricted Access</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>path = /var/spool/samba_my_printer</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>printer admin = kurt</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>browseable = yes</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>printable = yes</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>writeable = no</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>hosts allow = 0.0.0.0</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>hosts deny = turbo_xp, 10.160.50.23, 10.160.51.60</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>guest ok = no</tt></i></td></tr></table></div><p> +This is an example configuration. You may not find all the settings that are in +the confioguration file that was provided by the OS vendor. Samba configuration +parameters, if not explicitly set default to a sensible value. +To see all settings, as <tt class="constant">root</tt> use the <b class="command">testparm</b> +utility. <b class="command">testparm</b> gives warnings for misconfigured settings. +</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2922020"></a>Detailed Explanation Settings</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +The following is a discussion of the settings from above shown example. +</p><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2922033"></a>The [global] Section</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> +The <i class="parameter"><tt>[global]</tt></i> section is one of four special +sections (along with [<i class="parameter"><tt>[homes]</tt></i>, +<i class="parameter"><tt>[printers]</tt></i> +and <i class="parameter"><tt>[print$]</tt></i>...). The +<i class="parameter"><tt>[global]</tt></i> contains all parameters which apply +to the server as a whole. It is the place for parameters that have only a +global meaning. It may also contain service level parameters that then define +default settings for all other sections and shares. This way you can simplify +the configuration and avoid setting the same value repeatedly. (Within each +individual section or share you may, however, override these globally set +share settings and specify other values). +</p><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term"><a class="indexterm" name="id2922094"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>printing</tt></i> = bsd </span></dt><dd><p>Causes Samba to use default print commands + applicable for the BSD (also known as RFC 1179 style or LPR/LPD) printing + system. In general, the <i class="parameter"><tt>printing</tt></i> parameter informs Samba about the + print subsystem it should expect. Samba supports CUPS, LPD, LPRNG, + SYSV, HPUX, AIX, QNX, and PLP. Each of these systems defaults to a + different <a class="indexterm" name="id2922127"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>print command</tt></i> (and other queue control + commands).</p><div class="caution" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Caution</h3><p>The <a class="indexterm" name="id2922147"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>printing</tt></i> parameter is + normally a service level parameter. Since it is included here in the + <i class="parameter"><tt>[global]</tt></i> section, it will take effect for all + printer shares that are not defined differently. Samba-3 no longer + supports the SOFTQ printing system.</p></div></dd><dt><span class="term"><a class="indexterm" name="id2922176"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>load printers</tt></i> = yes </span></dt><dd><p>Tells Samba to create automatically all + available printer shares. Available printer shares are discovered by + scanning the printcap file. All created printer shares are also loaded + for browsing. If you use this parameter, you do not need to specify + separate shares for each printer. Each automatically created printer + share will clone the configuration options found in the + <i class="parameter"><tt>[printers]</tt></i> section. (The <i class="parameter"><tt>load printers + = no</tt></i> setting will allow you to specify each UNIX printer + you want to share separately, leaving out some you do not want to be + publicly visible and available).</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a class="indexterm" name="id2922227"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>show add printer wizard</tt></i> = yes </span></dt><dd><p>Setting is normally enabled by default (even if the parameter is not specified in <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt>). + It causes the <span class="guiicon">Add Printer Wizard</span> icon to appear + in the <span class="guiicon">Printers</span> folder of the Samba host's + share listing (as shown in <span class="guiicon">Network Neighborhood</span> or + by the <b class="command">net view</b> command). To disable it, you need to + explicitly set it to <tt class="constant">no</tt> (commenting it out + will not suffice). The <i class="parameter"><tt>Add Printer Wizard</tt></i> lets you upload printer + drivers to the <i class="parameter"><tt>[print$]</tt></i> share and associate it + with a printer (if the respective queue exists before the + action), or exchange a printer's driver against any other previously + uploaded driver.</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a class="indexterm" name="id2922312"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>total print jobs</tt></i> = 100 </span></dt><dd><p>Sets the upper limit to 100 print jobs + being active on the Samba server at any one time. Should a client + submit a job that exceeds this number, a “<span class="quote">no more space + available on server</span>” type of error message will be returned by + Samba to the client. A setting of zero (the default) means there is + <span class="emphasis"><em>no</em></span> limit at all. + </p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a class="indexterm" name="id2922350"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>printcap name</tt></i> = /etc/printcap </span></dt><dd><p>Tells Samba where to look for a list of + available printer names. Where CUPS is used, make sure that a printcap + file is written. This is controlled by the <tt class="constant">Printcap</tt> directive in the + <tt class="filename">cupsd.conf</tt> file. + </p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a class="indexterm" name="id2922389"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>printer admin</tt></i> = @ntadmin </span></dt><dd><p>Members of the ntadmin group should be able to add + drivers and set printer properties (<tt class="constant">ntadmin</tt> is only an example name, + it needs to be a valid UNIX group name); root is implicitly always a + <a class="indexterm" name="id2922416"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>printer admin</tt></i>. The @ sign precedes group names in the + <tt class="filename">/etc/group</tt>. A printer admin can do anything to + printers via the remote administration interfaces offered by MS-RPC + (see below). In larger installations, the <a class="indexterm" name="id2922440"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>printer admin</tt></i> + parameter is normally a per-share parameter. This permits different groups to administer each printer share. + </p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a class="indexterm" name="id2922460"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>lpq cache time</tt></i> = 20 </span></dt><dd><p>Controls the cache time for the results of the + lpq command. It prevents the lpq command being called too often and + reduces the load on a heavily used print server. + </p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a class="indexterm" name="id2922487"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>use client driver</tt></i> = no </span></dt><dd><p>If set to <tt class="constant">yes</tt>, only + takes effect for Windows NT/200x/XP clients (and not for Win 95/98/ME). Its + default value is <tt class="constant">No</tt> (or <tt class="constant">False</tt>). + It must <span class="emphasis"><em>not</em></span> be enabled on print shares + (with a <tt class="constant">yes</tt> or <tt class="constant">true</tt> setting) that + have valid drivers installed on the Samba server. For more detailed + explanations see the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> man page. + </p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="ptrsect"></a>The [printers] Section</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> +This is the second special section. If a section with this name appears in +the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt>, users are able to connect to any printer specified in the +Samba host's printcap file, because Samba on startup then creates a printer +share for every printername it finds in the printcap file. You could regard +this section as a general convenience shortcut to share all printers with +minimal configuration. It is also a container for settings that should +apply as default to all printers. (For more details see the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> +man page.) Settings inside this container must be Share Level parameters. +</p><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term"><a class="indexterm" name="id2922592"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>comment</tt></i> = All printers </span></dt><dd><p> + The <a class="indexterm" name="id2922612"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>comment</tt></i> is shown next to the share if + a client queries the server, either via <span class="guiicon">Network Neighborhood</span> or with + the <b class="command">net view</b> command to list available shares. + </p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a class="indexterm" name="id2922646"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>printable</tt></i> = yes </span></dt><dd><p> + The <i class="parameter"><tt>[printers]</tt></i> service <span class="emphasis"><em>must</em></span> + be declared as printable. If you specify otherwise, smbd will refuse to load at + startup. This parameter allows connected clients to open, write to and submit spool files + into the directory specified with the <a class="indexterm" name="id2922680"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>path</tt></i> + parameter for this service. It is used by Samba to differentiate printer shares from + file shares. + </p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a class="indexterm" name="id2922702"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>path</tt></i> = /var/spool/samba </span></dt><dd><p> + Must point to a directory used by Samba to spool incoming print files. <span class="emphasis"><em>It + must not be the same as the spool directory specified in the configuration of your UNIX + print subsystem!</em></span> The path typically points to a directory that is world + writeable, with the “<span class="quote">sticky</span>” bit set to it. + </p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a class="indexterm" name="id2922740"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>browseable</tt></i> = no </span></dt><dd><p> + Is always set to <tt class="constant">no</tt> if + <a class="indexterm" name="id2922764"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>printable</tt></i> = yes. It makes + the <i class="parameter"><tt>[printer]</tt></i> share itself invisible in the list of + available shares in a <b class="command">net view</b> command or in the Explorer browse + list. (You will of course see the individual printers). + </p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a class="indexterm" name="id2922800"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>guest ok</tt></i> = yes </span></dt><dd><p> + If this parameter is set to <tt class="constant">yes</tt>, no password is required to + connect to the printer's service. Access will be granted with the privileges of the + <a class="indexterm" name="id2922826"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>guest account</tt></i>. On many systems the guest + account will map to a user named “<span class="quote">nobody</span>”. This user will usually be found + in the UNIX passwd file with an empty password, but with no valid UNIX login. (On some + systems the guest account might not have the privilege to be able to print. Test this + by logging in as your guest user using <b class="command">su - guest</b> and run a system + print command like: + </p><p> + <b class="userinput"><tt>lpr -P printername /etc/motd</tt></b> + </p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a class="indexterm" name="id2922875"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>public</tt></i> = yes </span></dt><dd><p> + Is a synonym for <a class="indexterm" name="id2922894"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>guest ok</tt></i> = yes. + Since we have <a class="indexterm" name="id2922909"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>guest ok</tt></i> = yes, it + really does not need to be here. (This leads to the interesting question: “<span class="quote">What if I + by accident have two contradictory settings for the same share?</span>” The answer is the + last one encountered by Samba wins. Testparm does not complain about different settings + of the same parameter for the same share. You can test this by setting up multiple + lines for the <i class="parameter"><tt>guest account</tt></i> parameter with different usernames, + and then run testparm to see which one is actually used by Samba.) + </p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a class="indexterm" name="id2922947"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>read only</tt></i> = yes </span></dt><dd><p> + Normally (for other types of shares) prevents users from creating or modifying files + in the service's directory. However, in a “<span class="quote">printable</span>” service, it is + <span class="emphasis"><em>always</em></span> allowed to write to the directory (if user privileges allow the + connection), but only via print spooling operations. Normal write operations are not permitted. + </p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a class="indexterm" name="id2922986"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>writeable</tt></i> = no </span></dt><dd><p> + Is a synonym for <a class="indexterm" name="id2923006"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>read only</tt></i> = yes. + </p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2923024"></a>Any [my_printer_name] Section</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> +If a section appears in the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file, which when given the parameter +<a class="indexterm" name="id2923042"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>printable</tt></i> = yes causes Samba to configure it +as a printer share. Windows 9x/Me clients may have problems with connecting or loading printer drivers +if the share name has more than eight characters. Do not name a printer share with a name that may conflict +with an existing user or file share name. On Client connection requests, Samba always tries to find file +shares with that name first. If it finds one, it will connect to this and will not connect +to a printer with the same name! +</p><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term"><a class="indexterm" name="id2923073"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>comment</tt></i> = Printer with Restricted Access </span></dt><dd><p> + The comment says it all. + </p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a class="indexterm" name="id2923099"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>path</tt></i> = /var/spool/samba_my_printer </span></dt><dd><p> + Sets the spooling area for this printer to a directory other than the default. It is not + necessary to set it differently, but the option is available. + </p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a class="indexterm" name="id2923126"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>printer admin</tt></i> = kurt </span></dt><dd><p> + The printer admin definition is different for this explicitly defined printer share from the general + <i class="parameter"><tt>[printers]</tt></i> share. It is not a requirement; we + did it to show that it is possible. + </p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a class="indexterm" name="id2923161"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>browseable</tt></i> = yes </span></dt><dd><p> + This makes the printer browseable so the clients may conveniently find it when browsing the + <span class="guiicon">Network Neighborhood</span>. + </p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a class="indexterm" name="id2923196"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>printable</tt></i> = yes </span></dt><dd><p> + See <link linkend="ptrsect">. + </p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a class="indexterm" name="id2923228"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>writeable</tt></i> = no </span></dt><dd><p> + See <link linkend="ptrsect">. + </p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a class="indexterm" name="id2923260"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>hosts allow</tt></i> = 10.160.50.,10.160.51. </span></dt><dd><p> + Here we exercise a certain degree of access control by using the <a class="indexterm" name="id2923281"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>hosts allow</tt></i> and <a class="indexterm" name="id2923294"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>hosts deny</tt></i> + parameters. This is not by any means a safe bet. It is not a way to secure your + printers. This line accepts all clients from a certain subnet in a first evaluation of + access control. + </p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a class="indexterm" name="id2923317"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>hosts deny</tt></i> = turbo_xp,10.160.50.23,10.160.51.60 </span></dt><dd><p> + All listed hosts are not allowed here (even if they belong to the allowed subnets). As + you can see, you could name IP addresses as well as NetBIOS hostnames here. + </p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a class="indexterm" name="id2923345"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>guest ok</tt></i> = no </span></dt><dd><p> + This printer is not open for the guest account. + </p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2923371"></a>Print Commands</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> +In each section defining a printer (or in the <i class="parameter"><tt>[printers]</tt></i> section), +a <i class="parameter"><tt>print command</tt></i> parameter may be defined. It sets a command to process the files +that have been placed into the Samba print spool directory for that printer. (That spool directory was, +if you remember, set up with the <a class="indexterm" name="id2923399"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>path</tt></i> parameter). Typically, +this command will submit the spool file to the Samba host's print subsystem, using the suitable system +print command. But there is no requirement that this needs to be the case. For debugging or +some other reason, you may want to do something completely different than print the file. An example is a +command that just copies the print file to a temporary location for further investigation when you need +to debug printing. If you craft your own print commands (or even develop print command shell scripts), +make sure you pay attention to the need to remove the files from the Samba spool directory. Otherwise, +your hard disk may soon suffer from shortage of free space. +</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2923428"></a>Default UNIX System Printing Commands</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> +You learned earlier on that Samba, in most cases, uses its built-in settings for many parameters +if it cannot find an explicitly stated one in its configuration file. The same is true for the +<a class="indexterm" name="id2923441"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>print command</tt></i>. The default print command varies depending +on the <a class="indexterm" name="id2923458"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>printing</tt></i> parameter setting. In the commands listed +below, you will notice some parameters of the form <span class="emphasis"><em>%X</em></span> where <span class="emphasis"><em>X</em></span> is +<span class="emphasis"><em>p, s, J</em></span>, and so on. These letters stand for printer name, spoolfile and job ID, respectively. +They are explained in more detail further below. <link linkend="printOptions"> presents an overview of key +printing options but excludes the special case of CUPS that is discussed in <link linkend="CUPS-printing">. +</p><div class="table"><a name="printOptions"></a><p class="title"><b>Table 18.1. Default Printing Settings</b></p><table summary="Default Printing Settings" border="1"><colgroup><col align="left"><col align="left"></colgroup><thead><tr><th align="left">Setting</th><th align="left">Default Printing Commands</th></tr></thead><tbody><tr><td align="left"><a class="indexterm" name="id2923569"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>printing</tt></i> = bsd|aix|lprng|plp</td><td align="left">print command is <b class="command">lpr -r -P%p %s</b></td></tr><tr><td align="left"><a class="indexterm" name="id2923599"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>printing</tt></i> = sysv|hpux</td><td align="left">print command is <b class="command">lp -c -P%p %s; rm %s</b></td></tr><tr><td align="left"><a class="indexterm" name="id2923631"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>printing</tt></i> = qnx</td><td align="left">print command is <b class="command">lp -r -P%p -s %s</b></td></tr><tr><td align="left"><a class="indexterm" name="id2923662"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>printing</tt></i> = bsd|aix|lprng|plp</td><td align="left">lpq command is <b class="command">lpq -P%p</b></td></tr><tr><td align="left"><a class="indexterm" name="id2923692"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>printing</tt></i> = sysv|hpux</td><td align="left">lpq command is <b class="command">lpstat -o%p</b></td></tr><tr><td align="left"><a class="indexterm" name="id2923723"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>printing</tt></i> = qnx</td><td align="left">lpq command is <b class="command">lpq -P%p</b></td></tr><tr><td align="left"><a class="indexterm" name="id2923753"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>printing</tt></i> = bsd|aix|lprng|plp</td><td align="left">lprm command is <b class="command">lprm -P%p %j</b></td></tr><tr><td align="left"><a class="indexterm" name="id2923784"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>printing</tt></i> = sysv|hpux</td><td align="left">lprm command is <b class="command">cancel %p-%j</b></td></tr><tr><td align="left"><a class="indexterm" name="id2923814"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>printing</tt></i> = qnx</td><td align="left">lprm command is <b class="command">cancel %p-%j</b></td></tr><tr><td align="left"><a class="indexterm" name="id2923845"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>printing</tt></i> = bsd|aix|lprng|plp</td><td align="left">lppause command is <b class="command">lp -i %p-%j -H hold</b></td></tr><tr><td align="left"><a class="indexterm" name="id2923876"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>printing</tt></i> = sysv|hpux</td><td align="left">lppause command (...is empty)</td></tr><tr><td align="left"><a class="indexterm" name="id2923901"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>printing</tt></i> = qnx</td><td align="left">lppause command (...is empty)</td></tr><tr><td align="left"><a class="indexterm" name="id2923926"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>printing</tt></i> = bsd|aix|lprng|plp</td><td align="left">lpresume command is <b class="command">lp -i %p-%j -H resume</b></td></tr><tr><td align="left"><a class="indexterm" name="id2923957"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>printing</tt></i> = sysv|hpux</td><td align="left">lpresume command (...is empty)</td></tr><tr><td align="left"><a class="indexterm" name="id2923983"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>printing</tt></i> = qnx</td><td align="left">lpresume command (...is empty)</td></tr></tbody></table></div><p> +We excluded the special case of CUPS here, because it is discussed in the next chapter. For +<i class="parameter"><tt>printing = CUPS</tt></i>, if Samba is compiled against libcups, it uses the CUPS API to submit +jobs. (It is a good idea also to set <a class="indexterm" name="id2924021"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>printcap</tt></i> = cups +in case your <tt class="filename">cupsd.conf</tt> is set to write its autogenerated printcap file to an +unusual place). Otherwise, Samba maps to the System V printing commands with the -oraw option for printing, +i.e., it uses <b class="command">lp -c -d%p -oraw; rm %s</b>. With <i class="parameter"><tt>printing = cups</tt></i>, +and if Samba is compiled against libcups, any manually set print command will be ignored! +</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2924063"></a>Custom Print Commands</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> +After a print job has finished spooling to a service, the <a class="indexterm" name="id2924074"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>print command</tt></i> + will be used by Samba via a <span class="emphasis"><em>system()</em></span> call to process the +spool file. Usually the command specified will submit the spool file to the host's printing subsystem. But +there is no requirement at all that this must be the case. The print subsystem may not remove the spool +file on its own. So whatever command you specify, you should ensure that the spool file is deleted after +it has been processed. +</p><p> +There is no difficulty with using your own customized print commands with the traditional printing +systems. However, if you do not wish to roll your own, you should be well informed about the default +built-in commands that Samba uses for each printing subsystem (see +Table 17.1). In all the +commands listed in the last paragraphs, you see parameters of the form <span class="emphasis"><em>%X</em></span>. These are +<span class="emphasis"><em>macros</em></span>, or shortcuts, used as placeholders for the names of real objects. At the time +of running a command with such a placeholder, Samba will insert the appropriate value automatically. Print +commands can handle all Samba macro substitutions. In regard to printing, the following ones do have +special relevance: +</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p><i class="parameter"><tt>%s, %f</tt></i> the path to the spool file name.</p></li><li><p><i class="parameter"><tt>%p</tt></i> the appropriate printer name.</p></li><li><p><i class="parameter"><tt>%J</tt></i> the job name as transmitted by the client.</p></li><li><p><i class="parameter"><tt>%c</tt></i> the number of printed pages of the spooled job (if known).</p></li><li><p><i class="parameter"><tt>%z</tt></i> the size of the spooled print job (in bytes).</p></li></ul></div><p> +The print command must contain at least one occurrence of <i class="parameter"><tt>%s</tt></i> or +the <i class="parameter"><tt>%f</tt></i>. The <i class="parameter"><tt>%p</tt></i> is optional. If no printer name is supplied, +the <i class="parameter"><tt>%p</tt></i> will be silently removed from the print command. In this case, the job is +sent to the default printer. +</p><p> +If specified in the <i class="parameter"><tt>[global]</tt></i> section, the print command given will be +used for any printable service that does not have its own print command specified. If there is neither a +specified print command for a printable service nor a global print command, spool files will be created +but not processed! Most importantly, print files will not be removed, so they will consume disk space. +</p><p> +Printing may fail on some UNIX systems when using the “<span class="quote">nobody</span>” account. If this happens, create an +alternative guest account and give it the privilege to print. Set up this guest account in the +<i class="parameter"><tt>[global]</tt></i> section with the <i class="parameter"><tt>guest account</tt></i> parameter. +</p><p> +You can form quite complex print commands. You need to realize that print commands are just +passed to a UNIX shell. The shell is able to expand the included environment variables as +usual. (The syntax to include a UNIX environment variable <i class="parameter"><tt>$variable</tt></i> +in the Samba print command is <i class="parameter"><tt>%$variable</tt></i>.) To give you a working +<a class="indexterm" name="id2924309"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>print command</tt></i> example, the following will log a print job +to <tt class="filename">/tmp/print.log</tt>, print the file, then remove it. The semicolon (“<span class="quote">;</span>” +is the usual separator for commands in shell scripts: +</p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>print command = echo Printing %s >> /tmp/print.log; lpr -P %p %s; rm %s</tt></i></td></tr></table><p> +You may have to vary your own command considerably from this example depending on how you normally print +files on your system. The default for the <a class="indexterm" name="id2924363"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>print command</tt></i> +parameter varies depending on the setting of the <a class="indexterm" name="id2924379"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>printing</tt></i> +parameter. Another example is: +</p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>print command = /usr/local/samba/bin/myprintscript %p %s</tt></i></td></tr></table></div></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2924414"></a>Printing Developments Since Samba-2.2</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +Prior to Samba-2.2.x, print server support for Windows clients was limited to <span class="emphasis"><em>LanMan</em></span> +printing calls. This is the same protocol level as Windows 9x/Me PCs offer when they share printers. +Beginning with the 2.2.0 release, Samba started to support the native Windows NT printing mechanisms. These +are implemented via <span class="emphasis"><em>MS-RPC</em></span> (RPC = <span class="emphasis"><em>Remote Procedure Calls</em></span> +). MS-RPCs use the <span class="emphasis"><em>SPOOLSS</em></span> named pipe for all printing. +</p><p> +The additional functionality provided by the new SPOOLSS support includes: +</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p> + Support for downloading printer driver files to Windows 95/98/NT/2000 clients upon + demand (<span class="emphasis"><em>Point'n'Print</em></span>). + </p></li><li><p> + Uploading of printer drivers via the Windows NT <span class="emphasis"><em>Add Printer Wizard</em></span> (APW) + or the <ulink url="http://imprints.sourceforge.net/">Imprints</ulink> tool set. + </p></li><li><p> + Support for the native MS-RPC printing calls such as + StartDocPrinter, EnumJobs(), and so on. (See the + <ulink url="http://msdn.microsoft.com/">MSDN documentation</ulink> for more information on the + Win32 printing API). + </p></li><li><p> + Support for NT <span class="emphasis"><em>Access Control Lists</em></span> (ACL) on printer objects. + </p></li><li><p> + Improved support for printer queue manipulation through the use of internal databases for spooled + job information (implemented by various <tt class="filename">*.tdb</tt> files). + </p></li></ul></div><p> +A benefit of updating is that Samba-3 is able to publish its printers to Active Directory (or LDAP). +</p><p> +A fundamental difference exists between MS Windows NT print servers and Samba operation. Windows NT +permits the installation of local printers that are not shared. This is an artifact of the fact that +any Windows NT machine (server or client) may be used by a user as a workstation. Samba will publish all +printers that are made available, either by default or by specific declaration via printer-specific shares. +</p><p> +Windows NT/200x/XP Professional clients do not have to use the standard SMB printer share; they can +print directly to any printer on another Windows NT host using MS-RPC. This, of course, assumes that +the client has the necessary privileges on the remote host that serves the printer resource. The +default permissions assigned by Windows NT to a printer gives the Print permissions to the well-known +<span class="emphasis"><em>Everyone</em></span> group. (The older clients of type Windows 9x/Me can only print to shared +printers). +</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2924566"></a>Point'n'Print Client Drivers on Samba Servers</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +There is much confusion about what all this means. The question is often asked, “<span class="quote">Is it or is +it not necessary for printer drivers to be installed on a Samba host in order to support printing from +Windows clients?</span>” The answer to this is no, it is not necessary. +</p><p> +Windows NT/2000 clients can, of course, also run their APW to install drivers <span class="emphasis"><em>locally</em></span> +(which then connect to a Samba-served print queue). This is the same method used by Windows 9x/Me +clients. (However, a <span class="emphasis"><em>bug</em></span> existed in Samba 2.2.0 that made Windows NT/2000 clients +require that the Samba server possess a valid driver for the printer. This was fixed in Samba 2.2.1). +</p><p> +But it is a new capability to install the printer drivers into the <i class="parameter"><tt>[print$]</tt></i> +share of the Samba server, and a big convenience, too. Then <span class="emphasis"><em>all</em></span> clients +(including 95/98/ME) get the driver installed when they first connect to this printer share. The +<span class="emphasis"><em>uploading</em></span> or <span class="emphasis"><em>depositing</em></span> of the driver into this +<i class="parameter"><tt>[print$]</tt></i> share and the following binding of this driver to an existing +Samba printer share can be achieved by different means: +</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p> + Running the <span class="emphasis"><em>APW</em></span> on an NT/200x/XP Professional client (this does not work from 95/98/ME clients). + </p></li><li><p> + Using the <span class="emphasis"><em>Imprints</em></span> toolset. + </p></li><li><p> + Using the <span class="emphasis"><em>smbclient</em></span> and <span class="emphasis"><em>rpcclient</em></span> commandline tools. + </p></li><li><p> + Using <span class="emphasis"><em>cupsaddsmb</em></span> (only works for the CUPS + printing system, not for LPR/LPD, LPRng, and so on). + </p></li></ul></div><p> +Samba does not use these uploaded drivers in any way to process spooled files. These drivers are utilized +entirely by the clients who download and install them via the “<span class="quote">Point'n'Print</span>” mechanism +supported by Samba. The clients use these drivers to generate print files in the format the printer +(or the UNIX print system) requires. Print files received by Samba are handed over to the UNIX printing +system, which is responsible for all further processing, as needed. +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2924710"></a>The Obsoleted [printer$] Section</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + Versions of Samba prior to 2.2 made it possible to use a share named + <i class="parameter"><tt>[printer$]</tt></i>. This name was taken from the same named service created by + Windows 9x/Me clients when a printer was shared by them. Windows 9x/Me printer servers always + have a <i class="parameter"><tt>[printer$]</tt></i> service that provides read-only access (with + no password required) to support printer driver downloads. However, Samba's initial + implementation allowed for a parameter named <i class="parameter"><tt>printer driver location</tt></i> to + be used on a per share basis. This specified the location of the driver files associated with + that printer. Another parameter named <i class="parameter"><tt>printer driver</tt></i> provided a means of + defining the printer driver name to be sent to the client. + </p><p> + These parameters, including the <i class="parameter"><tt>printer driver file</tt></i> parameter, + are now removed and cannot be used in installations of Samba-3. The share name + <i class="parameter"><tt>[print$]</tt></i> is now used for the location of downloadable printer + drivers. It is taken from the <i class="parameter"><tt>[print$]</tt></i> service created + by Windows NT PCs when a printer is shared by them. Windows NT print servers always have a + <i class="parameter"><tt>[print$]</tt></i> service that provides read-write access (in the context + of its ACLs) to support printer driver downloads and uploads. This does not mean Windows + 9x/Me clients are now thrown aside. They can use Samba's <i class="parameter"><tt>[print$]</tt></i> + share support just fine. + </p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2924810"></a>Creating the [print$] Share</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +In order to support the uploading and downloading of printer driver files, you must first configure a +file share named <i class="parameter"><tt>[print$]</tt></i>. The public name of this share is hard coded +in the MS Windows clients. It cannot be renamed since Windows clients are programmed to search for a +service of exactly this name if they want to retrieve printer driver files. +</p><p> +You should modify the server's file to add the global parameters and create the +<i class="parameter"><tt>[print$]</tt></i> file share (of course, some of the parameter values, such +as <a class="indexterm" name="id2924847"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>path</tt></i> are arbitrary and should be replaced with appropriate values for your +site). See <link linkend="prtdollar">. +</p><p> +</p><div class="example"><a name="prtdollar"></a><p class="title"><b>Example 18.3. [print\$] example</b></p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td> </td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>[global]</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td># members of the ntadmin group should be able to add drivers and set</td></tr><tr><td># printer properties. root is implicitly always a 'printer admin'.</td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>printer admin = @ntadmin</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td>...</td></tr><tr><td> </td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>[printers]</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td>...</td></tr><tr><td> </td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>[print$]</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>comment = Printer Driver Download Area</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>path = /etc/samba/drivers</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>browseable = yes</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>guest ok = yes</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>read only = yes</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>write list = @ntadmin, root</tt></i></td></tr></table></div><p> +</p><p> +Of course, you also need to ensure that the directory named by the +<a class="indexterm" name="id2925004"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>path</tt></i> parameter exists on the UNIX file system. +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2925021"></a>[print$] Section Parameters</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +The <i class="parameter"><tt>[print$]</tt></i> is a special section in <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt>. It contains settings relevant to +potential printer driver download and is used by windows clients for local print driver installation. +The following parameters are frequently needed in this share section: +</p><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term"><a class="indexterm" name="id2925058"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>comment</tt></i> = Printer Driver Download Area </span></dt><dd><p> + The comment appears next to the share name if it is listed in a share list (usually Windows + clients will not see it, but it will also appear up in a <b class="command">smbclient -L sambaserver + </b> output). + </p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a class="indexterm" name="id2925094"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>path</tt></i> = /etc/samba/printers </span></dt><dd><p> + Is the path to the location of the Windows driver file deposit from the UNIX point of view. + </p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a class="indexterm" name="id2925120"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>browseable</tt></i> = no </span></dt><dd><p> + Makes the <i class="parameter"><tt>[print$]</tt></i> share invisible to clients from the + <span class="guimenu">Network Neighborhood</span>. However, you can still mount it from any client + using the <b class="command">net use g:\\sambaserver\print$</b> command in a DOS-box or the + <span class="guimenu">Connect network drive menu></span> from Windows Explorer. + </p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a class="indexterm" name="id2925177"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>guest ok</tt></i> = yes </span></dt><dd><p> + Gives read-only access to this share for all guest users. Access may be granted to + download and install printer drivers on clients. The requirement for <i class="parameter"><tt>guest ok + = yes</tt></i> depends on how your site is configured. If users will be guaranteed + to have an account on the Samba host, then this is a non-issue. + </p><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p> + If all your Windows NT users are guaranteed to be authenticated by the Samba server + (for example, if Samba authenticates via an NT domain server and the user has already been + validated by the Domain Controller in order to logon to the Windows NT session), then guest + access is not necessary. Of course, in a workgroup environment where you just want + to print without worrying about silly accounts and security, then configure the share for + guest access. You should consider adding <a class="indexterm" name="id2925224"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>map to guest</tt></i> = Bad + User in the <i class="parameter"><tt>[global]</tt></i> section + as well. Make sure you understand what this parameter does before using it. + </p></div></dd><dt><span class="term"><a class="indexterm" name="id2925252"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>read only</tt></i> = yes </span></dt><dd><p> + Because we do not want everybody to upload driver files (or even change driver settings), + we tagged this share as not writeable. + </p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a class="indexterm" name="id2925280"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>write list</tt></i> = @ntadmin, root </span></dt><dd><p> + The <i class="parameter"><tt>[print$]</tt></i> was made read-only by the previous + setting so we should create a <i class="parameter"><tt>write list</tt></i> entry also. UNIX + groups (denoted with a leading “<span class="quote">@</span>” character). Users listed here are allowed + write-access (as an exception to the general public's read-only access), which they need to + update files on the share. Normally, you will want to only name administrative-level user + account in this setting. Check the file system permissions to make sure these accounts + can copy files to the share. If this is a non-root account, then the account should also + be mentioned in the global <a class="indexterm" name="id2925328"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>printer admin</tt></i> + parameter. See the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> man page for more information on configuring file shares. + </p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2925355"></a>The [print$] Share Directory</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +In order for a Windows NT print server to support the downloading of driver files by multiple client +architectures, you must create several subdirectories within the <i class="parameter"><tt>[print$]</tt></i> +service (i.e., the UNIX directory named by the <a class="indexterm" name="id2925375"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>path</tt></i> +parameter). These correspond to each of the supported client architectures. Samba follows this model as +well. Just like the name of the <i class="parameter"><tt>[print$]</tt></i> share itself, the subdirectories +must be exactly the names listed below (you may leave out the subdirectories of architectures you do +not need to support). +</p><p> +Therefore, create a directory tree below the +<i class="parameter"><tt>[print$]</tt></i> share for each architecture you wish +to support like this: +</p><pre class="programlisting"> +[print$]--+ + |--W32X86 # serves drivers to Windows NT x86 + |--WIN40 # serves drivers to Windows 95/98 + |--W32ALPHA # serves drivers to Windows NT Alpha_AXP + |--W32MIPS # serves drivers to Windows NT R4000 + |--W32PPC # serves drivers to Windows NT PowerPC +</pre><p> +</p><div class="important" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Required permissions</h3><p> + In order to add a new driver to your Samba host, one of two conditions must hold true: + </p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p> + The account used to connect to the Samba host must have a UID of 0 (i.e., a root account). + </p></li><li><p> + The account used to connect to the Samba host must be named in the <span class="emphasis"><em>printer admin</em></span>list. + </p></li></ul></div><p> + Of course, the connected account must still have write access to add files to the subdirectories beneath + <i class="parameter"><tt>[print$]</tt></i>. Remember that all file shares are set to “<span class="quote">read-only</span>” by default. + </p></div><p> +Once you have created the required <i class="parameter"><tt>[print$]</tt></i> service and +associated subdirectories, go to a Windows NT 4.0/200x/XP client workstation. Open <span class="guiicon">Network +Neighborhood</span> or <span class="guiicon">My Network Places</span> and browse for the Samba host. Once you +have located the server, navigate to its <span class="guiicon">Printers and Faxes</span> folder. You should see +an initial listing of printers that matches the printer shares defined on your Samba host. +</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2925525"></a>Installing Drivers into [print$]</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +Have you successfully created the <i class="parameter"><tt>[print$]</tt></i> share in <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt>, and have your forced Samba +to re-read its <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file? Good. But you are not yet ready to use the new facility. The client driver +files need to be installed into this share. So far it is still an empty share. Unfortunately, it is +not enough to just copy the driver files over. They need to be +correctly installed so that appropriate +records for each driver will exist in the Samba internal databases so it can provide the correct +drivers as they are requested from MS Windows clients. And that is a bit tricky, to say the least. We +now discuss two alternative ways to install the drivers into <i class="parameter"><tt>[print$]</tt></i>: +</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p> + Using the Samba commandline utility <b class="command">rpcclient</b> with its various subcommands (here: + <b class="command">adddriver</b> and <b class="command">setdriver</b>) from any UNIX workstation. + </p></li><li><p> + Running a GUI (<span class="guiicon">Printer Properties</span> and <span class="guiicon">Add Printer Wizard</span>) + from any Windows NT/200x/XP client workstation. + </p></li></ul></div><p> +The latter option is probably the easier one (even if the process may seem a little bit weird at first). +</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2925644"></a>Add Printer Wizard Driver Installation</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +The initial listing of printers in the Samba host's <span class="guiicon">Printers</span> folder accessed from a +client's Explorer will have no real printer driver assigned to them. By default this driver name is set +to a null string. This must be changed now. The local <span class="guiicon">Add Printer Wizard</span> (APW), run from +NT/2000/XP clients, will help us in this task. +</p><p> +Installation of a valid printer driver is not straightforward. You must attempt +to view the printer properties for the printer to which you want the driver assigned. Open the Windows +Explorer, open <span class="guiicon">Network Neighborhood</span>, browse to the Samba host, open Samba's <span class="guiicon">Printers</span> +folder, right-click on the printer icon and select <span class="guimenu">Properties...</span>. You are now trying to +view printer and driver properties for a queue that has this default <tt class="constant">NULL</tt> driver +assigned. This will result in the following error message: +</p><p><span class="errorname"> + Device settings cannot be displayed. The driver for the specified printer is not installed, + only spooler properties will be displayed. Do you want to install the driver now? + </span></p><p> +Do not click on <span class="guibutton">Yes</span>! Instead, click on <span class="guibutton">No</span> in the error dialog. +Only now you will be presented with the printer properties window. From here, the way to assign a driver +to a printer is open to us. You now have the choice of: +</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p> + Select a driver from the pop-up list of installed drivers. Initially this list will be empty. + </p></li><li><p> + Click on <span class="guibutton">New Driver</span> to install a new printer driver (which will + start up the APW). + </p></li></ul></div><p> +Once the APW is started, the procedure is exactly the same as the one you are familiar with in Windows (we +assume here that you are familiar with the printer driver installations procedure on Windows NT). Make sure +your connection is, in fact, setup as a user with <a class="indexterm" name="id2925776"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>printer admin</tt></i> +privileges (if in doubt, use <b class="command">smbstatus</b> to check for this). If you wish to install +printer drivers for client operating systems other than <span class="application">Windows NT x86</span>, +you will need to use the <span class="guilabel">Sharing</span> tab of the printer properties dialog. +</p><p> +Assuming you have connected with an administrative (or root) account (as named by the +<a class="indexterm" name="id2925818"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>printer admin</tt></i> parameter), you will also be able to modify +other printer properties such as ACLs and default device settings using this dialog. For the default +device settings, please consider the advice given further in <link linkend="inst-rpc">. +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="inst-rpc"></a>Installing Print Drivers Using <b class="command">rpcclient</b></h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +The second way to install printer drivers into <i class="parameter"><tt>[print$]</tt></i> and set them +up in a valid way is to do it from the UNIX command line. This involves four distinct steps: +</p><div class="orderedlist"><ol type="1"><li><p> + Gather info about required driver files and collect the files. + </p></li><li><p> + Deposit the driver files into the <i class="parameter"><tt>[print$]</tt></i> share's correct subdirectories + (possibly by using <b class="command">smbclient</b>). + </p></li><li><p> + Run the <b class="command">rpcclient</b> command line utility once with the <b class="command">adddriver</b> + subcommand. + </p></li><li><p> + Run <b class="command">rpcclient</b> a second time with the <b class="command">setdriver</b> subcommand. + </p></li></ol></div><p> +We provide detailed hints for each of these steps in the paragraphs that follow. +</p><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2925958"></a>Identifying Driver Files</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> +To find out about the driver files, you have two options. You could check the contents of the driver +CDROM that came with your printer. Study the <tt class="filename">*.inf</tt> files lcoated on the CDROM. This +may not be possible, since the <tt class="filename">*.inf</tt> file might be missing. Unfortunately, vendors have now started +to use their own installation programs. These installations packages are often in some Windows platform +archive format. Additionally, the files may be re-named during the installation process. This makes it +extremely difficult to identify the driver files required. +</p><p> +Then you only have the second option. Install the driver locally on a Windows client and +investigate which file names and paths it uses after they are installed. (You need to repeat +this procedure for every client platform you want to support. We show it here for the +<span class="application">W32X86</span> platform only, a name used by Microsoft for all Windows NT/200x/XP +clients.) +</p><p> +A good method to recognize the driver files is to print the test page from the driver's +<span class="guilabel">Properties</span> dialog (<span class="guilabel">General</span> tab). Then look at the list of +driver files named on the printout. You'll need to recognize what Windows (and Samba) are calling the +<span class="guilabel">Driver File</span>, <span class="guilabel">Data File</span>, <span class="guilabel">Config File</span>, +<span class="guilabel">Help File</span> and (optionally) the <span class="guilabel">Dependent Driver Files</span> +(this may vary slightly for Windows NT). You need to take a note of all file names for the next steps. +</p><p> +Another method to quickly test the driver filenames and related paths is provided by the +<b class="command">rpcclient</b> utility. Run it with <b class="command">enumdrivers</b> or with the +<b class="command">getdriver</b> subcommand, each at the <tt class="filename">3</tt> info level. In the following example, +<span class="emphasis"><em>TURBO_XP</em></span> is the name of the Windows PC (in this case it was a Windows XP Professional +laptop). I installed the driver locally to TURBO_XP, from a Samba server called <tt class="constant">KDE-BITSHOP</tt>. +We could run an interactive <b class="command">rpcclient</b> session; then we would get an +<b class="command">rpcclient /></b> prompt and would type the subcommands at this prompt. This is left as +a good exercise to the reader. For now, we use <b class="command">rpcclient</b> with the <tt class="option">-c</tt> +parameter to execute a single subcommand line and exit again. This is the method you would use if you +want to create scripts to automate the procedure for a large number of printers and drivers. Note the +different quotes used to overcome the different spaces in between words: +</p><pre class="screen"> +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>rpcclient -U'Danka%xxxx' -c \ + 'getdriver "Heidelberg Digimaster 9110 (PS)" 3' TURBO_XP</tt></b> +cmd = getdriver "Heidelberg Digimaster 9110 (PS)" 3 + +[Windows NT x86] +Printer Driver Info 3: + Version: [2] + Driver Name: [Heidelberg Digimaster 9110 (PS)] + Architecture: [Windows NT x86] + Driver Path: [C:\WINNT\System32\spool\DRIVERS\W32X86\2\HDNIS01_de.DLL] + Datafile: [C:\WINNT\System32\spool\DRIVERS\W32X86\2\Hddm91c1_de.ppd] + Configfile: [C:\WINNT\System32\spool\DRIVERS\W32X86\2\HDNIS01U_de.DLL] + Helpfile: [C:\WINNT\System32\spool\DRIVERS\W32X86\2\HDNIS01U_de.HLP] + + Dependentfiles: [C:\WINNT\System32\spool\DRIVERS\W32X86\2\Hddm91c1_de.DLL] + Dependentfiles: [C:\WINNT\System32\spool\DRIVERS\W32X86\2\Hddm91c1_de.INI] + Dependentfiles: [C:\WINNT\System32\spool\DRIVERS\W32X86\2\Hddm91c1_de.dat] + Dependentfiles: [C:\WINNT\System32\spool\DRIVERS\W32X86\2\Hddm91c1_de.cat] + Dependentfiles: [C:\WINNT\System32\spool\DRIVERS\W32X86\2\Hddm91c1_de.def] + Dependentfiles: [C:\WINNT\System32\spool\DRIVERS\W32X86\2\Hddm91c1_de.hre] + Dependentfiles: [C:\WINNT\System32\spool\DRIVERS\W32X86\2\Hddm91c1_de.vnd] + Dependentfiles: [C:\WINNT\System32\spool\DRIVERS\W32X86\2\Hddm91c1_de.hlp] + Dependentfiles: [C:\WINNT\System32\spool\DRIVERS\W32X86\2\HDNIS01Aux.dll] + Dependentfiles: [C:\WINNT\System32\spool\DRIVERS\W32X86\2\HDNIS01_de.NTF] + + Monitorname: [] + Defaultdatatype: [] +</pre><p> +You may notice that this driver has quite a large number of <span class="guilabel">Dependent files</span> +(there are worse cases, however). Also, strangely, the +<span class="guilabel">Driver File</span> is tagged here +<span class="guilabel">Driver Path</span>. We do not yet have support for the so-called +<span class="application">WIN40</span> architecture installed. This name is used by Microsoft for the Windows +9x/Me platforms. If we want to support these, we need to install the Windows 9x/Me driver files in +addition to those for <span class="application">W32X86</span> (i.e., the Windows NT72000/XP clients) onto a +Windows PC. This PC can also host the Windows 9x/Me drivers, even if it runs on Windows NT, 2000 or XP. +</p><p> +Since the <i class="parameter"><tt>[print$]</tt></i> share is usually accessible through the <span class="guiicon">Network +Neighborhood</span>, you can also use the UNC notation from Windows Explorer to poke at it. The Windows +9x/Me driver files will end up in subdirectory <tt class="filename">0</tt> of the <tt class="filename">WIN40</tt> +directory. The full path to access them will be <tt class="filename">\\WINDOWSHOST\print$\WIN40\0\</tt>. +</p><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p> +More recent drivers on Windows 2000 and Windows XP are installed into the “<span class="quote">3</span>” subdirectory +instead of the “<span class="quote">2</span>”. The version 2 of drivers, as used in Windows NT, were running in Kernel +Mode. Windows 2000 changed this. While it still can use the Kernel Mode drivers (if this is enabled by +the Admin), its native mode for printer drivers is User Mode execution. This requires drivers designed +for this. These types of drivers install into the “<span class="quote">3</span>” subdirectory. +</p></div></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2926311"></a>Obtaining Driver Files from Windows Client [print$] Shares</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> +Now we need to collect all the driver files we identified in our previous step. Where do we get them +from? Well, why not retrieve them from the very PC and the same <i class="parameter"><tt>[print$]</tt></i> +share that we investigated in our last step to identify the files? We can use <b class="command">smbclient</b> +to do this. We will use the paths and names that were leaked to us by <b class="command">getdriver</b>. The +listing is edited to include linebreaks for readability: +</p><pre class="screen"> +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>smbclient //TURBO_XP/print\$ -U'Danka%xxxx' \ + -c 'cd W32X86/2;mget HD*_de.* hd*ppd Hd*_de.* Hddm*dll HDN*Aux.DLL'</tt></b> + +added interface ip=10.160.51.60 bcast=10.160.51.255 nmask=255.255.252.0 +Got a positive name query response from 10.160.50.8 ( 10.160.50.8 ) +Domain=[DEVELOPMENT] OS=[Windows 5.1] Server=[Windows 2000 LAN Manager] +<tt class="prompt">Get file Hddm91c1_de.ABD? </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>n</tt></b> +<tt class="prompt">Get file Hddm91c1_de.def? </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>y</tt></b> +getting file \W32X86\2\Hddm91c1_de.def of size 428 as Hddm91c1_de.def +<tt class="prompt">Get file Hddm91c1_de.DLL? </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>y</tt></b> +getting file \W32X86\2\Hddm91c1_de.DLL of size 876544 as Hddm91c1_de.DLL +[...] +</pre><p> +After this command is complete, the files are in our current local directory. You probably have noticed +that this time we passed several commands to the <tt class="option">-c</tt> parameter, separated by semi-colons. +This effects that all commands are executed in sequence on the remote Windows server before smbclient +exits again. +</p><p> +Remember to repeat the procedure for the <span class="application">WIN40</span> architecture should +you need to support Windows 9x/Me/XP clients. Remember too, the files for these architectures are in the +<tt class="filename">WIN40/0/</tt> subdirectory. Once this is complete, we can run <b class="command">smbclient ... +put</b> to store the collected files on the Samba server's <i class="parameter"><tt>[print$]</tt></i> +share. +</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2926467"></a>Installing Driver Files into [print$]</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> +We are now going to locate the driver files into the <i class="parameter"><tt>[print$]</tt></i> +share. Remember, the UNIX path to this share has been defined +previously in your words missing here. You +also have created subdirectories for the different Windows client types you want to +support. Supposing your <i class="parameter"><tt>[print$]</tt></i> share maps to the UNIX path +<tt class="filename">/etc/samba/drivers/</tt>, your driver files should now go here: +</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p> + For all Windows NT, 2000 and XP clients into <tt class="filename">/etc/samba/drivers/W32X86/</tt> but + not (yet) into the <tt class="filename">2</tt> subdirectory. + </p></li><li><p> + For all Windows 95, 98 and ME clients into <tt class="filename">/etc/samba/drivers/WIN40/</tt> but not + (yet) into the <tt class="filename">0</tt> subdirectory. + </p></li></ul></div><p> +We again use smbclient to transfer the driver files across the network. We specify the same files +and paths as were leaked to us by running <b class="command">getdriver</b> against the original +<span class="emphasis"><em>Windows</em></span> install. However, now we are going to store the files into a +<span class="emphasis"><em>Samba/UNIX</em></span> print server's <i class="parameter"><tt>[print$]</tt></i> share. +</p><pre class="screen"> +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>smbclient //SAMBA-CUPS/print\$ -U'root%xxxx' -c \ + 'cd W32X86; put HDNIS01_de.DLL; \ + put Hddm91c1_de.ppd; put HDNIS01U_de.DLL; \ + put HDNIS01U_de.HLP; put Hddm91c1_de.DLL; \ + put Hddm91c1_de.INI; put Hddm91c1KMMin.DLL; \ + put Hddm91c1_de.dat; put Hddm91c1_de.dat; \ + put Hddm91c1_de.def; put Hddm91c1_de.hre; \ + put Hddm91c1_de.vnd; put Hddm91c1_de.hlp; \ + put Hddm91c1_de_reg.HLP; put HDNIS01Aux.dll; \ + put HDNIS01_de.NTF'</tt></b> + +added interface ip=10.160.51.60 bcast=10.160.51.255 nmask=255.255.252.0 +Got a positive name query response from 10.160.51.162 ( 10.160.51.162 ) +Domain=[CUPS-PRINT] OS=[UNIX] Server=[Samba 2.2.7a] +putting file HDNIS01_de.DLL as \W32X86\HDNIS01_de.DLL +putting file Hddm91c1_de.ppd as \W32X86\Hddm91c1_de.ppd +putting file HDNIS01U_de.DLL as \W32X86\HDNIS01U_de.DLL +putting file HDNIS01U_de.HLP as \W32X86\HDNIS01U_de.HLP +putting file Hddm91c1_de.DLL as \W32X86\Hddm91c1_de.DLL +putting file Hddm91c1_de.INI as \W32X86\Hddm91c1_de.INI +putting file Hddm91c1KMMin.DLL as \W32X86\Hddm91c1KMMin.DLL +putting file Hddm91c1_de.dat as \W32X86\Hddm91c1_de.dat +putting file Hddm91c1_de.dat as \W32X86\Hddm91c1_de.dat +putting file Hddm91c1_de.def as \W32X86\Hddm91c1_de.def +putting file Hddm91c1_de.hre as \W32X86\Hddm91c1_de.hre +putting file Hddm91c1_de.vnd as \W32X86\Hddm91c1_de.vnd +putting file Hddm91c1_de.hlp as \W32X86\Hddm91c1_de.hlp +putting file Hddm91c1_de_reg.HLP as \W32X86\Hddm91c1_de_reg.HLP +putting file HDNIS01Aux.dll as \W32X86\HDNIS01Aux.dll +putting file HDNIS01_de.NTF as \W32X86\HDNIS01_de.NTF +</pre><p> + +Whew that was a lot of typing! Most drivers are a lot smaller many only having three generic +PostScript driver files plus one PPD. While we did retrieve the files from the <tt class="filename">2</tt> +subdirectory of the <tt class="filename">W32X86</tt> directory from the Windows box, we do not put them +(for now) in this same subdirectory of the Samba box. This relocation will automatically be done by the +<b class="command">adddriver</b> command, which we will run shortly (and do not forget to also put the files +for the Windows 9x/Me architecture into the <tt class="filename">WIN40/</tt> subdirectory should you need them). +</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2926676"></a><b class="command">smbclient</b> to Confirm Driver Installation</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> +For now we verify that our files are there. This can be done with <b class="command">smbclient</b>, too +(but, of course, you can log in via SSH also and do this through a standard UNIX shell access): +</p><pre class="screen"> +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>smbclient //SAMBA-CUPS/print\$ -U 'root%xxxx' \ + -c 'cd W32X86; pwd; dir; cd 2; pwd; dir'</tt></b> + added interface ip=10.160.51.60 bcast=10.160.51.255 nmask=255.255.252.0 +Got a positive name query response from 10.160.51.162 ( 10.160.51.162 ) +Domain=[CUPS-PRINT] OS=[UNIX] Server=[Samba 2.2.8a] + +Current directory is \\SAMBA-CUPS\print$\W32X86\ +. D 0 Sun May 4 03:56:35 2003 +.. D 0 Thu Apr 10 23:47:40 2003 +2 D 0 Sun May 4 03:56:18 2003 +HDNIS01Aux.dll A 15356 Sun May 4 03:58:59 2003 +Hddm91c1KMMin.DLL A 46966 Sun May 4 03:58:59 2003 +HDNIS01_de.DLL A 434400 Sun May 4 03:58:59 2003 +HDNIS01_de.NTF A 790404 Sun May 4 03:56:35 2003 +Hddm91c1_de.DLL A 876544 Sun May 4 03:58:59 2003 +Hddm91c1_de.INI A 101 Sun May 4 03:58:59 2003 +Hddm91c1_de.dat A 5044 Sun May 4 03:58:59 2003 +Hddm91c1_de.def A 428 Sun May 4 03:58:59 2003 +Hddm91c1_de.hlp A 37699 Sun May 4 03:58:59 2003 +Hddm91c1_de.hre A 323584 Sun May 4 03:58:59 2003 +Hddm91c1_de.ppd A 26373 Sun May 4 03:58:59 2003 +Hddm91c1_de.vnd A 45056 Sun May 4 03:58:59 2003 +HDNIS01U_de.DLL A 165888 Sun May 4 03:58:59 2003 +HDNIS01U_de.HLP A 19770 Sun May 4 03:58:59 2003 +Hddm91c1_de_reg.HLP A 228417 Sun May 4 03:58:59 2003 + 40976 blocks of size 262144. 709 blocks available + +Current directory is \\SAMBA-CUPS\print$\W32X86\2\ +. D 0 Sun May 4 03:56:18 2003 +.. D 0 Sun May 4 03:56:35 2003 +ADOBEPS5.DLL A 434400 Sat May 3 23:18:45 2003 +laserjet4.ppd A 9639 Thu Apr 24 01:05:32 2003 +ADOBEPSU.DLL A 109568 Sat May 3 23:18:45 2003 +ADOBEPSU.HLP A 18082 Sat May 3 23:18:45 2003 +PDFcreator2.PPD A 15746 Sun Apr 20 22:24:07 2003 + 40976 blocks of size 262144. 709 blocks available +</pre><p> +Notice that there are already driver files present in the <tt class="filename">2</tt> subdirectory (probably +from a previous installation). Once the files for the new driver are there too, you are still a few +steps away from being able to use them on the clients. The only thing you could do now is to retrieve +them from a client just like you retrieve ordinary files from a file share, by opening print$ in Windows +Explorer. But that wouldn't install them per Point'n'Print. The reason +is: Samba does not yet know that +these files are something special, namely <span class="emphasis"><em>printer driver files</em></span> and it does not know +to which print queue(s) these driver files belong. +</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2926841"></a>Running <b class="command">rpcclient</b> with <b class="command">adddriver</b></h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> +Next, you must tell Samba about the special category of the files you just uploaded into the +<i class="parameter"><tt>[print$]</tt></i> share. This is done by the <b class="command">adddriver</b> +command. It will prompt Samba to register the driver files into its internal TDB database files. The +following command and its output has been edited, again, for readability: +</p><pre class="screen"> +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>rpcclient -Uroot%xxxx -c 'adddriver "Windows NT x86" \ + "dm9110:HDNIS01_de.DLL: \ + Hddm91c1_de.ppd:HDNIS01U_de.DLL:HDNIS01U_de.HLP: \ + NULL:RAW:Hddm91c1_de.DLL,Hddm91c1_de.INI, \ + Hddm91c1_de.dat,Hddm91c1_de.def,Hddm91c1_de.hre, \ + Hddm91c1_de.vnd,Hddm91c1_de.hlp,Hddm91c1KMMin.DLL, \ + HDNIS01Aux.dll,HDNIS01_de.NTF, \ + Hddm91c1_de_reg.HLP' SAMBA-CUPS</tt></b> + +cmd = adddriver "Windows NT x86" \ + "dm9110:HDNIS01_de.DLL:Hddm91c1_de.ppd:HDNIS01U_de.DLL: \ + HDNIS01U_de.HLP:NULL:RAW:Hddm91c1_de.DLL,Hddm91c1_de.INI, \ + Hddm91c1_de.dat,Hddm91c1_de.def,Hddm91c1_de.hre, \ + Hddm91c1_de.vnd,Hddm91c1_de.hlp,Hddm91c1KMMin.DLL, \ + HDNIS01Aux.dll,HDNIS01_de.NTF,Hddm91c1_de_reg.HLP" + +Printer Driver dm9110 successfully installed. +</pre><p> +After this step, the driver should be recognized by Samba on the print server. You need to be very +careful when typing the command. Don't exchange the order of the fields. Some changes would lead to +an <tt class="computeroutput">NT_STATUS_UNSUCCESSFUL</tt> error message. These become obvious. Other +changes might install the driver files successfully, but render the driver unworkable. So take care! +Hints about the syntax of the adddriver command are in the man page. The CUPS printing chapter +provides a more detailed description, should you need it. +</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2926940"></a>Checking <b class="command">adddriver</b> Completion</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> +One indication for Samba's recognition of the files as driver files is the <tt class="computeroutput">successfully +installed</tt> message. Another one is the fact that our files have been moved by the +<b class="command">adddriver</b> command into the <tt class="filename">2</tt> subdirectory. You can check this +again with <b class="command">smbclient</b>: +</p><pre class="screen"> +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>smbclient //SAMBA-CUPS/print\$ -Uroot%xx \ + -c 'cd W32X86;dir;pwd;cd 2;dir;pwd'</tt></b> + added interface ip=10.160.51.162 bcast=10.160.51.255 nmask=255.255.252.0 + Domain=[CUPS-PRINT] OS=[UNIX] Server=[Samba 2.2.7a] + + Current directory is \\SAMBA-CUPS\print$\W32X86\ + . D 0 Sun May 4 04:32:48 2003 + .. D 0 Thu Apr 10 23:47:40 2003 + 2 D 0 Sun May 4 04:32:48 2003 + 40976 blocks of size 262144. 731 blocks available + + Current directory is \\SAMBA-CUPS\print$\W32X86\2\ + . D 0 Sun May 4 04:32:48 2003 + .. D 0 Sun May 4 04:32:48 2003 + DigiMaster.PPD A 148336 Thu Apr 24 01:07:00 2003 + ADOBEPS5.DLL A 434400 Sat May 3 23:18:45 2003 + laserjet4.ppd A 9639 Thu Apr 24 01:05:32 2003 + ADOBEPSU.DLL A 109568 Sat May 3 23:18:45 2003 + ADOBEPSU.HLP A 18082 Sat May 3 23:18:45 2003 + PDFcreator2.PPD A 15746 Sun Apr 20 22:24:07 2003 + HDNIS01Aux.dll A 15356 Sun May 4 04:32:18 2003 + Hddm91c1KMMin.DLL A 46966 Sun May 4 04:32:18 2003 + HDNIS01_de.DLL A 434400 Sun May 4 04:32:18 2003 + HDNIS01_de.NTF A 790404 Sun May 4 04:32:18 2003 + Hddm91c1_de.DLL A 876544 Sun May 4 04:32:18 2003 + Hddm91c1_de.INI A 101 Sun May 4 04:32:18 2003 + Hddm91c1_de.dat A 5044 Sun May 4 04:32:18 2003 + Hddm91c1_de.def A 428 Sun May 4 04:32:18 2003 + Hddm91c1_de.hlp A 37699 Sun May 4 04:32:18 2003 + Hddm91c1_de.hre A 323584 Sun May 4 04:32:18 2003 + Hddm91c1_de.ppd A 26373 Sun May 4 04:32:18 2003 + Hddm91c1_de.vnd A 45056 Sun May 4 04:32:18 2003 + HDNIS01U_de.DLL A 165888 Sun May 4 04:32:18 2003 + HDNIS01U_de.HLP A 19770 Sun May 4 04:32:18 2003 + Hddm91c1_de_reg.HLP A 228417 Sun May 4 04:32:18 2003 + 40976 blocks of size 262144. 731 blocks available +</pre><p> +Another verification is that the timestamp of the printing TDB files is now updated +(and possibly their file size has increased). +</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2927063"></a>Check Samba for Driver Recognition</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> +Now the driver should be registered with Samba. We can easily verify this, and will do so in a +moment. However, this driver is not yet associated with a particular printer. We may check the driver +status of the files by at least three methods: +</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p> + From any Windows client browse Network Neighborhood, find the Samba host and open the Samba + <span class="guiicon">Printers and Faxes</span> folder. Select any printer icon, right-click and select + the printer <span class="guimenuitem">Properties</span>. Click the <span class="guilabel">Advanced</span> + tab. Here is a field indicating the driver for that printer. A drop-down menu allows you to + change that driver (be careful not to do this unwittingly). You can use this list to view + all drivers known to Samba. Your new one should be among them. (Each type of client will only + see his own architecture's list. If you do not have every driver installed for each platform, + the list will differ if you look at it from Windows95/98/ME or WindowsNT/2000/XP.) + </p></li><li><p> + From a Windows 200x/XP client (not Windows NT) browse <span class="guiicon">Network Neighborhood</span>, + search for the Samba server and open the server's <span class="guiicon">Printers</span> folder, + right-click on the white background (with no printer highlighted). Select <span class="guimenuitem">Server + Properties</span>. On the <span class="guilabel">Drivers</span> tab you will see the new driver + listed. This view enables you to also inspect the list of files belonging to that driver + (this does not work on Windows NT, but only on Windows 2000 and Windows XP; Windows NT does not + provide the <span class="guimenuitem">Drivers</span> tab). An + alternative and much quicker method for + Windows 2000/XP to start this dialog is by typing into a DOS box (you must of course adapt the + name to your Samba server instead of <i class="replaceable"><tt>SAMBA-CUPS</tt></i>): + </p><p><b class="userinput"><tt>rundll32 printui.dll,PrintUIEntry /s /t2 /n\\<i class="replaceable"><tt>SAMBA-CUPS</tt></i></tt></b></p></li><li><p> + From a UNIX prompt, run this command (or a variant thereof) where + <i class="replaceable"><tt>SAMBA-CUPS</tt></i> is the name of the Samba host and xxxx represents the + actual Samba password assigned to root: + </p><p><b class="userinput"><tt>rpcclient -U'root%xxxx' -c 'enumdrivers' <i class="replaceable"><tt>SAMBA-CUPS</tt></i></tt></b></p><p> + You will see a listing of all drivers Samba knows about. Your new one should be among + them. But it is only listed under the <i class="parameter"><tt>[Windows NT x86]</tt></i> heading, not under + <i class="parameter"><tt>[Windows 4.0]</tt></i>, since you didn't install that part. Or did you? + You will see a listing of all drivers Samba knows about. Your new one should be among them. In + our example it is named <tt class="constant">dm9110</tt>. Note that the third column shows the other + installed drivers twice, one time for each supported architecture. Our new driver only shows up + for <span class="application">Windows NT 4.0 or 2000</span>. To have it present for <span class="application">Windows + 95, 98 and ME</span>, you'll have to repeat the whole procedure with the WIN40 architecture + and subdirectory. + </p></li></ul></div></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2927262"></a>Specific Driver Name Flexibility</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> +You can name the driver as you like. If you repeat the <b class="command">adddriver</b> step with the same +files as before but with a different driver name, it will work the same: +</p><pre class="screen"> +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>rpcclient -Uroot%xxxx \ + -c 'adddriver "Windows NT x86" \ + "mydrivername:HDNIS01_de.DLL: \ + Hddm91c1_de.ppd:HDNIS01U_de.DLL:HDNIS01U_de.HLP: \ + NULL:RAW:Hddm91c1_de.DLL,Hddm91c1_de.INI, \ + Hddm91c1_de.dat,Hddm91c1_de.def,Hddm91c1_de.hre, \ + Hddm91c1_de.vnd,Hddm91c1_de.hlp,Hddm91c1KMMin.DLL, \ + HDNIS01Aux.dll,HDNIS01_de.NTF,Hddm91c1_de_reg.HLP' SAMBA-CUPS + </tt></b> + +cmd = adddriver "Windows NT x86" \ + "mydrivername:HDNIS01_de.DLL:Hddm91c1_de.ppd:HDNIS01U_de.DLL:\ + HDNIS01U_de.HLP:NULL:RAW:Hddm91c1_de.DLL,Hddm91c1_de.INI, \ + Hddm91c1_de.dat,Hddm91c1_de.def,Hddm91c1_de.hre, \ + Hddm91c1_de.vnd,Hddm91c1_de.hlp,Hddm91c1KMMin.DLL, \ + HDNIS01Aux.dll,HDNIS01_de.NTF,Hddm91c1_de_reg.HLP" + +Printer Driver mydrivername successfully installed. +</pre><p> +You will be able to bind that driver to any print queue (however, you are responsible that +you associate drivers to queues that make sense with respect to target printers). You cannot run the +<b class="command">rpcclient</b> <b class="command">adddriver</b> command repeatedly. Each run consumes the +files you had put into the <i class="parameter"><tt>[print$]</tt></i> share by moving them into the +respective subdirectories. So you must execute an <b class="command">smbclient ... put</b> command before +each <b class="command">rpcclient ... adddriver</b> command. +</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2927366"></a>Running <b class="command">rpcclient</b> with the <b class="command">setdriver</b></h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> +Samba needs to know which printer owns which driver. Create a mapping of the driver to a printer, and +store this info in Samba's memory, the TDB files. The <b class="command">rpcclient setdriver</b> command +achieves exactly this: +</p><pre class="screen"> +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>rpcclient -U'root%xxxx' -c 'setdriver dm9110 mydrivername' <i class="replaceable"><tt>SAMBA-CUPS</tt></i></tt></b> + cmd = setdriver dm9110 mydrivername + +Successfully set dm9110 to driver mydrivername. +</pre><p> +Ah, no, I did not want to do that. Repeat, this time with the name I intended: +</p><pre class="screen"> +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>rpcclient -U'root%xxxx' -c 'setdriver dm9110 dm9110' <i class="replaceable"><tt>SAMBA-CUPS</tt></i></tt></b> + cmd = setdriver dm9110 dm9110 +Successfully set dm9110 to driver dm9110. +</pre><p> +The syntax of the command is: +</p><pre class="screen"> +<b class="userinput"><tt>rpcclient -U'root%<i class="replaceable"><tt>sambapassword</tt></i>' -c 'setdriver <i class="replaceable"><tt>printername</tt></i> \ + <i class="replaceable"><tt>drivername</tt></i>' <i class="replaceable"><tt>SAMBA-Hostname</tt></i></tt></b>. +</pre><p> +Now we have done most of the work, but not all of it. +</p><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p> +The <b class="command">setdriver</b> command will only succeed if the +printer is already known to Samba. A +bug in 2.2.x prevented Samba from recognizing freshly installed printers. You had to restart Samba, +or at least send an HUP signal to all running smbd processes to work around this: <b class="userinput"><tt>kill -HUP +`pidof smbd`</tt></b>. +</p></div></div></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2927518"></a>Client Driver Installation Procedure</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +As Don Quixote said: “<span class="quote">The proof of the pudding is in the eating.</span>” The proof +for our setup lies in the printing. So let's install the printer driver onto the client PCs. This is +not as straightforward as it may seem. Read on. +</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2927537"></a>First Client Driver Installation</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +Especially important is the installation onto the first client PC (for each architectural platform +separately). Once this is done correctly, all further clients are easy to setup and shouldn't need further +attention. What follows is a description for the recommended first procedure. You work now from a client +workstation. You should guarantee that your connection is not unwittingly mapped to <span class="emphasis"><em>bad +user</em></span> nobody. In a DOS box type: +</p><p><b class="userinput"><tt>net use \\<i class="replaceable"><tt>SAMBA-SERVER</tt></i>\print$ /user:root</tt></b></p><p> +Replace root, if needed, by another valid <a class="indexterm" name="id2927577"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>printer admin</tt></i> user as given in +the definition. Should you already be connected as a different user, you will get an error message. There +is no easy way to get rid of that connection, because Windows does not seem to know a concept of logging +off from a share connection (do not confuse this with logging off from the local workstation; that is +a different matter). You can try to close all Windows file explorer +and Internet Explorer for Windows. As +a last resort, you may have to reboot. Make sure there is no automatic reconnection set up. It may be +easier to go to a different workstation and try from there. After you have made sure you are connected +as a printer admin user (you can check this with the <b class="command">smbstatus</b> command on Samba), +do this from the Windows workstation: +</p><div class="procedure"><ol type="1"><li><p> + Open <span class="guiicon">Network Neighborhood</span>. + </p></li><li><p> + Browse to Samba server. + </p></li><li><p> + Open its <span class="guiicon">Printers and Faxes</span> folder. + </p></li><li><p> + Highlight and right-click on the printer. + </p></li><li><p> + Select <span class="guimenuitem">Connect</span> (for Windows NT4/200x + it is possibly <span class="guimenuitem">Install</span>). + </p></li></ol></div><p> +A new printer (named <i class="replaceable"><tt>printername</tt></i> on Samba-server) should now have +appeared in your <span class="emphasis"><em>local</em></span> Printer folder (check <span class="guimenu">Start</span> -- +<span class="guimenuitem">Settings</span> -- <span class="guimenuitem">Control Panel</span> -- <span class="guiicon">Printers +and Faxes</span>). +</p><p> +Most likely you are now tempted to try to print a test page. After all, you now can open the printer +properties, and on the <span class="guimenu">General</span> tab there is a button offering to do just that. But +chances are that you get an error message saying <span class="errorname">Unable to print Test Page</span>. The +reason might be that there is not yet a valid Device Mode set for the driver, or that the “<span class="quote">Printer +Driver Data</span>” set is still incomplete. +</p><p> +You must make sure that a valid <i class="parameter"><tt>Device Mode</tt></i> is set for the +driver. We now explain what that means. +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2927769"></a>Setting Device Modes on New Printers</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +For a printer to be truly usable by a Windows NT/200x/XP client, it must possess: +</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p> + A valid <span class="emphasis"><em>Device Mode</em></span> generated by the driver for the printer (defining things + like paper size, orientation and duplex settings). + </p></li><li><p> + A complete set of <span class="emphasis"><em>Printer Driver Data</em></span> generated by the driver. + </p></li></ul></div><p> +If either of these is incomplete, the clients can produce less than optimal output at best. In the +worst cases, unreadable garbage or nothing at all comes from the printer or it produces a harvest of +error messages when attempting to print. Samba stores the named values and all printing related information in +its internal TDB database files <tt class="filename">(ntprinters.tdb</tt>, <tt class="filename">ntdrivers.tdb</tt>, +<tt class="filename">printing.tdb</tt> and <tt class="filename">ntforms.tdb</tt>). +</p><p> +What do these two words stand for? Basically, the Device Mode and the set of Printer Driver Data is a +collection of settings for all print queue properties, initialized in a sensible way. Device Modes and +Printer Driver Data should initially be set on the print server (the Samba host) to healthy +values so the clients can start to use them immediately. How do we set these initial healthy values? +This can be achieved by accessing the drivers remotely from an NT (or 200x/XP) client, as is discussed +in the following paragraphs. +</p><p> +Be aware that a valid Device Mode can only be initiated by a +<a class="indexterm" name="id2927864"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>printer admin</tt></i>, or root +(the reason should be obvious). Device Modes can only be correctly +set by executing the printer driver program itself. Since Samba cannot execute this Win32 platform driver +code, it sets this field initially to NULL (which is not a valid setting for clients to use). Fortunately, +most drivers automatically generate the Printer Driver Data that is needed when they are uploaded to the +<i class="parameter"><tt>[print$]</tt></i> share with the help of the APW or rpcclient. +</p><p> +The generation and setting of a first valid Device Mode, however, requires some tickling from a client, +to set it on the Samba server. The easiest means of doing so is to simply change the page orientation on +the server's printer. This executes enough of the printer driver program on the client for the desired +effect to happen, and feeds back the new Device Mode to our Samba server. You can use the native Windows +NT/200x/XP printer properties page from a Window client for this: +</p><div class="procedure"><ol type="1"><li><p> + Browse the <span class="guiicon">Network Neighborhood.</span> + </p></li><li><p> + Find the Samba server. + </p></li><li><p> + Open the Samba server's <span class="guiicon">Printers and Faxes</span> folder. + </p></li><li><p> + Highlight the shared printer in question. + </p></li><li><p> + Right-click on the printer (you may already be here, if you followed the last section's description). + </p></li><li><p> + At the bottom of the context menu select <span class="guimenu">Properties</span> (if the menu still offers the + <span class="guimenuitem">Connect</span> entry further above, you + need to click on that one first to achieve the driver + installation as shown in the last section). + </p></li><li><p> + Go to the <span class="guilabel">Advanced</span> tab; click on <span class="guibutton">Printing Defaults</span>. + </p></li><li><p> + Change the <span class="guimenuitem">Portrait</span> page setting to <span class="guimenuitem">Landscape</span> (and back). + </p></li><li><p> + Make sure to apply changes between swapping the page orientation to cause the change to actually take effect. + </p></li><li><p> + While you are at it, you may also want to set the desired printing defaults here, which then apply to all future + client driver installations on the remaining from now on. + </p></li></ol></div><p> +This procedure has executed the printer driver program on the client platform and fed back the correct +Device Mode to Samba, which now stored it in its TDB files. Once the driver is installed on the client, +you can follow the analogous steps by accessing the <span class="emphasis"><em>local</em></span> <span class="guiicon">Printers</span> +folder, too, if you are a Samba printer admin user. From now on, printing should work as expected. +</p><p> +Samba includes a service level parameter name <i class="parameter"><tt>default devmode</tt></i> for generating a default +Device Mode for a printer. Some drivers will function well with Samba's default set of properties. Others +may crash the client's spooler service. So use this parameter with caution. It is always better to have +the client generate a valid device mode for the printer and store it on the server for you. +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2928112"></a>Additional Client Driver Installation</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +Every additional driver may be installed, along the lines described +above. Browse network, open the +<span class="guiicon">Printers</span> folder on Samba server, right-click on <span class="guiicon">Printer</span> and choose +<span class="guimenuitem">Connect...</span>. Once this completes (should be not more than a few seconds, +but could also take a minute, depending on network conditions), you should find the new printer in your +client workstation local <span class="guiicon">Printers and Faxes</span> folder. +</p><p> +You can also open your local <span class="guiicon">Printers and Faxes</span> folder by +using this command on Windows 200x/XP Professional workstations: +</p><p><b class="userinput"><tt>rundll32 shell32.dll,SHHelpShortcuts_RunDLL PrintersFolder</tt></b></p><p> +or this command on Windows NT 4.0 workstations: +</p><p><b class="userinput"><tt> +rundll32 shell32.dll,Control_RunDLL MAIN.CPL @2 +</tt></b></p><p> +You can enter the commands either inside a <span class="guilabel">DOS box</span> window or in the <span class="guimenuitem">Run +command...</span> field from the <span class="guimenu">Start</span> menu. +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2928220"></a>Always Make First Client Connection as root or “<span class="quote">printer admin</span>”</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +After you installed the driver on the Samba server (in its <i class="parameter"><tt>[print$]</tt></i> +share, you should always make sure that your first client installation completes correctly. Make it a +habit for yourself to build the very first connection from a client as <a class="indexterm" name="id2928244"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>printer admin</tt></i>. This is to make sure that: +</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p> + A first valid <span class="emphasis"><em>Device Mode</em></span> is really initialized (see above for more + explanation details). + </p></li><li><p> + The default print settings of your printer for all further client installations are as you want them. + </p></li></ul></div><p> +Do this by changing the orientation to landscape, click on <span class="guiicon">Apply</span>, and then change it +back again. Next, modify the other settings (for example, you do not want the default media size set to +<span class="guiicon">Letter</span> when you are all using <span class="guiicon">A4</span>, right? You may want to set the +printer for <span class="guiicon">duplex</span> as the default, and so on). +</p><p> +To connect as root to a Samba printer, try this command from a Windows 200x/XP DOS box command prompt: +</p><pre class="screen"> +<tt class="prompt">C:\> </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>runas /netonly /user:root "rundll32 printui.dll,PrintUIEntry /p /t3 /n + \\<i class="replaceable"><tt>SAMBA-SERVER</tt></i>\<i class="replaceable"><tt>printername</tt></i>"</tt></b> +</pre><p> +</p><p> +You will be prompted for root's Samba-password; type it, wait a few +seconds, click on <span class="guibutton">Printing +Defaults</span>, and proceed to set the job options that should be used as defaults by all +clients. Alternately, instead of root you can name one other member of the <a class="indexterm" name="id2928372"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>printer admin</tt></i> from the setting. +</p><p> + Now all the other users downloading and installing the driver the same way (called +“<span class="quote">Point'n'Print</span>”) will have the same defaults set for them. If you miss this step +you'll get a lot of Help Desk calls from your users, but maybe you like to talk to people. +</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2928404"></a>Other Gotchas</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +Your driver is installed. It is now ready for Point'n'Print +installation by the clients. You may have tried to download and use it +onto your first client machine, but +wait. Let's make sure you are acquainted first with a few tips and tricks you may find useful. For example, +suppose you did not set the defaults on the printer, as advised in the preceding +paragraphs. Your users complain about various issues (such as, “<span class="quote">We need to set the paper size +for each job from Letter to A4 and it will not store it.</span>”) +</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2928430"></a>Setting Default Print Options for Client Drivers</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +The last sentence might be viewed with mixed feelings by some users and +admins. They have struggled for hours and could not arrive at a point +where their settings seemed to be saved. It is not their fault. The confusing +thing is that in the multi-tabbed dialog that pops up when you right-click +on the printer name and select <span class="guimenuitem">Properties</span>, you +can arrive at two dialogs that appear identical, each claiming that they help +you to set printer options in three different ways. Here is the definite +answer to the Samba default driver setting FAQ: +</p><p><b>“<span class="quote">I can not set and save default print options +for all users on Windows 200x/XP. Why not?</span>” </b> +How are you doing it? I bet the wrong way. (It is not easy to find out, though). There are three different +ways to bring you to a dialog that seems to set everything. All three +dialogs look the same, but only one +of them does what you intend. You need to be Administrator or Print Administrator to do this for all +users. Here is how I reproduce it in an XP Professional: + +The following list needs periods after the letters and numbers::::::::: +</p><div class="orderedlist"><ol type="A"><li><p>The first “<span class="quote">wrong</span>” way: + </p><div class="orderedlist"><ol type="1"><li><p>Open the <span class="guiicon">Printers</span> folder.</p></li><li><p>Right-click on the printer (<span class="emphasis"><em>remoteprinter on cupshost</em></span>) and + select in context menu <span class="guimenu">Printing Preferences...</span></p></li><li><p>Look at this dialog closely and remember what it looks like.</p></li></ol></div></li><li><p>The second “<span class="quote">wrong</span>” way: + </p><div class="orderedlist"><ol type="1"><li><p>Open the <span class="guimenu">Printers</span> folder.</p></li><li><p>Right-click on the printer (<span class="emphasis"><em>remoteprinter on + cupshost</em></span>) and select in the context menu + <span class="guimenuitem">Properties</span></p></li><li><p>Click on the <span class="guilabel">General</span> + tab</p></li><li><p>Click on the <span class="guibutton">Printing + Preferences...</span></p></li><li><p>A new dialog opens. Keep this dialog open and go back + to the parent dialog.</p></li></ol></div><p> + </p></li><li><p> + The third and correct way: (should you do this from the beginning, just carry out steps 1 + and 2 from the second method above). + </p><div class="orderedlist"><ol type="1"><li><p>Click on the <span class="guilabel">Advanced</span> + tab. (If everything is “<span class="quote">grayed out,</span>” then you are not logged + in as a user with enough privileges).</p></li><li><p>Click on the <span class="guibutton">Printing + Defaults</span> button.</p></li><li><p>On any of the two new tabs, + click on the + <span class="guilabel">Advanced</span> button.</p></li><li><p>A new dialog opens. Compare + this one to the other. Are they + identical looking comparing one from + “<span class="quote">B.5</span>” and one from A.3".</p></li></ol></div></li></ol></div><p> +Do you see any difference in the two settings dialogs? I do not either. However, only the last one, which +you arrived at with steps C.1 through 6 will permanently save any settings which will then become the defaults +for new users. If you want all clients to have the same defaults, you need to conduct these steps as +administrator (<a class="indexterm" name="id2928716"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>printer admin</tt></i> in ) before +a client downloads the driver (the clients can later set their own per-user defaults +by following procedures A or B above). Windows 200x/XP allow per-user default settings and the ones the +administrator gives them, before they set up their own. The parents of the identically-looking dialogs have a slight difference in their window names; one is called <tt class="computeroutput">Default Print +Values for Printer Foo on Server Bar"</tt> (which is the one you need) and the other is called +“<span class="quote"><tt class="computeroutput">Print Settings for Printer Foo on Server Bar</tt></span>”. The last one is the one you +arrive at when you right-click on the printer and select <span class="guimenuitem">Print Settings...</span>. This +is the one that you were taught to use back in the days of Windows NT, so it is only natural to try the +same way with Windows 200x/XP. You would not dream that there is now a different path to arrive at an +identically looking, but functionally different, dialog to set defaults for all users. +</p><div class="tip" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Tip</h3><p>Try (on Windows 200x/XP) to run this command (as a user with the right privileges): +</p><p><b class="userinput"><tt> +rundll32 printui.dll,PrintUIEntry /p /t3 /n\\<i class="replaceable"><tt>SAMBA-SERVER</tt></i>\<i class="replaceable"><tt>printersharename</tt></i> +</tt></b></p><p> +To see the tab with the <span class="guilabel">Printing Defaults</span> button (the one you need),also run this command: +</p><p><b class="userinput"><tt> +rundll32 printui.dll,PrintUIEntry /p /t0 /n\\<i class="replaceable"><tt>SAMBA-SERVER</tt></i>\<i class="replaceable"><tt>printersharename</tt></i> +</tt></b></p><p> +To see the tab with the <span class="guilabel">Printing Preferences</span> +button (the one which does not set system-wide defaults), you can +start the commands from inside a DOS box" or from <span class="guimenu">Start</span> -> <span class="guimenuitem">Run</span>. +</p></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2928854"></a>Supporting Large Numbers of Printers</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +One issue that has arisen during the recent development phase of Samba is the need to support driver +downloads for hunderds of printers. Using Windows NT APW here is somewhat awkward (to say the least). If +you do not want to acquire RSS pains from the printer installation clicking orgy alone, you need +to think about a non-interactive script. +</p><p> +If more than one printer is using the same driver, the <b class="command">rpcclient setdriver</b> +command can be used to set the driver associated with an installed queue. If the driver is uploaded to +<i class="parameter"><tt>[print$]</tt></i> once and registered with the printing TDBs, it can be used by +multiple print queues. In this case, you just need to repeat the <b class="command">setprinter</b> subcommand of +<b class="command">rpcclient</b> for every queue (without the need to conduct the <b class="command">adddriver</b> +repeatedly). The following is an example of how this could be accomplished: +</p><pre class="screen"> +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>rpcclient <i class="replaceable"><tt>SAMBA-CUPS</tt></i> -U root%<i class="replaceable"><tt>secret</tt></i> -c 'enumdrivers'</tt></b> + cmd = enumdrivers + + [Windows NT x86] + Printer Driver Info 1: + Driver Name: [infotec IS 2075 PCL 6] + + Printer Driver Info 1: + Driver Name: [DANKA InfoStream] + + Printer Driver Info 1: + Driver Name: [Heidelberg Digimaster 9110 (PS)] + + Printer Driver Info 1: + Driver Name: [dm9110] + + Printer Driver Info 1: + Driver Name: [mydrivername] + + [....] +</pre><p> + +</p><pre class="screen"> +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>rpcclient <i class="replaceable"><tt>SAMBA-CUPS</tt></i> -U root%<i class="replaceable"><tt>secret</tt></i> -c 'enumprinters'</tt></b> + cmd = enumprinters + flags:[0x800000] + name:[\\SAMBA-CUPS\dm9110] + description:[\\SAMBA-CUPS\dm9110,,110ppm HiVolume DANKA Stuttgart] + comment:[110 ppm HiVolume DANKA Stuttgart] + [....] +</pre><p> + +</p><pre class="screen"> +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>rpcclient <i class="replaceable"><tt>SAMBA-CUPS</tt></i> -U root%<i class="replaceable"><tt>secret</tt></i> -c \ + 'setdriver <i class="replaceable"><tt>dm9110</tt></i> "<i class="replaceable"><tt>Heidelberg Digimaster 9110 (PS)</tt></i>"'</tt></b> + cmd = setdriver dm9110 Heidelberg Digimaster 9110 (PPD) + Successfully set dm9110 to driver Heidelberg Digimaster 9110 (PS). +</pre><p> + +</p><pre class="screen"> +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>rpcclient <i class="replaceable"><tt>SAMBA-CUPS</tt></i> -U root%<i class="replaceable"><tt>secret</tt></i> -c 'enumprinters'</tt></b> + cmd = enumprinters + flags:[0x800000] + name:[\\SAMBA-CUPS\dm9110] + description:[\\SAMBA-CUPS\dm9110,Heidelberg Digimaster 9110 (PS),\ + 110ppm HiVolume DANKA Stuttgart] + comment:[110ppm HiVolume DANKA Stuttgart] + [....] +</pre><p> + +</p><pre class="screen"> +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>rpcclient <i class="replaceable"><tt>SAMBA-CUPS</tt></i> -U root%<i class="replaceable"><tt>secret</tt></i> -c 'setdriver <i class="replaceable"><tt>dm9110</tt></i> <i class="replaceable"><tt>mydrivername</tt></i>'</tt></b> + cmd = setdriver dm9110 mydrivername + Successfully set dm9110 to mydrivername. +</pre><p> + +</p><pre class="screen"> +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>rpcclient <i class="replaceable"><tt>SAMBA-CUPS</tt></i> -U root%<i class="replaceable"><tt>secret</tt></i> -c 'enumprinters'</tt></b> + cmd = enumprinters + flags:[0x800000] + name:[\\SAMBA-CUPS\dm9110] + description:[\\SAMBA-CUPS\dm9110,mydrivername,\ + 110ppm HiVolume DANKA Stuttgart] + comment:[110ppm HiVolume DANKA Stuttgart] + [....] +</pre><p> +It may not be easy to recognize that the first call to <b class="command">enumprinters</b> showed the +“<span class="quote">dm9110</span>” printer with an empty string where the driver should have been listed (between +the 2 commas in the description field). After the <b class="command">setdriver</b> command +succeeded, all is well. +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2929151"></a>Adding New Printers with the Windows NT APW</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +By default, Samba exhibits all printer shares defined in <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> in the <span class="guiicon">Printers</span> +folder. Also located in this folder is the Windows NT Add Printer Wizard icon. The APW will be shown only if: +</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p> + The connected user is able to successfully execute an <b class="command">OpenPrinterEx(\\server)</b> with + administrative privileges (i.e., root or <a class="indexterm" name="id2929197"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>printer admin</tt></i>). + </p><div class="tip" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Tip</h3><p> Try this from a Windows 200x/XP DOS box command prompt: + </p><p><b class="userinput"><tt> + runas /netonly /user:root rundll32 printui.dll,PrintUIEntry /p /t0 /n \\<i class="replaceable"><tt>SAMBA-SERVER</tt></i>\<i class="replaceable"><tt>printersharename</tt></i> + </tt></b></p><p> + Click on <span class="guibutton">Printing Preferences</span>. + </p></div></li><li><p>... contains the setting + <a class="indexterm" name="id2929252"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>show add printer wizard</tt></i> = yes (the + default).</p></li></ul></div><p> +The APW can do various things: +</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p> + Upload a new driver to the Samba <i class="parameter"><tt>[print$]</tt></i> share. + </p></li><li><p> + Associate an uploaded driver with an existing (but still driverless) print queue. + </p></li><li><p> + Exchange the currently used driver for an existing print queue with one that has been uploaded before. + </p></li><li><p> + Add an entirely new printer to the Samba host (only in conjunction with a working + <a class="indexterm" name="id2929308"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>add printer command</tt></i>. A corresponding + <a class="indexterm" name="id2929324"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>delete printer command</tt></i> for removing entries from the + <span class="guiicon">Printers</span> folder may also be provided). + </p></li></ul></div><p> +The last one (add a new printer) requires more effort than the previous ones. To use +the APW to successfully add a printer to a Samba server, the <a class="indexterm" name="id2929353"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>add printer command</tt></i> must have a defined value. The program hook must successfully +add the printer to the UNIX print system (i.e., to <tt class="filename">/etc/printcap</tt>, +<tt class="filename">/etc/cups/printers.conf</tt> or other appropriate files) and to <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> if necessary. +</p><p> +When using the APW from a client, if the named printer share does not exist, smbd will execute the +<a class="indexterm" name="id2929396"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>add printer command</tt></i> and reparse to the to attempt to locate the new printer +share. If the share is still not defined, an error of <span class="errorname">Access Denied</span> is returned to +the client. The <a class="indexterm" name="id2929418"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>add printer command</tt></i> is executed +under the context of the connected user, not necessarily a root account. A <a class="indexterm" name="id2929433"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>map to guest</tt></i> = bad user may have connected you unwittingly under the wrong +privilege. You should check it by using the <b class="command">smbstatus</b> command. +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2929458"></a>Error Message: “<span class="quote"><span class="errorname">Cannot connect under a different Name</span></span>”</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +Once you are connected with the wrong credentials, there is no means to reverse the situation other than +to close all Explorer Windows, and perhaps reboot. +</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p> + The <b class="command">net use \\SAMBA-SERVER\sharename /user:root</b> gives you an error message: + “<span class="quote">Multiple connections to a server or a shared resource by the same user utilizing + the several user names are not allowed. Disconnect all previous connections to the server, + resp. the shared resource, and try again.</span>” + </p></li><li><p> + Every attempt to “<span class="quote">connect a network drive</span>” to <tt class="filename">\\SAMBASERVER\\print$</tt> + to <tt class="constant">z:</tt> is countered by the pertinacious message: “<span class="quote">This + network folder is currently connected under different credentials (username and password). + Disconnect first any existing connection to this network share in order to connect again under + a different username and password</span>”. + </p></li></ul></div><p> +So you close all connections. You try again. You get the same message. You check from the Samba side, +using <b class="command">smbstatus</b>. Yes, there are more connections. You kill them all. The client +still gives you the same error message. You watch the smbd.log file on a high debug level and try +reconnect. Same error message, but not a single line in the log. You start to wonder if there was a +connection attempt at all. You run ethereal and tcpdump while you try to connect. Result: not a single +byte goes on the wire. Windows still gives the error message. You close all Explorer windows and start it +again. You try to connect and this times it works! Windows seems to cache connection informtion somewhere and +does not keep it up-to-date (if you are unlucky you might need to reboot to get rid of the error message). +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2929564"></a>Take Care When Assembling Driver Files</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +You need to be extremely careful when you take notes about the files and belonging to a particular +driver. Don't confuse the files for driver version “<span class="quote">0</span>” (for Windows 9x/Me, going into +<tt class="filename">[print$]/WIN/0/</tt>), driver version <tt class="filename">2</tt> (Kernel Mode driver for Windows NT, +going into <tt class="filename">[print$]/W32X86/2/</tt> may be used on Windows 200x/XP also), and +driver version “<span class="quote">3</span>” (non-Kernel Mode driver going into <tt class="filename">[print$]/W32X86/3/</tt> +cannot be used on Windows NT). Quite often these different driver versions contain +files that have the same name but actually are very different. If you look at them from +the Windows Explorer (they reside in <tt class="filename">%WINDOWS%\system32\spool\drivers\W32X86\</tt>), +you will probably see names in capital letters, while an <b class="command">enumdrivers</b> command from Samba +would show mixed or lower case letters. So it is easy to confuse them. If you install them manually using +<b class="command">rpcclient</b> and subcommands, you may even succeed without an error message. Only later, +when you try install on a client, you will encounter error messages like <tt class="computeroutput">This server +has no appropriate driver for the printer</tt>. +</p><p> +Here is an example. You are invited to look closely at the various files, compare their names and +their spelling, and discover the differences in the composition of the version 2 and 3 sets. Note: the +version 0 set contained 40 <i class="parameter"><tt>Dependentfiles</tt></i>, so I left it out for space reasons: +</p><pre class="screen"> +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>rpcclient -U 'Administrator%<i class="replaceable"><tt>secret</tt></i>' -c 'enumdrivers 3' 10.160.50.8 </tt></b> + + Printer Driver Info 3: + Version: [3] + Driver Name: [Canon iR8500 PS3] + Architecture: [Windows NT x86] + Driver Path: [\\10.160.50.8\print$\W32X86\3\cns3g.dll] + Datafile: [\\10.160.50.8\print$\W32X86\3\iR8500sg.xpd] + Configfile: [\\10.160.50.8\print$\W32X86\3\cns3gui.dll] + Helpfile: [\\10.160.50.8\print$\W32X86\3\cns3g.hlp] + + Dependentfiles: [\\10.160.50.8\print$\W32X86\3\aucplmNT.dll] + Dependentfiles: [\\10.160.50.8\print$\W32X86\3\ucs32p.dll] + Dependentfiles: [\\10.160.50.8\print$\W32X86\3\tnl32.dll] + Dependentfiles: [\\10.160.50.8\print$\W32X86\3\aussdrv.dll] + Dependentfiles: [\\10.160.50.8\print$\W32X86\3\cnspdc.dll] + Dependentfiles: [\\10.160.50.8\print$\W32X86\3\aussapi.dat] + Dependentfiles: [\\10.160.50.8\print$\W32X86\3\cns3407.dll] + Dependentfiles: [\\10.160.50.8\print$\W32X86\3\CnS3G.cnt] + Dependentfiles: [\\10.160.50.8\print$\W32X86\3\NBAPI.DLL] + Dependentfiles: [\\10.160.50.8\print$\W32X86\3\NBIPC.DLL] + Dependentfiles: [\\10.160.50.8\print$\W32X86\3\cpcview.exe] + Dependentfiles: [\\10.160.50.8\print$\W32X86\3\cpcdspl.exe] + Dependentfiles: [\\10.160.50.8\print$\W32X86\3\cpcedit.dll] + Dependentfiles: [\\10.160.50.8\print$\W32X86\3\cpcqm.exe] + Dependentfiles: [\\10.160.50.8\print$\W32X86\3\cpcspl.dll] + Dependentfiles: [\\10.160.50.8\print$\W32X86\3\cfine32.dll] + Dependentfiles: [\\10.160.50.8\print$\W32X86\3\cpcr407.dll] + Dependentfiles: [\\10.160.50.8\print$\W32X86\3\Cpcqm407.hlp] + Dependentfiles: [\\10.160.50.8\print$\W32X86\3\cpcqm407.cnt] + Dependentfiles: [\\10.160.50.8\print$\W32X86\3\cns3ggr.dll] + + Monitorname: [] + Defaultdatatype: [] + + Printer Driver Info 3: + Version: [2] + Driver Name: [Canon iR5000-6000 PS3] + Architecture: [Windows NT x86] + Driver Path: [\\10.160.50.8\print$\W32X86\2\cns3g.dll] + Datafile: [\\10.160.50.8\print$\W32X86\2\IR5000sg.xpd] + Configfile: [\\10.160.50.8\print$\W32X86\2\cns3gui.dll] + Helpfile: [\\10.160.50.8\print$\W32X86\2\cns3g.hlp] + + Dependentfiles: [\\10.160.50.8\print$\W32X86\2\AUCPLMNT.DLL] + Dependentfiles: [\\10.160.50.8\print$\W32X86\2\aussdrv.dll] + Dependentfiles: [\\10.160.50.8\print$\W32X86\2\cnspdc.dll] + Dependentfiles: [\\10.160.50.8\print$\W32X86\2\aussapi.dat] + Dependentfiles: [\\10.160.50.8\print$\W32X86\2\cns3407.dll] + Dependentfiles: [\\10.160.50.8\print$\W32X86\2\CnS3G.cnt] + Dependentfiles: [\\10.160.50.8\print$\W32X86\2\NBAPI.DLL] + Dependentfiles: [\\10.160.50.8\print$\W32X86\2\NBIPC.DLL] + Dependentfiles: [\\10.160.50.8\print$\W32X86\2\cns3gum.dll] + + Monitorname: [CPCA Language Monitor2] + Defaultdatatype: [] + +</pre><p> +If we write the “<span class="quote">version 2</span>” files and the “<span class="quote">version 3</span>” files +into different text files and compare the result, we see this +picture: +</p><pre class="screen"> +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>sdiff 2-files 3-files</tt></b> + + + cns3g.dll cns3g.dll + iR8500sg.xpd iR8500sg.xpd + cns3gui.dll cns3gui.dll + cns3g.hlp cns3g.hlp + AUCPLMNT.DLL | aucplmNT.dll + > ucs32p.dll + > tnl32.dll + aussdrv.dll aussdrv.dll + cnspdc.dll cnspdc.dll + aussapi.dat aussapi.dat + cns3407.dll cns3407.dll + CnS3G.cnt CnS3G.cnt + NBAPI.DLL NBAPI.DLL + NBIPC.DLL NBIPC.DLL + cns3gum.dll | cpcview.exe + > cpcdspl.exe + > cpcqm.exe + > cpcspl.dll + > cfine32.dll + > cpcr407.dll + > Cpcqm407.hlp + > cpcqm407.cnt + > cns3ggr.dll + +</pre><p> + +Do not be fooled! Driver files for each version with identical +names may be different in their content, as you can see from this size +comparison: +</p><pre class="screen"> +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>for i in cns3g.hlp cns3gui.dll cns3g.dll; do \ + smbclient //10.160.50.8/print\$ -U 'Administrator%xxxx' \ + -c "cd W32X86/3; dir $i; cd .. ; cd 2; dir $i"; \ + done</tt></b> + + CNS3G.HLP A 122981 Thu May 30 02:31:00 2002 + CNS3G.HLP A 99948 Thu May 30 02:31:00 2002 + + CNS3GUI.DLL A 1805824 Thu May 30 02:31:00 2002 + CNS3GUI.DLL A 1785344 Thu May 30 02:31:00 2002 + + CNS3G.DLL A 1145088 Thu May 30 02:31:00 2002 + CNS3G.DLL A 15872 Thu May 30 02:31:00 2002 +</pre><p> +In my example were even more differences than shown here. Conclusion: you must be careful to select +the correct driver files for each driver version. Don't rely on the +names alone and don't interchange files +belonging to different driver versions. +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2929923"></a>Samba and Printer Ports</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +Windows NT/2000 print servers associate a port with each printer. These normally take the form of +<tt class="filename">LPT1:</tt>, <tt class="filename">COM1:</tt>, +<tt class="filename">FILE:</tt>, and so on. Samba must also +support the concept of ports associated with a printer. By default, only one printer port, named “<span class="quote">Samba +Printer Port</span>”, exists on a system. Samba does not really need such a “<span class="quote">port</span>” in order +to print; rather it is a requirement of Windows clients. They insist on being told about an available +port when they request this information, otherwise they throw an error message at you. So Samba fakes the port +information to keep the Windows clients happy. +</p><p> +Samba does not support the concept of <tt class="constant">Printer Pooling</tt> internally either. Printer +Pooling assigns a logical printer to multiple ports as a form of load balancing or fail over. +</p><p> +If you require multiple ports be defined for some reason or another (my users and my boss should not know +that they are working with Samba), configure <a class="indexterm" name="id2929988"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>enumports command</tt></i> +which can be used to define an external program that generates a listing of ports on a system. +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2930008"></a>Avoiding Common Client Driver Misconfiguration</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +So now the printing works, but there are still problems. Most jobs print well, some do not print at +all. Some jobs have problems with fonts, which do not look good. Some jobs print fast and some +are dead-slow. We cannot cover it all, but we want to encourage you to read the brief paragraph about +“<span class="quote">Avoiding the Wrong PostScript Driver Settings</span>” in the CUPS Printing part of this document. +</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2930033"></a>The Imprints Toolset</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +The Imprints tool set provides a UNIX equivalent of the Windows NT Add Printer +Wizard. For complete information, please refer to the Imprints Web site at <ulink url="http://imprints.sourceforge.net/">http://imprints.sourceforge.net/</ulink> as well as the documentation +included with the imprints source distribution. This section only provides a brief introduction to +the features of Imprints. +</p><p> +Unfortunately, the Imprints toolset is no longer maintained. As of December 2000, the project is in +need of a new maintainer. The most important skill to have is Perl coding and an interest in MS-RPC-based +printing used in Samba. If you wish to volunteer, please coordinate +your efforts on the Samba technical +mailing list. The toolset is still in usable form, but only for a series of older printer models where +there are prepared packages to use. Packages for more up-to-date print devices are needed if Imprints +should have a future. +</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2930071"></a>What is Imprints?</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +Imprints is a collection of tools for supporting these goals: +</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p> + Providing a central repository of information regarding Windows NT and 95/98 printer driver packages. + </p></li><li><p> + Providing the tools necessary for creating the Imprints printer driver packages. + </p></li><li><p> + Providing an installation client that will obtain printer drivers from a central Internet (or intranet) Imprints Server + repository and install them on remote Samba and Windows NT4 print servers. + </p></li></ul></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2930113"></a>Creating Printer Driver Packages</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +The process of creating printer driver packages is beyond the scope of this document (refer to Imprints.txt +also included with the Samba distribution for more information). In short, an Imprints driver package +is a gzipped tarball containing the driver files, related INF files, and a control file needed by the +installation client. +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2930132"></a>The Imprints Server</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +The Imprints server is really a database server that may be queried via standard HTTP mechanisms. Each +printer entry in the database has an associated URL for the actual downloading of the package. Each +package is digitally signed via GnuPG which can be used to verify that +the package downloaded is actually +the one referred in the Imprints database. It is strongly recommended that this security check +not be disabled. +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2930153"></a>The Installation Client</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +More information regarding the Imprints installation client is available from the the documentation file +<tt class="filename">Imprints-Client-HOWTO.ps</tt> that is included with the Imprints source package. The Imprints +installation client comes in two forms: +</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>A set of command line Perl scripts.</p></li><li><p>A GTK+ based graphical interface to the command line Perl scripts.</p></li></ul></div><p> +The installation client (in both forms) provides a means of querying the Imprints database server for +a matching list of known printer model names as well as a means to download and install the drivers on +remote Samba and Windows NT print servers. +</p><p> +The basic installation process is in four steps and Perl code is wrapped around smbclient and rpcclient. +</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p> + For each supported architecture for a given driver: + </p><div class="orderedlist"><ol type="1"><li><p>rpcclient: Get the appropriate upload directory on the remote server.</p></li><li><p>smbclient: Upload the driver files.</p></li><li><p>rpcclient: Issues an AddPrinterDriver() MS-RPC.</p></li></ol></div><p> + </p></li><li><p>rpcclient: Issue an AddPrinterEx() MS-RPC to actually create the printer.</p></li></ul></div><p> +One of the problems encountered when implementing the Imprints tool set was the name space issues between +various supported client architectures. For example, Windows NT includes a driver named “<span class="quote">Apple LaserWriter +II NTX v51.8</span>” and Windows 95 calls its version of this driver “<span class="quote">Apple LaserWriter II NTX</span>”. +</p><p> +The problem is how to know what client drivers have been uploaded for a printer. An astute reader will +remember that the Windows NT Printer Properties dialog only includes space for one printer driver name. A +quick look in the Windows NT 4.0 system registry at: +</p><p><tt class="filename"> + HKLM\System\CurrentControlSet\Control\Print\Environment +</tt></p><p> +will reveal that Windows NT always uses the NT driver name. This is okay as Windows NT always requires +that at least the Windows NT version of the printer driver is present. Samba does not have the +requirement internally, therefore, “<span class="quote">How can you use the NT driver name if it has not already been installed?</span>” +</p><p> +The way of sidestepping this limitation is to require that all Imprints printer driver packages include both the Intel Windows NT and +95/98 printer drivers and that the NT driver is installed first. +</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2930314"></a>Adding Network Printers without User Interaction</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +The following MS Knowledge Base article may be of some help if you need to handle Windows 2000 +clients: <span class="emphasis"><em>How to Add Printers with No User Interaction in Windows 2000,</em></span> (<ulink url="http://support.microsoft.com/default.aspx?scid=kb;en-us;189105">http://support.microsoft.com/default.aspx?scid=kb;en-us;189105</ulink>). +It also applies to Windows XP Professional clients. +The ideas sketched out in this section are inspired by this article, which describes a commandline method that can be +applied to install network and local printers and their drivers. This is most useful if integrated in Logon +Scripts. You can see what options are available by typing in the command prompt (<b class="command">DOS box</b>): +</p><p><b class="userinput"><tt>rundll32 printui.dll,PrintUIEntry /?</tt></b></p><p> +A window pops up that shows you all of the commandline switches available. An extensive list of examples +is also provided. This is only for Win 200x/XP, it does not work on +Windows NT. Windows NT probably has +some other tools in the respective Resource Kit. Here is a suggestion about what a client logon script +might contain, with a short explanation of what the lines actually do (it works if 200x/XP Windows +clients access printers via Samba, and works for Windows-based print servers too): +</p><pre class="screen"> +<b class="userinput"><tt>rundll32 printui.dll,PrintUIEntry /dn /n "\\cupsserver\infotec2105-IPDS" /q</tt></b> +<b class="userinput"><tt>rundll32 printui.dll,PrintUIEntry /in /n "\\cupsserver\infotec2105-PS"</tt></b> +<b class="userinput"><tt>rundll32 printui.dll,PrintUIEntry /y /n "\\cupsserver\infotec2105-PS"</tt></b> +</pre><p> +Here is a list of the used commandline parameters: +</p><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">/dn</span></dt><dd><p>deletes a network printer</p></dd><dt><span class="term">/q</span></dt><dd><p>quiet modus</p></dd><dt><span class="term">/n</span></dt><dd><p>names a printer</p></dd><dt><span class="term">/in</span></dt><dd><p>adds a network printer connection</p></dd><dt><span class="term">/y</span></dt><dd><p>sets printer as default printer</p></dd></dl></div><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p> + Line 1 deletes a possibly existing previous network printer <span class="emphasis"><em>infotec2105-IPDS</em></span> + (which had used native Windows drivers with LPRng that were removed from the server that was + converted to CUPS). The <b class="command">/q</b> at the end eliminates Confirm + or error dialog boxes from popping up. They should not be presented to the user logging on. + </p></li><li><p> + Line 2 adds the new printer + <span class="emphasis"><em>infotec2105-PS</em></span> (which actually is the same + physical device but is now run by the new CUPS printing system and associated with the + CUPS/Adobe PS drivers). The printer and its driver must have been added to Samba prior to + the user logging in (e.g., by a procedure as discussed earlier in this chapter, or by running + <b class="command">cupsaddsmb</b>). The driver is now auto-downloaded to the client PC where the + user is about to log in. + </p></li><li><p> + Line 3 sets the default printer to this new network printer (there might be several other + printers installed with this same method and some may be local as well, so we decide for a + default printer). The default printer selection may, of course, be different for different users. + </p></li></ul></div><p> +The second line only works if the printer <span class="emphasis"><em>infotec2105-PS</em></span> has an already working +print queue on the <tt class="constant">cupsserver</tt>, and if the +printer drivers have been successfully uploaded +(via the <b class="command">APW</b>, <b class="command">smbclient/rpcclient</b>, or <b class="command">cupsaddsmb</b>) +into the <i class="parameter"><tt>[print$]</tt></i> driver repository of Samba. Some Samba versions +prior to version 3.0 required a re-start of smbd after the printer install and the driver upload, +otherwise the script (or any other client driver download) would fail. +</p><p> +Since there no easy way to test for the existence of an installed network printer from the logon script, +do not bother checking, just allow the deinstallation/reinstallation to occur every time a user logs in; +it's really quick anyway (1 to 2 seconds). +</p><p> +The additional benefits for this are: +</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p> + It puts in place any printer default setup changes automatically at every user logon. + </p></li><li><p> + It allows for “<span class="quote">roaming</span>” users' login into the domain from different workstations. + </p></li></ul></div><p> +Since network printers are installed per user, this much simplifies the process of keeping the installation +up-to-date. The few extra seconds at logon time will not really be noticeable. Printers can be centrally +added, changed and deleted at will on the server with no user intervention required from the clients +(you just need to keep the logon scripts up-to-date). +</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2930639"></a>The <b class="command">addprinter</b> Command</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +The <b class="command">addprinter</b> command can be configured to be a shell script or program executed by +Samba. It is triggered by running the APW from a client against the Samba print server. The APW asks +the user to fill in several fields (such as printer name, driver to be used, comment, port monitor, +and so on). These parameters are passed on to Samba by the APW. If the addprinter command is designed in a +way that it can create a new printer (through writing correct printcap entries on legacy systems, or +execute the <b class="command">lpadmin</b> command on more modern systems) and create the associated share +in, then the APW will in effect really create a new printer on Samba and the UNIX print subsystem! +</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2930686"></a>Migration of Classical Printing to Samba</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +The basic NT-style printer driver management has not changed considerably in 3.0 over the 2.2.x releases +(apart from many small improvements). Here migration should be quite easy, especially if you followed +previous advice to stop using deprecated parameters in your setup. For migrations from an existing 2.0.x +setup, or if you continued Windows 9x/Me-style printing in your Samba 2.2 installations, it is more of +an effort. Please read the appropriate release notes and the HOWTO Collection for Samba-2.2.x. You can +follow several paths. Here are possible scenarios for migration: +</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p> + You need to study and apply the new Windows NT printer and driver support. Previously used + parameters <i class="parameter"><tt>printer driver file</tt></i>, <i class="parameter"><tt>printer driver</tt></i> + and <i class="parameter"><tt>printer driver location</tt></i> are no longer supported. + </p></li><li><p> + If you want to take advantage of Windows NT printer driver support, you also need to migrate the + Windows 9x/Me drivers to the new setup. + </p></li><li><p> + An existing <tt class="filename">printers.def</tt> file (the one specified in the now removed parameter + <i class="parameter"><tt>printer driver file</tt></i>) will no longer work with Samba-3. In 3.0, smbd attempts + to locate a Windows 9x/Me driver files for the printer in <i class="parameter"><tt>[print$]</tt></i> + and additional settings in the TDB and only there; if it fails, it will <span class="emphasis"><em>not</em></span> + (as 2.2.x used to do) drop down to using a <tt class="filename">printers.def</tt> (and all associated + parameters). The make_printerdef tool is removed and there is no backward compatibility for this. + </p></li><li><p>You need to install a Windows 9x/Me driver into the + <i class="parameter"><tt>[print$]</tt></i> share for a printer on your Samba + host. The driver files will be stored in the “<span class="quote">WIN40/0</span>” subdirectory of + <i class="parameter"><tt>[print$]</tt></i>, and some other settings and information go + into the printing-related TDBs.</p></li><li><p>If you want to migrate an existing + <tt class="filename">printers.def</tt> file into the new setup, the + only current + solution is to use the Windows NT APW to install the NT drivers + and the 9x/Me drivers. This can be scripted using smbclient and + rpcclient. See the Imprints installation client at: + </p><p> + <ulink url="http://imprints.sourceforge.net/">http://imprints.sourceforge.net/</ulink> + </p><p> + for an example. See also the discussion of rpcclient usage in the + “<span class="quote">CUPS Printing</span>” section.</p></li></ul></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2930861"></a>Publishing Printer Information in Active Directory or LDAP</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +This will be addressed in a later update of this document. If you wish to volunteer your services to help +document this, please contact <ulink url="mail://jht@samba.org">John H Terpstra.</ulink> +</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2930884"></a>Common Errors</h2></div></div><div></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2930892"></a>I Give My Root Password but I Do Not Get Access</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +Do not confuse the root password which is valid for the UNIX system (and in most cases stored in the +form of a one-way hash in a file named <tt class="filename">/etc/shadow</tt>), with the password used to +authenticate against Samba. Samba does not know the UNIX password. Root access to Samba resources +requires that a Samba account for root must first be created. This is done with the <b class="command">smbpasswd</b> +command as follows: +</p><pre class="screen"> +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt> smbpasswd -a root +New SMB password: secret +Retype new SMB password: secret +</pre></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2930943"></a>My Print Jobs Get Spooled into the Spooling Directory, but Then Get Lost</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +Do not use the existing UNIX print system spool directory for the Samba spool directory. It may seem +convenient and a savings of space, but it only leads to problems. The two must be separate. +</p></div></div></div><div class="navfooter"><hr><table width="100%" summary="Navigation footer"><tr><td width="40%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="msdfs.html">Prev</a> </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="u" href="optional.html">Up</a></td><td width="40%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="CUPS-printing.html">Next</a></td></tr><tr><td width="40%" align="left" valign="top">Chapter 17. Hosting a Microsoft Distributed File System tree on Samba </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="h" href="index.html">Home</a></td><td width="40%" align="right" valign="top"> Chapter 19. CUPS Printing Support</td></tr></table></div></body></html> diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/problems.html b/docs/htmldocs/problems.html new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..41ec5ccbd2 --- /dev/null +++ b/docs/htmldocs/problems.html @@ -0,0 +1,135 @@ +<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>Chapter 34. Analyzing and Solving Samba Problems</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.60.1"><link rel="home" href="index.html" title="SAMBA Project Documentation"><link rel="up" href="troubleshooting.html" title="Part V. Troubleshooting"><link rel="previous" href="diagnosis.html" title="Chapter 33. The Samba Checklist"><link rel="next" href="bugreport.html" title="Chapter 35. Reporting Bugs"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="navheader"><table width="100%" summary="Navigation header"><tr><th colspan="3" align="center">Chapter 34. Analyzing and Solving Samba Problems</th></tr><tr><td width="20%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="diagnosis.html">Prev</a> </td><th width="60%" align="center">Part V. Troubleshooting</th><td width="20%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="bugreport.html">Next</a></td></tr></table><hr></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="problems"></a>Chapter 34. Analyzing and Solving Samba Problems</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Gerald</span> <span class="othername">(Jerry)</span> <span class="surname">Carter</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jerry@samba.org">jerry@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Jelmer</span> <span class="othername">R.</span> <span class="surname">Vernooij</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">The Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jelmer@samba.org">jelmer@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">David</span> <span class="surname">Bannon</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:dbannon@samba.org">dbannon@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Dan</span> <span class="surname">Shearer</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:dan@samba.org">dan@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><p class="pubdate">8 Apr 2003</p></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="problems.html#id2971255">Diagnostics Tools</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="problems.html#id2971276">Debugging with Samba Itself</a></dt><dt><a href="problems.html#id2971441">Tcpdump</a></dt><dt><a href="problems.html#id2971477">Ethereal</a></dt><dt><a href="problems.html#id2971621">The Windows Network Monitor</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="problems.html#id2971938">Useful URLs</a></dt><dt><a href="problems.html#id2971978">Getting Mailing List Help</a></dt><dt><a href="problems.html#id2972155">How to Get Off the Mailing Lists</a></dt></dl></div><p> +There are many sources of information available in the form +of mailing lists, RFCs and documentation. The documentation that comes +with the Samba distribution contains good explanations of +general SMB topics such as browsing.</p><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2971255"></a>Diagnostics Tools</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p>With SMB networking, it is often not immediately clear what +the cause is of a certain problem. Samba itself provides rather +useful information, but in some cases you might have to fall back +to using a <span class="emphasis"><em>sniffer</em></span>. A sniffer is a program that +listens on your LAN, analyzes the data sent on it and displays it +on the screen.</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2971276"></a>Debugging with Samba Itself</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +One of the best diagnostic tools for debugging problems is Samba itself. +You can use the <tt class="option">-d option</tt> for both <span class="application">smbd</span> and <span class="application">nmbd</span> to specify the +<a class="indexterm" name="id2971308"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>debug level</tt></i> at which to run. +See the man pages for <b class="command">smbd, nmbd</b> and +<tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> for more information regarding debugging options. The debug +level can range from 1 (the default) to 10 (100 for debugging passwords). +</p><p> +Another helpful method of debugging is to compile Samba using the +<b class="command">gcc -g </b> flag. This will include debug information in the binaries and +allow you to attach gdb to the running <b class="command">smbd/nmbd</b> process. +To attach <b class="command">gdb</b> to an <b class="command">smbd</b> +process for an NT workstation, first get the workstation to make the +connection. Pressing ctrl-alt-delete and going down to the domain box +is sufficient (at least, the first time you join the domain) to +generate a <i class="parameter"><tt>LsaEnumTrustedDomains</tt></i>. Thereafter, the workstation +maintains an open connection and there will be an smbd +process running (assuming that you haven't set a really short smbd +idle timeout). So, in between pressing <b class="command">ctrl-alt-delete</b> and actually +typing in your password, you can attach <b class="command">gdb</b> and continue. +</p><p> +Some useful Samba commands worth investigating are: +</p><pre class="screen"> +<tt class="prompt">$ </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>testparm | more</tt></b> +<tt class="prompt">$ </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>smbclient -L //{netbios name of server}</tt></b> +</pre></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2971441"></a>Tcpdump</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +<ulink url="http://www.tcpdump.org/">Tcpdump</ulink> was the first +UNIX sniffer with SMB support. It is a command-line utility and +now, its SMB support is somewhat lagging that of <b class="command">ethereal</b> +and <b class="command">tethereal</b>. +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2971477"></a>Ethereal</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +<ulink url="http://www.ethereal.com/">Ethereal</ulink> is a graphical +sniffer, available for both UNIX (Gtk) and Windows. Ethereal's +SMB support is quite good.</p><p>For details on the use of <b class="command">ethereal</b>, read the well-written +Ethereal User Guide.</p><div class="figure"><a name="ethereal1"></a><p class="title"><b>Figure 34.1. Starting a capture.</b></p><div class="mediaobject"><img src="projdoc/imagefiles/ethereal1.png" width="270" alt="Starting a capture."></div></div><p> +Listen for data on ports 137, 138, 139, and 445. For example, use the filter <b class="userinput"><tt>port 137, port 138, port 139, or port 445</tt></b> as seen in <link linkend="ethereal1">.</p><p>A console version of ethereal is available as well and is called +<b class="command">tethereal</b>.</p><div class="figure"><a name="ethereal2"></a><p class="title"><b>Figure 34.2. Main ethereal data window.</b></p><div class="mediaobject"><img src="projdoc/imagefiles/ethereal2.png" width="270" alt="Main ethereal data window."></div></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2971621"></a>The Windows Network Monitor</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +For tracing things on Microsoft Windows NT, Network Monitor +(aka Netmon) is available on Microsoft Developer Network CDs, +the Windows NT Server install CD and the SMS CDs. The version of +Netmon that ships with SMS allows for dumping packets between any two +computers (i.e., placing the network interface in promiscuous mode). +The version on the NT Server install CD will only allow monitoring +of network traffic directed to the local NT box and broadcasts on the +local subnet. Be aware that Ethereal can read and write Netmon +formatted files. +</p><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2971641"></a>Installing Network Monitor on an NT Workstation</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> +Installing Netmon on an NT workstation requires a couple +of steps. The following are instructions for installing Netmon V4.00.349, which comes +with Microsoft Windows NT Server 4.0, on Microsoft Windows NT +Workstation 4.0. The process should be similar for other versions of +Windows NT version of Netmon. You will need both the Microsoft Windows +NT Server 4.0 Install CD and the Workstation 4.0 Install CD. +</p><p> +Initially you will need to install <span class="application">Network Monitor Tools and Agent</span> +on the NT Server to do this: +</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Go to <span class="guibutton">Start</span> -> <span class="guibutton">Settings</span> -> <span class="guibutton">Control Panel</span> -> + <span class="guibutton">Network</span> -> <span class="guibutton">Services</span> -> <span class="guibutton">Add</span>.</p></li><li><p>Select the <span class="guilabel">Network Monitor Tools and Agent</span> and click on <span class="guibutton">OK</span>.</p></li><li><p>Click on <span class="guibutton">OK</span> on the Network Control Panel.</p></li><li><p>Insert the Windows NT Server 4.0 install CD when prompted.</p></li></ul></div><p> +At this point, the Netmon files should exist in <tt class="filename">%SYSTEMROOT%\System32\netmon\*.*</tt>. +Two subdirectories exist as well, <tt class="filename">parsers\</tt> which contains the necessary DLLs +for parsing the Netmon packet dump, and <tt class="filename">captures\</tt>. +</p><p> +To install the Netmon tools on an NT Workstation, you will first need to install the +Network Monitor Agent from the Workstation install CD. +</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Go to <span class="guibutton">Start</span> -> <span class="guibutton">Settings</span> -> <span class="guibutton">Control Panel</span> -> + <span class="guibutton">Network</span> -> <span class="guibutton">Services</span> -> <span class="guibutton">Add</span>.</p></li><li><p>Select the <span class="guilabel">Network Monitor Agent</span>, click on <span class="guibutton">OK</span>.</p></li><li><p>Click on <span class="guibutton">OK</span> in the Network Control Panel. + </p></li><li><p>Insert the Windows NT Workstation 4.0 install CD when prompted.</p></li></ul></div><p> +Now copy the files from the NT Server in <tt class="filename">%SYSTEMROOT%\System32\netmon</tt> +to <tt class="filename">%SYSTEMROOT%\System32\netmon</tt> on the Workstation and set permissions +as you deem appropriate for your site. You will need administrative rights on the NT box to run Netmon. +</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2971911"></a>Installing Network Monitor on Windows 9x/Me</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> +To install Netmon on Windows 9x/Me, install the Network Monitor Agent +from the Windows 9x/Me CD (<tt class="filename">\admin\nettools\netmon</tt>). +There is a readme file located with the Netmon driver files on the CD if you need +information on how to do this. Copy the files from a working Netmon installation. +</p></div></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2971938"></a>Useful URLs</h2></div></div><div></div></div><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>See how Scott Merrill simulates a BDC behavior at + <ulink url="http://www.skippy.net/linux/smb-howto.html"> + http://www.skippy.net/linux/smb-howto.html</ulink>. </p></li><li><p>FTP site for older SMB specs: + <ulink url="ftp://ftp.microsoft.com/developr/drg/CIFS/"> + ftp://ftp.microsoft.com/developr/drg/CIFS/</ulink></p></li></ul></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2971978"></a>Getting Mailing List Help</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +There are a number of Samba-related mailing lists. Go to <ulink url="http://samba.org">http://samba.org</ulink>, click on your nearest mirror +and then click on <b class="command">Support</b> and next click on <b class="command"> +Samba-related mailing lists</b>. +</p><p> +For questions relating to Samba TNG, go to +<ulink url="http://www.samba-tng.org/">http://www.samba-tng.org/.</ulink> +It has been requested that you do not post questions about Samba-TNG to the +main-stream Samba lists.</p><p> +If you do post a message to one of the lists, please observe the following guidelines : +</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Always remember that the developers are volunteers, they are + not paid and they never guarantee to produce a particular feature at + a particular time. Any timelines are “<span class="quote">best guess</span>” and nothing more. + </p></li><li><p>Always mention what version of Samba you are using and what + operating system it's running under. You should list the relevant sections of + your <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file, at least the options in <i class="parameter"><tt>[global]</tt></i> + that affect PDC support. + </p></li><li><p>In addition to the version, if you obtained Samba via + CVS, mention the date when you last checked it out.</p></li><li><p> Try and make your questions clear and brief. Lots of long, + convoluted questions get deleted before they are completely read! + Do not post HTML encoded messages. Most people on mailing lists simply delete + them. + </p></li><li><p> If you run one of those nifty “<span class="quote">I'm on holidays</span>” things when + you are away, make sure its configured to not answer mailing list traffic. Auto-responses + to mailing lists really irritate the thousands of people who end up having to deal + with such bad netiquet bahavior. + </p></li><li><p>Don't cross post. Work out which is the best list to post to + and see what happens. Do not post to both samba-ntdom and samba-technical. + Many people active on the lists subscribe to more + than one list and get annoyed to see the same message two or more times. + Often someone will see a message and thinking it would be better dealt + with on another list, will forward it on for you.</p></li><li><p>You might include <span class="emphasis"><em>partial</em></span> + log files written at a debug level set to as much as 20. + Please do not send the entire log but just enough to give the context of the + error messages.</p></li><li><p>If you have a complete Netmon trace (from the opening of + the pipe to the error), you can send the *.CAP file as well.</p></li><li><p>Please think carefully before attaching a document to an email. + Consider pasting the relevant parts into the body of the message. The Samba + mailing lists go to a huge number of people. Do they all need a copy of your + <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> in their attach directory?</p></li></ul></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2972155"></a>How to Get Off the Mailing Lists</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p>To have your name removed from a Samba mailing list, go to the same +place where you went to +subscribe to it. Go to <ulink url="http://lists.samba.org/">http://lists.samba.org</ulink>, +click on your nearest mirror, click on <b class="command">Support</b> and +then click on<b class="command"> Samba related mailing lists</b>. +</p><p> +Please do not post messages to the list asking to be removed. You will only +be referred to the above address (unless that process failed in some way). +</p></div></div><div class="navfooter"><hr><table width="100%" summary="Navigation footer"><tr><td width="40%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="diagnosis.html">Prev</a> </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="u" href="troubleshooting.html">Up</a></td><td width="40%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="bugreport.html">Next</a></td></tr><tr><td width="40%" align="left" valign="top">Chapter 33. The Samba Checklist </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="h" href="index.html">Home</a></td><td width="40%" align="right" valign="top"> Chapter 35. Reporting Bugs</td></tr></table></div></body></html> diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/samba-bdc.html b/docs/htmldocs/samba-bdc.html new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..13a35e5198 --- /dev/null +++ b/docs/htmldocs/samba-bdc.html @@ -0,0 +1,356 @@ +<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>Chapter 6. Backup Domain Control</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.60.1"><link rel="home" href="index.html" title="SAMBA Project Documentation"><link rel="up" href="type.html" title="Part II. Server Configuration Basics"><link rel="previous" href="samba-pdc.html" title="Chapter 5. Domain Control"><link rel="next" href="domain-member.html" title="Chapter 7. Domain Membership"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="navheader"><table width="100%" summary="Navigation header"><tr><th colspan="3" align="center">Chapter 6. Backup Domain Control</th></tr><tr><td width="20%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="samba-pdc.html">Prev</a> </td><th width="60%" align="center">Part II. Server Configuration Basics</th><td width="20%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="domain-member.html">Next</a></td></tr></table><hr></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="samba-bdc"></a>Chapter 6. Backup Domain Control</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">John</span> <span class="othername">H.</span> <span class="surname">Terpstra</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org">jht@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Volker</span> <span class="surname">Lendecke</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:Volker.Lendecke@SerNet.DE">Volker.Lendecke@SerNet.DE</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Guenther</span> <span class="surname">Deschner</span></h3><span class="contrib">LDAP updates</span><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">SuSE<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:gd@suse.de">gd@suse.de</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="samba-bdc.html#id2891162">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="samba-bdc.html#id2891552">Essential Background Information</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="samba-bdc.html#id2891580">MS Windows NT4-style Domain Control</a></dt><dt><a href="samba-bdc.html#id2891874">LDAP Configuration Notes</a></dt><dt><a href="samba-bdc.html#id2892094">Active Directory Domain Control</a></dt><dt><a href="samba-bdc.html#id2892115">What Qualifies a Domain Controller on the Network?</a></dt><dt><a href="samba-bdc.html#id2892157">How does a Workstation find its Domain Controller?</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="samba-bdc.html#id2892268">Backup Domain Controller Configuration</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="samba-bdc.html#id2892538">Example Configuration</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="samba-bdc.html#id2892768">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="samba-bdc.html#id2892791">Machine Accounts Keep Expiring</a></dt><dt><a href="samba-bdc.html#id2892845">Can Samba Be a Backup Domain Controller to an NT4 PDC?</a></dt><dt><a href="samba-bdc.html#id2892880">How Do I Replicate the smbpasswd File?</a></dt><dt><a href="samba-bdc.html#id2892948">Can I Do This All with LDAP?</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></div><p> +Before you continue reading this section, please make sure that you are comfortable +with configuring a Samba Domain Controller as described in <link linkend="samba-pdc">. +</p><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2891162"></a>Features and Benefits</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +This is one of the most difficult chapters to summarize. It does not matter what we say here +for someone will still draw conclusions and/or approach the Samba Team with expectations +that are either not yet capable of being delivered, or that can be achieved far more +effectively using a totally different approach. In the event that you should have a persistent +concern that is not addressed in this book, please email <ulink url="mailto:jht@samba.org">John H. Terpstra</ulink> +clearly setting out your requirements and/or question and we will do our best to provide a solution. +</p><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2891195"></a> +Samba-3 is capable of acting as a Backup Domain Controller (BDC) to another Samba Primary Domain +Controller (PDC). A Samba-3 PDC can operate with an LDAP Account backend. The LDAP backend can be +either a common master LDAP server, or a slave server. The use of a slave LDAP server has the +benefit that when the master is down, clients may still be able to log onto the network. +This effectively gives Samba a high degree of scalability and is an effective solution +for large organizations. Do not use an LDAP slave server for a PDC, this may cause serious +stability and operational problems. +</p><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2891221"></a> +While it is possible to run a Samba-3 BDC with non-LDAP backend, the administrator will +need to figure out precisely what is the best way to replicate (copy/distribute) the +user and machine accounts' backend. +</p><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2891240"></a> +The use of a non-LDAP backend SAM database is particularly problematic because Domain Member +servers and workstations periodically change the Machine Trust Account password. The new +password is then stored only locally. This means that in the absence of a centrally stored +accounts database (such as that provided with an LDAP-based solution) if Samba-3 is running +as a BDC, the BDC instance of the Domain Member trust account password will not reach the +PDC (master) copy of the SAM. If the PDC SAM is then replicated to BDCs, this results in +overwriting the SAM that contains the updated (changed) trust account password with resulting +breakage of the domain trust. +</p><p> +Considering the number of comments and questions raised concerning how to configure a BDC, +let's consider each possible option and look at the pros and cons for each possible solution. +<link linkend="pdc-bdc-table"> lists possible design configurations for a PDC/BDC infrastructure. +<a class="indexterm" name="id2891281"></a> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2891291"></a> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2891302"></a> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2891313"></a> +</p><div class="table"><a name="pdc-bdc-table"></a><p class="title"><b>Table 6.1. Domain Backend Account Distribution Options</b></p><table summary="Domain Backend Account Distribution Options" border="1"><colgroup><col align="center"><col align="center"><col align="left"></colgroup><thead><tr><th align="center">PDC Backend</th><th align="center">BDC Backend</th><th align="left">Notes/Discussion</th></tr></thead><tbody><tr><td align="center"><p>Master LDAP Server</p></td><td align="center"><p>Slave LDAP Server</p></td><td align="left"><p>The optimal solution that provides high integrity. The SAM will be + replicated to a common master LDAP server.</p></td></tr><tr><td align="center"><p>Single Central LDAP Server</p></td><td align="center"><p>Single Central LDAP Server</p></td><td align="left"><p> + A workable solution without fail-over ability. This is a useable solution, but not optimal. + </p></td></tr><tr><td align="center"><p>tdbsam</p></td><td align="center"><p>tdbsam + <b class="command">net rpc vampire</b></p></td><td align="left"><p> + Does not work with Samba-3.0.0; may be implemented in a later release. The downside of this solution + is that an external process will control account database integrity. This solution may appeal to sites + that wish to avoid the complexity of LDAP. The <b class="command">net rpc vampire</b> is used to + synchronize domain accounts from the PDC to the BDC. + </p></td></tr><tr><td align="center"><p>tdbsam</p></td><td align="center"><p>tdbsam + <b class="command">rsync</b></p></td><td align="left"><p> + Do not use this configuration. + Does not work because the TDB files are live and data may not have been flushed to disk. + Use <b class="command">rsync</b> to synchronize the TDB database files from the PDC to the BDC. + </p></td></tr><tr><td align="center"><p>smbpasswd file</p></td><td align="center"><p>smbpasswd file</p></td><td align="left"><p> + Do not use this configuration. + Not an elegant solution due to the delays in synchronization. + Use <b class="command">rsync</b> to synchronize the TDB database files from the PDC to the BDC. + Can be made to work using a <b class="command">cron</b> job to synchronize data from the PDC to the BDC. + </p></td></tr></tbody></table></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2891552"></a>Essential Background Information</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +A Domain Controller is a machine that is able to answer logon requests from network +workstations. Microsoft LanManager and IBM LanServer were two early products that +provided this capability. The technology has become known as the LanMan Netlogon service. +</p><p> +When MS Windows NT3.10 was first released, it supported a new style of Domain Control +and with it a new form of the network logon service that has extended functionality. +This service became known as the NT NetLogon Service. The nature of this service has +changed with the evolution of MS Windows NT and today provides a complex array of +services that are implemented over an intricate spectrum of technologies. +</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2891580"></a>MS Windows NT4-style Domain Control</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +Whenever a user logs into a Windows NT4/200x/XP Professional Workstation, +the workstation connects to a Domain Controller (authentication server) to validate that +the username and password the user entered are valid. If the information entered +does not match account information that has been stored in the Domain +Control database (the SAM, or Security Account Manager database), a set of error +codes is returned to the workstation that has made the authentication request. +</p><p> +When the username/password pair has been validated, the Domain Controller +(authentication server) will respond with full enumeration of the account information +that has been stored regarding that user in the User and Machine Accounts database +for that Domain. This information contains a complete network access profile for +the user but excludes any information that is particular to the user's desktop profile, +or for that matter it excludes all desktop profiles for groups that the user may +belong to. It does include password time limits, password uniqueness controls, +network access time limits, account validity information, machine names from which the +user may access the network, and much more. All this information was stored in the SAM +in all versions of MS Windows NT (3.10, 3.50, 3.51, 4.0). +</p><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2891624"></a> +The account information (user and machine) on Domain Controllers is stored in two files, +one containing the Security information and the other the SAM. These are stored in files +by the same name in the <tt class="filename">C:\Windows NT\System32\config</tt> directory. These +are the files that are involved in replication of the SAM database where Backup Domain +Controllers are present on the network. +</p><p> +There are two situations in which it is desirable to install Backup Domain Controllers: +</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p> + On the local network that the Primary Domain Controller is on, if there are many + workstations and/or where the PDC is generally very busy. In this case the BDCs + will pick up network logon requests and help to add robustness to network services. + </p></li><li><p> + At each remote site, to reduce wide area network traffic and to add stability to + remote network operations. The design of the network, the strategic placement of + Backup Domain Controllers, together with an implementation that localizes as much + of network to client interchange as possible will help to minimize wide area network + bandwidth needs (and thus costs). + </p></li></ul></div><p> +The inter-operation of a PDC and its BDCs in a true Windows NT4 environemt is worth +mentioning here. The PDC contains the master copy of the SAM. In the event that an +administrator makes a change to the user account database while physically present +on the local network that has the PDC, the change will likely be made directly to +the PDC instance of the master copy of the SAM. In the event that this update may +be performed in a branch office, the change will likely be stored in a delta file +on the local BDC. The BDC will then send a trigger to the PDC to commence the process +of SAM synchronization. The PDC will then request the delta from the BDC and apply +it to the master SAM. The PDC will then contact all the BDCs in the Domain and +trigger them to obtain the update and then apply that to their own copy of the SAM. +</p><p> +Samba-3 can not participate in true SAM replication and is therefore not able to +employ precisely the same protocols used by MS Windows NT4. A Samba-3 BDC will +not create SAM update delta files. It will not inter-operate with a PDC (NT4 or Samba) +to synchronize the SAM from delta files that are held by BDCs. +</p><p> +Samba-3 cannot function as a BDC to an MS Windows NT4 PDC, and Samba-3 can not +function correctly as a PDC to an MS Windows NT4 BDC. Both Samba-3 and MS Windows +NT4 can function as a BDC to its own type of PDC. +</p><p> +The BDC is said to hold a <span class="emphasis"><em>read-only</em></span> of the SAM from which +it is able to process network logon requests and authenticate users. The BDC can +continue to provide this service, particularly while, for example, the wide area +network link to the PDC is down. A BDC plays a very important role in both the +maintenance of Domain Security as well as in network integrity. +</p><p> +In the event that the NT4 PDC should need to be taken out of service, or if it dies, +one of the NT4 BDCs can be promoted to a PDC. If this happens while the original NT4 PDC is on +line, it is automatically demoted to an NT4 BDC. This is an important aspect of Domain +Controller management. The tool that is used to effect a promotion or a demotion is the +Server Manager for Domains. It should be noted that Samba-3 BDCs can not be promoted +in this manner because reconfiguration of Samba requires changes to the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file. +</p><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2891756"></a>Example PDC Configuration</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> +Beginning with Version 2.2, Samba officially supports domain logons for all current Windows clients, +including Windows NT4, 2003 and XP Professional. For Samba to be enabled as a PDC, some +parameters in the <i class="parameter"><tt>[global]</tt></i>-section of the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> have to be set. +Refer to <link linkend="minimalPDC"> for an example of the minimum required settings. +</p><div class="example"><a name="minimalPDC"></a><p class="title"><b>Example 6.1. Minimal smb.conf for a PDC in Use With a BDC LDAP Server on PDC.</b></p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>workgroup = MIDEARTH</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>passdb backend = ldapsam://localhost:389</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>domain master = yes</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>domain logons = yes</tt></i></td></tr></table></div><p> +Several other things like a <i class="parameter"><tt>[homes]</tt></i> and a +<i class="parameter"><tt>[netlogon]</tt></i> share also need to be set along with +settings for the profile path, the user's home drive, and so on. This is not covered in this +chapter; for more information please refer to <link linkend="samba-pdc">. +</p></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2891874"></a>LDAP Configuration Notes</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +When configuring a master and a slave LDAP server, it is advisable to use the master LDAP server +for the PDC and slave LDAP servers for the BDCs. It is not essential to use slave LDAP servers, however, +many administrators will want to do so in order to provide redundant services. Of course, one or more BDCs +may use any slave LDAP server. Then again, it is entirely possible to use a single LDAP server for the +entire network. +</p><p> +When configuring a master LDAP server that will have slave LDAP servers, do not forget to configure +this in the <tt class="filename">/etc/openldap/slapd.conf</tt> file. It must be noted that the DN of a +server certificate must use the CN attribute to name the server, and the CN must carry the servers' +fully qualified domain name. Additional alias names and wildcards may be present in the +subjectAltName certificate extension. More details on server certificate names are in RFC2830. +</p><p> +It does not really fit within the scope of this document, but a working LDAP installation is +basic to LDAP enabled Samba operation. When using an OpenLdap server with Transport Layer Security +(TLS), the machine name in <tt class="filename">/etc/ssl/certs/slapd.pem</tt> must be the +same as in <tt class="filename">/etc/openldap/sldap.conf</tt>. The Red Hat Linux startup script +creates the <tt class="filename">slapd.pem</tt> file with hostname “<span class="quote">localhost.localdomain.</span>” +It is impossible to access this LDAP server from a slave LDAP server (i.e., a Samba BDC) unless the +certificate is recreated with a correct hostname. +</p><p> +Do not install a Samba PDC on a OpenLDAP slave server. Joining client machines to the domain +will fail in this configuration because the change to the machine account in the LDAP tree +must take place on the master LDAP server. This is not replicated rapidly enough to the slave +server that the PDC queries. It therfore gives an error message on the client machine about +not being able to set up account credentials. The machine account is created on the LDAP server +but the password fields will be empty. +</p><p> +Possible PDC/BDC plus LDAP configurations include: +</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p> + PDC+BDC -> One Central LDAP Server. + </p></li><li><p> + PDC -> LDAP master server, BDC -> LDAP slave server. + </p></li><li><p> + PDC -> LDAP master, with secondary slave LDAP server. + </p><p> + BDC -> LDAP master, with secondary slave LDAP server. + </p></li><li><p> + PDC -> LDAP master, with secondary slave LDAP server. + </p><p> + BDC -> LDAP slave server, with secondary master LDAP server. + </p></li></ul></div><p> +In order to have a fall-back configuration (secondary) LDAP server one would specify +the secondary LDAP server in the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file as shown in <link linkend="mulitldapcfg">. +</p><p> +</p><div class="example"><a name="mulitldapcfg"></a><p class="title"><b>Example 6.2. Multiple LDAP Servers in smb.conf</b></p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td>...</td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>passdb backend = ldapsam:ldap://master.quenya.org</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>ldapsam:ldap://slave.quenya.org</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td>...</td></tr></table></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2892094"></a>Active Directory Domain Control</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +As of the release of MS Windows 2000 and Active Directory, this information is now stored +in a directory that can be replicated and for which partial or full administrative control +can be delegated. Samba-3 is not able to be a Domain Controller within an Active Directory +tree, and it cannot be an Active Directory server. This means that Samba-3 also cannot +act as a Backup Domain Controller to an Active Directory Domain Controller. +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2892115"></a>What Qualifies a Domain Controller on the Network?</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +Every machine that is a Domain Controller for the domain MIDEARTH has to register the NetBIOS +group name MIDEARTH<#1c> with the WINS server and/or by broadcast on the local network. +The PDC also registers the unique NetBIOS name MIDEARTH<#1b> with the WINS server. +The name type <#1b> name is normally reserved for the Domain Master Browser, a role +that has nothing to do with anything related to authentication, but the Microsoft Domain +implementation requires the Domain Master Browser to be on the same machine as the PDC. +</p><p> +Where a WINS server is not used, broadcast name registrations alone must suffice. Refer to +<link linkend="netdiscuss"> for more information regarding TCP/IP network protocols and how + SMB/CIFS names are handled. +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2892157"></a>How does a Workstation find its Domain Controller?</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +There are two different mechanisms to locate a domain controller, one method is used when +NetBIOS over TCP/IP is enabled and the other when it has been disabled in the TCP/IP +network configuration. +</p><p> +Where NetBIOS over TCP/IP is disabled, all name resolution involves the use of DNS, broadcast +messaging over UDP, as well as Active Directory communication technologies. In this type of +environment all machines require appropriate DNS entries. More information may be found in +<link linkend="adsdnstech">. +</p><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2892189"></a>NetBIOS Over TCP/IP Enabled</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> +An MS Windows NT4/200x/XP Professional workstation in the domain MIDEARTH that wants a +local user to be authenticated has to find the Domain Controller for MIDEARTH. It does this +by doing a NetBIOS name query for the group name MIDEARTH<#1c>. It assumes that each +of the machines it gets back from the queries is a Domain Controller and can answer logon +requests. To not open security holes, both the workstation and the selected Domain Controller +authenticate each other. After that the workstation sends the user's credentials (name and +password) to the local Domain Controller for validation. +</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2892201"></a>NetBIOS Over TCP/IP Disabled</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> +An MS Windows NT4/200x/XP Professional workstation in the realm <tt class="constant">quenya.org</tt> +that has a need to affect user logon authentication will locate the Domain Controller by +requerying DNS servers for the <tt class="constant">_ldap._tcp.pdc.ms-dcs.quenya.org</tt> record. +More information regarding this subject may be found in <link linkend="adsdnstech">. +</p></div></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2892268"></a>Backup Domain Controller Configuration</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +The creation of a BDC requires some steps to prepare the Samba server before +<span class="application">smbd</span> is executed for the first time. These steps are outlines as follows: +<a class="indexterm" name="id2892289"></a> +</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p> + The domain SID has to be the same on the PDC and the BDC. In Samba versions + pre-2.2.5, the domain SID was stored in the file <tt class="filename">private/MACHINE.SID</tt>. + The domain SID is now stored in the file <tt class="filename">private/secrets.tdb</tt>. This file + is unique to each server and can not be copied from a PDC to a BDC, the BDC will generate + a new SID at start-up. It will over-write the PDC domain SID with the newly created BDC SID. + There is a procedure that will allow the BDC to aquire the Domain SID. This is described here. + </p><p> + To retrieve the domain SID from the PDC or an existing BDC and store it in the + <tt class="filename">secrets.tdb</tt>, execute: + </p><pre class="screen"> +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>net rpc getsid</tt></b> +</pre></li><li><p> + Specification of the <a class="indexterm" name="id2892368"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>ldap admin dn</tt></i> is obligatory. + This also requires the LDAP administration password to be set in the <tt class="filename">secrets.tdb</tt> + using the <b class="command">smbpasswd -w <i class="replaceable"><tt>mysecret</tt></i></b>. + </p></li><li><p> + Either <a class="indexterm" name="id2892405"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>ldap suffix</tt></i> or + <a class="indexterm" name="id2892419"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>ldap idmap suffix</tt></i> must be specified in + the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file. + </p></li><li><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2892446"></a> + The UNIX user database has to be synchronized from the PDC to the + BDC. This means that both the <tt class="filename">/etc/passwd</tt> and + <tt class="filename">/etc/group</tt> have to be replicated from the PDC + to the BDC. This can be done manually whenever changes are made. + Alternately, the PDC is set up as an NIS master server and the BDC as an NIS slave + server. To set up the BDC as a mere NIS client would not be enough, + as the BDC would not be able to access its user database in case of + a PDC failure. NIS is by no means the only method to synchronize + passwords. An LDAP solution would also work. + </p></li><li><p> + The Samba password database must be replicated from the PDC to the BDC. + Although it is possible to synchronize the <tt class="filename">smbpasswd</tt> + file with <b class="command">rsync</b> and <b class="command">ssh</b>, this method + is broken and flawed, and is therefore not recommended. A better solution + is to set up slave LDAP servers for each BDC and a master LDAP server for the PDC. + </p></li><li><p> + The netlogon share has to be replicated from the PDC to the + BDC. This can be done manually whenever login scripts are changed, + or it can be done automatically using a <b class="command">cron</b> job + that will replicate the directory structure in this share using a tool + like <b class="command">rsync</b>. + </p></li></ul></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2892538"></a>Example Configuration</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +Finally, the BDC has to be found by the workstations. This can be done by setting Samba as shown in <link linkend="minim-bdc">. +</p><div class="example"><a name="minim-bdc"></a><p class="title"><b>Example 6.3. Minimal setup for being a BDC</b></p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>workgroup = MIDEARTH</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>passdb backend = ldapsam:ldap://slave-ldap.quenya.org</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>domain master = no</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>domain logons = yes</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>idmap backend = ldapsam:ldap://slave-ldap.quenya.org</tt></i></td></tr></table></div><p> +In the <i class="parameter"><tt>[global]</tt></i>-section of the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> of the BDC. This makes the BDC +only register the name SAMBA<#1c> with the WINS server. This is no +problem as the name SAMBA<#1c> is a NetBIOS group name that is meant to +be registered by more than one machine. The parameter +<a class="indexterm" name="id2892643"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>domain master</tt></i> = no +forces the BDC not to register SAMBA<#1b> which as a unique NetBIOS +name is reserved for the Primary Domain Controller. +</p><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2892668"></a> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2892677"></a> +The <i class="parameter"><tt>idmap backend</tt></i> will redirect the <b class="command">winbindd</b> utility to +use the LDAP database to resolve all UIDs and GIDs for UNIX accounts. +</p><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2892706"></a> +Samba-3 has introduced a new ID mapping facility. One of the features of this facility is that it +allows greater flexibility in how user and group IDs are handled in respect to NT Domain User and Group +SIDs. One of the new facilities provides for explicitly ensuring that UNIX/Linux UID and GID values +will be consistent on the PDC, all BDCs and all Domain Member servers. The parameter that controls this +is called <i class="parameter"><tt>idmap backend</tt></i>. Please refer to the man page for <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> for more information +regarding its behavior. +</p></div><p> +The use of the <a class="indexterm" name="id2892744"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>idmap backend</tt></i> = ldap://master.quenya/org +option on a BDC only make sense where ldapsam is used on a PDC. The purpose for an LDAP based idmap backend is +also to allow a domain-member (without its own passdb backend) to use winbindd to resolve Windows network users +and groups to common UID/GIDs. In other words, this option is generally intended for use on BDCs and on Domain +Member servers. +</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2892768"></a>Common Errors</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +As this is a rather new area for Samba, there are not many examples that we may refer to. +Updates will be published as they become available and may be found in later Samba releases or +from the Samba web <ulink url="http://samba.org">site.</ulink> +</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2892791"></a>Machine Accounts Keep Expiring</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2892802"></a> +This problem will occur when the passdb (SAM) files are copied from a central +server but the local Backup Domain Controller is acting as a PDC. This results in the application of +Local Machine Trust Account password updates to the local SAM. Such updates +are not copied back to the central server. The newer machine account password is then over +written when the SAM is re-copied from the PDC. The result is that the Domain Member machine +on start up will find that its passwords do not match the one now in the database and +since the startup security check will now fail, this machine will not allow logon attempts +to proceed and the account expiry error will be reported. +</p><p> +The solution is to use a more robust passdb backend, such as the ldapsam backend, setting up +a slave LDAP server for each BDC, and a master LDAP server for the PDC. +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2892845"></a>Can Samba Be a Backup Domain Controller to an NT4 PDC?</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2892857"></a> +No. The native NT4 SAM replication protocols have not yet been fully implemented. +</p><p> +Can I get the benefits of a BDC with Samba? Yes, but only to a Samba PDC.The +main reason for implementing a BDC is availability. If the PDC is a Samba +machine, a second Samba machine can be set up to service logon requests whenever +the PDC is down. +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2892880"></a>How Do I Replicate the smbpasswd File?</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2892891"></a> +Replication of the smbpasswd file is sensitive. It has to be done whenever changes +to the SAM are made. Every user's password change is done in the smbpasswd file and +has to be replicated to the BDC. So replicating the smbpasswd file very often is necessary. +</p><p> +As the smbpasswd file contains plain text password equivalents, it must not be +sent unencrypted over the wire. The best way to set up smbpasswd replication from +the PDC to the BDC is to use the utility rsync. rsync can use ssh as a transport. +<b class="command">ssh</b> itself can be set up to accept <span class="emphasis"><em>only</em></span> +<b class="command">rsync</b> transfer without requiring the user to type a password. +</p><p> +As said a few times before, use of this method is broken and flawed. Machine trust +accounts will go out of sync, resulting in a broken domain. This method is +<span class="emphasis"><em>not</em></span> recommended. Try using LDAP instead. +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2892948"></a>Can I Do This All with LDAP?</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +The simple answer is yes. Samba's pdb_ldap code supports binding to a replica +LDAP server, and will also follow referrals and rebind to the master if it ever +needs to make a modification to the database. (Normally BDCs are read only, so +this will not occur often). +</p></div></div></div><div class="navfooter"><hr><table width="100%" summary="Navigation footer"><tr><td width="40%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="samba-pdc.html">Prev</a> </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="u" href="type.html">Up</a></td><td width="40%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="domain-member.html">Next</a></td></tr><tr><td width="40%" align="left" valign="top">Chapter 5. Domain Control </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="h" href="index.html">Home</a></td><td width="40%" align="right" valign="top"> Chapter 7. Domain Membership</td></tr></table></div></body></html> diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/samba-pdc.html b/docs/htmldocs/samba-pdc.html new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..37c513efff --- /dev/null +++ b/docs/htmldocs/samba-pdc.html @@ -0,0 +1,530 @@ +<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>Chapter 5. Domain Control</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.60.1"><link rel="home" href="index.html" title="SAMBA Project Documentation"><link rel="up" href="type.html" title="Part II. Server Configuration Basics"><link rel="previous" href="ServerType.html" title="Chapter 4. Server Types and Security Modes"><link rel="next" href="samba-bdc.html" title="Chapter 6. Backup Domain Control"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="navheader"><table width="100%" summary="Navigation header"><tr><th colspan="3" align="center">Chapter 5. Domain Control</th></tr><tr><td width="20%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="ServerType.html">Prev</a> </td><th width="60%" align="center">Part II. Server Configuration Basics</th><td width="20%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="samba-bdc.html">Next</a></td></tr></table><hr></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="samba-pdc"></a>Chapter 5. Domain Control</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">John</span> <span class="othername">H.</span> <span class="surname">Terpstra</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org">jht@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Gerald</span> <span class="othername">(Jerry)</span> <span class="surname">Carter</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jerry@samba.org">jerry@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">David</span> <span class="surname">Bannon</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:dbannon@samba.org">dbannon@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Guenther</span> <span class="surname">Deschner</span></h3><span class="contrib">LDAP updates</span><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">SuSE<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:gd@suse.de">gd@suse.de</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="samba-pdc.html#id2870050">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="samba-pdc.html#id2870321">Basics of Domain Control</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="samba-pdc.html#id2870336">Domain Controller Types</a></dt><dt><a href="samba-pdc.html#id2889080">Preparing for Domain Control</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="samba-pdc.html#id2889458">Domain Control Example Configuration</a></dt><dt><a href="samba-pdc.html#id2889951">Samba ADS Domain Control</a></dt><dt><a href="samba-pdc.html#id2889989">Domain and Network Logon Configuration</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="samba-pdc.html#id2890004">Domain Network Logon Service</a></dt><dt><a href="samba-pdc.html#id2890439">Security Mode and Master Browsers</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="samba-pdc.html#id2890570">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="samba-pdc.html#id2890577">$ Cannot Be Included in Machine Name</a></dt><dt><a href="samba-pdc.html#id2890661">Joining Domain Fails Because of Existing Machine Account</a></dt><dt><a href="samba-pdc.html#id2890722">The System Cannot Log You On (C000019B)</a></dt><dt><a href="samba-pdc.html#id2890822">The Machine Trust Account Is Not Accessible</a></dt><dt><a href="samba-pdc.html#id2890899">Account Disabled</a></dt><dt><a href="samba-pdc.html#id2890932">Domain Controller Unavailable</a></dt><dt><a href="samba-pdc.html#id2890954">Cannot Log onto Domain Member Workstation After Joining Domain</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></div><p> +There are many who approach MS Windows networking with incredible misconceptions. +That's okay, because it gives the rest of us plenty of opportunity to be of assistance. +Those who really want help would be well advised to become familiar with information +that is already available. +</p><p> +The reader is advised not to tackle this section without having first understood +and mastered some basics. MS Windows networking is not particularly forgiving of +misconfiguration. Users of MS Windows networking are likely to complain +of persistent niggles that may be caused by a broken network configuration. +To a great many people, however, MS Windows networking starts with a Domain Controller +that in some magical way is expected to solve all network operational ills. +</p><p> +The diagram in <link linkend="domain-example"> shows a typical MS Windows Domain Security +network environment. Workstations A, B and C are representative of many physical MS Windows +network clients. +</p><div class="figure"><a name="domain-example"></a><p class="title"><b>Figure 5.1. An Example Domain.</b></p><div class="mediaobject"><img src="projdoc/imagefiles/domain.png" width="270" alt="An Example Domain."></div></div><p> +From the Samba mailing list one can readily identify many common networking issues. +If you are not clear on the following subjects, then it will do much good to read the +sections of this HOWTO that deal with it. These are the most common causes of MS Windows +networking problems: +</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Basic TCP/IP configuration.</p></li><li><p>NetBIOS name resolution.</p></li><li><p>Authentication configuration.</p></li><li><p>User and group configuration.</p></li><li><p>Basic file and directory permission control in UNIX/Linux.</p></li><li><p>Understanding how MS Windows clients interoperate in a network + environment.</p></li></ul></div><p> +Do not be put off; on the surface of it MS Windows networking seems so simple that anyone +can do it. In fact, it is not a good idea to set up an MS Windows network with +inadequate training and preparation. But let's get our first indelible principle out of the +way: <span class="emphasis"><em>It is perfectly okay to make mistakes!</em></span> In the right place and at +the right time, mistakes are the essence of learning. It is very much not okay to make +mistakes that cause loss of productivity and impose an avoidable financial burden on an +organization. +</p><p> +Where is the right place to make mistakes? Only out of harm's way. If you are going to +make mistakes, then please do it on a test network, away from users and in such a way as +to not inflict pain on others. Do your learning on a test network. +</p><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2870050"></a>Features and Benefits</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2870061"></a> +<span class="emphasis"><em>What is the key benefit of Microsoft Domain Security?</em></span> +</p><p> +In a word, <span class="emphasis"><em>Single Sign On</em></span>, or SSO for short. To many, this is the Holy +Grail of MS Windows NT and beyond networking. SSO allows users in a well-designed network +to log onto any workstation that is a member of the domain that their user account is in +(or in a domain that has an appropriate trust relationship with the domain they are visiting) +and they will be able to log onto the network and access resources (shares, files and printers) +as if they are sitting at their home (personal) workstation. This is a feature of the Domain +Security protocols. +</p><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2870098"></a> +The benefits of Domain Security are available to those sites that deploy a Samba PDC. +A Domain provides a unique network security identifier (SID). Domain user and group security +identifiers are comprised of the network SID plus a relative identifier (RID) that is unique to +the account. User and Group SIDs (the network SID plus the RID) can be used to create Access Control +Lists (ACLs) attached to network resources to provide organizational access control. UNIX systems +recognize only local security identifiers. +</p><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p> +Network clients of an MS Windows Domain Security Environment must be Domain Members to be +able to gain access to the advanced features provided. Domain Membership involves more than just +setting the workgroup name to the Domain name. It requires the creation of a Domain trust account +for the workstation (called a machine account). Refer to <link linkend="domain-member"> +for more information. +</p></div><p> +The following functionalities are new to the Samba-3 release: +</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p> + Windows NT4 domain trusts. + </p></li><li><p> + <a class="indexterm" name="id2870155"></a> + Adding users via the User Manager for Domains. This can be done on any MS Windows + client using the <tt class="filename">Nexus.exe</tt> toolkit that is available from Microsoft's Web site. + Samba-3 supports the use of the Microsoft Management Console for user management. + </p></li><li><p> + Introduces replaceable and multiple user account (authentication) + backends. In the case where the backend is placed in an LDAP database, + Samba-3 confers the benefits of a backend that can be distributed, replicated + and is highly scalable. + </p></li><li><p> + Implements full Unicode support. This simplifies cross locale internationalization + support. It also opens up the use of protocols that Samba-2.2.x had but could not use due + to the need to fully support Unicode. + </p></li></ul></div><p> +The following functionalities are not provided by Samba-3: +</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2870209"></a> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2870218"></a> + SAM replication with Windows NT4 Domain Controllers + (i.e., a Samba PDC and a Windows NT BDC or vice versa). This means Samba + cannot operate as a BDC when the PDC is Microsoft-based or + replicate account data to Windows BDCs. + </p></li><li><p> + Acting as a Windows 2000 Domain Controller (i.e., Kerberos and + Active Directory). In point of fact, Samba-3 does have some + Active Directory Domain Control ability that is at this time + purely experimental that is certain to change as it becomes a + fully supported feature some time during the Samba-3 (or later) + life cycle. However, Active Directory is more then just SMB + it's also LDAP, Kerberos, DHCP, and other protocols (with proprietary + extensions, of course). + </p></li><li><p> + The Windows 200x/XP MMC (Computer Management) Console can not be used + to manage a Samba-3 server. For this you can use only the MS Windows NT4 + Domain Server manager and the MS Windows NT4 Domain User Manager. Both are + part of the SVRTOOLS.EXE package mentioned later. + </p></li></ul></div><p> +Windows 9x/Me/XP Home clients are not true members of a domain for reasons outlined +in this chapter. The protocol for support of Windows 9x/Me style network (domain) logons +is completely different from NT4/Windows 200x type domain logons and has been officially supported +for some time. These clients use the old LanMan Network Logon facilities that are supported +in Samba since approximately the Samba-1.9.15 series. +</p><p> +Samba-3 implements group mapping between Windows NT groups +and UNIX groups (this is really quite complicated to explain in a short space). This is +discussed more fully in <link linkend="groupmapping">. +</p><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2870290"></a> +Samba-3, like an MS Windows NT4 PDC or a Windows 200x Active Directory, needs to store +user and Machine Trust Account information in a suitable backend datastore. +Refer to <link linkend="machine-trust-accounts">. With Samba-3 there can be multiple +backends for this. A complete discussion of account database backends can be found in +<link linkend="passdb">. +</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2870321"></a>Basics of Domain Control</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +Over the years, public perceptions of what Domain Control really is has taken on an +almost mystical nature. Before we branch into a brief overview of Domain Control, +there are three basic types of Domain Controllers. +</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2870336"></a>Domain Controller Types</h3></div></div><div></div></div><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Primary Domain Controller</p></li><li><p>Backup Domain Controller</p></li><li><p>ADS Domain Controller</p></li></ul></div><p> +The <span class="emphasis"><em>Primary Domain Controller</em></span> or PDC plays an important role in MS +Windows NT4. In Windows 200x Domain Control architecture, this role is held by Domain Controllers. +Folklore dictates that because of its role in the MS Windows +network, the Domain Controller should be the most powerful and most capable machine in the network. +As strange as it may seem to say this here, good overall network performance dictates that +the entire infrastructure needs to be balanced. It is advisable to invest more in Stand-alone +(Domain Member) servers than in the Domain Controllers. +</p><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2870387"></a> +In the case of MS Windows NT4-style domains, it is the PDC that initiates a new Domain Control database. +This forms a part of the Windows registry called the Security Account Manager (SAM). It plays a key +part in NT4-type domain user authentication and in synchronization of the domain authentication +database with Backup Domain Controllers. +</p><p> +With MS Windows 200x Server-based Active Directory domains, one Domain Controller initiates a potential +hierarchy of Domain Controllers, each with their own area of delegated control. The master domain +controller has the ability to override any downstream controller, but a downline controller has +control only over its downline. With Samba-3, this functionality can be implemented using an +LDAP-based user and machine account backend. +</p><p> +New to Samba-3 is the ability to use a backend database that holds the same type of data as +the NT4-style SAM database (one of the registry files)<sup>[<a name="id2870421" href="#ftn.id2870421">1</a>]</sup>. +</p><p> +The <span class="emphasis"><em>Backup Domain Controller</em></span> or BDC plays a key role in servicing network +authentication requests. The BDC is biased to answer logon requests in preference to the PDC. +On a network segment that has a BDC and a PDC, the BDC will most likely service network +logon requests. The PDC will answer network logon requests when the BDC is too busy (high load). +A BDC can be promoted to a PDC. If the PDC is online at the time that a BDC is promoted to +PDC, the previous PDC is automatically demoted to a BDC. With Samba-3, this is not an automatic +operation; the PDC and BDC must be manually configured and changes also need to be made. +</p><p> +With MS Windows NT4, a decision is made at installation to determine what type of machine the server will be. +It is possible to promote a BDC to a PDC and vice versa. The only way +to convert a Domain Controller to a Domain Member server or a Stand-alone Server is to +reinstall it. The install time choices offered are: +</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p><span class="emphasis"><em>Primary Domain Controller</em></span> the one that seeds the domain SAM.</p></li><li><p><span class="emphasis"><em>Backup Domain Controller</em></span> one that obtains a copy of the domain SAM.</p></li><li><p><span class="emphasis"><em>Domain Member Server</em></span> one that has no copy of the domain SAM, rather it obtains authentication from a Domain Controller for all access controls.</p></li><li><p><span class="emphasis"><em>Stand-alone Server</em></span> one that plays no part is SAM synchronization, has its own authentication database and plays no role in Domain Security.</p></li></ul></div><p> +With MS Windows 2000, the configuration of Domain Control is done after the server has been +installed. Samba-3 is capable of acting fully as a native member of a Windows 200x server +Active Directory domain. +</p><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2889012"></a> +New to Samba-3 is the ability to function fully as an MS Windows NT4-style Domain Controller, +excluding the SAM replication components. However, please be aware that Samba-3 also supports the +MS Windows 200x Domain Control protocols. +</p><p> +At this time any appearance that Samba-3 is capable of acting as an +<span class="emphasis"><em>Domain Controller</em></span> in native ADS mode is limited and experimental in nature. +This functionality should not be used until the Samba Team offers formal support for it. +At such a time, the documentation will be revised to duly reflect all configuration and +management requirements. Samba can act as a NT4-style DC in a Windows 2000/XP +environment. However, there are certain compromises: + +</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li>No machine policy files.</li><li>No Group Policy Objects.</li><li>No synchronously executed AD logon scripts.</li><li>Can't use Active Directory management tools to manage users and machines.</li><li>Registry changes tattoo the main registry, while with AD they do not leave permanent changes in effect.</li><li>Without AD you cannot perform the function of exporting specific applications to specific users or groups.</li></ul></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2889080"></a>Preparing for Domain Control</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +There are two ways that MS Windows machines may interact with each other, with other servers +and with Domain Controllers: either as <span class="emphasis"><em>Stand-alone</em></span> systems, more commonly +called <span class="emphasis"><em>Workgroup</em></span> members, or as full participants in a security system, +more commonly called <span class="emphasis"><em>Domain</em></span> members. +</p><p> +It should be noted that <span class="emphasis"><em>Workgroup</em></span> membership involves no special configuration +other than the machine being configured so the network configuration has a commonly used name +for its workgroup entry. It is not uncommon for the name WORKGROUP to be used for this. With this +mode of configurationi, there are no Machine Trust Accounts and any concept of membership as such +is limited to the fact that all machines appear in the network neighborhood to be logically +grouped together. Again, just to be clear: <span class="emphasis"><em>workgroup mode does not involve security machine +accounts</em></span>. +</p><p> +Domain Member machines have a machine account in the Domain accounts database. A special procedure +must be followed on each machine to effect Domain Membership. This procedure, which can be done +only by the local machine Administrator account, will create the Domain machine account (if it does +not exist), and then initializes that account. When the client first logs onto the +Domain it triggers a machine password change. +</p><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p> +When Samba is configured as a Domain Controller, secure network operation demands that +all MS Windows NT4/200x/XP Professional clients should be configured as Domain Members. +If a machine is not made a member of the Domain, then it will operate like a workgroup +(Stand-alone) machine. Please refer to <link linkend="domain-member"> for +information regarding Domain Membership. +</p></div><p> +The following are necessary for configuring Samba-3 as an MS Windows NT4-style PDC for MS Windows +NT4/200x/XP clients: +</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Configuration of basic TCP/IP and MS Windows networking.</p></li><li><p>Correct designation of the Server Role (<a class="indexterm" name="id2889184"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>security</tt></i> = user).</p></li><li><p>Consistent configuration of Name Resolution<sup>[<a name="id2889204" href="#ftn.id2889204">2</a>]</sup>.</p></li><li><p>Domain logons for Windows NT4/200x/XP Professional clients.</p></li><li><p>Configuration of Roaming Profiles or explicit configuration to force local profile usage.</p></li><li><p>Configuration of network/system policies.</p></li><li><p>Adding and managing domain user accounts.</p></li><li><p>Configuring MS Windows client machines to become Domain Members.</p></li></ul></div><p> +The following provisions are required to serve MS Windows 9x/Me clients: +</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Configuration of basic TCP/IP and MS Windows networking.</p></li><li><p>Correct designation of the server role (<a class="indexterm" name="id2889279"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>security</tt></i> = user).</p></li><li><p>Network Logon Configuration (since Windows 9x/Me/XP Home are not technically domain + members, they do not really participate in the security aspects of Domain logons as such).</p></li><li><p>Roaming Profile Configuration.</p></li><li><p>Configuration of System Policy handling.</p></li><li><p>Installation of the network driver “<span class="quote">Client for MS Windows Networks</span>” and configuration + to log onto the domain.</p></li><li><p>Placing Windows 9x/Me clients in User Level Security if it is desired to allow + all client share access to be controlled according to domain user/group identities.</p></li><li><p>Adding and managing domain user accounts.</p></li></ul></div><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p> +Roaming Profiles and System/Network policies are advanced network administration topics +that are covered in the <link linkend="ProfileMgmt"> and +<link linkend="PolicyMgmt"> chapters of this document. However, these are not +necessarily specific to a Samba PDC as much as they are related to Windows NT networking concepts. +</p></div><p> +A Domain Controller is an SMB/CIFS server that: +</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p> + Registers and advertises itself as a Domain Controller (through NetBIOS broadcasts + as well as by way of name registrations either by Mailslot Broadcasts over UDP broadcast, + to a WINS server over UDP unicast, or via DNS and Active Directory). + </p></li><li><p> + Provides the NETLOGON service. (This is actually a collection of services that runs over + mulitple protocols. These include the LanMan Logon service, the Netlogon service, + the Local Security Account service, and variations of them.) + </p></li><li><p> + Provides a share called NETLOGON. + </p></li></ul></div><p> +It is rather easy to configure Samba to provide these. Each Samba Domain Controller must provide +the NETLOGON service that Samba calls the <a class="indexterm" name="id2889409"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>domain logons</tt></i> functionality +(after the name of the parameter in the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file). Additionally, one server in a Samba-3 +Domain must advertise itself as the Domain Master Browser<sup>[<a name="id2889433" href="#ftn.id2889433">3</a>]</sup>. +This causes the Primary Domain Controller to claim a domain-specific NetBIOS name that identifies it as a +Domain Master Browser for its given domain or workgroup. Local master browsers in the same domain or workgroup on +broadcast-isolated subnets then ask for a complete copy of the browse list for the whole wide area network. +Browser clients will then contact their Local Master Browser, and will receive the domain-wide browse list, +instead of just the list for their broadcast-isolated subnet. +</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2889458"></a>Domain Control Example Configuration</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +The first step in creating a working Samba PDC is to understand the parameters necessary +in <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt>. An example <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> for acting as a PDC can be found in <link linkend="pdc-example">. +</p><p> +</p><div class="example"><a name="pdc-example"></a><p class="title"><b>Example 5.1. smb.conf for being a PDC</b></p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td> </td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>[global]</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>netbios name = BELERIAND</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>workgroup = MIDEARTH</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>passdb backend = tdbsam</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>os level = 33</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>preferred master = yes</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>domain master = yes</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>local master = yes</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>security = user</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>domain logons = yes</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>logon path = \\%N\profiles\%u</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>logon drive = H:</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>logon home = \\homeserver\%u\winprofile</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>logon script = logon.cmd</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td> </td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>[netlogon]</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>path = /var/lib/samba/netlogon</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>read only = yes</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>write list = ntadmin</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td> </td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>[profiles]</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>path = /var/lib/samba/profiles</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>read only = no</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>create mask = 0600</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>directory mask = 0700</tt></i></td></tr></table></div><p> +</p><p> +The basic options shown in <link linkend="pdc-example"> are explained as follows: +</p><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">passdb backend </span></dt><dd><p> + This contains all the user and group account information. Acceptable values for a PDC + are: <span class="emphasis"><em>smbpasswd, tdbsam, and ldapsam</em></span>. The “<span class="quote">guest</span>” entry provides + default accounts and is included by default, there is no need to add it explicitly.</p><p> + Where use of backup Domain Controllers (BDCs) is intended, the only logical choice is + to use LDAP so the passdb backend can be distributed. The tdbsam and smbpasswd files + cannot effectively be distributed and therefore should not be used. + </p></dd><dt><span class="term">Domain Control Parameters </span></dt><dd><p> + The parameters <span class="emphasis"><em>os level, preferred master, domain master, security, + encrypt passwords, and domain logons</em></span> play a central role in assuring domain + control and network logon support.</p><p> + The <span class="emphasis"><em>os level</em></span> must be set at or above a value of 32. A Domain Controller + must be the Domain Master Browser, must be set in <span class="emphasis"><em>user</em></span> mode security, + must support Microsoft-compatible encrypted passwords, and must provide the network logon + service (domain logons). Encrypted passwords must be enabled. For more details on how + to do this, refer to <link linkend="passdb">. + </p></dd><dt><span class="term">Environment Parameters </span></dt><dd><p> + The parameters <span class="emphasis"><em>logon path, logon home, logon drive, and logon script</em></span> are + environment support settings that help to facilitate client logon operations and that help + to provide automated control facilities to ease network management overheads. Please refer + to the man page information for these parameters. + </p></dd><dt><span class="term">NETLOGON Share </span></dt><dd><p> + The NETLOGON share plays a central role in domain logon and Domain Membership support. + This share is provided on all Microsoft Domain Controllers. It is used to provide logon + scripts, to store Group Policy files (NTConfig.POL), as well as to locate other common + tools that may be needed for logon processing. This is an essential share on a Domain Controller. + </p></dd><dt><span class="term">PROFILE Share </span></dt><dd><p> + This share is used to store user desktop profiles. Each user must have a directory at the root + of this share. This directory must be write-enabled for the user and must be globally read-enabled. + Samba-3 has a VFS module called “<span class="quote">fake_permissions</span>” that may be installed on this share. This will + allow a Samba administrator to make the directory read-only to everyone. Of course this is useful + only after the profile has been properly created. + </p></dd></dl></div><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p> +The above parameters make for a full set of parameters that may define the server's mode +of operation. The following <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> parameters are the essentials alone: +</p><p> +</p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>netbios name = BELERIAND</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>workgroup = MIDEARTH</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>domain logons = Yes</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>domain master = Yes</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>security = User</tt></i></td></tr></table><p> +</p><p> +The additional parameters shown in the longer listing above just makes for +a more complete explanation. +</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2889951"></a>Samba ADS Domain Control</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +Samba-3 is not, and cannot act as, an Active Directory Server. It cannot truly function as +an Active Directory Primary Domain Controller. The protocols for some of the functionality +of Active Directory Domain Controllers has been partially implemented on an experimental +only basis. Please do not expect Samba-3 to support these protocols. Do not depend +on any such functionality either now or in the future. The Samba Team may remove these +experimental features or may change their behavior. This is mentioned for the benefit of those +who have discovered secret capabilities in Samba-3 and who have asked when this functionality will be +completed. The answer is maybe or maybe never! +</p><p> +To be sure, Samba-3 is designed to provide most of the functionality that Microsoft Windows NT4-style +Domain Controllers have. Samba-3 does not have all the capabilities of Windows NT4, but it does have +a number of features that Windows NT4 domain contollers do not have. In short, Samba-3 is not NT4 and it +is not Windows Server 200x, it is not an Active Directory server. We hope this is plain and simple +enough for all to understand. +</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2889989"></a>Domain and Network Logon Configuration</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +The subject of Network or Domain Logons is discussed here because it forms +an integral part of the essential functionality that is provided by a Domain Controller. +</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2890004"></a>Domain Network Logon Service</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +All Domain Controllers must run the netlogon service (<span class="emphasis"><em>domain logons</em></span> +in Samba). One Domain Controller must be configured with <a class="indexterm" name="id2890021"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>domain master</tt></i> = Yes +(the Primary Domain Controller); on all Backup Domain Controllers <a class="indexterm" name="id2890038"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>domain master</tt></i> = No +must be set. +</p><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2890053"></a>Example Configuration</h4></div></div><div></div></div><div class="example"><a name="PDC-config"></a><p class="title"><b>Example 5.2. smb.conf for being a PDC</b></p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td> </td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>[global]</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>domain logons = Yes</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>domain master = (Yes on PDC, No on BDCs)</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td> </td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>[netlogon]</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>comment = Network Logon Service</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>path = /var/lib/samba/netlogon</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>guest ok = Yes</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>browseable = No</tt></i></td></tr></table></div></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2890149"></a>The Special Case of MS Windows XP Home Edition</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> +To be completely clear: If you want MS Windows XP Home Edition to integrate with your +MS Windows NT4 or Active Directory Domain Security, understand it cannot be done. +The only option is to purchase the upgrade from MS Windows XP Home Edition to +MS Windows XP Professional. +</p><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p> +MS Windows XP Home Edition does not have the ability to join any type of Domain +Security facility. Unlike MS Windows 9x/Me, MS Windows XP Home Edition also completely +lacks the ability to log onto a network. +</p></div><p> +Now that this has been said, please do not ask the mailing list or email any of the +Samba Team members with your questions asking how to make this work. It can't be done. +If it can be done, then to do so would violate your software license agreement with +Microsoft, and we recommend that you do not do that. +</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2890186"></a>The Special Case of Windows 9x/Me</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> +A domain and a workgroup are exactly the same in terms of network +browsing. The difference is that a distributable authentication +database is associated with a domain, for secure login access to a +network. Also, different access rights can be granted to users if they +successfully authenticate against a domain logon server. Samba-3 does this +now in the same way as MS Windows NT/200x. +</p><p> +The SMB client logging on to a domain has an expectation that every other +server in the domain should accept the same authentication information. +Network browsing functionality of domains and workgroups is identical and +is explained in this documentation under the browsing discussions. +It should be noted that browsing is totally orthogonal to logon support. +</p><p> +Issues related to the single-logon network model are discussed in this +section. Samba supports domain logons, network logon scripts and user +profiles for MS Windows for workgroups and MS Windows 9X/ME clients, +which are the focus of this section. +</p><p> +When an SMB client in a domain wishes to logon, it broadcasts requests for a +logon server. The first one to reply gets the job, and validates its +password using whatever mechanism the Samba administrator has installed. +It is possible (but ill advised ) to create a domain where the user +database is not shared between servers, i.e., they are effectively workgroup +servers advertising themselves as participating in a domain. This +demonstrates how authentication is quite different from but closely +involved with domains. +</p><p> +Using these features you can make your clients verify their logon via +the Samba server; make clients run a batch file when they logon to +the network and download their preferences, desktop and start menu. +</p><p><span class="emphasis"><em> +MS Windows XP Home edition is not able to join a domain and does not permit +the use of domain logons. +</em></span></p><p> +Before launching into the configuration instructions, it is +worthwhile to look at how a Windows 9x/Me client performs a logon: +</p><div class="orderedlist"><ol type="1"><li><p> + The client broadcasts (to the IP broadcast address of the subnet it is in) + a NetLogon request. This is sent to the NetBIOS name DOMAIN<#1c> at the + NetBIOS layer. The client chooses the first response it receives, which + contains the NetBIOS name of the logon server to use in the format of + <tt class="filename">\\SERVER</tt>. + </p></li><li><p> + The client connects to that server, logs on (does an SMBsessetupX) and + then connects to the IPC$ share (using an SMBtconX). + </p></li><li><p> + The client does a NetWkstaUserLogon request, which retrieves the name + of the user's logon script. + </p></li><li><p> + The client then connects to the NetLogon share and searches for said script. + If it is found and can be read, it is retrieved and executed by the client. + After this, the client disconnects from the NetLogon share. + </p></li><li><p> + The client sends a NetUserGetInfo request to the server to retrieve + the user's home share, which is used to search for profiles. Since the + response to the NetUserGetInfo request does not contain much more than + the user's home share, profiles for Windows 9x clients must reside in the user + home directory. + </p></li><li><p> + The client connects to the user's home share and searches for the + user's profile. As it turns out, you can specify the user's home share as + a sharename and path. For example, <tt class="filename">\\server\fred\.winprofile</tt>. + If the profiles are found, they are implemented. + </p></li><li><p> + The client then disconnects from the user's home share and reconnects to + the NetLogon share and looks for <tt class="filename">CONFIG.POL</tt>, the policies file. If this is + found, it is read and implemented. + </p></li></ol></div><p> +The main difference between a PDC and a Windows 9x/Me logon server configuration is: +</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p> + Password encryption is not required for a Windows 9x/Me logon server. But note + that beginning with MS Windows 98 the default setting is that plain-text + password support is disabled. It can be re-enabled with the registry + changes that are documented in <link linkend="PolicyMgmt">. + </p></li><li><p> + Windows 9x/Me clients do not require and do not use Machine Trust Accounts. + </p></li></ul></div><p> +A Samba PDC will act as a Windows 9x/Me logon server; after all, it does provide the +network logon services that MS Windows 9x/Me expect to find. +</p><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p> +Use of plain-text passwords is strongly discouraged. Where used they are easily detected +using a sniffer tool to examine network traffic. +</p></div></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2890439"></a>Security Mode and Master Browsers</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +There are a few comments to make in order to tie up some loose ends. There has been +much debate over the issue of whether it is okay to configure Samba as a Domain +Controller in security modes other than user. The only security mode that will +not work due to technical reasons is share-mode security. Domain and server mode +security are really just a variation on SMB User Level Security. +</p><p> +Actually, this issue is also closely tied to the debate on whether +Samba must be the Domain Master Browser for its workgroup +when operating as a DC. While it may technically be possible +to configure a server as such (after all, browsing and domain logons +are two distinctly different functions), it is not a good idea to do +so. You should remember that the DC must register the DOMAIN<#1b> NetBIOS +name. This is the name used by Windows clients to locate the DC. +Windows clients do not distinguish between the DC and the DMB. +A DMB is a Domain Master Browser see <link linkend="DMB">. +For this reason, it is wise to configure the Samba DC as the DMB. +</p><p> +Now back to the issue of configuring a Samba DC to use a mode other than +<a class="indexterm" name="id2890493"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>security</tt></i> = user. If a Samba host is +configured to use another SMB server or DC in order to validate user connection requests, +it is a fact that some other machine on the network (the <a class="indexterm" name="id2890510"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>password server</tt></i>) +knows more about the user than the Samba host. About 99% of the time, this other host is +a Domain Controller. Now to operate in domain mode security, the <a class="indexterm" name="id2890527"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>workgroup</tt></i> +parameter must be set to the name of the Windows NT domain (which already has a Domain Controller). +If the domain does not already have a Domain Controller, you do not yet have a Domain. +</p><p> +Configuring a Samba box as a DC for a domain that already by definition has a +PDC is asking for trouble. Therefore, you should always configure the Samba DC +to be the DMB for its domain and set <a class="indexterm" name="id2890552"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>security</tt></i> = user. +This is the only officially supported mode of operation. +</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2890570"></a>Common Errors</h2></div></div><div></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2890577"></a>“<span class="quote">$</span>” Cannot Be Included in Machine Name</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +A machine account, typically stored in <tt class="filename">/etc/passwd</tt>, takes the form of the machine +name with a “<span class="quote">$</span>” appended. FreeBSD (and other BSD systems) will not create a user with a +“<span class="quote">$</span>” in the name. +</p><p> +The problem is only in the program used to make the entry. Once made, it works perfectly. +Create a user without the “<span class="quote">$</span>”. Then use <b class="command">vipw</b> to edit the entry, adding +the “<span class="quote">$</span>”. Or create the whole entry with vipw if you like; make sure you use a unique user login ID. +</p><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3>The machine account must have the exact name that the workstation has.</div><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p> +The UNIX tool <b class="command">vipw</b> is a common tool for directly editing the <tt class="filename">/etc/passwd</tt> file. +</p></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2890661"></a>Joining Domain Fails Because of Existing Machine Account</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +“<span class="quote">I get told, `You already have a connection to the Domain....' or `Cannot join domain, the +credentials supplied conflict with an existing set...' when creating a Machine Trust Account.</span>” +</p><p> +This happens if you try to create a Machine Trust Account from the machine itself and already have a +connection (e.g., mapped drive) to a share (or IPC$) on the Samba PDC. The following command +will remove all network drive connections: +</p><pre class="screen"> +<tt class="prompt">C:\> </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>net use * /d</tt></b> +</pre><p> +</p><p> +Further, if the machine is already a “<span class="quote">member of a workgroup</span>” that +is the same name as the domain you are joining (bad idea) you will +get this message. Change the workgroup name to something else, it +does not matter what, reboot, and try again. +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2890722"></a>The System Cannot Log You On (C000019B)</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>“<span class="quote">I joined the domain successfully but after upgrading +to a newer version of the Samba code I get the message, <span class="errorname">`The system +cannot log you on (C000019B), Please try again or consult your +system administrator</span> when attempting to logon.'</span>” +</p><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2890749"></a> +This occurs when the domain SID stored in the secrets.tdb database +is changed. The most common cause of a change in domain SID is when +the domain name and/or the server name (NetBIOS name) is changed. +The only way to correct the problem is to restore the original domain +SID or remove the domain client from the domain and rejoin. The domain +SID may be reset using either the net or rpcclient utilities. +</p><p> +To reset or change the domain SID you can use the net command as follows: + +</p><pre class="screen"> +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>net getlocalsid 'OLDNAME'</tt></b> +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>net setlocalsid 'SID'</tt></b> +</pre><p> +</p><p> +Workstation Machine Trust Accounts work only with the Domain (or network) SID. If this SID changes +Domain Members (workstations) will not be able to log onto the domain. The original Domain SID +can be recovered from the secrets.tdb file. The alternative is to visit each workstation to re-join +it to the domain. +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2890822"></a>The Machine Trust Account Is Not Accessible</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +“<span class="quote">When I try to join the domain I get the message, <span class="errorname">`The machine account +for this computer either does not exist or is not accessible'</span>. What's +wrong?</span>” +</p><p> +This problem is caused by the PDC not having a suitable Machine Trust Account. +If you are using the <a class="indexterm" name="id2890849"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>add machine script</tt></i> method to create +accounts then this would indicate that it has not worked. Ensure the domain +admin user system is working. +</p><p> +Alternately, if you are creating account entries manually then they +have not been created correctly. Make sure that you have the entry +correct for the Machine Trust Account in <tt class="filename">smbpasswd</tt> file on the Samba PDC. +If you added the account using an editor rather than using the smbpasswd +utility, make sure that the account name is the machine NetBIOS name +with a “<span class="quote">$</span>” appended to it (i.e., computer_name$). There must be an entry +in both /etc/passwd and the smbpasswd file. +</p><p> +Some people have also reported that inconsistent subnet masks between the Samba server and the NT +client can cause this problem. Make sure that these are consistent for both client and server. +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2890899"></a>Account Disabled</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>“<span class="quote">When I attempt to login to a Samba Domain from a NT4/W200x workstation, +I get a message about my account being disabled.</span>”</p><p> +Enable the user accounts with <b class="userinput"><tt>smbpasswd -e <i class="replaceable"><tt>username</tt></i> +</tt></b>. This is normally done as an account is created. +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2890932"></a>Domain Controller Unavailable</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>“<span class="quote">Until a few minutes after Samba has started, clients get the error `Domain Controller Unavailable'</span>”</p><p> +A Domain Controller has to announce its role on the network. This usually takes a while. Be patient for up to fifteen minutes, +then try again. +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2890954"></a>Cannot Log onto Domain Member Workstation After Joining Domain</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2890966"></a> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2890975"></a> +After successfully joining the domain, user logons fail with one of two messages: one to the +effect that the Domain Controller cannot be found; the other claims that the account does not +exist in the domain or that the password is incorrect. This may be due to incompatible +settings between the Windows client and the Samba-3 server for <span class="emphasis"><em>schannel</em></span> +(secure channel) settings or <span class="emphasis"><em>smb signing</em></span> settings. Check your Samba +settings for <span class="emphasis"><em> client schannel, server schannel, client signing, server signing</em></span> +by executing: +</p><pre class="screen"> +<b class="command">testparm -v | more</b> and looking for the value of these parameters. +</pre><p> +</p><p> +Also use the Microsoft Management Console Local Security Settings. This tool is available from the +Control Panel. The Policy settings are found in the Local Policies/Securty Options area and are prefixed by +<span class="emphasis"><em>Secure Channel: ..., and Digitally sign ....</em></span>. +</p><p> +It is important that these be set consistently with the Samba-3 server settings. +</p></div></div><div class="footnotes"><br><hr width="100" align="left"><div class="footnote"><link linkend="passdb"></div><div class="footnote"><p><sup>[<a name="ftn.id2889204" href="#id2889204">2</a>] </sup>See <link linkend="NetworkBrowsing">, and + <link linkend="integrate-ms-networks">.</p></div><div class="footnote"><link linkend="NetworkBrowsing"></div></div></div><div class="navfooter"><hr><table width="100%" summary="Navigation footer"><tr><td width="40%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="ServerType.html">Prev</a> </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="u" href="type.html">Up</a></td><td width="40%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="samba-bdc.html">Next</a></td></tr><tr><td width="40%" align="left" valign="top">Chapter 4. Server Types and Security Modes </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="h" href="index.html">Home</a></td><td width="40%" align="right" valign="top"> Chapter 6. Backup Domain Control</td></tr></table></div></body></html> diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/securing-samba.html b/docs/htmldocs/securing-samba.html new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..f4adfe8fd6 --- /dev/null +++ b/docs/htmldocs/securing-samba.html @@ -0,0 +1,180 @@ +<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>Chapter 15. Securing Samba</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.60.1"><link rel="home" href="index.html" title="SAMBA Project Documentation"><link rel="up" href="optional.html" title="Part III. Advanced Configuration"><link rel="previous" href="locking.html" title="Chapter 14. File and Record Locking"><link rel="next" href="InterdomainTrusts.html" title="Chapter 16. Interdomain Trust Relationships"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="navheader"><table width="100%" summary="Navigation header"><tr><th colspan="3" align="center">Chapter 15. Securing Samba</th></tr><tr><td width="20%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="locking.html">Prev</a> </td><th width="60%" align="center">Part III. Advanced Configuration</th><td width="20%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="InterdomainTrusts.html">Next</a></td></tr></table><hr></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="securing-samba"></a>Chapter 15. Securing Samba</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Andrew</span> <span class="surname">Tridgell</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:tridge@samba.org">tridge@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">John</span> <span class="othername">H.</span> <span class="surname">Terpstra</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org">jht@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><p class="pubdate">May 26, 2003</p></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="securing-samba.html#id2918114">Introduction</a></dt><dt><a href="securing-samba.html#id2918159">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="securing-samba.html#id2918244">Technical Discussion of Protective Measures and Issues</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="securing-samba.html#id2918263">Using Host-Based Protection</a></dt><dt><a href="securing-samba.html#id2918364">User-Based Protection</a></dt><dt><a href="securing-samba.html#id2918424">Using Interface Protection</a></dt><dt><a href="securing-samba.html#id2918507">Using a Firewall</a></dt><dt><a href="securing-samba.html#id2918564">Using IPC$ Share-Based Denials </a></dt><dt><a href="securing-samba.html#id2918648">NTLMv2 Security</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="securing-samba.html#id2918707">Upgrading Samba</a></dt><dt><a href="securing-samba.html#id2918731">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="securing-samba.html#id2918750">Smbclient Works on Localhost, but the Network Is Dead</a></dt><dt><a href="securing-samba.html#id2918774">Why Can Users Access Home Directories of Other Users?</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2918114"></a>Introduction</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +This note was attached to the Samba 2.2.8 release notes as it contained an +important security fix. The information contained here applies to Samba +installations in general. +</p><div class="blockquote"><blockquote class="blockquote"><p> +A new apprentice reported for duty to the chief engineer of a boiler house. He said, “<span class="quote">Here I am, +if you will show me the boiler I'll start working on it.</span>” Then engineer replied, “<span class="quote">You're leaning +on it!</span>” +</p></blockquote></div><p> +Security concerns are just like that. You need to know a little about the subject to appreciate +how obvious most of it really is. The challenge for most of us is to discover that first morsel +of knowledge with which we may unlock the secrets of the masters. +</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2918159"></a>Features and Benefits</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +There are three levels at which security principals must be observed in order to render a site +at least moderately secure. They are the perimeter firewall, the configuration of the host +server that is running Samba and Samba itself. +</p><p> +Samba permits a most flexible approach to network security. As far as possible Samba implements +the latest protocols to permit more secure MS Windows file and print operations. +</p><p> +Samba may be secured from connections that originate from outside the local network. This may be +done using <span class="emphasis"><em>host-based protection</em></span> (using samba's implementation of a technology +known as “<span class="quote">tcpwrappers,</span>” or it may be done be using <span class="emphasis"><em>interface-based exclusion</em></span> +so <span class="application">smbd</span> will bind only to specifically permitted interfaces. It is also +possible to set specific share or resource-based exclusions, for example on the <i class="parameter"><tt>[IPC$]</tt></i> +auto-share. The <i class="parameter"><tt>[IPC$]</tt></i> share is used for browsing purposes as well as to establish +TCP/IP connections. +</p><p> +Another method by which Samba may be secured is by setting Access Control Entries (ACEs) in an Access +Control List (ACL) on the shares themselves. This is discussed in <link linkend="AccessControls">. +</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2918244"></a>Technical Discussion of Protective Measures and Issues</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +The key challenge of security is the fact that protective measures suffice at best +only to close the door on known exploits and breach techniques. Never assume that +because you have followed these few measures that the Samba server is now an impenetrable +fortress! Given the history of information systems so far, it is only a matter of time +before someone will find yet another vulnerability. +</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2918263"></a>Using Host-Based Protection</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + In many installations of Samba, the greatest threat comes from outside + your immediate network. By default, Samba will accept connections from + any host, which means that if you run an insecure version of Samba on + a host that is directly connected to the Internet you can be + especially vulnerable. + </p><p> + One of the simplest fixes in this case is to use the <a class="indexterm" name="id2918285"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>hosts allow</tt></i> and + <a class="indexterm" name="id2918298"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>hosts deny</tt></i> options in the Samba <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> configuration file to only + allow access to your server from a specific range of hosts. An example might be: + </p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>hosts allow = 127.0.0.1 192.168.2.0/24 192.168.3.0/24</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>hosts deny = 0.0.0.0/0</tt></i></td></tr></table><p> + The above will only allow SMB connections from <tt class="constant">localhost</tt> (your own + computer) and from the two private networks 192.168.2 and 192.168.3. All other + connections will be refused as soon as the client sends its first packet. The refusal + will be marked as <span class="errorname">not listening on called name</span> error. + </p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2918364"></a>User-Based Protection</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + If you want to restrict access to your server to valid users only, then the following + method may be of use. In the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> <i class="parameter"><tt>[global]</tt></i> section put: + </p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>valid users = @smbusers, jacko</tt></i></td></tr></table><p> + This restricts all server access to either the user <span class="emphasis"><em>jacko</em></span> + or to members of the system group <span class="emphasis"><em>smbusers</em></span>. + </p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2918424"></a>Using Interface Protection</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + By default, Samba will accept connections on any network interface that + it finds on your system. That means if you have a ISDN line or a PPP + connection to the Internet then Samba will accept connections on those + links. This may not be what you want. + </p><p> + You can change this behavior using options like this: + </p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>interfaces = eth* lo</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>bind interfaces only = yes</tt></i></td></tr></table><p> + This tells Samba to only listen for connections on interfaces with a + name starting with <tt class="constant">eth</tt> such as <tt class="constant">eth0, eth1</tt> plus on the loopback + interface called <tt class="constant">lo</tt>. The name you will need to use depends on what + OS you are using. In the above, I used the common name for Ethernet + adapters on Linux. + </p><p> + If you use the above and someone tries to make an SMB connection to + your host over a PPP interface called <tt class="constant">ppp0,</tt> then they will get a TCP + connection refused reply. In that case, no Samba code is run at all as + the operating system has been told not to pass connections from that + interface to any Samba process. + </p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2918507"></a>Using a Firewall</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + Many people use a firewall to deny access to services they do not + want exposed outside their network. This can be a good idea, + although I recommend using it in conjunction with the above + methods so you are protected even if your firewall is not active + for some reason. + </p><p> + If you are setting up a firewall, you need to know what TCP and + UDP ports to allow and block. Samba uses the following: + </p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td>UDP/137 - used by nmbd</td></tr><tr><td>UDP/138 - used by nmbd</td></tr><tr><td>TCP/139 - used by smbd</td></tr><tr><td>TCP/445 - used by smbd</td></tr></table><p> + The last one is important as many older firewall setups may not be + aware of it, given that this port was only added to the protocol in + recent years. + </p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2918564"></a>Using IPC$ Share-Based Denials </h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + If the above methods are not suitable, then you could also place a + more specific deny on the IPC$ share that is used in the recently + discovered security hole. This allows you to offer access to other + shares while denying access to IPC$ from potentially untrustworthy + hosts. + </p><p> + To do this you could use: + </p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td> </td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>[IPC$]</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>hosts allow = 192.168.115.0/24 127.0.0.1</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>hosts deny = 0.0.0.0/0</tt></i></td></tr></table><p> + This instructs Samba that IPC$ connections are not allowed from + anywhere except from the two listed network addresses (localhost and the 192.168.115 + subnet). Connections to other shares are still allowed. As the + IPC$ share is the only share that is always accessible anonymously, + this provides some level of protection against attackers that do not + know a valid username/password for your host. + </p><p> + If you use this method, then clients will be given an <span class="errorname">`access denied'</span> + reply when they try to access the IPC$ share. Those clients will not be able to + browse shares, and may also be unable to access some other resources. This is not + recommended unless you cannot use one of the other methods listed above for some reason. + </p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2918648"></a>NTLMv2 Security</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + To configure NTLMv2 authentication, the following registry keys are worth knowing about: + </p><p> + </p><pre class="screen"> + [HKEY_LOCAL_MACHINE\SYSTEM\CurrentControlSet\Control\Lsa] + "lmcompatibilitylevel"=dword:00000003 + </pre><p> + </p><p> + The value 0x00000003 means send NTLMv2 response only. Clients will use NTLMv2 authentication, + use NTLMv2 session security if the server supports it. Domain Controllers accept LM, + NTLM and NTLMv2 authentication. + </p><p> + </p><pre class="screen"> + [HKEY_LOCAL_MACHINE\SYSTEM\CurrentControlSet\Control\Lsa\MSV1_0] + "NtlmMinClientSec"=dword:00080000 + </pre><p> + </p><p> + The value 0x00080000 means permit only NTLMv2 session security. If either NtlmMinClientSec or + NtlmMinServerSec is set to 0x00080000, the connection will fail if NTLMv2 + session security is not negotiated. + </p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2918707"></a>Upgrading Samba</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +Please check regularly on <ulink url="http://www.samba.org/">http://www.samba.org/</ulink> for updates and +important announcements. Occasionally security releases are made and +it is highly recommended to upgrade Samba when a security vulnerability +is discovered. Check with your OS vendor for OS specific upgrades. +</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2918731"></a>Common Errors</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +If all of Samba and host platform configuration were really as intuitive as one might like them to be, this +section would not be necessary. Security issues are often vexing for a support person to resolve, not +because of the complexity of the problem, but for the reason that most administrators who post what turns +out to be a security problem request are totally convinced that the problem is with Samba. +</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2918750"></a>Smbclient Works on Localhost, but the Network Is Dead</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + This is a common problem. Red Hat Linux (and others) installs a default firewall. + With the default firewall in place, only traffic on the loopback adapter (IP address 127.0.0.1) + is allowed through the firewall. + </p><p> + The solution is either to remove the firewall (stop it) or modify the firewall script to + allow SMB networking traffic through. See section above in this chapter. + </p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2918774"></a>Why Can Users Access Home Directories of Other Users?</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + “<span class="quote"> + We are unable to keep individual users from mapping to any other user's + home directory once they have supplied a valid password! They only need + to enter their own password. I have not found any method to configure + Samba so that users may map only their own home directory. + </span>” + </p><p>“<span class="quote"> + User xyzzy can map his home directory. Once mapped user xyzzy can also map + anyone else's home directory. + </span>”</p><p> + This is not a security flaw, it is by design. Samba allows users to have + exactly the same access to the UNIX file system as when they were logged + onto the UNIX box, except that it only allows such views onto the file + system as are allowed by the defined shares. + </p><p> + If your UNIX home directories are set up so that one user can happily <b class="command">cd</b> + into another users directory and execute <b class="command">ls</b>, the UNIX security solution is to change file + permissions on the user's home directories such that the <b class="command">cd</b> and <b class="command">ls</b> are denied. + </p><p> + Samba tries very hard not to second guess the UNIX administrators security policies, and + trusts the UNIX admin to set the policies and permissions he or she desires. + </p><p> + Samba allows the behavior you require. Simply put the <a class="indexterm" name="id2918859"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>only user</tt></i> = %S + option in the <i class="parameter"><tt>[homes]</tt></i> share definition. + </p><p> + The <a class="indexterm" name="id2918883"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>only user</tt></i> works in conjunction with the <a class="indexterm" name="id2918899"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>users</tt></i> = list, + so to get the behavior you require, add the line : + </p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>users = %S</tt></i></td></tr></table><p> + this is equivalent to adding + </p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>valid users = %S</tt></i></td></tr></table><p> + to the definition of the <i class="parameter"><tt>[homes]</tt></i> share, as recommended in + the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> man page. + </p></div></div></div><div class="navfooter"><hr><table width="100%" summary="Navigation footer"><tr><td width="40%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="locking.html">Prev</a> </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="u" href="optional.html">Up</a></td><td width="40%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="InterdomainTrusts.html">Next</a></td></tr><tr><td width="40%" align="left" valign="top">Chapter 14. File and Record Locking </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="h" href="index.html">Home</a></td><td width="40%" align="right" valign="top"> Chapter 16. Interdomain Trust Relationships</td></tr></table></div></body></html> diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/speed.html b/docs/htmldocs/speed.html new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..b55989d053 --- /dev/null +++ b/docs/htmldocs/speed.html @@ -0,0 +1,141 @@ +<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>Chapter 39. Samba Performance Tuning</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.60.1"><link rel="home" href="index.html" title="SAMBA Project Documentation"><link rel="up" href="Appendixes.html" title="Part VI. Appendixes"><link rel="previous" href="Other-Clients.html" title="Chapter 38. Samba and Other CIFS Clients"><link rel="next" href="DNSDHCP.html" title="Chapter 40. DNS and DHCP Configuration Guide"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="navheader"><table width="100%" summary="Navigation header"><tr><th colspan="3" align="center">Chapter 39. Samba Performance Tuning</th></tr><tr><td width="20%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="Other-Clients.html">Prev</a> </td><th width="60%" align="center">Part VI. Appendixes</th><td width="20%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="DNSDHCP.html">Next</a></td></tr></table><hr></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="speed"></a>Chapter 39. Samba Performance Tuning</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Paul</span> <span class="surname">Cochrane</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Dundee Limb Fitting Centre<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:paulc@dth.scot.nhs.uk">paulc@dth.scot.nhs.uk</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Jelmer</span> <span class="othername">R.</span> <span class="surname">Vernooij</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">The Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jelmer@samba.org">jelmer@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">John</span> <span class="othername">H.</span> <span class="surname">Terpstra</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org">jht@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="speed.html#id2976235">Comparisons</a></dt><dt><a href="speed.html#id2976281">Socket Options</a></dt><dt><a href="speed.html#id2976372">Read Size</a></dt><dt><a href="speed.html#id2976422">Max Xmit</a></dt><dt><a href="speed.html#id2976477">Log Level</a></dt><dt><a href="speed.html#id2976507">Read Raw</a></dt><dt><a href="speed.html#id2976592">Write Raw</a></dt><dt><a href="speed.html#id2976655">Slow Logins</a></dt><dt><a href="speed.html#id2976683">Client Tuning</a></dt><dt><a href="speed.html#id2976707">Samba Performance Problem Due to Changing Linux Kernel</a></dt><dt><a href="speed.html#id2976766">Corrupt tdb Files</a></dt></dl></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2976235"></a>Comparisons</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +The Samba server uses TCP to talk to the client. Thus if you are +trying to see if it performs well, you should really compare it to +programs that use the same protocol. The most readily available +programs for file transfer that use TCP are ftp or another TCP-based +SMB server. +</p><p> +If you want to test against something like an NT or Windows for Workgroups server, then +you will have to disable all but TCP on either the client or +server. Otherwise, you may well be using a totally different protocol +(such as NetBEUI) and comparisons may not be valid. +</p><p> +Generally, you should find that Samba performs similarly to ftp at raw +transfer speed. It should perform quite a bit faster than NFS, +although this depends on your system. +</p><p> +Several people have done comparisons between Samba and Novell, NFS or +Windows NT. In some cases Samba performed the best, in others the worst. I +suspect the biggest factor is not Samba versus some other system, but the +hardware and drivers used on the various systems. Given similar +hardware, Samba should certainly be competitive in speed with other +systems. +</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2976281"></a>Socket Options</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +There are a number of socket options that can greatly affect the +performance of a TCP-based server like Samba. +</p><p> +The socket options that Samba uses are settable both on the command +line with the <tt class="option">-O</tt> option, or in the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file. +</p><p> +The <a class="indexterm" name="id2976313"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>socket options</tt></i> section of the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> manual page describes how +to set these and gives recommendations. +</p><p> +Getting the socket options correct can make a big difference to your +performance, but getting them wrong can degrade it by just as +much. The correct settings are very dependent on your local network. +</p><p> +The socket option TCP_NODELAY is the one that seems to make the biggest single difference +for most networks. Many people report that adding +<a class="indexterm" name="id2976350"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>socket options</tt></i> = TCP_NODELAY +doubles the read performance of a Samba drive. The best explanation I have seen for +this is that the Microsoft TCP/IP stack is slow in sending TCP ACKs. +</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2976372"></a>Read Size</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +The option <a class="indexterm" name="id2976382"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>read size</tt></i> affects the overlap of disk +reads/writes with network reads/writes. If the amount of data being +transferred in several of the SMB commands (currently SMBwrite, SMBwriteX and +SMBreadbraw) is larger than this value, then the server begins writing +the data before it has received the whole packet from the network, or +in the case of SMBreadbraw, it begins writing to the network before +all the data has been read from disk. +</p><p> +This overlapping works best when the speeds of disk and network access +are similar, having little effect when the speed of one is much +greater than the other. +</p><p> +The default value is 16384, but little experimentation has been +done as yet to determine the optimal value, and it is likely that the best +value will vary greatly between systems anyway. A value over 65536 is +pointless and will cause you to allocate memory unnecessarily. +</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2976422"></a>Max Xmit</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> + At startup the client and server negotiate a <i class="parameter"><tt>maximum transmit</tt></i> size, +which limits the size of nearly all SMB commands. You can set the +maximum size that Samba will negotiate using the <a class="indexterm" name="id2976442"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>max xmit</tt></i> option +in <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt>. Note that this is the maximum size of SMB requests that +Samba will accept, but not the maximum size that the client will accept. +The client maximum receive size is sent to Samba by the client and Samba +honors this limit. +</p><p> +It defaults to 65536 bytes (the maximum), but it is possible that some +clients may perform better with a smaller transmit unit. Trying values +of less than 2048 is likely to cause severe problems. +In most cases the default is the best option. +</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2976477"></a>Log Level</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +If you set the log level (also known as <a class="indexterm" name="id2976487"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>debug level</tt></i>) higher than 2 +then you may suffer a large drop in performance. This is because the +server flushes the log file after each operation, which can be quite +expensive. +</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2976507"></a>Read Raw</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +The <a class="indexterm" name="id2976517"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>read raw</tt></i> operation is designed to be an optimized, low-latency +file read operation. A server may choose to not support it, +however, and Samba makes support for <a class="indexterm" name="id2976534"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>read raw</tt></i> optional, with it +being enabled by default. +</p><p> +In some cases clients do not handle <a class="indexterm" name="id2976552"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>read raw</tt></i> very well and actually +get lower performance using it than they get using the conventional +read operations. +</p><p> +So you might like to try <a class="indexterm" name="id2976573"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>read raw</tt></i> = no and see what happens on your +network. It might lower, raise or not effect your performance. Only +testing can really tell. +</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2976592"></a>Write Raw</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +The <a class="indexterm" name="id2976602"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>write raw</tt></i> operation is designed to be an optimized, low-latency +file write operation. A server may choose to not support it, however, and Samba makes support for +<a class="indexterm" name="id2976618"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>write raw</tt></i> optional, with it being enabled by default. +</p><p> +Some machines may find <a class="indexterm" name="id2976637"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>write raw</tt></i> slower than normal write, in which +case you may wish to change this option. +</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2976655"></a>Slow Logins</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +Slow logins are almost always due to the password checking time. Using +the lowest practical <a class="indexterm" name="id2976666"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>password level</tt></i> will improve things. +</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2976683"></a>Client Tuning</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +Often a speed problem can be traced to the client. The client (for +example Windows for Workgroups) can often be tuned for better TCP +performance. Check the sections on the various clients in +<link linkend="Other-Clients">. +</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2976707"></a>Samba Performance Problem Due to Changing Linux Kernel</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +A user wrote the following to the mailing list: +</p><p> +I am running Gentoo on my server and Samba 2.2.8a. Recently +I changed kernel version from <tt class="filename">linux-2.4.19-gentoo-r10</tt> to +<tt class="filename">linux-2.4.20-wolk4.0s</tt>. And now I have a performance issue with Samba. +Many of you will probably say, “<span class="quote">Move to vanilla sources!</span>” +Well, I tried that and it didn't work. I have a 100mb LAN and two computers (Linux and +Windows 2000). The Linux server shares directories with DivX files, the client +(Windows 2000) plays them via LAN. Before when I was running the 2.4.19 kernel +everything was fine, but now movies freeze and stop. I tried moving +files between the server and Windows and it is terribly slow. +</p><p> +The answer he was given is: +</p><p> +Grab the mii-tool and check the duplex settings on the NIC. +My guess is that it is a link layer issue, not an application +layer problem. Also run ifconfig and verify that the framing +error, collisions, and so on, look normal for ethernet. +</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2976766"></a>Corrupt tdb Files</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +Our Samba PDC server has been hosting three TB of data to our 500+ users +[Windows NT/XP] for the last three years using Samba without a problem. +Today all shares went very slow. Also the main smbd kept +spawning new processes so we had 1600+ running smbd's (normally we avg. 250). +It crashed the SUN E3500 cluster twice. After a lot of searching, I +decided to <b class="command">rm /var/locks/*.tdb</b>. Happy again. +</p><p> +<span class="emphasis"><em>Question:</em></span> Is there any method of keeping the *.tdb files in top condition or +how can I detect early corruption? +</p><p> +<span class="emphasis"><em>Answer:</em></span> Yes, run <b class="command">tdbbackup</b> each time after stopping nmbd and before starting nmbd. +</p><p> +<span class="emphasis"><em>Question:</em></span> What I also would like to mention is that the service latency seems +a lot lower than before the locks cleanup. Any ideas on keeping it top notch? +</p><p> +<span class="emphasis"><em>Answer:</em></span> Yes. Same answer as for previous question! +</p></div></div><div class="navfooter"><hr><table width="100%" summary="Navigation footer"><tr><td width="40%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="Other-Clients.html">Prev</a> </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="u" href="Appendixes.html">Up</a></td><td width="40%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="DNSDHCP.html">Next</a></td></tr><tr><td width="40%" align="left" valign="top">Chapter 38. Samba and Other CIFS Clients </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="h" href="index.html">Home</a></td><td width="40%" align="right" valign="top"> Chapter 40. DNS and DHCP Configuration Guide</td></tr></table></div></body></html> diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/troubleshooting.html b/docs/htmldocs/troubleshooting.html new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..76880a0fff --- /dev/null +++ b/docs/htmldocs/troubleshooting.html @@ -0,0 +1 @@ +<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>Part V. Troubleshooting</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.60.1"><link rel="home" href="index.html" title="SAMBA Project Documentation"><link rel="up" href="index.html" title="SAMBA Project Documentation"><link rel="previous" href="SWAT.html" title="Chapter 32. SWAT The Samba Web Administration Tool"><link rel="next" href="diagnosis.html" title="Chapter 33. The Samba Checklist"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="navheader"><table width="100%" summary="Navigation header"><tr><th colspan="3" align="center">Part V. Troubleshooting</th></tr><tr><td width="20%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="SWAT.html">Prev</a> </td><th width="60%" align="center"> </th><td width="20%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="diagnosis.html">Next</a></td></tr></table><hr></div><div class="part" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h1 class="title"><a name="troubleshooting"></a>Troubleshooting</h1></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt>33. <a href="diagnosis.html">The Samba Checklist</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="diagnosis.html#id2969273">Introduction</a></dt><dt><a href="diagnosis.html#id2969311">Assumptions</a></dt><dt><a href="diagnosis.html#id2969546">The Tests</a></dt></dl></dd><dt>34. <a href="problems.html">Analyzing and Solving Samba Problems</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="problems.html#id2971255">Diagnostics Tools</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="problems.html#id2971276">Debugging with Samba Itself</a></dt><dt><a href="problems.html#id2971441">Tcpdump</a></dt><dt><a href="problems.html#id2971477">Ethereal</a></dt><dt><a href="problems.html#id2971621">The Windows Network Monitor</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="problems.html#id2971938">Useful URLs</a></dt><dt><a href="problems.html#id2971978">Getting Mailing List Help</a></dt><dt><a href="problems.html#id2972155">How to Get Off the Mailing Lists</a></dt></dl></dd><dt>35. <a href="bugreport.html">Reporting Bugs</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="bugreport.html#id2972309">Introduction</a></dt><dt><a href="bugreport.html#id2972372">General Information</a></dt><dt><a href="bugreport.html#id2972408">Debug Levels</a></dt><dt><a href="bugreport.html#id2972617">Internal Errors</a></dt><dt><a href="bugreport.html#id2972752">Attaching to a Running Process</a></dt><dt><a href="bugreport.html#id2972799">Patches</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></div></div><div class="navfooter"><hr><table width="100%" summary="Navigation footer"><tr><td width="40%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="SWAT.html">Prev</a> </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="u" href="index.html">Up</a></td><td width="40%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="diagnosis.html">Next</a></td></tr><tr><td width="40%" align="left" valign="top">Chapter 32. SWAT The Samba Web Administration Tool </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="h" href="index.html">Home</a></td><td width="40%" align="right" valign="top"> Chapter 33. The Samba Checklist</td></tr></table></div></body></html> diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/type.html b/docs/htmldocs/type.html new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..b85042f009 --- /dev/null +++ b/docs/htmldocs/type.html @@ -0,0 +1,5 @@ +<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>Part II. Server Configuration Basics</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.60.1"><link rel="home" href="index.html" title="SAMBA Project Documentation"><link rel="up" href="index.html" title="SAMBA Project Documentation"><link rel="previous" href="FastStart.html" title="Chapter 3. Fast Start for the Impatient"><link rel="next" href="ServerType.html" title="Chapter 4. Server Types and Security Modes"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="navheader"><table width="100%" summary="Navigation header"><tr><th colspan="3" align="center">Part II. Server Configuration Basics</th></tr><tr><td width="20%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="FastStart.html">Prev</a> </td><th width="60%" align="center"> </th><td width="20%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="ServerType.html">Next</a></td></tr></table><hr></div><div class="part" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h1 class="title"><a name="type"></a>Server Configuration Basics</h1></div></div><div></div></div><div class="partintro" lang="en"><div><div><div><h1 class="title"><a name="id2885842"></a>First Steps in Server Configuration</h1></div></div><div></div></div><p> +Samba can operate in various modes within SMB networks. This HOWTO section contains information on +configuring samba to function as the type of server your network requires. Please read this +section carefully. +</p><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt>4. <a href="ServerType.html">Server Types and Security Modes</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="ServerType.html#id2885999">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="ServerType.html#id2886097">Server Types</a></dt><dt><a href="ServerType.html#id2886186">Samba Security Modes</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="ServerType.html#id2886291">User Level Security</a></dt><dt><a href="ServerType.html#id2886413">Share Level Security</a></dt><dt><a href="ServerType.html#id2886525">Domain Security Mode (User Level Security)</a></dt><dt><a href="ServerType.html#id2886821">ADS Security Mode (User Level Security)</a></dt><dt><a href="ServerType.html#id2886928">Server Security (User Level Security)</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="ServerType.html#id2887204">Password Checking</a></dt><dt><a href="ServerType.html#id2887400">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="ServerType.html#id2887429">What Makes Samba a Server?</a></dt><dt><a href="ServerType.html#id2887468">What Makes Samba a Domain Controller?</a></dt><dt><a href="ServerType.html#id2887504">What Makes Samba a Domain Member?</a></dt><dt><a href="ServerType.html#id2887542">Constantly Losing Connections to Password Server</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>5. <a href="samba-pdc.html">Domain Control</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="samba-pdc.html#id2870050">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="samba-pdc.html#id2870321">Basics of Domain Control</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="samba-pdc.html#id2870336">Domain Controller Types</a></dt><dt><a href="samba-pdc.html#id2889080">Preparing for Domain Control</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="samba-pdc.html#id2889458">Domain Control Example Configuration</a></dt><dt><a href="samba-pdc.html#id2889951">Samba ADS Domain Control</a></dt><dt><a href="samba-pdc.html#id2889989">Domain and Network Logon Configuration</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="samba-pdc.html#id2890004">Domain Network Logon Service</a></dt><dt><a href="samba-pdc.html#id2890439">Security Mode and Master Browsers</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="samba-pdc.html#id2890570">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="samba-pdc.html#id2890577">$ Cannot Be Included in Machine Name</a></dt><dt><a href="samba-pdc.html#id2890661">Joining Domain Fails Because of Existing Machine Account</a></dt><dt><a href="samba-pdc.html#id2890722">The System Cannot Log You On (C000019B)</a></dt><dt><a href="samba-pdc.html#id2890822">The Machine Trust Account Is Not Accessible</a></dt><dt><a href="samba-pdc.html#id2890899">Account Disabled</a></dt><dt><a href="samba-pdc.html#id2890932">Domain Controller Unavailable</a></dt><dt><a href="samba-pdc.html#id2890954">Cannot Log onto Domain Member Workstation After Joining Domain</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>6. <a href="samba-bdc.html">Backup Domain Control</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="samba-bdc.html#id2891162">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="samba-bdc.html#id2891552">Essential Background Information</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="samba-bdc.html#id2891580">MS Windows NT4-style Domain Control</a></dt><dt><a href="samba-bdc.html#id2891874">LDAP Configuration Notes</a></dt><dt><a href="samba-bdc.html#id2892094">Active Directory Domain Control</a></dt><dt><a href="samba-bdc.html#id2892115">What Qualifies a Domain Controller on the Network?</a></dt><dt><a href="samba-bdc.html#id2892157">How does a Workstation find its Domain Controller?</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="samba-bdc.html#id2892268">Backup Domain Controller Configuration</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="samba-bdc.html#id2892538">Example Configuration</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="samba-bdc.html#id2892768">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="samba-bdc.html#id2892791">Machine Accounts Keep Expiring</a></dt><dt><a href="samba-bdc.html#id2892845">Can Samba Be a Backup Domain Controller to an NT4 PDC?</a></dt><dt><a href="samba-bdc.html#id2892880">How Do I Replicate the smbpasswd File?</a></dt><dt><a href="samba-bdc.html#id2892948">Can I Do This All with LDAP?</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>7. <a href="domain-member.html">Domain Membership</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="domain-member.html#id2893185">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="domain-member.html#machine-trust-accounts">MS Windows Workstation/Server Machine Trust Accounts</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="domain-member.html#id2893524">Manual Creation of Machine Trust Accounts</a></dt><dt><a href="domain-member.html#id2893846">Managing Domain Machine Accounts using NT4 Server Manager</a></dt><dt><a href="domain-member.html#id2894113">On-the-Fly Creation of Machine Trust Accounts</a></dt><dt><a href="domain-member.html#id2894194">Making an MS Windows Workstation or Server a Domain Member</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="domain-member.html#domain-member-server">Domain Member Server</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="domain-member.html#id2894418">Joining an NT4-type Domain with Samba-3</a></dt><dt><a href="domain-member.html#id2894926">Why Is This Better Than security = server?</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="domain-member.html#ads-member">Samba ADS Domain Membership</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="domain-member.html#id2895131">Configure smb.conf</a></dt><dt><a href="domain-member.html#id2895267">Configure /etc/krb5.conf</a></dt><dt><a href="domain-member.html#ads-create-machine-account">Create the Computer Account</a></dt><dt><a href="domain-member.html#ads-test-server">Testing Server Setup</a></dt><dt><a href="domain-member.html#ads-test-smbclient">Testing with smbclient</a></dt><dt><a href="domain-member.html#id2895840">Notes</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="domain-member.html#id2895877">Sharing User ID Mappings between Samba Domain Members</a></dt><dt><a href="domain-member.html#id2896009">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="domain-member.html#id2896038">Cannot Add Machine Back to Domain</a></dt><dt><a href="domain-member.html#id2896072">Adding Machine to Domain Fails</a></dt><dt><a href="domain-member.html#id2896237">I Can't Join a Windows 2003 PDC</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>8. <a href="StandAloneServer.html">Stand-alone Servers</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="StandAloneServer.html#id2896324">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="StandAloneServer.html#id2896363">Background</a></dt><dt><a href="StandAloneServer.html#id2896435">Example Configuration</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="StandAloneServer.html#RefDocServer">Reference Documentation Server</a></dt><dt><a href="StandAloneServer.html#SimplePrintServer">Central Print Serving</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="StandAloneServer.html#id2897068">Common Errors</a></dt></dl></dd><dt>9. <a href="ClientConfig.html">MS Windows Network Configuration Guide</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="ClientConfig.html#id2897131">Note</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></div></div></div><div class="navfooter"><hr><table width="100%" summary="Navigation footer"><tr><td width="40%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="FastStart.html">Prev</a> </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="u" href="index.html">Up</a></td><td width="40%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="ServerType.html">Next</a></td></tr><tr><td width="40%" align="left" valign="top">Chapter 3. Fast Start for the Impatient </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="h" href="index.html">Home</a></td><td width="40%" align="right" valign="top"> Chapter 4. Server Types and Security Modes</td></tr></table></div></body></html> diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/unicode.html b/docs/htmldocs/unicode.html new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..01cc974f5c --- /dev/null +++ b/docs/htmldocs/unicode.html @@ -0,0 +1,69 @@ +<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>Chapter 27. Unicode/Charsets</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.60.1"><link rel="home" href="index.html" title="SAMBA Project Documentation"><link rel="up" href="optional.html" title="Part III. Advanced Configuration"><link rel="previous" href="integrate-ms-networks.html" title="Chapter 26. Integrating MS Windows Networks with Samba"><link rel="next" href="Backup.html" title="Chapter 28. Samba Backup Techniques"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="navheader"><table width="100%" summary="Navigation header"><tr><th colspan="3" align="center">Chapter 27. Unicode/Charsets</th></tr><tr><td width="20%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="integrate-ms-networks.html">Prev</a> </td><th width="60%" align="center">Part III. Advanced Configuration</th><td width="20%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="Backup.html">Next</a></td></tr></table><hr></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="unicode"></a>Chapter 27. Unicode/Charsets</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Jelmer</span> <span class="othername">R.</span> <span class="surname">Vernooij</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">The Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jelmer@samba.org">jelmer@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">John</span> <span class="othername">H.</span> <span class="surname">Terpstra</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org">jht@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">TAKAHASHI</span> <span class="surname">Motonobu</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:monyo@home.monyo.com">monyo@home.monyo.com</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><p class="pubdate">25 March 2003</p></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="unicode.html#id2963374">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="unicode.html#id2963419">What Are Charsets and Unicode?</a></dt><dt><a href="unicode.html#id2963499">Samba and Charsets</a></dt><dt><a href="unicode.html#id2963627">Conversion from Old Names</a></dt><dt><a href="unicode.html#id2963643">Japanese Charsets</a></dt><dt><a href="unicode.html#id2963781">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="unicode.html#id2963788">CP850.so Can't Be Found</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2963374"></a>Features and Benefits</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +Every industry eventually matures. One of the great areas of maturation is in +the focus that has been given over the past decade to make it possible for anyone +anywhere to use a computer. It has not always been that way, in fact, not so long +ago it was common for software to be written for exclusive use in the country of +origin. +</p><p> +Of all the effort that has been brought to bear on providing native language support +for all computer users, the efforts of the <ulink url="http://www.openi18n.org/">Openi18n organization</ulink> is deserving of +special mention. +</p><p> +Samba-2.x supported a single locale through a mechanism called +<span class="emphasis"><em>codepages</em></span>. Samba-3 is destined to become a truly trans-global +file and printer-sharing platform. +</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2963419"></a>What Are Charsets and Unicode?</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +Computers communicate in numbers. In texts, each number will be +translated to a corresponding letter. The meaning that will be assigned +to a certain number depends on the <span class="emphasis"><em>character set (charset) +</em></span> that is used. +</p><p> +A charset can be seen as a table that is used to translate numbers to +letters. Not all computers use the same charset (there are charsets +with German umlauts, Japanese characters, and so on). Usually a charset contains +256 characters, which means that storing a character with it takes +exactly one byte. </p><p> +There are also charsets that support even more characters, +but those need twice as much storage space (or more). These +charsets can contain <b class="command">256 * 256 = 65536</b> characters, which +is more than all possible characters one could think of. They are called +multibyte charsets because they use more then one byte to +store one character. +</p><p> +A standardized multibyte charset is <ulink url="http://www.unicode.org/">unicode</ulink>. +A big advantage of using a multibyte charset is that you only need one; there +is no need to make sure two computers use the same charset when they are +communicating. +</p><p>Old Windows clients use single-byte charsets, named +<i class="parameter"><tt>codepages</tt></i>, by Microsoft. However, there is no support for +negotiating the charset to be used in the SMB/CIFS protocol. Thus, you +have to make sure you are using the same charset when talking to an older client. +Newer clients (Windows NT, 200x, XP) talk unicode over the wire. +</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2963499"></a>Samba and Charsets</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +As of Samba-3.0, Samba can (and will) talk unicode over the wire. Internally, +Samba knows of three kinds of character sets: +</p><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term"><a class="indexterm" name="id2963521"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>unix charset</tt></i></span></dt><dd><p> + This is the charset used internally by your operating system. + The default is <tt class="constant">UTF-8</tt>, which is fine for most + systems, which covers all characters in all languages. The default in previous Samba releases was <tt class="constant">ASCII</tt>. + </p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a class="indexterm" name="id2963558"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>display charset</tt></i></span></dt><dd><p>This is the charset Samba will use to print messages + on your screen. It should generally be the same as the <i class="parameter"><tt>unix charset</tt></i>. + </p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a class="indexterm" name="id2963592"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>dos charset</tt></i></span></dt><dd><p>This is the charset Samba uses when communicating with + DOS and Windows 9x/Me clients. It will talk unicode to all newer clients. + The default depends on the charsets you have installed on your system. + Run <b class="command">testparm -v | grep "dos charset"</b> to see + what the default is on your system. + </p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2963627"></a>Conversion from Old Names</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p>Because previous Samba versions did not do any charset conversion, +characters in filenames are usually not correct in the UNIX charset but only +for the local charset used by the DOS/Windows clients.</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2963643"></a>Japanese Charsets</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p>Samba does not work correctly with Japanese charsets yet. Here are +points of attention when setting it up:</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>You should set <a class="indexterm" name="id2963664"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>mangling method</tt></i> = hash</p></li><li><p>There are various iconv() implementations around and not + all of them work equally well. glibc2's iconv() has a critical problem + in CP932. libiconv-1.8 works with CP932 but still has some problems and + does not work with EUC-JP.</p></li><li><p>You should set <a class="indexterm" name="id2963693"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>dos charset</tt></i> = CP932, not + Shift_JIS, SJIS.</p></li><li><p>Currently only <a class="indexterm" name="id2963713"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>UNIX charset</tt></i> = CP932 + will work (but still has some problems...) because of iconv() issues. + <a class="indexterm" name="id2963729"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>UNIX charset</tt></i> = EUC-JP does not work well because of + iconv() issues.</p></li><li><p>Currently Samba-3.0 does not support <a class="indexterm" name="id2963749"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>UNIX charset</tt></i> = UTF8-MAC/CAP/HEX/JIS*.</p></li></ul></div><p>More information (in Japanese) is available at: <ulink url="http://www.atmarkit.co.jp/flinux/special/samba3/samba3a.html">http://www.atmarkit.co.jp/flinux/special/samba3/samba3a.html</ulink>.</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2963781"></a>Common Errors</h2></div></div><div></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2963788"></a>CP850.so Can't Be Found</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>“<span class="quote">Samba is complaining about a missing <tt class="filename">CP850.so</tt> file.</span>”</p><p><span class="emphasis"><em>Answer:</em></span> CP850 is the default <a class="indexterm" name="id2963814"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>dos charset</tt></i>. + The <a class="indexterm" name="id2963828"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>dos charset</tt></i> is used to convert data to the codepage used by your dos clients. + If you do not have any dos clients, you can safely ignore this message. </p><p>CP850 should be supported by your local iconv implementation. Make sure you have all the required packages installed. + If you compiled Samba from source, make sure to configure found iconv.</p></div></div></div><div class="navfooter"><hr><table width="100%" summary="Navigation footer"><tr><td width="40%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="integrate-ms-networks.html">Prev</a> </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="u" href="optional.html">Up</a></td><td width="40%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="Backup.html">Next</a></td></tr><tr><td width="40%" align="left" valign="top">Chapter 26. Integrating MS Windows Networks with Samba </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="h" href="index.html">Home</a></td><td width="40%" align="right" valign="top"> Chapter 28. Samba Backup Techniques</td></tr></table></div></body></html> diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/upgrading-to-3.0.html b/docs/htmldocs/upgrading-to-3.0.html new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..5106814203 --- /dev/null +++ b/docs/htmldocs/upgrading-to-3.0.html @@ -0,0 +1,200 @@ +<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>Chapter 30. Upgrading from Samba-2.x to Samba-3.0.0</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.60.1"><link rel="home" href="index.html" title="SAMBA Project Documentation"><link rel="up" href="migration.html" title="Part IV. Migration and Updating"><link rel="previous" href="migration.html" title="Part IV. Migration and Updating"><link rel="next" href="NT4Migration.html" title="Chapter 31. Migration from NT4 PDC to Samba-3 PDC"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="navheader"><table width="100%" summary="Navigation header"><tr><th colspan="3" align="center">Chapter 30. Upgrading from Samba-2.x to Samba-3.0.0</th></tr><tr><td width="20%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="migration.html">Prev</a> </td><th width="60%" align="center">Part IV. Migration and Updating</th><td width="20%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="NT4Migration.html">Next</a></td></tr></table><hr></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="upgrading-to-3.0"></a>Chapter 30. Upgrading from Samba-2.x to Samba-3.0.0</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Jelmer</span> <span class="othername">R.</span> <span class="surname">Vernooij</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">The Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jelmer@samba.org">jelmer@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">John</span> <span class="othername">H.</span> <span class="surname">Terpstra</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org">jht@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Gerald</span> <span class="othername">(Jerry)</span> <span class="surname">Carter</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jerry@samba.org">jerry@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><p class="pubdate">June 30, 2003</p></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="upgrading-to-3.0.html#id2964134">Quick Migration Guide</a></dt><dt><a href="upgrading-to-3.0.html#id2964257">New Features in Samba-3</a></dt><dt><a href="upgrading-to-3.0.html#id2964410">Configuration Parameter Changes</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="upgrading-to-3.0.html#id2964433">Removed Parameters</a></dt><dt><a href="upgrading-to-3.0.html#id2964564">New Parameters</a></dt><dt><a href="upgrading-to-3.0.html#id2964983">Modified Parameters (Changes in Behavior):</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="upgrading-to-3.0.html#id2965064">New Functionality</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="upgrading-to-3.0.html#id2965071">Databases</a></dt><dt><a href="upgrading-to-3.0.html#id2965324">Changes in Behavior</a></dt><dt><a href="upgrading-to-3.0.html#id2965395">Charsets</a></dt><dt><a href="upgrading-to-3.0.html#id2965417">Passdb Backends and Authentication</a></dt><dt><a href="upgrading-to-3.0.html#id2965577">LDAP</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></div><p> +This chapter deals exclusively with the differences between Samba-3.0.0 and Samba-2.2.8a. +It points out where configuration parameters have changed, and provides a simple guide for +the move from 2.2.x to 3.0.0. +</p><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2964134"></a>Quick Migration Guide</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +Samba-3.0.0 default behavior should be approximately the same as Samba-2.2.x. +The default behavior when the new parameter <a class="indexterm" name="id2964147"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>passdb backend</tt></i> +is not defined in the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file provides the same default behviour as Samba-2.2.x +with <a class="indexterm" name="id2964171"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>encrypt passwords</tt></i> = Yes, and +will use the <tt class="filename">smbpasswd</tt> database. +</p><p> +So why say that <span class="emphasis"><em>behavior should be approximately the same as Samba-2.2.x?</em></span> Because +Samba-3.0.0 can negotiate new protocols, such as support for native Unicode, that may result in +differing protocol code paths being taken. The new behavior under such circumstances is not +exactly the same as the old one. The good news is that the domain and machine SIDs will be +preserved across the upgrade. +</p><p> +If the Samba-2.2.x system was using an LDAP backend, and there is no time to update the LDAP +database, then make sure that <a class="indexterm" name="id2964213"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>passdb backend</tt></i> = ldapsam_compat +is specified in the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file. For the rest, behavior should remain more or less the same. +At a later date, when there is time to implement a new Samba-3 compatible LDAP backend, it is possible +to migrate the old LDAP database to the new one through use of the <b class="command">pdbedit</b>. +See <link linkend="pdbeditthing">. +</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2964257"></a>New Features in Samba-3</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +The major new features are: +</p><div class="orderedlist"><ol type="1"><li><p> + Active Directory support. This release is able to join an ADS realm + as a member server and authenticate users using LDAP/kerberos. + </p></li><li><p> + Unicode support. Samba will now negotiate unicode on the wire and + internally there is a much better infrastructure for multi-byte + and unicode character sets. + </p></li><li><p> + New authentication system. The internal authentication system has + been almost completely rewritten. Most of the changes are internal, + but the new authoring system is also very configurable. + </p></li><li><p> + New filename mangling system. The filename mangling system has been + completely rewritten. An internal database now stores mangling maps + persistently. + </p></li><li><p> + New “<span class="quote">net</span>” command. A new “<span class="quote">net</span>” command has been added. It is + somewhat similar to the “<span class="quote">net</span>” command in Windows. Eventually, we + plan to replace a bunch of other utilities (such as smbpasswd) + with subcommands in “<span class="quote">net</span>”. + </p></li><li><p> + Samba now negotiates NT-style status32 codes on the wire. This + considerably improves error handling. + </p></li><li><p> + Better Windows 200x/XP printing support including publishing + printer attributes in Active Directory. + </p></li><li><p> + New loadable RPC modules for passdb backends and character sets. + </p></li><li><p> + New default dual-daemon winbindd support for better performance. + </p></li><li><p> + Support for migrating from a Windows NT 4.0 domain to a Samba + domain and maintaining user, group and domain SIDs. + </p></li><li><p> + Support for establishing trust relationships with Windows NT 4.0 + Domain Controllers. + </p></li><li><p> + Initial support for a distributed Winbind architecture using + an LDAP directory for storing SID to UID/GID mappings. + </p></li><li><p> + Major updates to the Samba documentation tree. + </p></li><li><p> + Full support for client and server SMB signing to ensure + compatibility with default Windows 2003 security settings. + </p></li></ol></div><p> +Plus lots of other improvements! +</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2964410"></a>Configuration Parameter Changes</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +This section contains a brief listing of changes to <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> options +in the 3.0.0 release. Please refer to the smb.conf(5) man page for +complete descriptions of new or modified parameters. +</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2964433"></a>Removed Parameters</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>(Ordered Alphabetically):</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>admin log </p></li><li><p>alternate permissions </p></li><li><p>character set </p></li><li><p>client codepage </p></li><li><p>code page directory </p></li><li><p>coding system </p></li><li><p>domain admin group </p></li><li><p>domain guest group </p></li><li><p>force unknown acl user </p></li><li><p>nt smb support </p></li><li><p>post script </p></li><li><p>printer driver </p></li><li><p>printer driver file </p></li><li><p>printer driver location </p></li><li><p>status </p></li><li><p>stip dot </p></li><li><p>total print jobs </p></li><li><p>use rhosts </p></li><li><p>valid chars </p></li><li><p>vfs options </p></li></ul></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2964564"></a>New Parameters</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>(New parameters have been grouped by function):</p><p>Remote Management</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>abort shutdown script </p></li><li><p>shutdown script </p></li></ul></div><p>User and Group Account Management:</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>add group script </p></li><li><p>add machine script </p></li><li><p>add user to group script </p></li><li><p>algorithmic rid base </p></li><li><p>delete group script </p></li><li><p>delete user from group script </p></li><li><p>passdb backend </p></li><li><p>set primary group script </p></li></ul></div><p>Authentication:</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>auth methods </p></li><li><p>realm </p></li></ul></div><p>Protocol Options:</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>client lanman auth </p></li><li><p>client NTLMv2 auth </p></li><li><p>client schannel </p></li><li><p>client signing </p></li><li><p>client use spnego </p></li><li><p>disable netbios </p></li><li><p>ntlm auth </p></li><li><p>paranoid server security </p></li><li><p>server schannel </p></li><li><p>server signing </p></li><li><p>smb ports </p></li><li><p>use spnego </p></li></ul></div><p>File Service:</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>get quota command </p></li><li><p>hide special files </p></li><li><p>hide unwriteable files </p></li><li><p>hostname lookups </p></li><li><p>kernel change notify </p></li><li><p>mangle prefix </p></li><li><p>map acl inherit </p></li><li><p>msdfs proxy </p></li><li><p>set quota command </p></li><li><p>use sendfile </p></li><li><p>vfs objects </p></li></ul></div><p>Printing:</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>max reported print jobs </p></li></ul></div><p>Unicode and Character Sets:</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>display charset </p></li><li><p>dos charset </p></li><li><p>unicode </p></li><li><p>UNIX charset </p></li></ul></div><p>SID to UID/GID Mappings:</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>idmap backend </p></li><li><p>idmap gid </p></li><li><p>idmap uid </p></li><li><p>winbind enable local accounts </p></li><li><p>winbind trusted domains only </p></li><li><p>template primary group </p></li><li><p>enable rid algorithm </p></li></ul></div><p>LDAP:</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>ldap delete dn </p></li><li><p>ldap group suffix </p></li><li><p>ldap idmap suffix </p></li><li><p>ldap machine suffix </p></li><li><p>ldap passwd sync </p></li><li><p>ldap trust ids </p></li><li><p>ldap user suffix </p></li></ul></div><p>General Configuration:</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>preload modules </p></li><li><p>privatedir </p></li></ul></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2964983"></a>Modified Parameters (Changes in Behavior):</h3></div></div><div></div></div><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>encrypt passwords (enabled by default) </p></li><li><p>mangling method (set to hash2 by default) </p></li><li><p>passwd chat </p></li><li><p>passwd program </p></li><li><p>password server </p></li><li><p>restrict anonymous (integer value) </p></li><li><p>security (new ads value) </p></li><li><p>strict locking (enabled by default) </p></li><li><p>winbind cache time (increased to 5 minutes) </p></li><li><p>winbind uid (deprecated in favor of idmap uid) </p></li><li><p>winbind gid (deprecated in favor of idmap gid) </p></li></ul></div></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2965064"></a>New Functionality</h2></div></div><div></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2965071"></a>Databases</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + This section contains brief descriptions of any new databases + introduced in Samba-3. Please remember to backup your existing + ${lock directory}/*tdb before upgrading to Samba-3. Samba will + upgrade databases as they are opened (if necessary), but downgrading + from 3.0 to 2.2 is an unsupported path. + </p><p> + The new tdb files are described in <link linkend="tdbfiledesc">. + </p><div class="table"><a name="tdbfiledesc"></a><p class="title"><b>Table 30.1. TDB File Descriptions</b></p><table summary="TDB File Descriptions" border="1"><colgroup><col align="left"><col align="justify"><col align="left"></colgroup><thead><tr><th align="left">Name</th><th align="justify">Description</th><th align="center">Backup?</th></tr></thead><tbody><tr><td align="left">account_policy</td><td align="justify">User policy settings</td><td align="left">yes</td></tr><tr><td align="left">gencache</td><td align="justify">Generic caching db</td><td align="left">no</td></tr><tr><td align="left">group_mapping</td><td align="justify"><p>Mapping table from Windows groups/SID to UNIX groups</p></td><td align="left">yes</td></tr><tr><td align="left">idmap</td><td align="justify"><p>new ID map table from SIDS to UNIX UIDs/GIDs</p></td><td align="left">yes</td></tr><tr><td align="left">namecache</td><td align="justify">Name resolution cache entries</td><td align="left">no</td></tr><tr><td align="left">netlogon_unigrp</td><td align="justify"><p>Cache of universal group membership obtained when operating + as a member of a Windows domain</p></td><td align="left">no</td></tr><tr><td align="left">printing/*.tdb</td><td align="justify"><p>Cached output from `lpq command' created on a per print + service basis</p></td><td align="left">no</td></tr><tr><td align="left">registry</td><td align="justify"><p>Read-only Samba registry skeleton that provides support for + exporting various db tables via the winreg RPCs</p></td><td align="left">no</td></tr></tbody></table></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2965324"></a>Changes in Behavior</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + The following issues are known changes in behavior between Samba-2.2 and + Samba-3 that may affect certain installations of Samba. + </p><div class="orderedlist"><ol type="1"><li><p> + When operating as a member of a Windows domain, Samba-2.2 would + map any users authenticated by the remote DC to the “<span class="quote">guest account</span>” + if a uid could not be obtained via the getpwnam() call. Samba-3 + rejects the connection as NT_STATUS_LOGON_FAILURE. There is no + current work around to re-establish the Samba-2.2 behavior. + </p></li><li><p> + When adding machines to a Samba-2.2 controlled domain, the + “<span class="quote">add user script</span>” was used to create the UNIX identity of the + Machine Trust Account. Samba-3 introduces a new “<span class="quote">add machine + script</span>” that must be specified for this purpose. Samba-3 will + not fall back to using the “<span class="quote">add user script</span>” in the absence of + an “<span class="quote">add machine script</span>”. + </p></li></ol></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2965395"></a>Charsets</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + You might experience problems with special characters when communicating with old DOS + clients. Codepage support has changed in Samba-3. Read <link linkend="unicode">, for details. + </p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2965417"></a>Passdb Backends and Authentication</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + There have been a few new changes that Samba administrators should be + aware of when moving to Samba-3. + </p><div class="orderedlist"><ol type="1"><li><p> + Encrypted passwords have been enabled by default in order to + interoperate better with out-of-the-box Windows client + installations. This does mean that either (a) a Samba account + must be created for each user, or (b) “<span class="quote">encrypt passwords = no</span>” + must be explicitly defined in <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt>. + </p></li><li><p> + Inclusion of new <a class="indexterm" name="id2965466"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>security</tt></i> = ads option for integration + with an Active Directory domain using the native Windows Kerberos 5 and LDAP protocols. + </p></li></ol></div><p> + Samba-3 also includes the possibility of setting up chains + of authentication methods + (<a class="indexterm" name="id2965488"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>auth methods</tt></i>) and account + storage backends + (<a class="indexterm" name="id2965503"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>passdb backend</tt></i>). + Please refer to the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> + man page and <link linkend="passdb">, for details. While both parameters assume sane default + values, it is likely that you will need to understand what the + values actually mean in order to ensure Samba operates correctly. + </p><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2965538"></a> + Certain functions of the <b class="command">smbpasswd</b> tool have been split between the + new <b class="command">smbpasswd</b> utility, the <b class="command">net</b> tool and the new <b class="command">pdbedit</b> + utility. See the respective man pages for details. + </p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2965577"></a>LDAP</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + This section outlines the new features effecting Samba/LDAP integration. + </p><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2965590"></a>New Schema</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> + A new object class (sambaSamAccount) has been introduced to replace + the old sambaAccount. This change aids us in the renaming of attributes + to prevent clashes with attributes from other vendors. There is a + conversion script (examples/LDAP/convertSambaAccount) to modify an LDIF + file to the new schema. + </p><p> + Example: + </p><pre class="screen"> + <tt class="prompt">$ </tt>ldapsearch .... -b "ou=people,dc=..." > old.ldif + <tt class="prompt">$ </tt>convertSambaAccount <DOM SID> old.ldif new.ldif + </pre><p> + The <DOM SID> can be obtained by running +</p><pre class="screen"> +<tt class="prompt">$ </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>net getlocalsid <DOMAINNAME></tt></b> +</pre><p> + on the Samba PDC as root. + </p><p> + The old sambaAccount schema may still be used by specifying the + <i class="parameter"><tt>ldapsam_compat</tt></i> passdb backend. However, the sambaAccount and + associated attributes have been moved to the historical section of + the schema file and must be uncommented before use if needed. + The Samba-2.2 object class declaration for a sambaAccount has not changed + in the Samba-3 samba.schema file. + </p><p> + Other new object classes and their uses include: + </p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p> + sambaDomain domain information used to allocate RIDs + for users and groups as necessary. The attributes are added + in “<span class="quote">ldap suffix</span>” directory entry automatically if + an idmap UID/GID range has been set and the “<span class="quote">ldapsam</span>” + passdb backend has been selected. + </p></li><li><p> + sambaGroupMapping an object representing the + relationship between a posixGroup and a Windows + group/SID. These entries are stored in the “<span class="quote">ldap + group suffix</span>” and managed by the “<span class="quote">net groupmap</span>” command. + </p></li><li><p> + sambaUNIXIdPool created in the “<span class="quote">ldap idmap suffix</span>” entry + automatically and contains the next available “<span class="quote">idmap UID</span>” and + “<span class="quote">idmap GID</span>”. + </p></li><li><p> + sambaIdmapEntry object storing a mapping between a + SID and a UNIX UID/GID. These objects are created by the + idmap_ldap module as needed. + </p></li></ul></div></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2965767"></a>New Suffix for Searching</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> + The following new smb.conf parameters have been added to aid in directing + certain LDAP queries when <i class="parameter"><tt>passdb backend = ldapsam://...</tt></i> has been + specified. + </p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>ldap suffix used to search for user and computer accounts.</p></li><li><p>ldap user suffix used to store user accounts.</p></li><li><p>ldap machine suffix used to store Machine Trust Accounts.</p></li><li><p>ldap group suffix location of posixGroup/sambaGroupMapping entries.</p></li><li><p>ldap idmap suffix location of sambaIdmapEntry objects.</p></li></ul></div><p> + If an <i class="parameter"><tt>ldap suffix</tt></i> is defined, it will be appended to all of the + remaining sub-suffix parameters. In this case, the order of the suffix + listings in smb.conf is important. Always place the <i class="parameter"><tt>ldap suffix</tt></i> first + in the list. + </p><p> + Due to a limitation in Samba's <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> parsing, you should not surround + the DNs with quotation marks. + </p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2965876"></a>IdMap LDAP Support</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> + Samba-3 supports an ldap backend for the idmap subsystem. The + following options inform Samba that the idmap table should be + stored on the directory server onterose in the "ou=idmap,dc=quenya,dc=org" partition. + </p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td> </td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>[global]</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td>...</td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>idmap backend = ldap:ldap://onterose/</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>ldap idmap suffix = ou=idmap,dc=quenya,dc=org</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>idmap uid = 40000-50000</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>idmap gid = 40000-50000</tt></i></td></tr></table><p> + This configuration allows Winbind installations on multiple servers to + share a UID/GID number space, thus avoiding the interoperability problems + with NFS that were present in Samba-2.2. + </p></div></div></div></div><div class="navfooter"><hr><table width="100%" summary="Navigation footer"><tr><td width="40%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="migration.html">Prev</a> </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="u" href="migration.html">Up</a></td><td width="40%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="NT4Migration.html">Next</a></td></tr><tr><td width="40%" align="left" valign="top">Part IV. Migration and Updating </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="h" href="index.html">Home</a></td><td width="40%" align="right" valign="top"> Chapter 31. Migration from NT4 PDC to Samba-3 PDC</td></tr></table></div></body></html> diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/winbind.html b/docs/htmldocs/winbind.html new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..480746898f --- /dev/null +++ b/docs/htmldocs/winbind.html @@ -0,0 +1,741 @@ +<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>Chapter 21. Winbind: Use of Domain Accounts</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.60.1"><link rel="home" href="index.html" title="SAMBA Project Documentation"><link rel="up" href="optional.html" title="Part III. Advanced Configuration"><link rel="previous" href="VFS.html" title="Chapter 20. Stackable VFS modules"><link rel="next" href="AdvancedNetworkManagement.html" title="Chapter 22. Advanced Network Management"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="navheader"><table width="100%" summary="Navigation header"><tr><th colspan="3" align="center">Chapter 21. Winbind: Use of Domain Accounts</th></tr><tr><td width="20%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="VFS.html">Prev</a> </td><th width="60%" align="center">Part III. Advanced Configuration</th><td width="20%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="AdvancedNetworkManagement.html">Next</a></td></tr></table><hr></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="winbind"></a>Chapter 21. Winbind: Use of Domain Accounts</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Tim</span> <span class="surname">Potter</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:tpot@linuxcare.com.au">tpot@linuxcare.com.au</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Andrew</span> <span class="surname">Tridgell</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:tridge@samba.org">tridge@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Naag</span> <span class="surname">Mummaneni</span></h3><span class="contrib">Notes for Solaris</span><div class="affiliation"><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:getnag@rediffmail.com">getnag@rediffmail.com</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">John</span> <span class="surname">Trostel</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jtrostel@snapserver.com">jtrostel@snapserver.com</a>></tt></p></div><span class="orgname">SNAP<br></span></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Jelmer</span> <span class="othername">R.</span> <span class="surname">Vernooij</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">The Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jelmer@samba.org">jelmer@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">John</span> <span class="othername">H.</span> <span class="surname">Terpstra</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org">jht@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><p class="pubdate">27 June 2002</p></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="winbind.html#id2949352">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="winbind.html#id2949476">Introduction</a></dt><dt><a href="winbind.html#id2949558">What Winbind Provides</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="winbind.html#id2949633">Target Uses</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="winbind.html#id2949664">How Winbind Works</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="winbind.html#id2949693">Microsoft Remote Procedure Calls</a></dt><dt><a href="winbind.html#id2949726">Microsoft Active Directory Services</a></dt><dt><a href="winbind.html#id2949752">Name Service Switch</a></dt><dt><a href="winbind.html#id2949887">Pluggable Authentication Modules</a></dt><dt><a href="winbind.html#id2949965">User and Group ID Allocation</a></dt><dt><a href="winbind.html#id2949998">Result Caching</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="winbind.html#id2950035">Installation and Configuration</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="winbind.html#id2950042">Introduction</a></dt><dt><a href="winbind.html#id2950108">Requirements</a></dt><dt><a href="winbind.html#id2950191">Testing Things Out</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="winbind.html#id2951948">Conclusion</a></dt><dt><a href="winbind.html#id2951967">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="winbind.html#id2952021">NSCD Problem Warning</a></dt><dt><a href="winbind.html#id2952067">Winbind Is Not Resolving Users and Groups</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2949352"></a>Features and Benefits</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> + Integration of UNIX and Microsoft Windows NT through a unified logon has + been considered a “<span class="quote">holy grail</span>” in heterogeneous computing environments for + a long time. + </p><p> + There is one other facility without which UNIX and Microsoft Windows network + interoperability would suffer greatly. It is imperative that there be a + mechanism for sharing files across UNIX systems and to be able to assign + domain user and group ownerships with integrity. + </p><p> + <span class="emphasis"><em>winbind</em></span> is a component of the Samba suite of programs that + solves the unified logon problem. Winbind uses a UNIX implementation of Microsoft + RPC calls, Pluggable Authentication Modules, and the Name Service Switch to + allow Windows NT domain users to appear and operate as UNIX users on a UNIX + machine. This chapter describes the Winbind system, explaining the functionality + it provides, how it is configured, and how it works internally. + </p><p> + Winbind provides three separate functions: + </p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p> + Authentication of user credentials (via PAM). + </p></li><li><p> + Identity resolution (via NSS). + </p></li><li><p> + Winbind maintains a database called winbind_idmap.tdb in which it stores + mappings between UNIX UIDs / GIDs and NT SIDs. This mapping is used only + for users and groups that do not have a local UID/GID. It stored the UID/GID + allocated from the idmap uid/gid range that it has mapped to the NT SID. + If <i class="parameter"><tt>idmap backend</tt></i> has been specified as ldapsam:url + then instead of using a local mapping Winbind will obtain this information + from the LDAP database. + </p></li></ul></div><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p> + If <b class="command">winbindd</b> is not running, smbd (which calls <b class="command">winbindd</b>) will fall back to + using purely local information from <tt class="filename">/etc/passwd</tt> and <tt class="filename">/etc/group</tt> and no dynamic + mapping will be used. + </p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2949476"></a>Introduction</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p>It is well known that UNIX and Microsoft Windows NT have + different models for representing user and group information and + use different technologies for implementing them. This fact has + made it difficult to integrate the two systems in a satisfactory + manner.</p><p>One common solution in use today has been to create + identically named user accounts on both the UNIX and Windows systems + and use the Samba suite of programs to provide file and print services + between the two. This solution is far from perfect, however, as + adding and deleting users on both sets of machines becomes a chore + and two sets of passwords are required both of which + can lead to synchronization problems between the UNIX and Windows + systems and confusion for users.</p><p>We divide the unified logon problem for UNIX machines into + three smaller problems:</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Obtaining Windows NT user and group information. + </p></li><li><p>Authenticating Windows NT users. + </p></li><li><p>Password changing for Windows NT users. + </p></li></ul></div><p>Ideally, a prospective solution to the unified logon problem + would satisfy all the above components without duplication of + information on the UNIX machines and without creating additional + tasks for the system administrator when maintaining users and + groups on either system. The Winbind system provides a simple + and elegant solution to all three components of the unified logon + problem.</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2949558"></a>What Winbind Provides</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p>Winbind unifies UNIX and Windows NT account management by + allowing a UNIX box to become a full member of an NT domain. Once + this is done the UNIX box will see NT users and groups as if + they were “<span class="quote">native</span>” UNIX users and groups, allowing the NT domain + to be used in much the same manner that NIS+ is used within + UNIX-only environments.</p><p>The end result is that whenever any + program on the UNIX machine asks the operating system to lookup + a user or group name, the query will be resolved by asking the + NT Domain Controller for the specified domain to do the lookup. + Because Winbind hooks into the operating system at a low level + (via the NSS name resolution modules in the C library), this + redirection to the NT Domain Controller is completely + transparent.</p><p>Users on the UNIX machine can then use NT user and group + names as they would “<span class="quote">native</span>” UNIX names. They can chown files + so they are owned by NT domain users or even login to the + UNIX machine and run a UNIX X-Window session as a domain user.</p><p>The only obvious indication that Winbind is being used is + that user and group names take the form <tt class="constant">DOMAIN\user</tt> and + <tt class="constant">DOMAIN\group</tt>. This is necessary as it allows Winbind to determine + that redirection to a Domain Controller is wanted for a particular + lookup and which trusted domain is being referenced.</p><p>Additionally, Winbind provides an authentication service + that hooks into the Pluggable Authentication Modules (PAM) system + to provide authentication via an NT domain to any PAM-enabled + applications. This capability solves the problem of synchronizing + passwords between systems since all passwords are stored in a single + location (on the Domain Controller).</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2949633"></a>Target Uses</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>Winbind is targeted at organizations that have an + existing NT-based domain infrastructure into which they wish + to put UNIX workstations or servers. Winbind will allow these + organizations to deploy UNIX workstations without having to + maintain a separate account infrastructure. This greatly + simplifies the administrative overhead of deploying UNIX + workstations into an NT-based organization.</p><p>Another interesting way in which we expect Winbind to + be used is as a central part of UNIX-based appliances. Appliances + that provide file and print services to Microsoft-based networks + will be able to use Winbind to provide seamless integration of + the appliance into the domain.</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2949664"></a>How Winbind Works</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p>The Winbind system is designed around a client/server + architecture. A long running <b class="command">winbindd</b> daemon + listens on a UNIX domain socket waiting for requests + to arrive. These requests are generated by the NSS and PAM + clients and is processed sequentially.</p><p>The technologies used to implement Winbind are described + in detail below.</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2949693"></a>Microsoft Remote Procedure Calls</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>Over the last few years, efforts have been underway + by various Samba Team members to decode various aspects of + the Microsoft Remote Procedure Call (MSRPC) system. This + system is used for most network-related operations between + Windows NT machines including remote management, user authentication + and print spooling. Although initially this work was done + to aid the implementation of Primary Domain Controller (PDC) + functionality in Samba, it has also yielded a body of code that + can be used for other purposes.</p><p>Winbind uses various MSRPC calls to enumerate domain users + and groups and to obtain detailed information about individual + users or groups. Other MSRPC calls can be used to authenticate + NT domain users and to change user passwords. By directly querying + a Windows PDC for user and group information, Winbind maps the + NT account information onto UNIX user and group names.</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2949726"></a>Microsoft Active Directory Services</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + Since late 2001, Samba has gained the ability to + interact with Microsoft Windows 2000 using its “<span class="quote">Native + Mode</span>” protocols, rather than the NT4 RPC services. + Using LDAP and Kerberos, a Domain Member running + Winbind can enumerate users and groups in exactly the + same way as a Windows 200x client would, and in so doing + provide a much more efficient and effective Winbind implementation. + </p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2949752"></a>Name Service Switch</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>The Name Service Switch, or NSS, is a feature that is + present in many UNIX operating systems. It allows system + information such as hostnames, mail aliases and user information + to be resolved from different sources. For example, a standalone + UNIX workstation may resolve system information from a series of + flat files stored on the local filesystem. A networked workstation + may first attempt to resolve system information from local files, + and then consult an NIS database for user information or a DNS server + for hostname information.</p><p>The NSS application programming interface allows Winbind + to present itself as a source of system information when + resolving UNIX usernames and groups. Winbind uses this interface, + and information obtained from a Windows NT server using MSRPC + calls to provide a new source of account enumeration. Using standard + UNIX library calls, one can enumerate the users and groups on + a UNIX machine running Winbind and see all users and groups in + a NT domain plus any trusted domain as though they were local + users and groups.</p><p>The primary control file for NSS is + <tt class="filename">/etc/nsswitch.conf</tt>. + When a UNIX application makes a request to do a lookup, + the C library looks in <tt class="filename">/etc/nsswitch.conf</tt> + for a line that matches the service type being requested, for + example the “<span class="quote">passwd</span>” service type is used when user or group names + are looked up. This config line specifies which implementations + of that service should be tried and in what order. If the passwd + config line is:</p><pre class="screen"> + passwd: files example + </pre><p>then the C library will first load a module called + <tt class="filename">/lib/libnss_files.so</tt> followed by + the module <tt class="filename">/lib/libnss_example.so</tt>. The + C library will dynamically load each of these modules in turn + and call resolver functions within the modules to try to resolve + the request. Once the request is resolved, the C library returns the + result to the application.</p><p>This NSS interface provides an easy way for Winbind + to hook into the operating system. All that needs to be done + is to put <tt class="filename">libnss_winbind.so</tt> in <tt class="filename">/lib/</tt> + then add “<span class="quote">winbind</span>” into <tt class="filename">/etc/nsswitch.conf</tt> at + the appropriate place. The C library will then call Winbind to + resolve user and group names.</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2949887"></a>Pluggable Authentication Modules</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>Pluggable Authentication Modules, also known as PAM, + is a system for abstracting authentication and authorization + technologies. With a PAM module it is possible to specify different + authentication methods for different system applications without + having to recompile these applications. PAM is also useful + for implementing a particular policy for authorization. For example, + a system administrator may only allow console logins from users + stored in the local password file but only allow users resolved from + a NIS database to log in over the network.</p><p>Winbind uses the authentication management and password + management PAM interface to integrate Windows NT users into a + UNIX system. This allows Windows NT users to log in to a UNIX + machine and be authenticated against a suitable Primary Domain + Controller. These users can also change their passwords and have + this change take effect directly on the Primary Domain Controller. + </p><p>PAM is configured by providing control files in the directory + <tt class="filename">/etc/pam.d/</tt> for each of the services that + require authentication. When an authentication request is made + by an application, the PAM code in the C library looks up this + control file to determine what modules to load to do the + authentication check and in what order. This interface makes adding + a new authentication service for Winbind very easy. All that needs + to be done is that the <tt class="filename">pam_winbind.so</tt> module + is copied to <tt class="filename">/lib/security/</tt> and the PAM + control files for relevant services are updated to allow + authentication via Winbind. See the PAM documentation + in <link linkend="pam"> for more information.</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2949965"></a>User and Group ID Allocation</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>When a user or group is created under Windows NT/200x + it is allocated a numerical relative identifier (RID). This is + slightly different from UNIX which has a range of numbers that are + used to identify users, and the same range in which to identify + groups. It is Winbind's job to convert RIDs to UNIX ID numbers and + vice versa. When Winbind is configured, it is given part of the UNIX + user ID space and a part of the UNIX group ID space in which to + store Windows NT users and groups. If a Windows NT user is + resolved for the first time, it is allocated the next UNIX ID from + the range. The same process applies for Windows NT groups. Over + time, Winbind will have mapped all Windows NT users and groups + to UNIX user IDs and group IDs.</p><p>The results of this mapping are stored persistently in + an ID mapping database held in a tdb database). This ensures that + RIDs are mapped to UNIX IDs in a consistent way.</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2949998"></a>Result Caching</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2950010"></a> + An active system can generate a lot of user and group + name lookups. To reduce the network cost of these lookups, Winbind + uses a caching scheme based on the SAM sequence number supplied + by NT Domain Controllers. User or group information returned + by a PDC is cached by Winbind along with a sequence number also + returned by the PDC. This sequence number is incremented by + Windows NT whenever any user or group information is modified. If + a cached entry has expired, the sequence number is requested from + the PDC and compared against the sequence number of the cached entry. + If the sequence numbers do not match, then the cached information + is discarded and up-to-date information is requested directly + from the PDC.</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2950035"></a>Installation and Configuration</h2></div></div><div></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2950042"></a>Introduction</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +This section describes the procedures used to get Winbind up and +running. Winbind is capable of providing access +and authentication control for Windows Domain users through an NT +or Windows 200x PDC for regular services, such as telnet and ftp, as +well for Samba services. +</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p> + <span class="emphasis"><em>Why should I do this?</em></span> + </p><p>This allows the Samba administrator to rely on the + authentication mechanisms on the Windows NT/200x PDC for the authentication + of Domain Members. Windows NT/200x users no longer need to have separate + accounts on the Samba server. + </p></li><li><p> + <span class="emphasis"><em>Who should be reading this document?</em></span> + </p><p> + This document is designed for system administrators. If you are + implementing Samba on a file server and wish to (fairly easily) + integrate existing Windows NT/200x users from your PDC onto the + Samba server, this document is for you. + </p></li></ul></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2950108"></a>Requirements</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +If you have a Samba configuration file that you are currently using, <span class="emphasis"><em>BACK IT UP!</em></span> +If your system already uses PAM, <span class="emphasis"><em>back up the <tt class="filename">/etc/pam.d</tt> directory +contents!</em></span> If you haven't already made a boot disk, <span class="emphasis"><em>MAKE ONE NOW!</em></span> +</p><p> +Messing with the PAM configuration files can make it nearly impossible to log in to your machine. That's +why you want to be able to boot back into your machine in single user mode and restore your +<tt class="filename">/etc/pam.d</tt> back to the original state they were in if you get frustrated with the +way things are going. +</p><p> +The latest version of Samba-3 includes a functioning winbindd daemon. Please refer to the <ulink url="http://samba.org/">main Samba Web page</ulink> or, better yet, your closest Samba mirror site for +instructions on downloading the source code. +</p><p> +To allow domain users the ability to access Samba shares and files, as well as potentially other services +provided by your Samba machine, PAM must be set up properly on your +machine. In order to compile the Winbind modules, you should have at least the PAM development libraries installed +on your system. Please refer the PAM web site <ulink url="http://www.kernel.org/pub/linux/libs/pam/">http://www.kernel.org/pub/linux/libs/pam/</ulink>. +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2950191"></a>Testing Things Out</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +Before starting, it is probably best to kill off all the Samba-related daemons running on your server. +Kill off all <span class="application">smbd</span>, <span class="application">nmbd</span>, and <span class="application">winbindd</span> processes that may be running. To use PAM, +make sure that you have the standard PAM package that supplies the <tt class="filename">/etc/pam.d</tt> +directory structure, including the PAM modules that are used by PAM-aware services, several pam libraries, +and the <tt class="filename">/usr/doc</tt> and <tt class="filename">/usr/man</tt> entries for pam. Winbind built +better in Samba if the pam-devel package is also installed. This package includes the header files +needed to compile PAM-aware applications. +</p><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2950252"></a>Configure <tt class="filename">nsswitch.conf</tt> and the Winbind Libraries on Linux and Solaris</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> +PAM is a standard component of most current generation UNIX/Linux systems. Unfortunately, few systems install +the <tt class="filename">pam-devel</tt> libraries that are needed to build PAM-enabled Samba. Additionally, Samba-3 +may auto-install the Winbind files into their correct locations on your system, so before you get too far down +the track be sure to check if the following configuration is really +necessary. You may only need to configure +<tt class="filename">/etc/nsswitch.conf</tt>. +</p><p> +The libraries needed to run the <span class="application">winbindd</span> daemon through nsswitch need to be copied to their proper locations: +</p><p> +</p><pre class="screen"> +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>cp ../samba/source/nsswitch/libnss_winbind.so /lib</tt></b> +</pre><p> +</p><p> +I also found it necessary to make the following symbolic link: +</p><p> +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt> <b class="userinput"><tt>ln -s /lib/libnss_winbind.so /lib/libnss_winbind.so.2</tt></b> +</p><p>And, in the case of Sun Solaris:</p><pre class="screen"> +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>ln -s /usr/lib/libnss_winbind.so /usr/lib/libnss_winbind.so.1</tt></b> +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>ln -s /usr/lib/libnss_winbind.so /usr/lib/nss_winbind.so.1</tt></b> +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>ln -s /usr/lib/libnss_winbind.so /usr/lib/nss_winbind.so.2</tt></b> +</pre><p> +Now, as root you need to edit <tt class="filename">/etc/nsswitch.conf</tt> to +allow user and group entries to be visible from the <span class="application">winbindd</span> +daemon. My <tt class="filename">/etc/nsswitch.conf</tt> file look like +this after editing: +</p><pre class="programlisting"> + passwd: files winbind + shadow: files + group: files winbind +</pre><p> +The libraries needed by the <b class="command">winbindd</b> daemon will be automatically +entered into the <b class="command">ldconfig</b> cache the next time +your system reboots, but it is faster (and you do not need to reboot) if you do it manually: +</p><p> +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>/sbin/ldconfig -v | grep winbind</tt></b> +</p><p> +This makes <tt class="filename">libnss_winbind</tt> available to winbindd +and echos back a check to you. +</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2950492"></a>NSS Winbind on AIX</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p>(This section is only for those running AIX.)</p><p> +The Winbind AIX identification module gets built as <tt class="filename">libnss_winbind.so</tt> in the +nsswitch directory of the Samba source. This file can be copied to <tt class="filename">/usr/lib/security</tt>, +and the AIX naming convention would indicate that it should be named WINBIND. A stanza like the following: +</p><pre class="programlisting"> +WINBIND: + program = /usr/lib/security/WINBIND + options = authonly +</pre><p> +can then be added to <tt class="filename">/usr/lib/security/methods.cfg</tt>. This module only supports +identification, but there have been success reports using the standard Winbind PAM module for +authentication. Use caution configuring loadable authentication +modules since you can make +it impossible to logon to the system. More information about the AIX authentication module API can +be found at “<span class="quote">Kernel Extensions and Device Support Programming Concepts for AIX</span>”<ulink url="http://publibn.boulder.ibm.com/doc_link/en_US/a_doc_lib/aixprggd/kernextc/sec_load_mod.htm"> +in Chapter 18(John, there is no section like this in 18). Loadable Authentication Module Programming +Interface</ulink> and more information on administering the modules +can be found at <ulink url="http://publibn.boulder.ibm.com/doc_link/en_US/a_doc_lib/aixbman/baseadmn/iandaadmin.htm"> System +Management Guide: Operating System and Devices.</ulink> +</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2950584"></a>Configure smb.conf</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> +Several parameters are needed in the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file to control the behavior of <span class="application">winbindd</span>. These +are described in more detail in the <a href="winbindd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">winbindd</span>(8)</span></a> man page. My <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file, as shown in <link linkend="winbindcfg">, was modified to include the necessary entries in the [global] section. +</p><div class="example"><a name="winbindcfg"></a><p class="title"><b>Example 21.1. smb.conf for Winbind set-up</b></p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td> </td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>[global]</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td># separate domain and username with '+', like DOMAIN+username</td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>winbind separator = +</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td># use uids from 10000 to 20000 for domain users</td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>idmap uid = 10000-20000</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td># use gids from 10000 to 20000 for domain groups</td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>winbind gid = 10000-20000</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td># allow enumeration of winbind users and groups</td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>winbind enum users = yes</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>winbind enum groups = yes</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td># give winbind users a real shell (only needed if they have telnet access)</td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>template homedir = /home/winnt/%D/%U</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>template shell = /bin/bash</tt></i></td></tr></table></div></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2950748"></a>Join the Samba Server to the PDC Domain</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> +Enter the following command to make the Samba server join the +PDC domain, where <i class="replaceable"><tt>DOMAIN</tt></i> is the name of +your Windows domain and <i class="replaceable"><tt>Administrator</tt></i> is +a domain user who has administrative privileges in the domain. +</p><p> +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>/usr/local/samba/bin/net rpc join -S PDC -U Administrator</tt></b> +</p><p> +The proper response to the command should be: “<span class="quote">Joined the domain +<i class="replaceable"><tt>DOMAIN</tt></i></span>” where <i class="replaceable"><tt>DOMAIN</tt></i> +is your DOMAIN name. +</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2950807"></a>Starting and Testing the <b class="command">winbindd</b> Daemon</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> +Eventually, you will want to modify your Samba startup script to +automatically invoke the winbindd daemon when the other parts of +Samba start, but it is possible to test out just the Winbind +portion first. To start up Winbind services, enter the following +command as root: +</p><p> +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>/usr/local/samba/bin/winbindd</tt></b> +</p><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p> +The above assumes that Samba has been installed in the <tt class="filename">/usr/local/samba</tt> +directory tree. You may need to search for the location of Samba files if this is not the +location of <b class="command">winbindd</b> on your system. +</p></div><p> +Winbindd can now also run in “<span class="quote">dual daemon modei</span>”. This will make it +run as two processes. The first will answer all requests from the cache, +thus making responses to clients faster. The other will +update the cache for the query that the first has just responded. +The advantage of this is that responses stay accurate and are faster. +You can enable dual daemon mode by adding <tt class="option">-B</tt> to the commandline: +</p><p> +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>/usr/local/samba/bin/winbindd -B</tt></b> +</p><p> +I'm always paranoid and like to make sure the daemon is really running. +</p><p> +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>ps -ae | grep winbindd</tt></b> +</p><p> +This command should produce output like this, if the daemon is running you would expect +to see a report something like this: +</p><pre class="screen"> +3025 ? 00:00:00 winbindd +</pre><p> +Now, for the real test, try to get some information about the users on your PDC: +</p><p> +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>/usr/local/samba/bin/wbinfo -u</tt></b> +</p><p> +This should echo back a list of users on your Windows users on +your PDC. For example, I get the following response: +</p><pre class="screen"> + CEO+Administrator + CEO+burdell + CEO+Guest + CEO+jt-ad + CEO+krbtgt + CEO+TsInternetUser +</pre><p> +Obviously, I have named my domain “<span class="quote">CEO</span>” and my <a class="indexterm" name="id2950988"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>winbind separator</tt></i> is “<span class="quote">+</span>”. +</p><p> +You can do the same sort of thing to get group information from the PDC: +</p><pre class="screen"> +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>/usr/local/samba/bin/wbinfo -g</tt></b> + CEO+Domain Admins + CEO+Domain Users + CEO+Domain Guests + CEO+Domain Computers + CEO+Domain Controllers + CEO+Cert Publishers + CEO+Schema Admins + CEO+Enterprise Admins + CEO+Group Policy Creator Owners +</pre><p> +The function <b class="command">getent</b> can now be used to get unified +lists of both local and PDC users and groups. Try the following command: +</p><p> +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>getent passwd</tt></b> +</p><p> +You should get a list that looks like your <tt class="filename">/etc/passwd</tt> +list followed by the domain users with their new UIDs, GIDs, home +directories and default shells. +</p><p> +The same thing can be done for groups with the command: +</p><p> +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>getent group</tt></b> +</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2951103"></a>Fix the init.d Startup Scripts</h4></div></div><div></div></div><div class="sect4" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h5 class="title"><a name="id2951110"></a>Linux</h5></div></div><div></div></div><p> +The <span class="application">winbindd</span> daemon needs to start up after the <span class="application">smbd</span> and <span class="application">nmbd</span> daemons are running. +To accomplish this task, you need to modify the startup scripts of your system. +They are located at <tt class="filename">/etc/init.d/smb</tt> in Red Hat Linux and they are located in +<tt class="filename">/etc/init.d/samba</tt> in Debian Linux. Edit your +script to add commands to invoke this daemon in the proper sequence. My +startup script starts up <span class="application">smbd</span>, <span class="application">nmbd</span>, and <span class="application">winbindd</span> from the +<tt class="filename">/usr/local/samba/bin</tt> directory directly. The <b class="command">start</b> +function in the script looks like this: +</p><pre class="programlisting"> +start() { + KIND="SMB" + echo -n $"Starting $KIND services: " + daemon /usr/local/samba/bin/smbd $SMBDOPTIONS + RETVAL=$? + echo + KIND="NMB" + echo -n $"Starting $KIND services: " + daemon /usr/local/samba/bin/nmbd $NMBDOPTIONS + RETVAL2=$? + echo + KIND="Winbind" + echo -n $"Starting $KIND services: " + daemon /usr/local/samba/bin/winbindd + RETVAL3=$? + echo + [ $RETVAL -eq 0 -a $RETVAL2 -eq 0 -a $RETVAL3 -eq 0 ] && \ + touch /var/lock/subsys/smb || RETVAL=1 + return $RETVAL +} +</pre><p>If you would like to run winbindd in dual daemon mode, replace +the line : +</p><pre class="programlisting"> + daemon /usr/local/samba/bin/winbindd +</pre><p> + +in the example above with: + +</p><pre class="programlisting"> + daemon /usr/local/samba/bin/winbindd -B +</pre><p>. +</p><p> +The <b class="command">stop</b> function has a corresponding entry to shut down the +services and looks like this: +</p><pre class="programlisting"> +stop() { + KIND="SMB" + echo -n $"Shutting down $KIND services: " + killproc smbd + RETVAL=$? + echo + KIND="NMB" + echo -n $"Shutting down $KIND services: " + killproc nmbd + RETVAL2=$? + echo + KIND="Winbind" + echo -n $"Shutting down $KIND services: " + killproc winbindd + RETVAL3=$? + [ $RETVAL -eq 0 -a $RETVAL2 -eq 0 -a $RETVAL3 -eq 0 ] && \ + rm -f /var/lock/subsys/smb + echo "" + return $RETVAL +} +</pre></div><div class="sect4" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h5 class="title"><a name="id2951286"></a>Solaris</h5></div></div><div></div></div><p> +Winbind does not work on Solaris 9, see <link linkend="winbind-solaris9"> for details. +</p><p> +On Solaris, you need to modify the <tt class="filename">/etc/init.d/samba.server</tt> startup script. It +usually only starts smbd and nmbd but should now start winbindd, too. If you have Samba installed in +<tt class="filename">/usr/local/samba/bin</tt>, the file could contains something like this: +</p><pre class="programlisting"> + ## + ## samba.server + ## + + if [ ! -d /usr/bin ] + then # /usr not mounted + exit + fi + + killproc() { # kill the named process(es) + pid=`/usr/bin/ps -e | + /usr/bin/grep -w $1 | + /usr/bin/sed -e 's/^ *//' -e 's/ .*//'` + [ "$pid" != "" ] && kill $pid + } + + # Start/stop processes required for Samba server + + case "$1" in + + 'start') + # + # Edit these lines to suit your installation (paths, workgroup, host) + # + echo Starting SMBD + /usr/local/samba/bin/smbd -D -s \ + /usr/local/samba/smb.conf + + echo Starting NMBD + /usr/local/samba/bin/nmbd -D -l \ + /usr/local/samba/var/log -s /usr/local/samba/smb.conf + + echo Starting Winbind Daemon + /usr/local/samba/bin/winbindd + ;; + + 'stop') + killproc nmbd + killproc smbd + killproc winbindd + ;; + + *) + echo "Usage: /etc/init.d/samba.server { start | stop }" + ;; + esac +</pre><p> +Again, if you would like to run Samba in dual daemon mode, replace: +</p><pre class="programlisting"> + /usr/local/samba/bin/winbindd +</pre><p> +in the script above with: +</p><pre class="programlisting"> + /usr/local/samba/bin/winbindd -B +</pre><p> +</p></div><div class="sect4" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h5 class="title"><a name="id2951403"></a>Restarting</h5></div></div><div></div></div><p> +If you restart the <span class="application">smbd</span>, <span class="application">nmbd</span>, and <span class="application">winbindd</span> daemons at this point, you +should be able to connect to the Samba server as a Domain Member just as +if you were a local user. +</p></div></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2951439"></a>Configure Winbind and PAM</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> +If you have made it this far, you know that <b class="command">winbindd</b> and Samba are working +together. If you want to use Winbind to provide authentication for other +services, keep reading. The PAM configuration files need to be altered in +this step. (Did you remember to make backups of your original +<tt class="filename">/etc/pam.d</tt> files? If not, do it now.) +</p><p> +You will need a PAM module to use winbindd with these other services. This +module will be compiled in the <tt class="filename">../source/nsswitch</tt> directory +by invoking the command: +</p><p> +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>make nsswitch/pam_winbind.so</tt></b> +</p><p> +from the <tt class="filename">../source</tt> directory. The +<tt class="filename">pam_winbind.so</tt> file should be copied to the location of +your other PAM security modules. On my RedHat system, this was the +<tt class="filename">/lib/security</tt> directory. On Solaris, the PAM security +modules reside in <tt class="filename">/usr/lib/security</tt>. +</p><p> +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>cp ../samba/source/nsswitch/pam_winbind.so /lib/security</tt></b> +</p><div class="sect4" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h5 class="title"><a name="id2951551"></a>Linux/FreeBSD-specific PAM configuration</h5></div></div><div></div></div><p> +The <tt class="filename">/etc/pam.d/samba</tt> file does not need to be changed. I +just left this file as it was: +</p><pre class="programlisting"> + auth required /lib/security/pam_stack.so service=system-auth + account required /lib/security/pam_stack.so service=system-auth +</pre><p> +The other services that I modified to allow the use of Winbind +as an authentication service were the normal login on the console (or a terminal +session), telnet logins, and ftp service. In order to enable these +services, you may first need to change the entries in +<tt class="filename">/etc/xinetd.d</tt> (or <tt class="filename">/etc/inetd.conf</tt>). +Red Hat Linux 7.1 and later uses the new xinetd.d structure, in this case you need +to change the lines in <tt class="filename">/etc/xinetd.d/telnet</tt> +and <tt class="filename">/etc/xinetd.d/wu-ftp</tt> from +</p><pre class="programlisting"> + enable = no +</pre><p> +to: +</p><pre class="programlisting"> + enable = yes +</pre><p> +For ftp services to work properly, you will also need to either +have individual directories for the domain users already present on +the server, or change the home directory template to a general +directory for all domain users. These can be easily set using +the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> global entry +<a class="indexterm" name="id2951653"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>template homedir</tt></i>. +</p><p> +The <tt class="filename">/etc/pam.d/ftp</tt> file can be changed +to allow Winbind ftp access in a manner similar to the +samba file. My <tt class="filename">/etc/pam.d/ftp</tt> file was +changed to look like this: +</p><pre class="programlisting"> +auth required /lib/security/pam_listfile.so item=user sense=deny \ + file=/etc/ftpusers onerr=succeed +auth sufficient /lib/security/pam_winbind.so +auth required /lib/security/pam_stack.so service=system-auth +auth required /lib/security/pam_shells.so +account sufficient /lib/security/pam_winbind.so +account required /lib/security/pam_stack.so service=system-auth +session required /lib/security/pam_stack.so service=system-auth +</pre><p> +The <tt class="filename">/etc/pam.d/login</tt> file can be changed nearly the +same way. It now looks like this: +</p><pre class="programlisting"> +auth required /lib/security/pam_securetty.so +auth sufficient /lib/security/pam_winbind.so +auth sufficient /lib/security/pam_UNIX.so use_first_pass +auth required /lib/security/pam_stack.so service=system-auth +auth required /lib/security/pam_nologin.so +account sufficient /lib/security/pam_winbind.so +account required /lib/security/pam_stack.so service=system-auth +password required /lib/security/pam_stack.so service=system-auth +session required /lib/security/pam_stack.so service=system-auth +session optional /lib/security/pam_console.so +</pre><p> +In this case, I added the </p><pre class="programlisting">auth sufficient /lib/security/pam_winbind.so</pre><p> +lines as before, but also added the </p><pre class="programlisting">required pam_securetty.so</pre><p> +above it, to disallow root logins over the network. I also added a +</p><pre class="programlisting">sufficient /lib/security/pam_unix.so use_first_pass</pre><p> +line after the <b class="command">winbind.so</b> line to get rid of annoying +double prompts for passwords. +</p></div><div class="sect4" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h5 class="title"><a name="id2951787"></a>Solaris-specific configuration</h5></div></div><div></div></div><p> +The <tt class="filename">/etc/pam.conf</tt> needs to be changed. I changed this file so my Domain +users can logon both locally as well as telnet. The following are the changes +that I made. You can customize the <tt class="filename">pam.conf</tt> file as per your requirements, but +be sure of those changes because in the worst case it will leave your system +nearly impossible to boot. +</p><pre class="programlisting"> +# +#ident "@(#)pam.conf 1.14 99/09/16 SMI" +# +# Copyright (c) 1996-1999, Sun Microsystems, Inc. +# All Rights Reserved. +# +# PAM configuration +# +# Authentication management +# +login auth required /usr/lib/security/pam_winbind.so +login auth required /usr/lib/security/$ISA/pam_UNIX.so.1 try_first_pass +login auth required /usr/lib/security/$ISA/pam_dial_auth.so.1 try_first_pass +# +rlogin auth sufficient /usr/lib/security/pam_winbind.so +rlogin auth sufficient /usr/lib/security/$ISA/pam_rhosts_auth.so.1 +rlogin auth required /usr/lib/security/$ISA/pam_UNIX.so.1 try_first_pass +# +dtlogin auth sufficient /usr/lib/security/pam_winbind.so +dtlogin auth required /usr/lib/security/$ISA/pam_UNIX.so.1 try_first_pass +# +rsh auth required /usr/lib/security/$ISA/pam_rhosts_auth.so.1 +other auth sufficient /usr/lib/security/pam_winbind.so +other auth required /usr/lib/security/$ISA/pam_UNIX.so.1 try_first_pass +# +# Account management +# +login account sufficient /usr/lib/security/pam_winbind.so +login account requisite /usr/lib/security/$ISA/pam_roles.so.1 +login account required /usr/lib/security/$ISA/pam_UNIX.so.1 +# +dtlogin account sufficient /usr/lib/security/pam_winbind.so +dtlogin account requisite /usr/lib/security/$ISA/pam_roles.so.1 +dtlogin account required /usr/lib/security/$ISA/pam_UNIX.so.1 +# +other account sufficient /usr/lib/security/pam_winbind.so +other account requisite /usr/lib/security/$ISA/pam_roles.so.1 +other account required /usr/lib/security/$ISA/pam_UNIX.so.1 +# +# Session management +# +other session required /usr/lib/security/$ISA/pam_UNIX.so.1 +# +# Password management +# +#other password sufficient /usr/lib/security/pam_winbind.so +other password required /usr/lib/security/$ISA/pam_UNIX.so.1 +dtsession auth required /usr/lib/security/$ISA/pam_UNIX.so.1 +# +# Support for Kerberos V5 authentication (uncomment to use Kerberos) +# +#rlogin auth optional /usr/lib/security/$ISA/pam_krb5.so.1 try_first_pass +#login auth optional /usr/lib/security/$ISA/pam_krb5.so.1 try_first_pass +#dtlogin auth optional /usr/lib/security/$ISA/pam_krb5.so.1 try_first_pass +#other auth optional /usr/lib/security/$ISA/pam_krb5.so.1 try_first_pass +#dtlogin account optional /usr/lib/security/$ISA/pam_krb5.so.1 +#other account optional /usr/lib/security/$ISA/pam_krb5.so.1 +#other session optional /usr/lib/security/$ISA/pam_krb5.so.1 +#other password optional /usr/lib/security/$ISA/pam_krb5.so.1 try_first_pass +</pre><p> +I also added a <i class="parameter"><tt>try_first_pass</tt></i> line after the <tt class="filename">winbind.so</tt> +line to get rid of annoying double prompts for passwords. +</p><p> +Now restart your Samba and try connecting through your application that you +configured in the pam.conf. +</p></div></div></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2951948"></a>Conclusion</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p>The Winbind system, through the use of the Name Service +Switch, Pluggable Authentication Modules, and appropriate +Microsoft RPC calls have allowed us to provide seamless +integration of Microsoft Windows NT domain users on a +UNIX system. The result is a great reduction in the administrative +cost of running a mixed UNIX and NT network.</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2951967"></a>Common Errors</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p>Winbind has a number of limitations in its current + released version that we hope to overcome in future + releases:</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Winbind is currently only available for + the Linux, Solaris, AIX, and IRIX operating systems, although ports to other operating + systems are certainly possible. For such ports to be feasible, + we require the C library of the target operating system to + support the Name Service Switch and Pluggable Authentication + Modules systems. This is becoming more common as NSS and + PAM gain support among UNIX vendors.</p></li><li><p>The mappings of Windows NT RIDs to UNIX IDs + is not made algorithmically and depends on the order in which + unmapped users or groups are seen by Winbind. It may be difficult + to recover the mappings of RID to UNIX ID mapping if the file + containing this information is corrupted or destroyed.</p></li><li><p>Currently the Winbind PAM module does not take + into account possible workstation and logon time restrictions + that may be set for Windows NT users, this is + instead up to the PDC to enforce.</p></li></ul></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2952021"></a>NSCD Problem Warning</h3></div></div><div></div></div><div class="warning" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Warning</h3><p> + Do not under any circumstances run <b class="command">nscd</b> on any system + on which <b class="command">winbindd</b> is running. + </p></div><p> + If <b class="command">nscd</b> is running on the UNIX/Linux system, then + even though NSSWITCH is correctly configured it will not be possible to resolve + domain users and groups for file and directory controls. + </p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2952067"></a>Winbind Is Not Resolving Users and Groups</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>“<span class="quote"> + My <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file is correctly configured. I have specified + <a class="indexterm" name="id2952087"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>idmap uid</tt></i> = 12000, + and <a class="indexterm" name="id2952101"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>idmap gid</tt></i> = 3000-3500 + and <b class="command">winbind</b> is running. When I do the following it all works fine. + </span>”</p><pre class="screen"> +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>wbinfo -u</tt></b> +MIDEARTH+maryo +MIDEARTH+jackb +MIDEARTH+ameds +... +MIDEARTH+root + +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>wbinfo -g</tt></b> +MIDEARTH+Domain Users +MIDEARTH+Domain Admins +MIDEARTH+Domain Guests +... +MIDEARTH+Accounts + +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>getent passwd</tt></b> +root:x:0:0:root:/root:/bin/bash +bin:x:1:1:bin:/bin:/bin/bash +... +maryo:x:15000:15003:Mary Orville:/home/MIDEARTH/maryo:/bin/false +</pre><p>“<span class="quote"> +But the following command just fails: +<pre class="screen"> +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>chown maryo a_file</tt></b> +chown: `maryo': invalid user +</pre> +This is driving me nuts! What can be wrong? +</span>”</p><p> +Same problem as the one above. +Your system is likely running <b class="command">nscd</b>, the name service +caching daemon. Shut it down, do not restart it! You will find your problem resolved. +</p></div></div></div><div class="navfooter"><hr><table width="100%" summary="Navigation footer"><tr><td width="40%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="VFS.html">Prev</a> </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="u" href="optional.html">Up</a></td><td width="40%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="AdvancedNetworkManagement.html">Next</a></td></tr><tr><td width="40%" align="left" valign="top">Chapter 20. Stackable VFS modules </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="h" href="index.html">Home</a></td><td width="40%" align="right" valign="top"> Chapter 22. Advanced Network Management</td></tr></table></div></body></html> |